Ricoh D129, D130 Service Manual. Www.s Manuals.com. Manual

User Manual: Multi-functional printer Ricoh Aficio MP 5002SP - Service manuals and Schematics, Disassembly / Assembly. Free.

Open the PDF directly: View PDF PDF.
Page Count: 1402

DownloadRicoh D129, D130 - Service Manual. Www.s-manuals.com. Manual
Open PDF In BrowserView PDF
D129/D130
SERVICE MANUAL

It is the reader's responsibility when discussing the information contained
within this document to maintain a level of confidentiality that is in the best
interest of Ricoh Americas Corporation and its member companies.
NO PART OF THIS DOCUMENT MAY BE REPRODUCED IN ANY
FASHION AND DISTRIBUTED WITHOUT THE PRIOR
PERMISSION OF RICOH AMERICAS CORPORATION.
All product names, domain names or product illustrations, including
desktop images, used in this document are trademarks, registered
trademarks or the property of their respective companies.
They are used throughout this book in an informational or editorial fashion
only and for the benefit of such companies. No such use, or the use of
any trade name, or web site is intended to convey endorsement or other
affiliation with Ricoh products.

 2012 RICOH Americas Corporation. All rights reserved.

WARNING
The Service Manual contains information
regarding service techniques, procedures,
processes and spare parts of office equipment
distributed by Ricoh Americas Corporation.
Users of this manual should be either service
trained or certified by successfully completing a
Ricoh Technical Training Program.
Untrained and uncertified users utilizing
information contained in this service manual to
repair or modify Ricoh equipment risk personal
injury, damage to property or loss of warranty
protection.

Ricoh Americas Corporation

LEGEND
COMPANY

PRODUCT
CODE

LANIER

RICOH

SAVIN

D129-17

MP 4002

Aficio MP 4002

MP 4002

D129-57

MP 4002SP

Aficio MP 4002SP

MP 4002SP

D130-17

MP 5002

Aficio MP 5002

MP 5002

D130-57

MP 5002SP

Aficio MP 5002SP

MP 5002SP

DOCUMENTATION HISTORY
REV. NO.
*

DATE
01/2012

COMMENTS
Original Printing

D129/D130
TABLE OF CONTENTS
1. PRODUCT INFORMATION ........................................................... 1-1
1.1 SPECIFICATIONS ..................................................................................... 1-1
1.2 MACHINE CONFIGURATION ................................................................... 1-2
1.2.1 COPIER ............................................................................................ 1-2
1.3 GUIDANCE FOR THOSE WHO ARE FAMILIAR WITH PREDECESSOR
PRODUCTS ..................................................................................................... 1-5
1.4 OVERVIEW ................................................................................................ 1-6
1.4.1 COMPONENT LAYOUT ................................................................... 1-6
1.4.2 PAPER PATH ................................................................................... 1-8
1.4.3 DRIVE LAYOUT ............................................................................... 1-9

2. INSTALLATION ............................................................................. 2-1
2.1 INSTALLATION REQUIREMENTS ............................................................ 2-1
2.1.1 ENVIRONMENT ............................................................................... 2-2
2.1.2 MACHINE LEVEL ............................................................................. 2-2
2.1.3 MINIMUM SPACE REQUIREMENTS ............................................... 2-3
2.1.4 POWER REQUIREMENTS .............................................................. 2-3
2.2 INSTALLATION FLOW CHART ................................................................. 2-4
2.3 MAIN MACHINE INSTALLATION .............................................................. 2-5
2.3.1 ACCESSORY CHECK ...................................................................... 2-5
2.3.2 INSTALLATION PROCEDURE ........................................................ 2-7
Preliminary Procedures ........................................................................ 2-7
PCDU (Photoconductor and Development Unit) ................................ 2-10
Toner Bottle........................................................................................ 2-13
Paper Trays........................................................................................ 2-13
Initialize TD Sensor and Developer .................................................... 2-14
Set Paper Size for Paper Trays.......................................................... 2-14
Electrical Total Counter ...................................................................... 2-14
Exposure Glass Cleaner .................................................................... 2-15
Settings Relevant to the Service Contract .......................................... 2-15
Data Overwrite Security ..................................................................... 2-16
HDD Encryption.................................................................................. 2-17
SM

i

D129/D130

App 2 Me Setting (SP model only) ..................................................... 2-18
2.3.3 MOVING THE MACHINE ................................................................ 2-19
2.3.4 TRANSPORTING THE MACHINE .................................................. 2-19
2.4 PAPER FEED UNIT INSTALLATION (D580)........................................... 2-20
2.4.1 ACCESSORY CHECK .................................................................... 2-20
2.4.2 INSTALLATION PROCEDURE ...................................................... 2-20
2.5 2000-SHEET LCT INSTALLATION (D581) .............................................. 2-23
2.5.1 ACCESSORY CHECK .................................................................... 2-23
2.5.2 INSTALLATION PROCEDURE ...................................................... 2-23
2.6 1200-SHEET LCT INSTALLATION (D631) .............................................. 2-26
2.6.1 COMPONENT CHECK ................................................................... 2-26
2.6.2 INSTALLATION PROCEDURE ...................................................... 2-27
2.7 ARDF INSTALLATION (D630) ................................................................. 2-29
2.7.1 COMPONENT CHECK ................................................................... 2-29
2.7.2 INSTALLATION PROCEDURE ...................................................... 2-29
2.8 1-BIN TRAY UNIT INSTALLATION (D632).............................................. 2-33
2.8.1 COMPONENT CHECK ................................................................... 2-33
2.8.2 INSTALLATION PROCEDURE ...................................................... 2-34
2.9 BRIDGE UNIT INSTALLATION (D634).................................................... 2-36
2.9.1 COMPONENT CHECK ................................................................... 2-36
2.9.2 INSTALLATION PROCEDURE ...................................................... 2-37
2.10 3000/2000-SHEET (BOOKLET) FINISHER (D636/D637) .................. 2-41
2.10.1 ACCESSORY CHECK ................................................................ 2-41
2.10.2 INSTALLATION PROCEDURE .................................................. 2-42
Support Tray Installation .................................................................... 2-45
2.11 PUNCH UNIT INSTALLATION (D570) ............................................... 2-46
2.11.1 COMPONENT CHECK ............................................................... 2-46
2.11.2 INSTALLATION PROCEDURE .................................................. 2-47
2.12 PLATEN COVER (D593).................................................................... 2-52
2.13 1000-SHEET FINISHER (D588)......................................................... 2-53
2.13.1 ACCESSORY CHECK ................................................................ 2-53
2.13.2 INSTALLATION PROCEDURE .................................................. 2-54
2.14 SIDE TRAY (D635) ............................................................................ 2-57
2.14.1 COMPONENT CHECK ............................................................... 2-57
2.14.2 INSTALLATION PROCEDURE .................................................. 2-58
2.15 INTERNAL SHIFT TRAY (D633) ........................................................ 2-62
2.15.1 COMPONENT CHECK ............................................................... 2-62
2.15.2 INSTALLATION PROCEDURE .................................................. 2-62
D129/D130

ii

SM

Rev. 04/23/2012

2.16 KEY COUNTER INSTALLATION ....................................................... 2-64
2.16.1 INSTALLATION PROCEDURE .................................................. 2-64
2.17 KEY COUNTER INTERFACE UNIT INSTALLATION ........................ 2-66
2.17.1 INSTALLATION PROCEDURE .................................................. 2-66
2.18 TRAY HEATER .................................................................................. 2-68
2.18.1 INSTALLATION PROCEDURE .................................................. 2-68
2.19 TRAY HEATER (OPTIONAL PAPER FEED UNIT) ............................ 2-70
2.19.1 COMPONENT CHECK ............................................................... 2-70
2.19.2 INSTALLATION PROCEDURE .................................................. 2-71
For installing the tray heater in the D580 (Two-tray paper feed unit) . 2-71
For installing the tray heater in the D581 (LCT) ................................. 2-73
2.20 HDD INSTALLATION (D640-11) ........................................................ 2-76
2.20.1 COMPONENT CHECK ............................................................... 2-76
2.20.2 INSTALLATION PROCEDURE .................................................. 2-77
After Installing the HDD ...................................................................... 2-78
2.21 COPY DATA SECURITY UNIT (B829) .............................................. 2-79
2.21.1 COMPONENT CHECK ............................................................... 2-79
2.21.2 INSTALLATION PROCEDURE .................................................. 2-80
User Tool Setting ............................................................................... 2-81
Check All Connections ....................................................................... 2-82
2.22 BROWSER UNIT TYPE I ................................................................... 2-83
2.22.1 INSTALLATION PROCEDURE .................................................. 2-83
2.22.2 UPDATE PROCEDURE ............................................................. 2-85
2.23 CARD READER BRACKET TYPE C3352 (D593) ............................. 2-87
2.23.1 COMPONENT CHECK ............................................................... 2-87
2.23.2 INSTALLATION PROCEDURE .................................................. 2-88
2.34 FAX CONNECTION UNIT TYPE A (D629-31) (REMOTE FAX) ........ 2-94

3. PREVENTIVE MAINTENANCE .................................................... 3-1
3.1 PM TABLES ............................................................................................... 3-1

4. REPLACEMENT AND ADJUSTMENT ........................................ 4-1
4.1 GENERAL CAUTIONS .............................................................................. 4-1
4.1.1 LASER UNIT ..................................................................................... 4-1
4.1.2 USED TONER .................................................................................. 4-1
4.2 SPECIAL TOOLS AND LUBRICANTS ...................................................... 4-2
4.2.1 SPECIAL TOOLS ............................................................................. 4-2
4.2.2 LUBRICANTS ................................................................................... 4-2
4.3 EXTERIOR COVERS ................................................................................ 4-3
4.3.1 FRONT DOOR, UPPER AND LOWER INNER COVER ................... 4-3
SM

iii

D129/D130

Rev. 09/11/2012

Upper Inner Cover ................................................................................ 4-3
Lower Inner Cover ................................................................................ 4-3
4.3.2 LEFT COVER ................................................................................... 4-4
4.3.3 REAR COVER .................................................................................. 4-4
4.3.4 RIGHT REAR COVER ...................................................................... 4-5
4.3.5 FRONT RIGHT COVER.................................................................... 4-6
4.3.6 OPERATION PANEL & LCD ............................................................ 4-6
4.3.7 PAPER EXIT COVER ..................................................................... 4-10
4.3.8 INNER TRAY .................................................................................. 4-11
4.4 SCANNER ............................................................................................... 4-12
4.4.1 EXPOSURE GLASS ....................................................................... 4-12
4.4.2 SCANNER EXTERIOR PANELS AND OPERATION PANEL ......... 4-12
Operation panel .................................................................................. 4-12
Scanner left cover .............................................................................. 4-12
Scanner right cover ............................................................................ 4-13
Scanner front cover ............................................................................ 4-13
Scanner rear cover ............................................................................. 4-13
4.4.3 LENS BLOCK ASSEMBLY ............................................................. 4-14
When reassembling ........................................................................... 4-15
4.4.4 ORIGINAL SIZE SENSOR .............................................................. 4-15
4.4.5 EXPOSURE LAMP ......................................................................... 4-17
Chromaticity rank adjustment ............................................................. 4-18
4.4.6 SCANNER HP SENSOR/PLATEN COVER SENSOR.................... 4-20
Scanner HP Sensor ........................................................................... 4-20
Platen Cover Sensor .......................................................................... 4-21
4.4.7 SCANNER MOTOR ........................................................................ 4-22
4.4.8 SCANNER MOTOR DRIVE BOARD .............................................. 4-24
4.4.9 FRONT SCANNER WIRE............................................................... 4-24
Reassembling the Front Scanner Wire............................................... 4-26
4.4.10 REAR SCANNER WIRE ............................................................. 4-29
Reassembling the Rear Scanner Wire ............................................... 4-30
4.5 LASER UNIT ............................................................................................ 4-31
4.5.1 CAUTION DECAL LOCATIONS ..................................................... 4-31
4.5.2 LASER UNIT ................................................................................... 4-31
4.5.3 POLYGON MIRROR MOTOR ........................................................ 4-33
4.5.4 LASER SYNCHRONIZATION DETECTOR .................................... 4-33
4.5.5 LD UNIT .......................................................................................... 4-34
Laser Beam Pitch Adjustment ............................................................ 4-34
D129/D130

iv

SM

4.6 PCDU ....................................................................................................... 4-37
4.6.1 PCDU (PHOTOCONDUCTOR AND DEVELOPMENT UNIT) ........ 4-37
Reinstallation...................................................................................... 4-37
4.6.2 DRUM ............................................................................................. 4-38
Re-installation .................................................................................... 4-39
4.6.3 PICK-OFF PAWLS.......................................................................... 4-40
Pick-off Pawl Position Adjustment ...................................................... 4-40
4.6.4 CHARGE ROLLER AND CLEANING ROLLER .............................. 4-41
4.6.5 DRUM CLEANING BLADE ............................................................. 4-42
Re-installation .................................................................................... 4-42
4.6.6 ID SENSOR .................................................................................... 4-43
4.7 DEVELOPMENT ...................................................................................... 4-44
4.7.1 DEVELOPMENT FILTER ............................................................... 4-44
4.7.2 DEVELOPMENT ROLLER ............................................................. 4-44
Cleaning Procedure............................................................................ 4-45
4.7.3 DEVELOPER .................................................................................. 4-46
4.7.4 TD SENSOR ................................................................................... 4-49
4.8 TRANSFER.............................................................................................. 4-50
4.8.1 TRANSFER BELT UNIT ................................................................. 4-50
4.8.2 TRANSFER BELT........................................................................... 4-51
4.8.3 TONER OVERFLOW SENSOR ...................................................... 4-53
4.8.4 TRANSFER BELT CLEANING BLADE/TONER OVERFLOW SENSOR
4-53
Transfer Belt Cleaning Blade ............................................................. 4-53
Toner Overflow Sensor ...................................................................... 4-54
4.9 PAPER FEED .......................................................................................... 4-55
4.9.1 PAPER FEED UNIT ........................................................................ 4-55
Tray 1 and Tray 2 ............................................................................... 4-55
4.9.2 PICK-UP, FEED AND SEPARATION ROLLERS............................ 4-56
Tray 1 and Tray 2 ............................................................................... 4-56
4.9.3 TRAY LIFT MOTOR........................................................................ 4-57
4.9.4 RELAY, TRAY LIFT, PAPER END AND PAPER FEED SENSORS 4-58
Tray 1 and Tray 2 ............................................................................... 4-58
4.9.5 REGISTRATION SENSOR ............................................................. 4-59
Reinstall the registration sensor ......................................................... 4-60
4.10 FUSING.............................................................................................. 4-61
4.10.1 FUSING UNIT ............................................................................. 4-61
4.10.2 WEB ROLLER UNIT ................................................................... 4-62
SM

v

D129/D130

4.10.3 BRAKE PAD ............................................................................... 4-62
4.10.4 WEB HOLDER ROLLER AND WEB ROLLERS ......................... 4-63
Installing a new web holder roller ....................................................... 4-65
Installing new web rollers ................................................................... 4-65
4.10.5 PRESSURE ROLLER CLEANING ROLLER .............................. 4-66
4.10.6 THERMOSTATS ......................................................................... 4-67
4.10.7 THERMISTOR ............................................................................ 4-68
4.10.8 HOT ROLLER STRIPPERS........................................................ 4-69
4.10.9 FUSING LAMPS ......................................................................... 4-70
4.10.10 HOT ROLLER AND PRESSURE ROLLER .............................. 4-71
4.11 PAPER EXIT ...................................................................................... 4-72
4.11.1 PAPER EXIT UNIT ..................................................................... 4-72
4.11.2 FUSING EXIT, PAPER OVERFLOW, AND PAPER EXIT SENSORS
4-73
4.11.3 JUNCTION JAM SENSOR ......................................................... 4-73
4.11.4 PAPER EXIT MOTOR ................................................................ 4-74
4.12 DUPLEX ............................................................................................. 4-75
4.12.1 DUPLEX UNIT ............................................................................ 4-75
4.12.2 RIGHT DOOR COVER ............................................................... 4-77
4.12.3 DUPLEX DOOR SENSOR.......................................................... 4-77
4.12.4 DUPLEX ENTRANCE SENSOR ................................................. 4-78
4.12.5 DUPLEX EXIT SENSOR ............................................................ 4-79
4.12.6 DUPLEX/BY-PASS MOTOR....................................................... 4-81
4.12.7 DUPLEX INVERTER MOTOR .................................................... 4-82
4.13 BY-PASS ............................................................................................ 4-84
4.13.1 BY-PASS PAPER SIZE SENSOR/BY-PASS PAPER LENGTH
SENSOR .................................................................................................. 4-84
When reinstalling the by-pass paper size sensor ............................... 4-86
4.13.2 BY-PASS PAPER END SENSOR .............................................. 4-87
4.13.3 BY-PASS PICK-UP, FEED AND SEPARATION ROLLER, TORQUE
LIMITER ................................................................................................... 4-87
4.13.4 BY-PASS FEED CLUTCH .......................................................... 4-88
4.14 DRIVE AREA ..................................................................................... 4-89
4.14.1 PAPER FEED CLUTCH.............................................................. 4-89
Tray 1 and Tray 2 ............................................................................... 4-89
4.14.2 DEVELOPMENT PADDLE MOTOR ........................................... 4-90
4.14.3 TRANSFER/DEVELOPMENT MOTOR ...................................... 4-90
4.14.4 DRUM MOTOR ........................................................................... 4-91
D129/D130

vi

SM

4.14.5 FUSING MOTOR ........................................................................ 4-91
4.14.6 WEB MOTOR ............................................................................. 4-92
4.14.7 PAPER FEED MOTOR ............................................................... 4-92
4.14.8 TRANSFER BELT CONTACT MOTOR ...................................... 4-93
4.14.9 REGISTRATION MOTOR........................................................... 4-93
4.14.10 TONER SUPPLY MOTOR ........................................................ 4-94
4.15 ELECTRICAL COMPONENTS .......................................................... 4-95
4.15.1 CONTROLLER UNIT .................................................................. 4-95
4.15.2 HDD UNIT................................................................................... 4-96
Before Replacing the HDD Unit .......................................................... 4-96
Replacement Procedure..................................................................... 4-96
After installing the new HDD unit ........................................................ 4-97
4.15.3 CONTROLLER BOARD ............................................................. 4-98
Before Replacing the Controller Board in the Model without HDD ..... 4-98
Replacement Procedure..................................................................... 4-98
When Installing the New Controller Board........................................ 4-100
4.15.4 AFTER INSTALLING THE CONTROLLER BOARD ................. 4-101
4.15.5 MOTHER BOARD .................................................................... 4-101
4.15.6 BCU .......................................................................................... 4-103
When installing the new BCU ........................................................... 4-104
4.15.7 IPU ............................................................................................ 4-104
4.15.8 IOB ........................................................................................... 4-105
When installing a new IOB ............................................................... 4-105
4.15.9 PSU .......................................................................................... 4-105
4.15.10 HIGH VOLTAGE POWER SUPPLY ....................................... 4-106
4.15.11 FUSING EXHAUST FAN ........................................................ 4-106
When installing the fusing exhaust fan ............................................. 4-106
4.15.12 CONTROLLER FAN ............................................................... 4-107
When installing the controller fan ..................................................... 4-107
4.15.13 NVRAM ON THE BCU BOARD .............................................. 4-108
Replacement procedure for the NVRAM on the BCU Board ............ 4-108
4.16 COPY ADJUSTMENTS: PRINTING/SCANNING ............................. 4-109
4.16.1 OVERVIEW .............................................................................. 4-109
4.16.2 PRINTING................................................................................. 4-109
Registration - Leading Edge/Side-to-Side ........................................ 4-109
Blank Margin .................................................................................... 4-111
Main Scan Magnification .................................................................. 4-112
Parallelogram Image Adjustment ..................................................... 4-112
SM

vii

D129/D130

4.16.3 SCANNING ............................................................................... 4-114
Registration: Platen Mode ................................................................ 4-114
Magnification .................................................................................... 4-115
4.16.4 ADF .......................................................................................... 4-116
Registration ...................................................................................... 4-116
4.16.5 TOUCH SCREEN CALIBRATION ............................................ 4-117

5. SERVICE TABLES ....................................................................... 5-1
5.1 SERVICE PROGRAM MODE .................................................................... 5-1
5.1.1 SERVICE PROGRAM MODE OPERATION ..................................... 5-1
Service Mode Lock/Unlock ................................................................... 5-1
5.1.2 SERVICE PROGRAM MODE TABLES ............................................ 5-2
Service Table Key ................................................................................ 5-2
5.2 SERVICE PROGRAM MODE TABLES ..................................................... 5-3
5.2.1 SP TABLES ...................................................................................... 5-3
5.3 MAIN SP TABLES-1 .................................................................................. 5-4
5.3.1 SP1-XXX: FEED ............................................................................... 5-4
5.4 MAIN SP TABLES-2 ................................................................................ 5-13
5.4.1 SP2-XXX: DRUM ............................................................................ 5-13
5.5 MAIN SP TABLES-3 ................................................................................ 5-18
5.5.1 SP3-XXX: PROCESS ..................................................................... 5-18
5.6 MAIN SP TABLES-4 ................................................................................ 5-19
5.6.1 SP4-XXX: SCANNER ..................................................................... 5-19
5.7 MAIN SP TABLES-5 ................................................................................ 5-41
5.7.1 SP5-XXX: MODE ............................................................................ 5-41
5.8 MAIN SP TABLES-6 .............................................................................. 5-108
5.8.1 SP6-XXX: PERIPHERALS............................................................ 5-108
5.9 MAIN SP TABLES-7 .............................................................................. 5-117
5.9.1 SP7-XXX: DATA LOG................................................................... 5-117
5.10 MAIN SP TABLES-8 ........................................................................ 5-132
5.10.1 SP8-XXX: DATA LOG 2 ........................................................... 5-132
5.11 MAIN SP TABLES-9 ........................................................................ 5-183
5.11.1 INPUT CHECK TABLE ............................................................. 5-183
Copier............................................................................................... 5-183
Table 1: Paper Height Sensor .......................................................... 5-186
Table 2: Paper Size Switch .............................................................. 5-187
Table 3: Paper Size (By-pass Table) ............................................... 5-188
APS Original Size Detection............................................................. 5-189
3000/2000-Sheet (Booklet) Finisher (D636/D637) ........................... 5-190
D129/D130

viii

SM

1000-Sheet Finisher (D588) ............................................................. 5-193
5.11.2 OUTPUT CHECK TABLE ......................................................... 5-194
Copier............................................................................................... 5-194
1000-Sheet Finisher (D588) ............................................................. 5-199
3000 /2000-Sheet (Booklet) Finisher (D636/D637) .......................... 5-200
5.11.3 PRINTER SERVICE TABLES................................................... 5-202
SP1-XXX (Service Mode) ................................................................. 5-202
5.11.4 SCANNER SERVICE TABLES ................................................. 5-210
SP1-xxx (System and Others) .......................................................... 5-210
SP2-XXX (Scanning-image quality) ................................................. 5-211
5.12 UPDATING THE FIRMWARE .......................................................... 5-212
5.12.1 BEFORE YOU BEGIN .............................................................. 5-212
5.12.2 UPDATING FIRMWARE ........................................................... 5-213
Preparation....................................................................................... 5-213
Updating Procedure ......................................................................... 5-213
Error Messages ................................................................................ 5-215
Firmware Update Error ..................................................................... 5-215
Recovery after Power Loss .............................................................. 5-215
5.12.3 HANDLING FIRMWARE UPDATE ERRORS ........................... 5-216
Error Message Table ........................................................................ 5-216
5.13 UPLOADING/DOWNLOADING NVRAM DATA ............................... 5-218
5.13.1 UPLOADING NVRAM DATA (SP5-824) ................................... 5-218
5.13.2 DOWNLOADING NVRAM DATA (SP5-825)............................. 5-219
5.14 SELF-DIAGNOSTIC MODE ............................................................. 5-221
5.14.1 SELF-DIAGNOSTIC MODE AT POWER ON ........................... 5-221
5.14.2 SELF-DIAGNOSTIC TEST FLOW ............................................ 5-222
5.14.3 DETAILED SELF-DIAGNOSTIC MODE ................................... 5-223
5.14.4 EXECUTING DETAILED SELF-DIAGNOSIS ........................... 5-223
5.15 USING THE DEBUG LOG ............................................................... 5-224
5.15.1 OVERVIEW .............................................................................. 5-224
5.15.2 SWITCHING ON AND SETTING UP SAVE DEBUG LOG ....... 5-224
4-Digit Entries for Keys 1 to 10......................................................... 5-226
Key to Acronyms .............................................................................. 5-227
Retrieving the Debug Log from the HDD .......................................... 5-228
Recording Errors Manually ............................................................... 5-228

6. TROUBLESHOOTING ................................................................. 6-1
6.1 SERVICE CALL CONDITIONS .................................................................. 6-1
6.1.1 SUMMARY ....................................................................................... 6-1
SM

ix

D129/D130

6.1.2 SC CODE DESCRIPTIONS .............................................................. 6-2
SC Tables: SC1xx ................................................................................ 6-3
SC Tables: SC2xx ................................................................................ 6-6
SC Tables: SC3xx ................................................................................ 6-8
SC Tables: SC4xx .............................................................................. 6-11
SC Tables: SC5xx .............................................................................. 6-12
SC Tables: SC6xx .............................................................................. 6-21
SC Tables: SC7xx .............................................................................. 6-30
SC Tables: SC8xx .............................................................................. 6-42
SC Tables: SC9xx .............................................................................. 6-65
6.2 ELECTRICAL COMPONENT DEFECTS ................................................. 6-71
6.2.1 SENSORS ...................................................................................... 6-71
6.2.2 SWITCHES ..................................................................................... 6-75
6.3 BLOWN FUSE CONDITIONS .................................................................. 6-76
6.4 FUSES ..................................................................................................... 6-77

D129/D130

x

SM

Read This First
Safety Notices
Important Safety Notices
Prevention of Physical Injury
1.

Before disassembling or assembling parts of the copier and peripherals, make sure that the
copier power cord is unplugged.

2.

The wall outlet should be near the copier and easily accessible.

3.

Note that some components of the copier and the paper tray unit are supplied with
electrical voltage even if the main power switch is turned off.

4.

If any adjustment or operation check has to be made with exterior covers off or open while
the main switch is turned on, keep hands away from electrified or mechanically driven
components.

5.

If the Start key is pressed before the copier completes the warm-up period (the Start key
starts blinking red and green alternatively), keep hands away from the mechanical and the
electrical components as the copier starts making copies as soon as the warm-up period is
completed.

6.

The inside and the metal parts of the fusing unit become extremely hot while the copier is
operating. Be careful to avoid touching those components with your bare hands.


To prevent a fire or explosion, keep the machine away from flammable liquids, gases,
and aerosols.

Health Safety Conditions
1.

Toner and developer are non-toxic, but if you get either of them in your eyes by accident, it
may cause temporary eye discomfort. Immediately wash eyes with plenty of water. If
unsuccessful, get medical attention.

2.

This machine, which uses a high voltage power source, can generate ozone gas. High
ozone density is harmful to human health. Therefore, the machine must be installed in a
well-ventilated room.

Observance of Electrical Safety Standards
1.

This machine and its peripherals must be serviced by a customer service representative
who has completed the training course on those models.

2.

The NVRAM on the system control board has a lithium battery which can explode if
replaced incorrectly. Replace the NVRAM only with an identical one. The manufacturer
recommends replacing the entire NVRAM. Do not recharge or burn this battery. Used
NVRAM must be handled in accordance with local regulations.

Handling Toner


Work carefully when removing paper jams or replacing toner bottles or cartridges to avoid
spilling toner on clothing or the hands.



If toner is inhaled, immediately gargle with large amounts of cold water and move to a well
ventilated location. If there are signs of irritation or other problems, seek medical attention.



If toner gets on the skin, wash immediately with soap and cold running water.



If toner gets into the eyes, flush the eyes with cold running water or eye wash. If there are
signs of irritation or other problems, seek medical attention.



If toner is swallowed, drink a large amount of cold water to dilute the ingested toner. If there
are signs of any problem, seek medical attention.



If toner spills on clothing, wash the affected area immediately with soap and cold water.
Never use hot water! Hot water can cause toner to set and permanently stain fabric.



Always store toner and developer supplies such as toner and developer packages,
cartridges, and bottles (including used toner and empty bottles and cartridges) out of the
reach of children.



Always store fresh toner supplies or empty bottles or cartridges in a cool, dry location that is
not exposed to direct sunlight.


Do not use the cleaner to suck spilled toner (including used toner). Sucked toner may
cause firing or explosion due to electrical contact flickering inside the cleaner. However,
it is possible to use the cleaner designed for dust explosion-proof purpose. If toner is
spilled over the floor, sweep up spilled toner slowly and clean remainder with wet cloth.

Safety and Ecological Notes for Disposal
1.

Do not incinerate toner bottles or used toner. Toner dust may ignite suddenly when
exposed to an open flame.

2.

Dispose of used toner, the maintenance unit which includes developer or the organic
photoconductor in accordance with local regulations. (These are non-toxic supplies.)

3.

Dispose of replaced parts in accordance with local regulations.

4.

When keeping used lithium batteries in order to dispose of them later, do not put more than
100 batteries per sealed box. Storing larger numbers or not sealing them apart may lead to
chemical reactions and heat build-up.

Laser Safety
The Center for Devices and Radiological Health (CDRH) prohibits the repair of laser-based
optical units in the field. The optical housing unit can only be repaired in a factory or at a
location with the requisite equipment. The laser subsystem is replaceable in the field by a
qualified Customer Engineer. The laser chassis is not repairable in the field. Customer
engineers are therefore directed to return all chassis and laser subsystems to the factory or
service depot when replacement of the optical subsystem is required.


Use of controls, or adjustment, or performance of procedures other than those
specified in this manual may result in hazardous radiation exposure.



Turn off the main switch before attempting any of the procedures in the Laser Optics
Housing Unit section. Laser beams can seriously damage your eyes.

CAUTION MARKING:

Conventions in this Manual
Symbols and Abbreviations
This manual uses several symbols and abbreviations. The meaning of those symbols and
abbreviations are as follows:

See or Refer to
Clip ring
Screw
Connector
Clamp
E-ring
SEF

Short Edge Feed

LEF

Long Edge Feed

Cautions, Notes, etc.
The following headings provide special information:


FAILURE TO OBEY WARNING INFORMATION COULD RESULT IN SERIOUS
INJURY OR DEATH.



Obey these guidelines to ensure safe operation and prevent minor injuries.



This information provides tips and advice about how to best service the machine.

PRODUCT INFORMATION
R E V I S I O N H I S T O RY
Pag e

Date

Ad d ed / Upd ated / New
None

Specifications

Product
Information

1. PRODUCT INFORMATION
1.1 SPECIFICATIONS
See "Appendices" for the following information:


General Specifications



Optional Equipment

SM

1-1

D129/D130

Machine Configuration

1.2 MACHINE CONFIGURATION
1.2.1 COPIER

Key: Symbol: U: Unique option, C: Option also used with other products

Item

Copier

D129/D130

Callout

Key

D129/D130

[1]

-

D129/D130

Platen Cover (See Note 1)

[2]

C

D593

ARDF (See Note 1)

[3]

C

D630

2000-sheet LCT

[4]

C

D581

1200-sheet LCT

[5]

C

D631

Two-Tray Paper Feed Unit

[6]

C

D580

1-Bin Tray

[7]

U

D632

1-2

Machine Code

SM

Machine Configuration

Callout

Key

Bridge Unit

[8]

C

D634

Internal Shift Tray

[9]

U

D633

Side Tray

[10]

U

D635

1000-sheet Finisher (See Note 2)

[11]

C

D588

[12]

C

D637

[13]

C

D636

-Punch Unit (See Note 3)

-

C

-Punch Unit (See Note 3)

-

C

-Punch Unit (See Note 3)

-

C

Key Counter Bracket

-

C

A674

HDD (for basic model only)

-

U

D640

Copy Data Security Unit

-

C

B829

Fax Option

-

U

D629

G3 Interface Unit

-

U

D629

SAF Memory

-

C

G578

Handset

-

C

D645

Fax Communication Unit

-

U

D629

Printer/Scanner Unit

-

U

D641

Printer Unit

-

U

D641

Scanner Scanner Upgrade Unit

-

U

D641

-

U

D641

2000-Sheet Booklet Finisher (See
Note 2)
3000-Sheet Finisher (See Note 2)

Fax

Printer/

PostScript3 Unit

SM

1-3

Machine Code
Product
Information

Item

D570-00 (2/3-hole)
NA
D570-01 (2/4-hole)
EU
D570-02 (4-hole)
Scandinavia

D129/D130

Machine Configuration

Item

Callout

Key

Machine Code

IPDS Unit

-

U

D641

Gigabit Ethernet

-

C

G874

IEEE 1284

-

C

B679

IEEE 802.11a/g, g

-

C

D377

Bluetooth

-

C

D566

Memory Unit 512 MB

-

C

D594

File Format Converter

-

C

D377

Browser Unit

-

U

D640

VM Card

-

C

D640

Netware

-

U

D629

NOTE:
1.

The ARDF and platen cover cannot be installed together.

2.

The finisher requires the bridge unit and two-tray paper feed unit or 2000-sheet LCT. The
1000-sheet finisher and 2000/3000-sheet (Booklet) finisher cannot be installed together.

3.

The punch unit requires the 2000/3000-sheet (Booklet) finisher.

D129/D130

1-4

SM

1.3 GUIDANCE FOR THOSE WHO ARE FAMILIAR WITH
PREDECESSOR PRODUCTS
The D129/D130 series are successor models to the D091/D092 series. If you have experience
with the predecessor products, the following information will be of help when you read this
manual.
Different Points from Predecessor Products

D129/D130

D091/D092

Controller Type

GW+ Controller

GW Controller

Operation Panel

Tilt Operation Panel Type

Stationary Operation Panel

Includes USB/SD slot (not all

Type

functions can be used in Basic
models)
Scanner Lamp

LED

Xenon

Safety Shut Down

Available

Not Available

Standard (SP model only)

Option

Function
PDF Direct

Included in Printer/Scanner.
App2Me

Standard (SP model only)

Standard (SP model only)

Included in Printer/Scanner,

Included in VM SD Card.

Printer SD Card.
Users who bought the VM card
can download App2Me from the
Web Site.
Data Overwrite

Standard

Option

Standard

Option

Security
HDD Encryption

SM

1-5

D129/D130

Product
Information

Guidance for Those Who are Familiar with Predecessor Products

Overview

1.4 OVERVIEW
1.4.1 COMPONENT LAYOUT

1

Exposure Glass

21

By-pass Feed Roller

2

2nd Mirror

22

By-pass Separation Roller

3

1st Mirror

23

Duplex/by-pass transport roller

4

Exposure Lamp

24

Upper Relay Belt

5

Original Length Sensors

25

Feed Roller

6

Scanner Motor

26

Separation Roller

D129/D130

1-6

SM

7

Lens

27

Pick-up Roller

8

SBU

28

Bottom Plate

9

Junction Gate 2

29

Development Unit

10

Duplex Inverter Gate

30

Charge Roller

11

Duplex Entrance Sensor

31

F

12

Duplex Inverter Roller

32

Barrel Toroidal Lens (BTL)

13

Hot Roller

33

Polygonal Mirror Motor

14

Pressure Roller

34

Laser Unit

15

Transfer Belt Cleaning Blade

35

Toner Bottle Holder

16

Duplex Transport Roller

36

Junction Gate 1

17

Transfer Belt

37

Exit Roller

18

OPC Drum

38

Paper Exit Sensor

19

Registration Roller

39

3rd Mirror

20

By-pass Pick-up Roller

40

Scanner HP Sensor

SM

1-7

Product
Information

Overview

Mirror

D129/D130

Overview

1.4.2 PAPER PATH

1

ARDF

2

Interchange Unit

3

Duplex Unit

4

By-pass Tray

5

Large Capacity Tray (LCT: 1200-sheet)

6

Paper Tray Unit

7

Two-Tray Finisher

8

Bridge Unit

9

1-Bin Tray

D129/D130

1-8

SM

Overview

Product
Information

1.4.3 DRIVE LAYOUT

1

Scanner Motor

10

Paper Feed Clutch 1

2

Fusing Motor

11

Feed Motor

3

Web Motor

12

By-pass Paper Feed Clutch

4

Transfer/Development Motor

13

Registration Motor

5

Drum Motor

14

Duplex/By-pass Motor

6

Development Paddle Motor

15

Transfer Belt Contact Motor

7

Tray Lift Motor 1

16

Duplex Inverter Motor

8

Tray Lift Motor 2

17

Paper Exit Motor

9

Paper Feed Clutch 2

SM

1-9

D129/D130

INSTALLATION
R E V I S I O N H I S T O RY
P a ge

Date

A d de d /U pd at e d /N ew

83 ~ 93

04/20/2012

Added Browser Unit Type I

94 ~ 102

04/23/2012

Added Fax Connection Unit Type A (D629-31)

Installation Requirements

2. INSTALLATION



Never turn off the main power switch when the power LED is lit or flashing. To avoid
damaging the hard disk or memory, press the operation power switch to switch the
power off, wait for the power LED to go off, and then switch the main power switch off.



Install the machine in a safe place for keeping security.



Make sure that the operation instructions are kept at a customer's hand.



The main power LED lights or flashes while the platen cover or ARDF is open, while
the main machine is communicating with a facsimile or the network server, or while the
machine is accessing the hard disk or memory for reading or writing data.



Rating voltage for peripherals: Make sure to plug the cables into the correct
sockets.

SM

2-1

D129/D130

Installation

2.1 INSTALLATION REQUIREMENTS

Installation Requirements

2.1.1 ENVIRONMENT

Temperature Range:

10°C to 32°C (50°F to 90°F)

Humidity Range:

15% to 80% RH

Ambient Illumination:

Less than 1,500 lux (do not expose to direct sunlight.)

Ventilation:

Room air should turn at least 30 m3/hr/person

Ambient Dust:

Less than 0.10 mg/m3 (2.7 x 10/6 oz/yd3)

1.

Avoid areas exposed to sudden temperature changes:
1) Areas directly exposed to cool air from an air conditioner.
2) Areas directly exposed to heat from a heater.

2.

Do not place the machine where it will be exposed to corrosive gases.

3.

Do not install the machine at any location over 2,000 m (6,500 ft.) above sea level.

4.

Place the main machine on a strong and level base. Inclination on any side should
be no more than 5 mm (0.2").

5.

Do not place the machine where it may be subjected to strong vibrations.

2.1.2 MACHINE LEVEL

Front to back:

Within 5 mm (0.2") of level

Right to left:

Within 5 mm (0.2") of level

D129/D130

2-2

SM

Installation Requirements

2.1.3 MINIMUM SPACE REQUIREMENTS

Installation

Place the main machine near the power source, providing clearance as shown:



Front [A]: Over 75 cm (29.6")



Left [B]: 10 cm (4")



Rear [C]: 10 cm (4")



Right [D]: 55 cm (21.7")


The 75 cm (29.6") recommended for the space at the front is for pulling out the paper
tray only. If the operator stands at the front of the main machine, more space is
required.

2.1.4 POWER REQUIREMENTS


Make sure that the wall outlet is near the main machine and easily accessible. Make
sure the plug is firmly inserted in the outlet.

1.



Avoid multi-wiring.



Be sure to ground the machine.

Input voltage level:
North America 120 V, 60 Hz: More than 12.5 A
Europe/Asia 220 V to 240V, 50 Hz/60 Hz: more than 7 A

2.

Permissible voltage fluctuation: 10% to 15%

3.

Never set anything on the power cord.

SM

2-3

D129/D130

Installation Flow Chart

2.2 INSTALLATION FLOW CHART
The following flow chart shows how to install the optional units more efficiently.

Bridge Unit: Needed for the finishers.
Paper Tray Unit or LCT 2000-sheet: Needed for the LCT 1200-sheet and finishers.

D129/D130

2-4

SM

Main Machine Installation

2.3 MAIN MACHINE INSTALLATION
2.3.1 ACCESSORY CHECK

Description

1

2

Q'ty

Decal – Energy Save (-91, -61, -17, -57, -18, -58, -27, -67,
-29, -69, -19, -59, -28, -68)
Rating plate (-17, -18, -19, -21, -27, -28, -29, -57, -58, -59,
-61, -67, -69, -68)

1

1

3

Decal – VERMONT (-91, -17, -57, -18, -58)

1

4

Model Name Decal (-91, -92, 17, -57)

1

5

Decal – WEEE (-27, -67)

1

6

Main SW Decal

1

7

Decal – Eco Label (-21, -61)

1

8

Decal – Rohs (-21, -61)

1

9

Decal – Rohs date(-21, -61)

1

10 Decal – Certificates (-21, -61)

2

11 Decal – LASERCLASS1 (-19, -59, -28, -68, -21, -61)

1

12 Decal – Impoter (-19, -59)

1

13 Decal – SDK (-57, -58, -67, -69, -59, -68, -61)

1

14 Decal – Caution - Copy

1

15 Emblem Cover

1

16 Emblem

1

17 Decal – Brand

1

18 Warranty (-21, -61)

1

SM

Installation

Check the quantity and condition of the accessories in the box against the following list:

2-5

D129/D130

Main Machine Installation

Description

Q'ty

19 Quick Reference Guide – Safety (-27, -67)

20

21

Sheet – Communication management – Blank (-27, -67,
-19, -59)
Decal – Paper Tray (-91, -17, -57, -18, -58, -27, -67, -29,
-69, -19, -59, -28, -68, -21, -61)

1

1

1

22 Decal – Caution – Original (-91, -17, -57, -18, -58)

1

23 Sheet – EMC – Traceability (-27, -67)

1

24 Sheet – Name – Tel (-21, -61)

1

25 Stamp (-91, -17, -57, -18, -58, -)

1

26 Exposure Glass Cleaning Cloth

1

27 Cloth Holder

1

28 Ferrite Core

1

29

Sheet – Exposure Glass (-91, -17, -18, -19, -21, -27, -28,
-29, -57, -58, -59, -61, -67, -69, -68)

30 Power Supply Cord

31

1

1

CD-ROM: Operation Instruction (-91, -92, -17, -18, -21, -27,
-28, -29, -57, -58, -67, -69, -68)

1

32 CD-ROM: Driver (-57, -58, -67, -69, -68)

1

33 CD-ROM: Operation Instruction/Driver (-19, -59, -21, -61)

1

Operation Instruction – Read This First
34 (-91, -92, -17, -18, -19, -21, -27, -29, -57, -58, -59, -61, -67,

1

-69)
Operation Instruction – User Guide
35 (-91, -92, -17, -18, -19, -21, -27, -29, -57, -58, -59, -61, -67,

1

-69)
36 Sheet – EULA (-57, -58, -67, -68, -69, -19, -59, -21, -61)

1

37 Sheet – Caution (-57, -58, -67, -68, -69, -68, -61)

1

D129/D130

2-6

SM

Main Machine Installation

Description

Q'ty

CD-ROM: Operation Instruction - App 2 Me
(-57, -58, -67, -69, -59)
Quick Reference Guide - App 2 Me

39

1

1

(-57, -58, -69, -59)

40 Quick Reference Guide – Start Up (-27, -67)

1

41 Sheet – Notes – Manual – CD (-19, -59, -21, -61)

1

Installation

38

2.3.2 INSTALLATION PROCEDURE
Preliminary Procedures
Put the machine on the paper feed unit or the LCT first if you will install an optional paper feed
unit or the optional LCT at the same time. Then install the machine and other options.


Keep the shipping retainers after you install the machine. You may need them in the
future if you transport the machine to another location.

1.

Remove all the tapes and retainers on the machine.

2.

Remove all the tapes and retainers in trays 1 and 2, and then take out the power cord from
tray 1 (if applicable).

SM

2-7

D129/D130

Main Machine Installation

3.

Open the right door [A].

4.

Remove the two stoppers [A] from the fusing unit.

5.

Remove the scanner unit stay [A].

D129/D130

2-8

SM

Installation

Main Machine Installation

6.

Open the front door [A], and then remove the jam location sheet [B].

7.

Keep the scanner unit stay [A] inside the front door [B].

8.

Reattach the jam location sheet.

9.

Close the front door.

SM

2-9

D129/D130

Main Machine Installation

10. Attach the correct brand decal to the machine [A].
11. Attach the correct emblem and the cover to the front door [B] of the machine, if the emblem
is not attached.


If you want to change the emblem that has been already attached, remove the
panel with a small screwdriver, and then install the correct emblem.

12. Attach the correct paper tray number and size decals to the paper trays [C].

13. Pull out the feeler [A] for the output tray full detection mechanism.

PCDU (Photoconductor and Development Unit)

1.

Open the front door.

2.

Open the right door [1].

3.

Release the lock lever [2].

4.

Pull out the PCDU [3] and place it on a clean flat surface.

5.

Spread a large piece of paper on a flat surface.

D129/D130

2-10

SM

Main Machine Installation



Make sure the area is free of pins, paper clips, staples, etc. to avoid attraction to

Installation

the magnetic development roller.

6.

Remove the opening cap [4], and then install it in the opening [5] of the PCDU.

7.

Open the PCDU [6] (

8.

Remove the entrance seal plate [7] (

9.

Remove the development roller unit [8], and set it on the paper.

SM

x 2).

x 2).

2-11

D129/D130

Main Machine Installation

10. Pour the developer [9] into the development unit.


The developer lot number is embossed on the end of the developer package. Do
not discard the package until you have recorded the lot number. (

p.4-46

"Developer")
1) Pour approximately 1/3 of the developer evenly along the length of the development unit.
2) Rotate the drive gear [10] to work the developer into the unit.
3) Repeat until all the developer is in the development unit.
4) Continue to turn the drive gear until the developer is even with the top of the unit.
11. Put the opening cap [4] back in its original place.
12. Reassemble the PCDU.
13. Re-install the PCDU.

D129/D130

2-12

SM

Main Machine Installation

Installation

Toner Bottle

1.

Open the front door.

2.

Turn the toner bottle holder lever [1] counterclockwise, push down the lever [2], and then
pull out the toner bottle holder [3].

3.

Hold the toner bottle [5] horizontally, and shake it 5 or 6 times.

4.

Unscrew the bottle cap [4] and set the bottle [5] in the holder.

5.

Push the toner bottle holder into the main machine until it locks in place.

6.

Turn the toner bottle holder lever [1] clockwise to lock it.

7.

Close the front door.

Paper Trays
1.

Open the 1st paper tray, and then press down on the right side of the lock switch to unlock
the side fences.

2.

Press in on the sides of the fence release, and slide the side fences to the appropriate mark
for the paper size.

3.

Pinch the sides of the end fence and move it to the appropriate mark for the paper size,
then load the paper.

4.

Check the position of the stack.


Confirm that there is no gap between the stack and the side fences. If you see a gap,
adjust the position of the side fences.

5.

Press down the lock to lock the side fences.

6.

Repeat this procedure to load paper in the 2nd paper tray.

SM

2-13

D129/D130

Main Machine Installation

Initialize TD Sensor and Developer
1.

Connect the main machine to the power outlet, switch on the main machine, and wait for
the fusing unit to warm up.

2.

Enter Copy SP Mode.

3.

Press SP Direct to highlight "SP Direct", enter 2801, and then press

4.

When the message prompts you to enter the lot number of the developer, enter the 7-digit
lot number, press

.

on the touch-panel. Press [Yes], and then press [Execute]. This

initializes the TD sensor. It takes 60 to 90 sec.


The lot number is printed on the end of the developer package. Recording the lot
number could help troubleshoot problems later. If the lot number is unavailable,
enter any seven-digit number.

5.

Press SP Direct to highlight "SP Direct" and enter 2805, press

, and then press

"Execute" on the touch-panel. This initializes the developer.
6.

Press "Exit" twice to return to the copy window.

Set Paper Size for Paper Trays
1.

Press User Tools/Counter

2.

On the touch panel, press "System Settings".

3.

Press the "Tray Paper Settings" tab.

4.

Press the button for the tray to change.

5.

Change the setting and press the [OK] button.

6.

Repeat for each tray installed.

7.

Press Exit twice to return to the main display


.

The 1st, 2nd, 3rd, and 4th paper trays are provided with the paper size switches. The
detected paper size by the paper size switches has priority over the UP settings.
However, if you change the "Auto Detect" with the UP setting, you can select the paper
size.

8.

Check the copy quality and machine operation.

Electrical Total Counter
The electrical total counter no longer requires initialization. The new incrementing counter is set
to "0" at the factory.

D129/D130

2-14

SM

Main Machine Installation

Installation

Exposure Glass Cleaner

1.

Attach the exposure glass cleaner holder [1] to the left side of the machine.

2.

Place the exposure glass cleaner [2] inside the holder.


The exposure glass cleaner is used to clean the ARDF exposure glass, the glass strip
to the left of the large exposure glass.

Settings Relevant to the Service Contract
Change the necessary settings for the following SP modes if the customer has made a service
contract.

Item

A3/11" x 17"
double
counting

SP No.

Function

Default

Specifies whether the counter is
SP5-104-001

doubled for A3/11" x 17" paper.

"No": Single

(SSP)

When you have to change this

counting

setting, contact your supervisor.
5812-002 programs the service
station fax number. The number is

Service Tel.

SP5-812-001

No. Setting

through 004

printed on the counter list when
the meter charge mode is
selected. This lets the user fax the
counter data to the service
station.

SM

2-15

D129/D130

Main Machine Installation

Data Overwrite Security
Do the following procedure if a customer wants to use this function.
1.

Do SP5-878-1(Option Setup - Data Overwrite Security) and touch [EXECUTE].

2.

Go out of the SP mode, turn off the operation switch, then turn off the main power switch.

3.

Turn the machine power on.

4.

Press [User Tools] and select System Setting > Administrator Tools > Auto Erase Memory
Setting > On

5.

Exit from User Tools mode.

6.

Check the display and make sure that the overwrite erase icon [A] is displayed.

7.

Make a Sample Copy.

8.

Check the overwrite erase icon.


The icon [B] changes to [C] when job data is stored in the hard disk.



The icon goes back to its usual shape [B] after this function has completed a data
overwrite operation to the hard disk.

9.

Do SP5990-005 (SP print mode - Diagnostic Report).

10. Look at the report:


Under "[ROM No./Firmware Version]" check the number and version number listed for
"HDD Format Option".



Under "[Loading Program]" check the option number and version number listed for
"GW_zoffy".



These two version numbers should be identical.

11. Exit SP mode.

D129/D130

2-16

SM

Main Machine Installation

HDD Encryption
1.

Do SP5-878-2 (Option Setup - Encryption Option) and touch [EXECUTE]

2.

Go out of the SP mode, turn off the operation switch, then turn off the main power switch.

3.

Turn the machine power on.

4.

Push [User Tools] and select System Setting > Administrator Tools > Machine Data
Encryption Setting.

5.

Press [Encrypt].

6.

Select the data to be carried over to the hard disk and not to be reset
To carry all of the data over to the hard disk, select [All data].To carry over only the machine
setting data, select [File System Data Only]. To reset all of the data, select [Format All
Data].

7.

Press the [Start] Key.
The encryption key for backup data is printed.

SM

2-17

D129/D130

Installation

Do the following procedure if a customer wants to use this function.

Main Machine Installation

App 2 Me Setting (SP model only)
SP models have VM and "App 2 Me" built in. Do the following procedure if a customer wants to
use "App 2 Me".
1.

Press "User Tools" key on the operation panel.

2.

Touch the "Extended Feature Settings" button twice.

3.

Touch the "App 2 Me" line in the Startup Setting tab.

4.

Touch the "Extended Feature Info" tab on the LCD.

5.

Touch the "App 2 Me" line.

6.

Set the setting of "Auto Start" to "On".

7.

Touch the "Exit" button.

8.

Exit the "User Tools" settings.

Update Procedure for App 2 Me Provider
1.

Push the "User/Tools" key.

2.

If an administrator setting is registered for the machine, steps 2 and 3 are required.
Otherwise, skip to step 4.

3.

Push the "Login/Logout" key.

4.

Login with the administrator user name and password.

5.

Touch "Extended Feature Settings" twice on the LCD.

6.

Touch all the applications. Then, the status will be changed to "Stop".

7.

Turn off the machine. And then remove the VM Card.

8.

Prepare newer App 2 Me Provider zip file from Firmware Download Center. Unzip the zip
file. (The folder name is "337051920".) And then copy the App 2 Me Provider folder in the
specified path of VM card. The path is "SD_Card Drive¥ sdk¥dsdk¥dist¥337051920" as
shown above.

D129/D130

2-18

SM

Main Machine Installation

9.

Turn the SD card label face to the rear of the machine. Then push it slowly into Slot 2
(Lower Slot) until you hear a click.

10. Turn on the main power switch.
11. Press the "User Tools" key on the operation panel.
12. Touch the "Extended Feature Settings" button twice.
Installation

13. Touch the "Extended Feature Info" tab on LCD.
14. Touch the "App2Me" line.
15. Set the setting of the "Auto Start" to "On".
16. Touch the "Exit" button.
17. Exit the "User Tools/Counter" settings.

2.3.3 MOVING THE MACHINE
This section shows you how to manually move the machine from one floor to another floor. See
the section "Transporting the Machine" if you have to pack the machine and move it a longer
distance.
1.

Remove all trays from the optional paper feed unit or LCT.

2.3.4 TRANSPORTING THE MACHINE
1.

Do SP 4806-001 to move the scanner carriage from the home position. This prevents dust
from falling into the machine during transportation.

2.

Make sure there is no paper left in the paper trays. Then fix down the bottom plates with a
sheet of paper and tape.

3.

SM

Do one of the following:


Attach shipping tape to the covers and doors.



Shrink-wrap the machine tightly.

2-19

D129/D130

Paper Feed Unit Installation (D580)

2.4 PAPER FEED UNIT INSTALLATION (D580)
2.4.1 ACCESSORY CHECK
Check the quantity and condition of the accessories against the following list.

No.

Description

Q'ty

1

Screw (M4x10)

2

2

Screw with Spring Washer (M4x10)

1

3

Securing Bracket

2

2.4.2 INSTALLATION PROCEDURE


Unplug the machine power cord before starting the following procedure.



The handles of the main machine for lifting must be inserted inside the machine and
locked unless these handles are used for the installation or relocation of the main
machine.



You need two or more persons to lift the copier. The copier is highly unstable when
lifted by one person, and may cause human injury or property damage.

D129/D130

2-20

SM

Paper Feed Unit Installation (D580)

Remove all tape on the paper feed unit.

2.

Remove the paper trays and remove all tape and padding.

3.

Grasp the handle [A] and grips [B] of the machine.

4.

Lift the copier and install it on the paper feed unit [C].

Installation

1.



You need two or more persons to lift the copier.



Hold the handle and grips of the machine when you lift and move the machine.

5.

Remove trays 1 and 2 of the machine.

6.

Fasten the spring washer screw [A].

7.

Reinstall all trays.

SM

2-21

D129/D130

Paper Feed Unit Installation (D580)

8.

Attach the securing brackets [B] (

x 1 each; M4x10).

9.

Attach the appropriate paper tray number decal [A] and paper size decal [B] to the line [C]
on each tray of the paper feed unit.


The paper tray number and size sheet is in the accessory box of the main
machine.

10. Lock the caster stoppers for the front two casters under the paper feed unit.
11. Load paper into the paper feed unit.
12. Turn on the main power switch of the machine.
13. Check the paper feed unit operation and copy quality.

D129/D130

2-22

SM

2000-sheet LCT Installation (D581)

2.5 2000-SHEET LCT INSTALLATION (D581)
2.5.1 ACCESSORY CHECK

No.

Description

Installation

Check the quantity and condition of the accessories against the following list.

Q'ty

1

Screw (M4x10)

2

2

Screw with Spring washer (M4x10)

1

3

Securing bracket

2

2.5.2 INSTALLATION PROCEDURE


Unplug the machine power cord before starting the following procedure.



The handles of the main machine for lifting must be inserted inside the machine and
locked, unless these handles are used for the installation or relocation of the main
machine.



You need two or more persons to lift the copier. The copier is highly unstable when
lifted by one person, and may cause human injury or property damage.

1.

SM

Remove the strips of tape.

2-23

D129/D130

2000-sheet LCT Installation (D581)

2.

Grasp the handle [A] and grips [B] of the machine.

3.

Lift the copier and install it on the LCT [C].


You need two or more persons to lift the copier.



Hold the handle [A] and grips [B] of the machine when you lift and move the
machine.

4.

Remove trays 1 and 2 of the machine.

5.

Fasten the Spring Washer Screw [A].

6.

Reinstall all trays.

7.

Attach the securing brackets [B] (

D129/D130

x 1 each; M4x10).

2-24

SM

Installation

2000-sheet LCT Installation (D581)

8.

Attach the appropriate paper tray number decal [A] and paper size decal [B] to the line [C]
on the tray of the LCT.


The paper tray number and size sheet is in the accessory box of the main
machine.

9.

Lock the caster stoppers for the front two casters under the paper feed unit.

10. Load paper into the LCT.
11. Turn on the main power switch of the machine.
12. Check the LCT operation and copy quality.

SM

2-25

D129/D130

1200-sheet LCT Installation (D631)

2.6 1200-SHEET LCT INSTALLATION (D631)
2.6.1 COMPONENT CHECK
Check the quantity and condition of the components against the following list.

No.

Description

Q'ty

1

Front Bracket

1

2

Rear Bracket

1

3

Stud Screw

4

4

Joint Pin

2

5

LCT

1

D129/D130

2-26

SM

1200-sheet LCT Installation (D631)

2.6.2 INSTALLATION PROCEDURE
Unplug the main machine power cord before starting the following procedure.



The Paper Tray Unit (D580) or LCT 2000-sheet (D581) must be installed before
Installation



installing this 1200-sheet LCT.

1.

Unpack the LCT and remove the tapes.

2.

Remove the stand covers [A].

3.

Release the locks [B] of the front and rear caster stands.

4.

Remove the caster stands [C].

5.

Remove the paper path cover [A], connector cover [B] and six hole covers [C].

SM

2-27

D129/D130

1200-sheet LCT Installation (D631)

6.

Insert the joint pins [A].

7.

Attach the front [B] and rear brackets [C]. (

8.

Pull out the front and rear rails [A], and then hang them on each bracket [B].

9.

Connect the LCT cable [C] to the main machine.

x2 each)

10. Slide the LCT [D] into the main machine.
11. Make sure that the front and rear sides of the LCT are closely attached to the main
machine.

D129/D130

2-28

SM

ARDF Installation (D630)

2.7 ARDF INSTALLATION (D630)
2.7.1 COMPONENT CHECK

No.

Description

Installation

Check the quantity and condition of the accessories against the following list.

Q'ty

1

ARDF

1

2

Attention Decal Sheet – Top Cover

1

3

Stamp

1

4

Knob Screw

2

5

Stud Screw

2

6

Platen Sheet

1

2.7.2 INSTALLATION PROCEDURE

1.

SM

Unplug the copier power cord before starting the following procedure.

Remove the all tapes and shipping retainers.

2-29

D129/D130

ARDF Installation (D630)

2.

Insert the two stud screws [A] on the top of the machine.

3.

Mount the ARDF [A] by aligning the screw keyholes [B] of the ARDF support plate over the
stud screws.

4.

Slide the ARDF toward the front of the machine.

5.

Secure the ARDF with the two knob screws [C].

6.

Connect the I/F cable [D] to the machine.

D129/D130

2-30

SM

Installation

ARDF Installation (D630)

7.

Remove two screws [A] from the bottom of the ARDF.

8.

Remove all tapes on the ARDF.

9.

Place the platen sheet [A] on the exposure glass.

10. Align the rear left corner (of the platen sheet) with the corner [B] on the exposure glass.
11. Close the ARDF.
12. Open the ARDF and check that the platen sheet is correctly attached.

SM

2-31

D129/D130

ARDF Installation (D630)

13. Open the ARDF cover [A].
14. Open the feed-in guide plate [B] and feed-out guide plate [C].
15. Install the stamp [D] into the ARDF.
16. Close two guide plates [C] [B].
17. Close the ARDF cover [A].

18. Attach the decal [A] to the top cover as shown. Choose the language you want.
19. Plug in and turn on the main power switch of the machine, and then check the ARDF
operation.
20. Make a full size copy. Check that the registrations (side-to-side and leading edge) and
image skew are correct. If they are not, adjust the registrations and image skew referring to
the "Copy Adjustments" in the section of the "Replacements and Adjustments".

D129/D130

2-32

SM

1-Bin Tray Unit Installation (D632)

2.8 1-BIN TRAY UNIT INSTALLATION (D632)
2.8.1 COMPONENT CHECK

No.

SM

Description

Installation

Check the quantity and condition of the components against the following list.

Q’ty

1

1 Bin Tray Unit

1

2

End-fence

1

3

Tray Support Bar

1

4

Screws (M3 x 16)

2

5

Screws (M3 x 8)

1

6

Harness Cover

1

7

Tray

1

2-33

D129/D130

1-Bin Tray Unit Installation (D632)

2.8.2 INSTALLATION PROCEDURE


Unplug the copier power cord before starting the following procedure.

If the bridge unit (D634) or side tray (D635) has already been installed in the machine, remove it
before installing 1-bin tray unit (D632). This will make it easier for you to do the following
procedure.
1.

Remove all tapes.

2.

Open the right door of the machine.

3.

Remove the front right cover (

p.4-6).

4.

Remove the paper exit cover (

p.4-8).



Keep the screw removed in step 4 for step 5.

x 1,

x 1 [This screw was removed in step 4]).

5.

Install the 1 bin tray unit [A] (

6.

Attach the tray support bar [A] to the tray [B] as shown, and then attach the end-fence [C].

D129/D130

2-34

SM

Installation

1-Bin Tray Unit Installation (D632)

7.

Install the tray [A] with the tray support bar in the machine (M3 x 16:

8.

Connect the harness to the connector of the 1-bin tray unit (

9.

Attach the harness cover [A] (

x 2).

x 1).

x 1; M3 x 8).

10. Reinstall the front right cover on the machine, and then close the right door of the machine.
11. Turn on the main power switch of the machine.
12. Check the 1-bin tray unit operation.

SM

2-35

D129/D130

Bridge Unit Installation (D634)

2.9 BRIDGE UNIT INSTALLATION (D634)
2.9.1 COMPONENT CHECK
Check the quantity and condition of the components against the following list.

No.

Description

Q’ty

1

Bridge Unit

1

2

Frame Cover

1

3

Knob Screw

1

4

Long Knob Screw

1

5

Holder Bracket Cover

1

6

Guide

2

D129/D130

2-36

SM

Bridge Unit Installation (D634)



Unplug the copier power cord before starting the following procedure.



If you will install the 1-bin tray (D632) on the machine, install the 1-bin tray first before
installing the bridge unit (D634). This makes it easy to do the following procedure.



If you will install the finisher unit (D588, D636 or D637) on the machine, install it after
installing the bridge unit (D634).

1.

Remove all tapes.

2.

If the sensor feeler [A] is out, fold it into the machine.

3.

Open the right door of the machine.

4.

Remove the upper inner tray [A].

5.

Remove the front right cover [B] (

x 1).

6.

Remove the connector cover [C] (

x 1).

SM

2-37

D129/D130

Installation

2.9.2 INSTALLATION PROCEDURE

Bridge Unit Installation (D634)

7.

Attach the two guides [A] to the cutouts [B] in the inner tray.

1) Place the lower hook of the guide in the cutout of the paper exit.
2) Attach the guide as shown until the two side hooks hold the paper exit.
3) Press the guide.
4) Press down the guide as shown.

D129/D130

2-38

SM

Installation

Bridge Unit Installation (D634)

8.

Install the bridge unit [A] in the machine.

9.

Secure the bridge unit with the long knob screw [A] and knob screw [B].

10. Attach the frame cover [C].
11. Reinstall the front right cover on the machine, and then close the right door of the machine.


Open the bridge unit cover [D] when installing the front right cover. Otherwise, you
cannot reinstall it.

12. Install the optional finisher (refer to the finisher installation procedure).

SM

2-39

D129/D130

Bridge Unit Installation (D634)



Holder bracket [E] is used in the installation procedure of the finisher (D588, D636
or D637). Do not install it at this time.

13. Pull out the extension tray [A] only if the 1000-sheet finisher (D588) will be installed on the
main machine.
14. Turn on the main power switch of the machine.
15. Check the bridge unit operation.

D129/D130

2-40

SM

3000/2000-sheet (Booklet) Finisher (D636/D637)

2.10 3000/2000-SHEET (BOOKLET) FINISHER (D636/D637)
2.10.1 ACCESSORY CHECK

No.

SM

Description

Installation

Check the quantity and condition of the accessories against the following list.

Q'ty

1

Rear joint bracket

1

2

Front joint bracket

1

3

Ground (earth) plate

1

4

Tapping screws - M4 x14

4

5

Tapping screws - M3 x 8

1

6

Tapping screws - M3 x 6

6

7

Upper output tray

1

8

Support Tray

1

9

Lower output tray (D637 only)

1

10

Cushion (with double-sided tape)

1

11

Small Ground (earth) plate

2

2-41

D129/D130

3000/2000-sheet (Booklet) Finisher (D636/D637)

2.10.2 INSTALLATION PROCEDURE


Unplug the main machine power cord before starting the following procedure.

If this finisher is installed on this machine, the following options must be installed before
installing this finisher.


Bridge Unit (D634)



Paper Feed Unit (D580) or LCIT (D581)

1.

Unpack the finisher and remove all tapes and packing materials from the finisher.

2.

Open the front door, and then remove all tapes and packing materials from the inside of the
finisher.

D129/D130

2-42

SM

Installation

3000/2000-sheet (Booklet) Finisher (D636/D637)

3.

Pull out the jogger unit [A], and then remove all tapes and retainers.

4.

Attach the cushion [A] to the finisher.


Make sure that the cushion is placed within 0 to 1 mm from the edge of the cover.

5.

Install the ground plate [B] on the finisher (

6.

Install the small ground plates [C] on the finisher(

SM

x 2; M3 x 6).

2-43

x 2; M3 x 6 each).

D129/D130

3000/2000-sheet (Booklet) Finisher (D636/D637)

x 2; M4 x 14).

7.

Attach the rear joint bracket [A] (

8.

Attach the front joint bracket [B] and the holder bracket [C] (


x 2; M4 x 14).

Holder bracket [C] must be placed outside the front joint bracket [B]. This bracket
is provided with the Bridge Unit (D634).

9.

Pull the lock lever [A] (

x 1).

10. Slowly push the finisher to the left side of the machine, keeping its front door open until the
brackets [B] [C] go into their slots.
11. Push the lock lever [A], and then secure it (

x 1).

12. Close the front door of the finisher.
13. Connect the finisher connector [D] to the machine.

D129/D130

2-44

SM

Installation

3000/2000-sheet (Booklet) Finisher (D636/D637)

14. Install the upper output tray [A] (

x 1; M3 x 8).

15. Only for D637, install the lower output tray [B].
16. Turn on the main power switch of the machine.
17. Check the finisher operation.

Support Tray Installation

If a stacking problem occurs several times on the upper output tray [A], put the support tray [B]
on the tray as shown.


SM

Keep this tray in the manual pocket if this tray does not need to be installed.

2-45

D129/D130

Punch Unit Installation (D570)

2.11 PUNCH UNIT INSTALLATION (D570)
The Punch Unit D570 can be installed in the 3000/2000-Sheet (Booklet) Finisher D636/D637.

2.11.1 COMPONENT CHECK
Check the quantity and condition of the components against the following list.

No.

Description

Q'ty

1

Punch-out Waste Unit

1

2

Slide Drive Unit

1

3

Punch Waste Hopper

1

4

Wire harness: short-circuit

1

5

Screws (M3 x 6)

5

6

Side-to-Side Detection Unit

1

7

Punching Unit

1

D129/D130

2-46

SM

Punch Unit Installation (D570)

2.11.2 INSTALLATION PROCEDURE


Unplug the main machine power cord before starting the following procedure. If the
2000/3000-sheet booklet finisher has been installed, disconnect it and pull it away from
Installation

the machine.
1.

Remove all tapes and shipping retainers.

2.

If the finisher is connected to the copier, disconnect the power connector [A] and separate
the finisher from the copier.

3.

Remove the rear cover [B] (


x 2) and open the front door.

At the base of the back cover, be sure to disconnect the tabs that fasten the cover
to the frame.

4.

SM

Remove the guide plate [C] (

x 2).

2-47

D129/D130

Punch Unit Installation (D570)

x 2) from the punch unit.

5.

Remove the shipping retainer [A] (

6.

Move the punch unit [A] along its rails into the finisher. Make sure that the pin engages
correctly at the front and rear.

7.

Connect the cables [B] of the finisher to the connectors (CN601 and CN602) on the punch
unit board (


x 2,

x 1).

The cables [B] are coiled and attached to the PCB.

D129/D130

2-48

SM

Installation

Punch Unit Installation (D570)

8.

Attach the slide drive unit [A] to the finisher and connect it to the punch unit (
Push in the slide drive unit at

9.

when you attach the screw

x 2,

x 1).

.

Make sure that the punch unit moves freely and is not blocked by the screws.

10. Put the side-to-side detection unit [A] in the machine. Make sure that the two pins are
engaged correctly at the front.
11. Make sure that the side-to-side detection unit moves smoothly on its rails. If it does not,
make sure that the rails are aligned with their grooves.
12. Attach the side-to-side detection unit and connect it at the rear (

x 2,

x 1,

x 1).

13. Pull the short connector out of the connector [B], then connect the cable of the finisher (
x 1).

SM

2-49

D129/D130

Punch Unit Installation (D570)



This is the 3-pin connector.

14. Connect "Wire harness: short-circuit" [A] to the CN110 connector.

15. At the front, use a pair of wire cutters to remove the part [A] of the cover.
16. Install the punch-waste transport unit [B] in the finisher.
17. Make sure that the punch-waste transport unit moves smoothly on its rails. If it does not,
make sure that the rails are aligned with the grooves.
18. Remove the short connector from the connector [C].

D129/D130

2-50

SM

Punch Unit Installation (D570)



This is the 4-pin connector.

19. Connect the cable to connector [C] and attach the punch-waste transport unit (

x

x 1).

Installation

1,

x 1,

20. Set the hopper [A] in its holder.
21. Reassemble the finisher, and then install it on the main machine.
22. Connect the power cord to the outlet, and then turn the main power switch on.
23. Check the punch unit operation.

SM

2-51

D129/D130

Platen Cover (D593)

2.12 PLATEN COVER (D593)

1.

Install screws [1] (

2.

Position the platen cover bracket [2] on the heads of the stud screws, and slide the platen

x 2) on the top cover as shown.

cover [3] to the left.

D129/D130

2-52

SM

1000-sheet Finisher (D588)

2.13 1000-SHEET FINISHER (D588)
2.13.1 ACCESSORY CHECK

No.

SM

Description

Q'ty

For this model

1

Grounding Plate

1

Yes

2

Rear Joint Bracket

1

Not used

3

Front Joint Bracket

1

Yes

4

Rear Joint Bracket

1

Yes

5

Copy Tray

1

Yes

6

Screw - M3 x 8

1

Yes

7

Screw - M4 x 13

4

Yes

8

Knob Screw - M3 x 8

1

Yes

9

Knob Screw - M4 x 10

1

Yes

10

Screw - M4 x 25

3

Not used

11

Staple Position Decal

1

Yes

2-53

Installation

Check the quantity and condition of the accessories against the following list.

D129/D130

1000-sheet Finisher (D588)

2.13.2 INSTALLATION PROCEDURE


Unplug the main machine power cord before starting the following procedure.

If this finisher is installed, the Bridge Unit (D634) and Paper Feed Unit (D580) or LCT (D581)
must be installed before installing this finisher.

1.

Unpack the finisher and remove the tapes.


D129/D130

Be sure to keep screw [A]. It will be needed to secure the grounding plate in step 3.

2-54

SM

Installation

1000-sheet Finisher (D588)

2.

Install the rear joint bracket [A] (


x 2; M4 x 13) and front joint bracket [B] ( x 2; M4 x 13).

Holder bracket [C] must be placed outside the front joint bracket [B]. This bracket
is provided with the Bridge Unit (D634).

3.

SM

Install the grounding plate [A] on the finisher (

2-55

x 2; M3 x 8)

D129/D130

1000-sheet Finisher (D588)



Use the screw removed in step 1 and the screw from the accessory box.

4.

Open the front door [B]. Then pull the locking lever [C].

5.

Align the finisher on the joint brackets, and lock it in place by pushing the locking lever.

6.

Secure the locking lever (

7.

Install the copy tray [D] (

8.

Connect the finisher cable [E] to the main machine as shown above.

9.

Attach the staple position decal [A] to the ARDF as shown.

x 1; knob M3 x 8) and close the front door.
x 1; knob M4 x 10).

10. Turn on the main power switch and check the finisher operation.

D129/D130

2-56

SM

Side Tray (D635)

2.14 SIDE TRAY (D635)
2.14.1 COMPONENT CHECK

No.

Description

Q’ty

1

Side Tray Unit

1

2

Sub Output Tray

1

3

Main Output Tray

1

4

Screw

1

5

Knob Screw

1

6

Frame Cover

1

7

Holder Bracket Cover

1

8

Guide

1

SM

Installation

Check the quantity and condition of the accessories against the following list.

2-57

D129/D130

Side Tray (D635)

2.14.2 INSTALLATION PROCEDURE


Turn off the main switch of the copier and unplug the power cord before you start the
installation procedure.



If you will install the 1-bin tray (D632) on the machine, install the 1-bin tray first before
installing the side tray (D635). This makes it easier to do the following procedure.

1.

Remove all tapes.

2.

If the sensor feeler [A] is out, fold it into the machine.

3.

Open the right door of the machine.

4.

Remove the inner tray [A].

5.

Remove the front right cover [B] (

x 1).

6.

Remove the connector cover [C] (

x 1).

D129/D130

2-58

SM

Installation

Side Tray (D635)

7.

Attach the two guides [A] to the cutouts [B] in the inner tray.

1) Place the lower hook of the guide in the cutout of the paper exit.
2) Attach the guide as shown until the two side hooks hold the paper exit.
3) Press the guide.
4) Press down the guide as shown.

SM

2-59

D129/D130

Side Tray (D635)

8.

Attach the main output tray [A] and sub output tray [B] to the side tray unit.

9.

Install the side tray unit [A] in the machine.

10. Open the side tray cover [A].
11. Secure the side tray unit with the knob screw [B].
12. Attach the frame cover [C].
13. Reinstall the front right cover on the machine, and then close the right door of the machine.

D129/D130

2-60

SM

Side Tray (D635)



Open the side tray cover [A] when installing the front right cover. Otherwise, you
cannot reinstall it.

14. Install the holder bracket [D] (

x 1).

15. Turn on the main power switch of the machine.
Installation

16. Check the side tray operation.

SM

2-61

D129/D130

Internal Shift Tray (D633)

2.15 INTERNAL SHIFT TRAY (D633)
2.15.1 COMPONENT CHECK
Check the quantity and condition of the components against the following list.

No.

Description

Q’ty

1

Shift Tray Unit

1

2

Paper Guide - Small

2

3

Connector Cover

1

2.15.2 INSTALLATION PROCEDURE


Unplug the copier power cord before starting the following procedure.

1.

Remove all tapes.

2.

Remove the standard tray [A].

D129/D130

2-62

SM

Internal Shift Tray (D633)

Remove the inner cover [B] (

x 1).

4.

Install the small paper guides [A].

5.

Attach the connector cover [A] to the shift tray unit [B].

6.

Install the shift tray unit [B] in the machine.

7.

Push down the left edge [C] of the shift tray.

8.

Turn on the main power switch of the machine.

9.

Check the shift tray unit operation.

Installation

3.

SM

2-63

D129/D130

Key Counter Installation

2.16 KEY COUNTER INSTALLATION
2.16.1 INSTALLATION PROCEDURE

1.

Hold the key counter plate nuts [1] on the inside of the key counter bracket [2] and insert
the key counter holder [3].

2.

Secure the key counter holder to the bracket (

3.

Install the key counter cover [4] (

4.

Rear cover [5] (

D129/D130

x 2).

x 2).

x 5)

2-64

SM

Installation

Key Counter Installation

5.

Cut off the part [6] of the rear cover.

6.

Connect the harness to CN211 [7] on the IOB (

7.

Peel off the double-sided tape on the key counter bracket and attach the key counter to the

x 3).

scanner right cover [8].
8.

SM

Reassemble the machine.

2-65

D129/D130

Key Counter Interface Unit Installation

2.17 KEY COUNTER INTERFACE UNIT INSTALLATION
2.17.1 INSTALLATION PROCEDURE

1.

Rear cover [1] (

2.

Install the key counter interface board in the location [2] (

3.

Connect the harness to CN3 on the key counter interface board.

4.

Connect the other terminal of the harness to CN214 [3] on the IOB (

D129/D130

x 6)

2-66

x 4).
x 3).

SM

Installation

Key Counter Interface Unit Installation

5.

Cut off the part [4] of the rear cover.

6.

Connect the harness from the counter device to CN4 on the key counter interface board
and clamp it with three clamps [5].

7.

SM

Reassemble the machine.

2-67

D129/D130

Tray Heater

2.18 TRAY HEATER
2.18.1 INSTALLATION PROCEDURE

1.

Remove trays 1 and 2 from the machine.

2.

Connect the connector [1] of the heater to the connector [2] of the main machine.

3.

Install the heater [3] inside the machine (

4.

Remove the connector cover [4] (

D129/D130

x 1).

x 1).

2-68

SM

Installation

Tray Heater

5.

Release the heater relay connector [5] (

6.

Connect the heater relay connector to the connector [6] (front side) of the main frame (

x 1).
x

1).
7.

SM

Reassemble the machine.

2-69

D129/D130

Tray Heater (Optional Paper Feed Unit)

2.19 TRAY HEATER (OPTIONAL PAPER FEED UNIT)
2.19.1 COMPONENT CHECK

No.

Description

Q'ty

1

Tray heater

1

2

On-standby decal

1

3

Harness 2

1

4

Harness 1

1

5

Screw M4 x 10

2

-

Installation procedure

1

D129/D130

2-70

SM

Tray Heater (Optional Paper Feed Unit)

2.19.2 INSTALLATION PROCEDURE


Unplug the machine power cord before starting the following procedure.

1.

Pull out the two trays from the optional paper feed unit.

2.

Install the tray heater [1] in the optional paper feed unit (

3.

Remove the two securing brackets [2] (
optional paper feed unit (

SM

Installation

For installing the tray heater in the D580 (Two-tray paper feed unit)

x 1).

x 1 each), and then the rear cover [3] of the

x 2).

2-71

D129/D130

Tray Heater (Optional Paper Feed Unit)

4.

Connect the harness [4] to the connector [5] of the tray heater.

5.

Route the harness [4] as shown and clamp it with four clamps (

6.

Connect the harness [4] to the connector [6] of the mainframe.

7.

Remove the connector cover [7] (

8.

Release the optional heater relay connector [8] (

9.

Connect the optional heater relay connector to the connector [9] (rear side) of the main
frame (

D129/D130

x 4).

x 1).

x 1).

x 1).

2-72

SM

Tray Heater (Optional Paper Feed Unit)

10. Reassemble the mainframe and optional paper feed unit.

For installing the tray heater in the D581 (LCT)
Remove the rear cover of the mainframe (

2.

Pull out the LCT drawer.


x 6).

If the right tray comes out with the left tray, push the right tray into the LCT.

3.

Left tray [1] (

4.

Remove the right tray [2] while pressing down the stopper [3].


x 2)

When reinstalling the right tray, set the right tray on the guide rail and carefully
push the tray in, making sure to keep the tray level.

SM

2-73

D129/D130

Installation

1.

Tray Heater (Optional Paper Feed Unit)

5.

Install the tray heater [4] in the optional LCT (

6.

Remove the two securing brackets [5] (
optional LCT (

x 1).

x 1 each), and then the rear cover [6] of the

x 2).

7.

Connect the harness [7] to the connector [8] of the tray heater.

8.

Route the harness [7] as shown and clamp it with four clamps (

D129/D130

2-74

x 4).

SM

Tray Heater (Optional Paper Feed Unit)

9.

Connect the harness [7] to the connector [9] of the mainframe.

Installation

10. Reassemble the rear cover of the optional LCT.

11. Remove the connector cover [10] (

x 1).

12. Release the optional heater relay connector [11] (

x 1).

13. Connect the optional heater relay connector to the connector [12] (rear side) of the main
frame (

x 1).

14. Reassemble the mainframe and optional LCT.

SM

2-75

D129/D130

HDD Installation (D640-11)

2.20 HDD INSTALLATION (D640-11)
2.20.1 COMPONENT CHECK

No.

Description

Q'ty

1

HDD Unit

1

2

Connecting Board Unit

1

3

Screw - M3 x 6

5

4

Harness 1

1

5

Harness 2

1

D129/D130

2-76

SM

HDD Installation (D640-11)

Installation

2.20.2 INSTALLATION PROCEDURE

1.

Remove the controller board unit [A] (

2.

Connect the two harnesses to the HDD unit [A] (

3.

Install the connecting board unit [A] on the HDD unit [B] (

SM

x 2).

2-77

x 2).

x 2).

D129/D130

HDD Installation (D640-11)

4.

Connect the two harnesses from the HDD unit to the connecting board [A] (

5.

Install the HDD unit [A] on the controller board unit (

6.

Reinstall the controller board unit in the machine.

x 2).

x 3).

After Installing the HDD
1.

Do SP5832-001 to format the hard disk.

2.

Do SP5853-001 to copy the preset stamp data from the firmware to the hard disk.

3.

Do SP5846-040 to copy the address book to the hard disk from the controller board.

4.

Do SP5846-041 to let the user get access to the address book.

5.

Turn the main power switch off/on.

D129/D130

2-78

SM

Copy Data Security Unit (B829)

2.21 COPY DATA SECURITY UNIT (B829)

No.

SM

Description

Q’ty

For this model

1

Bracket 1

1

Yes

2

ICIB-3

1

Yes

3

Flexible cable: Long

1

Not used

4

Flexible cable: Short

1

Not used

5

Harness with bands

1

Not used

6

Harness

1

Not used

7

Small Bracket

1

Not used

8

Saddle Clamp

1

Not used

9

Screws: M3x6

6

Yes

10

Screws: M3x4

2

Yes

11

Bracket 2

1

Not used

2-79

Installation

2.21.1 COMPONENT CHECK

D129/D130

Copy Data Security Unit (B829)

2.21.2 INSTALLATION PROCEDURE


Unplug the main machine power cord before you do the following procedure.
p.4-4)

1.

Rear cover (

2.

Controller unit (

p.4-95)

3.

Controller box (

p.4-101 "Mother Board")

4.

Attach bracket 1 [A] to the ICIB-3 [B] (

D129/D130

x 2; M3 x 4).

2-80

SM

Installation

Copy Data Security Unit (B829)

5.

Connect the ICIB-3 with bracket 1 [A] to CN 505 on the IPU (

6.

Reassemble the machine.

x 2; M3 x 6).

User Tool Setting
1.

Plug in and turn on the main power switch.

2.

Go into the User Tools mode, and select System Settings > Administrator Tools > Data
Security for Copying > "On".

3.

Exit the User Tools.

4.

Check the operation.


The machine will issue an SC165 error if the machine is powered on with the
ICIB-1 removed and the "Data Security for Copying" feature is set to "ON".



When you remove this option from the machine, first set the setting to "OFF" with
the user tool before removing this board. If you forget to do this, "Data Security for
Copying" feature cannot appear in the user tool settings. And then SC165 will
appear every time the machine is switched on, and the machine cannot be used.

SM

2-81

D129/D130

Copy Data Security Unit (B829)

Check All Connections
Make sure that the machine can recognize the option.
1.

Plug in the power cord.

2.

Turn on the main switch.

3.

Enter the printer user mode. Then print the configuration page.
User Tools > Printer Features > List Test Print > Configuration Page

4.

All installed options are shown sin the "System Reference" column.

D129/D130

2-82

SM

Browser Unit Type I

Rev. 04/20/2012

⇒ 2.22 BROWSER UNIT TYPE I
2.22.1 INSTALLATION PROCEDURE
1.

Turn the main switch ON.

2.

Press the “User Tools/Counter” key.

3.

On the touch panel, press “System Settings”.

4.

Make sure that the “Increase Scanner Memory by Disabling Browser” setting in the
General Features tab is OFF.

5.

Turn the main switch OFF.

6.

Remove the control cover [A] (screws x 2).

7.

Insert the Browser Option SD card in the lower slot [A].

8.

Turn the main switch ON.

9.

Touch the “User Tools/Counter” key.

SM

2-83

D129/D130

Installation

Use the following procedure to install the Browser Unit Type I.

Browser Unit Type I

Rev. 04/20/2012

10. On the touch panel, touch “Extended Feature settings”.

11. Touch “Extended Feature settings” in the Extended Feature Settings Menu.

12. Make sure that “Extended JS” application was automatically installed in the Startup
Settings tab.
13. Turn the main switch OFF/ON.
14. Move the application to the SD card that is installed to slot 1.
15. Note: See the Service Manual for details on merging SD Applications.

D129/D130

2-84

SM

Browser Unit Type I

Rev. 04/20/2012

Installation

16. Press the “User Tools/Counter” key.

17. Touch “Edit home”.

18. Touch “Add Icon”.

19. Touch “Browse”.

20. Touch a blank square to set the location for the browser icon.
21. Touch “Exit” to complete the addition of the FAX browser icon.

SM

2-85

D129/D130

Browser Unit Type I

Rev. 04/20/2012

2.22.2 DO THE FOLLOWING STEPS IF THE CUSTOMER IS USING
THE RICOH JAVASCRIPT CONNECTED TO A WEB
APPLICATION DEVELOPED BY OPERIUS/RIDP.
1.

Turn the main switch ON.

2.

Press the “User Tools/Counter” key.

3.

On the touch panel, touch “Browser Features”.

4.

Touch “JavaScript”.

5.

Change the Extended JavaScript setting to “Active”.

D129/D130

2-86

SM

Browser Unit Type I

Rev. 04/20/2012

2.22.3 EXJS FIRMWARE UPDATE PROCEDURE
Note:
z The firmware configuration of the Browser Unit Type I has been changed to enhance
browsing.

firmware is equivalent to the existing browser firmware. Therefore, it is possible to update
the EXJS firmware using the same procedure as that of SDK application firmware.
z Both the Browser firmware and EXJS firmware are automatically installed when the
Browser SD card is inserted in the upper slot.

Preparation:
1.

Download the latest EXJS firmware from the RISSN server.

2.

Extract the exe file (XXXX. exe), after which the following two files are generated:
XXXX_machine. exe/ XXXX_stock.exe.
Note: The file (XXXX_machine) is for updating the EXJS firmware in the field.

3.

Extract the file (XXXX_machine), after which the “SDK” folder is created.

4.

Copy the “SDK” folder to an SD card.

Note: XXXX = part number.

Main procedure:

1.

SM

Remove the control cover [A] (screws x 2).

2-87

D129/D130

Installation

z The Browser Unit Type I consists of the Browser firmware and EXJS firmware. The EXJS

Browser Unit Type I

Rev. 04/20/2012

2.

Insert the SD card included for firmware update into the lower slot [A].

3.

Turn the main switch ON.

4.

After the Update screen is displayed, select the “Browser”.

5.

Touch “Update (#)”.

6.

After the "Update Done" message appears on the screen, turn the main power switch OFF.

7.

Remove the SD card from the lower slot.

Do the following steps if you are updating the Extended JavaScript.
8.

Turn the main switch ON.

9.

Press the “User Tools/Counter” key.

10. On the touch panel, touch “Extended Feature settings”.
11. Touch “Extended Feature settings” in the Extended Feature Settings Menu.

12. Change the status of “Extended JS” to “Ending” in the Startup Settings tab.
13. Turn the main switch OFF.
14. Insert the SD card containing the Extended JS firmware into the lower slot.
15. Turn the main switch ON.
16. Press the “User Tools/Counter” key.

D129/D130

2-88

SM

Browser Unit Type I

Rev. 04/20/2012

17. On the touch panel, push “Extended Feature settings”.

Installation

18. Touch “Extended Feature settings” in the Extended Feature Settings Menu.

19. Touch the “Install” tab.

20. Touch “SD card”, then select “Extended JS” from the list of Extended Features.

21. Select “Machine HDD” as the “Install to” destination, then touch “Next”.
22. Check the Extended Features information on the “Ready to Install” screen, then press
“OK”.

SM

2-89

D129/D130

Browser Unit Type I

Rev. 04/20/2012

23. After “The following extended feature has already been installed. Are you sure you want to
overwrite it?” is displayed, press “Yes”.
24. Change the status of Extended JS to “waiting” in the Startup Settings tab.
25. Turn the main switch OFF.
26. Remove the SD card from slot 2 (lower slot).
27. Turn the main switch ON.
28. Press the “User Tools/Counter” key.
29. On the touch panel, touch “Extended Feature settings”.
30. Touch “Extended Feature settings” in the Extended Feature settings Menu.
31. Make sure that the “Extended JS” has been updated to the latest version in the Startup
Settings tab.

2.22.4 EXJS FIRMWARE UN-INSTALL PROCEDURE
1.

Turn the main switch ON.

2.

Press the “User Tools/Counter” key.

3.

Login with an administrator user name and password.

4.

On the touch panel, touch “Extended Feature settings”.

5.

Touch “Extended Feature settings” in the Extended Feature Settings Menu.

6.

Touch “Extended Feature settings” in the Extended Feature Settings Menu.

D129/D130

2-90

SM

Browser Unit Type I

Installation

Rev. 04/20/2012

7.

Touch “Uninstall”.

8.

Touch “Browser”, and then touch “Yes” after “Are you sure you want to uninstall the
following extended feature?” is displayed.
Note: “Uninstalling the extended feature... Please wait” is then displayed on the touch

screen.
9.

After "Completed" is displayed, turn the main power switch OFF

Note: The Browser firmware is un-installed from the machine when the Browser SD card is
removed.

SM

2-91

D129/D130

Card Reader Bracket Type C3352 (D593)

Rev. 04/20/2012

2.23 CARD READER BRACKET TYPE C3352 (D593)
2.23.1 COMPONENT CHECK
Check the quantity and condition of the accessories against the following list.

No

Description

Q'ty

For This Model

1

Screw: M3 x 8

5

Yes

2

Screw: M3 x 14

1

Not used

3

Screw: M4 x 25

1

Not used

4

Tapping Screw: M3 x 10

3

Yes

5

Upper Tray

1

Yes

6

Lower Tray

1

Yes

7

Tray Bracket

1

Yes

D129/D130

2-92

SM

Card Reader Bracket Type C3352 (D593)

Rev. 04/20/2012

Installation

2.23.2 INSTALLATION PROCEDURE

1.

Attach the tray bracket [A] to the scanner right cover (
ƒ

[B] x 2: M3x 8

For this model, use the screw holes marked "1" on the table bracket.

2.

Attach the lower tray [A] to the tray bracket (

x 2: M3x8).

3.

Attach the upper tray [B] to the tray bracket (

x 1: M3x8).

4.

Connect the cable to the designated connector (the connector to use depends on the type
of device to be connected).

SM

2-93

D129/D130

Fax Connection Unit Type A (D629-31)

Rev. 04/23/2012

⇒ 2.24 FAX CONNECTION UNIT TYPE A (D629-31)
(REMOTE FAX)

2.24.1 INSTALLATION PROCEDURE
This unit allows a machine without the FAX unit installed (“Client-side Machine”) to send and
receive faxes via a machine with the FAX unit installed (“Remote Machine”).

Requirements:
ƒ

Both the Client-side Machine and Remote Machine must have this unit, the Printer unit, and
Scanner unit installed.

ƒ

Up to six machines can be registered as the Client-side Machines.

ƒ

Machines that have the FAX unit installed cannot be used as the Client-side Machine.

ƒ

Only machine can be registered as the Remote Machine.

ƒ

Firmware for this unit: “aics” (software number: D6295750)

ƒ

Remote Fax transmissions are possible on a G3 line.

ƒ

The remote fax function does not support User Code Authentication. Disable the User
Code Authentication on the Remote machine.

ƒ

Use this function to check the contents of a file that is stored in memory and not yet sent.
Also, use this function to cancel a transmission from the Client-side Machine.

Before installing this option:
‚

Upgrade the machine firmware to the following versions or newer.
Firmware

P/N

Suffix

Ver.

System/Copy

D1295751

F

2.00.3

Network Support

D1295754

D

11.77.2

Network DocBox

D1295757

D

2.01

Fax

D1295753

D

02.03.00

RemoteFax

D1295752

D

02.00.00

Websupport

D1295755

D

1.11

WebUapl

D1295756

D

1.04

JAVA (Standard)

D1295735

C

10.03.01

JAVA (Option)

D6405750

G

10.03.01

Scanner

D1295759

C

01.11

Printer

D1295763

C

1.06

PCL

D1295762

C

1.08

FCU

D6295570

C

02.00.00

D129/D130

2-94

SM

Fax Connection Unit Type A (D629-31)

Rev. 04/23/2012

2.24.2 INSTALLING THE APPLICATION

Installation

On both the Remote Machine and the Client-side Machines:

1.

Remove the SD-card slot cover [A] from the SD card slots (Screw x 1)

2.

Insert the SD card (Fax Connection Unit Type A) in SD slot 2 (lower) with its label face [B]
towards the front of the machine. Then push it slowly into SD slot 2 (lower) until you hear a
click.

3.

Plug in, and then turn on the machine.

4.

Move the Fax Connection Unit Type A application from the SD card in SD slot 2 (lower) to
the SD card in SD slot 1 (upper) with SP5-873-001.

5.

Turn off the machine.

6.

Remove the SD card from SD slot 2 (lower), and then keep it in a safe place (see “SD Card
Appli Move” in the manual for the main frame).

7.

Attach the SD-card slot cover, and then turn on the machine (x 1)

8.

Make sure that the machine can recognize the option (see ‘Check All Connections’ in the
controller option section of the manual for the main frame)

SM

2-95

D129/D130

Fax Connection Unit Type A (D629-31)

Rev. 04/23/2012

2.24.3 REGISTERING THE REMOTE MACHINE
ƒ

Only one machine can be registered as the Remote Machine.

On the Client-side Machine(s):
1.

Press the [User Tools/Counter] key on the operation panel

2.

Press [System Settings > Administrator Tools] to select.

3.

Press [Program/Delete Remote Machine] to select.

4.

Enter the IP address or host name of the Remote Machine.

5.

Press [Set] to set after “connection test”.

6.

Press [Exit] to exit from the set-up procedure.

2.24.4 REGISTERING THE CLIENT-SIDE MACHINE(S)
ƒ

Up to six machines can be registered as the Client-side Machines.

On the Remote Machine:
1.

Press the [User Tools/Counter] key on the operation panel

2.

Press [Administrator Tools] to select.

3.

Press [Program/Delete

4.

Enter the IP address or host name of the Client-side Machines.

5.

Press [Set] to set after “connection test”.

D129/D130

Remote Machine] to select.

2-96

SM

Fax Connection Unit Type A (D629-31)

Rev. 04/23/2012

2.24.5 CONFIGURING THE REMOTE RECEPTION SETTINGS
Do the following procedure to enable the Client-side Machine(s) to receive faxes via the
Remote Machine. You can forward or route received documents per line or special sender or

ƒ

By performing procedures #1-3 above, the Client-side Machines can send faxes via the
Remote Machine. The procedures shown below are necessary to enable the
Client-side Machines to receive faxes.

On the Remote Machine:
1) If you use "Remote Reception Setting per Line"
1.

Press [Facsimile Features] to select.

2.

Press [Remote Reception Setting per Line] in [Reception Settings] to select.

3.

Enter an IP address or a host name of the client-side machine to connect.

4.

Press [Set], and [Exit] to exit from the setting.

2) If you use "Remote Reception per Sender"

SM

1.

Press [Facsimile Features] to select.

2.

Press [Program Special Sender] in [Reception Settings] to select.

3.

Select the Special Sender.

2-97

D129/D130

Installation

box.

Fax Connection Unit Type A (D629-31)

Rev. 04/23/2012

4.

Press [Remote Reception Setting per Sender] to select.

5.

Press [On] and [Remote Machine] to select.

6.

Enter an IP address or a host name of the client-side machine to connect.

7.

Press [OK] to exit from the setting.

D129/D130

2-98

SM

Fax Connection Unit Type A (D629-31)

Rev. 04/23/2012

3) If you use "Remote Reception per Box"
Press [Facsimile Features] to select.

2.

Press [Box Setting] in [General Settings] to select.

3.

Select the box.

Installation

1.

SM

2-99

D129/D130

Fax Connection Unit Type A (D629-31)

Rev. 04/23/2012

4.

Press [Personal Box] to select.

5.

Enter a dial-in number.

6.

Press [Remote Machine] to select.

7.

Enter an IP address or a host name of the client-side machine to connect.

8.

Press [OK] to exit from the set-up procedure.

D129/D130

2-100

SM

Fax Connection Unit Type A (D629-31)

Rev. 04/23/2012

2.24.6 REMOTE FAX ICON ADDITION FOR REMOTE MACHINE
This procedure allows the remote fax icon to appear on the home screen of the operation panel.

SM

1.

Press [User Tools].

2.

Press [Edit Home].

3.

Press [Add Icon].

Installation

On both the Remote Machine and the Client-side Machines:

2-101

D129/D130

Fax Connection Unit Type A (D629-31)

Rev. 04/23/2012

4.

Press [Remote Fax].

5.

Press a [Blank] to set a location for the remote fax icon.

6.

Press [Exit] to exit from the set-up procedure.

D129/D130

2-102

SM

PREVENTIVE MAINTENANCE
R E V I S I O N H I S T O RY
Pag e

Date

Ad d ed / Upd ated / New
None

PM Tables

3. PREVENTIVE MAINTENANCE
3.1 PM TABLES
See "Appendices" for the following information:
PM Tables

Preventive
Maintenance



SM

3-1

D129/D130

REPLACEMENT AND ADJUSTMENT
R E V I S I O N H I S T O RY
P a ge
6 ∼ 13

Date

A d de d /U pd at e d /N ew

09/11/2012

Updated Operation Panel including LCD

12/27/2012

NVRAM on the BCU board

108

1/4/2013

NVRAM on the BCU board

116

05/16/2012

108 ~ 117

Touch Screen Calibration

General Cautions

4. REPLACEMENT AND ADJUSTMENT
4.1 GENERAL CAUTIONS


To avoid damage to the transfer belt, drum, or development unit when it is removed or
re-installed, never turn off power switch while electrical components are active.



Turn off the main power switch and unplug the machine before attempting any of the
procedures in this section.

4.1.1 LASER UNIT
1.

Do not loosen the screws that secure the LD drive board to the laser diode casing. Doing so

2.

Do not adjust the variable resistors on the LD unit, as they are adjusted in the factory.

3.

The polygon mirror and F-theta lenses are very sensitive to dust. Do not open the optical
housing unit.

4.

Do not touch the glass surface of the polygon mirror motor unit with bare hands.

5.

After replacing the LD unit, do the laser beam pitch adjustment.

4.1.2 USED TONER
Dispose of used toner in accordance with local regulations. Never throw toner into an open
flame, for toner dust may ignite.

SM

4-1

D129/D130

Replacement
and
Adjustment

would throw the LD unit out of adjustment.

Special Tools and Lubricants

4.2 SPECIAL TOOLS AND LUBRICANTS
4.2.1 SPECIAL TOOLS

Part Number

Description

Q’ty

A0069104

Scanner Positioning Pin (4 pc./set)

1

A2929500

Test Chart – S5S (10 pc./set)

1

A2309003

Adjustment Cam – Laser Unit

1

A2309004

Positioning Pin – Laser Unit

1

B6455010

SD Card

1

G0219350

Loop Back Connector

1

4.2.2 LUBRICANTS

Part Number

Description

Q’ty

A2579300

Grease Barrierta S552R

1

52039502

Silicone Grease G-501

1

D129/D130

4-2

SM

Exterior Covers

4.3 EXTERIOR COVERS
4.3.1 FRONT DOOR, UPPER AND LOWER INNER COVER
Left Cover (

p.4-4)

2.

Open and remove the front door [A] (pin x 2).

Replacement
and
Adjustment

1.

Upper Inner Cover
1.

Open the front door [A].

2.

Upper inner cover [B] (

x 2)

Lower Inner Cover
1.

Remove the front door [A] (pin x 2)

2.

Shield glass cover [C]

3.

Shield glass [D] (

4.

Lower inner cover [E]

SM

x 2)

4-3

D129/D130

Exterior Covers

4.3.2 LEFT COVER

1.

Left cover [A] (

x 6)

4.3.3 REAR COVER

1.

Rear cover [A] (

D129/D130

x 6)

4-4

SM

Exterior Covers

4.3.4 RIGHT REAR COVER
Rear cover(

2.

Open the right door [A].

3.

Scanner right cover [B] (

4.

Right top cover [C] (

5.

Right rear cover [D] (

SM

p.4-4)

Replacement
and
Adjustment

1.

x 2)

x 1)
x 4)

4-5

D129/D130

Exterior Covers

Rev. 09/11/2012

4.3.5 FRONT RIGHT COVER

1.

Open the right door [A].

2.

Front right cover [A] (

⇒4.3.6

x 1)

OPERATION PANEL

1.

Front right cover (

2.

Position the operation panel [A] as shown above.

3.

Operation panel connector upper cover [B] ( x 1)

D129/D130

p.4-6 "Front Right Cover")

4-6

SM

Exterior Covers

Rev. 09/11/2012

⇒

4.

Position the operation panel [A] as shown above.

5.

Remove the operation panel connector lower cover [B].

6.

Remove the Scanner Left Cover (

7.

Remove the Scanner Right Cover (

Scanner Panels 4.4.2).

8.

Remove the Scanner Front Cover (

Scanner Panels 4.4.2).

9.

Remove the Grounding Line [A].

[A]

10. Operation panel [A] ( x 4,  x 3)

SM

4-7

D129/D130

Replacement
and
Adjustment

Scanner Panels 4.4.2).

Exterior Covers

Rev. 09/11/2012

⇒ LCD
1. Remove the operation panel cover (

4.3.6.

2. Remove the rear cover [A] ( x 6).

[A]

3. Remove the rear cover [B] together with the hinge [C] ( x 7).
[B]

[C]

4. Remove the three cables [D].

[D]

D129/D130

4-8

SM

Exterior Covers

Rev. 09/11/2012

⇒

Important
-

There are two types of LCDs that use the same part number (D1291420), labeled Type
A and Type B below. They are completely interchangeable (0.

-

However, the harnesses are connected in slightly different locations on the board. Make
sure to connect the harnesses in the correct position, depending on the type of LCD.
Harness connectors and screws are circled in red for both types.

Part

Description

Type A

Type B

number
D1291420

LCD:TFT:
WVGA:

Replacement
and
Adjustment

LED:MV

5. Remove the LCDC [E] ( x 6,  x 5).
6. Remove the bracket [F] ( x 9).
7. Remove the LCD.

Replacing TYPE A:
[E]

[F]

SM

4-9

D129/D130

Exterior Covers

Rev. 09/11/2012

⇒ Replacing TYPE B:
[E]

[F]

4.3.7 PAPER EXIT COVER
1.

Front right cover (

2.

Paper exit cover [A] ( x 1)

D129/D130

p.4-6)

4-10

SM

Exterior Covers

Rev. 09/11/2012

4.3.8 INNER TRAY
Left cover (

2.

Upper inner cover (

3.

Paper exit cover (

4.

Connector cover [A]

5.

Inner rear cover [A]

6.

Inner tray [A]

SM

p.4-4)
p.4-3 "Front Door, Upper and Lower Inner Cover")
p.4-8)

Replacement
and
Adjustment

1.

4-11

D129/D130

Scanner

Rev. 09/11/2012

4.4 SCANNER
4.4.1 EXPOSURE GLASS
1.

Glass cover [A] ( x 2)

2.

ARDF exposure glass [B]

3.

Rear scale [C] ( x 3)

4.

Exposure glass with left scale [D]

ƒ

Position the white marker [E] at the rear-left corner and the black or blue marker
at the front-left corner when you reattach the ARDF exposure glass.

4.4.2 SCANNER EXTERIOR PANELS AND OPERATION PANEL
Operation panel
1.

Remove the Operation Panel (

4.3.6)

Scanner left cover

1.

Scanner left cover [A] ( x 3)

D129/D130

4-12

SM

Scanner

Rev. 09/11/2012

Scanner right cover

1.

Scanner right cover [A] ( x 2)

Scanner front cover
Operation panel (

p.4-7)

2.

Scanner front cover [A] ( x 2)

Replacement
and
Adjustment

1.

Scanner rear cover

1.

SM

Scanner rear cover [A] ( x 1)

4-13

D129/D130

Scanner

4.4.3 LENS BLOCK ASSEMBLY
1.

Exposure glass (

2.

Scanner right cover (

3.

SBU cover [A] (

4.

Original size sensor bracket (

5.

Lens block assembly [A] (


p.4-10)
p.4-11 "Scanner Exterior Panels and Operation Panel")

x 4)
p.4-15 "Original Size Sensor")

x 4, Grand screw x 1,

x 2)

Do not remove the other screws on the lens block unit.

D129/D130

4-14

SM

Scanner

When reassembling
Adjust the following SP modes after you replace the lens block assembly:


SP4–008 (Sub Scan Mag): (

"Scanning" in "Copy Adjustments: Printing/Scanning")



SP4–010 (Sub Mag Reg.): (

"Scanning" in "Copy Adjustments: Printing/Scanning")



SP4–011 (Main Scan Reg): (



SP4–688 (DF: Density Adjustment): Use this to adjust the density level if the ID of outputs

"Scanning" in "Copy Adjustments: Printing/Scanning")

made in the DF and Platen mode is different.

4.4.4 ORIGINAL SIZE SENSOR
1.

Exposure glass with left scale (

p.4-10 "Exposure Glass")

2.

Scanner right cover (

3.

SBU cover (

4.

Remove the screw [A] on the sensor board bracket.

5.

Circuit chip [A] (

p.4-11 "Scanner Exterior Panels and Operation Panel")

Replacement
and
Adjustment

p.4-14 "Lens Block Assembly")

SM

x 1,

x 1)

4-15

D129/D130

Scanner

6.

Original size sensor bracket [A] (

7.

Original size sensors [A] (hooks)

D129/D130

x 2)

4-16

SM

Scanner

4.4.5 EXPOSURE LAMP
Before replacing the scanner lamp, check and note the first three digits in the bar-code
on the new scanner lamp (

“Chromaticity rank adjustment” in this section).

1.

Operation panel (

p.4-7)

2.

Exposure glass (

p.4-10)

3.

Scanner front cover (

4.

Move the first scanner carriage [A] to the position shown above.

5.

Remove the two screws on the scanner lamp [A].

SM

p.4-11 "Scanner Exterior Panels and Operation Panel")

4-17

Replacement
and
Adjustment



D129/D130

Scanner

6.

Disconnect the connector [A] on the scanner lamp.

7.

Pull out the scanner lamp [A].

Chromaticity rank adjustment
Each scanner lamp has a specific chromaticity rank. The chromaticity rank is indicated by the
bar-code on the new scanner lamp. After replacing the lamp, adjust the chromaticity rank to
correspond to the new scanner lamp.

1.

Check the first three digits [A] in the bar-code on the new scanner lamp before installing the
new lamp.

D129/D130

4-18

SM

Scanner

2.

After installing the new lamp, go to SP4-954-005 and enter the SP setting number referring
to the table below.

SM

139

3

166

12

140

2

167

11

141

1

168

10

142

6

169

15

143

5

170

14

144

4

171

13

145

9

172

18

146

8

173

17

147

7

174

16

148

12

204

3

149

11

205

2

150

10

206

1

151

15

207

6

152

14

208

5

153

13

209

4

154

18

210

9

155

17

211

8

156

16

212

7

157

3

213

12

158

2

214

11

159

1

215

10

160

6

216

15

4-19

Replacement
and
Adjustment

1st Three Digits SP Setting (SP4-954-005) 1st Three Digits SP Setting (SP4-954-005)

D129/D130

Scanner

1st Three Digits SP Setting (SP4-954-005) 1st Three Digits SP Setting (SP4-954-005)
161

5

217

14

162

4

218

13

163

9

219

18

164

8

220

17

165

7

221

16

4.4.6 SCANNER HP SENSOR/PLATEN COVER SENSOR
Scanner HP Sensor
1.

Scanner rear cover (

2.

Exposure glass (

3.

Move the 1st scanner carriage [A] to the right side.

4.

Remove the mylar [A].

D129/D130

p.4-11 "Scanner Exterior Panels and Operation Panel")
p.4-10)

4-20

SM

Scanner

5.

Remove the scanner HP sensor [A] (

x 1, three snaps)

Platen Cover Sensor
Scanner rear cover (

2.

Platen cover sensor [A] (

p.4-11 "Scanner Exterior Panels and Operation Panel")
Replacement
and
Adjustment

1.

SM

x 1,

x 1)

4-21

D129/D130

Scanner

4.4.7 SCANNER MOTOR
1.

Scanner rear cover (

2.

Remove the 8 screws of the scanner rear frame [A].

3.

Disconnect the two connectors.

D129/D130

p.4-11 "Scanner Exterior Panels and Operation Panel")

4-22

SM

Scanner

4.

Pull over the scanner rear stay [A] and remove it (

5.

Scanner motor bracket [A] (

x 1)

6.

Scanner motor [A] (

x 1, spring x 1, belt x 1)

x 3).

Replacement
and
Adjustment

x 2,



x 2,

After replacing the scanner motor, do the image adjustments in the following
section of the manual (

SM

"Scanning" in "Copy Adjustments: Printing/Scanning").

4-23

D129/D130

Scanner

4.4.8 SCANNER MOTOR DRIVE BOARD
1.

Scanner rear cover (

2.

Scanner rear stay. (

3.

SIO [A] (

x 4,

p.4-11 "Scanner Exterior Panels and Operation Panel")
p.4-22 "Scanner Motor")

x All)

4.4.9 FRONT SCANNER WIRE
1.

Scanner front cover (

2.

Scanner left cover (

p.4-11 "Scanner Exterior Panels and Operation Panel")

3.

Scanner left stay [A] (

x 3)

4.

Scanner left rail frame [B].

D129/D130

p.4-11 "Scanner Exterior Panels and Operation Panel")

4-24

SM

Scanner

x 5,

x 1)

Operation panel stay [A] (

6.

Scanner front stay [A] (

7.

To make reassembly easy, slide the 1st scanner carriage to the right.

Replacement
and
Adjustment

5.

SM

x 5)

4-25

D129/D130

Scanner

8.

Front scanner wire clamp [A]

9.

Front scanner wire bracket [B] (

x 1)

10. Front scanner wire and scanner drive pulley [C] (

x 1)

Reassembling the Front Scanner Wire

1.

Position the center ball [A] in the middle of the forked holder.

2.

Pass the right end (with the ball) [B] through the square hole. Pass the left end (with the
ring) [C] through the notch.

3.

Wind the right end counterclockwise (shown from the machine’s front) five times. Wind the
left end clockwise twice.


The two red marks [D] come together when you have done this. Stick the wire to
the pulley with tape. This lets you easily handle the assembly at the time of
installation.

D129/D130

4-26

SM

Scanner

Install the drive pulley on the shaft [E].


5.

Do not attach the pulley to the shaft with the screw at this time.

Insert the left end into the slit [F]. The end should go via the rear track of the left pulley [G]
and the rear track of the movable pulley [H].

6.

Hook the right end onto the front scanner wire bracket [I]. The end should go via the front
track of the right pulley [J] and the front track of the movable pulley [K].


SM

Do not attach the scanner wire bracket with the screw at this time.

4-27

D129/D130

Replacement
and
Adjustment

4.

Scanner

7.

Remove the tape from the drive pulley.

8.

Insert a scanner-positioning pin [L] through the 2nd carriage hole [M] and the left holes [N]
in the front rail. Insert another scanner positioning pin [O] through the 1st carriage hole [P]
and the right holes in the front rail [Q].

9.

Insert two more scanner positioning pins through the holes in the rear rail.

10. Screw the drive pulley to the shaft [R].
11. Screw the scanner wire bracket to the front rail [S].
12. Install the scanner wire clamp [T].
13. Pull out the positioning pins.


Make sure the 1st and 2nd carriages move smoothly after you remove the
positioning pins. Do steps 8 through 13 again if they do not.



After replacing the scanner wire, do the image adjustments in the following section
of the manual (

D129/D130

"Scanning" in "Copy Adjustments: Printing/Scanning").

4-28

SM

Scanner

4.4.10 REAR SCANNER WIRE
1.

Scanner front cover (

p.4-11 "Scanner Exterior Panels and Operation Panel")

2.

Scanner left cover (

3.

Scanner left stay (

4.

Scanner left rail frame (

5.

Scanner rear cover (

6.

Scanner rear stay (

7.

Rear rail frame [A] (

8.

SIO (

9.

To make reassembly easy, slide the first scanner to the center.

p.4-11 "Scanner Exterior Panels and Operation Panel")
p.4-24 "Front Scanner Wire")
p.4-24 "Front Scanner Wire")
p.4-11 "Scanner Exterior Panels and Operation Panel")

Replacement
and
Adjustment

p.4-22 "Scanner Motor")

x 5)

p.4-24 "Scanner Motor Drive Board")

10. Rear scanner wire clamp [B]
11. Rear scanner wire bracket [C] (
12. Scanner motor gear [D] (

x 1)

x 1)

13. Rear scanner wire and scanner drive pulley [E] (

SM

4-29

x 1)

D129/D130

Scanner

Reassembling the Rear Scanner Wire

1.

Position the center ball [B] in the middle of the forked holder.

2.

Pass the end with the ball [A] through the right square hole from the front.

3.

Position the center ball [B] in the middle of the notch, as shown by the arrow.

4.

Pass the ball end [A] through the drive pulley notch.

5.

Wind the end with the ring [C] clockwise (shown from the machine’s front) three times; wind
the ball end [A] clockwise (shown from the machine’s front) five times.


6.

The two red marks [D] should meet when you have done this.

Stick the wire to the pulley with tape, so you can easily handle the pulley and wire during
installation.

7.

Install the drive pulley on the shaft.


8.

Do not screw the pulley onto the shaft yet.

Install the wire.


The winding of the wire on the three pulleys at the rear of the scanner should be
the same as the winding on the three pulleys at the front. This must show as a
mirror image. Example: At the front of the machine, the side of the drive pulley with
the three windings must face the front of the machine. At the rear of the machine, it
must face the rear.

9.

Perform steps 8 through 13 in “Reassembling the Front Scanner Wire”.


After replacing the scanner wire, do the image adjustments in the following section
of the manual (

D129/D130

"Scanning" in "Copy Adjustments: Printing/Scanning").

4-30

SM

Laser Unit

4.5 LASER UNIT


Turn off the main power switch and unplug the machine before attempting any of the
procedures in this section. Laser beams can seriously damage your eyes.

4.5.1 CAUTION DECAL LOCATIONS
Two caution decals are located in the laser section as shown below. (See the next page for

Replacement
and
Adjustment

removal instructions.)

4.5.2 LASER UNIT

1.

Open the front door.

2.

Front door [A] (pins x 2)

SM

4-31

D129/D130

Laser Unit

3.

Upper inner cover [B] (

4.

Glass cap [C]

5.

Shield glass [D]

6.

Lower inner cover [E] (

7.

Laser unit connectors [E] (


x 2)

x 2)

x 3,

x 1)

Do not disconnect the harnesses on the LD board [F] unless the LD unit has to be
replaced. This board is precisely adjusted in the factory.

8.

Laser unit [G] (


D129/D130

x 2)

When sliding out the laser unit, do not hold the LD board. Hold the laser unit.

4-32

SM

Laser Unit

4.5.3 POLYGON MIRROR MOTOR

Laser unit (

2.

Laser unit cover [A] (

3.

Polygon mirror motor [B] (

4.

After replacing the polygon mirror motor, do the image adjustment (

x 4)
x 4,

x 1)
p.4-108 "Copy

Adjustments: Printing/Scanning").

4.5.4 LASER SYNCHRONIZATION DETECTOR
1.

Laser unit (

2.

Laser synchronization detector [A] (

SM

p.4-31)

x1,

x1)

4-33

D129/D130

Replacement
and
Adjustment

p.4-31)

1.

Laser Unit

4.5.5 LD UNIT
1.

Laser unit (

2.

Upper spring plate [A] (

x 1)

3.

Lower spring plate [B] (

x 1)

4.

LD unit [C] (


p.4-31)

x 1,

x1, spring x 1)

To avoid damaging the LD board, hold it securely when disconnecting the
connectors. Hold the laser unit casing.

5.

After replacing the LD board, do the "Laser Beam Pitch Adjustment" (described in the
following section). Keep the lower inner cover removed before doing this adjustment
because you need to adjust the adjustor screw [D] on the LD unit with a screwdriver.

Laser Beam Pitch Adjustment

1.

Install a (new) LD unit [A] with the left side of the LD unit being lower than the right side.
(This makes this adjustment easier.)

D129/D130

4-34

SM

Laser Unit

2.

Print the test pattern "Hounds Tooth Check (2-Dot Horizontal)" (No. 16 in SP2109-001).

3.

Check if the vertical stripes appear on the second pattern (counted from the leading edge)
of the printout.

4.



Correct: No vertical stripes appear (see the sample following this procedure.)



Wrong: Vertical stripes appear (see the sample following this procedure.)

Turn the adjustor screw [B] by 90 degrees clockwise (counterclockwise).


If the image of the printout is getting worse, try reverse rotation (clockwise
counterclockwise)

5.

Print the test pattern and check it out.

6.

Try steps 2 to 4 again until you get an image with no vertical stripes.

7.

Reassemble the machine after completing this adjustment.

Replacement
and
Adjustment

Correct: No vertical stripes appear

SM

4-35

D129/D130

Laser Unit

Incorrect: Vertical stripes appear

D129/D130

4-36

SM

PCDU

4.6 PCDU
4.6.1 PCDU (PHOTOCONDUCTOR AND DEVELOPMENT UNIT)
Open the front door.

2.

Open the right door [A].

3.

Release the lock lever [B].

4.

Pull out the PCDU [C] and place it on a clean flat surface.

5.

Spread a large piece of paper on a flat surface.


Replacement
and
Adjustment

1.

Make sure the area is free of pins, paper clips, staples, etc. to avoid attraction to
the magnetic development roller.

Reinstallation
Open the right cover before you install the PCDU in the machine.

SM

4-37

D129/D130

PCDU

4.6.2 DRUM
1.

Remove the PCDU (

2.

Toner cap [A]

3.

Insert cap [A] into the opening of the PCDU [B].


4.

Make sure that the cap is inserted completely into the opening.

Open the PCDU [C] (

D129/D130

p.4-37)

x 2).

4-38

SM

PCDU

5.

Bracket [D] (

x 1)

6.

Pull the drum [E] towards the front

(the left side in the illustration) while releasing the

charge roller [F] using the release levers

.

Never touch the drum surface with bare hands.

Replacement
and
Adjustment



[G], and then remove the drum

Re-installation
1.

Replace the drum and close the PCDU (

2.

Put the opening cap [A in the previous procedure] back in its original place.

3.

After replacing the drum, do these SPs:

SM

x 2).



SP 2001: Charge Bias Setting – make sure that this is at the default setting



SP 3001-2: P Sensor Initial Setting (P sensor = ID Sensor)



SP 2805: Process Setting



SP 2810-1: Grayscale Setting

4-39

D129/D130

PCDU

4.6.3 PICK-OFF PAWLS
1.

Drum (

p.4-38)

2.

Pawl assembly [A]

3.

Pick-off pawl [B] (spring x 1, spur x 1)

Pick-off Pawl Position Adjustment
If the pick-off pawl has marked the drum with a line, the pick-off pawl position can be adjusted
using either method:


Changing the spur position



Changing the pick-off pawl assembly position

D129/D130

4-40

SM

PCDU

4.6.4 CHARGE ROLLER AND CLEANING ROLLER
1.

Drum (

p.4-38)

2.

Push the charge roller holder [A] toward the front of the drum (

x 2) and remove the

3.

Charge roller [C].


Disengage the charge roller on the right side to remove it. Try to avoid touching the
charge roller.

4.

Cleaning roller [D]


5.

Disengage the cleaning roller on the left to remove it.

After replacing the charge roller and cleaning roller, check the value of SP2001-001. If it is
not at the standard value (1500), set SP2001-001 to "1500".


If this is not done, the carrier will be attracted to the drum because the charge roller
voltage will be too high.

SM

4-41

D129/D130

Replacement
and
Adjustment

spring [B].

PCDU

4.6.5 DRUM CLEANING BLADE
1.

Drum (

p.4-38)

2.

Charge roller and cleaning roller (

3.

Remove drum cleaning blade [A] (

p.4-41)

x 2)

Re-installation
Put toner on the edge of cleaning blade and the mylar at the back side of cleaning blade before
re-installing this blade.

D129/D130

4-42

SM

PCDU

4.6.6 ID SENSOR
1.

PCDU (

2.

Fusing unit (

3.

ID sensor bracket [A] (

4.

ID sensor [B] (


SM

p.4-37)

x 2,

Replacement
and
Adjustment

p.4-61)

x 1)

x 1)

Do SP3-001-002 to initialize the ID sensor after replacing.

4-43

D129/D130

Development

4.7 DEVELOPMENT
4.7.1 DEVELOPMENT FILTER
1.

PCDU (

p.4-37)

2.

Open the PCDU. (

3.

Upper development cover [A] (

4.

Development filter [B]

p.4-38 "Drum")

x2)

4.7.2 DEVELOPMENT ROLLER
1.

PCDU (

2.

Open the PCDU. (

3.

Upper development cover (

4.

Development roller [A]


D129/D130

p.4-37)
p.4-38 "Drum")
p.4-44 "Development Filter")

Work carefully to avoid scratching or nicking the development roller.

4-44

SM

Development

Cleaning Procedure
PCDU (

p.4-37)

2.

Remove the two screws [A] and open the PCDU as shown above.

3.

Remove the upper development cover [A] (

4.

Fold up a sheet of copy paper [A] to fit the width of the uncovered area of the development

Replacement
and
Adjustment

1.

x 2).

roller, as shown below.
5.

SM

Slide the paper [A] along the length of the roller to clean the toner off the surface.

4-45

D129/D130

Development

6.

Rotate the development roller [A] in the direction of the arrow until the section you cleaned
is no longer visible.

7.

Repeat steps 5 and 6 until you have cleaned the entire surface of the roller.

8.

Reassemble the PCDU and install the PCDU into the machine.

4.7.3 DEVELOPER
1.

PCDU (

2.

Open the PCDU. (

3.

Development roller (

4.

Joint bracket [A] (

5.

Development unit [B]

D129/D130

p.4-37)
p.4-38 "Drum")
p.4-44)

x 2,

x 1)

4-46

SM

Development

6.

Tip out the old developer [C].

7.

Turn drive gear [D] to ensure that no developer remains in the unit or on the developer
roller.


Dispose of the used developer in accordance with local regulations. Work carefully
to avoid scratching or nicking the development roller.

Clean the development roller with a dry cloth.

9.

Pour approximately 1/3 of the developer [E] evenly along the length of the development

Replacement
and
Adjustment

8.

unit.
10. Rotate the drive gear [F] to work the developer into the unit.
11. Repeat steps 8 and 9 until all toner is in the unit and level with the edges.
12. Re-install the development roller.


Make sure that the seals at the both sides of the development roller are set inside
the case after you re-install the development roller.

SM

4-47

D129/D130

Development

13. Place a piece of paper [G] over the toner entrance hole. This prevents used toner falling
from the drum into the development unit during the TD sensor initial setting and interfering
with the Vref setting (toner density reference voltage)
14. Secure the drum [H] to the development unit, to close the PCDU (

x 2).

15. Install the PCDU in the machine and close the front and right doors.
16. Turn on the main power switch, and wait for the machine to warm up.
17. Do SP2801 to initialize the TD sensor and enter the developer lot number.
18. After performing the TD sensor initial setting, remove the sheet of paper from the PCDU.

D129/D130

4-48

SM

Development

4.7.4 TD SENSOR
PCDU (

2.

Empty all developer from the development unit. (

3.

Seal

4.

TD sensor [A] (


p.4-37)
p.4-46 "Developer")

x1)

The TD sensor is attached to the casing with double-sided tape [B]. Pry it off with
the flat head of a screwdriver. Use fresh double-sided tape to re-attach the sensor.

5.

Pour new developer into the development unit and perform the TD sensor initial setting
using SP2-801.


When performing the TD sensor initial setting, cover the toner entrance hole with a
piece of paper.

SM

4-49

D129/D130

Replacement
and
Adjustment

1.

Transfer

4.8 TRANSFER
4.8.1 TRANSFER BELT UNIT


To avoid exposing the drum to strong light, cover it with paper if the right cover will be
open for a long period.

1.

Open the right door [A].

2.

Release the lever [B].

3.

Transfer belt unit [C]


D129/D130

Avoid touching the transfer belt surface.

4-50

SM

Transfer

4.8.2 TRANSFER BELT
1.

Transfer belt unit (

p.4-50)

2.

Connector [A] (

3.

Remove the springs (front and rear) [B].

4.

Release the hooks (front and rear) [C].

5.

Transfer belt with rollers [D]

Replacement
and
Adjustment

x 1)

SM

4-51

D129/D130

Transfer

6.

Lay the transfer belt with rollers on a flat clean surface, and fold the unit [E] to release the
tension on the belt (

7.

x 2).

Transfer belt [F]


Avoid touching the transfer belt surface.



Before installing the new transfer belt, clean all the rollers and shafts with alcohol
to prevent the belt from slipping.



When reinstalling the transfer belt, make sure that the belt is under the pin [F].



To avoid damaging the transfer belt during installation, manually turn the rollers
and make sure that the new transfer belt is not running over the edges of any of
the rollers.

D129/D130

4-52

SM

Transfer

4.8.3 TONER OVERFLOW SENSOR
Transfer belt unit (

p.4-50)

2.

Toner overflow sensor [A] (

x 1,

x 1)

4.8.4 TRANSFER BELT CLEANING BLADE/TONER OVERFLOW
SENSOR
Transfer Belt Cleaning Blade
1.

Transfer belt unit (

2.

Transfer belt (

3.

Transfer belt cleaning blade [A] (


p.4-50)
p.4-51)

x 2)

Avoid touching the edge of the new blade. Check the new blade for dust or
damage.

SM

4-53

D129/D130

Replacement
and
Adjustment

1.

Transfer

Toner Overflow Sensor
1.

Transfer belt unit (

2.

Toner overflow sensor [A] (

D129/D130

p.4-50)

x 1,

x 1)

4-54

SM

Paper Feed

4.9 PAPER FEED
4.9.1 PAPER FEED UNIT
Tray 1 and Tray 2
1.

Right rear cover (

2.

Duplex unit (

3.

Pull out tray 1 and tray 2.

4.

Paper guide plate [A] (hook x 2)

5.

Harness cover [A] (

SM

p.4-5)

Replacement
and
Adjustment

p.4-75)

x 1)

4-55

D129/D130

Paper Feed

6.

Paper feed unit [A] (

x 2,

x 1)

4.9.2 PICK-UP, FEED AND SEPARATION ROLLERS
Tray 1 and Tray 2
1.

Paper feed unit (

p.4-55 "Paper Feed Unit")

2.

Roller holder [A] (

x 1)

3.

Pick-up roller [B]

4.

Feed roller [C]

5.

Separation roller [D] and torque limiter [E] (

D129/D130

x 1)

4-56

SM

Paper Feed

4.9.3 TRAY LIFT MOTOR
Rear cover (

2.

Tray lift motor 1 or 2 [A] (

SM

p.4-4)

x 2,

Replacement
and
Adjustment

1.

x 3)

4-57

D129/D130

Paper Feed

4.9.4 RELAY, TRAY LIFT, PAPER END AND PAPER FEED
SENSORS
Tray 1 and Tray 2
1.

Right rear cover (

2.

Duplex unit (

3.

Paper feed unit (

4.

Tray lift sensor [A] (

5.

Paper end feeler [B] and paper end sensor [C] (hook,

6.

Relay sensor bracket [D] (

7.

Relay sensor [E] (

8.

Paper feed sensor bracket [F] (

9.

Paper feed sensor [G] (

D129/D130

p.4-5)

p.4-75)
p.4-55)

x 1)
x 1 each)

x 1)

x 1, hook)
x 1)

x 1, hook)

4-58

SM

Paper Feed

4.9.5 REGISTRATION SENSOR
1.

Right rear cover (

2.

Duplex unit (

3.

Paper feed unit for tray 1 (

4.

Paper Trays 1 and 2

5.

Paper dust box [A]

6.

Open the front door.

7.

Pull out the paper dust container [B].

8.

Remove two screws [C].

SM

p.4-5)

p.4-75)

Replacement
and
Adjustment

p.4-55 "Paper Feed Unit")

4-59

D129/D130

Paper Feed


9.

This makes the paper guide [D] tilt a little bit. Now you can access the screw [E].

Dust container rail [F] (

10. Sensor bracket [G] (


[E] x 1)
x 1)

You can only access the screw on the sensor bracket from the inside (paper tray
location) of the machine.

11. Registration sensor [H] (

x 1, hooks)

Reinstall the registration sensor
It is very difficult to secure the sensor bracket to the frame. First attach the sensor bracket with
tape temporarily.

D129/D130

4-60

SM

Fusing

4.10 FUSING
4.10.1 FUSING UNIT


Turn off the main switch and wait until the fusing unit cools down before beginning any
of the procedures in this section. The fusing unit can cause serious burns.

Turn off the main power switch.

2.

Open the right door.

3.

Pull up the lock levers [A].

4.

Pull the fusing unit [B] until you hear a click.

Replacement
and
Adjustment

1.



The lock levers lock the fusing unit again at this time to prevent the fusing unit from
falling down.

5.

SM

Pull up the lock levers [A] again, and then remove the fusing unit [B].

4-61

D129/D130

Fusing

4.10.2 WEB ROLLER UNIT
1.

Fusing unit (

p.4-61)

2.

Web roller unit [A] (

x 2)

4.10.3 BRAKE PAD
1.

Web roller unit (

2.

Web left cover [A] (

x 1, stepped screw x 3)

3.

Web top frame [B] (

x 2)

D129/D130

p.4-62)

4-62

SM

Fusing

4.

Web left frame [C] (

5.

Brake pad [D]

x 2)

1.

Web roller unit (

p.4-62)

2.

Web left cover (

p.4-62 "Brake Pad")

3.

Web top frame (

p.4-62 "Brake Pad")

4.

Web left frame (

p.4-62 "Brake Pad")

5.

Front gear bracket [A] (

6.

All gears and bushings (rear side) [B] (

SM

Replacement
and
Adjustment

4.10.4 WEB HOLDER ROLLER AND WEB ROLLERS

x 2)
x 2)

4-63

D129/D130

Fusing

x 2)

7.

Rear gear bracket [C] (

8.

All gear and bushings (rear side) [D] (

9.

Front bracket [E] (

x 2, spring x 1)

x 2)

10. Web holder roller [F] (holder x 2, spring x 2)
)

11. Web take up roller [G] (
12. Web supply roller [H] (

D129/D130

)

4-64

SM

Fusing

Installing a new web holder roller

The holder [A] has a one-way clutch. Make sure that the holder [A] is set at the front side.

Replacement
and
Adjustment

Installing new web rollers

1.

Install the web supply roller [A] first (

). Make sure that the web sheet is under the

pin [B].
2.

Install the web take up roller [C] (

). Make sure that the printed number [D] is

outside the web take up roller.
3.

Reinstall the rear gear bracket (

4.

Reinstall the front and rear gears and bushings (

p.4-63 "Web Holder Roller and Web Rollers").
p.4-63 "Web Holder Roller and Web

Rollers").
5.

SM

Reinstall the rear gear bracket (

p.4-63 "Web Holder Roller and Web Rollers").

4-65

D129/D130

Fusing

6.

Turn the rear gear [E] in the arrow direction to remove the slack in the web sheet.

7.

Reinstall the front gear bracket [F] (

8.

Turn the coupling [G] in the arrow direction to remove the slack in the web sheet.

9.

Reinstall the web unit.

p.4-63 "Web Holder Roller and Web Rollers").

10. If you install a new cleaning web, reset SP 7806-008 (press "Execute" on the LCD).

4.10.5 PRESSURE ROLLER CLEANING ROLLER
1.

Fusing unit (

2.

Fusing exit guide [A] (lock x 2)

3.

Fusing front upper cover [B] (

x 3)

4.

Fusing rear upper cover [C] (

x 3)

5.

Fusing outer guide [D] (front:

D129/D130

p.4-61)

x 1, rear: stepped screw x 1)

4-66

SM

Fusing

x 4)

6.

Cleaning roller unit [E] (

7.

Pressure roller cleaning roller [F] (spring x 2, holder x 2)

1.

Fusing unit (

2.

Web roller unit (

3.

Fusing top cover [A] (front:

4.

Thermostat holder [B] (

x 2)

5.

Thermostat cover [C] (

x 2)

6.

Thermostat [D] (terminal x 2)

SM

Replacement
and
Adjustment

4.10.6 THERMOSTATS
p.4-61)
p.4-62)

x 1, rear: stepped screw x 1)

4-67

D129/D130

Fusing

4.10.7 THERMISTOR
1.

Fusing unit (

2.

Web roller unit (

3.

Fusing top cover (

4.

Pull the two tabs [A].

5.

Disconnect the two terminals [B].

6.

Sensor stays [C] (

7.

Thermistors [D] (

D129/D130

p.4-61)
p.4-62)
p.4-67 "Thermostats")

x 1 each)
x 2,

x 1)

4-68

SM

Fusing

4.10.8 HOT ROLLER STRIPPERS
1.

Fusing unit (

2.

Web roller unit (

3.

Fusing top cover (

4.

Fusing top frame [A] (


p.4-61)
p.4-62)

Replacement
and
Adjustment

p.4-67 "Thermostats")

x 5)

The cords on this frame are still connected to the fusing unit at this time. Be careful
not to damage the cords when removing the hot roller stripper [B].

5.

SM

Hot roller stripper [B] (spring x 1)

4-69

D129/D130

Fusing

4.10.9 FUSING LAMPS
1.

Fusing unit (

2.

Web roller unit (

3.

Fusing top cover (

4.

Connector cover [A] (

5.

Fusing top frame with connector [B] (

6.

Fusing front lower cover [C] (

7.

Fusing front frame [D] (

8.

Fusing rear lower cover [E] (

9.

Fusing rear frame [F] (

D129/D130

p.4-61)
p.4-62)
p.4-67 "Thermostats")

x 2)
x 9)

x 2)

x 3)
x 2)

x 5)

4-70

SM

Fusing

x 4)

10. Terminal bracket [G] (

11. Front holder bracket [H] (
12. Terminal base [I] (

x 1)

x 3)

13. Rear holder bracket [J] (

x 1)
Replacement
and
Adjustment

14. Fusing lamp-Center (550W) [K]
15. Fusing lamp-End (750W) [L]

4.10.10 HOT ROLLER AND PRESSURE ROLLER
1.

Fusing lamps-Center and End (

2.

Hot roller [A] (snap ring x 2, gear x 2, bushing x 2)

3.

Pressure roller [B] (

SM

p.4-70 "Fusing Lamps")

x 2, bushing x 2)

4-71

D129/D130

Paper Exit

4.11 PAPER EXIT
4.11.1 PAPER EXIT UNIT
1.

Fusing unit (

2.

Fusing exhaust fan duct (

3.

Paper exit unit [A] (

D129/D130

p.4-61)

x 3,

p.4-106 "Fusing Exhaust Fan")

x 2)

4-72

SM

Paper Exit

1.

Paper exit unit (

2.

Sensor bracket [A] (

3.

Paper exit sensor [B] (

4.

Paper overflow sensor [C] (

5.

Sensor bracket [D] (

6.

Fusing exit sensor [E] (

Replacement
and
Adjustment

4.11.2 FUSING EXIT, PAPER OVERFLOW, AND PAPER EXIT
SENSORS

p.4-72)
x 1)
x 1, hooks)
x 1, hooks)

x 2)
x 1,

x 1)

4.11.3 JUNCTION JAM SENSOR

1.

Paper exit unit (

p.4-72)

2.

Paper guide [A] (

x 3)

3.

Junction jam sensor [B] (

SM

x 1)

4-73

D129/D130

Paper Exit

4.11.4 PAPER EXIT MOTOR
1.

Paper exit unit (

2.

Motor cover [A] (

3.

Exit motor [B] (

D129/D130

p.4-72)

x 1)
x 2,

x 2,

x 1)

4-74

SM

Duplex

4.12 DUPLEX
4.12.1 DUPLEX UNIT
Right rear cover (

2.

Open the lower right cover [A] at the duplex unit.

3.

Release the tab [B] and remove the lower door (spring x 2).

4.

Open the right door.

5.

Release the front link [C] (

SM

p.4-5)

Replacement
and
Adjustment

1.

x 1).

4-75

D129/D130

Duplex

6.

Keep the right door fully open.

7.

Push up the duplex unit a little bit, while pressing the bracket [D] to lock the spring [E].


Do not let the duplex unit open fully before releasing the wire (step 9). Otherwise,
the lock for the spring [E] is released.

8.

Wire [F] (

9.

Push the projection [G].

D129/D130

x 1)

4-76

SM

Duplex

10. Duplex unit (

x 3,

x 1, ground cable x 1)

1.

Open the duplex door [A] and by-pass tray.

2.

Right door cover [B] (

Replacement
and
Adjustment

4.12.2 RIGHT DOOR COVER

x 4)

4.12.3 DUPLEX DOOR SENSOR
1.

Right door cover (

2.

Duplex door sensor [A] (

SM

p.4-77)

x 1, hook)

4-77

D129/D130

Duplex

4.12.4 DUPLEX ENTRANCE SENSOR
1.

Right door cover (

2.

Open the right door.

3.

Duplex entrance guide [A] ([B]:

4.

Duplex entrance sensor bracket [A] (

5.

Duplex entrance sensor [A] (hooks)

D129/D130

p.4-77)

x1, [C]: Stepped screw x 2)

x 1,

4-78

x 1)

SM

Duplex

4.12.5 DUPLEX EXIT SENSOR
Transfer belt unit (

2.

Right door rear cover [A] (

3.

Remove the shaft [B] (

4.

Transfer belt unit holder [C] (


p.4-50)

Replacement
and
Adjustment

1.

x 3)

x 1).
x 1,

x 1)

When re-installing the transfer belt unit holder, make sure that the spring [D]
correctly hooks onto the frame.

SM

4-79

D129/D130

Duplex

5.

Guide plate [E] (two hooks)

6.

Duplex exit sensor [F] (

D129/D130

x 1, hooks)

4-80

SM

Duplex

4.12.6 DUPLEX/BY-PASS MOTOR
1.

Rear cover (

2.

Right rear cover (

3.

Frame [A] (

4.

Duplex/By-pass motor bracket [B] (

5.

Duplex/By-pass motor [C] (

SM

p.4-4)

Replacement
and
Adjustment

p.4-5)

x 4)
x 2,

x 1)

x 4, bushing x 8, timing belt x 1)

4-81

D129/D130

Duplex

4.12.7 DUPLEX INVERTER MOTOR
1.

Right door cover (

2.

Open the right door.

3.

Right door rear cover [A] (

4.

Duplex door [B]

5.

Duplex guide plate [C] (

D129/D130

p.4-77)

x 3)

x 3)

4-82

SM

Duplex

x 2)

Bracket [D] (

7.

Duplex inverter motor [E] (

x 3,

x 1)
Replacement
and
Adjustment

6.

SM

4-83

D129/D130

By-pass

4.13 BY-PASS
4.13.1 BY-PASS PAPER SIZE SENSOR/BY-PASS PAPER LENGTH
SENSOR

1.

Open the lower right cover [A].

2.

Disconnect the connector and clamp.

3.

Open the by-pass tray [A].

D129/D130

4-84

SM

By-pass

4.

Move the side fences to the center.

5.

By-pass tray cover [A] (

6.

By-pass paper size sensor [A] (

7.

By-pass paper length sensor [B] (

Replacement
and
Adjustment

x 4)

SM

x 1)
x 1)

4-85

D129/D130

By-pass

When reinstalling the by-pass paper size sensor

1.

Adjust the projection [A] of the left side fence bar (it must be centered).

2.

Install the by-pass paper size detection switch so that the hole [B] in this switch faces the
projection [C] of the left side fence bar.

3.

Reassemble the copier.

4.

Plug in and turn on the main power switch.

5.

Check this switch operation with SP5803-024 (By-pass: Paper Size Sensor< Input Check).

- Display on the LCD -

Paper Size

Display

Paper Size

Display

A3 SEF

00001110

A5 SEF

00001011

B4 SEF

00001100

B6 SEF

00000011

A4 SEF

00001101

A6 SEF

00000111

B5 SEF

00001001

Smaller A6 SEF

00001111

D129/D130

4-86

SM

By-pass

4.13.2 BY-PASS PAPER END SENSOR
Right door cover (

p.4-77 "Right Door Cover")

2.

By-pass feed unit cover [A] (

3.

By-pass paper end sensor [B] (

x 2).
x 1, hooks)

4.13.3 BY-PASS PICK-UP, FEED AND SEPARATION ROLLER,
TORQUE LIMITER
1.

Right door cover (

2.

By-pass feed unit cover (

3.

By-pass pick-up roller [A] (hook)

4.

By-pass feed roller [B] (

5.

By-pass separation roller [C] (

6.

Torque limiter [D]

SM

p.4-77)
p.4-87 "By-pass Paper End Sensor")

x 1)
x 1)

4-87

D129/D130

Replacement
and
Adjustment

1.

By-pass

4.13.4 BY-PASS FEED CLUTCH
1.

Open the right door.

2.

Right door rear cover (

3.

Transfer belt unit (

4.

Transfer belt unit holder (

5.

By-pass feed clutch holder [A] (

6.

By-pass feed clutch [B] (

D129/D130

p.4-79 "Duplex Exit Sensor")
p.4-50)
p.4-79 "Duplex Exit Sensor")

x 1,

x 2)
x 1)

4-88

SM

Drive Area

4.14 DRIVE AREA
4.14.1 PAPER FEED CLUTCH
Tray 1 and Tray 2
Rear cover (

p.4-4)

2.

Clutch bracket [A] (

3.

Paper feed clutch [B] (

Replacement
and
Adjustment

1.

SM

x 2,

x 1, bushing x 1)
x 1)

4-89

D129/D130

Drive Area

4.14.2 DEVELOPMENT PADDLE MOTOR
1.

Rear cover (

p.4-4)

2.

Development paddle motor [A] (

x 4,

x 1)

4.14.3 TRANSFER/DEVELOPMENT MOTOR
1.

Rear cover (

2.

Transfer/development motor [A] (

D129/D130

p.4-4)

x 4,

x 1)

4-90

SM

Drive Area

4.14.4 DRUM MOTOR
Rear cover (

2.

Drum motor [A] (

p.4-4)

x 4,

Replacement
and
Adjustment

1.

x 1)

4.14.5 FUSING MOTOR
1.

Rear cover (

2.

Fusing motor [A] (

SM

p.4-4)

x 4,

x 1)

4-91

D129/D130

Drive Area

4.14.6 WEB MOTOR
1.

Rear cover (

p.4-4)

2.

Bracket [A] (

3.

Web motor [B] (

x 1)
x 1,

x 1)

4.14.7 PAPER FEED MOTOR
1.

Rear cover (

2.

Right rear cover (

3.

Paper feed motor [A] (

D129/D130

p.4-4)
p.4-5)

x 2,

x 1)

4-92

SM

Drive Area

4.14.8 TRANSFER BELT CONTACT MOTOR
1.

Rear cover (

p.4-4)

2.

Right rear cover (

3.

Transfer belt contact motor [A] (

p.4-5)

x 1)
Replacement
and
Adjustment

x 2,

4.14.9 REGISTRATION MOTOR
1.

Rear cover (

2.

Right rear cover (

3.

Registration motor bracket [A] (

4.

Registration motor [B] (

SM

p.4-4)
p.4-5)

x 2,

x 3,

x 1)

x 1)

4-93

D129/D130

Drive Area

4.14.10 TONER SUPPLY MOTOR
1.

Left cover (

2.

Upper inner cover (

3.

Inner Tray (

4.

Exhaust duct [A] (

5.

Toner supply motor [B] (hooks,

D129/D130

p.4-4)
p.4-3 "Front Door, Upper and Lower Inner Cover")

p.4-9)

x 2)
x 1)

4-94

SM

Electrical Components

4.15 ELECTRICAL COMPONENTS

1.

SM

Controller unit [A] (

Replacement
and
Adjustment

4.15.1 CONTROLLER UNIT

x 2)

4-95

D129/D130

Electrical Components

4.15.2 HDD UNIT
Before Replacing the HDD Unit
Copy the address book data to an SD card from the HDD with SP5846-051 if possible.

Replacement Procedure
1.

Controller unit (

2.

HDD unit [A] with connecting board [B] (

D129/D130

p.4-95)

x 3,

4-96

x 2)

SM

3.

HDD unit [A] (

x 2,

Replacement
and
Adjustment

Electrical Components

x 2)

After installing the new HDD unit
1.

Do SP5832-001 to format the hard disk.

2.

Do SP5853-001 to copy the preset stamp data from the firmware to the hard disk.

3.

Do SP5846-052 to copy back the address book to the hard disk from the SD card to which
you have already copied the address book data if possible.

4.

Turn the main power switch off/on.

Disposal of HDD Units


Never remove an HDD unit from the work site without the consent of the client.



If the customer has any concerns about the security of any information on the HDD, the
HDD must remain with the customer for disposal or safe keeping.



The HDD may contain proprietary or classified (Confidential, Secret) information.
Specifically, the HDD contains document server documents and data stored in temporary
files created automatically during copy job sorting and jam recovery. Such data is stored on
the HDD in a special format so it cannot normally be read but can be recovered with illegal
methods.

SM

4-97

D129/D130

Electrical Components

Reinstallation


Explain to the customer that the following information stored on the HDD is lost when the
HDD is replaced: document server documents, fixed stamps, document server address
book



The address book and document server documents (if needed) must be input again.

4.15.3 CONTROLLER BOARD


The battery on the control board can explode if replaced incorrectly.



Dispose of the old battery in accordance with the instructions.

Before Replacing the Controller Board in the Model without HDD
When you replace the controller board in a model without a HDD, address book data can be
copied from an old controller board to a new controller board using an SD card.
Copy the address book data to an SD card from the flash ROM on the controller board with
SP5846-051 if possible.

Replacement Procedure
1.

Controller unit (

2.

HDD unit (if it has been installed.) (

3.

Controller cover [A] (

D129/D130

p.4-95)
p.4-96)

x 2)

4-98

SM

Electrical Components

4.

Controller right bracket [A] (

5.

Controller board assembly [A] (

Replacement
and
Adjustment

x 5)

SM

x 4, connector caps)

4-99

D129/D130

Electrical Components

6.

NVRAMs [A]

7.

Interface rails [B] (hooks each)

8.

DIMM-RAM (If it is installed.)

9.

Controller board [C]

When Installing the New Controller Board
1.

Remove the NVRAMs from the old controller board.

2.

Install them on the new controller board after you replace the controller board.

3.

Replace the NVRAMs if the NVRAM on the old controller board is defective.


Make sure you print out the SMC reports ("SP Mode Data" and "Logging Data")
before you replace the NVRAMs.



Keep NVRAMs away from any objects that can cause static electricity. Static
electricity can damage NVRAM data.



Make sure the NVRAMs are correctly installed on the controller board.



Make sure that the DIP-switch settings on the old controller board are the same for
the new controller board. Do not change the DIP switches on the controller board
in the field.

D129/D130

4-100

SM

Electrical Components

4.15.4 AFTER INSTALLING THE CONTROLLER BOARD
1.

For a model without a HDD, do SP5846-052 to copy back the address book to the flash
ROM on the controller board from the SD card to which you have already copied the
address book data if possible.

2.

If the customer is using the data encryption feature, the encryption key must be restored.

3.

Turn the main power switch off/on.

4.15.5 MOTHER BOARD
1.

Rear cover (

p.4-4)

2.

Controller unit (

3.

Exhaust fan duct [A] (

Replacement
and
Adjustment

p.4-95)

SM

x 2,

x 1)

4-101

D129/D130

Electrical Components

4.

Controller box [A] (

x 6,

5.

Mother board [A] (

x 6)

D129/D130

x 4,

x 3)

4-102

SM

Electrical Components

4.15.6 BCU
1.

Controller box (

2.

BCU [A] (

3.

Remove the NVRAM [A] from the old board and install it on the new board.

4.

Set the DIP switches on the new BCU board to the same settings as the old board.

x 4)
Replacement
and
Adjustment

x 4,

p.4-101 "Mother Board")



Make sure the NVRAM is correctly installed on the BCU. Insert the NVRAM in the
NVRAM slot with the "half-moon" pointing [B] to the left side.

SM

4-103

D129/D130

Electrical Components

When installing the new BCU
1.

Remove the NVRAM from the old BCU.

2.

Install the NVRAM on the new BCU after you replace the BCU.

3.

Reassemble the machine.

4.

Turn on the main power switch.

5.

"SC995-01" occurs.

6.

Enter the serial number with SP5-811-004.

7.

Turn the main power switch off and on.


Make sure you print out the SMC reports ("SP Mode Data" and "Logging Data") before
you replace the NVRAM.



Keep NVRAM away from any objects that can cause static electricity. Static electricity
can damage NVRAM data.

4.15.7 IPU
1.

Controller box (

2.

IPU[[A] (

D129/D130

x 6,

p.4-101 "Mother Board")

x all)

4-104

SM

Electrical Components

4.15.8 IOB
Rear cover (

2.

IOB [A] (

p.4-4)

x 6,

Replacement
and
Adjustment

1.

x all)

When installing a new IOB
Set the bit switches on the new IOB to the same settings as the old IOB.

4.15.9 PSU
1.

Left cover (

2.

PSU [A] (

3.

Two clamps [B] (These clamps will be used for the new PSU.)

SM

p.4-4)

x 4,

x all)

4-105

D129/D130

Electrical Components

4.15.10 HIGH VOLTAGE POWER SUPPLY
1.

Rear cover (

p.4-4)

2.

Right rear cover (

3.

High voltage power supply board [A] (

p.4-5)

x 5,

x all)

4.15.11 FUSING EXHAUST FAN
1.

Rear cover (

p.4-4)

2.

Fusing exhaust duct [A] (

3.

Separate the duct (hooks).

4.

Fusing exhaust fan [B]

x 2,

x 1)

When installing the fusing exhaust fan
Make sure that the fusing fan is installed with its decal facing the right side of the machine.

D129/D130

4-106

SM

Electrical Components

4.15.12 CONTROLLER FAN
1.

Controller box (

p.4-101 "Mother Board")

2.

Fan cover [A] (

3.

Controller fan [B] (

x 2)
Replacement
and
Adjustment

x 1)

When installing the controller fan
Make sure that the controller fan is installed with its decal facing upward.

SM

4-107

D129/D130

Electrical Components

⇒

Rev. 1/4/2013

4.15.13 NVRAM ON THE BCU BOARD
Replacement Procedure for the NVRAM on the BCU Board
1. Turn the main power switch ON.
2. Access SP5990-001 and print out all data lists.
2. Turn the main power switch OFF.
3. Insert the SD card into the lower slot on the controller box.
4. Turn the main power switch ON.
5. Upload the NVRAM data (SP5-824-001) onto the SD card.
6. Turn the main power switch OFF.
7. Remove the old NVRAM from the BCU and attach the new one.
Important: Even if SC995 is displayed when you turn on the main switch (after
replacing the NVRAM), continue with this procedure.
9. Access SP5807-001 and set the area code.
Important: SP5807-001 is a Sales SP mode. Dealers must contact the Hotline for the
regional support rep. Direct must contact the Hotline for Sensei rep.
- The initial value stored in the NVRAM is “1”.
- After the NVRAM is replaced, the display for SP5807-001 changes to Japanese.
- Refer to the following area destination code list.
Area code

Destination

1

JP

2

NA

3

EU

4

TWN

5

AA

6

CHN

7

KOR

10. Access SP5-811-001 and program the machine serial number.
11. Access SP5-811-004 and program the BCU serial number.
12. Turn the main switch off.
13. Download the NVRAM data (SP5-825-001) stored on the SD card in Step 5 onto the
machine.
14. Remove the SD card from the lower slot in the controller box.
Important: If you cannot upload the NVRAM data (SP5-824-001) or download the NVRAM data
(SP5-825-001), do the following:
-Enter the data from the SMC report manually (included in the factory sheet).
-Reinstall the security options (Data Overwrite Security, HDD Encryption).

D129/D130

4-108

SM

Copy Adjustments: Printing/Scanning

Rev. 12/27/2012

4.16 COPY ADJUSTMENTS: PRINTING/SCANNING
4.16.1 OVERVIEW
Perform these adjustments after replacing any of the following:
ƒ

Scanner Wire

ƒ

Lens Block/SBU Assembly

ƒ

Scanner Drive Motor

ƒ

Polygon Mirror Motor

ƒ

Paper Side Fence

ƒ

Memory All Clear

4.16.2 PRINTING
Make sure paper is installed correctly in each paper tray before you start these
adjustments.
2.

Use the Trimming Area Pattern (SP2-109-1, No. 14) to print the test pattern for the following
procedures.

Registration - Leading Edge/Side-to-Side

1.

Check the leading edge registration [A] for each paper type and paper feed station, and
adjust it with following SP modes.

SP No.
Tray: Plain

Specification

SP1-001-1
0 ±9.0 mm

Tray: Thick 1

SM

SP1-001-2

4-109

D129/D130

Replacement
and
Adjustment

1.

Copy Adjustments: Printing/Scanning

Rev. 12/27/2012

SP No.

2.

Tray: Thick 2

SP1-001-3

By-pass: Plain

SP1-001-4

By-pass: Thick 1

SP1-001-5

By-pass: Thick 2

SP1-001-6

Duplex: Plain

SP1-001-7

Duplex: Thick 1

SP1-001-8

Specification

Check side-to-side registration [B] for each paper feed station, and adjust with the following
SP modes.

SP No.
By-pass

SP1-002-1

Tray 1

SP1-002-2

Tray 2

SP1-002-3

Tray 3

SP1-002-4

Tray 4

SP1-002-5

LCT

SP1-002-6

Duplex

SP1-002-7

D129/D130

Specification

0 ±4.0 mm

4-110

SM

Copy Adjustments: Printing/Scanning

Rev. 12/27/2012

Blank Margin
ƒ

If the leading edge/side-to-side registration cannot be adjusted within specifications,

1.

Check the trailing edge [A], right edge [B], leading edge [C] and left edge [D] blank margins,
and adjust them with the following SP modes.

SP No.
Leading Edge

Specification

SP2-103-1
3.0 mm [0.0 to 9.0 mm]

Trailing Edge

SP2-103-2

Left

SP2-103-3
2.0 mm [0.0 to 9.0 mm]

Right
Duplex: Trailing Edge:
L Size: Plain
Duplex: Trailing Edge:
M Size: Plain
Duplex: Trailing Edge:
S Size: Plain

SP2-103-4

SP2-103-5

1.0 mm [0.0 to 4.0 mm]

SP2-103-6

0.8 mm [0.0 to 4.0 mm]

SP2-103-7

0.6 mm [0.0 to 4.0 mm]

Duplex: Left: Plain

SP2-103-8

Duplex: Right: Plain

SP2-103-9

0.3 mm [0.0 to 1.5 mm]

SM

4-111

D129/D130

Replacement
and
Adjustment

adjust the leading/left side edge blank margin.

Copy Adjustments: Printing/Scanning

Rev. 12/27/2012

SP No.
Duplex: Trailing Edge:
L Size: Thick
Duplex: Trailing Edge:
M Size: Thick
Duplex: Trailing Edge:
S Size: Thick
Duplex: Left: Thick

SP2-103-10

Specification
0.8 mm [0.0 to 4.0 mm]

SP2-103-11

0.6 mm [0.0 to 4.0 mm]

SP2-103-12

0.4 mm [0.0 to 4.0 mm]

SP2-103-13
0.1 mm [0.0 to 1.5 mm]

Duplex: Right: Thick

SP2-103-14

ƒ

L Size: Paper length is 297.1 mm or more.

ƒ

M Size: Paper length is 216.1 to 297 mm

ƒ

S Size: Paper length is 216 mm or less.

Main Scan Magnification
1.

Use SP2-109-001 no 5 (Grid Pattern) to print a single dot pattern.

2.

Check magnification, and then SP2-102 (Magnification Adjustment Main Scan) to adjust
magnification if required. Specification: ±2%.

Parallelogram Image Adjustment
Do the following procedure if a parallelogram prints while adjusting the printing registration or
printing margin using a trimming area pattern.
The following procedure should be done after adjusting the side-to-side registration for each
paper tray station.
Use SP2-109-1 No. 14 (Trimming Area) to determine whether a parallelogram image appears. If
the parallelogram pattern appears, perform the following procedure.

D129/D130

4-112

SM

1.

Laser unit [A]

2.

Bracket [B] (

3.

Install adjustment cam [C] (P/N: A2309003).

4.

Secure positioning pin [D] (P/N A2309004) with the two screws removed with the bracket

x2)

[B]. Do not tighten the screws at this time.
5.

To adjust the position of the laser unit [E]
1) Adjust the laser unit position by turning the adjustment cam. (See the illustration above.)
2) Tighten the adjustment bracket.
3) Print the trimming area pattern to check the image. If the results are not satisfactory,
repeat steps 5-1) to 5-3).

SM

4-113

D129/D130

Replacement
and
Adjustment

Copy Adjustments: Printing/Scanning

Rev. 12/27/2012

Copy Adjustments: Printing/Scanning

Rev. 12/27/2012

4.16.3 SCANNING
Before doing the following scanner adjustments, perform or check the printing
registration/side-to-side adjustment and the blank margin adjustment.
ƒ

Use the S5S test chart to perform the following adjustments.

Registration: Platen Mode

1.

Place the test chart on the exposure glass and make a copy from one of the feed stations.

2.

Check the leading edge [A] and side-to-side [B] registration, and adjust them with the
following SP modes if necessary.

SP No.

Specification

Leading Edge

SP4-010-1

0 ±2.0 mm

Side-to-side

SP4-011-1

0 ±2.5 mm

D129/D130

4-114

SM

Copy Adjustments: Printing/Scanning

Rev. 12/27/2012

Magnification
Use the S5S test chart to perform the following adjustment.

1.

Place the test chart on the exposure glass and make a copy from one of the feed stations.

2.

Check the magnification ratio. Use SP4-008 (Scanner Sub Scan Magnification) to adjust if
necessary. Specification: ±0.9%.

SM

4-115

D129/D130

Replacement
and
Adjustment

Sub Scan Magnification

Copy Adjustments: Printing/Scanning

Rev. 12/27/2012

4.16.4 ADF
Registration

1.

Make a temporary test chart as shown above using A3/DLT paper.

2.

Place the temporary test chart on the ADF and make a copy from one of the feed stations.

3.

Check the registration, and adjust using the following SP modes if necessary.

SP No.

Specification

Side-to-side: 1st side

SP6-006-1

Side-to-side: 2nd side

SP6-006-2

Leading Edge

SP6-006-3

0.0 mm ±5 mm

Leading Edge: 1st side

SP6-006-5

0.0 mm ±3 mm

Leading Edge: 2nd side

SP6-006-6

0.0 mm ±2.5 mm

Trailing Erase edge:

SP6-006-7

0.0 mm ±10.0 mm

0.0 mm ±3 mm

D129/D130

4-116

SM

Copy Adjustments: Printing/Scanning

Rev. 12/27/2012

4.16.5 TOUCH SCREEN CALIBRATION

⇒ After clearing the memory, replacing the operation panel or NVRAM, or if the touch panel
detection function is not working correctly, follow this procedure to calibrate the touch screen.
ƒ

Do not attempt to use items [2] to [7] on the Self-Diagnostic Menu. These items are for

1.

Press

, "1", "9", "9", "3", and then press

5 times to open the Self-Diagnostics

menu.
2.

On the touch screen press "Touch Screen Adjust" (or press "1").

3.

Use a pointed (not sharp!) tool to press the upper left mark

4.

Press the lower right mark

5.

Touch a few spots on the touch panel to confirm that the marker (+) appears exactly where

.

after it appears.

the screen is touched.
If the + mark does not appear where the screen is touched, press Cancel and repeat from
Step 2.
6.

When you are finished, press [#] OK on the screen (or press

7.

Touch [#] Exit on the screen to close the Self-Diagnostic menu and save the calibration

).

settings.

SM

4-117

D129/D130

Replacement
and
Adjustment

design use only.

SERVICE TABLES
R E V I S I O N H I S T O RY
Pag e

Date

Ad d ed / Upd ated / New
None

Service Program Mode

5. SERVICE TABLES
5.1 SERVICE PROGRAM MODE


Never turn off the main power switch when the power LED is lit or flashing. To avoid
damaging the hard disk or memory, press the operation switch to switch the power off,
wait for the power LED to go off, and then switch the main power switch off.



The main power LED lights or flashes while the platen cover or ARDF is open, while
the main machine is communicating with a facsimile or the network server, or while the
machine is accessing the hard disk or memory for reading or writing data.

5.1.1 SERVICE PROGRAM MODE OPERATION
The service program (SP) mode is used to check electrical data, change modes, and adjust
values.


Never turn off the main power switch when the power LED is lit or flashing. To avoid
damaging the hard disk or memory, press the operation switch to switch the power off,
Service
Tables

wait for the power LED to go off, and then switch the main power switch off.

Service Mode Lock/Unlock
At locations where the machine contains sensitive data, the customer engineer cannot operate
the machine until the Administrator turns the service mode lock off. This function makes sure
that work on the machine is always done with the permission of the Administrator.
1.

If you cannot go into the SP mode, ask the Administrator to log in with the User Tool and
then set "Service Mode Lock" to OFF. After he or she logs in:
[User Tools] > System Settings > Administrator Tools > Service Mode Lock > OFF


This unlocks the machine and lets you get access to all the SP codes.



The service technician can do servicing on the machine and turn the machine off and
on. It is not necessary to ask the Administrator to log in again each time the machine is
turned on.

2.

SM

If you must use the printer bit switches, go into the SP mode and set SP5169 to "1".

5-1

D129/D130

Service Program Mode

3.

After machine servicing is completed:


Change SP5169 from "1" to "0".



Turn the machine off and on.



Tell the administrator that you completed servicing the machine.



The administrator will then set the "Service Mode Lock" to ON.

5.1.2 SERVICE PROGRAM MODE TABLES
Please note these general changes in this section:


Group 8(Data Log 2) is a new group of counters.



Along with the addition of Group 8, many of the Group 7 counters have been removed.

Service Table Key

Notation

What it means
Example: [-9 to +9 / 0 / 0.1 mm step]. The setting can be

[range / default / step]

adjusted in the range ±9, value reset to +3.0 after an NVRAM
reset, and the value can be changed in 0.1 mm steps with
each key press.

*

DFU

Japan only

Value stored in NVRAM. After a RAM reset, this default value
(factory setting) is restored.
Denotes "Design or Factory Use". Do not change this value.
The feature or item is for Japan only. Do not change this
value.

C2b

D129

C2c

D130

SSP

This denotes a "Special Service Program" mode.

D129/D130

5-2

SM

Service Program Mode Tables

5.2 SERVICE PROGRAM MODE TABLES
5.2.1 SP TABLES
There are the most commonly used SP codes in the "Main SP Tables - 1 to - 9" of "Main
Chapters".
See "Appendices" for the following information:
System SP Tables



Printer SP Tables



Scanner SP Tables

Service
Tables



SM

5-3

D129/D130

Main SP Tables-1

5.3 MAIN SP TABLES-1
5.3.1 SP1-XXX: FEED

Leading Edge Registration
1001*

Adjusts the leading edge registration by changing the registration clutch
operation timing.
001 Tray: Plain
002 Tray: Thick 1
003 Tray: Thick 2
004 By-pass: Plain
[–9 to 9/ 0 / 0.1 mm step]
005 By-pass: Thick 1
006 By-pass: Thick 2
007 Duplex: Plain
008 Duplex: Thick 1

Side-to-Side Registration
1002*

Adjusts the side to side registration by changing the laser main scan start
position for each mode.
001 By-pass
002 Tray 1
003 Tray 2
004 Tray 3

[–4 to 4/ 0 / 0.1 mm step]

005 Tray 4
006 LCT
007 Duplex

D129/D130

5-4

SM

Main SP Tables-1

Registration Buckle Adjustment
1003*

Adjusts the paper feed motor timing. Paper feed motor timing determines
the amount of paper buckle at Registration. (A "+" setting causes more
buckling.)
001 Tray 1: Plain
002 Tray 1: Thick 1
003 Tray 1: Thick 2
[-9 to 5 / -4 / 1 mm step]
004 Tray 2, 3, 4: Plain
005 Tray 2, 3, 4: Thick1
006 Tray 2, 3, 4: Thick2
007 By-pass: Plain
008 By-pass: Thick 1

[-9 to 5 / -2 /1 mm step]

010 Duplex: Plain

[-9 to 5 / -4 / 1 mm step]

011 Duplex: Thick 1

[-9 to 5 / -3 / 1 mm step]

Service
Tables

009 By-pass: Thick 2

012 LCT: Plain
013 LCT: Thick1

[-9 to 5 / -4 / 1 mm step]

014 LCT: Thick2

By-pass Paper Size Detection
1007*
Controls paper size detection for the by-pass feed table.
001 Detection Timing

002 LG Detection

SM

[-15 to 15 / 0 / 5 mm step]
[0 to 1 / 0 / 1]
0: LTSEF, 1: LG

5-5

D129/D130

Main SP Tables-1

Fusing Temperature Adjustment
Allows adjustment of the hot roller temperature at the center and ends of the
roller for the quality or thickness of the paper. The hot roller in this machine
has two fusing lamps: one heats the center of the roller, the other heats both
1105*

ends. Each fusing lamp can be adjusted separately.
The "re-load temperature" is the "print ready temperature". When the fusing
temperature exceeds this setting, the machine can operate. Do not set up a
re-load temperature (Re-load Temp. = Fusing. Temp – SP Value.) that is
higher than the SP1-105-2 setting.

Roller Center
001

C2b: [100 to 170 / 140 / 1 deg]
C2c: [100 to 170 / 150 / 1 deg]

Adjusts the fusing temperature at the center of the hot roller.

Roller Ends
002

C2b: [100 to 170 / 145 / 1 deg]
C2c: [100 to 170 / 155 / 1 deg]

Adjusts the fusing temperature at the ends of the hot roller.
Re-load Temp. Minus: Roller Center

[0 to 60 / 0 / 1 deg]

Sets the reload temperature for the center of the hot roller. This setting
depends on the target temperature.
003 Reload temp. = Target Temp – This SP Setting


Do not set a temperature that is higher than the setting for SP1105 1
(Roller Center: Trays)

Re-load Temp. Minus: Roller Ends

[0 to 60 / 0 / 1 deg]

Sets the reload temperature for the ends of the hot roller. This setting depends
on the target temperature.
004 Reload temp. = Target Temp – This SP Setting


Do not set a temperature that is higher than the setting for SP1105 2
(Roller Ends: Trays)

005 to The following SPs adjust the fusing temperature at the center or ends of the
022 hot roller for each paper type.

D129/D130

5-6

SM

Main SP Tables-1

005 Roller Center: M-Thick

006 Roller Ends: M-Thick

C2b: [100 to 170 / 145 / 1 deg]
C2c: [100 to 170 / 155 / 1 deg]
C2b: [100 to 170 / 150 / 1 deg]
C2c: [100 to 170 / 160 / 1 deg]

007 Roller Center: Thick 1
[100 to 170 / 130 / 1 deg]
008 Roller Ends: Thick 1
009 Roller Center: Thick 2
[100 to 170 / 150/ 1 deg]
010 Wait Temp: Center Minus

011 Wait Temp: Ends Minus

012 Roller Ends: Thin

013 Roller Center: OHP: Plain

C2b: [100 to 170 / 130 / 1 deg]
C2c: [100 to 170 / 140 / 1 deg]
C2b: [100 to 170 / 135 / 1 deg]
C2c: [100 to 170 / 145 / 1 deg]
[100 to 170 / 150/ 1 deg]

014 Roller Ends: OHP: Plain
[100 to 170 / 155/ 1 deg]

016 Roller Ends: OHP: Thick

017 Roller Center: Special 1

018 Roller Ends: Special 1

019 Roller Center: Special 2

020 Roller Ends: Special 2

021 Roller Center: Special 3

022 Roller Ends: Special 3

SM

Service
Tables

015 Roller Center: OHP: Thick
[100 to 170 / 160/ 1 deg]
C2b: [100 to 170 / 140 / 1 deg]
C2c: [100 to 170 / 150 / 1 deg]
C2b: [100 to 170 / 145 / 1 deg]
C2c: [100 to 170 / 155 / 1 deg]
C2b: [100 to 170 / 140 / 1 deg]
C2c: [100 to 170 / 150 / 1 deg]
C2b: [100 to 170 / 145 / 1 deg]
C2c: [100 to 170 / 155 / 1 deg]
C2b: [100 to 170 / 140 / 1 deg]
C2c: [100 to 170 / 150 / 1 deg]
C2b: [100 to 170 / 145 / 1 deg]
C2c: [100 to 170 / 155 / 1 deg]

5-7

D129/D130

Main SP Tables-1

023 Feed Waiting: Plain
024 Feed Waiting: M-Thick
025 Feed Waiting: Thick 1

Turns the feed waiting mode on or off for
each paper type.
[0 to 1 / 0 / 1]
0=Off, 1=On
The paper waits at the registration roller

026 Feed Waiting: Thick 2

until the fusing temperature reaches the
prescribed temperature (adjustable with
SP1105-028 to -37).

027 Feed Waiting: Thin

If you enable this feature, also set SP
1105-38 to a convenient value for the
customer.

028 Feed Wait: Center Minus: Plain
029 Feed Wait: Ends Minus: Plain
030 Feed Wait: Center Minus: M-Thick
031 Feed Wait: Ends Minus: M-Thick
Adjusts the offset value for each re-load
032 Feed Wait: Center Minus: Thick 1

temperature to exit the feed waiting

033 Feed Wait: Ends Minus: Thick 1

mode.
[0 to 60 / 0 / 1 deg]

034 Feed Wait: Center Minus: Thick 2
035 Feed Wait: Ends Minus: Thick 2
036 Feed Wait: Center Minus: Thin
037 Feed Wait: Ends Minus: Thin
Sets the maximum feed waiting time.
[0 to 30 / 0 / 1 sec]
The paper is fed when the time specified
038 Feed Waiting: Maximum Time

with this SP has passed even though the
fusing temperature has not reached the
prescribed temperature.
0: Disabled.

D129/D130

5-8

SM

Main SP Tables-1

1106

Fusing Temperature Display
001 Roller Center

Displays the temperature of the fusing
unit.

002 Roller Ends

[-20 to 250 / 0 / 1 deg]

003 Machine Inside at Power On

Displays the temperature inside the
machine.

004 Machine Inside

[-20 to 250 / 0 / 1 deg]

MotorSpeedAdjust
Adjusts the speeds of each motor. Each step decreases or increases motor
speed in 0.05% increments
Regist: Registration motor, Feed: Feed motor,
1801*

Duplex: Duplex/By-pass motor, Inverter: Duplex inverter motor,
Exit: Paper exit motor, Bridge: Bridge unit drive motor,
OpcMot: Drum motor, TransferMot: Transfer/Development Motor,
FusingMot: Fusing motor,

Service
Tables

DevPuddleMot: Development Paddle motor
001 Regist: 90: Thick 2
002 Regist: 154: Thick 1
[-2 to 2 / 0.4 / 0.05 %]
003 Regist: 180: Plain
004 Regist: 230: Plain
005 Feed: 90: Thick 2
[-2 to 2 / -0.4 / 0.05 %]
006 Feed: 154: Thick 1
007 Feed: 180: Plain
[-2 to 2 / -1 / 0.05 %]
008 Feed: 230: Plain
009 Duplex_CW: 90: Thick 2
[-4 to 4 / 0.4 / 0.1 %]
010 Duplex_CW: 154: Thick 1
011 Duplex_CW: 180: Plain

SM

[-4 to 4 / -2.3 / 0.1 %]

5-9

D129/D130

Main SP Tables-1

012 Duplex_CW: 230: Plain
013 Duplex_CCW: 90: Thick 2
[-4 to 4 / 0.4 / 0.1 %]
014 Duplex_CCW: 154: Thick 1
015 Duplex_CCW: 180: Plain
[-4 to 4 / -0.2 / 0.1 %]
016 Duplex_CCW: 230: Plain
017 Inverter_CW: 90: Thick 2
018 Inverter_CW: 154: Thick 1
019 Inverter_CW: 180: Plain
020 Inverter_CW: 230: Plain
021 Inverter_CCW: 90: Thick 2
022 Inverter_CCW: 154: Thick 1
023 Inverter_CCW: 180: Plain
024 Inverter_CCW: 230: Plain
[-4 to 4 / 0 / 0.1 %]
025 Exit_CW: 90: Thick 2
026 Exit_CW: 154: Thick 1
027 Exit_CW: 180: Plain
028 Exit_CW: 230: Plain
029 Bridge: 90: Thick 2
030 Bridge: 154: Thick 1
031 Bridge: 180: Plain
032 Bridge: 230: Plain
033 OpcMot:90
034 OpcMot:154
[-4 to 4 / 0 / 0.01 %]
035 OpcMot:180
036 OpcMot:230

D129/D130

5-10

SM

Main SP Tables-1

037 TransferMot:90
038 TransferMot:154
039 TransferMot:180
040 TransferMot:230
041 FusingMot:90
042 FusingMot:154
043 FusingMot:180
044 FusingMot:230
045 DevPuddleMot

1902*

[-4 to 4 / 0 / 0.1 %]

Cleaning Web Setting
Web Consumption

[0 to 120 / 0 / 1 %]

001
Displays the consumed amount of the web roll.

002

C2b: [3 to 130 / 8.4 / 0.1 sec]
C2c: [3 to 130 / 6.7 / 0.1 sec]

Service
Tables

Web Motor Interval

Adjusts the interval for web motor rotation.
Web Motor Time

[0.3 to 10 / 4.2 / 0.1 sec]

003
Adjusts the rotation time of the web motor.
C2b: EU [0 to 100 / 90 / 1 %]
Web Near End Setting
004

C2b: ASIA/NA [0 to 100 / 92 / 1 %]
C2c: EU [0 to 100 / 90 / 1 %]
C2c: ASIA/NA [0 to 100 / 92 / 1 %]

Adjusts the threshold for web near end.
Web Motor Interval: Thick 1

[3 to 130 / 11.2 / 0.1 sec]

005
Adjusts the interval for web motor rotation (thick 1).
Web Motor Interval: Thick 2

[3 to 130 / 16.8 / 0.1 sec]

006
Adjusts the interval for web motor rotation (thick 2).
SM

5-11

D129/D130

Main SP Tables-1

Paper Interval Time

[0 to 10 / 5 / 1 sec]

007 Adjusts the threshold for paper feeding. When the time between trailing
edge detection and leading edge detection is within the value of this setting,
the machine determines that the paper is still being fed.
Web Motor Setting: Web End

[0 to 60 / 27 / 1 sec]

008
Adjusts the motor rotation time after the web end.
Web Motor Rotation: Power On

[0 to 10 / 0 / 1 times]

009
Adjusts the number of web motor rotations at the re-load state.
Web Motor Interval: Pre-idle

[0 to 30 / 0 / 1 sec]

010
Adjusts the motor waiting time after the fusing motor idling.
Web Motor Rotation: Pre-idle

[0 to 10 / 0 / 1 times]

011
Adjusts the number of web motor rotations at the fusing idling state.

Tray Lock at Jam

[0 or 1 / 0 / 1 ] 0= OFF, 1= ON

1950*
Not used

D129/D130

5-12

SM

Main SP Tables-2

5.4 MAIN SP TABLES-2
5.4.1 SP2-XXX: DRUM

2005*

Bias Control
Bias Correction 1

[0.1 to 1 / 0.85 / 0.05 step]

001 Adjusts the lower threshold value for the charge roller correction.
When the value of VSDP/VSG is greater than this value, the charge roller
voltage increases by 30 V (e.g., from –500 to –530).
Bias Correction 2

[0.1 to 1 / 0.9 / 0.05 step]

002 Adjusts the upper threshold value for the charge roller correction.
When the value of VSDP/VSG is greater than this value, the charge roller
voltage decreases by 30 V (absolute value).
Bias Adjustment 1

[1000 to 2000 / 1500 / 10 vol]

003
Adjusts the lower limit value for charge roller voltage correction.
[1000 to 2000 / 2000 / 10 vol]

Service
Tables

Bias Adjustment 2
004

Adjusts the upper limit value for charge roller voltage correction.
Bias Adjustment 3

[0 to 100 / 30 / 10 vol]

005
Adjusts the correction voltage adjustment step size.

Erase Margin Adjustment
Adjusts the erase margin by deleting image data at the margins.
2103*

L Size: 297.1 mm or more (length)
M Size: 216.1 to 297 mm (length)
S Size: 216 mm or less (length)
001 Leading Edge
[0 to 9 / 3 / 0.1mm]
002 Trailing Edge
003 Left

SM

[0 to 9 / 2 / 0.1mm]

5-13

D129/D130

Main SP Tables-2

004 Right
005 Duplex Trail.: L Size: Plain

[0 to 4 / 1 / 0.1mm]

006 Duplex Trail.: M Size: Plain

[0 to 4 / 0.8 / 0.1mm]

007 Duplex Trail.: S Size: Plain

[0 to 4 / 0.6 / 0.1mm]

008 Duplex Left: Plain
[0 to 1.5 / 0.3 / 0.1mm]
009 Duplex Right: Plain
010 Duplex Trail.: L Size: Thick

[0 to 4 / 0.8 / 0.1mm]

011 Duplex Trail.: M Size: Thick

[0 to 4 / 0.6 / 0.1mm]

012 Duplex Trail.: S Size: Thick

[0 to 4 / 0.4 / 0.1mm]

013 Duplex Left: Thick
[0 to 1.5 / 0.1 / 0.1mm]
014 Duplex Right: Thick

LD Power Adjustment
2105*

Adjusts the LD power for each mode.
Each LD power setting is decided by the process control.
001 LD1: Copy
[–50 to 79 / -24 (C2b), 5 (C2c) /1 ]
002 LD2: Copy
003 LD1: Printer/Fax
[–50 to 79 / -44 (C2b), -25 (C2c)/1 ]
004 LD2: Printer/Fax

2109

Test Pattern

001 Pattern Selection

D129/D130

[0 to 24 / 0 /1 ]
Test pattern of the GAVD

5-14

SM

Main SP Tables-2

0: None

13: Independent Pattern (4 dot)

1: Vertical Line (1 dot)

14: Trimming Area

2: Vertical Line (2 dot)

15: Hound’s Tooth Check (Vertical)

3: Horizontal Line (1 dot)

16: Hound’s Tooth Check (Horizontal)

4: Horizontal Line (2 dot)

17: Black Band (Horizontal)

5: Grid Vertical Line

18: Black band (Vertical)

6: Grid Horizontal Line

19: Checker Flag Pattern

7: Grid pattern small

20: Grayscale (Vertical Margin)

8: Grid Pattern Large

21: Grayscale (Horizontal Margin)

9: Argyle Pattern Small

22: Two Beam Density Pattern

10: Argyle Pattern Large

23: Full Dot Pattern

11: Independent pattern (1 dot)

24:All white Pattern

12: Independent Pattern (2 dot)

[0 to 15 / 15 /1 ]
002 Density

Set the density of the test pattern which is output in
SP2109-001. This SP is not used for the Grayscale
patterns.

Adjusts the TD sensor reference voltage (Vref). Change this value after
replacing the development unit with another development unit that contains
toner.
[1 to 5 / 4 / 0.01 ]
2220*

1.

Check the value of SP2-220 in both the machine containing the test unit
and the machine that you are going to move it to.

2.

Install the test development unit, and then input the VREF for this unit
into SP2-220.

3.

After the test, put back the old development unit, and change SP2-220
back to the original value.

SM

5-15

D129/D130

Service
Tables

Vref Setting

Main SP Tables-2

Reverse Interval Drum,Transfer

[0 to 2000 / 0 / 1 sheets]

Adjusts the threshold for the reverse rotation of the drum and

2221*

development/transfer motors. This helps the drum and transfer belt cleaning
operations. This reverse rotation will interrupt a multiple printing job.

TD Sensor Initial Setting

Initialization

Performs the TD sensor initial setting and allows the service technician to
enter the lot number of the developer. (The lot number is embossed on the
edge of the developer package.) This SP mode controls the voltage applied
2801

to the TD sensor to make the TD sensor output about 3.0 V. Press
"Execute" to start. After finishing this, the TD sensor output voltage is
displayed.
Use this mode only after installing the machine, changing the TD sensor, or
adding new developer.

Toner Overflow Sensor

[0 = OFF, 1= ON]

2960*
Selects whether or not the toner overflow sensor is activated.

Grayscale Limit (SSP)
Controls the halftone density level to prevent deterioration of the OPC. The

2972*

halftone density is detected by the ID sensor, and the machine adjusts the
intensity of the LD beam according to the upper/lower limit setting.
Upper Limit

[0 to 100 / 58 (C2b), 63 (C2c)/ 1vol ]

Defines the upper limit for grayscale.
001 A larger value allows a wider range of halftones at the pale end of the scale.
If the image contains pale areas with fuzzy borders surrounded by dark
areas, reduce this value to make the borders clearer.
Lower Limit

[0 to 100 / 52 (C2b), 57 (C2c) / 1vol ]

002 Defines the lower limit for grayscale.
A smaller value allows a wider range of halftones at the dark end of the
scale.
D129/D130

5-16

SM

Main SP Tables-2

Grayscale Cycle (SSP)
2973*

[0 to 1000 / 100 / 10 sheets ]

Set s the halftone operation interval in order to prevent deterioration of the
OPC. If the number of copies exceeds this setting, at the end of the job, or if
the door is opened and closed, charge correction is executed.

2974*

Image Density
Adjustment Mode

[1 to 5 / 3 / 1 ]

001 Adjusts image density. Changing this setting adjusts development bias and
ID sensor output voltage that in turn raises or lowers image density.

Charge Counter

[0 to 1000000 / 0 / 1 sheets ]

Set the number of pages to print after toner and carrier initialization before
the charge input is increased to compensate for deterioration over time in
2980*

the polarity of the carrier.
The strength in the polarity of the carrier in the toner will eventually
increase after a specified number of copies can compensate for this effect.

SM

5-17

D129/D130

Service
Tables

decrease and cause lower charge output. Setting the charge output to

Main SP Tables-3

5.5 MAIN SP TABLES-3
5.5.1 SP3-XXX: PROCESS

3001

P Sensor Setting
Current

[0 to 43 / 13 / 0.1 mA ]

001* Allows you to reset the PWM of the ID sensor LED to avoid a service call
error after clearing NVRAM or replacing the NVRAM.
The PWM data is stored by executing SP-3001-2.
Initialization

-

Performs the ID sensor initial setting. ID sensor output for the bare drum
002 (VSG) is adjusted automatically to 4.0 ±0.2 V.
Press "Execute" to start. Perform this setting after replacing or cleaning the
ID sensor, replacing the drum, or clearing NVRAM.

3045*

Toner End Setting DFU
001 ON/OFF

3902*

[0 to 1 / 0 / 1] 0=Off, 1=On

New PCU Detection (Not used)

ON/OFF Setting

[0 to 1 / 0 / 1]
0: On, 1: Off

001
Turns on or off the new unit detection for the transfer belt unit and fusing
unit.

D129/D130

5-18

SM

Main SP Tables-4

5.6 MAIN SP TABLES-4
5.6.1 SP4-XXX: SCANNER

Sub Scan Mag. Adjustment
4008*

Adjusts the magnification of the sub scan direction during scanning.
Changing this value changes the scanner motor speed.
[–1 to 1 / 0 / 0.1% ]

L-Edge Regist Adjustment
4010*

Adjusts the leading edge registration for scanning.
[–2 to 2 / 0 / 0.1 mm ]
As you enter a negative value, the image moves toward the leading edge.

Scanner Erase Margin: Scale
Adjusts scanning margins for the leading and trailing edges (sub scan) and
Service
Tables

right and left edge (main scan).
4012*


Do not adjust unless the customer desires a scanner margin
greater than the printer margin.



These settings are adjusted to erase shadows caused by the gap
between the original and the scale of the scanner unit.

SM

001 Book: Leading Edge

[0 to 3 / 1 / 0.1 mm]

002 Book: Trailing Edge

[0 to 3 / 0 / 0.1 mm]

003 Book: Left

[0 to 3 / 1 / 0.1 mm]

004 Book: Right

[0 to 3 / 0 / 0.1 mm]

005 ADF: Leading Edge

[0 to 3 / 0 / 0.1 mm]

007 ADF: Right

[0 to 3 / 0 / 0.1 mm]

008 ADF: Left

[0 to 3 / 0 / 0.1 mm]

5-19

D129/D130

Main SP Tables-4

Scanner Free Run
4013
Performs a scanner free run with the exposure lamp on or off.
001 Lamp: OFF

[0 to 1 / 0 / 1]

002 Lamp: ON

0=Off, 1=On

4014

Scan
001 HP Detection Enable

Scanner free run with HP sensor check.

002 HP Detection Disable

Scanner free run without HP sensor check.

Dust Check
This function checks the narrow scanning glass of the ADF for dust that can

4020*

cause black lines in copies. If dust is detected a system banner message is
displayed, but processing does not stop.
Dust Detect: On/Off
Issues a warning if there is dust on the narrow scanning glass of the ADF
when the original size is detected before a job starts. This function can
detect dust on the white plate above the scanning glass, as well as dust on
the glass. Sensitivity of the level of detection is adjusted with SP4020-2.
001 [0 to 1 / 1 / 1]
0: Off. No dust warning.
1: On. Dust warning. This warning does not stop the job.


Before switching this setting on, clean the ADF scanning glass and
the white plate above the scanning glass.

002 Dust Detect: Lvl

D129/D130

5-20

SM

Main SP Tables-4

Adjusts the sensitivity for dust detection on the ADF scanning glass. This SP
is available only after SP4020-1 is switched on.
[0 to 8 / 4 / 1]
If you see black streaks in copies when no warning has been issued, raise
the setting to increase the level of sensitivity. If warnings are issued when
you see not black streaks in copies, lower the setting.


Dust that triggers a warning could move be removed from the glass
by the originals in the feed path. If the dust is removed by passing
originals, this is not detected and the warning remains on.

Dust Reject: Lvl
003 Selects the level of the sub scan line correction when using the ARDF.
[0 to 4 / 0 / 1]
0: OFF, 1: Weakest, 2: Weak, 3: Strong, 4: Strongest

APS Operation Check
Displays a code that represents the original size detected by the original
sensors. (

"Input Check Table" in "Main SP Tables-9")
Service
Tables

4301

APS Min. Size
Determines whether an original of non-standard size is detected as A5/HLT
size by the APS sensor.
4303

0: No original
1: A5 - lengthwise (SEF)
2: A5 - Sideways (LEF)
If "0" is selected, "Cannot detect original size" will be displayed.

SM

5-21

D129/D130

Main SP Tables-4

8K/16K Detection
[0 to 3 / 0 / 1 step]
0: Normal Detection ( the machine detects A4/LT size as A4 or LT,
4305

depending on the paper size setting)
1: A4-sideways LT-Lengthwise
2: LT-sideways A4-Lenghtwise
3: 8K 16K

4308*

Scan Size Detection
Detection ON/OFF
Selects whether the machine detects the original size.
001 [0 to 1 / 1 / 1 step]
0: OFF
1: ON

4309*

Scan Size Detect: Setting
Original Density Thresh
001 Adjust the density for the scan size detection.
[0 to 255 / 18 / 1 step]
Detection Time
002 Adjust the detection time for scan size detection.
[20 to 100 / 60 / 20 msec]
Lamp ON: Delay Time
003 Adjust the timing when to lamp on for the scan size detection.
[0 to 200 / 40 / 20 msec]
LED PWM Duty
004 Adjust the light value for the scan size detection.
[0 to 100 / 60 / 1 %]

D129/D130

5-22

SM

Main SP Tables-4

Scan Size Detect Value

[0 to 255 / 0 / 1 digit]

4310
Displays the scanned data for the original width detection.
001 S1: R
002 S1: G
003 S1: B
004 S2: R
005 S2: G
006 S2: B
007 S3: R
008 S3: G
009 S3: B

Each detection point (S1, S2, S3) in SP4310 is as follows.
Service
Tables



SM

5-23

D129/D130

Main SP Tables-4

IPU Test Pattern
Selects the IPU test Pattern.
[0 to 28 / 0 / 1]
0: Scanned image

15: Gray pattern (1)

1: Gradation main scan A

16: Gray pattern (2)

2: Gradation main scan B

17: Gray pattern (3)

3: Gradation main scan C

18: Shading pattern

4: Gradation main scan D

19: Thin line pattern

5: Gradation sub scan (1)

20: Scanned + Grid pattern

Test

6: Grid pattern (1)

21: Scanned + Gray scale

Pattern

7: Slant grid pattern

22: Scanned + Color patch

8: Gradation K

23: Scanned + Slant Grid C

9: Gray patch 16

24: Scanned + Slant Grid D

10: Gray patch 16 (1)

25: Gray Scale 18 text

11: Gray patch 16 (2)

26: Gray Scale 18 photo

12: Gray patch 64

27: Gray Scale 256 text

13: Grid pattern (2)

28: Gray Scale 256 photo

4417

14: Color patch K

4429*

Select Copy Data Security
001 Copying
002 Scanning
003 Fax Operation

D129/D130

Adjusts the density of the embedded message
with the copy data security unit.
[0 to 3 / 3 / 1 ]
3: Darkest density

5-24

SM

Main SP Tables-4

4450

Scan Image Path Selection
Black Subtraction ON/OFF

[0 to 1 / 1 / 1] 0=OFF, 1=ON

001
Uses or does not use the black reduction image path.
SH ON/OFF

[0 to 1 / 0 / 1] 0=OFF, 1=ON

002
Uses or does not use the shading image path.

Printer Vector Correction
4540*

This SP corrects the printer coverage of 12 hues (RY, YR, YG, etc. x 4

001-004

RY Phase: Option/R/G/B

005-008

YR Phase: Option/R/G/B

009-012

YG Phase: Option/R/G/B

013-016

GY Phase: Option/R/G/B

017-020

GC Phase: Option/R/G/B

021-024

CG Phase: Option/R/G/B

Specifies the printer vector correction value.

025-028

CB Phase: Option/R/G/B

[0 to 255 / 0 / 1 ]

029-032

BC Phase: Option/R/G/B

033-036

BM Phase: Option/R/G/B

037-040

MB Phase: Option/R/G/B

041-044

MR Phase: Option/R/G/B

045-048

RM Phase: Option/R/G/B

SM

5-25

D129/D130

Service
Tables

Colors [R, G, B, Option]) for a total of 48 parameters.

Main SP Tables-4

4600

SBU Version
001 SBU ID

Displays the ID of the SBU.

002 GASBU-N ID

Displays the ID of the GASBU.

003 VSP5100 ID

Displays the ID of the VSP5100.

4602

Scanner Memory Access

001 Scanner Memory Access

4603

Enables the read and write check for the
SBU registers.

AGC Execution
001 HP Detection Enable

Executes the AGC with the scanner detection.

002 HP Detection Disable

Executes the AGC with the scanner detection.

4609*

Gray Balance Set: R
Book Scan

[-384 to 255 / -46 / 1 digit]

001
Displays the scanning level value (adjustment) for the red signal in Book Scan.
DF Scan

[-384 to 255 / -46 / 1 digit]

002
Displays the scanning level value (adjustment) for the red signal in DF Scan.

4610*

Gray Balance Set: G
Book Scan

[-384 to 255 / -20 / 1 digit]

001 Displays the scanning level value (adjustment) for the green signal in Book
Scan.
DF Scan

[-384 to 255 / -20 / 1 digit]

002 Displays the scanning level value (adjustment) for the green signal in DF
Scan.

D129/D130

5-26

SM

Main SP Tables-4

4611*

Gray Balance Set: B
Book Scan

[-384 to 255 / -28 / 1 digit]

001 Displays the scanning level value (adjustment) for the blue signal in Book
Scan.
DF Scan

[-384 to 255 / -28 / 1 digit]

002
Displays the scanning level value (adjustment) for the blue signal in DF Scan.

4623 Black Level Adj. Display
Latest: RE Color

[0 to 16383 / 0 / 1 digit]

001 Displays the black offset value (rough adjustment) for the even red signal in the
SBU (color printing speed).
Latest: RO Color

[0 to 16383 / 0 / 1 digit]

002 Displays the black offset value (rough adjustment) for the odd red signal in the



4624

Service
Tables

SBU (color printing speed).

RE: Red Even signal, RO: Red Odd signal

Black Level Adj. Display
Latest: GE Color

001 [0 to 16383 / 0 / 1 digit]
Displays the black offset value (rough adjustment) for the even green signal in
the SBU (color printing speed).
Latest: GO Color
002 [0 to 16383 / 0 / 1 digit]
Displays the black offset value (rough adjustment) for the odd green signal in the
SBU (color printing speed).



SM

GE: Green Even signal, GO: Green Odd signal

5-27

D129/D130

Main SP Tables-4

4625

Black Level Adj. Display
Latest: BE Color

001 [0 to 16383 / 0 / 1 digit]
Displays the black offset value (rough adjustment) for the even blue signal in the
SBU (color printing speed).
Latest: BO Color
002 [0 to 16383 / 0 / 1 digit]
Displays the black offset value (rough adjustment) for the odd blue signal in the
SBU (color printing speed).



BE: Blue Even signal, BO: Blue Odd signal

Analog Gain Adjust
4628

Displays the gain value of the amplifiers on the controller for Red.
Only for the color scanner
001 Latest: R Color

[0 to 7 / 0 / 1 digit]

Analog Gain Adjust
4629

Displays the gain value of the amplifiers on the controller for Green.
SP4629-003 and -004 are used only for the color scanner model.
001 Latest: G Color

[0 to 7 / 0 / 1 digit]

Analog Gain Adjust
4630
Displays the gain value of the amplifiers on the controller for Blue.
001 Latest: B Color

D129/D130

[0 to 7 / 0 / 1 digit]

5-28

SM

Main SP Tables-4

Digital Gain Adjust
4631
Displays the gain value of the amplifiers on the controller for RE or RO.
001 Latest: RE Color

[0 to 1023 / 0 / 1 digit]

002 Latest RO Color

[0 to 1023 / 0 / 1 digit]

Digital Gain Adjust
4632
Displays the gain value of the amplifiers on the controller for GE or GO.
001 Latest: GE Color

[0 to 1023 / 0 / 1 digit]

002 Latest: GO Color

[0 to 1023 / 0 / 1 digit]

Digital Gain Adjust
4633

001 Latest: BE Color

[0 to 1023 / 0 / 1 digit]

002 Latest: BO Color

[0 to 1023 / 0 / 1 digit]

Service
Tables

Displays the gain value of the amplifiers on the controller for BE or BO.

Scan Adjust Error
4645
Displays the error value of the white level or black level adjustment.
001 White level

[0 to 65535 / 0 / 1 digit]

002 Black level

[0 to 65535 / 0 / 1 digit]

Scanner Hard Error
Displays the result of the SBU connection check.
4647

[0 to 35535 / 0 / 1 ]
Power-ON

0: OK, 1: SBU connection check failure
If the SBU connection check fails, SC144-001, -002 or
-003 occurs.

SM

5-29

D129/D130

Main SP Tables-4

4654* Black Level Adj. Display
Latest Correct Value: RE Color
001 [0 to 16383 / 0 / 1 digit ]
Displays the previous black offset value (rough adjustment) for the even red
signal in the SBU (color printing speed).
Last Correct Value: RO Color
002 [0 to 16383 / 0 / 1 digit ]
Displays the previous black offset value (rough adjustment) for the odd red
signal in the SBU (color printing speed).



RE: Red Even signal, RO: Red Odd signal

4655*

Black Level Adj. Display
Last Correct Value: GE Color

001 [0 to 16383 / 0 / 1 digit ]
Displays the previous black offset value (rough adjustment) for the even green
signal in the SBU (color printing speed).
Last Correct Value: GO Color
002 [0 to 16383 / 0 / 1 digit ]
Displays the previous black offset value (rough adjustment) for the even green
signal in the SBU (color printing speed).



GE: Green Even signal, GO: Green Odd signal

4656*

Black Level Adj. Display
Last Correct Value: BE Color

001 [0 to 16383 / 0 / 1 digit ]
Displays the previous black offset value (rough adjustment) for the even blue
signal in the SBU (color printing speed).

D129/D130

5-30

SM

Main SP Tables-4

Last Correct Value: BO Color
002 [0 to 16383 / 0 / 1 digit ]
Displays the previous black offset value (rough adjustment) for the odd blue
signal in the SBU (color printing speed).



BE: Blue Even signal, BO: Blue Odd signal

Analog Gain Adjust
4658*
Displays the previous gain value of the amplifiers on the controller for Red.
001 Last Correct Value: R Color

[0 to 7 / 0 / 1 digit ]

Analog Gain Adjust
4659*

Displays the previous gain value of the amplifiers on the controller for Green.
SP4659-003 and -004 are used only for the color scanner model.
[0 to 7 / 0 / 1 digit ]
Service
Tables

001 Last Correct Value: G Color

Analog Gain Adjust
4660*
Displays the previous gain value of the amplifiers on the controller for Blue.
001 Last Correct Value: B Color

4661*

[0 to 7 / 0 / 1 digit ]

Digital Gain Adjust
Last Correct Value: RE Color

001 [0 to 1023 / 0 / 1 digit ]
Displays the previous 2nd black offset value (rough adjustment) for the even
red signal in the SBU (color printing speed).
Last Correct Value: RO Color
002 [0 to 1023 / 0 / 1 digit ]
Displays the previous 2nd black offset value (rough adjustment) for the odd
red signal in the SBU (color printing speed).
SM

5-31

D129/D130

Main SP Tables-4



RE: Red Even signal, RO: Red Odd signal

4662*

Digital Gain Adjust
Last Correct Value: GE Color

001 [0 to 1023 / 0 / 1 digit ]
Displays the previous 2nd black offset value (rough adjustment) for the even
green signal in the SBU (color printing speed).
Last Correct Value: GO Color
002 [0 to 1023 / 0 / 1 digit ]
Displays the previous 2nd black offset value (rough adjustment) for the odd
green signal in the SBU (color printing speed).



GE: Green Even signal, GO: Green Odd signal

4663*

Digital Gain Adjust
Last Correct Value: BE Color

001 [0 to 1023 / 0 / 1 digit ]
Displays the previous 2nd black offset value (rough adjustment) for the even
blue signal in the SBU (color printing speed).
Last Correct Value: BO Color
002 [0 to 1023 / 0 / 1 digit ]
Displays the previous 2nd black offset value (rough adjustment) for the odd
blue signal in the SBU (color printing speed).



BE: Blue Even signal, BO: Blue Odd signal

D129/D130

5-32

SM

Main SP Tables-4

4673

Black Level Adj. Display
Factory Setting: RE Color
001 [0 to 16383 / 0 / 1 digit ]
Displays the factory setting value of the 2nd black offset level rough
adjustment for the even red signal in the SBU (color printing speed).
Factory Setting: RO Color
002 [0 to 16383 / 0 / 1 digit ]
Displays the factory setting values of the 2nd black offset level rough
adjustment for the odd red signal in the SBU (color printing speed).



4674

RE: Red Even signal, RO: Red Odd signal

Black Level Adj. Display
Factory Setting: GE Color

Service
Tables

001 [0 to 16383 / 0 / 1 digit ]
Displays the factory setting value of the 2nd black offset level rough
adjustment for the even green signal in the SBU (color printing speed).
Factory Setting: GO Color
002 [0 to 16383 / 0 / 1 digit ]
Displays the factory setting values of the 2nd black offset level rough
adjustment for the odd green signal in the SBU (color printing speed).



SM

GE: Green Even signal, GO: Green Odd signal

5-33

D129/D130

Main SP Tables-4

4675

Black Level Adj. Display
Factory Setting: BE Color
001 [0 to 16383 / 0 / 1 digit ]
Displays the factory setting value of the 2nd black offset level rough
adjustment for the even blue signal in the SBU (color printing speed).
Factory Setting: BO Color
002 [0 to 16383 / 0 / 1 digit ]
Displays the factory setting values of the 2nd black offset level rough
adjustment for the odd blue signal in the SBU (color printing speed).



BE: Blue Even signal, BO: Blue Odd signal

Analog Gain Adjust
4677

Displays the factory setting values of the gain adjustment for Red.
SP4677-003 and -004 are used only for the color scanner model.
001 Factory Setting: R

[ 0 to 7 / 0 / 1 digit]

Analog Gain Adjust
4678

Displays the factory setting values of the gain adjustment for Green.
SP4678-003 and -004 are used only for the color scanner model.
001 Factory Setting: G

[ 0 to 7 / 0 / 1 digit]

Analog Gain Adjust
4679
Displays the factory setting values of the gain adjustment for Blue.
001 Factory Setting: B

D129/D130

[ 0 to 7 / 0 / 1 digit]

5-34

SM

Main SP Tables-4

4680*

Digital Gain Adjust
Factory Setting: RE Color

001 [0 to 1023 / 0 / 1 digit ]
Displays the gain value of the amplifiers on the controller for Red.
Factory Setting: RO Color
002 [0 to 1023 / 0 / 1 digit ]
Displays the gain value of the amplifiers on the controller for odd Red.

4681*

Digital Gain Adjust
Factory Setting: GE Color

001 [0 to 1023 / 0 / 1 digit ]
Displays the gain value of the amplifiers on the controller for Green.
Factory Setting: GO Color
002 [0 to 1023 / 0 / 1 digit ]
Service
Tables

Displays the gain value of the amplifiers on the controller for odd Green.

4682*

Digital Gain Adjust
Factory Setting: BE Color

001 [0 to 1023 / 0 / 1 digit ]
Displays the gain value of the amplifiers on the controller for Blue.
Factory Setting: BO Color
002
Displays the gain value of the amplifiers on the controller for odd Blue.

SM

5-35

D129/D130

Main SP Tables-4

Scan Image Density Adjustment
Adjusts the white shading parameter when scanning an image with the ARDF.
4688*

Adjusts the density level if the ID of outputs made in the DF and Platen mode
is different.
[80 to 120 / 98 / 1 % ]

White Level Peak Read
4690
Displays the peak level of the white level scanning.
001 RE
[0 to 1023 / 0 / 1 digit ]
002 RO

White Level Peak Read
4691
Displays the peak level of the white level scanning.
001 GE
[0 to 1023 / 0 / 1 digit ]
002 GO

White Level Peak Read
4692
Displays the peak level of the white level scanning.
001 BE
[0 to 1023 / 0 / 1 digit ]
002 BO

Black Level Peak Read
4693
Displays the peak level of the black level scanning.
001 RE
[0 to 1023 / 0 / 1 digit ]
002 RO

D129/D130

5-36

SM

Main SP Tables-4

Black Level Peak Read
4694
Display the peak level of the black level scanning.
001 GE
[0 to 1023 / 0 / 1 digit ]
002 GO

Black Level Peak Read
4695
Display the peak level of the black level scanning.
001 BE
[0 to 1023 / 0 / 1 digit ]
002 BO

4802

DF Shading FreeRun
001 Lamp OFF

[0 to 1 / 0 / 1 ]
Executes the scanner free run of the shading
movement with exposure lamp on or off.

002 Lamp ON

Press "OFF" to stop this free run. Otherwise, the free
Service
Tables

run continues.

Moves the exposure lamp a short distance
4804

Home Position

and immediately returns it to its home
position.
Touch [Execute] > "Completed" > [Exit]

Carriage Save
Moves the exposure lamp a short distance away from the home position and
stops.
Touch [Execute] > "Completed" > [Exit]
4806

Do SP4804 to return the exposure lamp to its home position.


This SP is done before shipping the machine to another location.



Cycling the machine power off/on also returns the exposure lamp to
its home position.

SM

5-37

D129/D130

Main SP Tables-4

SBU Test Pattern Change
[0 to 255 / 0 / 1 /step]
1: Grid pattern

4807

2: Gradation main scan
3: Gradation sub scan
4 to 250: Default (Scanning Image)

4808

Factory Setting Input
002* Execution Flag

Man Gamma Adj (DFU)
Adjusts the offset data of the printer gamma for black in Photo mode or
4918

Letter mode.
Touch [Change] to open the printer gamma screen.
Enter the manual gamma adjustment screen.

4954

Read/Restore Std
Read New Chart
001
Execute the scanning of the A4 chart.
Recall Prev Chart
002
Clear the data of the scanned A4 chart.
Read Std Chart
003
Execute the scanning of the A4 standard chart.
Set Std Chart
004
Overwrite the standard data.
Read/Restore Std

[0 to 255 / 0 / 1]

005* Adjusts chromaticity rank. When replacing the scanner lamp, select a
number according to the barcode on the new scanner lamp.

D129/D130

5-38

SM

Main SP Tables-4

4991

IPU Image Pass Selection DFU
RGB Frame Memory
Selects the image path. Enter the number to be selected using the 10-key
pad.
[0 to 11 / 2/ 1]
0

Scanner input RGB images

1

Scanner I/F RGB images

2

RGB images done by Shading correction (Shading ON, Black offset
ON)

3

Shading data

4

Inner pattern data: Gray scale

5

RGB images done by Line skipping correction

6

RGB images done by Digital AE

7

RGB images done by Vertical line correction

8

RGB image done by Scanner gamma correction

9

RGB image done by Filtering correction

10

RGB images done by Full color ADS

11

RGB image done by Color correction

SM

5-39

Service
Tables

001

D129/D130

Main SP Tables-4

4993*

High Light Correction
Selects the Highlight correction level.
001 Sensitivity Selection

[0 to 9 / 4 / 1 /step]
0: weakest sensitivity
9: strongest sensitivity
Selects the Highlight correction level.

002 Range Selection

[0 to 9 / 4 / 1 /step]
0: weakest skew correction,
9: strongest skew correction

4994*

Text/Photo Detect Level Adj.
High Compression PDF
Selects the definition level between Text and Photo for high compression
PDF.
001 [0 to 2 / 1 / 1 ]
0: Text priority
1: Normal
2: Photo priority

D129/D130

5-40

SM

Main SP Tables-5

5.7 MAIN SP TABLES-5
5.7.1 SP5-XXX: MODE

mm/inch Display Selection

0: Europe/Asia (mm)
1: North America (inch)

5024*
Selects the unit of measurement.
After selection, turn the main power switch off and on.

5047*

Paper Display
Turns on or off the printed paper display on the LCD.
[0 to 1 / 0 / 1]
0: Not displayed, 1: Displayed

Display IP Address
5055*

Display or does not display the IP address on the LCD.
Service
Tables

[0 to 1 / 0 / 1]
0: OFF, 1: ON

5056*

Coverage Counter Display
Display or does not display the coverage counter on the LCD.
[0 to 1 / 0 / 1]
0: Not displayed, 1: Displayed

5061*

Toner Remaining Icon Display Change
Display or does not display the remaining toner display icon on the LCD.
[0 to 1 / 0 / 1 ]
0: Not display, 1: Display

SM

5-41

D129/D130

Main SP Tables-5

5071

Set Bypass Paper Size Display
Turn on or off the paper size confirmation pop-up on the LED. This pop-up
prevents mismatching between a paper size selected by the operation
001 panel and an actual paper size on the by-pass tray.
[0 or 1 / 0 / -]
0: Off, 1: On

5104*

A3/DLT Double Count (SSP)
Specifies whether the counter is doubled for A3/DLT. "Yes" counts except
from the bypass tray. When "Yes" is selected, A3 and DLT paper are
counted twice, that is A4 x2 and LT x2 respectively.

5113*

Optional Counter Type
Default Optional Counter Type
Selects the type of counter:
0: None
1: Key Card (RK3, 4) Japan only
001 2: Key Card Down
3: Pre-paid Card
4: Coin Rack
5: MF Key Card
11: Exp. Key Card (Add)
12: Exp. Key Card (Deduct)
External Optional Counter Type
Enables the SDK application. This lets you select a number for the external
device for user access control.
Note: "SDK" refers to software on an SD card.
002 [0 to 3 / 0 / 1]
0: None
1: Expansion Device 1
2: Expansion Device 2
3: Expansion Device 3

D129/D130

5-42

SM

Main SP Tables-5

5114*

Optional Counter I/F
MF Key Card Extension
001 Use this SP and change the setting to "1" only when the "5" (MF Key Card)
is selected with SP5113-001.
[0: Not installed/ 1: Installed (scanning accounting)]

Disable Copying
Temporarily denies access to the machine. Japan Only
5118*

[0 to 1 / 0 / 1]
0: Release for normal operation [Default]
1: Prohibit access to machine

Mode Clear Opt. Counter Removal
Selects if mode clear is done for an optional counter when an optional
5120*

counter is removed.
0: Yes. (Always mode clear)
1: StandBy. (Mode clear before/after a job)
Service
Tables

2: No. (No mode clear)

Counter Up Timing
Determines whether the optional key counter counts up at paper feed-in or
5121*

at paper exit.
[0 to 1 / 0 / 1 ]
0: Feed, 1: Exit

F Size Original Setting
Selects F size original setting.
5126*

[0 to 2 / 0 / 1 step]
0: 8 1/2 x 13 (Foolscap)
1: 8 1/4 x 13 (Folio)
2: 8 x 13 (F)

SM

5-43

D129/D130

Main SP Tables-5

APS Mode
5127*

Selects whether the APS function is enabled or disabled with the contact of
a pre-paid card or coin lock.
0: Disable (APS active) [Default], 1: Enable (APS not active)

Paper Size Type Selection
Selects the paper size (type) for both originals and copy paper.
5131*

[0 to 2 / - / 1 step]
0: Japan, 1: North America, 2: Europe
After changing the setting, turn the copier off and on. If the paper size of the
archive files stored on the HDD is different, abnormal copies could result.

Bypass Length Setting
Sets up the by-pass tray for long paper.
5150

[0 to 1 / 0 / 1]
0: Off [Default]
1: On. Sets the tray for feeding paper up to 600 mm long.
With this SP selected on, paper jams are not detected in the paper path.

App. Switch Method
Determines whether the application screen is switched with a hardware
5162*

switch or software switch.
0: Soft Key Set
1: Hard Key Set

Fax Printing Mode at Optional Counter Off
Enables or disables the automatic print out without an accounting device.
5167*

This SP is used when the receiving fax is accounted for by an external
accounting device.
0: Automatic printing
1: No automatic printing

D129/D130

5-44

SM

Main SP Tables-5

CE Login
If you will change the printer bit switches, you must 'log in' to service mode
5169*

with this SP before you go into the printer SP mode.
[0 to 1 / 0 / 1]
0: Off. Printer bit switches cannot be adjusted.
1: On. Printer bit switches can be adjusted.

Paper Size Setting
5181*

SM

001 Tray 1: 1

0: A4 LEF, 1: LT LEF

002 Tray 1: 2

0: A3, 1: DLT

003 Tray 1: 3

0: B4, 1: LG

004 Tray 1: 4

0: B5 LEF, 1: Exe LEF

005 Tray 2: 1

0: A4 LEF, 1: LT LEF

006 Tray 2: 2

0: A3, 1: DLT

007 Tray 2: 3

0: B4, 1: LG

008 Tray 2: 4

0: B5 LEF, 1: Exe LEF

009 Tray 3: 1 (Tandem)

0: A4 LEF, 1: LT LEF

010 Tray 3: 2

0: A3, 1: DLT

011 Tray 3: 3

0: B4, 1: LG

012 Tray 3: 4

0: B5 LEF, 1: Exe LEF

013 Tray 4: 1

0: A4 LEF, 1: LT LEF

014 Tray 4: 2

0: A3, 1: DLT

015 Tray 4: 3

0: B4, 1: LG

016 Tray 4: 4

0: B5 LEF, 1: Exe LEF

017 LCT

[0 to 2 / - / 1 ] 0: A4 LEF, 1: LT LEF, 2: B5 LEF

5-45

Service
Tables

Adjusts the paper size for each tray. [0 to 1 / - / 1]

D129/D130

Main SP Tables-5

RK4: Setting (Japan only)
Enable or distance the prevention for RK4 (Accounting device)
5186

Disconnection. If the RK4 is disconnected for 10 seconds when this SP is
set to "1 (Enable)", the machine automatically jams a sheet of paper and
stops.
[0 to 1 / 0 / 1]

Copy Nv Version
5188*
Displays the NV version on the controller.

External Controller Info. Settings
5193
DFU

Limitless SW
5195*
DFU

Paper Exit After Staple End
This SP determines whether a machine can continue to output paper if
5199

staple supply runs cannot continue to operate.
[0 to 1 / 0 / 1]
0: OFF. Paper cannot exit if no staples are available.
1: ON. Paper can exit with no staples.

D129/D130

5-46

SM

Main SP Tables-5

5212*

Page Numbering
Horizontally positions the page numbers
003

Duplex Printout Left/Right

printed on both sides during duplexing.

Position

[–10 to 10/ 0 / 1 mm]
0 is center, minus is left, + is right.
Vertically positions the page numbers printed

004

Duplex Printout High/Low

on both sides during duplexing.

Position

[–10 to 10/ 0 / 1 mm]
0 is center, minus is down, + is up.

5302*

Set Time
Time Difference
Sets the time clock for the local time. This setting is done at the factory
before delivery. The setting is GMT expressed in minutes.
[–1440 to 1440 / - / 1 min.]

Service
Tables

Japan: +540 (Tokyo)
002 NA: -300 (NY)
EU: +60 (Paris)
CH: +480 (Peking)
TW: +480 (Taipei)
AS: +480 (Hong Kong)
KO: +540 (Korea)

SM

5-47

D129/D130

Main SP Tables-5

5307

Summer Time
[0 to 1 / 1 (NA/EU), 0 (ASIA) / 1 /step]
Setting

0: Disabled
1: Enabled

001

Enables or disables the summer time mode.


Make sure that both SP5-307-3 and -4 are correctly set. Otherwise,
this SP is not activated even if this SP is set to "1".

Rule Set (Start)
Specifies the start setting for the summer time mode.
There are 8 digits in this SP. For months 1 to 9, the "0" cannot be input in the
first digit, so the eight-digit setting for -2 or -3 becomes a seven-digit setting.
1st and 2nd digits: The month. [1 to 12]
3rd digit: The week of the month. [1 to 5]
003

4th digit: The day of the week. [0 to 6 = Sunday to Saturday]
5th and 6th digits: The hour. [00 to 23]
7th digit: The length of the advanced time. [0 to 9 / 1 hour

/step]

8th digit: The length of the advanced time. [0 to 5 / 10 minutes /step]
For example: 3500010
The timer is advanced by 1 hour at am 0:00 on the 5th Sunday in March.
The digits are counted from the left.
Make sure that SP5-307-1 is set to "1".
Rule Set (End)
Specifies the end setting for the summer time mode.
There are 8 digits in this SP.
1st and 2nd digits: The month. [1 to 12]
004

3rd digit: The week of the month. [0 to 5]
4th digit: The day of the week. [0 to 7 = Sunday to Saturday]
5th and 6th digits: The hour. [00 to 23]
The 7th and 8 digits must be set to "00".
The digits are counted from the left.
Make sure that SP5-307-1 is set to "1".

D129/D130

5-48

SM

Main SP Tables-5

User Code Count Clear
5404

Clears the counts of the user codes assigned by the key operator to restrict
the use of the machine. Press [Execute] to clear.

5413

Lockout Setting
Lockout On/Off

[0 to 1 / 0 / 1] 0: OFF, 1:ON

001
Turns on or off the account lock for the local address book account.
Lockout Threshold

[1 to 10 / 5 / 1]

002
Sets the maximum trial times for accessing the address book account.
[0 to 1 / 0 / 1]
0: OFF (Lockout is not cancelled.)
Cancellation On/Off
003

1: ON (Lockout is cancelled if a user ID and
password are correctly entered after the lockout
function has been executed and a specific time has
passed.)

Cancellation Time

[1 to 9999 / 60 / 1 min]

004 Sets the interval of the retry for accessing the local address book account
after the lockout function has been executed.
This setting is enabled only if SP5413-3 is set to "1" (ON).

SM

5-49

D129/D130

Service
Tables

Turns on or off the cancellation function of the account lockout.

Main SP Tables-5

5414

Access Mitigation
Mitigation ON / OFF
Permits or does not permit consecutive access to the machine with the
001 same ID and password.
[0 to 1 / 0 / 1]
0: OFF (Permitted)
1: ON (Not permitted)
Mitigation Time
002 Sets the prohibiting time for consecutive access to the machine with the
same ID and password.
[0 to 60 / 15 / 1 min]

5415*

Password Attack
Permissible Number

[0 to 100 / 30 / 1 times]

001 Sets the threshold number of attempts to attack the system with random
passwords to gain illegal access to the system.
Detect Time

[0 to 10 / 5 / 1 sec]

002
Sets a detection time to count a password attack.

5416*

Access Information
Access User Max Num

[50 to 200 / 200 / 1 ]

001 Sets the number of users for the access exclusion and password attack
detection function.
Access Password Num

[50 to 200 / 200 / 1 ]

002 Sets the number of passwords for the access exclusion and password
attack detection function.
Monitor interval

[1 to 10 / 3 / 1 sec]

003
Sets the interval of watching out for user information and passwords.

D129/D130

5-50

SM

Main SP Tables-5

5417

Access Attack
Access Permissible number

[0 to 500 / 100 / 1]

001
Sets a limit on access attempts to prevent password cracking.
Access Detect Time

[10 to 30 / 10 / 1 sec]

002
Sets a detection time to count password cracking.
Productivity Fall Weight

[0 to 9 / 3 / 1 sec]

003 Sets the wait time to slow down the speed of certification when an excessive
number of access attempts have been detected.
Attack Max Num

[50 to 200 / 200 / 1]

004 Sets a limit on the number of requests received for certification in order to
slow down the certification speed when an excessive number of access
attempts have been detected.

These settings should be done with the System Administrator.
5420*


These functions are enabled only after the user access feature has
been enabled.
[0 or 1/ 0 / 1] 0: ON. 1: OFF

001 Copy

Determines whether certification is required
before a user can use the copy application.
[0 or 1/ 0 / 1] 0: ON. 1: OFF

011 Document Server

Determines whether certification is required
before a user can use the document server.
[0 or 1/ 0 / 1] 0: ON. 1: OFF

021 Fax

Determines whether certification is required
before a user can use the fax application.

SM

5-51

D129/D130

Service
Tables

User Authentication

Main SP Tables-5

[0 or 1/ 0 / 1] 0: ON. 1: OFF
Determines whether certification is required

031 Scanner

before a user can use the scanner
application.
[0 or 1/ 0 / 1] 0: ON. 1: OFF

041 Printer

Determines whether certification is required
before a user can use the printer application.

051 SDK1

[0 or 1/ 0 / 1] 0: ON. 1: OFF

061 SDK2

Determines whether certification is required
before a user can use the SDK application.

071 SDK3

[0 or 1/ 0 / 1] 0: ON. 1: OFF
Determines whether certification is required

081 Browser

before a user can use the browser
application.

Authentication Error Code
5481
These SP codes determine how the authentication failures are displayed.
[0 or 1 / 0 / -]
001 System Log Disp

0: OFF [Default], 1: ON
Determines whether an error code appears in the
system log after a user authentication failure occurs.
[0 or 1 / 1 / 1]
0: OFF, 1: ON [Default]

002 Panel Disp

Determines whether an error code appears on the
operation panel after a user authentication failure
occurs.

D129/D130

5-52

SM

Main SP Tables-5

MF KeyCard (Japan only)
Sets up operation of the machine with a keycard.
5490

[0 to 1 / 0 / 1]
0: Disabled. Cancels operation without a user code.
1: Enabled. Allows operation without a user code.

5501*

PM Alarm
PM Alarm Level
001 Sets the PM alarm interval.
[0 to 9999 / 0 / 1 k copies/step]
0: No PM alarm
Original Count Alarm (DFU)
002 Selects whether the PM alarm for the number of scans is enabled or not.
If this is "1", the PM alarm function is enabled.

Jam Alarm
Sets the alarm to sound for the specified jam level (document misfeeds are
not included).
5504*

[0 to 3 / 3 / 1 step]
0: Zero (Off)
1: Low (2.5K jams)
2: Medium (3K jams)
3: High (6K jams)

SM

5-53

D129/D130

Service
Tables

[0 = No / 1 = Yes]

Main SP Tables-5

Error Alarm
Sets the number of sheets to clear the error alarm counter.
The error alarm counter counts "1" when any SC is detected. However, the
error alarm counter decreases by "1" when an SC is not detected during a
5505*

set number of copied sheets (for example, default 5000 (C1b) or 10000
(C1c) sheets). The error alarm occurs when the SC error alarm counter
reaches "5".
[0 to 255 / 45 (C2b), 50 (C1b/C1.5b), 60 (C2c), 100 (C1c/C1.5c) / 100
copies / step]

5508

CC Call
001 Jam Remains
002 Continuous Jams
003 Continuous Door Open

Enables/disables initiating a call.
[0 to 1 / 1 / 1]
0: Disable
1: Enable
Sets the length of time to determine the

011 Jam Detection: Time Length

length of an unattended paper jam.
[3 to 30 / 10 / 1 minute]

012

Jam Detection Continuous
Count

Sets the number of continuous paper jams
required to initiate a call.
[2 to 10 / 5 / 1 time]
Sets the length of time the remains opens

013 Door Open: Time Length

to determine when to initiate a call.
[3 to 30/ 10 / 1 minute]

D129/D130

5-54

SM

Main SP Tables-5

SC/Alarm Setting
With @Remote in use, these SP codes can be set to issue an SC call when

5515*

an SC error occurs. If this SP is switched off, the SC call is not issued when
an SC error occurs.
001 SC Call
002 Service Parts Near End Call
003 Service Parts End Call
004 User Call
006 Communication Information Test Call

[0 or 1 / 1 / 1]
0: OFF

007 Machine Information Notice

1: ON

008 Alarm Notice
010 Supply Automatic Ordering Call
011 Supply Management Report Call

Service
Tables

012 Jam/Door Open Call

Individual PM Part Alarm Call
5516

With @Remote in use, these SP codes can be set to issue an PM alarm call
when one of the SP parts reaches its yield.

001

Disable/Enable Setting (0: Not

[0 or 1 / 1 / - ]

send, 1: Send)

0: Not send, 1: Send

004 Percent yield for triggering PM alert [1 to 255 / 75 / 1 %/step]

SM

5-55

D129/D130

Main SP Tables-5

Memory Clear
5801

Resets NVRAM data to the default settings. Before executing any of these
SP codes, print an SMC Report.
001 All Clear

002 Engine

Initializes items 2 to 15 below.
Initializes all registration settings for the engine and
copy process settings.
Initializes default system settings, SCS (System

003 SCS

Control Service) settings, operation display
coordinates, and ROM update information.

004 IMH Memory Clr

Initializes the image file system.
(IMH: Image Memory Handler)
Initializes the automatic delete time setting for stored

005 MCS

documents.
(MCS: Memory Control Service)

006 Copier application

Initializes all copier application settings.
Initializes the fax reset time, job login ID, all TX/RX

007 Fax Application

settings, local storage file numbers, and off-hook
timer.
Initializes the printer defaults, programs registered,

008 Printer Application

the printer SP bit switches, and the printer CSS
counter.

009 Scanner Application

Initializes the defaults for the scanner and all the
scanner SP modes.
Deletes the Netfile (NFA) management files and

010 Web Service

thumbnails, and initializes the Job login ID.
Netfiles: Jobs to be printed from the document server
using a PC and the DeskTopBinder software

D129/D130

5-56

SM

Main SP Tables-5

Initializes the system defaults and interface settings
(IP addresses also), the SmartDeviceMonitor for
011 NCS

Admin settings, WebStatusMonitor settings, and the
TELNET settings.
(NCS: Network Control Service)

014 Clear DCS Setting

015 Clear UCS Setting

016 MIRS Setting

017 CCS

018 SRM Memory Clr

SM

Initializes the job login ID, SmartDeviceMonitor for
Admin, job history, and local storage file numbers.
Initializes the DCS (Delivery Control Service) settings.
Initializes the UCS (User Information Control Service)
settings.
Initializes the MIRS (Machine Information Report
Service) settings.
Initializes the CCS (Certification and Charge-control
Service) settings.
Initializes the SRM (System Resource Manager)
settings.

019 LCS

Initializes the LCS (Log Count Service) settings.

020 Web Uapli

Initializes the web user application settings.

021 ECS

Initializes ECS (Engine Control Service).

023 AICS

Initializes the AICS settings.

5-57

Service
Tables

012 R-FAX

D129/D130

Main SP Tables-5

FreeRun
Performs a free run on the copier engine.
The correct paper should be loaded in the 1st tray or 2nd tray, but paper is

5802*

not fed.
The main switch has to be turned off and on after using the free run mode
for a test.
001 TRAY1:A4LEF

-

002 TRAY2:A3

-

003 TRAY2:A4SEF

-

Input Check
5803

Displays the signals received from sensors and switches. (

"Input Check

Table" in "Main SP Tables-9")

Output Check
5804

Turns on the electrical components individually for test purposes. (
"Output Check Table" in "Main SP Tables-9")

Anti-Condensation Heater
5805

[0 or 1 / 0 / -]
0:OFF / 1:ON

5810

SC Reset
Resets all level A service call conditions, such as
001 Fusing SC Reset

fusing errors. To clear the service call, touch
"Execute" on the LCD, then turn the main power
switch off/on.

D129/D130

5-58

SM

Main SP Tables-5

MachineSerial

5812*

002 Display

Displays the machine serial number.

003 BCU

Inputs the serial number.

005 FRAM

Displays the FRAM serial number.

Service Tel. No. Setting

001 Service

002 Facsimile

003 Supply

004 Operation

5816

Inputs the telephone number of the CE (displayed when a
service call condition occurs.)
Use this to input the fax number of the CE printed on the
Counter Report (UP mode).
Inputs the telephone number of the supplier displayed on the
user mode screen.
Allows the service center contact telephone number to be
displayed on the user mode screen.

Service
Tables

5811

Remote Service
I/F Setting
Selects the remote service setting.
001 [0 to 2 / 2 / 1 /step]
0: Remote service off
1: CSS remote service on
2: @Remote service on
CE Call
Performs the CE Call at the start or end of the service.
002 [0 or 1 / 0 / 1 /step]
0: Start of the service
1: End of the service
NOTE: This SP is activated only when SP 5816-001 is set to “2”.

SM

5-59

D129/D130

Main SP Tables-5

Function Flag
Enables or disables the remote service function.
003 [0 to 1 / 0 / 1 /step]
0: Disabled, 1: Enabled
NOTE: This SP setting is changed to "1" after @Remote registration has
been completed.
Communication Test Call
004 This SP issues a test call from a GW machine to determine whether it can
communicate successfully with the call center after it has been set up for
NRS. Successful return will be in the range 0 to 99.
Device Information Call
005 This SP issues a call to notify the NRS device information to the call center.
Successful return will be in the range 0 to 99.
SSL Disable
Uses or does not use the RCG certification by SSL when calling the RCG.
007 [0 to 1 / 0 / 1 /step]
0: Uses the RCG certification
1: Does no use the RCG certification
RCG Connect Timeout
008 Specifies the connect timeout interval when calling the RCG.
[1 to 90 / 30 / 1 second /step]
RCG Write Timeout
009 Specifies the write timeout interval when calling the RCG.
[0 to 100 / 60 / 1 second /step]
RCG Read Timeout
010 Specifies the read timeout interval when calling the RCG.
[0 to 100 / 60 / 1 second /step]

D129/D130

5-60

SM

Main SP Tables-5

Port 80 Enable
011 Enables/disables access via port 80 to the SOAP method.
[0 or 1 / 0 / – ]
0: Disabled, 1: Enabled
@Remote Communication Permission
[0 to 2 / 1 / 1 ]
012 0: Not permitted
1: Permitted
2: Partially limited
RFU (Remote Firmware Update) Timing
Selects the RFU timing.
013 [0 or 1 / 1 / – ]
0: RFU is executed whenever update request is received.
1: RFU is executed only when the machine is in the sleep mode.
RCG Error Cause

Service
Tables

[0 or 1 / 0 / – ]
014 0: Normal
1: Fails to reflect the client/server certificate settings by network failure to
reboot. Transition to 0 on restarting the machine.
RCG–C Registed
021 This SP displays the Embedded RC Gate installation end flag.
0: Installation not completed
1: Installation completed
Connect Type (N/M)
This SP displays and selects the Embedded RC Gate connection method.
023 [0 or 1 / 0 / 1 /step
0: Internet connection
1: Dial-up connection

SM

5-61

D129/D130

Main SP Tables-5

Cert. Expire Timing DFU
061
Proximity of the expiration of the certification.
Use Proxy
062 This SP setting determines if the proxy server is used when the machine
communicates with the service center.
Proxy Host
This SP sets the address of the proxy server used for communication
between Embedded RC Gate-N and the gateway. Use this SP to set up or
display the customer proxy server address. The address is necessary to set
063 up Embedded RC Gate-N.


The address display is limited to 128 characters. Characters beyond
the 128 character are ignored.



This address is customer information and is not printed in the SMC
report.

Proxy Port Number
This SP sets the port number of the proxy server used for communication
between Embedded RC Gate-N and the gateway. This setting is necessary to
064 set up Embedded RC Gate-N.


This port number is customer information and is not printed in the
SMC report.

Proxy User Name
This SP sets the HTTP proxy certification user name.
065



The length of the name is limited to 31 characters. Any character
beyond the 31st character is ignored.



This name is customer information and is not printed in the SMC
report.

D129/D130

5-62

SM

Main SP Tables-5

Proxy Password
This SP sets the HTTP proxy certification password.
066



The length of the password is limited to 31 characters. Any character
beyond the 31st character is ignored.



This name is customer information and is not printed in the SMC
report.

CERT: Up State
Displays the status of the certification update.

1

2

3

4
067
11

12

The certification used by Embedded RC Gate is set correctly.
The certification request (setAuthKey) for update has been received
from the GW URL and certification is presently being updated.
The certification update is completed and the GW URL is being notified
of the successful update.
The certification update failed, and the GW URL is being notified of the
failed update.
Service
Tables

0

The period of the certification has expired and new request for an
update is being sent to the GW URL.
A rescue update for certification has been issued and a rescue
certification setting is in progress for the rescue GW connection.
The rescue certification setting is completed and the GW URL is being
notified of the certification update request.
The notification of the request for certification update has completed

13

successfully, and the system is waiting for the certification update
request from the rescue GW URL.

14

15

SM

The notification of the certification request has been received from the
rescue GW controller, and the certification is being stored.
The certification has been stored, and the GW URL is being notified of
the successful completion of this event.

5-63

D129/D130

Main SP Tables-5

16

The storing of the certification has failed, and the GW URL is being
notified of the failure of this event.
The certification update request has been received from the GW URL,

17

the GW URL was notified of the results of the update after it was
completed, but a certification error has been received, and the rescue
certification is being recorded.

18

The rescue certification of No. 17 has been recorded, and the GW URL
is being notified of the failure of the certification update.

CERT: Error
Displays a number code that describes the reason for the request for update
of the certification.
0

1

068

2

3

Normal. There is no request for certification update in progress.
Request for certification update in progress. The current certification
has expired.
An SSL error notification has been issued. Issued after the certification
has expired.
Notification of shift from a common authentication to an individual
certification.

4

Notification of a common certification without ID2.

5

Notification that no certification was issued.

6

Notification that GW URL does not exist.

069 CERT: Up ID

The ID of the request for certification.

083 Firm Up Status

Displays the status of the firmware update.
This SP setting determines if the operator can
confirm the previous version of the firmware
before the firmware update execution. If the

085 Firm Up User Check

option to confirm the previous version is selected,
a notification is sent to the system manager and
the firmware update is done with the firmware
files from the URL.

D129/D130

5-64

SM

Main SP Tables-5

Allows the service technician to confirm the size
086 Firmware Size

of the firmware data files during the firmware
update execution.

087 CERT: Macro Ver.

088 CERT: PAC Ver.

Displays the macro version of the @Remote
certification.
Displays the PAC version of the @Remote
certification.
Displays ID2 for the @Remote certification.
Spaces are displayed as underscores (_).

089 CERT: ID2 Code

Asteriskes (*) indicate that no @Remote
certification exists. "000000___________"
indicates "Common certification".
Displays the common name of the @Remote
certification subject. CN = the following 17 bytes.

090 CERT: Subject

Spaces are displayed as underscores (_).
Asterisks (*) indicate that no @Remote
certification exists. "000000___________"

Service
Tables

indicates "Common certification".
Displays serial number for the @Remote
091 CERT: SerialNo.

certification. Asterisks (*) indicate that no
@Remote certification exists.
Displays the common name of the issuer of the

092 CERT: Issuer

@Remote certification. CN = the following 30
bytes. Asteriskes () indicate that no @Remote
certification exists.

093 CERT: Valid Start

094 CERT: Valid End

Displays the start time of the period for which the
current @Remote certification is enabled.
Displays the end time of the period for which the
current @Remote certification is enabled.

Server CN Check
096
Not used

SM

5-65

D129/D130

Main SP Tables-5

GW Host
096
Not used
GW URL Path
097
Not used
Debug RescueG/WURL Set
099
Not used
CERT: Encrypt Level
Displays the encryption level for the NRS certificate.
102* [1 or 2 / 1 / – ]
1: Indicates that the certificate encryption level is 512 bits.
2: Indicates that the certificate encryption level is 2048 bits.
Selection Country
150
Not used
Line Type Automatic Judgment
151
Not used
Line Type Judgment Result
152
Not used
Selection Dial / Push
153
Not used
Outside Line Outgoing Number
154
Not used
Dial Up User Name
156
Not used

D129/D130

5-66

SM

Main SP Tables-5

Dial Up Password
157
Not used
Local Phone Number
161
Not used
Connection Timing Adjustment Incoming
162
Not used
Access Point
163
Not used
Line Connecting
164
Not used
Modem Serial No.
173
Not used
Retransmission Limit
Service
Tables

174
Not used
RCG-C M DebugBitSW
186
Not used
FAX TX Priority
187
Not used

SM

5-67

D129/D130

Main SP Tables-5

Manual Polling
200
Executes the manual polling.
Regist Status
Displays a number that indicates the status of the @Remote service device.
0: Neither the @Remote device nor Embedded RCG Gate is set.
1: The Embedded RCG Gate is being set. Only Box registration is completed.
201 In this status, @Remote device cannot communicate with this device.
2: The Embedded RCG Gate is set. In this status, the @Remote device
cannot communicate with this device.
3: The @Remote device is being set. In this status the Embedded RCG Gate
cannot be set.
4: The @Remote module has not started.

202 Letter Number

203 Confirm Execute

Allows entry of the request number needed for the
Embedded RCG Gate.
Executes the confirmation request to the @Remote
Gateway.

204 Confirm Result
Displays a number that indicates the result of the confirmation executed with
SP5816-203.
0: Succeeded
1: Confirmation number error
2: Registration in progress
3: Proxy error (proxy enabled)
4: Proxy error (proxy disabled)
5: Proxy error (Illegal user name or password)
6: Communication error
7: Certification update error
8: Other error
9: Confirmation executing

D129/D130

5-68

SM

Main SP Tables-5

Confirm Place
205 Displays the result of the notification sent to the device from the Gateway in
answer to the confirmation request. Displayed only when the result is
registered at the Gateway.
206 Register Execute

Executes "Embedded RCG Registration".

Register Result
Displays a number that indicates the registration result.
0: Succeeded
2: Registration in progress
3: Proxy error (proxy enabled)
207 4: Proxy error (proxy disabled)
5: Proxy error (Illegal user name or password)
6: Communication error
7: Certification update error
8: Other error
9: Registration executing

Displays a number that describes the error code that was issued when either
SP5816-204 or SP5816-207 was executed.
Cause

Illegal Modem
208

Parameter

Code

Meaning

-11001

Chat parameter error

-11002

Chat execution error

-11003

Unexpected error

-12002

Operation Error,
Incorrect Setting

-12003

-12004

SM

Inquiry, registration attempted without
acquiring device status.
Attempted registration without execution
of an inquiry and no previous registration.
Attempted setting with illegal entries for
certification and ID2.

5-69

D129/D130

Service
Tables

Error Code

Main SP Tables-5

@Remote communication is prohibited.
-12005

The device has an Embedded RC
gate-related problem.
A confirmation request was made after

-12006

the confirmation had been already
completed.
The request number used at registration

-12007

was different from the one used at
confirmation.

-12008

-12009

-12010

Update certification failed because
mainframe was in use.
ID2 mismatch between an individual
certification and NVRAM
Certification area is not initialized.
Attempted dial up overseas without the

-2385

correct international prefix for the
telephone number.

Error Caused by

-2387

Not supported at the Service Center

Response from GW

-2389

Database out of service

-2390

Program out of service

-2391

Two registrations for same device

-2392

Parameter error

-2393

RCG device not managed

-2394

Device not managed

-2395

Box ID for RCG device is illegal

-2396

Device ID for RCG device is illegal

-2397

Incorrect ID2 format

-2398

Incorrect request number format

URL

D129/D130

5-70

SM

Main SP Tables-5

Releases the machine from its Embedded RCG
209 Instl Clear

Gate setup.
NOTE: Turn off and on the main power switch after
this setting has been changed.

250 CommLog Print

5821*

Prints the communication log.

Remote Service Address
Sets the IP address of the RCG (Remote
002 RCG IP Address

Communication Gate) destination for call
processing at the remote service center.
[00000000h to FFFFFFFFh / 00000000h / 1]
Sets the port number of the RCG (Remote

003 RCG Port

Communication Gate) destination for call
processing at the remote service center.
[0 to 65535 / 443 / 1]
Sets the URL path of the RCG (Remote
Communication Gate) destination for call
processing at the remote service center.
Service
Tables

004 RCG URL Path

[0 to 16 characters / /RCG/services/ /-]

NV-RAM Data Upload
5824

Uploads the NVRAM data to an SD card. Push Execute.
Note: When uploading data in this SP mode, the front door must be open.

NV-RAM Data Download
5825

Downloads data from an SD card to the NVRAM in the machine. After
downloading is completed, remove the card and turn the machine power off
and on.

SM

5-71

D129/D130

Main SP Tables-5

5828

Network Setting
IPv4 Address (Ethernet/IEEE 802.11)
001 This SP allows you to check and reset the IPv4 address for Ethernet and
wireless LAN (802.11): aaa.bbb.ccc.ddd
IPv4 Subnet Mask (Ethernet/IEEE 802.11)
002 This SP allows you to check and reset the IPv4 subnet mask for Ethernet
and wireless LAN (802.11): aaa.bbb.ccc.ddd
IPv4 Default Gateway (Ethernet/IEEE 802.11)
003 This SP allows you to check and reset the IPv4 default gateway used by the
network for Ethernet and wireless LAN (802.11): aaa.bbb.ccc.ddd
DHCP (Ethernet/IEEE 802.11)
This SP code allows you check and change the setting that determines
whether the IP address is used with DHCP on an Ethernet or wireless
006 (802.11) LAN network.
[0 to 1 / 1 / 1]
0: Not used (manual setting)
1: Used
Active IPv4 Address
021 This SP allows you to check the IPv4 address that was used when the
machine started up with DHCP.
Active IPv4 Subnet Mask
022 This SP allows you to check the IPv4 subnet mask setting that was used
when the machine started up with DHCP.

D129/D130

5-72

SM

Main SP Tables-5

Active IPv4 Gateway Address
023 This SP allows you to check the IPv4 default gateway setting that was used
when the machine started up with DHCP.
Enables and disables bi-directional
050

1284 Compatibility
(Centro)

communication on the parallel connection
between the machine and a computer.
[0 to 1 / 1 / 1 ]
0:Off, 1: On
Disables and enables the ECP feature (1284

052 ECP (Centro)

Mode) for data transfer.
[0 to 1 / 1 / 1]
0: Disabled, 1: Enabled
Switches the job spooling on and off.

065 Job Spooling

[0 to 1 / 0 / 1]
0: No spooling, 1: Spooling enabled
This SP determines whether the job interrupted

066

Job Spooling Clear: Start
Time

This SP operates only when SP5828-065 is set
to "1".
[0 to 1 / 1 / 1]
1: OFF Resumes printing spooled jog.
0: ON Clears spooled job.
This SP determines whether job spooling is
enabled or disabled for each protocol. This is a

Job Spooling (Protocol)

8-bit setting.
[0 to 1 / 1 / 1]
0: No spooling, 1: Spooling enabled

069

SM

0

LPR

4

BMLinks (Japan Only)

1

FTP (Not Used)

5

DIPRINT

2

IPP

6

Reserved (Not Used)

3

SMB

7

Reserved (Not Used)

5-73

D129/D130

Service
Tables

at power off is resumed at the next power on.

Main SP Tables-5

Disables or enables Telnet operation. If this SP
090

TELNET

is disabled, the Telnet port is closed.

(0:OFF 1:ON)

[0 to 1 / 1 / 1]
0: Disable, 1: Enable

091

Web
(0:OFF 1:ON)

Disables or enables the Web operation.
[0 to 1 / 1 / 1]
0: Disable, 1: Enable
This is the IPv6 local address referenced on the
Ethernet or wireless LAN (802.11) in the format:

145

Active IPv6 Link Local
Address

"Link-Local address" + "Prefix Length"
The IPv6 address consists of a total 128 bits
configured in 8 blocks of 16 bits each. These
notations can be abbreviated. See "Note: IPV6
Addresses " below this table.

147

149

151

153

155

Active IPv6 Stateless
Address 1
Active IPv6 Stateless
Address 2

These SPs are the IPv6 stateless addresses (1
to 5) referenced on the Ethernet or wireless LAN

Active IPv6 Stateless

(802.11b) in the format:

Address 3

"Stateless Address" + "Prefix Length"

Active IPv6 Stateless
Address 4

The IPv6 address consists of a total 128 bits
configured in 8 blocks of 16 bits each.

Active IPv6 Stateless
Address 5
IPv6 Manual Address
This SP is the IPv6 manually set address referenced on the Ethernet or
wireless LAN (802.11) in the format:

156 "Manual Set Address" + "Prefix Length"
The IPv6 address consists of a total 128 bits configured in 8 blocks of 16 bits
each. These notations can be abbreviated. See "Note: IPV6 Addresses"
below this table.

D129/D130

5-74

SM

Main SP Tables-5

IPv6 Gateway Address
This SP is the IPv6 gateway address referenced on the Ethernet or wireless
158 LAN (802.11). The IPv6 address consists of a total 128 bits configured in 8
blocks of 16 bits each. These notations can be abbreviated. See "Note: IPV6
Addresses" below this table.
Note: IPV6 Addresses
Ethernet and the Wireless LAN (802.11) reference the IPV6 "Link-Local address + Prefix
Length". The IPV6 address consists of 128 bits divided into 8 blocks of 16 bits:
aaaa:bbbb:cccc:dddd:eeee:ffff:gggg:hhhh:
The prefix length is inserted at the 17th byte (Prefix Range: 0x0 to 0x80). The initial
setting is 0x40 (64).
For example, the data: "2001123456789012abcdef012345678940h" is expressed:
"2001:1234:5678:9012:abcd:ef01:2345:6789": prefixlen 64
However, the actual IPV6 address display is abbreviated according to the following rules.
Rules for Abbreviating IPV6 Addresses
1.

The IPV6 address is expressed in hexadecimal delimited by colons (:) with the
following characters:

2.

Service
Tables

0123456789abcdefABCDEF
A colon is inserted as a delimiter every 4th hexadecimal character.
fe80:0000:0000:0000:0207:40ff:0000:340e
3.

The notations can be abbreviated by eliminating zeros where the MSB and digits
following the MSB are zero. The example in "2" above, then, becomes
fe80:0:0:0207:40ff:0:340e

4.

Sections where only zeros exist can be abbreviated with double colons (::). This
abbreviation can be done also where succeeding sections contain only zeros (but
this can be done only at one point in the address). The example in "2" and "3" above
then becomes:
fe80::207:40ff:0:340e (only the first null sets zero digits are abbreviated as "::")
-orfe80:0:0:0:207:40ff::340e (only the last null set before "340e" is abbreviated as "::")

SM

5-75

D129/D130

Main SP Tables-5

Enable or disables the automatic setting for IPv6
161

IPv6 Stateless Auto

stateless.

Setting

[0 or 1 / 1 / 1]
1: Enable, 0: Disable

Web Item visible
Displays or does not display the Web system items.
236 [0 x 0000 to 0 x ffff / 0 x ffff] 0: Not displayed, 1: Displayed
bit0: Net RICOH
bit1: Consumable Supplier
bit2-15: Reserved (all)
Web shopping link visible
Displays or does not display the link to Net RICOH on the top page and link
237 page of the web system.
[0 to 1 / 1 / 1]
0: Not display, 1:Display
Web supplies Link visible
Displays or does not display the link to Consumable Supplier on the top
238 page and link page of the web system.
[0 to 1 / 1 / 1]
0: Not display, 1:Display
Web Link1 Name
239 This SP confirms or changes the URL1 name on the link page of the web
system. The maximum characters for the URL name are 31 characters.
Web Link1 URL
240 his SP confirms or changes the link to URL1 on the link page of the web
system. The maximum characters for the URL are 127 characters.

D129/D130

5-76

SM

Main SP Tables-5

Web Link1 visible
Displays or does not display the link to URL1 on the top page of the web
241 system.
[0 to 1 / 1 / 1]
0: Not display, 1:Display
242 Web Link2 Name

Same as "-239"

243 Web Link2 URL

Same as "-240"

244 Web Link2 visible

Same as "-241"

DHCPv6 DUID
Sets DHCPv6 DUID.
249 [0000000000000000000000000000h to
FFFFFFFFFFFFFFFFFFFFFFFFFFFFh /
0000000000000000000000000000h / -]

5832

Enter the SP number for the partition to initialize, then press #. When the
execution ends, cycle the machine off and on.
001 HDD Formatting (All)
002 HDD Formatting (IMH)
003 HDD Formatting (Thumbnail)
004 HDD Formatting (Job Log)
005 HDD Formatting (Printer Fonts)
006 HDD Formatting (User Info)
007 Mail RX Data
008 Mail TX Data
009 HDD Formatting (Data for Design)

SM

5-77

D129/D130

Service
Tables

HDD

Main SP Tables-5

010 HDD Formatting (Log)
011 HDD Formatting (Ridoc I/F) (for Ridoc Desk Top Binder)

5836*

Capture Setting
Capture Function (0:Off 1:On)
With this function disabled, the settings related to the capture feature cannot
001 be initialized, displayed, or selected.
[0 to 1 / 0 / 1]
0: Disable, 1: Enable
Panel Setting
Determines whether each capture related setting can be selected or
002 updated from the initial system screen.
[0 to 1 / 0 / 1]
0: Disable, 1: Enable
The setting for SP5836-001 has priority.
[0 to 6 / 0 / 1]

072 Reduction for Copy B&W Text

0:1, 1:1/2, 2:1/3, 3:1/4, 6:2/3
[0 to 6 / 0 / 1]

073 Reduction for Copy B&W Other

0:1, 1:1/2, 2:1/3, 3:1/4, 6:2/3
[0 to 6 / 0 / 1]

075 Reduction for Printer B&W

0 1, 1:1/2, 2:1/3, 3:1/4, 6:2/3

078 Reduction for Printer B&W 1200

1: 1/2, 3: 1/4, 4: 1/6, 5: 1/8
[0 to 3 / 1 / 1]

082 Format for Copy B&W Text

0: JFIF/JPEG, 1: TIFF/MMR, 2:
TIFF/MH, 3: TIFF/MR

D129/D130

5-78

SM

Main SP Tables-5

[0 to 3 / 1 / 1]
083 Format Copy B&W Other

0: JFIF/JPEG, 1: TIFF/MMR, 2:
TIFF/MH, 3: TIFF/MR
[0 to 3 / 1 / 1]

085 Format for Printer B&W

0: JFIF/JPEG, 1: TIFF/MMR, 2:
TIFF/MH, 3: TIFF/MR

Default for JPEG

[5 to 95 / 50 / 1]

Sets the JPEG format default for documents sent to the document
091 management server with the MLB, with JPEG selected as the format.
Enabled only when optional File Format Converter (MLB: Media Link Board)
is installed.
Sets the IP address for the primary capture
101 Primary srv IP address

server. This is basically adjusted by the
remote system.

103 Primary srv port number

104 Primary srv URL path

This is basically adjusted by the remote
system.
This is basically adjusted by the remote

Service
Tables

102 Primary srv scheme

system.
This is basically adjusted by the remote
system.
Sets the IP address for the secondary capture

111 Secondary srv IP address

server. This is basically adjusted by the
remote system.

112 Secondary srv scheme

113 Secondary srv port number

114 Secondary srv URL path

SM

This is basically adjusted by the remote
system.
This is basically adjusted by the remote
system.
This is basically adjusted by the remote
system.

5-79

D129/D130

Main SP Tables-5

120 Default Reso Rate Switch

122 Reso: Copy (Mono)

This is basically adjusted by the remote
system.
[0 to 255 / 3 / 1/step]

Selects the resolution for BW copy mode. This is basically adjusted by the
remote system.
0: 600dpi/ 1: 400dpi/ 2: 300dpi/ 3: 200dpi/ 4: 150dpi/ 5: 100dpi
This is basically adjusted by the remote
124 Reso: Print (Mono)

system.
[0 to 255 / 3 / 1/step]

Selects the resolution for BW print mode. This is basically adjusted by the
remote system.
0: 600dpi/ 1: 400dpi/ 2: 300dpi/ 3: 200dpi/ 4: 150dpi/ 5: 100dpi
This is basically adjusted by the remote
126 Reso: Fax (Mono)

system.
[0 to 255 / 3 / 1/step]

Selects the resolution for BW fax mode. This is basically adjusted by the
remote system.
0: 600dpi/ 1: 400dpi/ 2: 300dpi/ 3: 200dpi/ 4: 150dpi/ 5: 100dpi/ 6: 75dpi
This is basically adjusted by the remote
127 Reso: Scan (Color)

system.
[0 to 255 / 4 / 1/step]

Selects the resolution for color scanning mode. This is basically adjusted by
the remote system.
0: 600dpi/ 1: 400dpi/ 2: 300dpi/ 3: 200dpi/ 4: 150dpi/ 5: 100dpi/ 6: 75dpi
This is basically adjusted by the remote
128 Reso: Scan (Mono)

system.
[0 to 255 / 3 / 1/step]

Selects the resolution for BW scanning mode. This is basically adjusted by
the remote system.
0: 600dpi/ 1: 400dpi/ 2: 300dpi/ 3: 200dpi/ 4: 150dpi/ 5: 100dpi/ 6: 75dpi

D129/D130

5-80

SM

Main SP Tables-5

141 All Addr Info Switch

[0 or 1 / 1 / -]
0: Off, 1: On

Turns on or off all the address information transmission for the captured
resources.
142 Stand-by Doc Max Number

[10 to 9999 / 2000 / 1/step]

Selects the maximum number of captured documents to be transmitted to
the document server.

5840*

IEEE 802.11
Channel MAX
Sets the maximum range of the bandwidth for the wireless LAN. This
006 bandwidth setting varies for different countries.
[1 to 14 / 11 (NA), 13 (EU), 14 (JPN) / 1]
JPN: 1 to 14, NA: 1 to 11, EU: 1 to 13

Sets the minimum range of the bandwidth for operation of the wireless LAN.
007 This bandwidth setting varies for different countries.
[1 to 14 / 1 / 1]
JPN: 1 to 14, NA: 1 to 11, EU: 1 to 13
Transmission speed

[0 x 00 to 0 x FF / 0 x FF to Auto / -]

0 x FF to Auto [Default]
0 x 11 - 55M Fix
0 x 10 - 48M Fix
008 0 x 0F - 36M Fix

0 x 07 - 11M Fix
0 x 05 - 5.5M Fix
0 x 08 - 1M Fix

0 x 0E - 18M Fix

0 x 13 - 0 x FE (reserved)

0 x 0D - 12M Fix

0 x 12 - 72M (reserved)

0 x 0B - 9M Fix

0 x 09 - 22M (reserved)

0 x 0A - 6M Fix

SM

5-81

D129/D130

Service
Tables

Channel MIN

Main SP Tables-5

WEP Key Select
Selects the WEP key.
011 Bit 1 and 0
00: Key1, 01: Key2 (Reserved),
10: Key3 (Reserved), 11: Key4(Reserved)
This SP is displayed only when the IEEE802.11 card is installed.
RTS/CTS Thresh
013 Adjusts the RTS/CTS threshold for the IEEE802.11 card.
[0 to 3000 / 2432 / 1]
This SP is displayed only when the IEEE802.11 card is installed.
Fragment Thresh
042 Adjusts the fragment threshold for the IEEE802.11 card.
[256 to 2346 / 2346 / 1]
This SP is displayed only when the IEEE802.11 card is installed.
11g CTS to Self
043 Determines whether the CTS self function is turned on or off.
[0 to 1 / 1 / 1] 0: Off, 1: On
This SP is displayed only when the IEEE802.11 card is installed.
11g Slot Time
044 Selects the slot time for IEEE802.11.
[0 to 1 / 0 / 1] 0: 20 m, 1: 9 m
This SP is displayed only when the IEEE802.11 card is installed.
WPA Debug Lvl
045 Selects the debug level for WPA authentication application.
[1 to 3 / 3 / 1] 1: Info, 2: warning, 3: error
This SP is displayed only when the IEEE802.11 card is installed.

D129/D130

5-82

SM

Main SP Tables-5

Supply Name Setting
5841*

Press the User Tools key. These names appear when the user presses the
Inquiry button on the User Tools screen.
001 Toner Name Setting: Black
007 OrgStamp
011 StapleStd1
012 StapleStd2
013 StapleStd3
014 StapleStd4
021 StapleBind1
022 StapleBind2
023 StapleBind3

USB
Service
Tables

5844

Transfer Rate
001 Sets the speed for USB data transmission.
[0 x 01 or 0 x 04 / 0 x 04 /-]
0 x 01 [Full Speed], 0 x 04 [Auto Change]
Vendor ID
002 Sets the vendor ID:
Initial Setting: 0x05A Ricoh Company
[0x0000 to 0xFFFF/1] (DFU)
Product ID
003 Sets the product ID.
[0x0000 to 0xFFFF/1] (DFU)

SM

5-83

D129/D130

Main SP Tables-5

Device Release No.
Sets the device release number of the BCD (binary coded decimal) display.
004 [0000 to 9999 / 100 / 1] (DFU)
Enter as a decimal number. NCS converts the number to hexadecimal
number recognized as the BCD.
005 Fixed USB Port
This SP standardizes for common use the model name and serial number
for USB PnP (Plug & Play). It determines whether the driver requires
re-installation.
[0 to 2 / 0 / 1]
0: OFF
1: Level 1
2: Level 2
006 PnP Model Name
This SP sets the model name to be used by the USB PnP when "Function
Enable (Level 2) is set so the USB Serial No. can have a common name
(SP5844-5).
Default: Laser Printer (up to 20 characters allowed).
007 PnP Serial Number
This SP sets the serial number to be used by the USB PnP when "Function
Enable (Level 2)
set so the USB Serial No. can have a common name (SP5844-5).
Default: None (up to 12 characters allowed for entry).


Make sure that this entry is the same as the serial number in use.



At initialization the serial number generated from the model name is
used, not the setting of this SP code.



D129/D130

At times other than initialization, the value set for this SP code is used.

5-84

SM

Main SP Tables-5

100 Notify Unsupport
This SP determines whether an alert message appears on the control panel
when a USB device (unsupported device) that cannot use an A-connector is
connected.
[0 to 1 / 1 / 1]
0: Function enable
1: Function disable


An unsupported device is a device that cannot use the functions of the
USB device. For example, a USB mouse cannot be used even if it
connected.



If the PictBridge option is not mounted, even if a digital camera is
connected it cannot be used because it is an unsupported device.

Delivery Server Setting
5845*
These are delivery server settings.
FTP Port No.
001
Service
Tables

[0 to 65535 / 3670 / 1]
IP Address (Primary)
002 Use this SP to set the Scan Router Server address. The IP address under
the transfer tab can be used with the initial system setting.
[Range: 000.000.000.000 to 255.255.255.255]
Delivery Error Display Time
Use this setting to set the length of time that the message is shown when a
006 test error occurs during document transfer with the NetFile application and
an external device.
[0 to 999 / 300 / 1 sec]
IP Address (Secondary)
Sets the IP address that is given to the computer that is the secondary
008 delivery server for Scan Router. This SP lets you set only the IP address,
and does not refer to the DNS setting.
[Range: 000.000.000.000 to 255.255.255.255]
SM

5-85

D129/D130

Main SP Tables-5

Delivery Server Model
Lets you change the model of the delivery server that is registered by the I/O
device.
[0 to 4 / 0 / 1 step]
009 0: Unknown
1: SG1 Provided
2: SG1 Package
3: SG2 Provided
4: SG2 Package
Delivery Svr. Capability
Changes the functions that the registered I/O device can do.
[0 to 255 / 0 / 1 step]
Bit7 = 1 Comment information exits
Bit6 = 1 Direct specification of mail address possible
010 Bit5 = 1 Mail RX confirmation setting possible
Bit4 = 1 Address book automatic update function exists
Bit3 = 1 Fax RX delivery function exists
Bit2 = 1 Sender password function exists
Bit1 = 1 Function to link MK-1 user and Sender exists
Bit0 = 1 Sender specification required (if set to 1, Bit6 is set to "0")
Delivery Svr.Capability (Ext)
011 These settings are for future use. They will let you increase the number of
registered devices (in addition to those registered for SP5845 010).
There are eight bits (Bit 0 to Bit 7). All are unused at this time.
013 Server Scheme (Primary)
014 Server port Number (Primary)

[1 to 65535 / 80 / 1]

015 Server URL Path (Primary)
016 Server Scheme (Secondary)
017 Server Port Number(Secondary)

[1 to 65535 / 80 / 1]

018 Server URL Path (Secondary)

D129/D130

5-86

SM

Main SP Tables-5

[0 to 1 / 1 / -]

Rapid Sending Control

0: Disable, 1: Enable

022
Enables or disables the prevention function for the continuous data sending
error.

5846*

UCS Setting
Machine ID (for Delivery Server)
Displays the unique device ID in use by the delivery server directory. The
001 value is only displayed and cannot be changed.
This ID is created from the NIC MAC or IEEE 1394 EUI.
The ID is displayed as either 6-byle or 8-byte binary.
Machine ID Clear (for Delivery Server)
Clears the unique ID of the device used as the name in the file transfer
002 directory. Execute this SP if the connection of the device to the delivery
server is unstable. After clearing the ID, the ID will be established again
automatically by cycling the machine off and on.

Service
Tables

Maximum Entries
Changes the maximum number of entries that UCS can handle.
003 [2000 to 20000 / 2000 / 1 step]
If a value smaller than the present value is set, the UCS managed data is
cleared, and the data (excluding user code information) is displayed.
Delivery Server Retry Timer
Sets the interval for retry attempts when the delivery server fails to acquire
006 the delivery server address book.
[0 to 255 / 0 / 1 step]
0: No retries

SM

5-87

D129/D130

Main SP Tables-5

Delivery Server Retry Times
007 Sets the number of retry attempts when the delivery server fails to acquire
the delivery server address book.
[0 to 255 / 0 / 1step]
Delivery Server Maximum Entries
008 Lets you set the maximum number of account entries and information about
the users of the delivery server controlled by UCS.
[2000 to 20000 / 2000 / 1 step]
LDAP Search Timeout
010 Sets the length of the time-out for the search of the LDAP server.
[1 to 255 / 60 /1 step]
WSD Maximum Entries
020 WSD (Web Services on Devices) is the Microsoft standard for connectivity
to web-service enabled devices.
[50 to 250 / 250 / 1]
Folder Auth Change
This SP determines whether the user login information (Login User name
and Password) or address (destination setting in the address book for
Scan-to-SMB) is used to permit folder access. The machine must be cycled
021 off/on for this setting to take effect if it is changed.
[0 to 1 / 0 / 1]
0: Login User
Uses operator login information (initial value of main machine)
1: Destination
Uses address authorization information
Initial Value of Upper Limit Count
022
[0 to 999999 / 500 / 1]

D129/D130

5-88

SM

Main SP Tables-5

Addr Book Migration (USB -> HDD)
This SP moves the address book data from the SD card or flash ROM on the
controller board to the HDD. You must cycle the machine off and on after
executing this SP.
1.

Turn the machine off.

2.

Install the HDD.

3.

Turn the machine on.

4.

Do SP5846 040.

040 5.

Turn the machine off/on.


Executing this SP overwrites any address book data already on the
HDD with the data from the flash ROM on the controller board.



We recommend that you back up all directory information to an SD
card with SP5846-051 before you execute this SP.



After the address book data is copied to HDD, all the address book
data is deleted from the flash ROM. If the operation fails, the data is
not erased from the flash ROM.

This SP must be executed immediately after installation of an HDD unit in a
basic machine that previously had no HDD. The first time the machine is
powered on with the new HDD installed, the system automatically takes the
address book from the NVRAM and writes it onto the new HDD. However,
the new address book on the HDD can be accessed only by the system
administrator at this stage. Executing this SP by the service technician
immediately after power on grants full address book access to all users.
Procedure
1.

Turn the machine off.

2.

Install the new HDD.

3.

Turn the machine on.

4.

The address book and its initial data are created on the HDD
automatically. However, at this point the address book can be accessed
by only the system administrator or key operator.

5.

Enter the SP mode and do SP5846 041. After this SP executes
successfully, any user can access the address book.

SM

5-89

D129/D130

Service
Tables

041 Fill Addr Acl Info.

Main SP Tables-5

Addr Book Media
Displays the slot number where an address book data is in.
[0 to 30 / - /1]
043

0: Unconfirmed
1: SD Slot 1

20: HDD

2: SD Slot 2

30: Nothing

4: USB Flash ROM
Initialize All Setting & Addr Book
046
Initializes all settings and the address book.
Initialize Local Address Book
047 Clears all of the address information from the local address book of a
machine managed with UCS.
Initialize Delivery Addr Book
048 Push [Execute] to delete all items (this does not include user codes) in the
delivery address book that is controlled by UCS.
Initialize LDAP Addr Book
049 Push [Execute] to delete all items (this does not include user codes) in the
LDAP address book that is controlled by UCS.
Initialize All Addr Book
050 Clears everything (including users codes) in the directory information
managed by UCS. However, the accounts and passwords of the system
administrators are not deleted.
Backup All Addr Book
051 Copies all directory information to the SD card. Do this SP before replacing
the controller board or HDD. The operation may not succeed if the controller
board or HDD is damaged.

D129/D130

5-90

SM

Main SP Tables-5

Restore All Addr Book
052 Copies back all directory information from the SD card to the flash ROM or
HDD. Upload the address book from the old flash ROM or HDD with
SP5846-51 before removing it. Do SP5846 52 after installing the new HDD.
Clear Backup Info
Deletes the address book uploaded from the SD card in the slot 2. Deletes
053 only the files uploaded for that machine. This feature does not work if the
card is write-protected.
Note: After you do this SP, go out of the SP mode, turn the power off. Do not
remove the SD card until the Power LED stops flashing.
Search Option
This SP uses bit switches to set up the fuzzy search options for the UCS
local address book.
Bit

Meaning

0

Checks both upper/lower case characters

060

2

Service
Tables

1
Japan Only

3

SM

4

--- Not Used ---

5

--- Not Used ---

6

--- Not Used ---

7

--- Not Used ---

5-91

D129/D130

Main SP Tables-5

Complexity Option 1
Use this SP to set the conditions for password entry to access the local
address book. Specifically, this SP limits the password entry to upper case
and sets the length of the password.
062 [0 to 32 / 0 / 1step]


This SP does not normally require adjustment.



This SP is enabled only after the system administrator has set up a
group password policy to control access to the address book.

Complexity Option 2
Use this SP to set the conditions for password entry to access the local
address book. Specifically, this SP limits the password entry to lower case
and defines the length of the password.
063 [0 to 32 / 0 / 1step]


This SP does not normally require adjustment.



This SP is enabled only after the system administrator has set up a
group password policy to control access to the address book.

Complexity Option 3
Use this SP to set the conditions for password entry to access the local
address book. Specifically, this SP limits the password entry to numbers and
defines the length of the password.
064 [0 to 32 / 0 / 1step]


This SP does not normally require adjustment.



This SP is enabled only after the system administrator has set up a
group password policy to control access to the address book.

D129/D130

5-92

SM

Main SP Tables-5

Complexity Option 4
Use this SP to set the conditions for password entry to access the local
address book. Specifically, this SP limits the password entry to symbols and
defines the length of the password.
065 [0 to 32 / 0 / 1step]


This SP does not normally require adjustment.



This SP is enabled only after the system administrator has set up a
group password policy to control access to the address book.

FTP Auth Port Setting
091 Sets the FTP port to get the delivery server address book that is used in the
individual authorization mode.
[0 to 65535 / 3671 / 1step]
Encryption Start
094 Shows the status of the encryption function of the address book on the
LDAP server.
Service
Tables

[0 to 255 / 1 ] No default

Rep Resolution Reduction
5847-2 through 5847-6 changes the default settings of image data sent
externally by the Net File page reference function.
5847*

5847-21 sets the default for JPEG image quality of image files controlled by
NetFile.
"NetFile" refers to jobs to be printed from the document server with a PC
and the DeskTopBinder software.
002 Rate for Copy B&W Text

[0 to 6 / 0 / 1]

003 Rate for Copy B&W Other

[0 to 6 / 0 / 1]

0: 1x
1: 1/2x
2: 1/3x
3: 1/4x

005 Rate for Printer B&W

[0 to 6 / 0 / 1]

4: 1/5x
5: 1/8x
6: 2/3x1

SM

5-93

D129/D130

Main SP Tables-5

007 Rate for Printer B&W 1200dpi [0 to 6 / 1 / 1]
Network Quality Default for JPEG
Sets the default value for the quality of JPEG images sent as NetFile pages.
021 This function is available only with the MLB (Media Link Board) option
installed.
[5 to 95 / 50 / 1step]

Web Service
5848-2 sets the 4-bit switch assignment for the access control setting.
5848*

Setting of 0001 has no effect on access and delivery from Scan Router.
5848-100 sets the maximum size of images that can be downloaded. The
default is equal to 1 gigabyte.
0000: No access control
002 Acc. Ctrl.: Repository (only Lower 4 Bits)

0001: Denies access to
DeskTop Binder.

003 Acc. Ctrl.: Doc. Svr. Print (Lower 4 Bits)
004 Acc. Ctrl.: User Directory (Lower 4 Bits)
007 Acc. Ctrl Comm. Log Fax (Lower 4 Bits)
009 Acc. Ctrl.: Job Control (Lower 4 Bits)

Switches access control on
and off.

011 Acc. Ctrl: Device Management (Lower 4 Bits)

0000: OFF, 0001: ON

021 Acc. Ctrl: Delivery (Lower 4 Bits)
022 Acc. Ctrl: User Administration (Lower 4 Bits)
099 Repository: Download Image Setting

D129/D130

5-94

SM

Main SP Tables-5

Specified the max size of
100 Repository: Download Image Max. Size

the image data that the
machine can download/
[1 to 2048 / 2048 / 1 MB]

Setting: Log Type: Job 1
210
No information is available at this time.
Setting: Log Type: Job 2
211
No information is available at this time.
Setting: Log Type: Access
212
No information is available at this time.
Setting: Primary Srv
213
No information is available at this time.
Setting: Secondary Srv
214
Service
Tables

No information is available at this time.
Setting: Start Time
215
No information is available at this time.
Setting: Interval Time
216
No information is available at this time.
Setting: Timing
217
No information is available at this time.

SM

5-95

D129/D130

Main SP Tables-5

Installation Date
5849
Displays or prints the installation date of the machine.

001 Display

The "Counter Clear Day" has been changed to
"Installation Date" or "Inst. Date".
Determines whether the installation date is printed on
the printout for the total counter.

002 Switch to Print

[0 to 1 / 1 / -]
0: OFF (No Print)
1: ON (Print)
When the total number of pages that are made reaches

003 Total Counter

this value, the current date becomes the 'official'
installation date for this machine.
[0 to 99999999 / 0 / 1]

5850*

Address Book Function Japan Only
Replacement of Circuit Classification
The machine is sold ready to use with a G3 line. This SP allows you to
003 switch all at once to convert to G4 after you add a G4 line. Conversely, if for
some reason the G4 line becomes unusable, you can easily switch back to
G3.

Bluetooth
5851*

Sets the operation mode for the Bluetooth Unit. Press either key.
[0: Public] / [1: Private]

D129/D130

5-96

SM

Main SP Tables-5

Stamp Data Download
Push [Execute] to download the fixed stamp data from the machine ROM
onto the hard disk. Then these stamps can be used by the system. If this is
5853

not done, the user will not have access to the fixed stamps ("Confidential",
"Secret", etc.).
You must always execute this SP after replacing the HDD or after formatting
the HDD. Always switch the machine off and on after executing this SP.

5856

Remote ROM Update
When set to "1" allows reception of firmware data via the local port (IEEE
1284) during a remote ROM update. This setting is reset to zero after the
machine is cycled off and on. Allows the technician to upgrade the firmware
002 using a parallel cable
[0 to 1 / 0 / 1 step]
0: Not allowed
1: Allowed

Save Debug Log

Service
Tables

5857

On/Off (1:ON 0:OFF)
Switches on the debug log feature. The debug log cannot be captured until
001 this feature is switched on.
[0 to 1 / 0 / 1]
0: OFF, 1: ON
Target (2: HDD 3: SD)
Selects the destination where the debugging information generated by the
002 event selected by SP5858 will be stored if an error is generated
[2 to 3 / 2 / 1]
2: HDD, 3: SD Card

SM

5-97

D129/D130

Main SP Tables-5

Save to HDD
005
Specifies the decimal key number of the log to be written to the hard disk.
Save to SD Card
006
Specifies the decimal key number of the log to be written to the SD Card.
Copy HDD to SD Card (Latest 4 MB)
Takes the most recent 4 MB of the log written to the hard disk and copies
009 them to the SD Card.
A unique file name is generated to avoid overwriting existing file names on
the SD Card. Up to 4MB can be copied to an SD Card. 4 MB segments can
be copied one by one to each SD Card.
Copy HDD to SD Card Latest 4 MB Any Key)
Takes the log of the specified key from the log on the hard disk and copies it
to the SD Card.
010 A unique file name is generated to avoid overwriting existing file names on
the SD Card. Up to 4 MB can be copied to an SD Card. 4 MB segments can
be copied one by one to each SD Card. This SP does not execute if there is
no log on the HDD with no key specified.
Erase HDD Debug Data
011
Erases all debug logs on the HDD
Erase SD Card Debug Data
Erases all debug logs on the SD Card. If the card contains only debugging
012 files generated by an event specified by SP5858, the files are erased when
SP5857 010 or 011 is executed.
To enable this SP, the machine must be cycled off and on.

D129/D130

5-98

SM

Main SP Tables-5

Free Space on SD Card
013
Displays the amount of space available on the SD card.
Copy SD to SD (Latest 4MB)
014 Copies the last 4MB of the log (written directly to the card from shared
memory) onto an SD card.
Copy SD to SD (Latest 4MB Any Key)
015 This SP copies the log on an SD card (the file that contains the information
written directly from shared memory) to a log specified by key number.
Make HDD Debug
016
This SP creates a 32 MB file to store a log on the HDD.
Make SD Debug
017
This SP creates a 4 MB file to store a log on an SD card.

These SPs select the content of the debugging information to be saved to

5858*

the destination selected by SP5857-002.
SP5858-003 stores one SC specified by number.

001* Engine SC Error (0:OFF 1:ON)

002*

SM

Stores SC codes generated by copier
engine errors.

Controller SC Error (0:OFF

Stores SC codes generated by GW

1:ON)

controller errors.

003* Any SC Error

[0 to 65535 / 0 / 1step]

004* Jam (0:OFF 1:ON)

Stores jam errors.

5-99

D129/D130

Service
Tables

Debug Save When

Main SP Tables-5

5859*

Debug Save Key No.
001 Key 1
002 Key 2
003 Key 3
004 Key 4
005 Key 5

These SPs allow you to set up to 10 keys for log files for
functions that use common memory on the controller board.

006 Key 6

[0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1]

007 Key 7
008 Key 8
009 Key 9
010 Key 10

5860*

SMTP/POP3/IMAP4
Partial Mail Receive Timeout
[1 to 168 / 72 / 1 hour]
020 Sets the amount of time to wait before saving a mail that breaks up during
reception. The received mail is discarded if the remaining portion of the mail
is not received during this prescribed time.
MDN Response RFC2298 Compliance
Determines whether RFC2298 compliance is switched on for MDN reply
021 mail.
[0 to 1 / 1 / 1]
0: No, 1: Yes

D129/D130

5-100

SM

Main SP Tables-5

SMTP Auth. From Field Replacement
Determines whether the FROM item of the mail header is switched to the
022 validated account after the SMTP server is validated.
[0 to 1 / 0 / 1]
0: No. "From" item not switched.
1: Yes. "From" item switched.
SMTP Auth Direct Sending
Select the authentication method for SMPT.
Bit 0: LOGIN
Bit 1: PLAIN
025 Bit 2: CRAM_MD5
Bit 3: DIGEST_MD5
Bit 4 to Bit 7: Not Used


This SP is activated only when SMTP authentication is enabled by
UP mode.

Service
Tables

S/MIME: MIME Header Setting
Selects the MIME header type of an E-mail sent by S/MIME.
026 [0 to 2 / 0 / 1]
0: Microsoft Outlook Express standard
1: Internet Draft standard
2: RFC standard
028 S/MIME: Authentication Check
When sending S/MIME mail, specifies whether to check the destination
authentication.
[0 to 1 / 0 / 1]
0: Not checked
1: Checked

SM

5-101

D129/D130

Main SP Tables-5

5870

Common Key Info Writing
Writes to flash ROM the common proof for validating the

001 Writing

device for @Remote specifications.

003 Initialize

004

Initializes the data area of the common proof for validating.

Writing:

Writes to flash ROM the common proof (2048-bit) for validating

2048bit

the device for @Remote specifications.

SD Card Appli Move
5873

Allows you to move applications from one SD card another. For more, see
"SD Card Appli Move" in the chapter "System Maintenance (Main Chapters).
001 Move Exec

Executes the move from one SD card to another.

002 Undo Exec

This is an undo function. It cancels the previous execution.

5875

SC Auto Reboot
This SP determines whether the machine reboots automatically when an SC
error occurs.


The reboot does not occur for Type A SC codes.
[0 to 1/ 0 / 1]

001

Reboot
Setting

0: The machine reboots automatically when the machine
issues an SC error and logs the SC error code. If the same
SC occurs again, the machine does not reboot.
1: The machine does not reboot when an SC error occurs.

002 Reboot Type

D129/D130

[0 to 1 / 0 / 1]
0: Manual reboot, 1: Automatic reboot

5-102

SM

Main SP Tables-5

5878

Option Setup
Press [Execute] to initialize the Data Overwrite
001 Data Overwrite Security

Security option for the copier. For more, see
"DataOverwriteSecurity Unit" in the chapter
"Installation".

Fixed Phase Block Erasing
5881
Detects the Fixed phrase.

5885*

Set WIM Function
Allows or disallows the functions of web image
monitor.
0: OFF, 1: ON
Bit:
0: Forbid all document server access
1: Forbid user mode access
2: Forbid print function
Service
Tables

020 DocSvr Acc Ctrl

3: Forbid Fax
4: Forbid scan sending
5: Forbid download
6: Forbid delete
7: Forbid guest user
DocSvr Format
50 Selects the display type for the document box list.
[0 to 2 / 0 / 1]
0: Thumbnail, 1: Icon, 2: Details
DocSvr Trans
51 Sets the number of documents to be displayed in the document box list.
[5 to 20 / 10 / 1]

SM

5-103

D129/D130

Main SP Tables-5

Set Signature
[0 to 2 / 0 / 1/step]
0: Signature for each e-mail
100 1: Signature for all e-mails
2: No signature
Selects whether the signature is added to the scanned documents with the
WIM when they are transmitted by an e-mail.
Set Encryption
Determines whether the scanned documents with the WIM are encrypted
101 when they are transmitted by an e-mail.
[0 to 1 / 0 / 1]
0: Not encrypted, 1:Encryption
200 Detect Mem Leak

Not used

201 DocSvr Timeout

Not used

SD Get Counter
5887
This SP determines whether the ROM can be updated.
This SP sends a text file to an SD card inserted in SD card Slot 2 (lower slot).
The operation stores. The file is stored in a folder created in the root directory
of the SD card called SD_COUNTER. The file is saved as a text file (*.txt)
001 prefixed with the number of the machine.
1.

Insert the SD card in SD card Slot 2 (lower slot).

2.

Select SP5887 then touch [EXECUTE].

Touch [Execute] in the message when you are prompted.

D129/D130

5-104

SM

Main SP Tables-5

Personal Information Protect
Selects the protection level for logs.
5888*

[0 to 1 / 0 / 1]
0: No authentication, No protection for logs
1: No authentication, Protected logs (only an administrator can see the logs)

SDK Application Counter
5893
Displays the counter name of each SDK application.
1 SDK-1
2 SDK-2
3 SDK-3
4 SDK-4
5 SDK-5

Service
Tables

6 SDK-6

Plug & Play Maker/Model Name
Selects the brand name and the production name for Windows Plug & Play.
5907

This information is stored in the NVRAM. If the NVRAM is defective, these
names should be registered again.
After selecting, press the "Original Type" key and "#" key at the same time.
When the setting is completed, the beeper sounds five times.

5913*

Switchover Permission Time
Print Application Timer

[3 to 30 / 3 / 1 second step]

002 Sets the length of time to elapse before allowing another application to take
control of the display when the application currently controlling the display is
not operating because a key has not been pressed.

SM

5-105

D129/D130

Main SP Tables-5

Copy Server: Set Function

0: ON, 1: OFF

Enable and disable the document server. This is a security measure that
5967*

prevents image data from being left in the temporary area of the HDD. After
changing this setting, you must switch the main switch off and on to enable
the new setting.

Cherry Server
Selects which version of the Scan Router application program, "Light" or
"Full" (Professional) is installed.

5974*

[0 or 1 / 0 / - ]
0: Light
1: Full

Device Setting
The NIC and USB support features are built into the GW controller. Use this

5985

SP to enable and disable these features. In order to use the NIC and USB
functions built into the controller board, these SP codes must be set to "1".
[0 to 2 / 0 / 1 /step]
0: Disable, 1: Enable, 2: Function limitation
When the "Function limitation" is set, "On board NIC" is
limited only for the NRS or LDAP/NT authentication.
001 On Board NIC



Other network applications than @Remote or
LDAP/NT authentication are not available when
this SP is set to "2". Even though you can
change the initial settings of those network
applications, the settings do not work

002 On Board USB

D129/D130

[0 or 1 / 0 / 1/step]
0: Disable, 1: Enable

5-106

SM

Main SP Tables-5

5987*

Counter Falsification Prevention
This SP detects that a mechanical counter device is removed. If it is
detected, SC610 occurs.
[0 or 1 / 1 / 1/step]
0: OFF. 1: ON

SP Print Mode
5990
Prints out the SMC sheets.
001 All ( Data List)
002 SP (Mode Data List)
003 User Program
004 Logging Data
005 Diagnostic Report
006 Non-Default
Service
Tables

007 NIB Summary
008 Capture Log
021 Copier User Program
022 Scanner SP
023 Scanner User Program
024 SDK/J Summary
025 SDK/J Application Info
026 Print SP

SM

5-107

D129/D130

Main SP Tables-6

5.8 MAIN SP TABLES-6
5.8.1 SP6-XXX: PERIPHERALS

ADF Registration Adjust
Adjusts the side-to-side and leading edge registration for simplex and

6006*

duplex original feeding in ARDF mode.
SP6006-5 sets the maximum setting allowed for rear edge erase.
001 Side-to-Side Regist: Front
[–3 to 3 / 0 / 0.1 mm / step]
002 Side-to-Side Regist: Rear
003 Leading Edge Registration

[–5 to 5 / 0 / 0.1 mm / step]

005 Buckle: Duplex Front

[–3 to 3 / 0 / 0.1 mm / step]

006 Buckle: Duplex Rear

[–2.5 to 2.5 / 0 / 0.1 mm / step]

007 Rear Edge Erase

[–10 to 10 / 0 / 0.1 mm / step]

6007

ADF Input Check

001

002

003

Original Length 1 (B5 Detection
Sensor)
Original Length 2 (A4 Detection
Sensor)
Original Length 3 (LG
Detection Sensor)

004 Original Width Sensor 1

0: Paper not detected
1: Paper detected

005 Original Width Sensor 2
006 Original Width Sensor 3
007 Original Width Sensor 4
008 Original Width Sensor 5

D129/D130

5-108

SM

Main SP Tables-6

009 Original Set Sensor
010 Separation Sensor
011 Skew Correction Sensor
012 Scan Entrance Sensor
013 Registration Sensor
014 Exit Sensor

016 Lift Up Sensor

017 Inverter Sensor

018 Pick-up Roller HP Sensor

019 Original Set HP Sensor

6008

0: ADF cover closed
1: ADF cover open
0: ADF closed
1: ADF open
0: Paper not detected
1: Paper detected
0: HP (Pick-up roller: Up)
1: Not HP (Pick-up roller: Down)
0: HP (Stopper: UP)
1: Not HP (Stopper: Down)

Service
Tables

015 Feed Cover Sensor

ADF Output Check
001 Pick-up Motor Forward
002 Pick-up Motor Reserve
003 Feed Motor Forward
004 Feed Motor Reserve
005 Relay Motor Forward
007 Inverter Motor Forward
008 Inverter Motor Reserve
011 Inverter Solenoid
012 Stamp

SM

5-109

D129/D130

Main SP Tables-6

013 Fan Motor

ADF FreeRun
Performs an ARDF free run in duplex mode. Press [ON] to start, press [OFF]

6009

to stop.
Note: This is a general free run controlled from the copier.
001 Free Run: Simplex Motion
002 Free Run: Duplex Motion
003 Free Run: Stamp Motion

ADF Stamp Position Adjust.

[–5 to 5 / 0 / 0.1 mm step]

6010*
Adjusts the horizontal position of the stamp on the scanned originals.

Original Size Detect Setting
Specifies the original size for a size detected by the original sensor, since
original sensors cannot recognize all sizes.
(7) 0000 0000 (0)
Different bits are used for detection, depending on the location as shown
below.
Bit
7
6016*

Size

Location

A4 (L)/LT (L)
Japan only

6

11" x 15"/DLT (L)

5

DLT (L)/ 11" x 15"

4

LT (S)/ US Exec (S)

3

LT (L)/ 8" x 10" (L)

2

LG (L)/ F4 (L)

1

A4 (L)/ 16K (L)

0

8K (L)/ DLT (L)

NA only

EU/AA only

D129/D130

5-110

SM

Main SP Tables-6

DF Magnification Adj.
6017*

[–5 to 5 / 0 / 0.1% step]

Adjusts the magnification in the sub-scan direction for ADF mode.
Use the key to toggle between + and - before entering the value

Skew Correction Moving Setting
Turns the original skew correction in the ARDF for all original sizes on or off.
6020*

[0 to 1 / 0 / 1 ]
0: Off (only for small original sizes)
1: On (for all original sizes)

Punch Position: Sub Scan
6128
Adjusts the punching position in the sub scan direction. (For D636/D637)
001 2-Hole: DOM (Japan)
002 3-Hole: NA
[-7.5 to 7.5 / 0 / 0.5 mm]
Service
Tables

003 4-Hole: EU
004 5-Hole: SCAN
005 2-Hole: NA

Punch Position: Main Scan
6129
Adjusts the punching position in the main scan direction. (For D636/D637)
001 2-Hole: DOM (Japan)
002 3-Hole: NA
003 4-Hole: EU

[-2 to 2 / 0 / 0.4 mm]

004 4-Hole: SCAN
005 2-Hole: NA

SM

5-111

D129/D130

Main SP Tables-6

Skew Correction: Buckle Adj.
6130*

Adjusts the paper buckle at the punch unit for each paper size. (For
D636/D637)
001 A3 SEF
002 B4 SEF
003 A4 SEF
004 A4 LEF
005 B5 SEF
006 B5 LEF
[-5 to 5 / 0 / 0.25 mm]
007 DLT SEF
008 LG SEF
009 LT SEF
010 LT LEF
011 12" x 18"
012 Other

Skew Correction Control
6131*
Selects the skew correction control for each paper size. (For D636/D637)
001 A3 SEF
002 B4 SEF
003 A4 SEF
004 A4 LEF

[0 to 1 / 1 / 1 mm]

005 B5 SEF
006 B5 LEF
007 DLT SEF

D129/D130

5-112

SM

Main SP Tables-6

008 LG SEF
009 LT SEF
010 LT LEF
011 12" x 18"
012 Other

Jogger Fence Fine Adj.
6132*

This SP adjusts the distance between the jogger fences and the sides of the
stack on the finisher stapling tray in the (Booklet) Finisher D636/D637. The
adjustment is done perpendicular to the direction of paper feed.
001 A3 SEF
002 B4 SEF
003 A4 SEF
004 A4 LEF

Service
Tables

005 B5 SEF
006 B5 LEF
[-1.5 to 1.5 / 0 / 0.5 mm]
007 DLT SEF
008 LG SEF
009 LT SEF
010 LT LEF
011 12" x 18"
012 Other

SM

5-113

D129/D130

Main SP Tables-6

Staple Position Adjustment
Adjusts the staple position for each finisher (D636/D637).
6133*

+ Value: Moves the staple position to the rear side.
- Value: Moves the staple position to the front side.
[-3.5 to 3.5 / 0 / 0.5 mm]

Saddle Stitch Position Adj.
6134*

Use this SP to adjust the stapling position of the booklet stapler when paper
is stapled and folded in the Booklet Finisher (D637).
001 A3 SEF
002 B4 SEF
[-3 to 3 / 0 / 0.2 mm]
003 A4 SEF
004 B5 SEF

+ Value: Shifts staple position toward the crease.
- Value: Shifts staple position away from the crease

005 DLT SEF
006 LG SEF
007 LT SEF
008 12" x 18"
009 Other

D129/D130

5-114

SM

Main SP Tables-6

Folder Position Adj.
6135*

This SP corrects the folding position when paper is stapled and folded in the
Booklet Finisher D637.
001 A3 SEF
002 B4 SEF
[-3 to 3 / 0 / 0.2 mm]
003 A4 SEF
004 B5 SEF

+ Value: Shifts staple position toward the crease.
- Value: Shifts staple position away from the crease.

005 DLT SEF
006 LG SEF
007 LT SEF
008 12" x 18"
009 Other

6136*

Sets the number of times that folding is done in the Booklet Finisher D637.
[2 to 30 / 2 / 1 time/step]

Entrance Sensor
6139

Display the signals received from sensors and switches of the (booklet)
finisher. (D588) (

"Input Check Table" in "Main SP Tables-9")

FIN (EUP) INPUT Check
6140

Display the signals received from sensors and switches of the (booklet)
finisher. (D636/D637) (

SM

"Input Check Table" in "Main SP Tables-9")

5-115

D129/D130

Service
Tables

Book Fold Repeat

Main SP Tables-6

FIN (KIN) OUPUT Check
6144

Display the signals received from sensors and switches of the (booklet)
finisher. (D588) (

"Output Check Table" in "Main SP Tables-9")

FIN (EUP) OUPUT Check
6145

Display the signals received from sensors and switches of the (booklet)
finisher. (D636/D637) (

"Output Check Table" in "Main SP Tables-9")

Max. Pre-Stack Sheet

[0 to 3 / 3 / 1 sheets step]

This SP sets the number of sheets sent to the pre-stack tray.
6149*


You may need to adjust this setting or switch it off when feeding
thick or slick paper.

D129/D130

5-116

SM

Main SP Tables-7

5.9 MAIN SP TABLES-7
5.9.1 SP7-XXX: DATA LOG

7401*

Total SC Counter
SC Counter
001 Displays the total number of service calls that have occurred.
This SC counter can be reset by executing SP7807 (SC/Jam Counter
Reset).
Total SC Counter
002 Displays the cumulative sum of service calls that have occurred.
This SC counter cannot be reset by executing SP7807 (SC/Jam Counter
Reset).

7403*

SC History

Service
Tables

001 Latest
002 Latest 1
003 Latest 2
004 Latest 3
005 Latest 4
Displays the most recent 10 service calls.
006 Latest 5
007 Latest 6
008 Latest 7
009 Latest 8
010 Latest 9

SM

5-117

D129/D130

Main SP Tables-7

7502*

Total Paper Jam
Jam Counter
001
Displays the total number of paper jams.
Total Jam Counter
002
Displays the cumulative sum of paper jams.

7503*

Total Original Jam
Original Jam Counter
001
Displays the total number of original jams.
Total Original Counter
002
Displays the cumulative sum of original jams.

013 Bank: Transport Sn 1: On
Total Jams Location
These SPs display the total number of paper jams by location. A "Check-in"
7504*

(paper late) error occurs when the paper fails to activate the sensor at the
precise time. A "Check-out" ("paper lag") paper jam occurs when the paper
remains at the sensor for longer than the prescribed time.
001 At power On
003 Tray 1: On
004 Tray 2: On
005 Tray 3: On
006 Tray 4: On
007 LCT: On
008 Bypass: On
009 Duplex: On

D129/D130

5-118

SM

Main SP Tables-7

013 Bank: Transport Sn 1: On
011 Vertical Transport 1: On
012 Vertical Transport 2: On
014 Bank: Transport Sn 2: On
017 Registration: On
019 Fusing Exit: On
020 Paper Exit: On
021 Bridge Exit On
022 Bridge Transport: On
024 Junction Gate Sensor: On
025 Duplex Exit: On
026 Duplex Entrance: On (In)
027 Duplex Entrance: On (Out)

Service
Tables

051 Vertical Transport 1: Off
052 Vertical Transport 2: Off
053 Bank Transport 1: Off
054 Bank Transport 2: Off
057 Registration Sensor: Off
058 LCT Feed Sensor: Off
060 Paper Exit: Off
061 Bridge: Exit: Off
062 Bridge: Transport: Off
064 Junction Gate Sensor: Off
065 Duplex Exit: Off
066 Duplex Entrance: Off (In)

SM

5-119

D129/D130

Main SP Tables-7

013 Bank: Transport Sn 1: On
067 Duplex Entrance: Off (Out)
100 Finisher Entrance: KIN
101 Finisher Shift Tray Exit: KIN
102 Finisher Staple: KIN
103 Finisher Exit: KIN
105 Finisher Tray Lift Motor: KIN
106 Finisher Jogger Motor: KIN
107 Finisher Shift Motor: KIN
108 Finisher Staple Motor: KIN
109 Finisher Exit Motor: KIN
191 Finisher Entrance: EUP
192 Finisher Proof Exit: EUP
193 Finisher Shift Tray Exit: EUP
194 Finisher Staple Exit: EUP
195 Finisher Exit: EUP
198 Finisher Folder: EUP
199 Finisher Tray Motor: EUP
200 Finisher Jogger Motor: EUP
201 Finisher Shift Motor: EUP
202 Finisher Staple Moving Motor: EUP
203 Finisher Staple Motor: EUP
204 Finisher Folder Motor: EUP
206 Finisher Punch Motor:EUP

D129/D130

5-120

SM

Main SP Tables-7

Original Jam Detection
Displays the total number of original jams by location. These jams occur
7505

when the original does not activate the sensors. A Check-in ("paper late")
error occurs when the paper fails to activate the sensor at the precise time. A
Check-out ("paper lag") paper jam occurs when the paper remains at the
sensor for longer than the prescribed time.
001 At Power: On
003 Separation Sensor: On
004 Skew Correction Sensor: On
005 Interval Sensor: On
006 Registration Sensor: On
007 Inverter Sensor: On
008 Original Exit Sensor: On
053 Separation Sensor: Off

Service
Tables

054 Skew Correction Sensor: Off
055 Interval Sensor: Off
056 Registration Sensor: Off
057 Inverter Sensor: Off
058 Original Exit Sensor: Off

SM

5-121

D129/D130

Main SP Tables-7

7506*

Jam Count by Paper Size
005 A4 LEF
006 A5 LEF
014 B5 LEF
038 LT LEF
044 HLT LEF
132 A3 SEF
133 A4 SEF
134 A5 SEF

Displays the total number of copy jams by paper size.

141 B4 SEF
142 B5 SEF
160 DLT SEF
164 LG SEF
166 LT SEF
172 HLT SEF
255 Others

D129/D130

5-122

SM

Main SP Tables-7

7507*

Plotter Jam History
001 Last
002 Latest 1
003 Latest 2

Displays the copy jam history (the most recent 10 jams)
Sample Display:
CODE:007

004 Latest 3
005 Latest 4

SIZE:05h
TOTAL:0000334
DATE: Mon Mar 15 11:44:50 2000

006 Latest 5

where:

007 Latest 6

CODE is the SP7504-*** number (see above.
SIZE is the ASAP paper size code in hex.

008 Latest 7
009 Latest 8

TOTAL is the total jam error count (SP7502)
DATE is the date the jams occurred.

Size

Code

Size

Code

Size

Code

A4 (S)

05

A3 (L)

84

DLT (L)

A0

A5 (S)

06

A4 (L)

85

LG (L)

A4

B5 (S)

0E

A5 (L)

86

LT (L)

A6

LT (S)

26

B4 (L)

8D

HLT (L)

AC

HLT (S)

2C

B5 (L)

8E

Others

FF

SM

5-123

Service
Tables

010 Latest 9

D129/D130

Main SP Tables-7

7508*

Original Jam History
001 Last
002 Last 1
003 Last 2

Displays the original jam history (the most recent 10 jams).
Sample Display:
CODE:007

004 Last 3
005 Last 4

SIZE:05h
TOTAL:0000334
DATE: Mon Mar 15 11:44:50 2000

006 Last 5

where:

007 Last 6

CODE is the SP7505*** number (see above.
SIZE is the ASAP paper size code in hex.

008 Last 7
009 Last 8

TOTAL is the total jam error count (SP7503)
DATE is the date the jams occurred.

010 Last 9
Size

Code

Size

Code

Size

Code

A4 (S)

05

A3 (L)

84

DLT (L)

A0

A5 (S)

06

A4 (L)

85

LG (L)

A4

B5 (S)

0E

A5 (L)

86

LT (L)

A6

LT (S)

26

B4 (L)

8D

HLT (L)

AC

HLT (S)

2C

B5 (L)

8E

Others

FF

ROM No./Firmware Version
7801

This SP codes display the firmware versions of all ROMs in the system,
including the mainframe, the ARDF, and peripheral devices.

D129/D130

5-124

SM

Main SP Tables-7

PM Counter Display
7803*
Displays the PM counter since the last PM.
Paper

[0 to 999999 / 0 / 1 page]

001
Displays the paper counter (pages)
Page: PCD

[0 to 999999 / 0 / 1 page]

002
Displays the PCD (Drum and Development unit) counter (pages)
Page: Transfer

[0 to 999999 / 0 / 1 page]

003
Displays the transfer unit counter (pages).
Page: Fuser

[0 to 999999 / 0 / 1 page]

004
Displays the fusing unit counter (pages).
Rotation: PCD

[0 to 999999999 / 0 / 1 mm ]

005
Displays the PCD rotation counter (distance).
Rotation: Transfer

[0 to 999999999 / 0 / 1 mm ]
Service
Tables

006
Displays the transfer unit rotation counter (distance).
Rotation: Fuser

[0 to 999999999 / 0 / 1 mm ]

007
Displays the fuser unit rotation counter (distance).
Rotation(%): PCD

[0 to 255 / 0 / 1 %]

008
Displays the PCD (%) rotation counter (Distance/PM).
Rotation(%):Transfer

[0 to 255 / 0 / 1 %]

009
Displays the transfer unit (%) rotation counter (distance/PM).
Rotation(%):Fuser

[0 to 255 / 0 / 1 %]

010
Displays the fuser unit (%) rotation counter (distance/PM).
Rotation(%):Web

[0 to 255 / 0 / 1 %]

011
Displays the web unit (%) rotation counter (distance/PM).

SM

5-125

D129/D130

Main SP Tables-7

PM Counter Reset
7804

Resets the PM counter.
Touch [Execute] two times > "Completed" > [Exit]
Paper
001
Resets the PM counter of the paper.
PCD
002 Resets the PM counter of the PCD (Drum and Development unit except
developer).
Transfer
003
Resets the PM counter of the transfer unit.
Fuser
004
Resets the PM counter of the fuser unit.
Web
005
Reset the PM counter of the web unit.
All Clear
006
Resets all PM counter

SC/Jam Counter Reset
7807

Resets the SC and jam counters. To reset, press Execute on the touch
panel.
This SP does not reset the jam history counters: SP7507, SP7508.

D129/D130

5-126

SM

Main SP Tables-7

Self-Diagnose Result Display
Execute to open the "Self-Diagnostics Result Display" to view details about
7832

errors. Use the keys in the display on the touch-panel to scroll through all
the information. If no errors have occurred, you will see the "No Error"
message on the screen.

Total Memory Size
7836
Displays the memory capacity of the controller system.

DF Glass Dust Check
Counts the number of occurrences (0 to 65,535) when dust was detected on

7852*

the scanning glass of the ADF or resets the dust detection counter.
Counting is done only if SP4-020-1 (Dust Check) is switched on.
001 Dust Detection Counter
Dust Detection Clear
Counter

[0 to 65535 / 0 / 1 /step]
Service
Tables

002

[0 to 65535 / 0 / 1 /step]

7853

Replacement Counter
PCD

[0 to 255 / 0 / 1 ]

001
Displays the replacement counter of the PCD (Drum and Development unit).
Transfer

[0 to 255 / 0 / 1 ]

002
Displays the replacement counter of the transfer unit.
Fuser

[0 to 255 / 0 / 1 ]

003
Displays the replacement counter of the fusing unit.
Web

[0 to 255 / 0 / 1 ]

004
Displays the replacement counter of the cleaning web.

SM

5-127

D129/D130

Main SP Tables-7

7906

Prev Counter
Page: PCD

[0 to 999999 / 0 / 1 page]

001
Displays the counter (pages) of the previous PCD
Page: Transfer

[0 to 999999 / 0 / 1 page]

002
Displays the previous counter (pages) of the previous transfer unit.
Page: Fuser

[0 to 999999 / 0 / 1 page]

003
Displays the previous counter (pages) of the previous fusing unit.
Rotation: PCD

[0 to 999999999 / 0 / 1 mm ]

004
Displays the previous counter (rotations) of the previous PCD
Rotation: Transfer

[0 to 999999999 / 0 / 1 mm ]

005
Displays the previous counter (rotations) of the previous transfer unit.
Rotation: Fuser

[0 to 999999999 / 0 / 1 mm ]

006
Displays the previous counter (rotations/PM %) of the previous fusing unit.
Rotation(%):PCD

[0 to 255 / 0 / 1 mm]

007
Displays the previous counter (rotations/PM %) of the previous PCD
Rotation(%):Transfer

[0 to 255 / 0 / 1 mm]

008
Displays the previous counter (rotations/PM %) of the previous transfer unit.
Rotation(%):Fuser

[0 to 255 / 0 / 1 mm]

009
Displays the previous counter (rotations/PM %) of the previous fusing unit.
Rotation(%):Web

[0 to 255 / 0 / 1 %]

010 Displays the previous counter (rotations/PM %) of the previous cleaning
web.

D129/D130

5-128

SM

Main SP Tables-7

7950

Replacement Date
PCD
001
Displays the replacement date of the PCD.
Transfer
002
Displays the replacement date of the transfer unit.
Fuser
003
Displays the replacement date of the fusing unit.
Web
004
Displays the replacement date of the web unit.

7951

Remaining Counter
PCD(Page)

[0 to 255 / 255 / 1 days]

001
Displays the remaining counter (pages) of the PCD.
[0 to 255 / 255 / 1 days]

Service
Tables

Transfer(Page)
002

Displays the remaining counter (pages) of the transfer unit.
Fuser(Page)

[0 to 255 / 255 / 1 days]

003
Displays the remaining counter (pages) of the fusing unit.
PCD(Rotation)

[0 to 255 / 255 / 1 days]

005
Displays the remaining counter (rotations) of the PCD.
Transfer(Rotation)

[0 to 255 / 255 / 1 days]

006
Displays the remaining counter (rotations) of the transfer unit.
Fuser(Rotation)

[0 to 255 / 255 / 1 days]

007
Displays the remaining counter (rotations) of the fusing unit.
PCD (%)

[0 to 255 / 100 / 1 %]

009
Displays the remaining counter (%) of the PCD.
SM

5-129

D129/D130

Main SP Tables-7

Transfer (%)

[0 to 255 / 100 / 1 %]

010
Displays the remaining counter (%) of the transfer unit.
Fuser (%)

[0 to 255 / 100 / 1 %]

011
Displays the remaining counter (%) of the fusing unit.
Web (%)

[0 to 255 / 100 / 1 %]

013
Displays the remaining counter (%) of the cleaning web.

PM Yield Setting
7952
Sets the each yield of the following.
PCD(Page)

[0 to 99999999/ 160000 / 1 sheet]

001
Sets the PM yield of the PCD (Pages).
Transfer(Page)

[0 to 9999999 / 160000 / 1 sheet]

002
Sets the PM yield of the transfer unit (Pages).
Fuser(Page)

[0 to 9999999 / 160000 / 1 sheet]

003
Sets the PM yield of the fusing unit (Pages).

PCD(Rotation)
005

C2b: [0 to 999999999 / 71990000 / 1 mm]
C2c: [0 to 999999999 / 75500000 / 1 mm]

Sets the PM yield of the PCD (Rotations).

Transfer(Rotation)
006

C2b: [0 to 999999999 / 62770000 / 1 mm]
C2c: [0 to 999999999 / 65420000 / 1 mm]

Sets the PM yield of the transfer unit (Rotations).

Fuser(Rotation)
007

C2b: [0 to 999999999 / 54880000 / 1 mm]
C2b: [0 to 999999999 / 55800000 / 1 mm]

Sets the PM yield of the fusing unit (Rotations).
Web (%)

[0 to 255 / 92 / 1 %]

009
Sets the PM yield (%) of the web unit.

D129/D130

5-130

SM

Main SP Tables-7

Day Threshold: PCD

[1 to 30 / 15 / 1 days]

021
Adjusts the threshold day for the near end for the PCD.
Day Threshold: Transfer Unit

[1 to 30 / 15 / 1 days]

022
Adjusts the threshold day for the near end for the transfer unit.
Day Threshold: Fusing Unit

[1 to 30 / 15 / 1 days]

023
Adjusts the threshold day for the near end for the fusing unit.

7953

Operation Env Log
T<10

[0 to 99999999 / 0 / 1 mm]

001
Displays the PCU rotation distance in the environment: T<10°C
10<=T<=17

[0 to 99999999 / 0 / 1 mm]

002
Displays the PCU rotation distance in the environment: 10°C<=T<=17°C
17

More (2> "2 or more", 4> "4 or more"

AddBook

Address Book

Apl

Application

B/W

Black & White

Bk

Black

C

Cyan

ColCr

Color Create

ColMode

Color Mode

SM

Service
Tables

Key for Abbreviations

5-133

D129/D130

Main SP Tables-8

Abbreviation

What It Means

Comb

Combine

Comp

Compression

Deliv

Delivery

DesApl

Designated Application. The application (Copy, Fax, Scan, Print)
used to store the job on the document server, for example.

Dev Counter

Development Count, no. of pages developed.

Dup, Duplex

Duplex, printing on both sides

Emul

Emulation

FC

Full Color

FIN

Post-print processing, i.e. finishing (punching, stapling, etc.)

Full Bleed

No Margins

GenCopy

Generation Copy Mode
Get Print Counter. For jobs 10 pages or less, this counter does

GPC

not count up. For jobs larger than 10 pages, this counter counts
up by the number that is in excess of 10 (e.g., for an 11-page
job, the counter counts up 11-10 =1)

IFax

ImgEdt

Internet Fax
Image Edit performed on the original with the copier GUI, e.g.
border removal, adding stamps, page numbers, etc.

K

Black (YMCK)

LS

Local Storage. Refers to the document server.

LSize

Large (paper) Size

Mag

Magnification

MC

One color (monochrome)

D129/D130

5-134

SM

Main SP Tables-8

Abbreviation

What It Means
New Remote Service, which allows a service center to monitor

NRS

machines remotely. "NRS" is used overseas, "CSS" is used in
Japan.

Org

Original for scanning

OrgJam

Original Jam
Print Job Manager/Desk Top Editor: A pair of utilities that allows

Palm 2

print jobs to be distributed evenly among the printers on the
network, and allows files to moved around, combined, and
converted to different formats.

PC

Personal Computer
Pages. A page is the total scanned surface of the original.

PGS

Duplex pages count as two pages, and A3 simplex count as two

PJob

Print Jobs

Ppr

Paper

PrtJam

Printer (plotter) Jam

PrtPGS

Print Pages

Service
Tables

pages if the A3/DLT counter SP is switched ON.

Red (Toner Remaining). Applies to the wide format model A2
R

only. This machine is under development and currently not
available.

Rez

Resolution

SC

Service Code (Error SC code displayed)

Scn

Scan

Sim, Simplex

Simplex, printing on 1 side.

S-to-Email

Scan-to-E-mail

SMC

SM

SMC report printed with SP5990. All of the Group 8counters are
recorded in the SMC report.

5-135

D129/D130

Main SP Tables-8

Abbreviation

What It Means

Svr

Server

TonEnd

Toner End

TonSave

Toner Save

TXJob

Send, Transmission

YMC

Yellow, Magenta, Cyan

YMCK

Yellow, Magenta, Cyan, BlacK



All of the Group 8 SPs are reset with SP5 801-1 Memory All Clear.

8001
8002

T:Total Jobs
These SPs count the number of times each
C:Total Jobs

application is used to do a job.
[0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1]

8003

F:Total Jobs

Note: The L: counter is the total number of times the

8004

P:Total Jobs

other applications are used to send a job to the

8005

S:Total Jobs

8006

L:Total Jobs

document server, plus the number of times a file



already on the document server is used.

These SPs reveal the number of times an application is used, not the number of pages
processed.



When an application is opened for image input or output, this counts as one job.



Interrupted jobs (paper jams, etc.) are counted, even though they do not finish.



Only jobs executed by the customer are counted. Jobs executed by the customer engineer
using the SP modes are not counted.



When using secure printing (when a password is required to start the print job), the job is
counted at the time when either "Delete Data" or "Specify Output" is specified.



A job is counted as a fax job when the job is stored for sending.



When a fax is received to fax memory, the F: counter increments but the L: counter does
not (the document server is not used).



A fax broadcast counts as one job for the F: counter (the fax destinations in the broadcast

D129/D130

5-136

SM

Main SP Tables-8

are not counted separately).


A fax broadcast is counted only after all the faxes have been sent to their destinations. If
one transmission generates an error, then the broadcast will not be counted until the
transmission has been completed.



A printed fax report counts as one job for the F: counter.



The F: counter does not distinguish between fax sending or receiving.



When a copy job on the document server is printed, SP8022 also increments, and when a
print job stored on the document server is printed, SP8024 also increments.



When an original is both copied and stored on the document server, the C: and L: counters
both increment.



When a print job is stored on the document server, only the L: counter increments.



When the user presses the Document Server button to store the job on the document
server, only the L: counter increments.



When the user enters document server mode and prints data stored on the document
server, only the L: counter increments.



When an image received from Palm 2 is received and stored, the L: counter increments.



When the customer prints a report (user code list, for example), the O: counter increments.
However, for fax reports and reports executed from the fax application, the F: counter

8011

T:Jobs/LS

8012

C:Jobs/LS

8013

F:Jobs/LS

8014

P:Jobs/LS

8015

S:Jobs/LS

8016

L:Jobs/LS

8017

O:Jobs/LS



Service
Tables

increments.

These SPs count the number of jobs stored to the
document server by each application, to reveal how local
storage is being used for input.
[0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1]
The L: counter counts the number of jobs stored from
within the document server mode screen at the operation
panel.

When a scan job is sent to the document server, the S: counter increments. When you
enter document server mode and then scan an original, the L: counter increments.



When a print job is sent to the document server, the P: counter increments.



When a network application sends data to the document server, the O: counter increments.



When an image from Palm 2 is stored on the document server, the O: counter increments.



When a fax is sent to the document server, the F: counter increments.

SM

5-137

D129/D130

Main SP Tables-8

8021

T:Pjob/LS

8022

C:Pjob/LS
These SPs reveal how files printed from the document

8023

F:Pjob/LS

8024

P:Pjob/LS

8025

S:Pjob/LS

8026

L:Pjob/LS

8027

O:Pjob/LS

server were stored on the document server originally.
[0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1]
The L: counter counts the number of jobs stored from
within the document server mode screen at the operation
panel.



When a copy job stored on the document server is printed with another application, the C:
counter increments.



When an application like DeskTopBinder merges a copy job that was stored on the
document server with a print job that was stored on the document server, the C: and P:
counters both increment.



When a job already on the document server is printed with another application, the L:
counter increments.



When a scanner job stored on the document server is printed with another application, the
S: counter increments. If the original was scanned from within document server mode, then
the L: counter increments.



When images stored on the document server by a network application (including Palm 2),
are printed with another application, the O: counter increments.



When a copy job stored on the document server is printed with a network application (Web
Image Monitor, for example), the C: counter increments.



When a fax on the document server is printed, the F: counter increments.

D129/D130

5-138

SM

Main SP Tables-8

8031

T:Pjob/DesApl

8032

C:Pjob/DesApl
These SPs reveal what applications were used to

8033

F:Pjob/DesApl

8034

P:Pjob/DesApl

8035

S:Pjob/DesApl

8036

L:Pjob/DesApl

8037

O:Pjob/DesApl

output documents from the document server.
[0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1]
The L: counter counts the number of jobs printed from
within the document server mode screen at the
operation panel.



When documents already stored on the document server are printed, the count for the
application that started the print job is incremented.



When the print job is started from a network application (Desk Top Binder, Web Image
Monitor, etc.) the L: counter increments.

8041

T:TX Jobs/LS

8042

C:TX Jobs/LS

8043

F:TX Jobs/LS

8044

P:TX Jobs/LS

8045

S:TX Jobs/LS

8046

L:TX Jobs/LS

8047

O:TX Jobs/LS

the document server that were later accessed for
transmission over the telephone line or over a network
(attached to an e-mail, or as a fax image by I-Fax).
[0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1]
Note: Jobs merged for sending are counted separately.
The L: counter counts the number of jobs scanned from
within the document server mode screen at the
operation panel.



When a stored copy job is sent from the document server, the C: counter increments.



When images stored on the document server by a network application or Palm2 are sent as
an e-mail, the O: counter increments.

SM

5-139

D129/D130

Service
Tables

These SPs count the applications that stored files on

Main SP Tables-8

8051

T:TX Jobs/DesApl
These SPs count the applications used to send

8052

C:TX Jobs/DesApl

8053

F:TX Jobs/DesApl

8054

P:TX Jobs/DesApl

8055

S:TX Jobs/DesApl

8056

L:TX Jobs/DesApl

8057

O:TX Jobs/DesApl

files from the document server over the telephone
line or over a network (attached to an e-mail, or as
a fax image by I-Fax). Jobs merged for sending
are counted separately.
[0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1]
The L: counter counts the number of jobs sent
from within the document server mode screen at
the operation panel.



If the send is started from Desk Top Binder or Web Image Monitor, for example, then the O:
counter increments.

T:FIN Jobs
8061

[0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1]

These SPs total the finishing methods. The finishing method is specified
by the application.
C:FIN Jobs

8062

[0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1]

These SPs total finishing methods for copy jobs only. The finishing method
is specified by the application.
F:FIN Jobs

8063

[0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1]

These SPs total finishing methods for fax jobs only. The finishing method
is specified by the application.
Note: Finishing features for fax jobs are not available at this time.
P:FIN Jobs

8064

[0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1]

These SPs total finishing methods for print jobs only. The finishing method
is specified by the application.
S:FIN Jobs

8065

[0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1]

These SPs total finishing methods for scan jobs only. The finishing method
is specified by the application.
Note: Finishing features for scan jobs are not available at this time.

D129/D130

5-140

SM

Main SP Tables-8

L:FIN Jobs
8066

[0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1]

These SPs total finishing methods for jobs output from within the
document server mode screen at the operation panel. The finishing
method is specified from the print window within document server mode.
O:FIN Jobs

8067

[0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1]

These SPs total finishing methods for jobs executed by an external
application, over the network. The finishing method is specified by the
application.
Number of jobs started in Sort mode. When a stored
806x 1 Sort

copy job is set for Sort and then stored on the
document server, the L: counter increments. (See
SP8066 1)

806x 2 Stack

Number of jobs started out of Sort mode.

806x 3 Staple

Number of jobs started in Staple mode.
Number of jobs started in Booklet mode. If the

806x 4 Booklet

machine is in staple mode, the Staple counter also

806x 5 Z-Fold

Number of jobs started In any mode other than the
Booklet mode and set for folding (Z-fold).
Number of jobs started in Punch mode. When Punch

806x 6 Punch

is set for a print job, the P: counter increments. (See
SP8064 6.)

806x 7 Other

806x 8 Inside-Fold

806x 9 Three-IN-Fold

SM

Reserved. Not used
Number of jobs started In any mode other than the
Booklet mode and set for folding (Inside-fold).
Letter Fold-in Not Used

806x 10 Three-OUT-Fold

Letter Fold-out Not Used

806x 11 Four-Fold

Double Parallel Fold Not Used

806x 12 KANNON-Fold

Gate Fold Not Used

5-141

D129/D130

Service
Tables

increments.

Main SP Tables-8

806x 13 Perfect-Bind

Perfect Binder Not Used

806x 14 Ring-Bind

Ring Binder Not Used

T:Jobs/PGS
8071

[0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1]

These SPs count the number of jobs broken down by the number of pages
in the job, regardless of which application was used.
C:Jobs/PGS

8072

[0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1]

These SPs count and calculate the number of copy jobs by size based on
the number of pages in the job.
F:Jobs/PGS

8073

[0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1]

These SPs count and calculate the number of fax jobs by size based on
the number of pages in the job.
P:Jobs/PGS

8074

[0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1]

These SPs count and calculate the number of print jobs by size based on
the number of pages in the job.
S:Jobs/PGS

8075

[0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1]

These SPs count and calculate the number of scan jobs by size based on
the number of pages in the job.
L:Jobs/PGS

[0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1]

These SPs count and calculate the number of jobs printed from within the

8076

document server mode window at the operation panel, by the number of
pages in the job.
O:Jobs/PGS

[0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1]

These SPs count and calculate the number of "Other" application jobs

8077

(Web Image Monitor, Palm 2, etc.) by size based on the number of pages
in the job.
807x 1 1 Page

807x 8 21 to 50 Pages

807x 2 2 Pages

807x 9 51 to 100 Pages

D129/D130

5-142

SM

Main SP Tables-8



807x 3 3 Pages

807x 10 101 to 300 Pages

807x 4 4 Pages

807x 11 301 to 500 Pages

807x 5 5 Pages

807x 12 501 to 700 Pages

807x 6 6 to 10 Pages

807x 13 701 to 1000 Pages

807x 7 11 to 20 Pages

807x 14 1001 to Pages

For example: When a copy job stored on the document server is printed in document server
mode, the appropriate L: counter (SP8076 0xx) increments.



Printing a fax report counts as a job and increments the F: counter (SP 8073).



Interrupted jobs (paper jam, etc.) are counted, even though they do not finish.



If a job is paused and re-started, it counts as one job.



If the finisher runs out of staples during a print and staple job, then the job is counted at the
time the error occurs.



For copy jobs (SP 8072) and scan jobs (SP 8075), the total is calculated by multiplying the
number of sets of copies by the number of pages scanned. (One duplex page counts as 2.)



The first test print and subsequent test prints to adjust settings are added to the number of
pages of the copy job (SP 8072).



Service
Tables

When printing the first page of a job from within the document server screen, the page is
counted.

T:FAX TX Jobs

[0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1]

These SPs count the total number of jobs (color or black-and-white) sent
8111

by fax, either directly or using a file stored on the document server, on a
telephone line.
Note: Color fax sending is not available at this time.
001 B/W

Black TX

F:FAX TX Jobs
8113

[0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1]

These SPs count the total number of jobs (color or black-and-white) sent
by fax directly on a telephone line.
Note: Color fax sending is not available at this time.
001 B/W

SM

Black TX

5-143

D129/D130

Main SP Tables-8



These counters count jobs, not pages.



This SP counts fax jobs sent over a telephone line with a fax application, including
documents stored on the document server.



If the mode is changed during the job, the job will count with the mode set when the job
started.



If the same document is faxed to both a public fax line and an I-Fax at a destination where
both are available, then this counter increments, and the I-Fax counter (812x) also
increments.



The fax job is counted when the job is scanned for sending, not when the job is sent.

T:IFAX TX Jobs

[0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1]

These SPs count the total number of jobs (color or black-and-white) sent,
8121

either directly or using a file stored on the document server, as fax images
using I-Fax.
Note: Color fax sending is not available at this time.
001 B/W

Black TX

F:IFAX TX Jobs

[0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1]

These SPs count the number of jobs (color or black-and-white) sent (not

8123

stored on the document server), as fax images using I-Fax.
Note: Color fax sending is not available at this time.
001 B/W

Black TX



These counters count jobs, not pages.



The counters for color are provided for future use; the color fax feature is not available at
this time.



The fax job is counted when the job is scanned for sending, not when the job is sent.

D129/D130

5-144

SM

Main SP Tables-8

T:S-to-Email Jobs
8131

[0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1]

These SPs count the total number of jobs scanned and attached to an
e-mail, regardless of whether the document server was used or not.
001 B/W

Black TX

002 Color

Color TX

003 ACS

Color TX

S:S-to-Email Jobs
8135

These SPs count the number of jobs scanned and attached to an e-mail,

001 B/W

Black TX

002 Color

Color TX

003 ACS

Color TX



These counters count jobs, not pages.



If the job is stored on the document server, after the job is stored it is determined to be color
or black-and-white then counted.



If the job is cancelled during scanning, or if the job is cancelled while the document is
waiting to be sent, the job is not counted.



If the job is cancelled during sending, it may or may not be counted, depending on what
stage of the process had been reached when the job was cancelled.



If several jobs are combined for sending to the Scan Router, Scan-to-Email, or Scan-to-PC,
or if one job is sent to more than one destination. each send is counted separately. For
example, if the same document is sent by Scan-to-Email as well as Scan-to-PC, then it is
counted twice (once for Scan-to-Email and once for Scan-to-PC).

SM

5-145

D129/D130

Service
Tables

without storing the original on the document server.

Main SP Tables-8

T:Deliv Jobs/Svr
8141

[0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1]

These SPs count the total number of jobs scanned and sent to a Scan
Router server.
001 B/W

Black Deliv

002 Color

Color Deliv

003 ACS

Color Deliv

S:Deliv Jobs/Svr
8145

These SPs count the number of jobs scanned and sent to a Scan Router
server.
001 B/W

Black Deliv

002 Color

Color Deliv

003 ACS

Color Deliv



These counters count jobs, not pages.



The jobs are counted even though the arrival and reception of the jobs at the Scan Router
server cannot be confirmed.



If even one color image is mixed with black-and-white images, then the job is counted as a
"Color" job.



If the job is cancelled during scanning, or if the job is cancelled while the document is
waiting to be delivered, the job is not counted.



If the job is cancelled during sending, it may or may not be counted, depending on what
stage of the process had been reached when the job was cancelled.



Even if several files are combined for sending, the transmission counts as one job.

D129/D130

5-146

SM

Main SP Tables-8

T:Deliv Jobs/PC
8151

[0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1]

These SPs count the total number of jobs scanned and sent to a folder on
a PC (Scan-to-PC).
Note: At the present time, 8151 and 8155 perform identical counts.
001 B/W

Black Deliv

002 Color

Color Deliv

003 ACS

Color Deliv

S:Deliv Jobs/PC
8155

These SPs count the total number of jobs scanned and sent with
Scan-to-PC.
001 B/W

Black Deliv

002 Color

Color Deliv

003 ACS

Color Deliv

These counters count jobs, not pages.



If the job is cancelled during scanning, it is not counted.



If the job is cancelled while it is waiting to be sent, the job is not counted.



If the job is cancelled during sending, it may or may not be counted, depending on what

Service
Tables



stage of the process had been reached when the job was cancelled.


SM

Even if several files are combined for sending, the transmission counts as one job.

5-147

D129/D130

Main SP Tables-8

8161

T:PCFAX TX Jobs

These SPs count the number of PC Fax
transmission jobs. A job is counted from when it is
registered for sending, not when it is sent.

8163

F:PCFAX TX Jobs

[0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1]
Note: At the present time, these counters perform
identical counts.



This counts fax jobs started from a PC using a PC fax application, and sending the data out
to the destination from the PC through the copier.

8171

T:Deliv Jobs/WSD

These SPs count the pages scanned by WSD.

8175

S:Deliv Jobs/WSD

[0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1]

001 B/W

Black Deliv

002 Color

Color Deliv

003 ACS

Color Deliv

8181

T:Scan to Media Jobs

8185

S:Scan to Media Jobs

These SPs count the pages scanned to media by
the scanner application.

001 B/W

Black Deliv

002 Color

Color Deliv

003 ACS

Color Deliv

D129/D130

[0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1]

5-148

SM

Main SP Tables-8

8191

T:Total Scan PGS

8192

C:Total Scan PGS

8193

F:Total Scan PGS

8195

S:Total Scan PGS

8196

L:Total Scan PGS



These SPs count the pages scanned by each
application that uses the scanner to scan images.
[0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1]

SP 8191 to 8196 count the number of scanned sides of pages, not the number of physical
pages.



These counters do not count reading user stamp data, or reading color charts to adjust
color.



Previews done with a scanner driver are not counted.



A count is done only after all images of a job have been scanned.



Scans made in SP mode are not counted.

Examples


If 3 B5 pages and 1 A3 page are scanned with the scanner application but not stored, the S:
count is 4.



Service
Tables

If both sides of 3 A4 sheets are copied and stored to the document server using the Store
File button in the Copy mode window, the C: count is 6 and the L: count is 6.



If both sides of 3 A4 sheets are copied but not stored, the C: count is 6.



If you enter document server mode then scan 6 pages, the L: count is 6.

8201

T:LSize Scan PGS

[0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1]

8203

F Lsize Scan PGS

[0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1]

S:LSize Scan PGS

[0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1]

These SP codes count the total number of large pages input with the
8205

scanner for scan jobs only. Large size paper (A3/DLT) scanned for fax
transmission are not counted.
Note: These counters are displayed in the SMC Report, and in the User
Tools display..

SM

5-149

D129/D130

Main SP Tables-8

8211

T:Scan PGS/LS

8212

C:Scan PGS/LS

8213

F:Scan PGS/LS

8215

S:Scan PGS/LS

8216

L:Scan PGS/LS

These SPs count the number of pages scanned into
the document server .
[0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1]
The L: counter counts the number of pages stored
from within the document server mode screen at the
operation panel, and with the Store File button from
within the Copy mode screen



Reading user stamp data is not counted.



If a job is cancelled, the pages output as far as the cancellation are counted.



If the scanner application scans and stores 3 B5 sheets and 1 A4 sheet, the S: count is 4.



If pages are copied but not stored on the document server, these counters do not change.



If both sides of 3 A4 sheets are copied and stored to the document server, the C: count is 6
and the L: count is 6.



If you enter document server mode then scan 6 pages, the L: count is 6.

ADF Org Feeds
8221

[0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1]

These SPs count the number of pages fed through the ADF for front and
back side scanning.
Number of front sides fed for scanning:
With an ADF that can scan both sides simultaneously, the Front
side count is the same as the number of pages fed for either
001 Front

simplex or duplex scanning.
With an ADF that cannot scan both sides simultaneously, the
Front side count is the same as the number of pages fed for
duplex front side scanning. (The front side is determined by which
side the user loads face up.)
Number of rear sides fed for scanning:
With an ADF that can scan both sides simultaneously, the Back
count is the same as the number of pages fed for duplex

002 Back

scanning.
With an ADF that cannot scan both sides simultaneously, the
Back count is the same as the number of pages fed for duplex
rear-side scanning.

D129/D130

5-150

SM

Main SP Tables-8



When 1 sheet is fed for duplex scanning the Front count is 1 and the Back count is 1.



If a jam occurs during the job, recovery processing is not counted to avoid double counting.
Also, the pages are not counted if the jam occurs before the first sheet is output.

Scan PGS/Mode
8231

[0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1]

These SPs count the number of pages scanned by each ADF mode to
determine the work load on the ADF.

002 SADF

003 Mixed Size

004 Custom Size

005 Platen

006 Mixed 1side/2side



Selectable. Large copy jobs that cannot be loaded in
the ADF at one time.
Selectable. Feeding pages one by one through the
ADF.
Selectable. Select "Mixed Sizes" on the operation
panel.
Selectable. Originals of non-standard size.
Book mode. Raising the ADF and placing the original
directly on the platen.
Selectable. Select "Simplex/Duplex" on the operation
Service
Tables

001 Large Volume

panel.

If the scan mode is changed during the job, for example, if the user switches from ADF to
Platen mode, the count is done for the last selected mode.



The user cannot select mixed sizes or non-standard sizes with the fax application so if the
original's page sizes are mixed or non-standard, these are not counted.



If the user selects "Mixed Sizes" for copying in the platen mode, the Mixed Size count is
enabled.



In the SADF mode if the user copies 1 page in platen mode and then copies 2 pages with
SADF, the Platen count is 1 and the SADF count is 3.

T:Scan PGS/Org
8241

[0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1]

These SPs count the total number of scanned pages by original type for all
jobs, regardless of which application was used.

8242

SM

C:Scan PGS/Org

[0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1]

5-151

D129/D130

Main SP Tables-8

These SPs count the number of pages scanned by original type for Copy
jobs.
F:Scan PGS/Org
8243

[0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1]

These SPs count the number of pages scanned by original type for Fax
jobs.
S:Scan PGS/Org

8245

[0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1]

These SPs count the number of pages scanned by original type for Scan
jobs.
L:Scan PGS/Org

8246

[0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1]

These SPs count the number of pages scanned and stored from within the
document server mode screen at the operation panel, and with the Store
File button from within the Copy mode screen



8241

8242

8243

8245

8246

824x 1: Text

Yes

Yes

Yes

Yes

Yes

824x 2: Text/Photo

Yes

Yes

Yes

Yes

Yes

824x 3: Photo

Yes

Yes

Yes

Yes

Yes

824x 4: GenCopy, Pale

Yes

Yes

No

Yes

Yes

824x 5: Map

Yes

Yes

No

No

Yes

824x 6: Normal/Detail

Yes

No

Yes

No

No

824x 7: Fine/Super Fine

Yes

No

Yes

No

No

824x 8: Binary

Yes

No

No

Yes

No

824x 9: Grayscale

Yes

No

No

Yes

No

824x 10: Color

Yes

No

No

Yes

No

824x 11: Other

Yes

Yes

Yes

Yes

Yes

If the scan mode is changed during the job, for example, if the user switches from ADF to
Platen mode, the count is done for the last selected mode.

D129/D130

5-152

SM

Main SP Tables-8

8251

T:Scan PGS/ImgEdt

8252

C:Scan PGS/ImgEdt

8255

S:Scan PGS/ImgEdt

8256

L:Scan PGS/ImgEdt

These SPs show how many times Image Edit
features have been selected at the operation panel
for each application. Some examples of these
editing features are:
Erase> Border
Erase> Center
Image Repeat
Centering
Positive/Negative

8257

O:Scan PGS/ImgEdt

[0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1]
Note: The count totals the number of times the edit
features have been used. A detailed breakdown of
exactly which features have been used is not given.

The L: counter counts the number of pages stored from within the document server mode
screen at the operation panel, and with the Store File button from within the Copy mode screen.

8281

T:Scan PGS/TWAIN

These SPs count the number of pages scanned
using a TWAIN driver. These counters reveal how

8285

S:Scan PGS/TWAIN

[0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1]
Note: At the present time, these counters perform
identical counts.

8291

T:Scan PGS/Stamp

8293

F:Scan PGS/Stamp

These SPs count the number of pages stamped
with the stamp in the ADF unit.
[0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1]
The L: counter counts the number of pages stored

8295

S:Scan PGS/Stamp

from within the document server mode screen at the
operation panel, and with the Store File button from
within the Copy mode screen

SM

5-153

D129/D130

Service
Tables

the TWAIN driver is used for delivery functions.

Main SP Tables-8

T:Scan PGS/Size
8301

[0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1]

These SPs count by size the total number of pages scanned by all
applications. Use these totals to compare original page size (scanning) and
output (printing) page size [SP 8-441].
C:Scan PGS/Size

8302

[0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1]

These SPs count by size the total number of pages scanned by the Copy
application. Use these totals to compare original page size (scanning) and
output (printing) page size [SP 8-442].
F:Scan PGS/Size

8303

[0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1]

These SPs count by size the total number of pages scanned by the Fax
application. Use these totals to compare original page size (scanning) and
output page size [SP 8-443].
S:Scan PGS/Size

8305

[0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1]

These SPs count by size the total number of pages scanned by the Scan
application. Use these totals to compare original page size (scanning) and
output page size [SP 8-445].
L:Scan PGS/Size

[0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1]

These SPs count by size the total number of pages scanned and stored
8306

from within the document server mode screen at the operation panel, and
with the Store File button from within the Copy mode screen. Use these
totals to compare original page size (scanning) and output page size [SP
8-446].

830x 1

A3

830x 2

A4

830x 3

A5

830x 4

B4

830x 5

B5

830x 6

DLT

D129/D130

5-154

SM

Main SP Tables-8

830x 7

LG

830x 8

LT

830x 9

HLT

830x 10

Full Bleed

830x 254

Other (Standard)

830x 255

Other (Custom)

T:Scan PGS/Rez
8311

[0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1]

These SPs count by resolution setting the total number of pages scanned by
applications that can specify resolution settings.
S:Scan PGS/Rez

8315

[0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1]

These SPs count by resolution setting the total number of pages scanned by
applications that can specify resolution settings.

831x 1

1200dpi to

831x 2

600dpito1199dpi

831x 3

400dpito599dpi

831x 4

200dpito399dpi

831x 5

to199dpi

Service
Tables

Note: At the present time, 8311 and 8315 perform identical counts.



Copy resolution settings are fixed so they are not counted.



The Fax application does not allow finely-adjusted resolution settings so no count is done
for the Fax application.

SM

5-155

D129/D130

Main SP Tables-8

8381

T:Total PrtPGS
These SPs count the number of pages printed by

8382

C:Total PrtPGS

8383

F:Total PrtPGS

8384

P:Total PrtPGS

8385

S:Total PrtPGS

8386

L:Total PrtPGS

8387

O:Total PrtPGS

the customer. The counter for the application used
for storing the pages increments.
[0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1]
The L: counter counts the number of pages stored
from within the document server mode screen at
the operation panel. Pages stored with the Store
File button from within the Copy mode screen go to
the C: counter.



When the A3/DLT double count function is switched on with SP5104, 1 A3/DLT page is
counted as 2.



When several documents are merged for a print job, the number of pages stored are
counted for the application that stored them.



These counters are used primarily to calculate charges on use of the machine, so the
following pages are not counted as printed pages:
Blank pages in a duplex printing job.
Blank pages inserted as document covers, chapter title sheets, and slip sheets.
Reports printed to confirm counts.
All reports done in the service mode (service summaries, engine maintenance reports, etc.)
Test prints for machine image adjustment.
Error notification reports.
Partially printed pages as the result of a copier jam.

LSize PrtPGS
8391

[0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1]

These SPs count pages printed on paper sizes A3/DLT and larger.
Note: In addition to being displayed in the SMC Report, these counters are
also displayed in the User Tools display on the copy machine.

D129/D130

5-156

SM

Main SP Tables-8

8401

T:PrtPGS/LS

8402

C:PrtPGS/LS

8403

F:PrtPGS/LS

8404

P:PrtPGS/LS

within the document server mode screen at the

8405

S:PrtPGS/LS

operation panel.

These SPs count the number of pages printed from the
document server. The counter for the application used
to print the pages is incremented.
The L: counter counts the number of jobs stored from

[0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1]
8406

L:PrtPGS/LS



Print jobs done with Web Image Monitor and Desk Top Binder are added to the L: count.



Fax jobs done with Web Image Monitor and Desk Top Binder are added to the F: count.

This SP counts the amount of paper (front/back
8411

Prints/Duplex

counted as 1 page) used for duplex printing. Last pages
printed only on one side are not counted.
[0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1]

8421

[0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1]

These SPs count by binding and combine, and n-Up settings the number of
pages processed for printing. This is the total for all applications.
C:PrtPGS/Dup Comb

8422

[0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1]

These SPs count by binding and combine, and n-Up settings the number of
pages processed for printing by the copier application.
F:PrtPGS/Dup Comb

8423

[0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1]

These SPs count by binding and combine, and n-Up settings the number of
pages processed for printing by the fax application.
P:PrtPGS/Dup Comb

8424

[0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1]

These SPs count by binding and combine, and n-Up settings the number of
pages processed for printing by the printer application.

8425

SM

S:PrtPGS/Dup Comb

[0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1]

5-157

D129/D130

Service
Tables

T:PrtPGS/Dup Comb

Main SP Tables-8

These SPs count by binding and combine, and n-Up settings the number of
pages processed for printing by the scanner application.
L:PrtPGS/Dup Comb
8426

[0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1]

These SPs count by binding and combine, and n-Up settings the number of
pages processed for printing from within the document server mode window
at the operation panel.
O:PrtPGS/Dup Comb

8427

[0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1]

These SPs count by binding and combine, and n-Up settings the number of
pages processed for printing by Other applications

842x 1

Simplex> Duplex

842x 2

Duplex> Duplex

842x 3

Book> Duplex

842x 4

Simplex Combine

842x 5

Duplex Combine

842x 6

2in1

2 pages on 1 side (2-Up)

842x 7

4in1

4 pages on 1 side (4-Up)

842x 8

6in1

6 pages on 1 side (6-Up)

842x 9

8in1

8pages on 1 side (8-Up)

842x 10

9in1

9 pages on 1 side (9-Up)

842x 11

16in1

16 pages on 1 side (16-Up)

842x 12

Booklet

842x 13

Magazine

842x 14

2in1 + Booklet

842x 15

4in1 + Booklet

842x 16

6in1 + Booklet

842x 17

8in1 + Booklet

D129/D130

5-158

SM

Main SP Tables-8

842x 18

9in1 + Booklet

842x 19

2in1 + Magazine

842x 20

4in1 + Magazine

842x 21

6in1 + Magazine

842x 22

8in1 + Magazine

842x 23

9in1 + Magazine

842x 24

16in1 + Magazine



These counts (SP8421 to SP8427) are especially useful for customers who need to
improve their compliance with ISO standards for the reduction of paper consumption.



Pages that are only partially printed with the n-Up functions are counted as 1 page.



Here is a summary of how the counters work for Booklet and Magazine modes:

SM

Magazine

Original Pages

Count

Original Pages

Count

1

1

1

1

2

2

2

2

3

2

3

2

4

2

4

2

5

3

5

4

6

4

6

4

7

4

7

4

8

4

8

4

5-159

Service
Tables

Booklet

D129/D130

Main SP Tables-8

T:PrtPGS/ImgEdt
8431

[0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1]

These SPs count the total number of pages output with the three features
below, regardless of which application was used.
C:PrtPGS/ImgEdt

8432

[0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1]

These SPs count the total number of pages output with the three features
below with the copy application.
P:PrtPGS/ImgEdt

8434

[0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1]

These SPs count the total number of pages output with the three features
below with the print application.
L:PrtPGS/ImgEdt

8436

[0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1]

These SPs count the total number of pages output from within the document
server mode window at the operation panel with the three features below.
O:PrtPGS/ImgEdt

8437

[0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1]

These SPs count the total number of pages output with the three features
below with Other applications.

843x 1

Cover/Slip Sheet

843x 2

Series/Book

Total number of covers or slip sheets inserted. The
count for a cover printed on both sides counts 2.
The number of pages printed in series (one side) or
printed as a book with booklet right/left pagination.
The number of pages printed where stamps were

843x 3

User Stamp

applied, including page numbering and date
stamping.

T:PrtPGS/Ppr Size
8441

[0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1]

These SPs count by print paper size the number of pages printed by all
applications.

8442

D129/D130

C:PrtPGS/Ppr Size

[0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1]

5-160

SM

Main SP Tables-8

These SPs count by print paper size the number of pages printed by the
copy application.
F:PrtPGS/Ppr Size
8443

[0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1]

These SPs count by print paper size the number of pages printed by the fax
application.
P:PrtPGS/Ppr Size

8444

[0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1]

These SPs count by print paper size the number of pages printed by the
printer application.
S:PrtPGS/Ppr Size

8445

[0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1]

These SPs count by print paper size the number of pages printed by the
scanner application.
L:PrtPGS/Ppr Size

8446

[0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1]

These SPs count by print paper size the number of pages printed from
within the document server mode window at the operation panel.

8447

[0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1]

These SPs count by print paper size the number of pages printed by Other
applications.

844x 1

A3

844x 2

A4

844x 3

A5

844x 4

B4

844x 5

B5

844x 6

DLT

844x 7

LG

844x 8

LT

844x 9

HLT

844x 10

Full Bleed

SM

5-161

D129/D130

Service
Tables

O:PrtPGS/Ppr Size

Main SP Tables-8



844x 254

Other (Standard)

844x 255

Other (Custom)

These counters do not distinguish between LEF and SEF.

PrtPGS/Ppr Tray

[0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1]

8451
These SPs count the number of sheets fed from each paper feed station.
001 Bypass Tray

Bypass Tray

002 Tray 1

Copier

003 Tray 2

Copier

004 Tray 3

Paper Tray Unit (Option)

005 Tray 4

Paper Tray Unit (Option)

006 Tray 5

LCT (Option)

007 Tray 6

Currently not used.

008 Tray 7

Currently not used.

009 Tray 8

Currently not used.

010 Tray 9

Currently not used.

011 Tray 10

Currently not used.

012 Tray 11

Currently not used.

013 Tray 12

Currently not used.

014 Tray 13

Currently not used.

015 Tray 14

Currently not used.

016 Tray 15

Currently not used.

D129/D130

5-162

SM

Main SP Tables-8

T:PrtPGS/Ppr Type

[0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1]

These SPs count by paper type the number pages printed by all
applications.
These counters are not the same as the PM counter. The PM counter is
8461

based on feed timing to accurately measure the service life of the feed
rollers. However, these counts are based on output timing.
Blank sheets (covers, chapter covers, slip sheets) are also counted.
During duplex printing, pages printed on both sides count as 1, and a page
printed on one side counts as 1.
C:PrtPGS/Ppr Type

8462

[0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1]

These SPs count by paper type the number pages printed by the copy
application.
F:PrtPGS/Ppr Type

8463

[0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1]

These SPs count by paper type the number pages printed by the fax
application.

8464

[0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1]

These SPs count by paper type the number pages printed by the printer
application.
L:PrtPGS/Ppr Type

8466

[0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1]

These SPs count by paper type the number pages printed from within the
document server mode window at the operation panel.

846x 1

Normal

846x 2

Recycled

846x 3

Special

846x 4

Thick

846x 5

Normal (Back)

846x 6

Thick (Back)

846x 7

OHP

SM

5-163

D129/D130

Service
Tables

P:PrtPGS/Ppr Type

Main SP Tables-8

846x 8

Other

PrtPGS/Mag

[0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1]

8471
These SPs count by magnification rate the number of pages printed.
001 to 49%
002 50% to 99%
003 100%
004 101% to 200%
005 201% to



Counts are done for magnification adjusted for pages, not only on the operation panel but
performed remotely with an external network application capable of performing
magnification adjustment as well.



Magnification adjustments done with printer drivers with PC applications such as Excel are
also counted.



Magnification adjustments done for adjustments after they have been stored on the
document server are not counted.



Magnification adjustments performed automatically during Auto Reduce/Enlarge copying
are counted.



The magnification rates of blank cover sheets, slip sheets, etc. are automatically assigned
a rate of 100%.

8481

T:PrtPGS/TonSave

8484

P:PrtPGS/TonSave
These SPs count the number of pages printed with the Toner Save feature
switched on.
Note: These SPs return the same results as this SP is limited to the Print
application.
[0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1]

D129/D130

5-164

SM

Main SP Tables-8

T:PrtPGS/Emul
8511

[0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1]

These SPs count by printer emulation mode the total number of pages
printed.
P:PrtPGS/Emul

8514

[0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1]

These SPs count by printer emulation mode the total number of pages
printed.
001 RPCS
002 RPDL
003 PS3
004 R98
005 R16
006 GL/GL2
007 R55

Service
Tables

008 RTIFF
009 PDF
010 PCL5e/5c
011 PCL XL
012 IPDL-C
013 BM-Links

Japan Only

014 Other
015 IPDS



SP8511 and SP8514 return the same results as they are both limited to the Print
application.



SM

Print jobs output to the document server are not counted.

5-165

D129/D130

Main SP Tables-8

T:PrtPGS/FIN
8521

[0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1]

These SPs count by finishing mode the total number of pages printed by
all applications.
C:PrtPGS/FIN

8522

[0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1]

These SPs count by finishing mode the total number of pages printed by
the Copy application.
F:PrtPGS/FIN

[0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1]

These SPs count by finishing mode the total number of pages printed by
8523

the Fax application.
Note:
Print finishing options for received faxes are currently not available.
P:PrtPGS/FIN

8524

[0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1]

These SPs count by finishing mode the total number of pages printed by
the Print application.
S:PrtPGS/FIN

8525

[0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1]

These SPs count by finishing mode the total number of pages printed by
the Scanner application.
L:PrtPGS/FIN

8526

[0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1]

These SPs count by finishing mode the total number of pages printed from
within the document server mode window at the operation panel.

852x 1

Sort

852x 2

Stack

852x 3

Staple

852x 4

Booklet

852x 5

Z-Fold

852x 6

Punch

852x 7

Other

D129/D130

5-166

SM

Main SP Tables-8

852x 8

Inside-Fold

852x 9

Three-IN-Fold

852x 10

Three-OUT-Fold

852x 11

Four-Fold

852x 12

KANNON-Fold

852x 13

Perfect-Bind

852x 14

Ring-Bind



If stapling is selected for finishing and the stack is too large for stapling, the unstapled
pages are still counted.



The counts for staple finishing are based on output to the staple tray, so jam recoveries
are counted.

This SP counts the amount of staples used by the
8531

Staples

machine.

8551

T:PrtBooks/FIN

8552

C:PrtBooks/FIN

8554

P:PrtBooks/FIN

8556

L:PrtBooks/FIN

Service
Tables

[0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1]

001 Perfect-Bind

Not Used

002 Ring-Bind

Not Used

8561

T:A Sheet Of Paper

[0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1]

8562

C:A Sheet Of Paper

[0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1]

8563

F:A Sheet Of Paper

[0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1]

8564

P:A Sheet Of Paper

[0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1]

SM

5-167

D129/D130

Main SP Tables-8

8566

L:A Sheet Of Paper

[0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1]

O:A Sheet Of Paper

[0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1]

8567
These SPs count the totals number of duplex pages printed.
001 Total: Over A3/DLT
002 Total: Under A3/DLT
003 Duplex: Over A3/DLT
004 Duplex: Under A3/DLT

T: Counter

[0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1]

These SPs count the total output broken down by color output, regardless
of the application used. In addition to being displayed in the SMC Report,
8581

these counters are also displayed in the User Tools display on the copy
machine.
Note: This SP is expanded for color MFP and color LP machines. For this
machine, the count is done for black only.

O: Counter

[0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1]

These SPs count the totals for A3/DLT paper use, number of duplex pages

8591

printed, and the number of staples used. These totals are for Other (O:)
applications only.
001 A3/DLT
002 Duplex

D129/D130

5-168

SM

Main SP Tables-8

T:Coverage Counter
8601
These SPs count the total coverage for each color and printout pages.
001 B/W

[0 to 2147483647 / 0 / 1]

011 B/W Printing Pages

[0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1]

C:Coverage Counter

[0 to 2147483647 / 0 / 1]

8602
These SPs count the total coverage for B/W.
F:Coverage Counter

[0 to 2147483647 / 0 / 1]

8603
These SPs count the total coverage for B/W.
P:Coverage Counter

[0 to 2147483647 / 0 / 1]

8604
These SPs count the total coverage for B/W.
L:Coverage Counter

[0 to 2147483647 / 0 / 1]

8606
These SPs count the total coverage for B/W.

[0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1]

Service
Tables

SDK Apli Counter
8617

These SPs count the total printout pages for each SDK applicaion.
001 SDK-1
002 SDK-2
003 SDK-3
004 SDK-4
005 SDK-5
006 SDK-6

SM

5-169

D129/D130

Main SP Tables-8

T:FAX TX PGS
8631

[0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1]

These SPs count by color mode the number of pages sent by fax to a
telephone number.
001 B/W

Black TX

F:FAX TX PGS
8633

[0 to 999999 / 0 / 1]

These SPs count by color mode the number of pages sent by fax to a
telephone number.
001 B/W



Black TX

If a document has color and black-and-white pages mixed, the pages are counted
separately as B/W or Color.



At the present time, this feature is provided for the Fax application only so SP8631 and
SP8633 are the same.



The counts include error pages.



If a document is sent to more than one destination with a Group transmission, the count is
done for each destination.



Polling transmissions are counted but polling RX are not.



Relay, memory, and confidential mailbox transmissions and are counted for each
destination.

D129/D130

5-170

SM

Main SP Tables-8

T:FAX TX PGS
8641

[0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1]

These SPs count by color mode the number of pages sent by fax to as fax
images using I-Fax.
001 B/W

Black TX

F:FAX TX PGS
8643

[0 o 9999999 / 0 / 1]

These SPs count by color mode the number of pages sent by Fax as fax
images using I-Fax.
001 B/W



Black TX

If a document has color and black-and-white pages mixed, the pages are counted
separately as B/W or Color.



At the present time, this feature is provided for the Fax application only so SP8641 and
SP8643 are the same.



The counts include error pages.



If a document is sent to more than one destination with a Group transmission, the count is



Polling transmissions are counted but polling RX are not.



Relay, memory, and confidential mailbox transmissions and are counted for each

Service
Tables

done for each destination.

destination.

SM

5-171

D129/D130

Main SP Tables-8

T:S-to-Email PGS
8651

[0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1]

These SPs count by color mode the total number of pages attached to an
e-mail for both the Scan and document server applications.
001 B/W
002 Color
S:S-to-Email PGS

8655

[0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1]

These SPs count by color mode the total number of pages attached to an
e-mail for the Scan application only.
001 B/W
002 Color



The count for B/W and Color pages is done after the document is stored on the HDD. If
the job is cancelled before it is stored, the pages are not counted.



If Scan-to-Email is used to send a 10-page document to 5 addresses, the count is 10
(the pages are sent to the same SMTP server together).



If Scan-to-PC is used to send a 10-page document to 5 folders, the count is 50 (the
document is sent to each destination of the SMB/FTP server).



Due to restrictions on some devices, if Scan-to-Email is used to send a 10-page
document to a large number of destinations, the count may be divided and counted
separately. For example, if a 10-page document is sent to 200 addresses, the count is
10 for the first 100 destinations and the count is also 10 for the second 100
destinations, for a total of 20).

D129/D130

5-172

SM

Main SP Tables-8

T:Deliv PGS/Svr
8661

[0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1]

These SPs count by color mode the total number of pages sent to a Scan
Router server by both Scan and LS applications.
001 B/W
002 Color
S:Deliv PGS/Svr

8665

[0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1]

These SPs count by color mode the total number of pages sent to a Scan
Router server by the Scan application.
001 B/W
002 Color



The B/W and Color counts are done after the document is stored on the HDD of the
Scan Router server.
If the job is canceled before storage on the Scan Router server finishes, the counts are
not done.



The count is executed even if regardless of confirmation of the arrival at the Scan
Router server.

T: Deliv PGS/PC
8671

[0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1]

These SPs count by color mode the total number of pages sent to a folder
on a PC (Scan-to-PC) with the Scan and LS applications.
001 B/W
002 Color
S: Deliv PGS/PC

8675

[0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1]

These SPs count by color mode the total number of pages sent with
Scan-to-PC with the Scan application.
001 B/W
002 Color

SM

5-173

D129/D130

Service
Tables



Main SP Tables-8

8681

T:PCFAX TXPGS

These SPs count the number of pages sent by PC
Fax. These SPs are provided for the Fax application
only, so the counts for SP8681 and SP8683 are the

8683

F:PCFAX TXPGS

same.
[0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1]



This counts pages sent from a PC using a PC fax application, from the PC through the
copier to the destination.



When sending the same message to more than one place using broadcasting, the pages
are only counted once. (For example, a 10-page fax is sent to location A and location B.
The counter goes up by 10, not 20.)

8691

T:TX PGS/LS

8692

C:TX PGS/LS

8693

F:TX PGS/LS

[0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1]

8694

P:TX PGS/LS

The L: counter counts the number of pages stored from

These SPs count the number of pages sent from the
document server. The counter for the application that
was used to store the pages is incremented.

within the document server mode screen at the
8695

S:TX PGS/LS

8696

L:TX PGS/LS

operation panel. Pages stored with the Store File button
from within the Copy mode screen go to the C: counter.



Print jobs done with Web Image Monitor and Desk Top Binder are added to the count.



If several documents are merged for sending, the number of pages stored are counted
for the application that stored them.



When several documents are sent by a Fax broadcast, the F: count is done for the
number of pages sent to each destination.

D129/D130

5-174

SM

Main SP Tables-8

TX PGS/Port
8701

[0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1]

These SPs count the number of pages sent by the physical port used to
send them. For example, if a 3-page original is sent to 4 destinations via
ISDN G4, the count for ISDN (G3, G4) is 12.
001 PSTN-1
002 PSTN-2
003 PSTN-3
004 ISDN (G3,G4)
005 Network

T:Scan PGS/Comp
8711

[0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1]

These SPs count the number of compressed pages scanned into the
document server, counted by the formats listed below.
001 JPEG/JPEG2000
Service
Tables

002 TIFF (Multi/Single)
003 PDF
004 Other
005 PDF/Comp
006 PDF/A

S:Scan PGS/Comp
8715

[0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1]

These SPs count the number of compressed pages scanned by the scan
application, counted by the formats listed below.
001 JPEG/JPEG2000
002 TIFF (Multi/Single)
003 PDF

SM

5-175

D129/D130

Main SP Tables-8

004 Other
005 PDF/Comp
006 PDF/A

8721

T:Deliv PGS/WSD

[0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1]

S:Deliv PGS/WSD

[0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1]

8725
These SPs count the number of pages scanned by each scanner mode.
001 B/W
002 Color

8731

8735

T:Scan PGS/Media

[0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1]

S:Scan PGS/Media

[0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1]

These SPs count the number of pages scanned and saved in a meia by
each scanner mode.
001 B/W
002 Color

RX PGS/Port
8741

[0to9999999/ 0 / 1]

These SPs count the number of pages received by the physical port used to
receive them.
001 PSTN-1
002 PSTN-2
003 PSTN-3
004 ISDN (G3,G4)
005 Network

D129/D130

5-176

SM

Main SP Tables-8

Dev Counter

[0to9999999/ 0 / 1]

These SPs count the frequency of use (number of rotations of the
8771

development rollers) for black and other color toners.
Note: For machines that do not support color, the Black toner count is the
same as the Total count.

Toner_Botol_Info.
8781

This SP displays the number of toner bottles used. The count is done based
on the equivalent of 1,000 pages per bottle.

This SP displays the percent of space
8791

LS Memory Remain

available on the document server for storing
documents.
[0 to 100 / 0 / 1]

Toner Remain

[0 to 100 / 0 / 1]
Service
Tables

This SP displays the percent of toner remaining for each color. This SP
allows the user to check the toner supply at any time.
Note:
8801

This precise method of measuring remaining toner supply (1% steps) is
better than other machines in the market that can only measure in
increments of 10 (10% steps).
This SP is expanded for color MFP and color LP machines. For this
machine, the count is done for black only.

SM

5-177

D129/D130

Main SP Tables-8

8811

Eco Counter
Eco Total

[0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1]

001 Displays the number of pages reduced by using the duplex and the combine
function.
Duplex

[0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1]

004
Displays the number of pages reduced by using the duplex function.
Combine

[0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1]

005
Displays the number of pages reduced by using the combine function.
Duplex(%)

[0 to 100 / 0 / 1]

008
Displays the utilization ratio of the duplex function.
Combine(%)

[0 to 100 / 0 / 1]

009
Displays the utilization ratio of the duplex function.
Paper Cut(%)

[0 to 100 / 0 / 1]

010
Displays the paper reduction ratio.

Cvr Cnt:0-10%
8851

[0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1]

These SPs count the percentage of dot coverage for black other color
toners.
011 0 to 2%: BK
021 3 to 4%: BK
031 5 to 7%: BK
041 8 to 10%: BK

D129/D130

5-178

SM

Main SP Tables-8

Cvr Cnt:11-20%
8861

[0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1]

These SPs count the percentage of dot coverage for black other color
toners.
001 BK

Black toner

Cvr Cnt:21-30%
8871

[0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1]

These SPs count the percentage of dot coverage for black other color
toners.
001 BK

Black toner

Cvr Cnt:31%8881

[0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1]

These SPs count the percentage of dot coverage for black other color
toners.
Black toner

Page/Toner Bottle

Service
Tables

001 BK

[0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1]

8891
These SPs display the amount of the remaining current toner.
001 BK

Black toner

Page/Toner_Prev1

[0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1]

8901
These SPs display the amount of the remaining previous toner.
001 BK

SM

Black toner

5-179

D129/D130

Main SP Tables-8

Page/Toner_Prev2

[0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1]

8911
These SPs display the amount of the remaining 2nd previous toner.
001 BK

Black toner

Cvr Cnt/Total

[0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1]

8921
Displays the total coverage and total printout number for each color.
001 Coverage (%) BK
011 Coverage/P:BK

Machine Status

[0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1]

These SPs count the amount of time the machine spends in each
8941

operation mode. These SPs are useful for customers who need to
investigate machine operation for improvement in their compliance with
ISO Standards.
Engine operation time. Does not include time while
001 Operation Time

controller is saving data to HDD (while engine is not
operating).
Engine not operating. Includes time while controller

002 Standby Time

saves data to HDD. Does not include time spent in
Energy Save, Low Power, or Off modes.

003 Energy Save Time

Includes time while the machine is performing
background printing.
Includes time in Energy Save mode with Engine on.

004 Low Power Time

Includes time while machine is performing
background printing.
Includes time while machine is performing

005 Off Mode Time

background printing. Does not include time machine
remains powered off with the power switches.

006 SC

D129/D130

Total down time due to SC errors.

5-180

SM

Main SP Tables-8

007 PrtJam

008 OrgJam

Total down time due to paper jams during printing.
Total down time due to original jams during
scanning.

009 Supply PM Unit End Total down time due to supply unit end.

AddBook Register
8951

These SPs count the number of events when the machine manages data
registration.
User Code /User
ID

User code registrations.

002 Mail Address

Mail address registrations.

003 Fax Destination

Fax destination registrations.

004 Group

005

Group destination
registrations.

Transfer

Fax relay destination

Request

registrations for relay TX.

006 F-Code

[0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1]

Service
Tables

001

F-Code box registrations.
Copy application

007 Copy Program

registrations with the
Program (job settings)
feature.
Fax application registrations

008 Fax Program

with the Program (job

[0 to 255 / 0 / 255]

settings) feature.
Printer application
009 Printer Program

registrations with the
Program (job settings)
feature.

SM

5-181

D129/D130

Main SP Tables-8

Scanner application
010

Scanner

registrations with the

Program

Program (job settings)
feature.

Adomin. Counter List

[0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1]

8999
Display the total coverage and total printout number for each color.
001 Total
003 Copy: BW
007 Printer: BW
010 Fax Print: BW
012 A3/DLT
013 Duplex
023 Copy: BW (%)
027 Printer: BW (%)
030 Fax Print: BW (%)
101 Transmission Total: Color
102 Transmission Total: BW
103 Fax Transmission
104 Scanner Transmission: Color
105 Scanner Transmission: BW

D129/D130

5-182

SM

Main SP Tables-9

5.11 MAIN SP TABLES-9
5.11.1 INPUT CHECK TABLE
When entering the Input Check mode, 8 digits display the result for a section. Each digit
corresponds to a different device as shown in the table.

Bit No.

7

6

5

4

3

2

1

0

Result

0 or 1

0 or 1

0 or 1

0 or 1

0 or 1

0 or 1

0 or 1

0 or 1

Copier

Input Check
5803

Reading
Description
0

See the table 1 following this table.
Service
Tables

001 Tray 1: Paper Size Sensor

1

002 Tray 1: Tray Set Sensor

Set

Not set

003 Tray 1: Paper Lift Sensor

Not upper limit

Upper limit

004 Tray 1: Paper End Sensor

No paper

Paper remaining

005

Tray 1:
Paper Height Sensor 1
See the table 2 following this table.

006

Tray 1:
Paper Height Sensor 2

007 Tray 2: Paper Size Sensor

SM

See the table 1 following this table.

008 Tray 2: Tray Set Sensor

Set

Not set

009 Tray 2: Paper Lift Sensor

Not upper limit

Upper limit

010 Tray 2: Paper End Sensor

No paper

Paper remaining

5-183

D129/D130

Main SP Tables-9

011

Tray 2:
Paper Height Sensor 1
See the table 2 following this table.

012

Tray 2:
Paper Height Sensor 2

013 Tray 1: Paper Feed Sensor

Paper detected

No paper detected

014 Tray 2: Paper Feed Sensor

Paper detected

No paper detected

015 Tray 3: Paper Feed Sensor

Paper detected

No paper detected

016 Tray 4: Paper Feed Sensor

Paper detected

No paper detected

No paper detected

Paper detected

018 Relay Sensor 1

Paper detected

No paper detected

019 Relay Sensor 2

Paper detected

No paper detected

020 Relay Sensor 3

No paper detected

Paper detected

021 Relay Sensor 4

No paper detected

Paper detected

022 Relay Sensor: LCT

No paper detected

Paper detected

Not end

Paper end

017 LCT: Paper Feed Sensor

023 By-pass: Paper End Sensor
024 By-pass: Paper Size Sensor

See the table 3 following this table.

025 Registration Sensor

Paper detected

No paper detected

026 Fusing Exit Sensor

No paper detected

Paper detected

027 Fusing Entrance Sensor

Paper detected

No paper detected

028 Junction Gate Relay Sensor

Paper detected

No paper detected

029 Exit Sensor

Paper detected

No paper detected

030 Paper Overflow Sensor

Not full

Full

031 Right Cover Open/Close

Close

Open

032 Duplex Unit Open/Close

Open

Close

033 Duplex Entrance Sensor

Paper detected

No paper detected

034 Duplex Exit Sensor

Paper detected

No paper detected

D129/D130

5-184

SM

Main SP Tables-9

035 Bank Right Cover Open/Close

Close

Open

036 Tray Cover Open/Close

Close

Open

Set

Not set

038 Bridge/Exit Tray: Exit Sensor

Paper detected

No paper detected

039 Bridge/Exit Tray: Relay Sensor

Paper detected

No paper detected

040 Bridge/Exit/Shift: Set Detection

Set

Not set

Close

Open

Close

Open

Not HP

HP

Set (Bit1)

Not set (Bit1)

Not full

Full

037 LCT Set

042

Bridge/Exit Tray: Left Guide
Open/Close
Bridge/Exit Tray: Right Guide
Open/Close

043 Transfer Belt Unit HP Sensor
046 Fusing Unit Set
047 Toner Overflow Sensor

048 Interlock Detection 1

049 Interlock Detection 2

Right or front door is Right or front door is
open.

Right or front door is Right or front door is
open.

close.

050 Key Card Set

Set

Not set

051 Key Counter Set

Set

Not set

Not set

set

Set

Not set

Paper detected

No paper detected

Not end

End

No paper detected

Paper detected

Stay at rear

Stay at front

Paper detected

No paper detected

052 Mechanical Counter Set
053 1-Bin Unit Set
054 1-Bin Unit: Paper Set
057 Cleaning Web End
060 Shift Sensor
064 Shift Tray Sensor

065

SM

close.

Bypass Tray Paper Length
Detection

5-185

D129/D130

Service
Tables

041

Main SP Tables-9

200 Scanner HP Sensor

Not HP

HP

201 Platen Cover Sensor

Open

Close

Table 1: Paper Height Sensor
0: Deactivated, 1: Activated (actuator inside sensor)

Remaining paper

Paper height sensor 1

Paper height sensor 2

Full

0

0

Nearly full

1

0

Near end

1

1

Almost empty

0

1

D129/D130

5-186

SM

Main SP Tables-9

Table 2: Paper Size Switch
Switch 1 is used for the tray set detection.
0: Pushed, 1: Not pushed

North America

Switch Location
Europe/Asia

4

3

2

0

0

1

0

0

0

11" x 17" SEF*1

A3 SEF*1

(A3 SEF)

(11" x 17" SEF)

8.5" x 14" SEF *2

B4 SEF *2

(B4 SEF)

(8.5" x 14" SEF)

A4 SEF

A4 SEF

1

1

0

8.5" x 11" SEF

8.5" x 11" SEF

1

1

1

B5 SEF

B5 SEF

0

1

1

11" x 81/2" LEF*3

A4 LEF*3

(A4 LEF)

(11" x 81/2" LEF)

1

0

0

10.5" x 7.25" LEF*4

B5 LEF*4

(B5 LEF)

(10.5" x 7.25" LEF)

0

1

0

A5 LEF

A5 LEF

1

0

1

*1: The machine detects either 11" x 17" SEF or A3 SEF, depending on the setting of SP
5-181-002 (Tray 1) or -006 (Tray 2).
*2: The machine detects either 8.5" x 14" SEF or B4 SEF, depending on the setting of SP
5-181-003 (Tray 1) or -007 (Tray 2).
*3: The machine detects either 11" x 81/2" LEF or A4 LEF, depending on the setting of SP
5-181-001 (Tray 1) or -005 (Tray 2).
*4: The machine detects either B5 LEF or 10.5" x 7.25" LEF, depending on the setting of
SP 5-181-004 (Tray 1) or -008 (Tray 2)..

SM

5-187

D129/D130

Service
Tables

Models

Main SP Tables-9

Table 3: Paper Size (By-pass Table)
0: Pushed, 1: Not pushed

Models

Bit No.

North America

Europe/Asia

3

2

1

0

11" x 17" SEF*1

A3 SEF*1

(11" x 8.5" LEF)

(A4 LEF)

1

1

1

0

11" x 17" SEF*1

A3 SEF*1

(11" x 8.5" LEF)

(A4 LEF)

1

1

0

0

8.5" x 11" SEF*1

A4 SEF*1

(8.5" x 11" SEF*2)

(A5 LEF)

1

1

0

1

8.5" x 11" SEF*1

A4 SEF*1

(8.5" x 11" SEF*2)

(B5 LEF)

1

0

0

1

5.5" x 8.5" SEF

A5 SEF

1

0

1

1

5.5" x 8.5" SEF

A5 SEF

0

0

1

1

5.5" x 8.5" SEF

A6 SEF

0

1

1

1

5.5" x 8.5" SEF

A6 SEF

1

1

1

1



*1: When the machine determines that the paper feed direction is "LEF", it considers
that the paper size is bracketed size.

D129/D130

5-188

SM

Main SP Tables-9

APS Original Size Detection

Original Size

Length Sensor

Width
Sensor

SP4-301
display

Metric version

Inch version

L3

L2

L1

W1

W2

A3

11" x 17"

O

O

O

O

O

00011111

B4

10" x 14"

O

O

O

O

X

00011110

8.5" x 14"

O

O

O

X

X

00011100

A4 LEF

8.5" x 11"

X

X

X

O

O

00000011

B5 LEF

-

X

X

X

O

X

00000010

A4 SEF

11" x 8.5"

X

O

O

X

X

00001100

B5 SEF

-

X

X

O

X

X

00000100

X

X

X

X

X

00000000

F4
8.5" x 13", 8.25" x
13", or 8" x 13"
SP 5126 controls the

A5 LEF/ SEF

SM

5.5" x 8.5",
8.5" x 5.5"

5-189

D129/D130

Service
Tables

size that is detected

Main SP Tables-9

3000/2000-Sheet (Booklet) Finisher (D636/D637)

Reading
6140

Bit Description
0

1

001 Entrance Sensor

No paper detected

Paper detected

002 Proof Exit Sensor

No paper detected

Paper detected

Not Full

Full

No paper

Paper

detected*1

detected*1

No paper detected

Paper detected

Not HP

HP

No paper detected

Paper detected

Not HP

HP

009 Lower Tray Height Sensor

No paper detected

Paper detected

010 Upper Tray Height Sensor

No paper detected

Paper detected

011 Upper Tray Full Sensor

Not Full

Full

012 Stack Roller HP Sensor

Not HP

HP

013 Jogger HP Sensor

Not HP

HP

HP

Not HP

No paper detected

Paper detected

016 Corner Stapler HP Sensor

Not HP

HP

017 Stapler Rotation HP Sensor

Not HP

HP

Not Limit

Limit

019 Door Switch

Closed

Open

020 Corner Stapler Operation

Not HP

HP

003 Proof Full Detection Sensor

004 Upper Tray Exit Sensor

005 Staple Exit Sensor
006 Shift Roller HP Sensor
007 Shift Exit Sensor
008 Exit Guide Plate HP Sensor

014 Feed Out Belt HP Sensor
015 Stapling Tray Paper Sensor

018 Upper Tray Limit SW

D129/D130

5-190

SM

Main SP Tables-9

Reading
Bit Description
0

1

021 Staple Detection

No staple detected

Staple detected

022 Staple Dip Detection

No staple detected

Staple detected

023 Punch Movement HP Sensor

Not HP

HP

024 Paper Position Slide HP Sensor

Not HP

HP

No paper detected

Paper detected

026 Punch Full Sensor

Not Full

Full

027 Punch HP Sensor

Not HP

HP

025 Paper Position Sensor

028 Punch DIP SW 1

See *1

029 Punch DIP SW 2

See *1

030 Stack Junction Gate HP Sensor

Not HP

HP

No paper detected

Paper detected

Not HP

HP

No paper detected

Paper detected

034 Bottom Fence HP Sensor

Not HP

HP

035 Fold Cam HP Sensor

Not HP

HP

036 Fold Plate HP Sensor

Not HP

HP

037 Fold Unit Exit Sensor

No paper detected

Paper detected

No paper

Paper

detected*2

detected*2

No paper

Paper

detected*2

detected*2

Not HP

HP

No staple detected

Staple detected

031 Stack Present Sensor
032 Clamp Roller HP Sensor
033 Fold Entrance Sensor

038 Lower Tray Full Sensor: Front

039 Lower Tray Full Sensor: Rear

040

Booklet Stapler 1: Operation
(Rotation/Front)

041 Booklet Stapler 1: Staple In (Front)

SM

5-191

D129/D130

Service
Tables

6140

Main SP Tables-9

Reading
6140

Bit Description

042

043

Booklet Stapler 1: Staple In
(Leading Edge/Front)
Booklet Stapler 1: Operation
(Rotation/Rear)

044 Booklet Stapler 1: Staple In (Rear)

045

Booklet Stapler 1: Staple In
(Leading Edge/Rear)

046 Upper Tray Full Sensor: 3000

0

1

No staple detected

Staple detected

Not HP

HP

No staple detected

Staple detected

No staple detected

Staple detected

Not Full

Full

*1: Combination of DIP SW 1 and SW 2

DIP SW 1

DIP SW 2

Punch Type

0

0

Japan

1

0

Europe

0

1

North America

1

1

North Europe

*2: Please refer to "Lower Tray (D637 Only)" in the Service Manual for the "3000/2000-Sheet
(Booklet) Finisher ".

D129/D130

5-192

SM

Main SP Tables-9

1000-Sheet Finisher (D588)

Reading
Bit

Description
0

001 Entrance Sensor

002

003

004

005

Paper detected

Shift Exit Sensor

No paper detected

(Lower Tray Exit Sensor)
Staple Entrance Sensor

Paper detected

(Stapler Tray Entrance Sensor)
Staple Moving HP Sensor
(Stapler HP Sensor)
Jogger HP Sensor
(Jogger Fence HP Sensor)

006 Stack Feed-out Belt HP Sensor
007 Staple Tray Paper Sensor

008

Staple Rotation Sensor
(Staple Rotation HP Sensor)

013

014

SM

Paper Sensor
(Stack Height Sensor)
Tray Lower Sensor
(Lower Tray Lower Limit Sensor)
5-193

No paper
detected

HP

HP

Not HP

No paper detected

Paper detected

Not HP

HP

Staple detected

012 Shift HP Sensor

Paper detected

Not HP

010 Staple READY Detection

(Exit Guide Plate HP Sensor)

detected

HP

Staple detected

Exit Guide Plate HP

No paper

Not HP

009 Staple Sensor

011

1

No staple
detected
No staple
detected

Not HP

HP

Not HP

HP

No output tray

Output tray

detected

detected

Lower limit

Not lower limit

D129/D130

Service
Tables

6139

Main SP Tables-9

Reading
6139

015

Bit

Description

Proof Full Sensor
(Paper Limit Sensor)

0

1

Not full

Full

5.11.2 OUTPUT CHECK TABLE
Copier

5804

Output Check
001 Exit Motor: 350
002 Exit Motor: 175
003 Exit Motor: 230
Paper exit motor (Mainframe)
004 Exit Motor: 180
005 Exit Motor: 154
006 Exit Motor: 90
007 Feed Motor: 300
008 Feed Motor: 255
009 Feed Motor: 230
Paper feed motor (Mainframe)

010 Feed Motor: 215
011 Feed Motor: 180
012 Feed Motor: 154
013 Feed Motor: 90
014 Bank: Feed Motor: 300

Paper feed motor (Optional paper

015 Bank: Feed Motor: 255

feed unit)

016 Bank: Feed Motor: 230

D129/D130

5-194

SM

Main SP Tables-9

5804

Output Check
017 Bank: Feed Motor: 215
018 Bank: Feed Motor: 180
019 Bank: Feed Motor: 154
020 Bank: Feed Motor: 90
021 LCT: Feed Motor: 300
022 LCT: Feed Motor: 255
023 LCT: Feed Motor: 230
Paper feed motor (Optional LCT)

024 LCT: Feed Motor: 215
025 LCT: Feed Motor: 180
026 LCT: Feed Motor: 154
027 LCT: Feed Motor: 90
028 Paper Feed Clutch 1

Paper feed clutch 1/2 (Mainframe)
Service
Tables

029 Paper Feed Clutch 2
030 Bank: Paper Feed Clutch 3

Paper feed clutch 3/4 (Optional

031 Bank: Paper Feed Clutch 4

paper feed unit)

032 LCT: Paper Feed Clutch

Paper feed clutch (Optional LCT)

033 Pick-up Solenoid 1
Pick-up Solenoid 1/2 (Mainframe)
034 Pick-up Solenoid 2
035 Bank: Pick-up Solenoid 3

Pick-up Solenoid 3/4 (Optional

036 Bank: Pick-up Solenoid 4

paper feed unit)

037 LCT: Pick-up Solenoid

Pick-up Solenoid (LCT)

038 Tray Lift Motor 1: Up
039 Tray Lift Motor 1: Down

-

040 Tray Lift Motor 2: Up

SM

5-195

D129/D130

Main SP Tables-9

5804

Output Check
041 Tray Lift Motor 2: Down
042 Paper Tray Lock Solenoid

Not used

043 Bank: Paper Tray Lock Solenoid

Tray lock solenoid (Optional paper
feed unit)

044 Registration Motor: 230
045 Registration Motor: 180
046 Registration Motor: 154
047 Registration Motor: 90
048 Exit: Junction Gate Solenoid

Junction gate 1 solenoid

049 Duplex: Inverter Gate Solenoid

Not used

050 Duplex Inverter Motor: Fwd: 230
051 Duplex Inverter Motor: Fwd: 180
052 Duplex Inverter Motor: Fwd: 154
053 Duplex Inverter Motor: Fwd: 90
054 Duplex Inverter Motor: Rev: 230
055 Duplex Inverter Motor: Rev: 180
056 Duplex Inverter Motor: Rev: 154
057 Duplex Inverter Motor: Rev: 90
058 Duplex/By-pass Motor: Fwd: 230
059 Duplex/By-pass Motor: Fwd: 180
060 Duplex/By-pass Motor: Fwd: 154
061 Duplex/By-pass Motor: Fwd: 90
062 Duplex/By-pass Motor: Rev: 230
063 Duplex/By-pass Motor: Rev: 180

D129/D130

5-196

SM

Main SP Tables-9

5804

Output Check
064 Duplex/By-pass Motor: Rev: 154
065 Duplex/By-pass Motor: Rev: 90
066 By-pass Feed Clutch

-

067 By-pass Pick-up Solenoid

-

068 Bridge/Exit Tray: Drive Motor: 230
069 Bridge/Exit Tray: Drive Motor: 180
Drive motor (Bridge unit)
070 Bridge/Exit Tray: Drive Motor: 154
071 Bridge/Exit Tray: Drive Motor: 90
Bridge/Exit Tray: Junction Gate

Junction Gate Solenoid (Bridge

Solenoid

unit)

073 Bridge/Exit Tray: Drive Motor: Reset

-

074 Bridge/Exit Tray: Drive Motor: Enable

-

075 Bridge: Cooling Fan Motor

Not used

076 Transfer Belt Contact Motor

-

Service
Tables

072

077 OPC Motor: 230
078 OPC Motor: 180
Drum motor
079 OPC Motor: 154
080 OPC Motor: 90
081 Transfer/Development Motor: 230
082 Transfer/Development Motor: 180
083 Transfer/Development Motor: 154
084 Transfer/Development Motor: 90
085 Fusing Motor: 230
086 Fusing Motor: 180

SM

5-197

D129/D130

Main SP Tables-9

5804

Output Check
087 Fusing Motor: 154
088 Fusing Motor: 90
089 Development Paddle Motor

-

090 PTL Control

-

091 Fusing Fan Motor: High
Fusing exhaust fan motor
092 Fusing Fan Motor: Low
093 Exhaust Fan Motor: High
Exhaust fan motor
094 Exhaust Fan Motor: Low
095 Duct Fan Motor

Cooling fan motor

096 Exit Fan Motor: High
Paper exit cooling fan motor
097 Exit Fan Motor: Low
098 PSU Fan Motor

Junction gate 2 solenoid (1-bin

099 1-Bin Junction Gate Solenoid

unit)

100 Polygon Motor: 230
101 Polygon Motor: 180
102 Polygon Motor: 154
103 Polygon Motor: 90
104 LD 1
105 LD 2
106 Toner Bottle Motor: Fwd

Toner supply motor

107 Quenching Lamp

-

108 Charge Bias

-

109 Development Bias

-

D129/D130

5-198

SM

Main SP Tables-9

5804

Output Check
110 Transfer Belt Voltage

-

111 ID Sensor LED

-

115 Cleaning Web Motor

Web motor

116 Shift Tray Motor

Not used

117 CTL Cooling FAN

Controller fan

202 Scanner Lamp

-

1000-Sheet Finisher (D588)

Output Check
6144

SM

Description

001 Upper Relay Motor

Upper Transport Motor

002 Lower Relay Motor

Lower Transport Motor

003 Exit Motor

-

004 Proof Junction Gate SOL

Tray Junction Gate Solenoid

005 Lower Tray Lift Motor

-

006 Jogger Fence Motor

-

007 Stapler Motor

-

008 Stapler Hammer

-

009 Stapler Junction Gate Solenoid

-

010 Positioning Roller Solenoid

-

011 Stack Feed-out Motor

-

012 Shift Motor

-

013 Exit Guide Plate Motor

-

5-199

Service
Tables

Display

D129/D130

Main SP Tables-9

3000 /2000-Sheet (Booklet) Finisher (D636/D637)

Output
6145
Display

Description

001 Entrance Motor

-

002 Upper Transport Motor

-

003 Lower Transport Motor

-

004 Upper/Proof Tray Exit Motor

-

005 Clamp Roller Retraction Motor

-

006 Shift Roller Motor

-

007 Exit Guide Plate Motor

-

008 Upper Tray Lift Motor

-

009 Stacking Sponge Roller Motor

-

010 Jogger Fence Motor

-

011 Feed Out Belt Motor

-

012 Corner Stapler Movement Motor

-

013 Corner Stapler Rotation Motor

-

014 Corner Stapler

-

015 Proof Junction Gate Solenoid

-

016 Stapling Tray Junction Gate Solenoid

-

017

Stapling Edge Pressure Plate

-

Solenoid

018 Positioning Roller Solenoid

-

019 Booklet Pressure Roller Solenoid

-

020 Stack Junction Gate Motor

-

021 Fold Unit Bottom Fence Lift Motor

-

D129/D130

5-200

SM

Main SP Tables-9

-

023 Booklet Stapler: Rear

-

024 Fold Plate Motor

-

025 Fold Roller Motor

-

026 Positioning Roller Motor

-

027 Punch Drive Motor

-

028 Punch Movement Motor

-

029 Paper Position Sensor Slide Motor

-

Service
Tables

022 Booklet Stapler: Front

SM

5-201

D129/D130

Main SP Tables-9

5.11.3 PRINTER SERVICE TABLES
SP1-XXX (Service Mode)

1001

Bit Switch

001 Bit Switch 1

0

1

bit 0

DFU

-

-

bit 1

DFU

-

-

bit 2

DFU

-

-

bit 3

No I/O Timeout

0: Disable

1: Enable

Enable: The MFP I/O Timeout setting will have no effect. I/O Timeouts will
never occur.
bit 4

SD Card Save Mode

0: Disable

1: Enable

Enable: Print jobs will be saved to an SD Card in the GW SD slot.
bit 5

DFU

-

-

bit 6

DFU

-

-

bit 7

[RPCS,PCL]: Printable area frame border

0: Disable

1: Enable

Enable: The machine prints all RPCS and PCL jobs with a border on the
edges of the printable area.

1001

Bit Switch

002 Bit Switch 2

0

1

bit 0

DFU

-

-

bit 1

DFU

-

-

bit 2

Applying a collation Type

Shift

Normal

Collate

Collate

D129/D130

5-202

SM

Main SP Tables-9

A collation type (shift or normal) will be applied to all jobs that do not
already have a ‘Collate Type’ configured.

bit 3

If #5-0 is enabled, this Bit Switch has no effect.

[PCL5e/c,PS]: PDL Auto Switching

0: Enable

1: Disable

Disable: The MFPs ability to change the PDL processor mid-job.
Some host systems submit jobs that contain both PS and PCL5e/c. If Auto
PDL switching is disabled, these jobs will not be printed properly.
DFU

-

-

bit 5

DFU

-

-

bit 6

DFU

-

-

bit 7

DFU

-

-

0

1

Bit Switch

003 Bit Switch 3
bit 0

DFU

-

-

bit 1

DFU

-

-

bit 2

[PCL5e/c]: Legacy HP compatibility

0: Disable

1: Enable

Service
Tables

1001

bit 4

Enable: Uses the same left margin as older HP models such as
HP4000/HP8000.
In other words, the left margin defined in the job (usually "*r0A")
will be changed to "*r1A"

SM

bit 3

DFU

-

-

bit 4

DFU

-

-

bit 5

DFU

-

-

bit 6

DFU

-

-

bit 7

DFU

-

-

5-203

D129/D130

Main SP Tables-9

1001

Bit Switch

004 Bit Switch 4

0

1

bit 0

DFU

-

-

bit 1

DFU

-

-

bit 2

DFU

-

-

bit 3

IPDS print-side reversal

0: Disable

1: Enable

Enable: Increases printing speed but simplex pages may be printed on the
back side of the sheet.
bit 4

DFU

-

-

bit 5

DFU

-

-

bit 6

DFU

-

-

bit 7

DFU

-

-

D129/D130

5-204

SM

Main SP Tables-9

1001

Bit Switch

005 Bit Switch 5

0

1

Disable

Enable

Show "Collate Type", "Staple Type" and
"Punch Type" buttons on the operation
panel.
bit 0

If enabled, users will be able to configure a Collate Type, Staple Type, and
Punch Type from the operation panel. The available types will depend on
the device and configured options.
After enabling the function, the settings will appear under:
"User Tools > Printer Features > System"

bit 1

Multiple copies if a paper size or type
mismatch occurs

0: Disable
(Single
copy)

1: Enable
(Multiple copy)

If a paper size or type mismatch occurs during the printing of multiple
copies, only a single copy is output by default. Using this Bit Switch, the
device can be configured to print all copies even if a paper mismatch

bit 2

DFU

bit 3

[PS] PS Criteria

Service
Tables

occurs.
-

-

Pattern3

Pattern1

Change the number of PS criterion used by the PS interpreter to
determine whether a job is PS data or not.
Pattern3: includes most PS commands.
Pattern1: A small number of PS tags and headers
bit 4

Increase max number of the stored jobs
to 1000 jobs.

Disable

Enable (1000)

(100)

Enable: Changes the maximum number of jobs that can be stored on the
HDD via Job Type settings to 1000. The default is 100.
bit 5

DFU

bit 6

Method for determining the image
rotation for the edge to bind on.

SM

5-205

-

-

0: Disable

1: Enable

D129/D130

Main SP Tables-9

If enabled, the image rotation will be performed as they were in the
specifications of older models for the binding of pages of mixed orientation
jobs.
The old models are below:
- PCL: Pre-04A models
- PS/PDF/RPCS:Pre-05S models
bit 7

Letterhead mode printing

0: Disable

1: Enable
(Duplex)

Routes all pages through the duplex unit.
If this is disabled, simplex pages or the last page of an odd-paged duplex
job are not routed through the duplex unit. This could result in problems
with letterhead/pre-printed pages.
Only affects pages specified as Letterhead paper.

1001

Bit Switch

006 Bit Switch 6 DFU

1001

-

-

0

1

0: Disable

1: Enable

Bit Switch

007 Bit Switch 7
Print path

If enabled, simplex pages (in mixed simplex/duplex PS/PCL5 jobs only)
bit 0

and the last page of an odd paged duplex job (PS, PCL5, PCL6), are
always routed through the duplex unit. Not having to switch paper paths
increases the print speed slightly.

bit 1
to 7

1001

DFU

-

-

-

-

Bit Switch

008 Bit Switch 8 DFU

D129/D130

5-206

SM

Main SP Tables-9

1001

Bit Switch

009 Bit Switch 9
PDL Auto Detection timeout of jobs
submitted via USB or Parallel Port (IEEE
1284).

0

1

"Disabled

"Enabled

(Immediately)"

(10 seconds)"

bit 0
To be used if PDL auto-detection fails. A failure of PDL autodetection doesn't
necessarily mean that the job can't be printed. This bit switch tells the device
whether to time-out immediately (default) upon failure or to wait 10 seconds.
bit 1

DFU

bit 2

Job Cancel

-

-

Disabled
(Not
cancelled)

Enabled
(Cancelled)

If this bit switch, all jobs will be cancelled after a jam occurs.
Note: If this bitsw is enabled, printing under the following conditions might
result in problems:
- Spool printing (WIM >Configuration > Device Settings > System)
bit 3

PCL/PS bypass tray paper rotation
(SEF/LEF)

0: Disable

1: Enable

This bitsw causes the device to revert to the behavior of previous
generations. It only takes effect if "Bypass Tray Setting Priority" =
"Driver/Command".
Previous spec (bitsw=1): If a standard sized paper mismatch occurred in the
bypass tray, the MFP always prompted for SEF paper.
If this bitsw=0 (default) then in the event of a standard sized paper mismatch,
the MFP will always prompt for paper of the rotation (SEF/LEF) determined by
the MFP bypass tray paper setting or by the bypass tray sensor.
bit 4

Response to PJL USTATUS when
multiple collated copies are printed

SM

5-207

0: Disable

1: Enable

D129/D130

Service
Tables

- Job submission via USB or Parallel Port

Main SP Tables-9

When enabled, if multiple collated copies are printed, the device no longer
responds to PJL USTATUS with the number of pages in the current copy.
Instead the device will return the total number of pages for all copies.
Bit 5

DFU

-

to 7

1001

-

Bit Switch

010 Bit Switch 10
bit 0
to 4
bit 5

DFU

List / Test Print Lock

0

1

-

-

0: Disable

1: Enable

If enabled, you can lock or unlock the [List/Test Print] items under the
Pinter Features menu when the Store and Skip Errored Job Function is
on.
Bit 6

Optional charge machines

-

-

0: Disable

1: Enable

-

-

0

1

0: Disable

1: Enable

If enabled, you can use the optional charge
machines when the Store and Skip Errored
Job Function is on.
Bit 7

1001

DFU

Bit Switch

011 Bit Switch 11
bit 0

List / Test Print menu

When enabled, [Multiple Lists] menu is displayed in [List / Test Print] under
the Printer Features menu.
bit 1

D129/D130

Interrupt printing

0: Job

5-208

1: Page

SM

Main SP Tables-9

Selects the interrupt unit for the interrupt printing function.
When you select "0," you can interrupt the printing of a job while being
processed.
When you select "1," you can interrupt the printing of a page while being
processed.
Bit 2

DFU

to 7

1001

-

-

0

1

-

-

Bit Switch

012 Bit Switch 12
bit 0
to 7

1003

DFU

[Clear Setting]
Initialize Printer System

1003 001
Initializes settings in the "System" menu of the user mode.

1004

Service
Tables

1003 003 Delete Program

[Print Summary]
Print Printer Summary

1004 001
Prints the service summary sheet (a summary of all the controller settings).

1006

[Sample/Locked Print]

*CTL

0: Linked, 1: On

Enables and disables the document server. When you select "0," the
1006 001

document server is enabled or disabled in accordance with Copy Service
Mode SP5-967. When you select "1," the document server is enabled
regardless of Copy Service Mode SP5-967.

SM

5-209

D129/D130

Main SP Tables-9

5.11.4 SCANNER SERVICE TABLES
SP1-xxx (System and Others)

[Erase margin (Remote Scan)]
1005

Creates an erase margin for all edges of the scanned image.
If the machine has scanned the edge of the original, create a margin. This
SP is activated only when the machine uses TWAIN scanning.

1005 1 Range from 0 to 5 mm

1009

[Remote scan disable]

*CTL

*CTL

[0 to 5 / 0 / 1 mm/step ]

[0 or 1 / 0 / - ]
0: enable, 1: disable

1009 1 Enable or disable remote scan.

1010

[Non Display Clear Light
PDF]

*CTL

[0 or 1 / 0 / - ]
0: Display, 1: Non display

1010 1 Enable or disable remote scan.

D129/D130

5-210

SM

Main SP Tables-9

SP2-XXX (Scanning-image quality)

[Compression Level (Gray-scale)]
2021

Selects the compression ratio for grayscale processing mode (JPEG) for the
three settings that can be selected at the operation panel.

2021 1 Comp1: 5-95

[5 to 95 / 20 / 1 /step ]

2021 2 Comp2: 5-95

[5 to 95 / 40 / 1 /step ]

2021 3 Comp3: 5-95

*CTL

[5 to 95 / 65 / 1 /step ]

2021 4 Comp4: 5-95

[5 to 95 / 80 / 1 /step ]

2021 5 Comp5: 5-95

[5 to 95 / 95 / 1 /step ]

[Compression ratio of ClearLight PDF]
2024

Selects the compression ratio for clearlight PDF for the two settings that can
be selected at the operation panel.

2024 2

SM

Compression Ratio (High

[5 to 95 / 25 / 1 /step ]
Service
Tables

2024 1 Compression Ratio (Normal)
*CTL

[5 to 95 / 20 / 1 /step ]

comp image)

5-211

D129/D130

Updating the Firmware

5.12 UPDATING THE FIRMWARE
To update the firmware for this machine, you must have the new version of the firmware
downloaded onto an SD (Secure Digital) Card. The SD Card is inserted into SD Card Slot 2
(Lower Slot) on the controller box.

5.12.1 BEFORE YOU BEGIN
An SD card is a precision device. Always observe the following precautions when you handle
SD cards:


Always switch the machine off before you insert an SD card. Never insert the SD card into
the slot with the power on.



Do not remove the SD card from the service slot after the power has been switched on.



Never switch the machine off while the firmware is downloading from the SD card.



Keep SD cards in a safe location where they are not exposed to high temperature, high
humidity, or exposure to direct sunlight.



Always handle SD cards with care. Do not bend or scratch them. Do not let the SD card get
exposed to shock or vibration.



Make sure that the write protection of an SD card is unlocked when you download an
application to it. If not, downloading fails and a download error (e.g. Error Code 44) occurs
during a firmware upgrade.

Keep the following points in mind when you use the firmware update software:


"Upload" means to send data from the machine to the SD card. "Download" means to
send data from the SD card to the machine.



To select an item on the LCD, touch the appropriate button on the soft touch-screen of the
LCD, or, press the appropriate number key on the 10-key pad of the operation panel. For
example, when "Exit (0)" shows on the screen you can touch the Exit button on the screen,
or, press the "0" button on the operation panel of the copier.



Make sure that the machine is disconnected from the network to prevent a print job for
arriving while the firmware update is in progress before you start the firmware update
procedure.

D129/D130

5-212

SM

Updating the Firmware

5.12.2 UPDATING FIRMWARE
Preparation
1.

If the SD card is blank, copy the entire "romdata" folder onto the SD card.

2.

If the card already contains the "romdata" folder, copy the "D129" folder onto the card.

Updating Procedure
1.

Turn the main power switch off.

2.

Remove the controller cover (

3.

Insert the SD card into SD Card Slot 2 (Lower Slot) [A]. Make sure the label on the SD card

Service
Tables

x 2).

faces the rear side of the machine.
4.

Slowly push the SD card into the slot so it locks in place. You will hear it click. Make sure
the SD card locks in place.

SM

5-213

D129/D130

Updating the Firmware



To remove the SD, push it in to unlock the spring lock. Then release it so it pops
out of the slot.

5.

Disconnect the network cable from the copier if the machine is connected to a network.

6.

Switch the main power switch on. After about 45 seconds, the initial version update screen
appears on the LCD in English.

7.

On the screen, touch the button or press the corresponding number key on the operation
panel to select the item in the menu that you want to update.

ROM/NEW

What it means
Tells you the number of the module and name of the version

ROM:

currently installed. The first line is the module number, the second
line the version name.
Tells you the number of the module and name version on the SD

NEW:

card. The first line is the module number, the second line the
version name.



Controller, engine and operation panel firmware cannot be updated at the same
time. It is recommended to update firmware modules one by one.

8.

Touch "UpDate (#)" (or


) to start the update.

While downloading is in progress, the LCD will display "Loading". When
downloading has been completed, the panel will display "update done".



For operation panel software, the Start key lights red while downloading is in
progress, and then lights green again after downloading is completed.

9.

The "Update is Done" message appears on the operation panel after completing the
updating. The message differs depending on the firmware that has been updated.

10. Switch the copier main power switch off when you see the "Update is Done" message or
follow the procedure that is displayed on the operation panel.
11. Press in the SD card to release it. Then remove it from the slot.
12. Switch the copier on for normal operation.

D129/D130

5-214

SM

Updating the Firmware

Error Messages
An error message shows in the first line if an error occurs during the download.
The error code consists of the letter "E" and a number. The example above shows error "E24"
displayed. For details, refer to the Error Message Table. (

"Handling Firmware Update

Errors" in this section)

Firmware Update Error
If a firmware update error occurs, this means the update was cancelled during the update

Service
Tables

because the module selected for update was not on the SD card.

Recovery after Power Loss
If the ROM update is interrupted as a result of accidental loss of power while the firmware is
updating, then the correct operation of the machine cannot be guaranteed after the machine is
switched on again. If the ROM update does not complete successfully for any reason, then in
order to ensure the correct operation of the machine, the ROM update error will continue to
show until the ROM is updated successfully.
In this case, insert the card again and switch on the machine to continue the firmware download
automatically from the card without the menu display.

SM

5-215

D129/D130

Updating the Firmware

5.12.3 HANDLING FIRMWARE UPDATE ERRORS
An error message shows in the first line if an error occurs during a download. The error code
consists of the letter "E" and a number ("E20", for example).

Error Message Table

Code

Meaning

Solution
Make sure the SD card is installed correctly, or

20

Cannot map logical address

21

Cannot access memory

HDD connection incorrect or replace HDD.

Cannot decompress

Incorrect ROM data on the SD card, or data is

compressed data

damaged.

Error occurred when ROM

Controller program defective. If the second

update program started

attempt fails, replace controller board.

22

23

24

30

31

32

33

34

SD card access error

No HDD available for stamp
data download

Data incorrect for continuous
download

Data incorrect after download
interrupted

Incorrect SD card version

use a different SD card.

Make sure the SD card is inserted correctly, or
use a different SD card.

HDD connection incorrect or replace HDD.

Insert the SD card with the remaining data
required for the download, the re-start the
procedure.
Execute the recovery procedure for the intended
module download, then repeat the installation
procedure.
Incorrect ROM data on the SD card, or data is
corrupted.

Module mismatch - Correct

SD update data is incorrect. Acquire the correct

module is not on the SD

data (Japan, Overseas, OEM, etc.) then install

card)

again.

D129/D130

5-216

SM

Updating the Firmware

35

36

40

42

43

44

50

SM

Meaning

Solution

Module mismatch – Module

SD update data is incorrect. The data on the SD

on SD card is not for this

card is for another machine. Acquire correct

machine

update data then install again.

Cannot write module –
Cause other than E34, E35

Engine module download
failed

SD update data is incorrect. The data on the SD
card is for another machine. Acquire correct
update data then install again.
Replace the update data for the module on the
SD card and try again, or replace the BCU
board.

Operation panel module

Replace the update data for the module on the

download failed

SD card and try again, or replace the LCDC.

Stamp data module

Replace the update data for the module on the

download failed

SD card and try again, or replace the hard disks.

Controller module download
failed

Electronic confirmation check
failed

Replace the update data for the module on the
SD card and tray again, or replace controller
board.
SD update data is incorrect. The data on the SD
card is for another machine. Acquire correct
update data then install again.

5-217

D129/D130

Service
Tables

Code

Uploading/Downloading NVRAM Data

5.13 UPLOADING/DOWNLOADING NVRAM DATA
The content of the NVRAM can be uploaded to and downloaded from an SD card.

5.13.1 UPLOADING NVRAM DATA (SP5-824)
1.

Turn off the main switch.

2.

Remove the controller cover [A] (

3.

Insert the SD card into SD card slot 2 (Lower Slot) [A].

4.

Turn on the main switch.

5.

Execute SP5-824.

6.

Press "1" to start uploading the NVRAM data.

D129/D130

x 2).

5-218

SM

Uploading/Downloading NVRAM Data

5.13.2 DOWNLOADING NVRAM DATA (SP5-825)
The following data are not downloaded from the SD card:


Total counter



C/O, P/O Counter



Duplex, A3/DLT/Over 420 mm, Staple and Scanner application scanning counters (system
settings).



Engine SP data

1.

Turn off the main switch.

2.

Remove the controller cover [A] (

3.

Plug the SD card into SD card slot 2 (Lower Slot) [A].

4.

Turn on the main switch.

5.

Execute SP5-825.

6.

Press "1" to start downloading the NVRAM data.

Service
Tables

x 2).

SM

5-219

D129/D130

Uploading/Downloading NVRAM Data

Note that the following errors could occur during downloading:


If a card is not installed in the card slot and a message tells you that downloading cannot
proceed, you cannot execute downloading, even by pressing "1".



If the correct card for the NVRAM data is not inserted in the card slot, after you press "1" a
message will tell you that downloading cannot proceed because the card is abnormal and
the execution will halt.

D129/D130

5-220

SM

Self-Diagnostic Mode

5.14 SELF-DIAGNOSTIC MODE
5.14.1 SELF-DIAGNOSTIC MODE AT POWER ON
As soon as the main machine is powered on, the controller waits for the initial settings of the
copy engine to take effect and then starts an independent self-diagnostic test program. The
self-diagnostic test follows the path of the flow chart shown below and checks the CPU, memory,
HDD, and so on. An SC code is displayed in the touch panel if the self-diagnostic program

Service
Tables

detects any malfunction or abnormal condition.

SM

5-221

D129/D130

Self-Diagnostic Mode

5.14.2 SELF-DIAGNOSTIC TEST FLOW

D129/D130

5-222

SM

Self-Diagnostic Mode

5.14.3 DETAILED SELF-DIAGNOSTIC MODE
In addition to the self-diagnostic test initiated every time the main machine is powered on, you
can set the machine in a more detailed diagnostic mode manually in order to test other
components or conditions that are not tested during self-diagnosis after power on. The following
device is required in order to put the machine in the detailed self-diagnosis mode.

No.

Name

G02119350

Parallel Loopback Connector

5.14.4 EXECUTING DETAILED SELF-DIAGNOSIS
Follow this procedure to execute detailed self-diagnosis.
1.

Switch off the machine, and connect the parallel loopback device to the Centronics I/F port.

2.

Hold down

, press and hold down

, and then while pressing both keys at the same

time, switch on the machine.
You will see "Now Loading" on the touch-panel, and then you will see the results of the test.
A report is printed every time a detailed self-diagnostic test is executed, whether errors

Service
Tables

were detected or not.

SM

5-223

D129/D130

Using the Debug Log

5.15 USING THE DEBUG LOG
5.15.1 OVERVIEW
This machine provides a Save Debug Log feature that allows the Customer Engineer to save
and retrieve error information for analysis.
Every time an error occurs, debug information is recorded in volatile memory but this
information is lost when the machine is switched off and on.
To capture this debug information, the Save Debug Log feature provides two main features:


Switching on the debug feature so error information is saved directly to the HDD for later
retrieval.



Copying the error information from the HDD to an SD card.

When a user is experiencing problems with the machine, follow the procedure below to set up
the machine so the error information is saved automatically to the HDD. Then ask the user to
reproduce the problem.

5.15.2 SWITCHING ON AND SETTING UP SAVE DEBUG LOG
The debug information cannot be saved the until the "Save Debug Log" function has been
switched on and a target has been selected.
1.

Enter the SP mode.

2.

Under "5857 Save Debug Log", press "1".

3.

On the control panel keypad, press "1" then press

. This switches the Save Debug Log

feature on.


The default setting is "0" (OFF). This feature must be switched on in order for the
debug information to be saved.

4.

Next, select the target destination where the debug information will be saved. Under "5857
Save Debug Log", touch "2 Target", enter "2" with the operation panel key to select the hard
disk as the target destination, then press

D129/D130

.

5-224

SM

Using the Debug Log



Select "3 SD Card" to save the debug information directly to the SD card if it is
inserted in Slot 2 (Lower Slot).

5.

Now touch "5858" and specify the events that you want to record in the debug log. SP5858
(Debug Save When) provides the following items for selection.

1

Engine SC Error

2

Controller SC Error

3

Any SC Error

4

Jam



Saves data when an engine-related SC code is
generated.
Saves debug data when a controller-related SC Code
is generated.
Saves data only for the SC code that you specify by

Service
Tables

entering code number.
Saves data for jams.

More than one event can be selected.

Example 1: To Select Items 1, 2, 4
Touch the appropriate items(s). Press "ON" for each selection. This example shows
"Engine SC Error" selected.

Example 2: To Specify an SC Code
Touch "3 Any SC Error", enter the 3-digit SC code number with the control panel number
keys, then press
SM

. This example shows an entry for SC670.
5-225

D129/D130

Using the Debug Log



For details about SC code numbers, please refer to the SC tables in Section "4.
Troubleshooting"

6.

Next, select the one or more memory modules for reading and recording debug information.
Touch "5859".
Under "5859" press the appropriate key item for the module that you want to record.
Enter the appropriate 4-digit number, then press


.

Refer to the two tables below for the 4-digit numbers to enter for each key.

The example below shows "Key 1" with "2222" entered.

The following keys can be set with the corresponding numbers. (The initials in parentheses
indicate the names of the modules.)

4-Digit Entries for Keys 1 to 10

Key No.

Copy

1

2222 (SCS)

2

2223 (SRM)

3

256 (IMH)

4

1000 (ECS)

5

1025 (MCS)

D129/D130

Printer

5-226

Scanner

Web

SM

Using the Debug Log

6

4848(COPY)

4400 (GPS)

5375 (Scan)

5682 (NFA)

7

2224 (BCU)

4500 (PDL)

5682 (NFA)

6600 (WebDB)

3000 (NCS)

3300 (PTS)

2000 (NCS)

6666 (WebSys)

4600

8

(GPS-PM)

9

2000 (NCS)

10

2224 (BCU)



2000 (NCS)

The default settings for Keys 1 to 10 are all zero ("0").

Acronym

Meaning

Acronym

Meaning

ECS

Engine Control Service

NFA

Net File Application

GPS

GW Print Service

PDL

Printer Design Language

PTS

Print Server

System Control Service

GSP-PM

GW Print Service – Print
Module

IMH

Image Memory Handler

SCS

MCS

Memory Control Service

SRM

NCS

Network Control Service

WebDB

System Resource
Management
Web Document Box
(Document Server)

The machine is now set to record the debugging information automatically on the HDD (the
target selected with SP5-857-002) for the events that you selected SP5-858and the memory
modules selected with SP5-859.
Please keep the following important points in mind when you are doing this setting:


Note that the number entries for Keys 1 to 5 are the same for the Copy, Printer, Scanner,
and Web memory modules.



The initial settings are all zero.



These settings remain in effect until you change them. Be sure to check all the settings,
especially the settings for Keys 6 to 10. To switch off a key setting, enter a zero for that key.

SM

5-227

D129/D130

Service
Tables

Key to Acronyms

Using the Debug Log



You can select any number of keys from 1 to 10 (or all) by entering the corresponding
4-digit numbers from the table.



You cannot mix settings for the groups (COPY, PRINTER, etc.) for 006to010. For example,
if you want to create a PRINTER debug log you must select the settings from the 9
available selections for the "PRINTER" column only.



One area of the disk is reserved to store the debug log. The size of this area is limited to 4
MB.

Retrieving the Debug Log from the HDD
1.

Insert the SD card into Slot 2 (Lower Slot).

2.

Enter the SP mode and execute SP5857 009 (Copy HDD to SD Card (Latest 4 MB) to write
the debugging data to the SD card.


The SD card can hold up to 4MB of data. If the debugging data is larger than 4MB,
you can switch to another SD card.

3.

Use a card reader to copy the file and send it for analysis to your local Ricoh representative
by email, or just send the SD card by mail.

Recording Errors Manually
Since only SC errors and jams are recorded to the debug log automatically, for any other errors
that occur while the customer engineer is not on site, please instruct customers to perform the
following immediately after occurrence to save the debug data. Such problems would include a
controller or panel freeze.


In order to use this feature, the customer engineer must have previously switched on
the Save Debug Feature (SP5857-001) and selected the hard disk as the save
destination (SP5857-002).

1.

When the error occurs, on the operation panel, press

2.

On the control panel, enter "01" then hold down

(Reset Key).
for at least 3 sec. until the machine

beeps then release. This saves the debug log to the hard disk for later retrieval with an SD
card by the service representatives.
3.

Switch the machine off and on to resume operation.
The debug information for the error is saved on the hard disk so the service representatives
can retrieve it on their next visit by copying it from the HDD to an SD card.

D129/D130

5-228

SM

TROUBLESHOOTING
R E V I S I O N H I S T O RY
Pag e

Date

Ad d ed / Upd ated / New
None

Service Call Conditions

6. TROUBLESHOOTING
6.1 SERVICE CALL CONDITIONS
6.1.1 SUMMARY
There are 4 levels of service call conditions.

Level

A

Definition

Reset Procedure

To prevent damage to the machine, the main

Enter SP mode, use SP

machine cannot be operated until the SC has

5810, touch [Execute], and

been reset by a service representative (see the

then turn the main power

note below).

switch off and on.

SCs that disable only the features that use the
defective item. Although these SCs are not shown
B

to the user under normal conditions, they are
displayed on the operation panel only when the

Turn the operation switch or
main switch off and on.

defective feature is selected.

D

operated as usual.

The SC will not be displayed.
Only the SC history is
updated.

Turning the main switch off then on resets SCs

Turn the operation switch off

displayed on the operation panel. These are

and on.

re-displayed if the error occurs again.

Also see below.

Troubleshooting

C

The SC history is updated. The machine can be

When a Level "D" SC code occurs
When a Level D SC occurs, a screen opens on the operation panel to tell the operator:


An error occurred



The job in progress will be erased



The machine will reboot automatically after approximately 30 seconds.

The operator can wait until the machine reboots automatically or touch "Reset" on the screen to
reset the machine immediately and go back to the copy screen.

SM

6-1

D129/D130

Service Call Conditions

If the operator does not touch "Reset"
The next message tells the operator that the machine will reset automatically and that the
previous job was lost and must be started again. After reading the message, the operator
touches "Confirm" on the screen. The next screen shows the number and title of the SC code,
and stops until the operator turns the machine off and on.
If the operator touches "Reset"
If the operator touches "Reset" to bypass the 30-second interval for the machine to reboot, the
machine reboots immediately and the operation panel displays the copy screen.


Do not try to use the operation panel during an automatic reboot.



If the Remote Service System is in use, the SC code is sent immediately to the Service
Center.

6.1.2 SC CODE DESCRIPTIONS


If a problem concerns a circuit board, disconnect and reconnect the connectors and
then test the machine. Often a loose or disconnected harness is the cause of the
problem. Always do this before you decide to replace the PCB.



If a motor lock error occurs, check the mechanical load before you decide to replace
the motor or sensors.



When a Level "A" or "B" SC occurs while in an SP mode, the machine cannot display
the SC number. If this occurs, check the SC number after leaving the SP mode.



The machine reboots automatically when the machine issues a Level "D" SC code.
This is done for Level "D" SC codes only.



Never turn off the main power switch when the power LED is lit or flashing. To avoid
damaging the hard disk or memory, press the operation switch to switch the power off,
wait for the power LED to go off, and then switch the main power switch off.



The main power LED lights or flashes while the platen cover or ARDF is open, while
the main machine is communicating with a facsimile or the network server, or while the
machine is accessing the hard disk or memory for reading or writing data.

D129/D130

6-2

SM

Service Call Conditions

SC Tables: SC1xx

Exposure lamp error
-001: Shading at AGC
-002: Shading at scanning


The standard white level was not detected properly when scanning the
white plate

101

D



Exposure lamp defective



Lamp stabilizer defective



Exposure lamp connector defective



Standard white plate dirty



Scanner mirror or scanner lens out of position or dirty



SBU defective



BCU defective

The peak white level is less than 64/255 digits (8 bits) when scanning the
shading plate. (The shading data peak does not reach the specified
threshold)

Scanner home position error 1
Troubleshooting

The scanner home position sensor does not detect the "OFF" condition
during initialization or copying.

120

D



SIB (B/W), SIB (Color) or scanner drive motor defective



Scanner motor defective



Harness between SIB and scanner drive motor disconnected



Harness between SIB and scanner drive motor power source
disconnected

SM



Scanner HP sensor defective



Harness between SIB and HP sensor disconnected



Scanner wire, timing belt, pulley, or carriage defective



BCU defective

6-3

D129/D130

Service Call Conditions

Scanner home position error 2
The scanner home position sensor does not detect the "ON" condition during
initialization or copying.

121

D



SIB (B/W), SIB (Color) or scanner motor drive board defective



Scanner motor defective



Harness between SIB and scanner drive motor disconnected



Harness between SIB and scanner drive motor power source
disconnected



Scanner HP sensor defective



Harness between SIB and scanner HP sensor disconnected



Scanner wire, timing belt, pulley, or carriage defective



BCU defective

Black level detection error
The black level cannot be adjusted within the target value during the zero
141

D

clamp.


Defective SBU



BCU defective

White level detection error
The white level cannot be adjusted within the target during auto gain control.
142

D

D129/D130



Dirty exposure glass or optics section



SBU board defective



Exposure lamp defective



Lamp stabilizer defective



BCU defective

6-4

SM

Service Call Conditions

SBU connection error
The SBU connection cannot be detected at power on or recovery from the
144

D

energy save mode.


Defective SBU



Defective harness



Defective detection port on the BCU

IPU error

161

D

The error result of self-diagnostic by the ASIC on the IPU is detected.


Defective IPU



Defective connection between IPU and SBU

IPU PCIE Communication error
The link up interrupt did not proceed from the LYRA when the main switch
162

D

was turned on or when recovering from the energy saver mode.


Defective IPU



Defective BCU

The copy data security board is not detected when the copy data security
function is set "ON" with the initial setting.
165

D

A device check error occurs when the copy data security function is set to
"ON" with the initial setting.

SM



Incorrect installation of the copy data security board



Defective copy data security board

6-5

D129/D130

Troubleshooting

Copy Data Security Unit error

Service Call Conditions

SC Tables: SC2xx

Polygon motor error 1: ON timeout
202

D

The polygon mirror motor does not reach the targeted operating speed within
10 sec. after turning on or changing speed
Polygon motor error 2: OFF timeout

203

D

The polygon mirror motor does not leave the READY status within 3 sec.
after the polygon motor switched off.
Polygon motor error 3: XSCRDY signal error
The SCRDY_N signal remains HIGH for 200 ms while the LD unit is firing.

204

D



Polygon motor/driver board harness loose or broken



Polygon motor/driver board defective



Laser optics unit defective



IPU defective

Laser synchronizing detection error: start position LD0
The laser synchronizing detection signal for the start position of the LDB is
not output for two seconds after LDB unit turns on while the polygon motor is
220

D

rotating normally


The Copy Data Security Unit card not installed



The Copy Data Security Unit card is installed, but it is not the correct
type for the machine.

Laser synchronizing detection error: start position LD1
The laser synchronizing detection signal for the start position of the LDB is
not output for two seconds after LDB unit turns on while the polygon motor is
221

D

rotating normally.


The Copy Data Security Unit card not installed



The Copy Data Security Unit card is installed, but it is not the correct
type for the machine.

D129/D130

6-6

SM

Service Call Conditions

FGATE ON error
230

D

The FGATE signal does not assert within the prescribed time. (The IPU
generates the FGATE signal and sends it to the LD unit when the registration
sensor switches on.)
FGATE OFF error
The FGATE signal does not assert within the prescribed time. (The IPU
generates the FGATE signal and sends it to the LD unit when the registration

231

D

sensor switches on.)


IPU defective



IPU, Controller board harness loose or broken



Controller board defective.

LD error

240

C

The IPU detected a problem at the LD unit.


Worn-out LD



Disconnected or broken harness of the LD.

270

SM

D



The I2C bus device ID is not identified during initialization.



A device-status error occurs during I2C bus communication.



The I2C bus communication is not established due to an error other than
a buffer shortage.



Loose connection



Defective IPU



Defective LD controller board

6-7

D129/D130

Troubleshooting

GAVD communication error

Service Call Conditions

SC Tables: SC3xx

Charge roller bias leak
A charge roller bias leak signal was detected.
302

D



Charge roller damaged



High voltage supply board defective



PCDU harness defective or disconnected

Charge roller bias correction leak
The charge roller bias correction is performed twice even if the maximum
304

D

charge roller bias (-2000V) is applied to the roller.


ID sensor defective



Worn charge roller



Charge roller damaged

Development roller bias leak
The development roller bias leak is detected for 60 ms after the high voltage
has been supplied to the development unit.
320

D

D129/D130



Development bias leak



Broken harness



Defective high voltage power supply, voltage supply



Defective high voltage supply unit

6-8

SM

Service Call Conditions

Development paddle motor error
The machine detects a lock signal error from the development puddle motor
for 2 seconds after the drum motor has turned on.
324

D



Overload on the development puddle motor



Defective development puddle motor



Defective harness



Defective IOB

ID sensor pattern test error
One of the following readings occurred 10 times in the ID sensor output when
the ID sensor pattern was checked:
1) Vsp > 2.5V
2) Vsg < 2.5V
D

3) Vsp =0V
4) Vsg = 0V


ID sensor connector defective



Poor ID sensor connector connection



I/O board (IOB) defective



Poor writing of ID sensor pattern on the drum



High voltage supply board defective

ID sensor Vsg test error
When the ID sensor was checked, the ID sensor output voltage is 5.0V while
the LED current value is 0.

351

SM

D



ID sensor defective or dirty



ID sensor connector defective



Poor ID sensor connection



I/O board (IOB) defective



Scanning system defective



High voltage supply board defective



Defect at the ID sensor pattern writing area of the drum

6-9

D129/D130

Troubleshooting

350

Service Call Conditions

Grayscale measurement error
When the grayscale control result is the maximum and it does not operate
355

C

correctly and these cases are detected 15 times.


ID sensor defective or dirty



The life of ID sensor or photo conductor



Shield glass dirty

TD sensor (Vt) error 1
The following condition occurs thirty times consecutively during printing. Vt is
360

D

less than 0.5V or 4.8V or more


TD sensor disconnected



Harness between TD sensor and PCDU defective



Defective TD sensor.

TD sensor adjustment error
Vts is less than 1.8V or 4.8V or more during TD sensor initialization.
372

D



Heat seal not removed from a new developer pack



TD harness sensor disconnected, loose or defective



TD sensor defective



Harness between TD sensor and drawer disconnected, defective

Drum motor error
The machine detects a lock signal error from the drum motor for 2 seconds
after the drum motor turned on.
396

D

D129/D130



Overload on the motor



Defective drum motor



Defective harness



Defective IOB

6-10

SM

Service Call Conditions

SC Tables: SC4xx

Vsg adjustment error

400

D

Vsg is more than 4.2V or 3.8V or less when the machine adjusts Vsg value.


Dirty or defective ID sensor



Defective ID sensor shutter

Transfer belt bias error
The feed back bias from the transfer belt is more than 4V for 60 msec while
the transfer belt bias is output.
440

D

The A/D conversion level is 20 or less for 60 msec.
The PWM duty is 24% or more for 60 msec.


Power pack broken



Defective harness



Disconnected connector

Transfer/Development motor error
The machine detects a lock signal error from the transfer/development motor
441

SM

D



Overload on the motor



Defective transfer/development motor



Defective harness



Defective IOB

6-11

Troubleshooting

for a continuous 20 times after the transfer/development motor turned on.

D129/D130

Service Call Conditions

Transfer belt contact motor error
The transfer belt HP sensor detects incorrect movement of the transfer belt
after the transfer belt contact motor has turned on.
442

D



Dirty transfer belt HP sensor



Defective transfer belt contact motor



Disconnected connector of the transfer belt HP sensor or motor



Disconnected cable



Defective IOB

SC Tables: SC5xx

1st tray lift malfunction
The tray lift sensor is not activated after the tray lift motor has been on for 10
seconds. If the main power switch is turned on when the paper is already at
the feed height, the paper height position is detected again. At this time, the
tray lift sensor should de-activate within 1.5 sec after the paper bottom plate
starts to drop. If it does not deactivate within 1.5 sec., a message will prompt
501

B

the user to reset Tray 1. After two attempts to release the error by re-setting
the paper tray, if this does not solve the problem then this SC is displayed.


An obstruction (jammed paper, paper scraps, etc.) has blocked the
motor drive and caused an overload.

D129/D130



Tray lift sensor connection loose, disconnected, or damaged



Tray lift sensor defective



Tray lift motor connection loose, disconnected, or damaged



Tray lift motor defective

6-12

SM

Service Call Conditions

2nd tray lift malfunction
The tray lift sensor is not activated after the tray lift motor has been on for 10
seconds. If the main power switch is turned on when the paper is already at
the feed height, the paper height position is detected again. At this time, the
tray lift sensor should de-activate within 1.5 sec. after the paper bottom plate
starts to drop. If it does not deactivate within 1.5 sec., a message will prompt
502

B

the user to reset Tray 2. After two attempts to re-set the paper tray, if this
does not solve the problem then this SC is displayed.


An obstruction (jammed paper, paper scraps, etc.) has blocked the
motor drive and caused an overload.

503

B



Tray lift sensor connection loose, disconnected, or damaged



Tray lift sensor defective



Tray lift motor connection loose, disconnected, or damaged



Tray lift motor defective

3rd tray lift malfunction (optional paper feed unit or LCT)
For the paper feed unit:


SC 503-01 occurs if the lift sensor does not turn on within 10 seconds
after the tray lift motor has turned on.

For the LCT:


SC 503-01 occurs if the lift sensor does not turn on or turn off within 8
Troubleshooting

seconds after the tray lift motor has turned on to lift or lower the tray.
For the paper feed unit:
-01

-



Defective tray lift motor or connector disconnection



Defective lift sensor or connector disconnection

For the LCT:

SM



Defective stack transport clutch or connector disconnection



Defective tray motor or connector disconnection



Defective end fence home position sensor or connector disconnection



Defective upper limit sensor or connector disconnection



Defective tray lift motor or connector disconnection

6-13

D129/D130

Service Call Conditions

This SC is generated if the following condition occurs 3 consecutive times.
For the paper feed unit:


When the tray lowers, the tray lift sensor does not go off within 1.5 sec.

For the LCT:


When the main switch is turned on or when the LCT is set, if the end
fence is not in its position (home position sensor ON), the tray lift motor
stops.


-02

If the upper limit does not go off for 1.5 seconds even the tray lift motor
turns on to lower the tray after the upper limit has been detected at

-

power on.
For the paper feed unit:


Defective tray lift motor or connector disconnection



Defective lift sensor or connector disconnection

For the LCT:


Defective stack transport clutch or connector disconnection



Defective tray motor or connector disconnection



Defective end fence home position sensor or connector disconnection

4th tray lift malfunction (optional paper feed unit or LCT)
For the two-tray paper feed unit:


When the tray lift motor is turned on, the upper limit is not detected within
15 seconds. If this condition occurs three consecutive times, the SC is
generated.



When the tray lowers, the tray lift sensor does not go off within 1.5 sec.

For the LCT:
504

B



After the job is finished, if the end fence is not in the home position
(home position sensor ON), the tray lift motor stops.



When the main switch is turned on or when the paper feed unit is set, if
the end fence is not in the home position (home position sensor ON), the
tray lift motor stops. If this condition occurs three consecutive times, the
SC is generated.



If the upper or lower limit is not detected within 8 seconds when the tray
lift motor is turned on to lift up or lower the tray.



D129/D130

When the tray lowers, the tray lift sensor does not go off within 1.5 sec.

6-14

SM

Service Call Conditions

For the paper feed unit:


Defective tray lift motor or connector disconnection



Defective lift sensor or connector disconnection

For the LCT:


Defective tray lift motor or connector disconnection



Defective lift sensor or connector disconnection

5th tray lift malfunction (optional LCT)
For the two-tray paper feed unit:


If the upper limit of the LCT 1200-sheet is not detected within 8 seconds
when the tray lift motor is turned on to lift up the tray.



When the tray lowers, the tray lift sensor does not go off within 1.5 sec.

For the LCT:
505

B



If the upper limit of the LCT 1200-sheet is not detected within 8 seconds
when the tray lift motor is turned on to lift up or lower the tray.



The tray lift sensor of the LCT 1200-sheet does not go off within 1.5
seconds when the tray lowers. If this condition occurs three consecutive
times, the SC is generated.



Tray lift motor defective or disconnected



Upper limit sensor defective or disconnected

The IOB does not receive the lock signal for10 seconds after turning on the
530

SM

D

fusing exhaust fan.


Defective fusing exhaust fan motor or connector disconnection



Defective IOB



Disconnected harness

6-15

D129/D130

Troubleshooting

Fusing exhaust fan motor error

Service Call Conditions

Exhaust fan motor error
The IOB does not receive the lock signal for 10 seconds after turning on the
531

D

exhaust fan motor.


Defective exhaust fan motor or connector disconnection.



Defective IOB



Disconnected harness

Cooling fan motor error
The machine does not detect the fan motor lock signal for 10 seconds after
532

D

turning on the cooling fan motor.


Defective cooling fan motor or connector disconnection.



Disconnected harness



Defective IOB

Paper exit cooling fan motor error
The machine does not detect the fan motor lock signal for 10 seconds after
533

D

turning on the paper exit cooling fan motor.


Defective paper exit cooling fan motor or connector disconnection.



Defective IOB



Disconnected harness

Fusing motor error
The IOB does not receive the lock signal for 2 seconds after turning on the
fusing motor.
540

D

D129/D130



Motor overload



Defective fusing motor or connector disconnection.



Defective IOB



Disconnected harness

6-16

SM

Service Call Conditions

Fusing thermistor open (center)

541

A

The thermistor (center) detects 0°C or less for 5 sec.


Fusing thermistor disconnected



Fusing thermistor connector defective

Fusing temperature warm-up error(center)
This SC is generated if the following condition occurs:

542

A

The thermistor (center) does not detect an 8°C increment in the fusing
temperature for 1.5 sec. just after the fusing temperature reached 45°C.



The temperature of the center thermistor does not reach the target
temperature for 28 seconds after the fusing lamps turned on.



Thermistor warped or broken

Fusing overheat error 1 (software detection)
A fusing temperature (at the center) of over 230°C (446°F) is detected for 1
second by the fusing thermistors at the center or at either end of the fusing
A

roller.


Power supply unit defective



I/O board (IOB) defective



BCU defective



TRIAC short on PSU (PSU defective)

Troubleshooting

543

Fusing overheat error 1 (hardware detection)
A fusing temperature (at the center) over 250°C is detected by the fusing
544

SM

A

temperature monitor circuit in the BCU board.


I/O board (IOB) defective



BCU defective

6-17

D129/D130

Service Call Conditions

Fusing lamp consecutive full power 1
After warm-up the fusing lamp remains at full power for 15 seconds without
545

A

the hot roller rotating.


Disconnected or defective thermistors (center)



Defective fusing lamp

Zero cross error


The zero cross signal is detected three times even though the heater
relay is off when turning on the main power.



The zero cross signal is not detected for 2 seconds even though the
heater relay is on after turning on the main power or closing the front

547

D

door.


The detection error occurs twice or more in the 11 zero cross signal
detections. This error is defined when the detected zero cross signal is
less than 45.



Defective fusing lamp relay



Defective fusing lamp relay circuit



Unstable power supply

Fusing thermistor open (end)

551

A

The thermistor (end) detects 0°C or less for 5 sec.


Fusing thermistor (end) disconnected



Fusing thermistor (end) connector defective

Fusing temperature warm-up error (end)
This SC is generated if the following condition occurs:

552

A

The thermistor (end) does not detect an 8°C increment in the fusing
temperature for 1.5 sec. just after the fusing temperature reached 45°C.



The temperature of the end thermistor does not reach the target
temperature for 31 seconds after the fusing lamps turned on.


D129/D130

Thermistor warped or broken
6-18

SM

Service Call Conditions

Fusing overheat error 1 (software detection)
A fusing temperature (at the end) of over 230°C (446°F) is detected for 1
second by the fusing thermistors at the center or at either end of the fusing
553

A

roller.


Power supply unit defective



I/O board (IOB) defective



BCU defective



TRIAC short on PSU (PSU defective)

Fusing overheat error 1 (hardware detection)
A fusing temperature (at the end) over 250°C is detected by the fusing
554

A

temperature monitor circuit in the BCU board.


I/O board (IOB) defective



BCU defective

Fusing lamp consecutive full power 1
After warm-up, the fusing lamp remains at full power for 40 seconds without
A

the hot roller rotating.


Disconnected or defective thermistors (ends)



Defective fusing lamp
Troubleshooting

555

Zero cross frequency error
When the zero cross signal is 66 or more and it is detected 10 times or more
557

C

in 11 detections, the machine determines that input 60 Hz and SC557
occurs.


SM

Noise (High frequency)

6-19

D129/D130

Service Call Conditions

Fusing unit jam
The fusing sensor detected a fusing unit paper late jam three times. The
paper was late and the fusing exit sensor could not detect the paper three
559

A

times.


Remove the paper that is stopped in the fusing unit.



Check that the fusing unit is clean and has no obstacles in the paper
feed path.





If the error persists, replace the fusing unit.

SC559 does not operate until SP1159 has been set to "1" (ON). This sets the machine
to count the number of occurrences of paper late jams in the fusing unit. The default
setting is "0" (OFF).



SC559 is issued after the third occurrence of a paper late jam in the fusing unit. Once
this SC has been issued, the machine cannot be used until the service technician
removes the cause of the jam and restores it to normal operation.



The jam counter is reset after a sheet of paper successfully passes the fusing exit
sensor after the cause of the jam has been removed.

D129/D130

6-20

SM

Service Call Conditions

SC Tables: SC6xx

Mechanical counter error: BK
This SC is only for NA models.
610

620

D

D

The machine detects the mechanical counter error when SP5987-001 is set
to "1".


Disconnected mechanical counter



Defective mechanical counter

ADF communication error
Communication error between machine and ADF
Communication error between machine and ADF with ASAP is detected.

-01

-



Disconnected cable



ARDF defective



IPU board defective

External noise
Communication error between IPU and ADF
After the ARDF is detected, the break signal occurs or communication
-02

-



Incorrect installation of ARDF



ARDF defective



IPU board defective



External noise

Troubleshooting

timeout occurs.

Communication timeout error between IOB and finisher or mailbox
A break (low) signal is received from the finisher or the mailbox.
621

SM

D



Disconnected cable



Defective IOB



Defective main board in the peripherals

6-21

D129/D130

Service Call Conditions

Paper feed unit communication error
While the IOB communicates with a peripheral, an SC code is displayed if
one of following conditions occurs.

622

D

The IOB receives the break signal which is generated by the peripheral
only just after the main switch is turned on.



The IOB receives the break signal which is generated by URAT.



Defective main control board of the peripheral



Defective BCU or IOB



Disconnected peripheral

2nd Paper Bank communication error

623

D

This SC is not issued for this machine when a communication error signal
between the 1st paper bank and 2nd paper bank is received.


Loose connector

CSS communication error
630

C

A communication error occurred during communication with the CSS.


Communication line error

MF accounting device error 1

632

B

The controller sends data to the accounting device, but the device does not
respond. This occurs three times.


Loose connection between the controller and the accounting device

MF accounting device error 2

633

B

After communication is established, the controller receives the brake signal
from the accounting device.


D129/D130

Loose connection between the controller and the accounting device

6-22

SM

Service Call Conditions

MF accounting device error 3
The accounting device sends the controller the report that indicates a
634

B

backup RAM error has occurred.


Defective controller of the MF accounting device



Battery error

MF accounting device error 4
The accounting device sends the controller the report that indicates the
635

636

B

D

battery voltage error has occurred.


Defective controller of the MF accounting device



Battery error

IC Card Error
External authentication module error
This SC is generated if the external authentication is enabled and following

-01

D

condition occurs:


No external authentication module



SD card error or external authentication module broken



No DESS module

-02

D

Troubleshooting

Version error
The version of the external authentication module is not correct.


Incorrect module version

OSM User Code File Error
The correct "usercode" file could not be found in the root folder of the SD
-11

D

card because the file is not present, or the existing file is corrupted or the
wrong type file.
Make sure the eccm.mod file is in the root folder of the SD card.
Note: Check the eccm.mod file is in the root folder of the SD card.

SM

6-23

D129/D130

Service Call Conditions

Management area error

-99

D

The management number of the external authentication module exceeds
the maximum limit.


637

D

Software error

Tracking Information Notice Error
Tracking Application Error
When the tracking information is lost, this SC is issued.

-01

D



The machine failed to give notice the tracking information to the
tracking SDK application.



Tracking information is lost, and the machine cannot count correctly.

Tracking Information Notice Error
When the tracking information is lost, this SC is issued.
-02

D



The machine failed to give notice the tracking information to the
management server.



Tracking information is lost, and the machine cannot count correctly.

BCU communication error

641

D

D129/D130

The BCU does not respond to the frame transmitted from the controller.


Defective controller



Detective BCU

6-24

SM

Service Call Conditions

650

-

Communication error of the remote service modem
(Embedded RCG-M)
Authentication error
The authentication for the Embedded RCG-M fails at a dial up connection.

-001

-



Incorrect SP settings



Disconnected telephone line



Disconnected modem board

Check and set the correct user name (SP5816-156) and password
(SP5816-157).
Incorrect modem setting

-004

-

Dial up fails due to the incorrect modem setting.


Same as -001

Check and set the correct AT command (SP5816-160).
Communication line error
The supplied voltage is not sufficient due to a defective communication line
-005

-

or defective connection.


Same as -001

Consult with the user's local telephone company.

The modem board does not work properly even though the setting of the
modem board is installed with a dial up connection.
-013

-



Same as -001

1.

Install the modem board.

2.

Check and reset the modem board setting with SP5816.

3.

Replace the modem board.

Modem board error 2

-014

SM

-

The modem board is installed even though the RCG-N is installed.
1.

Uninstall the modem board, if it is installed.

2.

Check that the Wireless LAN or Ethernet LAN is working properly.
6-25

D129/D130

Troubleshooting

Modem board error 1

Service Call Conditions

Incorrect dial up connection
-001: Program parameter error

651

C

-002: Program execution error
An unexpected error occurs when the modem (Embedded RCG-M) tries to
call the center with a dial up connection.


Caused by a software bug

ID2 mismatching
ID2 for @Remote certification is mismatching between the controller board
and NVRAM.

652

D



Used controller board installed



Used NVRAM installed

An unexpected error occurs when the modem (Embedded RCG-M) tries to
call the center with a dial up connection.
1.

Install the correct controller board or new controller board.

2.

Install the correct NVRAM or new NVRAM.

ID2 error
ID2 stored in the NVRAM is incorrect.

653

D



Used NVRAM installed

An unexpected error occurs when the modem (Embedded RCG-M) tries to
call the center with a dial up connection.
Clear the ID2 in the NVRAM, and then input a correct ID2.

D129/D130

6-26

SM

Service Call Conditions

D

EEPROM error
[1]

Open communication error: ID error

[2]

Open communication error: Channel error

[3]

Open communication error: Device error

[4]

Open communication error: Communication failed error

[5]

Open communication error: Communication time error

[6]

-

SM

-

Open communication error: Communication suspended
error

[7]

Open communication error: Buffer full error

[8]

Close communication error: No error code

[9]

Close communication error: ID error

[10]

Close communication error: No error code

[11]

Data write error: ID error

[12]

Data write error: Channel error

[13]

Data write error: Device error

[14]

Data write error: Communication suspended error

[15]

Data write error: Communication time over error

[16]

Data write error: Communication suspended error

[17]

Data write error: Buffer full error

[18]

Data write error: No error code

[19]

Data read error: ID error

[20]

Data read error: Channel error

[21]

Data read error: Device error

[22]

Data read error: Communication failed error

[23]

Data read error: Communication time over error
6-27

Troubleshooting

669

D129/D130

Service Call Conditions

-

-

[24]

Data read error: Communication suspended error

[25]

Data read error: Buffer full error

[26]

Data read error: No error code

[27]

Device detection error: ID error

[28]

Device detection error: Channel error

[29]

Device detection error: Device error

[30]

Device detection error: Communication failed error

[31]

Device detection error: Communication time over error

[32]

Device detection error: Communication suspended error

[33]

Device detection error: Buffer full error

[34]

Device detection error: No error code

Retry of EEPROM communication fails three times after the machine has
detected the EEPROM error.


Caused by noise

Engine startup error
The BCU fails to respond with the prescribed time when the machine is
turned on.
670

D



Connections between BCU and controller board are loose,
disconnected, or damaged

D129/D130

1.

Replace the BCU

2.

Replace the controller board

6-28

SM

Service Call Conditions

Controller-to-operation panel communication error at startup


After the machine is powered on, the communication between the
controller and the operation panel is not established, or communication
with controller is interrupted after a normal startup.



After startup reset of the operation panel, the attention code or the
attention acknowledge code is not sent from the controller within 30
seconds.


672

After the controller issues a command to check the communication line
with the controller at 30-second intervals, the controller fails to respond

D

twice.


Controller stalled



Controller board installed incorrectly



Controller board defective



Operation panel connector loose or defective



The controller is not completely shutdown when you turn the main
switch off.

Check the setting of SP5875-001. If the setting is set to "1 (OFF)", change it
to "0 (ON)".

Transmission error in controller board
D

Video transmission error is detected in the controller board.


Defective Controller Board

Troubleshooting

674

Memory address (PER) command error
The BCU does not receive a memory address command from the controller
for the prescribed time after the paper has reached the registration sensor.
687

SM

D



Harness Disconnection at BCU



Controller board loose or broken



Defective BCU



Defective Controller Board

6-29

D129/D130

Service Call Conditions

SC Tables: SC7xx

700

D

Scanner feeding error 1
Pick-up roller HP error
When the pick-up motor turns on counterclockwise, the pick-up roller HP

01

-

sensor does not detect the home position of the pick-up roller.


Defective pick-up roller HP sensor



Defective pick-up motor



Defective DF drive board

Original stopper HP error
When the pick-up motor turns on clockwise, the original stopper HP sensor
02

-

does not detect the home position of the original stopper.


Defective original stopper HP sensor



Defective pick-up motor



Defective DF drive board

DF fan motor 1 error

12

-

DF fan motor lock signal is detected after the original transportation has
finished.


701

D

Turn the main switch off and on.

Scanner feeding error 2
Pick-up motor driver error
The error flag of the pick-up motor driver IC is asserted when the jam error is

02

-

issued.
Pick-up motor driver detected an error.
Turn the main switch off and on.

D129/D130

6-30

SM

Service Call Conditions

Paper feed motor error
The error flag of the paper feed motor driver IC is asserted when the jam
03

-

error is issued.
Pick-up motor driver detected an error.
Turn the main switch off and on.

720

B

2000/3000-Sheet (booklet) Finisher Error
Finisher exit guide plate motor error
After moving away from the guide plate position sensor, the exit guide is not
detected at the home position within the prescribed time.

-24

-

The 1st detection failure issues a jam error, and the 2nd failure issues this
SC code.


Guide plate motor disconnected, defective



Guide plate motor overloaded due to obstruction



Guide plate position sensor disconnected, defective

Finisher punch motor error
The punch HP sensor is not activated within the specified time after the
punch motor turned on.

SM

-

The 1st detection failure causes a jam error, and the 2nd failure causes this
SC code.


Punch HP sensor disconnected, defective



Punch motor disconnected or defective



Punch motor overload due to obstruction

6-31

Troubleshooting

-25

D129/D130

Service Call Conditions

Finisher jogger motor error
The jogger fences move out of the home position but the HP sensor output
does not change within the specified number of pulses.
The 1st failure issues an original jam message, and the 2nd failure issues
-30

-

this SC code.


Jogger HP sensor disconnected, defective



Jogger motor disconnected, defective



Jogger motor overloaded due to obstruction



Finisher main board and jogger motor

Stack feed-out motor error


The stack feed-out HP sensor does not detect the home position of the
stack feed-out belt 3000ms after the stack feed-out belt has moved to its
home position.



The stack feed-out HP sensor does not turn off 200 ms after the stack
feed-out belt has moved from its home position.

-41

-

The 1st detection failure causes a jam error, and the 2nd failure causes this
SC code.


Defective stack feed-out HP sensor



Overload on the stack feed-out motor



Defective stack feed-out motor



Defective main board



Disconnected or defective harness

Finisher stapler movement motor error
Staple movement is not finished within a certain time.
The 1st detection failure causes a jam error, and the 2nd failure causes this
SC code.
-42

-

D129/D130



Motor overload



Loose connection of the stapler home position sensor



Loose connection of the stapler movement motor



Defective stapler home position sensor



Defective stapler movement motor

6-32

SM

Service Call Conditions

Finisher corner stapler rotation motor error
The stapler does not return to its home position within the specified time
after stapling.
-43

-

The 1st detection failure causes a jam error, and the 2nd failure causes this
SC code.


Defective stapler rotation motor



Overload on the stapler rotation motor



Defective stapler rotation HP sensor

Finisher corner stapler motor error
The 1st detection failure causes a jam error, and the 2nd failure causes this
SC code.


The stapler motor does not switch off within the prescribed time after
operating.

-44

-



The HP sensor of the staple unit does not detect the home position after
the staple unit moves to its home position.



The HP sensor of the staple unit detects the home position after the
staple unit moves from its home position.
Staple jam



Motor overload



Defective stapler motor

Troubleshooting



SM

6-33

D129/D130

Service Call Conditions

Finisher folder plate motor error
The folder plate moves but is not detected at the home position within the
specified time.
-52

-

The 1st detection failure causes a jam error, and the 2nd failure causes this
SC code.


Folder plate HP sensor disconnected, defective



Folder plate motor disconnected, defective



Folder plate motor overloaded due to obstruction.

Folding unit bottom fence lift motor
The folding unit bottom fence movement is not finished within a certain time.
The 1st detection failure causes a jam error, and the 2nd failure causes this
-53

-

SC code.


Motor harness loose, broken



Motor drive obstructed



Motor defective

Clamp roller retraction motor error
The clamp roller movement is not finished within a certain time.
The 1st detection failure causes a jam error, and the 2nd failure causes this
-55

-

SC code.


Motor harness loose, broken



Motor drive obstructed



Motor defective

Stack junction gate motor error
The stack junction gate motor moves but the stack junction gate is not
detected at its position within a specific time.
-57

-

D129/D130

The 1st detection failure causes a jam error, and the 2nd failure causes this
SC code.


Motor broken



Motor connection loose



Motor overloaded

6-34

SM

Service Call Conditions

Booklet stapler motor error 1
The 1st detection failure causes a jam error, and the 2nd failure causes this
SC code.
-60

-

The front stapler unit saddle-stitch motor does not start operation within the
specified time.


Motor overload



Loose connection of the front stapler motor



Defective front stapler motor

Booklet staple motor error 2
The 1st detection failure causes a jam error, and the 2nd failure causes this
SC code.
-61

-

The rear stapler unit saddle-stitch motor does not start operation within the
specified time.


Motor overload



Loose connection of the rear stapler motor



Defective rear stapler motor

Tray lift motor error
The 1st detection failure causes a jam error, and the 2nd failure causes this
SC code.

SM

-

The upper tray paper height sensor does not change its status with the
specified time after the tray raises or lowers.


Motor overload



Loose connection of the tray lift motor



Defective tray lift motor

6-35

Troubleshooting

-70

D129/D130

Service Call Conditions

Finisher Tray 1 shift motor error
The shift roller HP sensor of the upper tray does not activate within the
prescribed time after the shift tray starts to move toward or away from the
home position.
-71

-

The 1st detection failure issues a jam error, and the 2nd failure issues this
SC code.


Shift tray HP sensor of the upper tray disconnected, defective



Shift tray motor of the upper tray disconnected, defective



Shift tray motor of the upper tray overloaded due to obstruction

Shift jogger motor 1 error
The side fence does not retract within the prescribed time after the shift
jogger motor 1 switches on.
-72

-

The 1st detection failure issues a jam error, and the 2nd failure issues this
SC code.


Shift jogger motor 1 disconnected, defective



Shift jogger motor 1 overloaded due to obstruction



Shift jogger 1 HP sensor disconnected, defective

Shift jogger motor 2 error
The side fence does not retract within the prescribed time after the shift
jogger motor 2 switches on.
-73

-

D129/D130

The 1st detection failure issues a jam error, and the 2nd failure issues this
SC code.


Shift jogger motor 2 disconnected, defective



Shift jogger motor 2 overloaded due to obstruction



Shift jogger 2 HP sensor disconnected, defective

6-36

SM

Service Call Conditions

Shift jogger retraction motor error
The side fences do not retract within the prescribed time after the retraction
motor switches on.
The 1st detection failure issues a jam error, and the 2nd failure issues this
-74

-

SC code.


Shift jogger retraction motor broken



Shift jogger retraction motor connection loose



Shift jogger retraction motor overloaded



Defective shift jogger retraction HP sensor

Return roller motor error
This occurs during the operation of the lower tray pressure motor
-75

-



Motor harness disconnected, loose, defective



Motor overloaded



Home position sensor harness disconnected, loose, defective



Home position defective

Punch movement motor error
The punch unit moves but is not detected at the home position within the
specified time.
-80

-

The 1st detection failure causes a jam error, and the 2nd failure causes this



Motor harness disconnected, loose, defective



Defective motor

Troubleshooting

SC code.

Paper position sensor slide motor error
The paper position sensor moves but is not detected at the home position
within the specified time.
-81

-

The 1st detection failure causes a jam error, and the 2nd failure causes this
SC code.

SM



Motor harness disconnected, loose, defective



Defective motor

6-37

D129/D130

Service Call Conditions

722

B

1000-Sheet Finisher Error
Upper transport motor error
The upper transport motor in the finisher is not operating.

-10

-



Upper transport motor drive is obstructed (jammed paper, paper scraps,
etc.)



The motor harness is loose or broken



Upper transport motor defective

Lower transport motor error
The lower transport motor in the finisher is not operating.
-14

-



Lower transport motor drive is obstructed (jammed paper, paper scraps,
etc.)



The motor harness is loose or broken



Lower transport motor defective

Exit motor error
The exit motor in the finisher is not operating.
-17

-



Exit motor drive is obstructed (jammed paper, paper scraps, etc.)



The motor harness is loose or broken



Exit motor defective

Finisher exit guide plate motor error
The exit guide plate HP sensor did not activate within the prescribed time
after the exit guide plate motor turned on.
-24

-

D129/D130



Finisher exit guide plate motor drive is obstructed (jammed paper, paper
scraps, etc.)



Exit guide plate motor harness loose, broken



Exit guide plate HP sensor harness loose, broken



Exit guide plate motor defective



Exit guide plate HP sensor defective

6-38

SM

Service Call Conditions

Front fence motor error
The jogger fence motor in the finisher is not operating.
-30

-



Jogger motor drive is obstructed (jammed paper, paper scraps, etc.)



The motor harness is loose or broken



Jogger fence HP sensor dirty, loose, defective



Jogger fence motor defective

Feed-out belt motor error
The feed-out belt did not return to the home position within the prescribed
time.
-41

-



Feed-out belt motor drive is obstructed (jammed paper, paper scraps,
etc.)



Motor harness loose or broken



Feed-out belt HP sensor dirty, disconnected, broken



Motor defective

Stapler movement motor
The 1st detection failure issues a jam error, and the 2nd failure causes this
SC code.
The stapler HP sensor is not activated within the specified time after the

SM

-

stapler motor turned on.


Stapler or motor drive is blocked by obstruction



Motor harness loose or broken



Stapler HP sensor harness loose, broken



Motor defective



Stapler HP sensor defective

6-39

Troubleshooting

-42

D129/D130

Service Call Conditions

Corner stapler motor error
The 1st detection failure issues a jam error, and the 2nd failure causes this
SC code.


The stapler motor does not switch off within the prescribed time after
operating.


-44

-

The HP sensor of the staple unit does not detect the home position after
the staple unit moves to its home position.

The HP sensor of the staple unit detects the home position after the staple
unit moves from its home position.


Staple jam



Number of sheets in stack exceeds allowed number of sheets for
stapling



Stapler motor obstructed



Stapler motor defective

Tray lift motor error
The tray lift motor is not operating.
-70

-



Motor harness loose, broken



Motor drive obstructed



Stack height sensor dirty, harness loose, broken



Motor defective



Stack height sensor defective

Shift tray motor error
The shift tray motor is not operating.
-71

-

D129/D130



Shift motor drive is obstructed (jammed paper, paper scraps, etc.)



Shift motor harness loose, broken



Shift tray HP sensor harness loose, broken



Shift motor defective



Shit tray HP sensor defective

6-40

SM

Service Call Conditions

Shift motor error
The shift motor HP sensor does not detect any change for 1.86 seconds after
770

B

the shift motor has turned on at power on or during its operation.


Defective shift motor



Defective shift motor HP sensor

Bridge unit error
The machine recognizes the finisher, but does not recognize the bridge unit.
791

D



Defective connector



Broken harness



Incorrect installation

Finisher error
The machine does not recognize the finisher, but recognizes the bridge unit.
B



Defective connector



Defective harness



Incorrect installation

Troubleshooting

792

SM

6-41

D129/D130

Service Call Conditions

SC Tables: SC8xx

Energy save I/O sub-system error
816

D

Energy saver sub-system detects an error.


Defective controller board

Monitor Error
This is a file detection and electronic file signature check error when the boot
loader attempts to read the self-diagnostic module, system kernel, or root
817

D

system files from the OS Flash ROM, or the items on the SD card in the
controller slot are false or corrupted.


OS Flash ROM data defective; change the controller firmware



SD card data defective; use another SD card

Watchdog timer error
The watchdog timer detect the error even if system processing normally.
818

D

D129/D130



System program defective



Controller board defective



Optional board defective

6-42

SM

Service Call Conditions

Fatal kernel error
Due to a control error, a RAM overflow occurred during system processing.
One of the following messages was displayed on the operation panel.

819

C

0x6261

6261 6420 6469 7200 00 -> "bad dir"

0x696e

0x69742064 -> "init died"

0x766d

0x5f706167 -> "vm_pageout: VM is full"

554C

UL (USB error)

----

Error in the OS
"init died", "vm_pageout: VM is full", "Cache
Error"





System program defective



Controller board defective



Optional board defective



Replace controller firmware

For more details about this SC code error, execute SP5990 to print an SMC report so

Troubleshooting

you can read the error code. The error code is not displayed on the operation panel.

SM

6-43

D129/D130

Service Call Conditions

820

CTL

Self-diagnostics error: CPU

D

[XXXX]: Detailed error code
CPU error
During the self-diagnostic, the controller CPU detects an error. There
are 47 types of error code (0001 to 4005) depending on the cause of
the error. The CPU detects an error and displays the specific error code
with the program address where the error occurs.

[0001] to
[06FF]



System firmware problem



Defective controller

1.

Turn the main switch off and on.

[0801] to [4005] 2.
3.

Reinstall the controller system firmware.
Replace the controller.

When the problem cannot be fixed with the above procedure, the
following information displayed on the screen needs to be fed back to a
technical support center.


SC code



Detailed error code



Program address

CPU/Memory Error

[0701] to
[070A]

D129/D130



System firmware problem



Defective RAM-DIMM



Defective controller

1.

Reinstall the controller system software.

2.

Replace the RAM-DIMM.

3.

Replace the controller.

6-44

SM

Service Call Conditions

821

D

Self-diagnostics error: ASIC
[XXXX]: Detailed error code
ASIC error

[0B00]

The write-&-verify check error has occurred in the ASIC.


Defective ASIC device

Replace the controller board.
Self-diagnosis error: ASIC
The CPU checks if the ASIC timer works correctly compared with the CPU
timer. If the ASIC timer does not function in the specified range, this SC code
[0D05]

is displayed.


System firmware problem



Defective RAM-DIMM



Defective controller

Replace the controller board.
Video bridge device (ASIC) error 1
[50A1]

The CPU does not detect the video bridge device.


Defective I/F between the video bridge device and controller

[50A2]

The CPU detects the video bridge device, but detects error data from the
video bridge device.




Defective I/F between the video bridge device and controller

For more details about this SC code error, execute SP5990 to print an SMC report so
you can read the error code. The error code is not displayed on the operation panel.

SM

6-45

D129/D130

Troubleshooting

Video bridge device (ASIC) register error 1

Service Call Conditions

822

B

Self-diagnostic error: HDD
Check performed only when HDD is installed:


HDD device busy for over 31 s.



After a diagnostic command is set for the HDD, but the device remains
busy for over 6 s.

[3003]


HDD defective



HDD harness disconnected, defective



Controller board defective

No response to the self-diagnostic command from the ASIC to the HDDs.
[3004]


823

B

HDD defective

Self-diagnostic error: NIB
[XXXX]: Detailed error code
MAC address check sum error

[6101]

The result of the MAC address check sum does not match the check sum
stored in ROM.
PHY IC error

[6104]

The PHY IC on the controller cannot be correctly recognized.
PHY IC loop-back error

[6105]

An error occurred during the loop-back test for the PHY IC on the controller.

Self-diagnostic error : NVRAM
NVRAM device does not exist, NVRAM device is damaged, or NVRAM
socket damaged.
824

D

D129/D130



NVRAM defective



Controller board defective



NVRAM backup battery exhausted



NVRAM socket damaged

6-46

SM

Service Call Conditions

826

D

Self-diagnostic Error: RTC/optional NVRAM
The one second counted by the RTC is different from the one second
counted by the CPU on the controller.

[1501]



Defective RTC device

The RTC device is not detected.
[15FF]

827

D



Defective RTC device



NVRAM without RTC installed



Discharged backup battery

Self-diagnostic error: Standard SDRAM DIMM
[XXXX]: Detailed error code
Verification error
Error detected during a write/verify check for the standard RAM (SDRAM

[0201]

DIMM).


Loose connection



Defective SDRAM DIMM



Defective controller

Resident memory error

[0202]



Defective RAM DIMM



Defective SPD ROM on RAM DIMM



Defective 12C bus

Troubleshooting

The SPD values in all RAM DIMM are incorrect or unreadable.

Replace the RAM DIMM.

SM

6-47

D129/D130

Service Call Conditions

828

Self-diagnostic error: ROM

D

[XXXX]: Detailed error code
Check sum error 1


The boot monitor and OS program stored in the ROM DIMM is
checked. If the check sum of the program is incorrect, this SC code is

[0101]

displayed.
1.

829

D

Replace the controller board.

Self-diagnostic error: Optional RAM
[XXXX]: Detailed error code
Verification error
Error detected during a write/verify check for the optional RAM (SDRAM
DIMM).

[0301]



Loose connection



Defective SDRAM DIMM



Defective controller

Turn the main switch off and on.
Replace the SDRAM DIMM.
Replace the controller.
Memory structure data error
The memory structure data error for the optional RAM (SDRAM DIMM) is
detected when the self-diagnostic is executed.
[0302]



Defective RAM DIMM



Defective SPD ROM on RAM DIMM



Defective 12C bus

Replace the RAM DIMM.

D129/D130

6-48

SM

Service Call Conditions

833

C

Self-diagnostic error 8: Engine I/F ASIC
ASIC (Mandolin) for system control could not be detected. After the PCI

[0F30]

configuration, the device ID for the ASIC could not be checked.

[0F31]
Replace the IPU.
ASIC (Mandolin) for system control could not be detected. After the PCI
[0F41]

configuration, the device ID for the ASIC could not be checked.
Replace the IPU.
Could not initialize or read the bus connection.

[50B1]

Check for loose connections at the mother board.
Replace the IPU.
Value of the SSCG register is incorrect.

[50B2]

Check for loose connections at the mother board.

Troubleshooting

Replace the IPU.

SM

6-49

D129/D130

Service Call Conditions

835

C

Self-diagnostic error: Centronic device
Loopback connector is connected but check results in an error.

[1102]



IEEE1284 connector error



Centronic loopback connector defective

Replace the controller board.
Loopback connector is connected but check results in an error.

[110C]



ASIC device error



IEEE1284 connector error



Centronic loopback connector defective

Replace the controller board.
Centronic loopback connector is not connected for detailed self-diagnostic
test.

[1120]



Centronic loopback connector not connected correctly



Centronic loopback connector defective



ASIC device defective

Replace the controller board.

838

B

Self-diagnostic Error: Clock Generator
A verify error occurred when setting data was read from the clock generator
via the I2C bus.

[2701]



Defective clock generator



Defective I2C bus



Defective I2C port on the CPU

Replace the controller board.

D129/D130

6-50

SM

Service Call Conditions

839

C

USB NAND Flash ROM error
USB NAND Flash ROM cannot be read.

[9001]


Defective controller board

The ID of the USB NAND Flash ROM cannot be read.
[9101]


Defective controller board

The USB NAND Flash ROM controller is disconnected.
[9110]


Defective controller board

EEPROM error 1: EEPROM access

840

B

During the I/O processing, a reading error occurred. The 3rd reading
failure causes this SC code.



During the I/O processing, a writing error occurred.

Defective EEPROM

EEPROM error 2: EEPROM read/write error
841

B

Mirrored data of the EEPROM is different from the original data in EEPROM.

Troubleshooting

Data in the EEPROM is overwritten for some reason.

Flash ROM verification error
Verification error of the flash ROM on the controller board occurs.
842

B



This SC is logged at 1st error detection.SC819 is issued at 2nd error
detection.



SC819 is issued at 2nd error detection.

Defective flash ROM (controller board)

SM

6-51

D129/D130

Service Call Conditions

IEEE 1394 I/F error
Driver setting incorrect and cannot be used by the 1394 I/F.
851

B

Not supported by this machine


NIB (PHY), LINK module defective; change the Interface Board

Controller board defective

Wireless LAN Error 1
During machine operation, the Wireless LAN device (Bluetooth) is inserted
853

B

into the controller board.


During machine operation, the Wireless LAN device (Bluetooth) is
inserted into the controller board.

Wireless LAN Error 2
During machine operation, the Wireless LAN device (Bluetooth) is pulled out
854

B

from the controller board.


During machine operation, the Wireless LAN device (Bluetooth) is pulled
out from the controller board.

Wireless LAN error 3

855

B

An error is detected on the wireless LAN card (802.11a/g, g).


Wireless LAN card defective



Wireless LAN card connection incorrect

USB I/F Error

857

B

The USB driver is not stable and caused an error.


Bad USB card connection

Replace the controller board

D129/D130

6-52

SM

Service Call Conditions

HDD Encryption unit error 1
858

C

A serious error occurs when data is encrypted to update an encryption key
with the HDD encryption unit.
Encryption key acquisition error:
The controller fails to get a new encryption key.

-00



Defective controller board

Replace the controller board.
Encryption key setting for HDD error:
The controller fails to copy a new encryption key to the HDD.
-01



Defective SATA chip on the controller board

Replace the controller board.
NVRAM data encryption error 1:
An error occurs while the NVRAM data is encrypted.
-02



Defective NVRAM on the controller board

Replace the NVRAM.
NVRAM data encryption error 2:
An error occurs before the NVRAM data is encrypted.
-30



Defective controller board

Troubleshooting

Replace the controller board.
Other error:
-31

-

A serious error occurs while the data is encrypted.


SM

Same as SC991

6-53

D129/D130

Service Call Conditions

HDD Encryption unit error 2
859

C

A serious error occurs when the HDD data is encrypted to update an
encryption key with the HDD encryption unit.
HDD check error:
The HDD is not correctly installed.

-08

-



No HDD installed



Unformatted HDD



The encryption key on the controller is different from the one on the HDD

1.

Install the HDD correctly.

2.

Initialize the HDD.

Power failure during the data encryption:
The data encryption (NVRAM and HDD) has not been completed.
-09



Power failure during the data encryption

Initialize the HDD.
Data read/write error:
-10

-

The DMAC error is detected twice or more.


Same as SC863

HDD startup error at main power on

860

B



HDD is connected but a driver error is detected.



The driver does not respond with the HDD within 30 s.



HDD is not initialized



Label data is corrupted



Defective HDD

Initialize the HDD with SP5832-001.

D129/D130

6-54

SM

Service Call Conditions

HDD re-try failure
At power on, the HDD is detected. Power supply to the HDD is interrupted
after the system has entered the energy save mode, but after the HDD has
been awakened from the energy save mode, it does not return to the ready
861

D

status within 30 sec.


Harness between HDD and controller board disconnected, defective



HDD power connector disconnected



HDD defective



Controller board defective

Bad sector number error
The number of bad sectors in the HDD (image data area) goes over 101.
862

D



Defective HDD

Format the HDD with SP5-832-002.
Replace the HDD.

863

D

HDD data read failure
The data written to the HDD cannot be read normally, due to bad sectors
generated during operation.
Troubleshooting

Note: [001] to [017] indicate the type of partition where the error occurred.
Enable display of these numbers with SP7902.

-

SM

[001]

An area which does not belong to a partition

[002]

a partition

[003]

b partition

[004]

c partition

[005]

d partition

[006]

e partition

[007]

f partition

-

6-55

D129/D130

Service Call Conditions

-

-

[008]

g partition

[009]

h partition

[010]

i partition

[011]

j partition

[012]

k partition

[013]

l partition

[014]

m partition

[015]

n partition

[016]

o partition

[017]

p partition

[018]

q partition

[019]

r partition

[020]

s partition

[021]

q partition

[022]

t partition

[023]

u partition



HDD defective

Note: If the bad sectors are generated at the image partition, the bad sector
information is written to NVRAM, and the next time the HDD is accessed,
these bad sectors will not be accessed for read/write operation.

D129/D130

6-56

SM

Service Call Conditions

864

D

HDD data CRC error
During HDD operation, the HDD cannot respond to a CRC error query. Data
transfer does not execute normally while data is being written to the HDD.
Note: [001] to [017] indicate the type of partition where the error occurred.
Enable display of these numbers with SP7902.

-

SM

An area which does not belong to a partition

[002]

a partition

[003]

b partition

[004]

c partition

[005]

d partition

[006]

e partition

[007]

f partition

[008]

g partition

[009]

h partition

[010]

i partition

[011]

j partition

[012]

k partition

[013]

l partition

[014]

m partition

[015]

n partition

[016]

o partition

[017]

p partition

[018]

q partition

[019]

r partition

[020]

s partition

-

-

Troubleshooting

-

[001]

6-57

D129/D130

Service Call Conditions

[021]

q partition

[022]

t partition

[023]

u partition



865

D

HDD defective

HDD access error
HDD responded to an error during operation for a condition other than those
for SC863, 864.
Note: [001] to [017] indicate the type of partition where the error occurred.
Enable display of these numbers with SP7902.

-

-

D129/D130

[001]

An area which does not belong to a partition

[002]

a partition

[003]

b partition

[004]

c partition

[005]

d partition

[006]

e partition

[007]

f partition

[008]

g partition

[009]

h partition

[010]

i partition

[011]

j partition

[012]

k partition

[013]

l partition

[014]

m partition

[015]

n partition

[016]

o partition

6-58

SM

Service Call Conditions

-

-

[017]

p partition

[018]

q partition

[019]

r partition

[020]

s partition

[021]

q partition

[022]

t partition

[023]

u partition



HDD defective.

SD card error 1: Confirmation
The machine detects an electronic license error in the application on the SD
card in the controller slot immediately after the machine is turned on. The
program on the SD card contains electronic confirmation license data. If the
866

B

program does not contain this license data, or if the result of the check shows
that the license data in the program on the SD card is incorrect, then the
checked program cannot execute and this SC code is displayed.


Program missing from the SD card



Download the correct program for the machine to the SD card

867

D

Troubleshooting

SD card error 2: SD card removed
The SD card in the slot is removed while the machine is on.
Insert the SD card, then turn the machine off and on.

SM

6-59

D129/D130

Service Call Conditions

SD card error 3: SC card access
An error occurs while an SD card is used.
868

D



SD card not inserted correctly



SD card defective



Controller board defective

Note: If you want to try to reformat the SC card, use SD Formatter Ver 1.1.

Address book data error
The address book data cannot be read from the HDD, SD card or flash ROM
on the controller where it is stored, or the data read from the media is
defective.


Software defective:

Turn the machine off/on. If this is not the solution for the problem, then
870

B

replace the controller firmware.


HDD defective.

More Details


Do SP5846-046 (Initialize All Setting & Addr Book) to reset all address
book data.



Reset the user information with SP5832-006 (HDD Formatting– User
Information).



Replace the HDDs.

HDD mail receive data error

872



The machine detects that the HDD is not operating correctly at power on.



The machine detects that the HDD is not operating correctly (can neither

B

read nor write) while processing incoming email.


HDD defective



The machine is turned off while the HDD is being accessed.

Do SP5832-008 to format the mail RX data on the HDD.

D129/D130

6-60

SM

Service Call Conditions

HDD mail send data error
An error is detected on the HDD immediately after the machine has been
873

B

turned on, or power has been turned off while the machine has used the
HDD.
1.

Do SP5832-008 (Format HDD – Mail TX Data) to initialize the HDD.

2.

Replace the HDD

Delete All error 1: HDD
A data error is detected for the HDD/NVRAM after the Delete All option has
been used.
874

D

Note: The source of this error is the DataOverwriteSecurity Unit running from
an SD card.
1.

Turn the main switch off/on and try the operation again.

2.

Install the DataOverwriteSecurity Unit again. For more, see "Installation".

3.

HDD defective

Troubleshooting

Delete All error 2: Data area
An error occurs while the machine deletes data from the HDD.
Note: The source of this error is the DataOverwriteSecurity Unit (D362)
running from an SD card.
875

D

-001

An error occurs in hddchack-i.

-002

Failed to delete data from the HDD.

-003
Turn the main switch off/on and try the operation again

SM

6-61

D129/D130

Service Call Conditions

Log Data Error
876

D

An error is detected in the handling of the log data at power on or during
machine operation. This can be caused by switching the machine off while it
is operating.
Log Data Error 1

-01

-



Damaged log data file in the HDD

Initialize the HDD with SP5832-004.
Log Data Error 2

-02

-



HDD encryption unit not installed

1.

Ask the customer's administrator to disable the HDD encryption setting
with a user tool.

2.

Install the HDD encryption unit.

Log Data Error 3

-03

-



Invalid log encryption key due to defective NVRAM data

1.

Initialize the HDD with SP5832-004.

2.

Ask the customer's administrator to disable the HDD encryption setting
with a user tool.

Log Data Error 4
-04

-



Unusual HDD encryption function due to defective NVRAM data

Initialize the HDD with SP5832-004.
Log Data Error 5

-05

-



Installed a NVRAM or HDD which was used in another machine

1.

Reinstall the previous NVRAM or HDD.

2.

Initialize the HDD with SP5832-004.

Log Data Error 99
-99

-



Other than the above causes

Ask your supervisor.
D129/D130

6-62

SM

Service Call Conditions

HDD DataOverwriteSecurity SD card error
The 'all delete' function cannot be executed but the DataOverwriteSecurity
Unit is installed and activated.
877

878

B

D



Defective SD card



SD card not installed

1.

Replace the NVRAM and then install the new SD card.

2.

Check and reinstall the SD card.

USB Flash Error
TPM system authentication error
The system firmware is not authenticated by TPM (security chip).

-00

-



Incorrect updating for the system firmware



Defective flash ROM on the controller board

Replace the controller board.
USB Flash Error
File system in the USB flash device is defective.
-



Cannot mount partition 3 in the USB flash device.



Encryption key does not exist.



Cannot find the file for KMMD to be operated.
Troubleshooting

-01

Replace the controller board.
TPM Error
An error occurred in TPM or in TPM driver.
-02



TPM defective

Replace the controller board.

SM

6-63

D129/D130

Service Call Conditions

TCSD Error
An error occurred in TPM or in TPM driver.
-03



TPM defective

Replace the controller board.

File Format Converter (MLB) error
880

B

A request to get access to the MLB is not answered within the specified time.


MLB defective, replace the MLB

Authentication area error

881

D

Authentication application error is detected.


Error data in an authentication application reaches the management
limit.

Software performance error
If the processing program shows abnormal performance and the program is
899

D

D129/D130

abnormally ended, this SC is issued.


Controller board defective



Software defective

6-64

SM

Service Call Conditions

SC Tables: SC9xx

Electrical total counter error
The total counter contains something that is not a number.
900

920

D

B



NVRAM incorrect type



NVRAM defective



NVRAM data scrambled



Unexpected error from external source

Printer error

-01

Timeout error during the PM operation

-02

Working memory error
-

-03

Cannot start-up the filtering process

-04

Abnormal exit from the filtering process
An internal application error was detected and operation cannot continue.

-

-



Software defective; turn the machine off/on, or change the controller
firmware
Insufficient memory

921

D

Printer font error

-01

-

Resident font is not found

-02

-

Option font is not found

Troubleshooting



A necessary font is not found in the SD card.
-

SM

-



A necessary font is not found in the SD card.



The SD card data is corrupted.

6-65

D129/D130

Service Call Conditions

925

B

Net File function error

-00

-

HDD is defective

-01

-

NetFile management file is broken
The NetFile file management on the HDD cannot be used, or a NetFile
management file is corrupted and operation cannot continue. The HDDs are
defective and they cannot be debugged or partitioned, so the Scan Router

-

-

functions (delivery of received faxes, document capture, etc.), Web
services, and other network functions cannot be used.
HDD status codes are displayed below the SC code.


Refer to the four procedures below (Recovery from SC 925).

Here is a list of HDD status codes:

Display

Meaning

(-1)

HDD not connected

(-2)

HDD not ready

(-3)

No label

(-4)

Partition type incorrect

(-5)

Error returned during label read or check

(-6)

Error returned during label read or check

(-7)

"filesystem" repair failed

(-8)

"filesystem" mount failed

(-9)

Drive does not answer command

(-10)

Internal kernel error

(-11)

Size of drive is too small

(-12)

Specified partition does not exist

D129/D130

6-66

SM

Service Call Conditions

Display
(-13)

Meaning
Device file does not exist

Recovery from SC 925
Procedure 1
If the machine shows SC codes for HDD errors (SC860 to SC865) with SC 925, do the recovery
procedures for SC860 to SC865.
Procedure 2
If the machine does not show one of the five HDD errors (SC860 to SC865), turn the machine
power off and on. If this is not the solution for the problem, then initialize the NetFile partition on
the HDD with SP5832-011 (HDD Formatting – Ridoc I/F).
NetFiles: Jobs printed from the document server using a PC and DeskTopBinder


Before you initialize the NetFile partition on the HDD, tell the customer that:



Received faxes on the delivery server will be erased



All captured documents will be erased



DeskTopBinder/Print Job Manager/Desk Top Editor job history will be erased



Documents on the document server, and scanned documents, will not be erased.



The first time that the network gets access to the machine, the management information
must be configured again (this will use a lot of time).

Before you initialize the Netfile partition with SP5832-011, do these steps:
1.

Go into the User Tools mode and do "Delivery Settings" to print all received fax documents

2.

In the User Tools mode, do Document Management> Batch Delete Transfer Documents.

3.

Do SP5832-011, then turn the machine power off and on.

Procedure 3
If "Procedure 2" is not the solution for the problem, do SP5832-001 (HDD Formatting – All), then
turn the machine power off and on.
SP5832-001 erases all document and address book data on the hard disks. Ask the customer
before you do this SP code.

SM

6-67

D129/D130

Troubleshooting

that are scheduled for delivery. Then erase them.

Service Call Conditions

Procedure 4
If "Procedure 3" is not the solution for the problem, replace the HDD.

Software error 1

990

D

The software performs an unexpected function and the program cannot
continue.


Software defective, re-boot

Software error 2

991

C

The software performs an unexpected function. However, unlike SC990,
recovery processing allows the program to continue.


Software defective, re-boot

In order to get more details about SC990 and SC991:
1) Execute SP7403 or print an SMC Report (SP5990) to read the history of the 10 most recent
logged errors.
2) If you press the zero key on the operation panel with the SP selection menu displayed, you
will see detailed information about the recently logged SC990 or SC991, including the software
file name, line number, and so on.


1) is the recommended method, because another SC could write over the information
for the previous SC.

Undefined error
992

D

Defective software program


An error undetectable by any other SC code occurred

Application Item Error

994

C

The number of executed application items on the operation panel reach
the maximum limit for the operation panel structure.


D129/D130

Too much executed application items

6-68

SM

Service Call Conditions

995

-01

D

CPM setting error

-



Defective BCU



NVRAM Replacement error

1.

Install the previous NVRAM.

2.

Input the serial number with SP5811-003, and turn the main power
switch off/on.

-02

-



Defective NVRAM



Defective controller

1.

Update the controller firmware.

2.

Install a new NVRAM, and turn off and on the main power switch after
SC995-002 has occurred.

-03

-04

-



Incorrect type controller installed



Defective controller

1.

Replace the controller with the correct type.



Incorrect model controller installed.

1.

Replace the controller with the correct model.

-

Software Error 3: Cannot select application function
An application does not start after the user pushed the correct key on the
B

operation panel.


Software bug



A RAM or DIMM option necessary for the application is not installed
or not installed correctly.

SM

6-69

D129/D130

Troubleshooting

997

Service Call Conditions

Software Error 4: Application cannot start
Register processing does not operate for an application within 60 s after
the machine power is turned on. No applications start correctly, and all
998

D

end abnormally.


Software bug



A RAM or DIMM option necessary for the application is not installed
or not installed correctly.

D129/D130

6-70

SM

Electrical Component Defects

6.2 ELECTRICAL COMPONENT DEFECTS
6.2.1 SENSORS

Component
(Symbol)

CN

Condition

By-pass Paper

236-2

Open

Length Sensor

(IOB)

Shorted

Duplex Entrance

217-A8 (IOB)

Duplex Cover

Duplex Exit

Symptom

Paper size error

Open

Jam Z

Shorted

Jam Z

217-A11

Open

"Open Cover" is displayed.

(IOB)

Shorted

“Open cover" cannot be detected.

217-A14

Open

Jam Z

(IOB)

Shorted

am Z (Jam 1)
The Paper End indicator lights

Open

even if paper is placed on the
by-pass tray.

By-pass Paper End

217-B3 (IOB)
Shorted

light even if there is no paper on
the by-pass tray.

217-B9,
By-pass Paper Size

Open

B10,B12,B13
(IOB)

Paper size error
Shorted
CPU cannot detect the toner
Open

Toner Overflow

overflow even the waste toner in

217-B15

the transfer belt unit is full.

(IOB)

CPU detects the toner overflow
Shorted

even the waste toner in the
transfer belt unit is not full.

SM

6-71

D129/D130

Troubleshooting

The Paper End indicator does not

Electrical Component Defects

Component
(Symbol)

CN

Condition

Symptom

No symptom, but this may cause
Paper Feed 1

216-A4 (IOB) Open/Shorted

Jam A, and some pieces of paper
are remaining at the paper feed
unit when tray 1 is opened.

Relay 1

Open

Jam A

Shorted

Jam A, B

216-A7 (IOB)

The Paper End indicator lights
Open
Paper End 1

even if paper is placed in the

216-A10

paper tray 1.

(IOB)

The Paper End indicator does not
Shorted

light even if there is no paper in
the paper tray 1.

Tray Lift 1

216-A13

Open/

(IOB)

Shorted

SC501 is displayed.

No symptom, but this may cause
Paper Feed 2

216-B4 (IOB)

Open/

Jam A and some pieces of paper

Shorted

are remaining at the paper feed
unit when tray 2 is opened.

Relay 2

Open

Jam A

Shorted

Jam A, B

216-B7 (IOB)

The Paper End indicator lights
Open
Paper End 2

even if paper is placed in the

216-B10

paper tray 2.

(IOB)

The Paper End indicator does not
Shorted

light even if there is no paper in
the paper tray 2.

D129/D130

6-72

SM

Electrical Component Defects

(Symbol)

Tray Lift 2

Registration

Paper Size 1

Paper Size 2

Lower Paper Height
1
Lower Paper Height
2
Upper Paper Height
1
Upper Paper Height
2

Junction Jam

Paper Exit

Fusing Exit

SM

CN

Condition

216-B13

Open/

(IOB)

Shorted

Symptom

SC502 is displayed.

Open

Jam A (Jam 8, 17)

Shorted

Jam A, B (Jam 1)

209-2 (IOB)

209-4, 5, 5, 8 Open/
(IOB)

Shorted

209-9, 10,

Open/

11, 13 (IOB)

Shorted

210-4 (IOB)

210-7 (IOB)

210-12 (IOB)

210-15 (IOB)

Paper size error in tray 1

Paper size error in tray 2

Open/
Shorted

Remaining paper volume in tray 2

Open/

on the LCD is wrong.

Shorted
Open/
Shorted

Remaining paper volume in tray 1

Open/

on the LCD is wrong.

Shorted

221-A10

Open/

(IOB)

Shorted

Jam C

Open

Jam C

Shorted

Jam C

Open

Jam C

Shorted

Jam C

Troubleshooting

Component

221-B2 (IOB)

221-B5 (IOB)

6-73

D129/D130

Electrical Component Defects

Component
(Symbol)

CN

Condition

Symptom

Paper overflow message is not
Open

displayed when a paper overflow
condition exists.

Paper Overflow

221-B8 (IOB)
Paper overflow message is
Shorted

displayed when a paper overflow
condition does not exist.
The add toner indicator blinks

Open
TD (Toner Density)

even if there is toner in the

213-14 (IOB)

development unit.
Shorted

CPU detects the web end even

Open
Web End

the web is not used up.

208-16 (IOB)
Shorted

ID (Image Density)

SC390 is displayed.

CPU cannot detect the web end
even the web is used up.

Open

SC350 is displayed after copying.

Shorted

SC351 is displayed after copying.

208-11 (IOB)

CPU cannot detect paper even a
Open

sheet of paper remains at the
fusing unit.

Fusing Entrance

208-8 (IOB)
CPU detects paper even a sheet
Shorted

of paper does not remain at the
fusing unit.

Scanner Home
Position

D129/D130

Open

SC121 is displayed.

Shorted

SC120 is displayed.

318-2 (SIO)

6-74

SM

Electrical Component Defects

Component

CN

(Symbol)

Condition

APS and ARE do not function

Open
Platen Cover

properly.

318-5 (SIO)
Shorted

Original Length 1

Original Length 2

Symptom

No symptom.
CPU cannot detect the original

313-2

Open/

(SIO)

Shorted

313-8

Open/

(SIO)

Shorted

size properly. APS and ARE do
not function correctly.
CPU cannot detect the original
size properly. APS and ARE do
not function correctly.

6.2.2 SWITCHES

(Symbol)

CN

Condition

"Open Cover" is displayed even if

Open
Right Door

the right door is closed.

221-B10
(IOB)
Shorted

Main Power

Symptom

The LCD goes blank when the
right door is opened.

903-1,2

Open

The machine does not turn on.

(PSU)

Shorted

The machine does not turn off.

Troubleshooting

Component

"Doors/Covers Open" is displayed
Open
Interlock

even if the front or right door is

913-1,2

closed.

(PSU)
Shorted

SM

6-75

The LCD goes blank when the
front or right door is opened.

D129/D130

Blown Fuse Conditions

6.3 BLOWN FUSE CONDITIONS


Use a correct rating fuse for the fuse replacement. Never use a wrong rating fuse. If do
so, the machine may be damaged.

Rating
Fuse

Symptom at power on
115V

210 to 230V

Power Supply Board
FU21

6.3A / 250V

6.3A / 250V

SC 533 (Power to IOB)

FU22

6.3A / 250V

6.3A / 250V

SC 144-02 (Power to SIO)

FU23

10A / 250V

10A / 250V

FU24

10A / 250V

10A / 250V

FU25

6.3A / 250V

6.3A / 250V

"Open Cover" is displayed.
(Power to Interlock Switch)
"Open Cover" is displayed.
(Power to Interlock Switch)
Alert LED turns on and operation panel does
not turn on. (Power to MB)
Stack paper in the optional paper feed unit or

FU26

6.3A / 250V

6.3A / 250V

LCT is not detected. SC 503 is issued after
opening and closing the tray 3 or 4. (Power
to optional PFU or LCT)
The machine does not detect a finisher.

FU27

6.3A / 250V

6.3 A/ 250V

FU101

15A / 250V

8A / 250V

No response

FU102

12A / 250V

4A / 250V

No response

D129/D130

(Power to optional Finisher)

6-76

SM

Fuses

6.4 FUSES

Part No.

Q'ty

FU11

11071229

1

FU21, 22, 25, 26, 27

11071295

5

FU23, 24

11071216

2

FU101

11071252

1

FU102

11071320

1

FU103, 12, 14

11071225

3

Troubleshooting

Fuse Address

SM

6-77

D129/D130

D129/D130
SERVICE MANUAL APPENDICES

D129/D130 APPENDICES
TABLE OF CONTENTS
1. APPENDIX: GENERAL SPECIFICATIONS ................................. 1-1
1.1 GENERAL SPECIFICATIONS ................................................................... 1-1
1.1.1 GENERAL ......................................................................................... 1-1
1.1.2 POWER CONSUMPTION ................................................................ 1-4
1.1.3 PRINTER CONTROLLER................................................................. 1-5
1.1.4 SCANNER SPECIFICATIONS ......................................................... 1-7
1.2 OPTIONAL EQUIPMENT........................................................................... 1-8
1.2.1 ARDF (D630) .................................................................................... 1-8
1.2.2 TWO-TRAY PAPER FEED UNIT (D580) .......................................... 1-9
1.2.3 LCT 2000-SHEET (D581) ................................................................. 1-9
1.2.4 LCT 1200-SHEET (D631) ............................................................... 1-10
1.2.5 1-BIN TRAY UNIT (D632) ............................................................... 1-10
1.2.6 SIDE TRAY (D635) ......................................................................... 1-11
1.2.7 INTERNAL SHIFT TRAY (D633) .................................................... 1-11
1.2.8 BRIDGE UNIT (D634) ..................................................................... 1-12
1.2.9 1000-SHEET FINISHER (D588) ..................................................... 1-12
Upper Tray ......................................................................................... 1-12
Lower Tray ......................................................................................... 1-13
1.2.10
3000-SHEET FINISHER (D636) .............................................. 1-14
1.2.11
2000-SHEET BOOKLET FINISHER (D637) ............................ 1-16
1.2.12
PUNCH UNIT FOR 2000/3000-SHEET (BOOKLET) FINISHER1-18

2. APPENDIX: PM TABLES .............................................................. 2-1
2.1 PM TABLES ............................................................................................... 2-1
2.1.1 MAINFRAME .................................................................................... 2-1
2.1.2 OPTIONS.......................................................................................... 2-5
ARDF ................................................................................................... 2-6
PFU ...................................................................................................... 2-6
LCT ...................................................................................................... 2-7
SR5020 ................................................................................................ 2-7
2000/3000-Sheet (Booklet) Finisher ..................................................... 2-8
SM Appendix

i

D129/D130

Rev. 11/15/2012

Bridge Unit ........................................................................................... 2-8
1-Bin Tray Unit ..................................................................................... 2-9

3. APPENDIX: SERVICE PROGRAM MODE TABLES ................... 3-1
3.1 SYSTEM SP TABLE-1 ............................................................................... 3-1
3.1.1 SP1-XXX: FEED ............................................................................... 3-1
3.2 SYSTEM SP TABLES-2 .......................................................................... 3-17
3.2.1 SP2-XXX: DRUM ............................................................................ 3-17
3.3 SYSTEM SP TABLE-3 ............................................................................. 3-43
3.3.1 SP3-XXX: PROCESS ..................................................................... 3-43
3.4 SYSTEM SP TABLES-4 .......................................................................... 3-46
3.4.1 SP4-XXX: SCANNER ..................................................................... 3-46
3.5 SYSTEM SP TABLES-5 .......................................................................... 3-79
3.5.1 SP5-XXX: MODE ............................................................................ 3-79
3.6 SYSTEM SP TABLES-6 ........................................................................ 3-165
3.6.1 SP6-XXX: PERIPHERALS............................................................ 3-165
3.7 SYSTEM SP TABLES-7 ........................................................................ 3-176
3.7.1 SP7-XXX: DATA LOG................................................................... 3-176
3.8 SYSTEM SP TABLES-8 ........................................................................ 3-197
3.8.1 SP8-XXX: DATA LOG 2................................................................ 3-197
3.9 INPUT CHECK....................................................................................... 3-251
3.9.1 COPIER ........................................................................................ 3-251
Table 1: Paper Height Sensor .......................................................... 3-254
Table 2: Paper Size Switch .............................................................. 3-255
Table 3: Paper Size (By-pass Table) ............................................... 3-256
APS Original Size Detection............................................................. 3-257
3.9.2 OPTIONS...................................................................................... 3-258
3000/2000-Sheet (Booklet) Finisher (D636/D637) ........................... 3-258
1000-Sheet Finisher (D588) ............................................................. 3-261
3.10 OUTPUT CHECK ............................................................................. 3-263
3.10.1
COPIER ................................................................................. 3-263
3.10.2
1000-SHEET FINISHER (D588) ............................................ 3-268
3.10.3
3000 /2000-SHEET (BOOKLET) FINISHER (D636/D637)..... 3-269
3.11 PRINTER SERVICE TABLES .......................................................... 3-271
3.11.1
SP1-XXX (SERVICE MODE) ................................................. 3-271
3.12 SCANNER SERVICE TABLE........................................................... 3-282
3.12.1
SP TABLES ........................................................................... 3-282
3.13 DETAILED DESCRIPTION OF SP5-749 ......................................... 3-284

D129/D130

ii

SM Appendix

APPENDIX:
SPECIFICATIONS
R E V I S I O N H I S T O RY
Pag e

Date

Ad d ed / Upd ated / New
None

General Specifications

Appendix:
Specifications

1. APPENDIX: GENERAL SPECIFICATIONS
1.1 GENERAL SPECIFICATIONS
1.1.1 GENERAL

Configuration

Desktop

Copy Process

Dry electrostatic transfer system

Original

Sheet, book, three-dimensional object

Original Size

Maximum A3/11" x 17"
A3/11" x 17" - A5 LEF
Paper trays:

Non-standard sizes:
Width: 182 - 297 mm (7.2" - 11.7")
Length: 148 mm - 432 mm (5.8" - 17")
12" x 18"/305 x 457.2 mm,
A3/11" x 17" - A6 SEF

Copy Paper Size

By-pass tray:

Non-standard sizes:
Width: 90 - 305 mm (3.6" - 12")
Length: 148 - 600 mm (5.8" - 23.6")
A3/11" x 17" - A6 SEF

Duplex:

Non-standard sizes:
Width: 90 - 297 mm (3.6" - 11.7")
Length: 148 - 432 mm (5.8" - 17")

Copy Paper Weight

SM Appendix

Paper trays:

60 - 216 g/m 2 (16 lb. Bond - 80 lb. Cover)

By-pass:

52 - 220 g/m 2 (14 lb. Bond - 80 lb. Cover)

Duplex:

60 - 169 g/m 2 (16 lb. Bond - 90 lb. Index)

1-1

D129/D130

General Specifications

Metric version (%): 400, 200, 141, 122, 115,
7R5E:
Reproduction Ratios

93, 82, 75, 71, 65, 50, 25
Inch version (%): 400, 200, 155, 129, 121, 93,
85, 78, 73, 65, 50, 25

Zoom:

25 to 400% in 1% steps

D129

40 cpm A4, 81/2" x 11" LEF, 1-to-1 (ADF)

D130

50 cpm, A4, 81/2" x 11" LEF, 1-to-1 (ADF)

Basic

4.1 s, 1st Tray, A4/81/2" x 11" LEF

SP

3.5 s, 1st Tray, A4/81/2" x 11" LEF

Basic

Less than 14.7s

SP

Less than 19 s

Copying Speed

First Copy Time

Warm-up Time

Continuous Copy

1 to 999 (operation panel entry)

Paper Capacity

1,200 sheets

(without options)

(550 sheets/tray x 2 with 100 sheets in the by-pass tray)

Paper Capacity (with
options)

4,400 sheets
(550 sheets/tray x 2 with 100 sheets in the by-pass tray,
1200-sheet LCT and 2000-sheet LCT)
A4, 81/2" x 11" and

Paper Output

Power Source

smaller:

500 sheets

B4 and larger:

250 sheets

North America:

120 – 127V/60 Hz, 12 A

Europe/Asia:

220 – 240 V/50, 60 Hz, 7 A

Taiwan

110V/60Hz, 14 A

Without ADF

670 mm x 682 mm x 760 mm (26.4" x
26.9" x 30.0")

Dimensions (w x d x h)
With ADF

D129/D130

670 mm x 682 mm x 895 mm (26.3" x
26.9" x 35.3")

1-2

SM Appendix

EU

Less than 85 kg (187.4 lb.)

NA

Less than 97 kg (213.9 lb.)

Appendix:
Specifications

General Specifications

Weight

Resolution

600 dpi (Scanning and Printing)

Gradation

256 levels (Scanning and Printing)

Original Archive

More than 2,500 A4 pages for document server (ITU-T No. 4
Chart)

Toner Replenishment

Cartridge exchange (630 g)

Total Counter

Electric counter

Noise Emission:
Copying

Noise Emission:
Stand-by

SM Appendix

Mainframe Only

Full System

D129

64.6 dB(A)

71.1 dB(A)

D130

66.4 dB(A)

71.6 dB(A)

Mainframe Only

Full System

D129

33.8 dB(A)

34.0 dB(A)

D130

32.6 dB(A)

33.6 dB(A)

1-3

D129/D130

General Specifications

1.1.2 POWER CONSUMPTION

Basic

D129

D130

NA

156 W

NA

165 W

EU, Asia

157 W

EU, Asia

166 W

NA

745 W

NA

835 W

EU, Asia

742 W

EU, Asia

849 W

NA

1490 W

NA

1490 W

EU, Asia

1460W

EU, Asia

1460 W

Ready

Operating

Maximum

SP

D129

D130

NA

160 W

NA

167 W

EU, Asia

159 W

EU, Asia

172 W

NA

736 W

NA

828 W

EU, Asia

754 W

EU, Asia

864 W

NA

1490 W

NA

1490 W

EU, Asia

1460W

EU, Asia

1460 W

Ready

Operating

Maximum

Full System

D129

D130

NA

1584 W

NA

1584 W

EU, Asia

1550 W

EU, Asia

1550 W

Maximum



The above measurements were made in accordance with ISO 7779.



In the above "Panel Off" condition, the polygonal mirror motor is not rotating.

D129/D130

1-4

SM Appendix

Appendix:
Specifications

General Specifications

1.1.3 PRINTER CONTROLLER

PCL 6/5e
PDF Direct
Printer Languages:

Adobe PostScript 3 (optional)
IPDS (optional)
MediaPrint: JPEG/TIFF
PCL 5e:
300 x 300 dpi
600 x 600 dpi : Fast (1-bit)
PCL 6:
600 x 600 dpi : Fast (1-bit)

Resolution and
Gradation:

PDF Direct:
300 x 300 dpi/600 x 600 dpi
PS3:
300 x 300 dpi/600 x 600 dpi
XPS:
600 x 600 dpi : Fast (1-bit)
IPDS:
300 x 300 dpi/ 600 x 600 dpi

Printing speed:

D129: Maximum 40 ppm (A4/LT LEF)
D130: Maximum 50 ppm (A4/LT LEF)
PCL 6/5e (Standard): 45 Compatible fonts, 13 International fonts,

Resident Fonts:

6 Bitmap fonts
PDF Direct: 136 fonts
IPDS (Optional): 108 fonts
USB2.0 Type A and Type B: Standard
Ethernet (100 Base-TX/10 Base-T): Standard

Host Interfaces:

Gigabit Ethernet (1000 Base-T): Optional
IEEE1284 parallel x 1: Optional
IEEE802.11a/b/g (Wireless LAN): Optional
Bluetooth (USB type): Optional

SM Appendix

1-5

D129/D130

General Specifications

Network Protocols:

TCP/IP (IPv4, IPv6), IPX/SPX
Maximum
Basic model: 512 MB

RAM:

SP model: 1024 MB (Resident 512 MB + Additional 512)


Additional 512 MB is required for all printer/scanner unit
and printer units.

D129/D130

1-6

SM Appendix

Appendix:
Specifications

General Specifications

1.1.4 SCANNER SPECIFICATIONS

Standard Scanner

Main scan/Sub scan

Resolution:

100 to 600 dpi
Twain Mode:

Available scanning

100 to 1200 dpi

Resolution Range:

Delivery Mode:
100/200/300/400/600 dpi

Grayscales:

Scanning
Throughput
(ARDF mode):

Interface:

1 bit or 8 bits/pixel each for RGB
BW: 61 ipm (A4LEF / BW Text/ Photo / 200dpi /Compression: On
(MH))
FC: 31 ipm (A4LEF / FC Text / Photo / 200dpi / Compression:
Standard)
Ethernet 10Base-T / 100Base-TX, Gigabit Ethernet (1000Base-T),
Wireless LAN (IEEE 802.11a/b/g)

Compression

B&W: TIFF (MH, MR, MMR, JBIG2)

Method:

Gray Scale/Full Color: JPEG

Video Memory
Capacity:

109.41 MB (A4, Full Color, 600dpi)

Number of originals per file: Maximum 1,000 pages
Image Storage

Maximum of files: 3,000 files

Capacity:

Storage on Doc.Server: Maximum 9,000 pages (B&W (ITU-T
No.1/200 dpi MMR)

SM Appendix

1-7

D129/D130

Optional Equipment

1.2 OPTIONAL EQUIPMENT
1.2.1 ARDF (D630)

Size

A3 to A5, DLT to HLT

Weight

40 to 128 g/m 2 (11 to 34 lb.)

Size

A3 to A5, DLT to HLT

Weight

52 to 128 g/m 2 (14 to 34 lb.)

Simplex
Paper Size/Weight:
Duplex

Table Capacity:

100 sheets (81.4 g/m 2, 22 lb)

Original Standard Position:

Rear left corner

Separation:

Feed belt and separation roller

Original Transport:

Roller transport

Original Feed Order:

From the top original

Supported Magnification
Ratios:

32 to 200 %

Power Source:

DC 24V, 5V from the scanner unit

Power Consumption:

Less than 70W

Dimensions (W x D x H):

570 mm x 520 mm x 135 mm (22.4"x20.5"x5.3")

Weight:

Less than 12kg (26.5 lb.)

D129/D130

1-8

SM Appendix

Appendix:
Specifications

Optional Equipment

1.2.2 TWO-TRAY PAPER FEED UNIT (D580)

Paper Feed System:

FRR

Paper Height Detection:

5 steps (100%, 70%, 30%, 10% (Near end), and Empty)

Capacity:

550 sheets x 2 trays

Paper Weight:

60 to 216 g/m 2 (16 to 80 lb. Cover)

Paper Size:

A3 SEF to A5, DLT SEF to HLT

Power Source:

DC 24V, 5V (from the main frame)

Power Consumption:

Less than 40 W (Max.)/ Less than 25 W (Ave,)

Dimensions (W x D x H):

580 mm x 629 mm x 260 mm (22.8" x 24.8" x 10.2")

Weight:

26 kg (57.3 lb.)

1.2.3 LCT 2000-SHEET (D581)

Paper Size:

A4 LEF/LT LEF

Paper Weight:

60 g/m 2 to 216 g/m 2, 16 lb. Bond to 80 lb. Cover

Tray Capacity:

2,000 sheets (80 g/m 2, 20 lb. Bond)

Remaining Paper Detection:

5 steps (100%, 70%, 30%, 10%, Empty): Right Tray
4 steps (100%, 70%, 30%, Empty): Left Tray

Power Source:

DC 24 V, 5 V (from copier/printer)

Power Consumption:

45 W (Max.)/27 W (Ave.)

Dimensions (W x D x H):

580 mm x 620 mm x 260 mm (22.8" x 24.4" x 10.2")

Weight:

26 kg (57.3 lb.)

SM Appendix

1-9

D129/D130

Optional Equipment

1.2.4 LCT 1200-SHEET (D631)

Paper Size:

A4 LEF/ LT LEF/ B5 LEF

Paper Weight:

60 g/m 2 to 216 g/m 2, 16 lb. Bond to 80 lb. Cover

Tray Capacity:

1200 sheets (80 g/m 2, 20lb. Bond)

Remaining Paper Detection:

5 steps (100%, 75%, 30%, 10%, End)

Power Source:

DC 24 V, 5 V (from copier/printer)

Power Consumption:

55 W (Max)/ 25 W (Ave.)

Dimensions (W x D x H):

348 mm x 540 mm x 290 mm (13.7" x 21.3" x 11.4")

Weight:

14 kg (30.8 lb.)

1.2.5 1-BIN TRAY UNIT (D632)

Paper Size:

Standard Size:
A3 /DLT to A6/ HLT SEF

Paper Weight:

60 to 169 g/m 2, 16 to 45 lb. Bond

Tray Capacity:

125 sheets (80 g/m 2, 20 lb. Bond, A4)

Power Source:

DC 24 V, 5 V (from the copier)

Power Consumption:

12 W or less

Dimensions (W x D x H):

565 mm x 410 mm x 115 mm (22.3"x16.2"x4.6")

Weight:

2 .5 kg (5.6 lb.)

D129/D130

1-10

SM Appendix

Appendix:
Specifications

Optional Equipment

1.2.6 SIDE TRAY (D635)

Paper Size:

Paper Weight:

Standard Size:
A3 /DLT to A6/ HLT SEF
52 to 300 g/m 2, 14 lb. Bond to 110 lb. Cover
Internal tray:
250 sheets (80 g/m 2, 20 lb. Bond, A4/LT or smaller)

Tray Capacity:

125 sheets (80 g/m 2, 20 lb. Bond, B4, LG or larger)
External tray:
125 sheets (80 g/m 2, 20 lb. Bond)

Power Source:

DC 24 V, 5 V (from the copier)

Power Consumption:

20 W or less

Dimensions (W x D x H):

780 mm x 412 mm x 138 mm (30.8"x16.3"x5.5")

Weight:

4.5 kg (10.0 lb.)

1.2.7 INTERNAL SHIFT TRAY (D633)

Paper Size:

Paper Weight:

Tray Capacity:

Standard Size:
A3 /DLT to A6/ HLT SEF
52 to 160 g/m 2, 14 lb. Bond to 60 lb. Cover
250 sheets (80 g/m 2, 20 lb. Bond, A4/LT or smaller)
125 sheets (80 g/m 2, 20 lb. Bond, B4, LG or larger)

Power Source:

DC 24 V, 5 V (from the copier)

Power Consumption:

10 W or less

Dimensions (W x D x H):

432 mm x 468 mm x 114 mm (16.7"x18.5"x4.5")

Weight:

2 kg (4.5 lb.)

SM Appendix

1-11

D129/D130

Optional Equipment

1.2.8 BRIDGE UNIT (D634)

Paper Weight:

Tray Capacity:

52 g/m 2 to 256 g/m 2, 16 lb. Bond to 68 lb. Bond
250 sheets (80 g/m 2, 20 lb. Bond, A4/LT or smaller)
125 sheets (80 g/m 2, 20 lb. Bond, B4, LG or larger)

Power Source:

DC 24 V, 5 V (form the copier/printer)

Power Consumption:

20 W or less

Dimensions (W x D x H):

415 mm x 412 mm x 111 mm (16.3" x 16.2" x 4.4")

Weight

4 kg (8.9 lb.)

1.2.9 1000-SHEET FINISHER (D588)
Upper Tray

Paper Size:

Paper Weight:

Paper Capacity:

D129/D130

12" x 18"/305 x 457.2 mm, A3 to A6, 11" x 17" to 5.5" x
8.5"
52 to 256 g/m 2 (14 to 68 lb. Bond)
250 sheets (A4, LT or smaller)
50 sheets (B4, LG or larger)

1-12

SM Appendix

Appendix:
Specifications

Optional Equipment

Lower Tray

No staple mode:
12" x 18"/305 x 457.2 mm, A3 to B5, DLT to HLT

Paper Size:

Staple mode:
12" x 18"/305 x 457.2 mm, A3, B4, A4, B5, DLT to LT
No staple mode: 52 to 160 g/m 2 (14 lb. Bond to 60 lb.

Paper Weight:

Cover)
Staple mode: 64 to 90 g/m 2 (17 to 24 lb. Bond)

Stapler Capacity:

50 sheets (A4, B5, LT)
30 sheets (A3, B4, DLT, LG)
No staple mode:
1,000 sheets (A4/LT or smaller: 80 g/m 2, 20 lb.)
500 sheets (B4 /LG or larger: 80 g/m 2, 20 lb.)
Staple mode: (80 g/m 2, 20 lb., number of sets)

Paper Capacity:

Paper Size

Sheets

Sets

A4,/LT LEF, B5 LEF

2 to 9

100

A4,/LT LEF,

10 to 50

100 to 20

A4,/LT LEF, B5 LEF

10 to 50

50 to 10

A3, B4, DLT, LG

2 to 9

50

A3, B4, DLT, LG

10 to 30

50 to 10

Staple positions:

Top, Bottom, 2 Staples

Staple Replenishment:

Cartridge (5,000 staples/cartridge)

Power Source:

DC 24 V, 5 V (from the copier/printer)

Power Consumption:

50 W

Weight:

25 kg (55.2 lbs)

Dimensions

SM Appendix

(W x D x H):

520 x 520 x 790 mm (20.5" x 20.5" x 31.2")

1-13

D129/D130

Optional Equipment

1.2.10 3000-SHEET FINISHER (D636)

Finisher
Dimension (w x d x h)

657 mm x 613 mm x 960 mm (25.9" x 24.2" x 37.8")
Less than 54 kg (119 lb.) (no punch unit)

Weight

Less than 56 kg (123.5 lb.) (with punch unit)

Power Consumption

Less than 96 W

Noise

Less than 75 db

Configuration

Console type attached base-unit

Power Source

From base-unit

Stack Capacity

Proof Tray

Paper Size

Paper Weight

250 sheets: A4, 8.5" x 11" or smaller
50 sheets: B4, 8.5" x 14 or larger
A6 SEF, B6 SEF, A5-A3 SEF,
5.5" x 8.5"-11" x 17" SEF, 12" x 18" SEF
52 g/m 2 - 160 g/m 2 (14 lb. Bond - 60 lb. Cover)
3,000 sheets

A4 LEF, 8.5" x 11" LEF
A3 SEF, A4 SEF, B4 SEF, B5, 11" x

1,500 sheets
Stack Capacity

100 sheets

Paper Size

Paper Weight

SEF,
12" x 18" SEF

500 sheets

Shift Tray

17" SEF, 8.5" x 14" SEF, 8.5" x 11"

A5 LEF
A5 SEF, B6 SEF, A6 SEF,
5.5" x 8.5" SEF

A5 - A3 SEF, A6 SEF, B6 SEF, 5.5" x 8.5"- 11" x 17"
SEF, 12" x 18" SEF
52 g/m 2 - 256 g/m 2 (14 lb. Bond - 68 lb. Bond)

Staples

D129/D130

1-14

SM Appendix

Optional Equipment

8.5" x 11" - 11" x 17", 12" x 18"

Paper Weight

64 g/m 2 - 90 g/m 2 (17 lb. Bond - 20 lb. Bond)

Staple Position

Top, Bottom, 2 Staple, Top-slant

Stapling
Capacity

Appendix:
Specifications

B5 - A3

Paper Size

Same Paper

50 sheets

A4, 8.5" x 11" or smaller

Size

30 sheets

B4, 8.5" x 14" or larger

Mixed Paper

30 sheets

Size

Staple Replenishment

A4 LEF + A3 SEF, B5 LEF + B4 SEF,
8.5" x11" LEF + 11" x 17" SEF

Cartridge exchange / 5000 pins per cartridge
Paper Size

Pages/Set

Sets

20 - 50 pages

150 - 60 sets

2 - 19 pages

150 sets

A4 SEF, B5, 8.5" x 11"

15 - 50 pages

100 - 30 sets

SEF

2 - 14 pages

100 sets

15 - 30 pages

100 - 33 sets

2 - 14 pages

100 sets

2 - 30 pages

50 set

A4 LEF, 8.5" x 11" LEF
Stapled Stack Capacity
(same size)

Others

Stapled Stack Capacity
(mixed sizes)

SM Appendix

A4 LEF & A3 SEF, B5
LEF & B4 SEF, 8.5" x11"
LEF & 11" x 17" SEF,

1-15

D129/D130

Optional Equipment

1.2.11 2000-SHEET BOOKLET FINISHER (D637)

Finisher
Dimension W x D x H

657 mm x 613 mm x 960 mm (25.9 x 24.2 x 37.8")
Less than 63 kg (138.6 lb.) (no punch unit)

Weight

Less than 65 kg (143 lb.) (with punch unit)

Power Consumption

Less than 96 W

Noise

Less than 75 db

Configuration

Console type attached base-unit

Power Source

From base-unit

Stack Capacity

Proof Tray

Paper Size

Paper Weight

250 sheets: A4, 8.5" x 11" or smaller
50 sheets: B4, 8.5" x 14 or larger
A6 SEF, B6 SEF, A5-A3 SEF,
5.5" x 8.5"-11" x 17" SEF, 12" x 18" SEF
52 g/m 2 - 160 g/m 2 (14 lb. Bond - 60 lb. Cover)
2,000

A4 LEF, 8.5" x 11" LEF

sheets

A3 SEF, A4 SEF, B4 SEF, B5

1,000
Stack Capacity

11" x 17" SEF, 8.5" x 14" SEF,

sheets

8.5" x 11" SEF, 12"x18" SEF

500 sheets A5 LEF

Shift Tray

100 sheets

Paper Size

Paper Weight

A5 SEF, B6 SEF, A6 SEF, 5.5" x 8.5"
SEF

A5 - A3 SEF, A6 SEF, B6 SEF
5.5" x 8.5" to 11" x 17" SEF, 12" x 18" SEF
52 g/m 2 - 256 g/m 2 (14 lb. Bond - 68 lb. Bond)

Staple
Paper Size
D129/D130

B5-A3, 8.5" x 11" - 11" x 17", 12" x 18"
1-16

SM Appendix

Paper Weight

64 g/m 2 - 90 g/m 2, 17 lb. Bond - 28 lb. Bond

Staple Position

Top, Bottom, 2 Staple, Top-slant
Same Paper

50 sheets

A4, 8.5" x 11" or smaller

Size

30 sheets

B4, 8.5" x 14" or larger

Mixed Paper
Staples Capacity

Size

Appendix:
Specifications

Optional Equipment

A4 LEF & A3 SEF, B5 LEF & B4
30 sheets

SEF, 8.5" x 11" LEF & 11" x 17"
SEF
A4 SEF, A3 SEF, B5 SEF, B4 SEF,

Booklet Stapling

15 sheets

8.5" x 11" SEF, 8.5" x 14" SEF,
11" x 17" SEF, 12" x 18" SEF

Corner staple

5,000 staples per
cartridge

Staple Replenishment
Booklet staple

2,000 staples per
cartridge
13 - 50 pages

A4 LEF, 8.5" x 11" LEF
2 - 12 pages
10 - 50 pages
Same Size

A4 SEF, B5, 8.5" x 11" SEF
2 - 9 pages

Corner Staple
Capacity

10 - 30 pages
Others
2 - 9 pages
A4 LEF + A3 SEF
Mixed Size

B5 LEF + B4 SEF

2 - 30 pages

8.5" x 11" LEF + 11" x 17" SEF

Booklet Staple
Capacity

SM Appendix

A4 SEF, A3 SEF, B5 SEF, B4 SEF
8.5" x 11" SEF, 8.5" x 14" SEF, 11" x 17" SEF
12" x 18" SEF

2 - 5 pages
6 - 10 pages
11 - 15 pages

1-17

D129/D130

Optional Equipment

1.2.12 PUNCH UNIT FOR 2000/3000-SHEET (BOOKLET) FINISHER

Available Punch Units

Punch Waste Replenishment

NA

2/3 holes switchable

EU

2/4 holes switchable

Scandinavia

4 holes

NA 2-holes

Up to 5,000 sheets

NA 3-holes

Up to 5,000 sheets

EU 2-holes

Up to 14,000 sheets

EU 4-holes

Up to 7,000 sheets

Scandinavia
4-holes

Up to 7,000 sheets

52 g/m 2 - 163 g/m 2, 14 lb Bond - 43 lb Bond

Paper Weight

SEF

A5 to A3, 5.5" x 8.5" to 11" x 17"

LEF

A5 to A4, 5.5" x 8.5" , 8.5" x 11"

SEF

A3, B4, 11" x 17"

LEF

A4, B5, 8.5" x 11"

SEF

A5 to A3, 5.5" x 8.5" to 11" x 17"

LEF

A5 to A4, 5.5" x 8.5", 8.5" x 11"

SEF

A3, B4, 11"x17"

LEF

A4, B5, 8.5" x 11"

Scandinavia

SEF

A5 to A3, 5.5" x 8.5" to 11" x 17"

4-holes

LEF

A5 to A4, 5.5" x 8.5", 8.5" x 11"

NA 2-holes

NA 3-holes

Paper Sizes EU 2-holes

EU 4-holes

D129/D130

1-18

SM Appendix

APPENDIX:
PREVENTIVE MAINTENANCE TABLES
R E V I S I O N H I S T O RY
P a ge

Date

1~9

8/21/2012

A d de d /U pd at e d /N ew
PM tables

PM Tables

Rev. 8/21/2012

2. APPENDIX: PM TABLES
2.1 PM TABLES
Appendix:
Preventive
Maintenance
Tables

Amounts mentioned as the PM interval indicate the number of prints.

2.1.1 MAINFRAME
Symbol key: C: Clean, R: Replace, L: Lubricate, I: Inspect

EM

160K

320K

800K

Note

Scanner/Optics
Reflector

C

Optics cloth

1st Mirror

C

Optics cloth

2nd Mirror

C

Optics cloth

3rd Mirror

C

Optics cloth

Scanner Guide Rails

C

Do not use alcohol.

Exposure Glass

C

C

Cleaner

Toner Shield Glass

C

C

Dry cloth or cleaner

C

Dry cloth

C

Cleaner

APS Sensor
Exposure Glass (Sheet
through)

⇒

LED Board

C

C

Drum (OPC) Area
OPC Drum
Charge Roller
Charge Roller Cleaning
Roller
Drum Cleaning Blade 1

SM Appendix

I

R
R

R

R

2-1

D129/D130

PM Tables

Rev. 08/21/2012

EM

⇒

Quenching Lamp

320K

800K

C

Pick-off Pawls

Note
Dry cloth

R

Spurs

C

C

ID Sensor

C

C

Cleaning Entrance Seal

⇒

160K

Dry cloth
Perform SP3-001-2 after
blower brush cleaning.
Blower brush.

C

Side Seal

Replace if required.

C

Development Unit
Development Drive

C

Gears
Development Filter

⇒
⇒

⇒
⇒
⇒

R

Developer
Entrance Seal

I
C

R
C

Side Seal

I

Development Roller

C

Development Case

C

Development Sleeve
Lock Lever

Dry cloth

Dry cloth

C
C

C

C

I

C

Paper Feed
Registration Roller

Water
Detach and tap gently on

Idle Roller Dust Blade

I

C

flat surface to empty.
Blower brush.

D129/D130

2-2

SM Appendix

PM Tables

Rev. 08/21/2012

160K

I

C

Blower brush.

Feed Rollers

I

C

Water

Pick-up Rollers

I

C

Water

Separation Rollers

I

C

Water

By-pass Feed Roller

I

C

Water

By-pass Pick-up Roller

I

C

Water

I

C

Water

Paper Feed Guides

I

C

Dry cloth

Relay Rollers

I

C

Water

Bottom Plate Pad

I

C

Water

I

C

Water

I

C

Blower brush

I

L

Silicone Grease G-501

Relay Sensors

I

C

Blower Brush

Paper Feed Sensors

I

C

Blower Brush

Inverter Rollers

I

C

Water

Transport Rollers

I

C

Water

Entrance Sensor

I

C

Water

Exit Sensor

I

C

Water

Registration Roller Dust
Blade

By-pass Separation
Roller

Bottom Plate Pad
(By-pass feed)
Registration Sensor
By-pass Feed Roller
Gear

320K

800K

Note

Appendix:
Preventive
Maintenance
Tables

EM

Duplex Unit

⇒
⇒
⇒
⇒

SM Appendix

2-3

D129/D130

PM Tables

Rev. 8/21/2012

EM

160K

320K

800K

Note

Transfer Belt Unit
Dry cloth.
To prevent damage to the
Transfer Belt

C

cleaning blade, always

R

replace these items
together.
Transfer Belt Cleaning

R

Blade

⇒

Transfer Belt Rollers

C

Dry cloth

Entrance Seal

C

Dry cloth

Transfer Entrance Guide

C

C

Dry cloth

Used Toner Tank

I

C

Empty the tank

Seal (for paper dust)

C

Paper Exit
Paper Exit Sensor

I

I

Blower brush

I

C

Blower brush

Fusing Exit Sensor

I

I

Blower brush

Paper Exit Rollers

I

I

Water

Junction Transport Roller

I

I

Water

Paper Exit Guide

I

I

Water

Junction Gate Jam
sensor

ƒ

Due to their durability and extended service life, the feed rollers, separation rollers, and
pick-up rollers of the mainframe, optional paper trays, and LCT are not replaced at PM.

*1

: Lubricate the by-pass feed clutch gear with Silicone Grease G501 every P.M.

D129/D130

2-4

SM Appendix

PM Tables

Rev. 8/21/2012

EM

160K

320K

800K

Note

Fusing Unit and Paper Exit

Exit Guide Plates

C

Hot Roller

R

Pressure Roller

R

Fusing Thermistors

R

Cleaning Roller
Bushings

Water or alcohol
Appendix:
Preventive
Maintenance
Tables

Fusing Entrance and

L

Hot Roller Strippers

Grease: Barrierta JFE 55/2

R

⇒
Web Supply Roller

R

Web Holder Roller

R

Brake Pad

R

2.1.2 OPTIONS
Amounts mentioned as the PM interval indicate the number of prints/ originals.
Symbol key: C: Clean, R: Replace, L: Lubricate, I: Inspect

SM Appendix

2-5

D129/D130

PM Tables

Rev. 8/21/2012

ARDF

⇒

D630

120K

EM

Note

(Originals)

ARDF (for originals)

⇒
⇒
⇒

Pick-up Roller

C

R

Damp cloth; alcohol

Feed Belt

C

R

Damp cloth; alcohol

Separation Roller

C

R

Damp cloth; alcohol

Sensors

C

Blower brush

Platen Sheet Cover

C

Damp cloth; alcohol (Replace if required.)

White Plate

C

Dry or damp cloth

Drive Gear

L

Grease G501

Transport Roller

C

Damp cloth; alcohol

Exit Roller

C

Damp cloth; alcohol

Inverter Roller

C

Damp cloth; alcohol

Idle Rollers

C

Damp cloth; alcohol

⇒ PFU
D580

EM

150K

300K

450K

Note

Paper Feed Unit
Relay Rollers

C

Dry or damp cloth

Bottom Plate Pad

C

Dry or damp cloth

Relay Sensors

C

Dry or damp cloth

Paper Feed Sensors

C

Dry or damp cloth

Paper Feed Rollers

C

Dry or damp cloth

D129/D130

2-6

SM Appendix

PM Tables

Rev. 08/21/2012

⇒ LCT
D581

EM

150K

300K

450K

Note

Bottom Plate Pad

C

Dry or damp cloth

Relay Rollers

C

Dry or damp cloth

Relay Sensors

C

Dry or damp cloth

Paper Feed Sensors

C

Dry or damp cloth

Paper Feed Rollers

C

Dry or damp cloth

D631

EM

150K

300K

450K

Appendix:
Preventive
Maintenance
Tables

LCT 2000-sheet

Note

LCT 1200-sheet
Bottom Plate Pad

C

Dry or damp cloth

Relay Rollers

C

Dry or damp cloth

Relay Sensors

C

Dry or damp cloth

Paper Feed Sensors

C

Dry or damp cloth

Paper Feed Rollers

C

Dry or damp cloth

B588

EM

150K

300K

450K

Note

1000-Sheet Finisher
Rollers

C

Discharge Brush

C

Sensors

C

Jogger Fences

I

SM Appendix

Water or alcohol.
C

Dry cloth
Blower brush

I

Replace if required.

2-7

D129/D130

PM Tables

Rev. 8/21/2012

2000/3000-Sheet (Booklet) Finisher

⇒

D637/D636

EM

Note

2000/3000-Sheet (Booklet) Finisher
Rollers

C

Water or alcohol.

Discharge Brush

C

Dry cloth

Sensors

C

Blower brush

Jogger Fences

I

Replace if required.

C

Discard chads.

Punch Unit
Punch Chads

Bridge Unit

⇒

D634

EM

Note

Bridge Unit
Rollers

C

Dry or damp cloth

Copy Tray

C

Dry or damp cloth

Sensors

C

Blower brush

D129/D130

2-8

SM Appendix

PM Tables

Rev. 8/21/2012

1-Bin Tray Unit

⇒

D632

EM

Note

Rollers

C

Dry or damp cloth

Copy Tray

C

Dry or damp cloth

Sensors

C

Blower brush

Appendix:
Preventive
Maintenance
Tables

1-Bin Tray Unit

Side Tray

⇒

D635

EM

Note

Side Tray
Rollers

C

Dry or damp cloth

Sensors

C

Blower brush

Shift Tray

⇒

D633

EM

Note

Shift Tray
Copy Tray

SM Appendix

C

Dry or damp cloth

2-9

D129/D130

APPENDIX:
SERVICE PROGRAM MODE TABLES
R E V I S I O N H I S T O RY
P a ge

Date

A d de d /U pd at e d /N ew

82

11/15/2012

SP5104 Default changed to 1 Blinks, added Note to SP5083

82 ~ 83

08/21/2012

SP5083 [LED Light Switch Setting - Toner Near End]

08/27/2012

Added SP5747 204 and 205.

105

System SP Table-1

3. APPENDIX: SERVICE PROGRAM MODE
TABLES
3.1 SYSTEM SP TABLE-1
3.1.1 SP1-XXX: FEED

1001*

Appendix:
Service
Program
Mode Tables

Leading Edge Registration:
Adjusts the leading edge registration by changing the registration clutch
operation timing.
001 Tray: Plain
002 Tray: Thick 1
003 Tray: Thick 2
004 By-pass: Plain
[–9 to 9/ 0 / 0.1 mm step]
005 By-pass: Thick 1
006 By-pass: Thick 2
007 Duplex: Plain
008 Duplex: Thick 1

SM Appendix

3-1

D129/D130

System SP Table-1

Side-to-Side Registration
1002*

Adjusts the side to side registration by changing the laser main scan start
position for each mode.
001 By-pass
002 Tray 1
003 Tray 2
004 Tray 3

[–4 to 4/ 0 / 0.1 mm step]

005 Tray 4
006 LCT
007 Duplex

Registration Buckle Adjustment
Adjusts the paper feed motor timing. Paper feed motor timing determines

1003*

the amount of paper buckle at Registration. (A "+" setting causes more
buckling.)
001 Tray 1: Plain
002 Tray 1: Thick 1
003 Tray 1: Thick 2
[-9 to 5 / -4 / 1 mm step]
004 Tray 2, 3, 4: Plain
005 Tray 2, 3, 4: Thick1
006 Tray 2, 3, 4: Thick2
007 By-pass: Plain
008 By-pass: Thick 1

[-9 to 5 / -2 /1 mm step]

009 By-pass: Thick 2
010 Duplex: Plain

[-9 to 5 / -4 / 1 mm step]

011 Duplex: Thick 1

[-9 to 5 / -3 / 1 mm step]

D129/D130

3-2

SM Appendix

System SP Table-1

012 LCT: Plain
013 LCT: Thick1

[-9 to 5 / -4 / 1 mm step]

014 LCT: Thick2

By-pass Paper Size Detection
1007*
Controls paper size detection for the by-pass feed table.

002 LG Detection

[-15 to 15 / 0 / 5 mm step]
Appendix:
Service
Program
Mode Tables

001 Detection Timing

[0 to 1 / 0 / 1]
0: LT SEF, 1: LG

Fusing Idling
Switches fusing idling on/off. When on, printing will not start until enough
time has elapsed so the hot roller can reach optimum temperature. This
1103*

ensures even heat on the hot roller.
Switch on if fusing on the 1st and 2nd copies is incomplete (this may occur if
the room is cold.). You must switch SP1103-1 ON before you set the fusing
interval with SP1103-2.
001 Enable Fusing Idling

0 = Off, 1 = On

002 Interval

[0 to 60 / 30 / 1 sec.]
Sets the machine to fusing idling only for 30
sec. for every job (when the original is set on
the ARDF, when the ARDF cover is opened,

003 Idling Time at Every Job

etc.) and the fusing unit has reached the
reload temperature (optimum temperature for
operation).
[0 to 30 / 0 / 1 sec.]
0: No idling done before a job.

SM Appendix

3-3

D129/D130

System SP Table-1

Fusing Temperature Control
On-Off/Phase
Selects the fusing temperature control method. After changing this setting,
be sure to turn the machine off and on again with the main power switch to
enable the new setting.
[0 to 1 / 0 / 1]
0: Normal (ON/OFF control). Allows full application from ac power supply to
bring the hot roller up to the target fusing temperature then shuts off.
Determines the on-time from the present temperature (detected by the
thermistor on the hot roller) and the temperature of 1 cycle before.
1: Phase (hysterisis) control. Sets the upper and lower limits for the
1104*

temperature; at the lower temperature the fusing lamp is on and at the
higher temperature the fusing lamp is off.
Change this setting to "0" only if the user has excessive electrical noise or
interference on the power supply line. Such interference can cause voltage
to drop when power is applied using the ON/OFF control method.
Interference can be caused by the general poor quality of the power supply
lines, or if the machine is sharing a power supply with other electrical
devices such as fluorescent lights. Before changing this setting, make sure
that the machine is connected to a power supply not shared by other
electrical equipment.


Selecting Phase control ("1") could cause the fusing temperature
control board to emit low pitched noise

Fusing Temperature Adjustment
Allows adjustment of the hot roller temperature at the center and ends of the
roller for the quality or thickness of the paper. The hot roller in this machine
has two fusing lamps: one heats the center of the roller, the other heats both
1105*

ends. Each fusing lamp can be adjusted separately.
The "re-load temperature" is the "print ready temperature". When the fusing
temperature exceeds this setting, the machine can operate. Do not set up a
re-load temperature (Re-load Temp. = Fusing. Temp – SP Value.) that is
higher than the SP1-105-2 setting.

D129/D130

3-4

SM Appendix

System SP Table-1

Roller Center
001

C1b/C1.5b: [100 to 170 / 140 / 1 deg]
C1c/C1.5c: [100 to 170 / 150 / 1 deg]

Adjusts the fusing temperature at the center of the hot roller.

Roller Ends
002

C1b/C1.5b: [100 to 170 / 145 / 1 deg]
C1c/C1.5c: [100 to 170 / 155 / 1 deg]

Adjusts the fusing temperature at the ends of the hot roller.
Re-load Temp. Minus: Roller Center

[0 to 60 / 0 / 1 deg]
Appendix:
Service
Program
Mode Tables

Sets the reload temperature for the center of the hot roller. This setting
depends on the target temperature.
003 Reload temp. = Target Temp – This SP Setting


Do not set a temperature that is higher than the setting for SP1105 1
(Roller Center: Trays)

Re-load Temp. Minus: Roller Ends

[0 to 60 / 0 / 1 deg]

Sets the reload temperature for the ends of the hot roller. This setting depends
on the target temperature.
004 Reload temp. = Target Temp – This SP Setting


Do not set a temperature that is higher than the setting for SP1105 2
(Roller Ends: Trays)

005 to The following SPs adjust the fusing temperature at the center or ends of the
022 hot roller for each paper type.

005 Roller Center: M-Thick

006 Roller Ends: M-Thick

C1b/C1.5b: [100 to 170 / 145 / 1 deg]
C1c/C1.5c: [100 to 170 / 155 / 1 deg]
C1b/C1.5b: [100 to 170 / 150 / 1 deg]
C1c/C1.5c: [100 to 170 / 160 / 1 deg]

007 Roller Center: Thick 1
[100 to 170 / 130 / 1 deg]
008 Roller Ends: Thick 1
009 Roller Center: Thick 2
[100 to 170 / 150/ 1 deg]
010 Roller Ends: Thick 2

SM Appendix

3-5

D129/D130

System SP Table-1

011 Roller Center: Thin

012 Roller Ends: Thin

013 Roller Center: OHP: Plain

C1b/C1.5b: [100 to 170 / 130 / 1 deg]
C1c/C1.5c: [100 to 170 / 140 / 1 deg]
C1b/C1.5b: [100 to 170 / 135 / 1 deg]
C1c/C1.5c: [100 to 170 / 145 / 1 deg]
[100 to 170 / 150/ 1 deg]

014 Roller Ends: OHP: Plain
[100 to 170 / 155/ 1 deg]
015 Roller Center: OHP: Thick
016 Roller Ends: OHP: Thick

017 Roller Center: Special 1

018 Roller Ends: Special 1

019 Roller Center: Special 2

020 Roller Ends: Special 2

021 Roller Center: Special 3

022 Roller Ends: Special 3

023 Feed Waiting: Plain
024 Feed Waiting: M-Thick
025 Feed Waiting: Thick 1

[100 to 170 / 160/ 1 deg]
C1b/C1.5b: [100 to 170 / 140 / 1 deg]
C1c/C1.5c: [100 to 170 / 150 / 1 deg]
C1b/C1.5b: [100 to 170 / 145 / 1 deg]
C1c/C1.5c: [100 to 170 / 155 / 1 deg]
C1b/C1.5b: [100 to 170 / 140 / 1 deg]
C1c/C1.5c: [100 to 170 / 150 / 1 deg]
C1b/C1.5b: [100 to 170 / 145 / 1 deg]
C1c/C1.5c: [100 to 170 / 155 / 1 deg]
C1b/C1.5b: [100 to 170 / 140 / 1 deg]
C1c/C1.5c: [100 to 170 / 150 / 1 deg]
C1b/C1.5b: [100 to 170 / 145 / 1 deg]
C1c/C1.5c: [100 to 170 / 155 / 1 deg]
Turns the feed waiting mode on or off for
each paper type.
[0 to 1 / 0 / 1]
0=Off, 1=On
The paper waits at the registration roller

026 Feed Waiting: Thick 2

until the fusing temperature reaches the
prescribed temperature (adjustable with
SP1105-028 to -37).

027 Feed Waiting: Thin

If you enable this feature, also set SP
1105-38 to a convenient value for the
customer.

D129/D130

3-6

SM Appendix

System SP Table-1

028 Feed Wait: Center Minus: Plain
029 Feed Wait: Ends Minus: Plain
030 Feed Wait: Center Minus: M-Thick
031 Feed Wait: Ends Minus: M-Thick
Adjusts the offset value for each re-load
032 Feed Wait: Center Minus: Thick 1

temperature to exit the feed waiting

033 Feed Wait: Ends Minus: Thick 1

mode.
[0 to 60 / 0 / 1 deg]
Appendix:
Service
Program
Mode Tables

034 Feed Wait: Center Minus: Thick 2
035 Feed Wait: Ends Minus: Thick 2
036 Feed Wait: Center Minus: Thin
037 Feed Wait: Ends Minus: Thin
Sets the maximum feed waiting time.
[0 to 30 / 0 / 1 sec]
The paper is fed when the time specified
038 Feed Waiting: Maximum Time

with this SP has passed even though the
fusing temperature has not reached the
prescribed temperature.
0: Disabled.

1106

Fusing Temperature Display
001 Roller Center

Displays the temperature of the fusing
unit.

002 Roller Ends

[-20 to 250 / 0 / 1 deg]

003 Machine Inside at Power On

Displays the temperature inside the
machine.

004 Machine Inside

SM Appendix

[-20 to 250 / 0 / 1 deg]

3-7

D129/D130

System SP Table-1

Fusing Nip Band Check
1109*
Checks the fusing nip band.
001 Execution
Idling Rotation Time

[0 to 120 / 60 / 1 sec]

002
Specifies the fusing rotation time before executing SP1109-001.
Pre-Idling Time

[5 to 30 / 10 / 1 sec]

003 Specifies the time that the paper stops in the fusing unit for measuring the
nip.

Fusing Jam Detection
1159
SC Code Display
[0 to 1 / 0 / 1] 0:OFF, 1:ON
This SP setting determines whether SC559 is issued after three paper late
jams occur in the fusing unit. After this SP code is turned on, a counter
monitors the number of paper late jams that occur in the fusing unit. After
the 3rd occurrence of a fusing jam, SC559 is issued and the machine
cannot be used until the service technician releases the error.


Switching the machine off/on does not reset this jam counter. The
counter is reset after the cause of the jam has been removed and a
sheet of paper successfully passes the fusing exit sensor.

D129/D130

3-8

SM Appendix

System SP Table-1

Motor Speed Adjustment
Adjusts the speeds of each motor. Each step decreases or increases motor
speed in 0.05% increments
Regist: Registration motor, Feed: Feed motor,
1801*

Duplex: Duplex/By-pass motor, Inverter: Duplex inverter motor,
Exit: Paper exit motor, Bridge: Bridge unit drive motor,
OpcMot: Drum motor, TransferMot: Transfer/Development Motor,
FusingMot: Fusing motor,
Appendix:
Service
Program
Mode Tables

DevPuddleMot: Development Paddle motor
001 Regist: 90: Thick 2
002 Regist: 154: Thick 1
[-2 to 2 / 0.4 / 0.05 %]
003 Regist: 180: Plain
004 Regist: 230: Plain
005 Feed: 90: Thick 2
[-2 to 2 / -0.4 / 0.05 %]
006 Feed: 154: Thick 1
007 Feed: 180: Plain
[-2 to 2 / -1 / 0.05 %]
008 Feed: 230: Plain
009 Duplex_CW: 90: Thick 2
[-4 to 4 / 0.4 / 0.1 %]
010 Duplex_CW: 154: Thick 1
011 Duplex_CW: 180: Plain
[-4 to 4 / -2.3 / 0.1 %]
012 Duplex_CW: 230: Plain
013 Duplex_CCW: 90: Thick 2
[-4 to 4 / 0.4 / 0.1 %]
014 Duplex_CCW: 154: Thick 1
015 Duplex_CCW: 180: Plain
[-4 to 4 / -2.3 / 0.1 %]
016 Duplex_CCW: 230: Plain
017 Inverter_CW: 90: Thick 2
[-4 to 4 / 0 / 0.1 %]
018 Inverter_CW: 154: Thick 1
SM Appendix

3-9

D129/D130

System SP Table-1

019 Inverter_CW: 180: Plain
020 Inverter_CW: 230: Plain
021 Inverter_CCW: 90: Thick 2
022 Inverter_CCW: 154: Thick 1
023 Inverter_CCW: 180: Plain
024 Inverter_CCW: 230: Plain
025 Exit_CW: 90: Thick 2
026 Exit_CW: 154: Thick 1
027 Exit_CW: 180: Plain
028 Exit_CW: 230: Plain
029 Bridge: 90: Thick 2
030 Bridge: 154: Thick 1
031 Bridge: 180: Plain
032 Bridge: 230: Plain
033 OpcMot:90
034 OpcMot:154
035 OpcMot:180
036 OpcMot:230
037 TransferMot:90
038 TransferMot:154

[-4 to 4 / 0 / 0.01 %]

039 TransferMot:180
040 TransferMot:230
041 FusingMot:90
042 FusingMot:154
043 FusingMot:180

D129/D130

3-10

SM Appendix

System SP Table-1

044 FusingMot:230
045 DevPuddleMot

1902

[-4 to 4 / 0 / 0.1 %]

Cleaning Web Setting
Web Consumption

[0 to 120 / 0 / 1 %]

001
Displays the consumed amount of the web roll.

002

C1b/C1.5b: [3 to 130 / 8.4 / 0.1 sec]
C1c/C1.5c: [3 to 130 / 6.7 / 0.1 sec]

Appendix:
Service
Program
Mode Tables

Web Motor Interval

Adjusts the interval for web motor rotation.
Web Motor Time

[0.3 to 10 / 4.2 / 0.1 sec]

003
Adjusts the rotation time of the web motor.
C1b/C1.5b: EU [0 to 100 / 90 / 1 %]
Web Near End Setting
004

C1b/C1.5b: ASIA/NA [0 to 100 / 92 / 1 %]
C1c/C1.5c: EU [0 to 100 / 90 / 1 %]
C1c/C1.5c: ASIA/NA [0 to 100 / 92 / 1 %]

Adjusts the threshold for web near end.
Web Motor Interval: Thick 1

[3 to 130 / 11.2 / 0.1 sec]

005
Adjusts the interval for web motor rotation (thick 1).
Web Motor Interval: Thick 2

[3 to 130 / 16.8 / 0.1 sec]

006
Adjusts the interval for web motor rotation (thick 2).
Paper Interval Time

[0 to 10 / 5 / 1 sec]

007 Adjusts the threshold for paper feeding. When the time between trailing
edge detection and leading edge detection is within the value of this setting,
the machine determines that the paper is still being fed.
Web Motor Setting: Web End

[0 to 60 / 27 / 1 sec]

008
Adjusts the motor rotation time after the web end.
009 Web Motor Rotation: Power On

SM Appendix

[0 to 10 / 2 / 1 times]

3-11

D129/D130

System SP Table-1

Adjusts the number of web motor rotations at the re-load state.
Web Motor Interval: Pre-idle

[0 to 30 / 5 / 1 sec]

010
Adjusts the motor waiting time after the fusing motor idling.
Web Motor Rotation: Pre-idle

[0 to 10 / 2 / 1 times]

011
Adjusts the number of web motor rotations at the fusing idling state.

1903

Cleaning Web Setting
Total Paper Counter

[0 to 999999999 / 0 / 1 sec]

001
Displays the total paper feeding time.
Total Web Motor Drive Time

[0 to 999999999 / 0 / 1 sec]

002
Displays the total time of web motor rotation.

1907

Paper Feed Timing Adj. (DFU)
001 Feed Solenoid ON: Plain
[-10 to 40 / 0 / 2.5 mm]
002 Feed Solenoid ON: Thick
003 Feed Solenoid OFF: Plain
004 Feed Solenoid OFF: Thick
005 Feed Clutch ON: Plain
[-10 to 10 / 0 / 1 mm]

006 Feed Clutch ON: Thick
007 Stop Position before Inverter
008 Stop Position after Inverter
009 Re-Feed Stop Position
010 By-pass Solenoid OFF

[0 to 40 / 0 / 1 mm]

011 By-pass Solenoid ON

[0 to 1 / 1 / 1 mm]

012 By-pass Feed Clutch ON

[-10 to 10 / 0 / 1 mm]

D129/D130

3-12

SM Appendix

System SP Table-1

013 Exit Roller: Shift: 180
014 Exit Roller: Shift: 230
015 Exit: Junction Solenoid ON
016 Exit: Junction Solenoid OFF
017 Bridge: Junction Solenoid ON
018 Bridge: Junction Solenoid OFF

Appendix:
Service
Program
Mode Tables

019 1-Bin: Junction Solenoid ON
020 1-Bin: Junction Solenoid OFF
021 Shift Motor ON

1908

[-1 to 1 / 0 / 0.1 mm]

Paper Bank Feed Timing Adj (DFU)
001 Feed Clutch ON: Plain
[-10 to 10 / 0 / 1 mm]
002 Feed Clutch ON: Thick

SM Appendix

3-13

D129/D130

System SP Table-1

CPM Down Setting
When this machine gets a sequence of coping/printing jobs, the machine

1916

uses CPM down mode to prevent the fusing temperature from becoming too
low.
001 Temp.: Plain
002 Temp.: M-Thick

Adjusts the thresholds for each
environmental condition (between Low

003 Temp.: Thick 1

and Medium).
[10 to 23 / 17 / 1 deg]

004 Temp.: Thick 2
005 Temp.: Thin
006 ON/OFF: Low: Plain
007 ON/OFF: Low: M-Thick
008 ON/OFF: Low: Thick 1
009 ON/OFF: Low: Thick 2

Turns on or off the CPM down setting

010 ON/OFF: Low: Thin

for each paper type and ambient
temperature.

011 ON/OFF: Medium: Plain

[0 to 1 / 0 / 1 ]

012 ON/OFF: Medium: M-Thick

0= Off, 1= On

013 ON/OFF: Medium:: Thick 1
014 ON/OFF: Medium: Thick 2
015 ON/OFF: Medium: Thin
016 Waiting Time: Low: Plain
Adjusts the threshold time to enter the
017 Waiting Time: Low: M-Thick

CPM down mode.
[0 to 180 / 60 / 1 sec]

018 Waiting Time: Low: Thick 1

The machine determines whether the
019 Waiting Time: Low: Thick 2

CPM down mode is activated or not

020 Waiting Time: Low: Thin

after the time specified with these SPs
has passed.

021 Waiting Time: Medium: Plain

D129/D130

3-14

SM Appendix

System SP Table-1

022 Waiting Time: Medium: M-Thick
023 Waiting Time: Medium: Thick 1
024 Waiting Time: Medium: Thick 2
025 Waiting Time: Medium: Thin
026 Temp.: Low: Plain
027 Temp.: Low: Plain

the fusing unit to enter the CPM down
029 Temp.: Low: Thick 2

mode.
[100 to 200 / 120 / 1 deg]

030 Temp.: Low: Thin

If the temperature of the fusing unit is
031 Temp.: Medium: Plain

less than the temperature specified

032 Temp.: Medium: M-Thick

with these SPs, the machine changes
the CPM (adjustable with SP1916-36

033 Temp.: Medium: Thick 1

to -45).

034 Temp.: Medium: Thick 2
035 Temp.: Medium: Thin
Adjusts the CPM in the CPM down
mode.

036 CPM: Low: Plain

C1b/C1.5b: [20 to 35 / 35 / 5 cpm]
C1c/C1.5c: [20 to 45 / 45 / 5 cpm]
Adjusts the CPM in the CPM down
mode.

037 CPM: Low: M-Thick

C1b/C1.5b: [20 to 35 / 35 / 5 cpm]
C1c/C1.5c: [20 to 45 / 45 / 5 cpm]
Adjusts the CPM in the CPM down
mode.

038 CPM: Low: Thick 1

C1b/C1.5b: [5 to 15 / 15 / 5 cpm]
C1c/C1.5c: [5 to 25 / 25 / 5 cpm]
Adjusts the CPM in the CPM down

039 CPM: Low: Thick 2

mode.
[5 to 15 / 15 / 5 cpm]

SM Appendix

3-15

D129/D130

Appendix:
Service
Program
Mode Tables

Adjusts the threshold temperature of

028 Temp.: Low: Thick 1

System SP Table-1

040 CPM: Low: Thin

Adjusts the CPM in the CPM down
mode.

041 CPM: Medium: Plain

C1b/C1.5b: [20 to 35 / 35 / 5 cpm]
C1c/C1.5c: [30 to 45 / 45 / 5 cpm]

042 CPM: Medium: M-Thick

Adjusts the CPM in the CPM down
mode.

043 CPM: Medium: Thick 1

C1b/C1.5b: [5 to 15 / 15 / 5 cpm]
C1c/C1.5c: [5 to 25 / 25 / 5 cpm]
Adjusts the CPM in the CPM down

044 CPM: Medium: Thick 2

mode.
[5 to 15 / 15 / 5 cpm]
Adjusts the CPM in the CPM down
mode.

045 CPM: Medium: Thin

C1b/C1.5b: [20 to 35 / 35 / 5 cpm]
C1c/C1.5c: [30 to 45 / 45 / 5 cpm]

1930

OnOff Time Adjust
On Time Adjust

[0 to 100 / 40 / 10 msec]

001 Adjusts the Off-On interval of the transfer belt contact motor. ("On" means
that the transfer belt is in contact with the drum.)
Off Time Adjust

[0 to 100 / 20 / 10 msec]

002 Adjusts the On-Off interval of the transfer belt contact motor. ("Off" means
that the transfer belt is away from the drum.)

Tray Lock at Jam

[0 or 1 / 0 / 1 ] 0= OFF, 1= ON

1950
Not used

D129/D130

3-16

SM Appendix

System SP Tables-2

3.2 SYSTEM SP TABLES-2
3.2.1 SP2-XXX: DRUM

2001*

Charge Bias
Setting (Copying)

[1000 to 2000 / 1500 / 10 V]

001

Setting (P Pattern)

[0 to 700 / 250 / 10 V]

002 Adjusts the voltage applied to the charge roller when making the VSDP ID
sensor pattern (for charge roller voltage correction). The actual charge roller
voltage is this value plus the value of SP2001-1.

2005*

Bias Control
Bias Correction 1

[0.1 to 1 / 0.85 / 0.05 step]

001 Adjusts the lower threshold value for the charge roller correction.
When the value of VSDP/VSG is greater than this value, the charge roller
voltage increases by 30 V (e.g., from –500 to –530).
Bias Correction 2

[0.1 to 1 / 0.9 / 0.05 step]

002 Adjusts the upper threshold value for the charge roller correction.
When the value of VSDP/VSG is greater than this value, the charge roller
voltage decreases by 30 V (absolute value).
Bias Adjustment 1

[1000 to 2000 / 1500 / 10 vol]

003
Adjusts the lower limit value for charge roller voltage correction.
Bias Adjustment 2

[1000 to 2000 / 2000 / 10 vol]

004
Adjusts the upper limit value for charge roller voltage correction.
Bias Adjustment 3

[0 to 100 / 30 / 10 vol]

005
Adjusts the correction voltage adjustment step size.

SM Appendix

3-17

D129/D130

Appendix:
Service
Program
Mode Tables

Adjusts the voltage applied to the charge roller for copying.

System SP Tables-2

Magnification Adjustment
Main Scan

2102*

[-2 to 2 / 0 / 0.1 %]

Adjusts the magnification in the main scan direction for copy mode and
printer mode.

Erase Margin Adjustment
Adjusts the erase margin by deleting image data at the margins.
2103*

L Size: 297.1 mm or more (length)
M Size: 216.1 to 297 mm (length)
S Size: 216 mm or less (length)
001 Leading Edge
[0 to 9 / 3 / 0.1mm]
002 Trailing Edge
003 Left
[0 to 9 / 2 / 0.1mm]
004 Right
005 Duplex Trail.: L Size: Plain

[0 to 4 / 1 / 0.1mm]

006 Duplex Trail.: M Size: Plain

[0 to 4 / 0.8 / 0.1mm]

007 Duplex Trail.: S Size: Plain

[0 to 4 / 0.6 / 0.1mm]

008 Duplex Left: Plain
[0 to 1.5 / 0.3 / 0.1mm]
009 Duplex Right: Plain
010 Duplex Trail.: L Size: Thick

[0 to 4 / 0.8 / 0.1mm]

011 Duplex Trail.: M Size: Thick

[0 to 4 / 0.6 / 0.1mm]

012 Duplex Trail.: S Size: Thick

[0 to 4 / 0.4 / 0.1mm]

013 Duplex Left: Thick
[0 to 1.5 / 0.1 / 0.1mm]
014 Duplex Right: Thick

D129/D130

3-18

SM Appendix

System SP Tables-2

LD Power Adjustment(DFU)
2105*

Adjusts the LD power for each mode.
Each LD power setting is decided by the process control.
001 LD1: Copy
[–50 to 79 / -24 (C2b), 5 (C2c) /1 ]
002 LD2: Copy
003 LD1: Printer/Fax
[–50 to 79 / -44 (C2b), -25 (C2c)/1 ]

2106*

Appendix:
Service
Program
Mode Tables

004 LD2: Printer/Fax

POL REV TIME (Polygon motor rotation time)
PRE TIME

[0 to 60 / 10 /1 sec]

001 Adjusts the time of polygon motor rotation before a job.
If this is set to "0", this SP is not activated.
POST TIME

[0 to 60 / 0 /1 sec]

Adjusts the time of the polygon motor rotation after a job.
002 If this is set to "0", the polygon motor never switches off in standby mode.
However, if the machine enters the energy saver mode, the polygon motor
will ignore the zero setting and switch itself off.

SM Appendix

3-19

D129/D130

System SP Tables-2

2109

Test Pattern

001 Pattern Selection

[0 to 24 / 0 /1 ]
Test pattern of the GAVD

0: None

13: Independent Pattern (4 dot)

1: Vertical Line (1 dot)

14: Trimming Area

2: Vertical Line (2 dot)

15: Hound's Tooth Check (Vertical)

3: Horizontal Line (1 dot)

16: Hound's Tooth Check (Horizontal)

4: Horizontal Line (2 dot)

17: Black Band (Horizontal)

5: Grid Vertical Line

18: Black band ( Vertical)

6: Grid Horizontal Line

19: Checker Flag Pattern

7: Grid pattern small

20: Grayscale (Vertical Margin)

8: Grid Pattern Large

21: Grayscale (Horizontal Margin)

9: Argyle Pattern Small

22: Two Beam Density Pattern

10: Argyle Pattern Large

23: Full Dot Pattern

11: Independent pattern (1 dot)

24:All white Pattern

12: Independent Pattern (2 dot)

[0 to 15 / 15 /1 ]
002 Density

Set the density of the test pattern which is output in
SP2109-001. This SP is not used for the Grayscale
patterns.

2201*

Development Bias Adjustment
Development Bias

[200 to 700 / 560 / 10V ]

001 Adjusts the development bias for copying.
Use as a temporary measure to correct faint copies from an aging drum.
ID Sensor Pattern

[200 to 700 / 400 / 10V ]

002
Adjusts the development bias for the ID sensor pattern for VSP

D129/D130

3-20

SM Appendix

System SP Tables-2

Forced Toner Supply
2207

Forces the toner bottle to supply toner at 1-second intervals for up to 30
seconds. To start, press [EXECUTE].

Toner Supply Mode

[0: Sensor, 1: pixel ]

Selects the toner mode.
2208*

pixel count modes only as a temporary measure if the ID or TD sensor is
defective.

2209*

Toner Supply Rate
Toner Rate

[10 to 800 / 60 mg/s / 5 mg ]

Sets the amount of toner supplied every second by the toner supply motor.
The length of time the motor remains on is determined by the data read by
001 the TD sensor and ID sensor.
Increasing this value reduces the toner supply clutch on time. Use a lower
value if the user tends to make lots of copies that have a high proportion of
black.
Correction Data

[25 to 300 / 300 / 25 ]

Displays the toner supply correction coefficient (K). It can also be used to
adjust K, but the value is changed again when VT is measured for the next
002 copy.
The toner supply rate depends on the amount of toner in the toner bottle.
This change is corrected using this coefficient. This SP can be used to
check the toner supply condition. The lower the value of K, the lower the
toner density

SM Appendix

3-21

D129/D130

Appendix:
Service
Program
Mode Tables

If you select "1", SP2-209-002 should be set to its default value. Use image

System SP Tables-2

P Pattern Cycle
2210*
Sets the interval between ID sensor pattern prints.
Job Page Count

[0 to 200 / 10 / 1 sheet]

001* Sets the interval between ID sensor pattern printing. For users that do not
make many copies daily, set a smaller interval to compensate for the effects
of seasonal and weather changes.
Forced Page Count

[2 to 999 / 100 / 1 sheet]

002* Sets the interval between ID sensor pattern printing.
Forces creation of the ID sensor pattern to prevent low density copies for
customers who use the copier for long copy jobs.

Toner End Setting
Selects the detection type for toner end.
[0 to 2 / 0 / 1 step]
[0: 90 copies, 1: No copies, 2: 10 copies]
2213*



90 copies: Toner end is determined if a low density image (Vref <
Vt(10)) is detected 90 times after toner near end.



If "1" is selected, the machine stops printing when the TD sensor
output drops below the prescribed level.



Select 1 or 2 if the customer normally makes copies of very high
density.

D129/D130

3-22

SM Appendix

System SP Tables-2

Vref Setting
Adjusts the TD sensor reference voltage (Vref). Change this value after
replacing the development unit with another development unit that contains
toner.
[1 to 5 / 4 / 0.01 ]
2220*

1.

Check the value of SP2-220 in both the machine containing the test unit
and the machine that you are going to move it to.

2.

Install the test development unit, and then input the VREF for this unit

3.

After the test, put back the old development unit, and change SP2-220
back to the original value.

Reverse Interval Drum,Transfer

[0 to 2000 / 0 / 1 sheets]

Adjusts the threshold for the reverse rotation of the drum and

2221*

development/transfer motors. This helps the drum and transfer belt cleaning
operations. This reverse rotation will interrupt a multiple printing job.

2223*

Vt Display
Current

[0 to 5 / 4 / 0.01]

001
Displays the TD sensor output voltage for the immediately previous copy.
Average 10 copies

[0 to 5 / 4 / 0.01]

002 Displays the average of the most recent TD sensor outputs (from the
previous 10 copies).
Rate of Change

[-10000 to 10000 / 0 / 1]

003
Displays the rate of change in the TD sensor output.
GAIN

[0 to 255 / 0 / 1]

004 Displays the GAIN value used to calculate the on time for the toner supply
motor.

SM Appendix

3-23

D129/D130

Appendix:
Service
Program
Mode Tables

into SP2-220.

System SP Tables-2

Image Pixel Count

[0 to 255 / 0 / 1]

005
Displays the image pixel count.

Developer Lot
2228*

Displays the lot number of the developer. (The lot number is embossed on
the top edge of the developer pack.)

Transfer Current Adjustment
If the transfer current of image area is set highly than normal, the print

2301*

image is easily come out. If the leading transfer current is set as same, the
black line is come out due to exfoliation leave.

Image Area: 1st Side
001

C2b: [10 to 100 / 35 / 1 A]
C2c: [10 to 100 / 45 / 1 A]

Adjusts the transfer current for printing the first side of the paper

Image Area: 2nd Side
002

C2b: [10 to 100 / 35 / 1 A]
C2c: [10 to 100 / 40 / 1 A]

Adjusts the transfer current for printing the second side of the paper
Leading Edge: 1st Side

[10 to 100 / 20 / 1 A]

Adjusts the transfer current for copying at leading edge the first side of the
003 paper.
Increase the current to separate the paper from the drum properly in high
humidity and high temperature conditions.
Leading Edge: 2nd Side

[10 to 100 / 20 / 1 A]

Adjusts the transfer current for copying at leading edge the second side of
004 the paper.
Increase the current to separate the paper from the drum properly in high
humidity and high temperature conditions.

D129/D130

3-24

SM Appendix

System SP Tables-2

By-pass: Image Area

C2b: [10 to 100 / 35 / 1 A]
C2c: [10 to 100 / 45 / 1 A]

005 Adjusts the transfer current for copying from the by-pass tray.
If the user normally feeds thicker paper from the bypass tray, use a higher
setting.
[10 to 100 / 20 / 1 A ]

Adjusts the transfer current for copying at the leading edge of paper fed
006 from the by-pass tray.
Increase the current to separate the paper from the drum properly in high
humidity and high temperature conditions.
No Image Area (SSP)

[10 to 100 / 15 / 1 A ]

008
Adjusts the transfer current for copying.

2309*

Current: Paper Size Correction (SSP)
Paper Lower Width (a)

[1 to 150 / 150 / 1 mm ]

Adjusts the lower paper width threshold for the transfer current, charge
voltage, and development bias corrections.
001 Use this SP when an image problem (e.g., insufficient toner transfer) occurs
with a small width paper. If the paper width is smaller than this value, the
transfer current will be multiplied by the factor in SP2-309-3 (paper tray) or
SP2-309-5 (by-pass).
Paper Upper Width (a)

[151 to 296 / 216 / 1 mm ]

Adjusts the upper paper width threshold for the transfer current, charge
002 voltage, and development bias corrections.
As for SP2-309-1, but the factors are in SP2-309-4 (paper tray) and
SP2-309-6 (by-pass).

SM Appendix

3-25

D129/D130

Appendix:
Service
Program
Mode Tables

By-pass: Leading Edge

System SP Tables-2

Paper Tray: Plain (alpha)

[1 to 3 / 1 / 0.1 ]

003 Adjusts the transfer current correction coefficient used if the paper width is
less than the setting of SP2-309-1.
Paper Tray: Plain (beta)

[1 to 3 / 1 / 0.1 ]

004 Adjusts the transfer current correction coefficient used if the paper width is
less than the setting of SP2-309-2.
By-pass: Plain (gamma)

[1 to 3 / 1.1 / 0.1 ]

005 Adjusts the transfer current correction coefficient used if the paper width is
less than the setting of SP2-309-1.
By-pass: Plain (delta)

[1 to 3 / 1.1 / 0.1 ]

006 Adjusts the transfer current correction coefficient used if the paper width is
less than the setting of SP2-309-2.
007 Paper Tray: Thick 1 (alpha)
[1 to 3 / 1 / 0.1 ]
008 Paper Tray: Thick 1 (beta)
009 By-pass: Thick 1 (gamma)
[1 to 3 / 1.1 / 0.1 ]
010 By-pass: Thick 1 (delta)
011 Paper Tray: Thick 2 (alpha)
[1 to 3 / 1.1 / 0.1 ]
012 Paper Tray: Thick 2 (beta)
013 By-pass: Thick 2 (gamma)
[1 to 3 / 1.5 / 0.1 ]
014 By-pass: Thick 2 (delta)
015 Paper Tray: M-Thick (alpha)
[1 to 3 / 1 / 0.1 ]
016 Paper Tray: M-Thick (beta)
017 By-pass: M-Thick (gamma)
[1 to 3 / 1.1 / 0.1 ]
018 By-pass: M-Thick (delta)

D129/D130

3-26

SM Appendix

System SP Tables-2

019 Paper Tray: Thin (alpha)
[1 to 3 / 1 / 0.1 ]
020 Paper Tray: Thin (beta)
021 By-pass: Thin (gamma)
[1 to 3 / 1.1 / 0.1 ]
022 By-pass: Thin (delta)
023 Paper Tray: Special 1 (alpha)
[1 to 3 / 1 / 0.1 ]

Appendix:
Service
Program
Mode Tables

024 Paper Tray: Special 1 (beta)
025 By-pass: Special 1 (gamma)
[1 to 3 / 1.1 / 0.1 ]
026 By-pass: Special 1 (delta)
027 Paper Tray: Special 2 (alpha)
[1 to 3 / 1 / 0.1 ]
028 Paper Tray: Special 2 (beta)
029 By-pass: Special 2 (gamma)
[1 to 3 / 1.1 / 0.1 ]
030 By-pass: Special 2 (delta)
031 Paper Tray: Special 3 (alpha)
[1 to 3 / 1 / 0.1 ]
032 Paper Tray: Special 3 (beta)
033 By-pass: Special 3 (gamma)
[1 to 3 / 1.1 / 0.1 ]
034 By-pass: Special 3 (delta)

SM Appendix

3-27

D129/D130

System SP Tables-2

Current: Paper Type Correction (SSP)
Adjust the transfer current for each paper type. If the transfer current of
2310*

image area is set highly than normal, the print image is easily come out. If
the leading transfer current is set as same, the black line is come out due to
exfoliation leave.
Image 1st Side: Thick 1

[10 to 100 / 18 / 1 A]

001
Adjusts the transfer current for printing the first side of the paper (Thick 1).
Leading Edge 1st Side: Thick 1

[10 to 100 / 15 / 1 A]

002 Adjusts the transfer current for copying at leading edge the first side of the
paper. Increase the current to separate the paper from the drum properly in
high humidity and high temperature conditions (Thick 1).
Image 2nd Side: Thick 1

[10 to 100 / 18 / 1 A]

003 Adjusts the transfer current for printing the second side of the paper (Thick
1).
Leading Edge 2nd Side: Thick 1

[10 to 100 / 15 / 1 A]

004 Adjusts the transfer current for copying at leading edge the second side of
the paper (Thick 1). Increase the current to separate the paper from the
drum properly in high humidity and high temperature conditions.
Image: Thick 2

[10 to 100 / 18 / 1 A]

005
Adjusts the transfer current for printing (Thick 2).
Leading Edge: Thick 2

[10 to 100 / 15 / 1 A]

006 Adjusts the transfer current for copying at the leading edge of paper (Thick
2). Increase the current to separate the paper from the drum properly in high
humidity and high temperature conditions.

D129/D130

3-28

SM Appendix

System SP Tables-2

Image: OHP

[10 to 100 / 20 / 1 A]

007
Adjusts the transfer current for printing (OHP).
Leading Edge: OHP

[10 to 100 / 20 / 1 A]

008 Adjusts the transfer current for copying at the leading edge of paper (OHP).
Increase the current to separate the paper from the drum properly in high
humidity and high temperature conditions.
Image: Envelope

[10 to 100 / 20 / 1 A]
Appendix:
Service
Program
Mode Tables

009
Adjusts the transfer current for printing (Envelope).
Leading Edge: Envelope

[10 to 100 / 20 / 1 A]

010 Adjusts the transfer current for copying at the leading edge of paper
(Envelope). Increase the current to separate the paper from the drum
properly in high humidity and high temperature conditions.
C2b: [10 to 100 / 24 / 1 A]

Image 1st Side: M-Thick

C2c: [10 to 100 / 32 / 1 A]

011

Adjusts the transfer current for printing the first side of the paper (M-Thick).
Leading Edge 1st Side: M-Thick

[10 to 100 / 20 / 1 A]

012 Adjusts the transfer current for copying at leading edge the first side of the
paper (M-Thick). Increase the current to separate the paper from the drum
properly in high humidity and high temperature conditions.
C2b: [10 to 100 / 24 / 1 A]

Image 2nd Side: M-Thick

C2c: [10 to 100 / 32 / 1 A]

013
Adjusts the transfer current for printing the second side of the paper
(M-Thick).

SM Appendix

3-29

D129/D130

System SP Tables-2

Leading Edge 2nd Side: M-Thick

[10 to 100 / 20 / 1 A]

014 Adjusts the transfer current for copying at leading edge the second side of
the paper (M-Thick). Increase the current to separate the paper from the
drum properly in high humidity and high temperature conditions.
C2b: [10 to 100 / 35 / 1 A]

Image 1st Side: Special 1

C2c: [10 to 100 / 45 / 1 A]

015

Adjusts the transfer current for printing the first side of the paper (Special 1).
Leading Edge 1st Side: Special 1

[10 to 100 / 20 / 1 A]

016 Adjusts the transfer current for copying at leading edge the first side of the
paper (Special 1). Increase the current to separate the paper from the drum
properly in high humidity and high temperature conditions.
C2b: [10 to 100 / 35 / 1 A]

Image 2nd Side: Special 1

C2c: [10 to 100 / 40 / 1 A]

017
Adjusts the transfer current for printing the second side of the paper
(Special 1).
Leading Edge 2nd Side: Special 1

[10 to 100 / 20 / 1 A]

018 Adjusts the transfer current for copying at leading edge the second side of
the paper (Special 1). Increase the current to separate the paper from the
drum properly in high humidity and high temperature conditions.
C2b: [10 to 100 / 24 / 1 A]

Image 1st Side: Special 2

C2c: [10 to 100 / 32 / 1 A]

019

Adjusts the transfer current for printing the first side of the paper (Special 2).

D129/D130

3-30

SM Appendix

System SP Tables-2

Leading Edge 1st Side: Special 2

C2b: [10 to 100 / 24 / 1 A]
C2c: [10 to 100 / 32 / 1 A]

020 Adjusts the transfer current for copying at leading edge the first side of the
paper (Special 2). Increase the current to separate the paper from the drum
properly in high humidity and high temperature conditions.
C2b: [10 to 100 / 24 / 1 A]

Image 2nd Side: Special 2

C2c: [10 to 100 / 32 / 1 A]

021
Appendix:
Service
Program
Mode Tables

Adjusts the transfer current for printing the second side of the paper
(Special 2).

Leading Edge 2nd Side: Special 2

C2b: [10 to 100 / 24 / 1 A]
C2c: [10 to 100 / 32 / 1 A]

022 Adjusts the transfer current for copying at leading edge the second side of
the paper (Special 2). Increase the current to separate the paper from the
drum properly in high humidity and high temperature conditions.
C2b: [10 to 100 / 24 / 1 A]

Image 1st Side: Special 3

C2c: [10 to 100 / 32 / 1 A]

023

Adjusts the transfer current for printing the first side of the paper (Special 3).

Leading Edge 1st Side: Special 3

C2b: [10 to 100 / 24 / 1 A]
C2c: [10 to 100 / 32 / 1 A]

024 Adjusts the transfer current for copying at leading edge the first side of the
paper (Special 3). Increase the current to separate the paper from the drum
properly in high humidity and high temperature conditions.
C2b: [10 to 100 / 24 / 1 A]

Image 2nd Side: Special 3

C2c: [10 to 100 / 32 / 1 A]

025
Adjusts the transfer current for printing the second side of the paper
(Special 3).

SM Appendix

3-31

D129/D130

System SP Tables-2

Leading Edge 2nd Side: Special 3

C2b: [10 to 100 / 24 / 1 A]
C2c: [10 to 100 / 32 / 1 A]

026 Adjusts the transfer current for copying at leading edge the second side of
the paper (Special 3). Increase the current to separate the paper from the
drum properly in high humidity and high temperature conditions.

PTL Control (SSP)
Use this SP when an image problem occurs caused by the pick-off paws.
This SP is for the printing which target line speed is 230 or 180 mm/sec. Set

2602*

the PTL control (SP2603-001) to “1: ON” after installing the PTL. If the PTL
control is set to ON, the black line is come out due to exfoliation leave. Set
SP2911-002 (or 005, 008, 011) to “20” when using the PTL.
1st Side: OFF/ON

[0 to 1 / 0 / 1]

001
Sets the PTL control setting for printing the first side of the paper.
1st Side: OFF Timing

[-10 to 10 / 2 / 1]

002 Sets the PTL control time for printing the first side of the paper when
SP2602-001 is set to “1”.
2nd Side: OFF/ON

[0 to 1 / 0 / 1]

003
Sets the PTL control setting for printing the second side of the paper.
2nd Side: OFF Timing

[-10 to 10 / 2 / 1]

004 Sets the PTL control time for printing the second side of the paper when
SP2602-003 is set to “1”.

D129/D130

3-32

SM Appendix

System SP Tables-2

PTL Control: 154 mm/s (SSP)
Use this SP when an image problem occurs caused by the pick-off paws.
This SP is for the printing which target line speed is 154 mm/sec. Set the

2603*

PTL control (SP2603-001) to “1: ON” after installing the PTL. If the PTL
control is set to ON, the black line is come out due to exfoliation leave. Set
SP2911-002 (or 005, 008, 011) to “20” when using the PTL.
1st Side: OFF/ON

[0 to 1 / 0 / 1]

001

1st Side: OFF Timing

Appendix:
Service
Program
Mode Tables

Sets the PTL control setting for printing the first side of the paper.
[-10 to 10 / 2 / 1]

002 Sets the PTL control time for printing the first side of the paper when
SP2602-001 is set to “1”.
2nd Side: OFF/ON

[0 to 1 / 0 / 1]

003
Sets the PTL control setting for printing the second side of the paper.
2nd Side: OFF Timing

[-10 to 10 / 2 / 1]

004 Sets the PTL control time for printing the second side of the paper when
SP2602-003 is set to “1”.

SM Appendix

3-33

D129/D130

System SP Tables-2

PTL Control: 90 mm/s (SSP)
Use this SP when an image problem occurs caused by the pick-off paws.
This SP is for the printing which target line speed is 90 mm/sec. Set the PTL

2604*

control (SP2603-001) to “1: ON” after installing the PTL. If the PTL control is
set to ON, the black line is come out due to exfoliation leave. Set
SP2911-002 (or 005, 008, 011) to “20” when using the PTL.
1st Side: OFF/ON

[0 to 1 / 0 / 1]

001
Sets the PTL control setting for printing the first side of the paper.
1st Side: OFF Timing

[-10 to 10 / 2 / 1]

002 Sets the PTL control time for printing the first side of the paper when
SP2602-001 is set to “1”.
2nd Side: OFF/ON

[0 to 1 / 0 / 1]

003
Sets the PTL control setting for printing the second side of the paper.
2nd Side: OFF Timing

[-10 to 10 / 2 / 1]

004 Sets the PTL control time for printing the second side of the paper when
SP2602-003 is set to “1”.

TD Sensor Initial Setting

Initialization

Performs the TD sensor initial setting and allows the service technician to
enter the lot number of the developer. (The lot number is embossed on the
edge of the developer package.) This SP mode controls the voltage applied
2801*

to the TD sensor to make the TD sensor output about 3.0 V. Press
"Execute" to start. After finishing this, the TD sensor output voltage is
displayed.
Use this mode only after installing the machine, changing the TD sensor, or
adding new developer.

D129/D130

3-34

SM Appendix

System SP Tables-2

TD Sensor Manual Setting
2802*
Allows you to adjust the TD sensor output manually for the following.
VTS

[1 to 5 / 4.78 / 0.01vol ]

Adjusts the TD sensor output (VT).
001 Change this value after replacing the development unit with another one
that already contains toner. For example, when using a development unit
from another machine for test purposes. To adjust VT, use a similar

VTMAX

Appendix:
Service
Program
Mode Tables

procedure as for SP2-220.
[1 to 5 / 4.78 / 0.01vol ]

002
Adjusts the maximum value for SP2802 1.
VTMIN

[1 to 5 / 1 / 0.01vol ]

003
Adjusts the minimum value for SP2802 1.

Process Setting
2805

Performs the developer initialization. Press "Execute" to start. This SP
should be performed after doing SP2801 at installation and after replacing
the drum.

Grayscale Setting
2810

Initializes the LD power setting. This SP should be done after replacing the
drum.

SM Appendix

3-35

D129/D130

System SP Tables-2

2812*

Drum Reverse Rotation (SSP)
Reverse time

[0 to 9 / 4 / 1 ]

001
Sets the reverse time of the drum motor after the end of a job.
Interval time

[0 to 19 / 9 /1 ]

002
Sets the waiting time of the drum motor reverse after the end of a job.

2911*

Transfer Current On/Off Timing (SSP)
La (On Timing)

[-20 to 20 / 0 / 1 mm]

001
Adjust the timing to turn on the transfer current for the leading edge.
Lb (Switch Timing)

[0 to 30 / 10 / 1 mm]

002 Adjust the timing to switch transfer current from the leading edge to the
image area.
Lc (Off Timing)

[-20 to 20 / -5 / 1 mm]

003
Adjust the timing to turn off the transfer current for the image area.
La (On Timing): Special 1

[-20 to 20 / 0 / 1 mm]

004 Adjust the timing to turn on the transfer current for the leading edge (Special
1).
Lb (Switch Timing): Special 1

[0 to 30 / 10 / 1 mm]

005 Adjust the timing to switch transfer current from the leading edge to the
image area (Special 1).

D129/D130

3-36

SM Appendix

System SP Tables-2

Lc (Off Timing): Special 1

[-20 to 20 / -5 / 1 mm]

006 Adjust the timing to turn off the transfer current for the image area (Special
1).
La (On Timing): Special 2

[-20 to 20 / 0 / 1 mm]

007 Adjust the timing to turn on the transfer current for the leading edge (Special
2).
[0 to 30 / 10 / 1 mm]
Appendix:
Service
Program
Mode Tables

Lb (Switch Timing): Special 2

008 Adjust the timing to switch transfer current from the leading edge to the
image area (Special 2).
Lc (Off Timing): Special 2

[-20 to 20 / -5 / 1 mm]

009 Adjust the timing to turn off the transfer current for the image area (Special
2).
La (On Timing): Special 3

[-20 to 20 / 0 / 1 mm]

010 Adjust the timing to turn on the transfer current for the leading edge (Special
2).
Lb (Switch Timing): Special 3

[0 to 30 / 10 / 1 mm]

011 Adjust the timing to switch transfer current from the leading edge to the
image area (Special 2).
Lc (Off Timing): Special 3

[-20 to 20 / -5 / 1 mm]

012 Adjust the timing to turn off the transfer current for the image area (Special
2).

2912*

Transfer Reverse Rotation
Interval

[0 to 10 / 3 / 1 ]

002 Sets the reverse time of the transfer/development motor after the end of a
job.

SM Appendix

3-37

D129/D130

System SP Tables-2

2914*

Paper Setting
C-alpha

[0 to 400 / 150 / 10vol ]

Adjusts the charge roller voltage used when paper with a small width is fed
from the by-pass tray. The paper width below which the correction starts
001 depends on the value of SP2-309-1.
Use this SP when an image problem (such as white spots at the center of
black dots or breaks in thin black lines) occurs when paper with a small
width is fed from the by-pass feed tray.
C-beta

[0 to 400 / 0 / 10vol ]

Adjusts the charge roller voltage used when paper with a small width is fed
002 from the by-pass tray. The paper width below which the correction starts
depends on the value of SP2-309-2.
Use this SP when an image problem (see 2-914-1) occurs when paper with
a small width is fed from the by-pass feed tray.
B-gamma

[0 to 300 / 200 / 10vol ]

Adjusts the development bias used when paper with a small width is fed
003 from the by-pass tray. The paper width below which the correction starts
depends on the value of SP2-309-1.
Use this SP when an image problem (see 2-914-1) occurs when paper with
a small width is fed from the by-pass feed tray.
B-delta

[0 to 300 / 50 / 10vol ]

Adjusts the development bias used when paper with a small width is fed
004 from the by-pass tray. The paper width below which the correction starts
depends on the value of SP2-309-2.
Use this SP when an image problem (see 2-914-1) occurs when paper with
a small width is fed from the by-pass feed tray.

D129/D130

3-38

SM Appendix

System SP Tables-2

2940*

Toner consump. (SSP)
[0: OFF 1: ON]

[0 to 1 / 1 / 1]

001 If this SP is set to ON, toner bottle consumes toner when the SP2801 (TD
Sensor Initial Setting) is executed. This prevents the image offset.
Setting

[0 to 1 / 0.06 / 0.01]

002 Specifies the threshold value for the toner consumption mode if

Toner Overflow Sensor

Appendix:
Service
Program
Mode Tables

SP2940-001 is set to ON.

[0 = OFF, 1= ON]

2960*
Selects whether or not the toner overflow sensor is activated.

Trans Cleaning Blade Forming (SSP)
Applies a pattern of toner to the transfer belt at a defined interval between
sheets on the transfer belt in order to reduce friction between the belt
surface and the cleaning blade.
2964*

Under conditions of high temperature and high humidity, the density control
feature may reduce the amount of toner, which also reduces the amount of
toner on the surface of the transfer belt. With less toner on the belt, the
friction between the belt and the blade increases, and could cause the blade
to bend or scour the surface of the belt.
001 0: OFF, 1: ON

[0 to 1 / 0 / 1 ]

002 Pattern Interval

[1 to 100 / 15 / 1 sheet]

003 Pattern Number

[1 to 3 / 1 / 1 line]

004 Pattern LD Power

[0 to 15 / 2 / 1 ]

SM Appendix

3-39

D129/D130

System SP Tables-2

Grayscale Limit (SSP)
Controls the halftone density level to prevent deterioration of the OPC. The

2972*

halftone density is detected by the ID sensor, and the machine adjusts the
intensity of the LD beam according to the upper/lower limit setting.
Upper Limit

[0 to 100 / 58 (C2b), 63 (C2c)/ 1vol ]

Defines the upper limit for grayscale.
001 A larger value allows a wider range of halftones at the pale end of the scale.
If the image contains pale areas with fuzzy borders surrounded by dark
areas, reduce this value to make the borders clearer.
Lower Limit

[0 to 100 / 52 (C2b), 57 (C2c) / 1vol ]

002 Defines the lower limit for grayscale.
A smaller value allows a wider range of halftones at the dark end of the
scale.

Grayscale Cycle (SSP)

[0 to 1000 / 100 / 10 sheets ]

Set s the halftone operation interval in order to prevent deterioration of the

2973*

OPC. If the number of copies exceeds this setting, at the end of the job, or if
the door is opened and closed, charge correction is executed.

2974*

Image Density
Adjustment Mode

[1 to 5 / 3 / 1 ]

001 Adjusts image density. Changing this setting adjusts development bias and
ID sensor output voltage that in turn raises or lowers image density.

D129/D130

3-40

SM Appendix

System SP Tables-2

Near End Setting
Detection Time
2975*

[0 to 2000 / 0 / 10 sec ]

Sets a time for toner supply motor rotation for issuing the toner near end
warning on the operation panel. The time may need to be shorter for
customers who run especially large print jobs (working at night, for example)
to ensure earlier warning of the toner near end condition so toner out does

Bottle Motor Time
Displays the total ON time of the toner supply motor, calculated from when
the toner bottle was replaced. Use this to check that the toner end count
2976*

(SP2975) is working properly.
When SP2975 is set to any value other than "0", this value is displayed
when it matches the setting of SP2975. When SP2975 is set to "0", SP2976
is disabled. SP2976 is automatically set to zero by toner end recovery.)
Time

SM Appendix

[0 to 7,000,000 / 0 / 1 msec]

3-41

D129/D130

Appendix:
Service
Program
Mode Tables

not interrupt a long job.

System SP Tables-2

Toner End Status
2977*
Indicates the toner near end or end condition.
[0 to 10 / 0 / 1 ]
0: Not detected
1: Detected by SP2975-001
001 Near End

2: Vt (10) - Vref > 0.2 and Vsp > 0.6
3: Vt (10) - Vref > 0.45
4: 0.45 > Vt (10) - Vref > 0.2 and toner end counter > 300
5 to 10: Not used
[0 to 10 / 0 / 1 ]
0: Not detected
1: Vsp > 2.0
2: Toner end counter > 90 when SP2213-001 is set to "0".

002 End

3: Toner end counter < 90 and Vt (10) > (Vref + 0.3) when
SP2213-001 is set to "0".
4: When SP2213-001 is set to "2"
5: Vsp > 0.9 when SP2213-001 is set to "2"
6: Special order
7 to 10: Not used

Charge Counter

[0 to 1000000 / 0 / 1 sheets ]

Set the number of pages to print after toner and carrier initialization before
the charge input is increased to compensate for deterioration over time in
2980*

the polarity of the carrier.
The strength in the polarity of the carrier in the toner will eventually
decrease and cause lower charge output. Setting the charge output to
increase after a specified number of copies can compensate for this effect.

D129/D130

3-42

SM Appendix

System SP Table-3

3.3 SYSTEM SP TABLE-3
3.3.1 SP3-XXX: PROCESS

P Sensor Setting
Current

[0 to 43 / 13 / 0.1 mA ]

001 Allows you to reset the PWM of the ID sensor LED to avoid a service call
error after clearing NVRAM or replacing the NVRAM.
The PWM data is stored by executing SP-3001-2.
ID Initialization

-

Performs the ID sensor initial setting. ID sensor output for the bare drum
002 (VSG) is adjusted automatically to 4.0 ±0.2 V.
Press "Execute" to start. Perform this setting after replacing or cleaning the
ID sensor, replacing the drum, or clearing NVRAM.

Toner End Setting, ON/OFF

DFU

3045*
[0 to 1 / 0 / 1] 0=Off, 1=On

P Sensor Output
Displays the current VSG, VSP, VSDP, and grayscale control.
If the P sensor does not detect the P pattern, "VSP = 5.0 V/VSG = 5.0 V" is

3103*

displayed and an SC code is generated.
If the P sensor does not detect the bare area of the drum, "VSP = 0.0
V/VSG =0.0 V" is displayed and an SC code is generated.
001 Vsg

[0 to 5 / 0 / 0.1]

002 Vsp

[0 to 5 / 0 / 0.1]

003 Vsdp

[0 to 5 / 0 / 0.1]

004 Vsm/Vsg

[0 to 5 / 0 / 0.1]

SM Appendix

3-43

D129/D130

Appendix:
Service
Program
Mode Tables

3001*

System SP Table-3

3902*

New PCU Detection (Not used)

On/OFF Setting

[0 to 1 / 0 / 1]
0: On, 1: Off

001
Turns on or off the new unit detection for the transfer belt unit and fusing
unit.

Hot Roller Stripper Cleaning
3905*

"Cleaning A": 15 sec. off/on cycle for the fusing motor.
"Cleaning B": Off (45 sec.) and On (15 sec.) cycle for the fusing motor.
1st Cleaning: Interval
001 Sets the threshold for the 1st cleaning mode.
"Cleaning A" is done once.
[0 to 5 / 5 / 1 sheets]
1st Cleaning: Mode Setting
002 Sets the number of additional execution times of the 1st cleaning mode.
[0 to 5 / 0 / 1 times]
2nd Cleaning: Interval
003 Sets the threshold for the 2nd cleaning mode.
"Cleaning A" is done twice.
[6 to 49 / 30 / 1 sheets]
2nd Cleaning: Mode Setting
004 Sets the number of additional execution times of the 2nd cleaning mode.
[0 to 5 / 0 / 1 times]
3rd Cleaning: Interval
Sets the threshold for the 3rd cleaning mode.
005 "Cleaning A" is done twice and "Cleaning B" is done "N" times.
"N" is specified with SP3905-006.
[50 to 999 / 100 / 1 sheets]

D129/D130

3-44

SM Appendix

System SP Table-3

3rd Cleaning: Mode Setting
Sets the number of execution times of the 3rd cleaning mode.
006 [0 to 5 / 0 / 1 times]


All fans remain on during cleaning and then switch off 60sec after
the cleaning cycle ends.

Cleaning Priority Setting

Appendix:
Service
Program
Mode Tables

007 [0 to 1 / 0 / 1 sheets]
0: Priority to printing (No job interruption)
1: Priority to cleaning (Job interruption)

SM Appendix

3-45

D129/D130

System SP Tables-4

3.4 SYSTEM SP TABLES-4
3.4.1 SP4-XXX: SCANNER

Sub Scan Mag. Adjustment
Adjusts the magnification of the sub scan direction during scanning.

4008*

Changing this value changes the scanner motor speed.
[–1 to 1 / 0 / 0.1% ]

L-Edge Regist Adjustment
Adjusts the leading edge registration for scanning.

4010*

[–2 to 2 / 0 / 0.1 mm ]
As you enter a negative value, the image moves toward the leading edge.

S-to-S Regist Adjustment
Adjusts side-to-side registration for scanning.
4011*

[–2.5 to 2.5 / 0 / 0.1 mm ]
As you enter negative values, the image will disappear at the left, and as
you enter positive values, the image will appear at the left.

Scanner Erase Margin: Scale
Adjusts scanning margins for the leading and trailing edges (sub scan) and
right and left edge (main scan).
4012*


Do not adjust unless the customer desires a scanner margin
greater than the printer margin.



These settings are adjusted to erase shadows caused by the gap
between the original and the scale of the scanner unit.

001 Book: Leading Edge

[0 to 3 / 1 / 0.1 mm]

002 Book: Trailing Edge

[0 to 3 / 0 / 0.1 mm]

003 Book: Left

[0 to 3 / 1 / 0.1 mm]

D129/D130

3-46

SM Appendix

System SP Tables-4

004 Book: Right

[0 to 3 / 0 / 0.1 mm]

005 ADF: Leading Edge

[0 to 3 / 0 / 0.1 mm]

007 ADF: Right

[0 to 3 / 0 / 0.1 mm]

008 ADF: Left

[0 to 3 / 0 / 0.1 mm]

Scanner Free Run
4013

001 Lamp: OFF

[0 to 1 / 0 / 1]

002 Lamp: ON

0=Off, 1=On

4014

Appendix:
Service
Program
Mode Tables

Performs a scanner free run with the exposure lamp on or off.

Scan
001 HP Detection Enable

Scanner free run with HP sensor check.

002 HP Detection Disable

Scanner free run without HP sensor check.

Dust Check
This function checks the narrow scanning glass of the ADF for dust that can

4020*

cause black lines in copies. If dust is detected a system banner message is
displayed, but processing does not stop.
Dust Detect: On/Off
Issues a warning if there is dust on the narrow scanning glass of the ADF
when the original size is detected before a job starts. This function can
detect dust on the white plate above the scanning glass, as well as dust on
the glass. Sensitivity of the level of detection is adjusted with SP4020-2.
001 [0 to 1 / 1 / 1]
0: Off. No dust warning.
1: On. Dust warning. This warning does not stop the job.


Before switching this setting on, clean the ADF scanning glass and
the white plate above the scanning glass.

SM Appendix

3-47

D129/D130

System SP Tables-4

Dust Detect: Lvl
Adjusts the sensitivity for dust detection on the ADF scanning glass. This SP
is available only after SP4020-1 is switched on.
[0 to 8 / 4 / 1]
If you see black streaks in copies when no warning has been issued, raise
002 the setting to increase the level of sensitivity. If warnings are issued when
you see not black streaks in copies, lower the setting.


Dust that triggers a warning could move be removed from the glass
by the originals in the feed path. If the dust is removed by passing
originals, this is not detected and the warning remains on.

Dust Reject: Lvl
003 Selects the level of the sub scan line correction when using the ARDF.
[0 to 4 / 0 / 1]
0: OFF, 1: Weakest, 2: Weak, 3: Strong, 4: Strongest

APS Operation Check
4301

Displays a code that represents the original size detected by the original
sensors. (

p.3-251 "Input Check")

APS Min. Size
Determines whether an original of non-standard size is detected as A5/HLT
size by the APS sensor.
4303

0: No original
1: A5 - lengthwise (SEF)
2: A5 - Sideways (LEF)
If "0" is selected, "Cannot detect original size" will be displayed.

D129/D130

3-48

SM Appendix

System SP Tables-4

8K/16K Detection
[0 to 3 / 0 / 1 step]
0: Normal Detection ( the machine detects A4/LT size as A4 or LT,
4305

depending on the paper size setting)
1: A4-sideways LT-Lengthwise
2: LT-sideways A4-Lenghtwise

4308*

Appendix:
Service
Program
Mode Tables

3: 8K 16K

Scan Size Detection
Detection ON/OFF
Selects whether the machine detects the original size.
001 [0 to 1 / 1 / 1 step]
0: OFF
1: ON

4309*

Scan Size Detect: Setting
Original Density Thresh
001 Adjust the density for the scan size detection.
[0 to 255 / 18 / 1 step]
Detection Time
002 Adjust the detection time for scan size detection.
[20 to 100 / 60 / 20 msec]
Lamp ON: Delay Time
003 Adjust the timing when to lamp on for the scan size detection.
[0 to 200 / 40 / 20 msec]
LED PWM Duty
004 Adjust the light value for the scan size detection.
[0 to 100 / 60 / 1 %]

SM Appendix

3-49

D129/D130

System SP Tables-4

Scan Size Detect Value

[0 to 255 / 0 / 1 digit]

4310
Displays the scanned data for the original width detection.
001 S1: R
002 S1: G
003 S1: B
004 S2: R
005 S2: G
006 S2: B
007 S3: R
008 S3: G
009 S3: B



Each detection point (S1, S2, S3) in SP4310 is as follows.

D129/D130

3-50

SM Appendix

System SP Tables-4

Scanner Erase Margin
4400*
These SPs set the area to be masked during platen (book) mode scanning.
001 Book: Leading Edge
002 Book: Trailing Edge
003 Book: Left
[0 to 3 / 0 / 0.1 mm]
Appendix:
Service
Program
Mode Tables

004 Book: Right
005 ADF: Leading Edge
007 ADF: Right
008 ADF: Left

SM Appendix

3-51

D129/D130

System SP Tables-4

IPU Test Pattern
Selects the IPU test Pattern.
[0 to 28 / 0 / 1]
0: Scanned image

15: Gray pattern (1)

1: Gradation main scan A

16: Gray pattern (2)

2: Gradation main scan B

17: Gray pattern (3)

3: Gradation main scan C

18: Shading pattern

4: Gradation main scan D

19: Thin line pattern

5: Gradation sub scan (1)

20: Scanned + Grid pattern

Test

6: Grid pattern (1)

21: Scanned + Grid scale

Pattern

7: Slant grid pattern

22: Scanned + Color patch

8: Gradation K

23: Scanned + Slant Grid C

9: Check pattern 16

24: Scanned + Slant Grid D

10: Gray patch 16 (1)

25: Gray Scale 18 text

11: Gray patch 16 (2)

26: Gray Scale 18 photo

12: Gray patch 64

27: Gray Scale 256 text

13: Grid pattern (2)

28: Gray Scale 256 photo

4417

14: Color patch K

4429*

Select Copy Data Security
001 Copying
002 Scanning
003 Fax Operation

D129/D130

Adjusts the density of the embedded message
with the copy data security unit.
[0 to 3 / 3 / 1 ]
3: Darkest density

3-52

SM Appendix

System SP Tables-4

4450

Scan Image Path Selection
Black Subtraction ON/OFF

[0 to 1 / 1 / 1] 0=OFF, 1=ON

001
Uses or does not use the black reduction image path.
SH ON/OFF

[0 to 1 / 0 / 1] 0=OFF, 1=ON

002
Uses or does not use the shading image path.

4460*

Appendix:
Service
Program
Mode Tables

Digital AE
Specifies the level of deleting the background in the ADS mode. You can
adjust its level for each scanning method (platen, ADF).
001 Low Limit Value

[0 to 1023 / 364 / 1 digit]

002 Background level

[512 to 1535 / 932 / 1 digit]

Printer Vector Correction
4540*

This SP corrects the printer coverage of 12 hues (RY, YR, YG, etc. x 4
Colors [R, G, B, Option]) for a total of 48 parameters.

001-004

RY Phase: Option/R/G/B

005-008

YR Phase: Option/R/G/B

009-012

YG Phase: Option/R/G/B

013-016

GY Phase: Option/R/G/B

017-020

GC Phase: Option/R/G/B

Specifies the printer vector correction value.

021-024

CG Phase: Option/R/G/B

[0 to 255 / 0 / 1 ]

025-028

CB Phase: Option/R/G/B

029-032

BC Phase: Option/R/G/B

033-036

BM Phase: Option/R/G/B

037-040

MB Phase: Option/R/G/B

SM Appendix

3-53

D129/D130

System SP Tables-4

041-044

MR Phase: Option/R/G/B

045-048

RM Phase: Option/R/G/B

4550*

Scan Apli:Txt/Print

4551*

Scan Apli:Txt

4552*

Scan Apli:Txt Dropout

4553*

Scan Apli:Txt/Photo

4554*

Scan Apli:Photo

4565*

Scan Apli:GrayScale

4570*

Scan Apli:Col Txt/Photo

4571*

Scan Apli:Col Gloss Photo

4572*

Scan Apli:AutoCol
[0 to 15 / 8 / 1 ]

MTF: 0(Off) 1-15 (Weak-Strong)

0: MTF OFF

-005
Sets the MTF level (Modulation Transfer Function) designed to improve
image contrast. Set higher for stronger effect, lower for weaker effect.
Smoothing: 0(x1) 1-7

[0 to 7 / 4 / 1 ]

-006 (Weak-Strong)

Use to remove "jaggies" if they appear. Set higher for smoother images.
Brightness: 1-255

[1 to 255 / 128 / 1 ]

-007
Set higher for darker, set lower for lighter.
Contrast: 1-255

[1 to 255 / 128 / 1 ]

-008
Set higher for more contrast, set lower for less contrast.

D129/D130

3-54

SM Appendix

System SP Tables-4

Ind Dot Erase: 0(Off) 1-7

[0 to 7 / 0 / 1 ]

(Weak-Strong)

-009 Sets the erasure level of Irregular Dots. Set higher for stronger effect, lower
for weaker effect.

4580*

Fax Apli:Txt/Chart

4581*

Fax Apli:Txt

4582*

Fax Apli:Txt/Photo

4583*

Fax Apli:Photo

4584*

Fax Apli:Original 1

4585*

Fax Apli:Original 2

Appendix:
Service
Program
Mode Tables

0: Not activated

[0 to 15 / 8 / 1 ]

MTF: 0(Off) 1-15 (Weak-Strong)

0: MTF OFF

-005
Sets the MTF level (Modulation Transfer Function) designed to improve
image contrast. Set higher for stronger effect, lower for weaker effect.
Smoothing: 0(x1) 1-7

[0 to 7 / 4 / 1 ]

-006 (Weak-Strong)

Use to remove "jaggies" if they appear. Set higher for smoother images.
Brightness: 1-255

[1 to 255 / 128 / 1 ]

-007
Set higher for darker, set lower for lighter.
Contrast: 1-255

[1 to 255 / 128 / 1 ]

-008
Set higher for more contrast, set lower for less contrast.
Ind Dot Erase: 0(Off) 1-7

[0 to 7 / 0 / 1 ]

(Weak-Strong)

-009 Sets the erasure level of Irregular Dots. Set higher for stronger effect, lower
for weaker effect.
0: Not activated
SM Appendix

3-55

D129/D130

System SP Tables-4

Texture Erase: 0 (Fix), 1-2

[0 to 2 / 0 / 1 ]

-010 Sets the erasure level of textures. Set higher for stronger effect, lower for
weaker effect.
Note: This SP code exists for SP4580, SP4582 and SP4583 only.

4600

SBU Version
001 SBU ID

Displays the ID of the SBU.

002 GASBU-N ID

Displays the ID of the GASBU.

003 VSP5100 ID

Displays the ID of the VSP5100.

4602

Scanner Memory Access

001 Scanner Memory Access

4603

Enables the read and write check for the
SBU registers.

AGC Execution
001 HP Detection Enable

Executes the AGC with the scanner detection.

002 HP Detection Disable

Executes the AGC with the scanner detection.

FGATE Open/Close
Opens or closes the FGATE signal. This SP automatically returns to the
4604

default status (close) after exiting this SP.
[0 to 1 / 0 / 1]
0: OFF, 1: ON

D129/D130

3-56

SM Appendix

System SP Tables-4

4609*

Gray Balance Set: R
Book Scan

[-384 to 255 / -46 / 1 digit]

001
Displays the scanning level value (adjustment) for the red signal in Book Scan.
DF Scan

[-384 to 255 / -46 / 1 digit]

002

4610*

Gray Balance Set: G
Book Scan

[-384 to 255 / -20 / 1 digit]

001 Displays the scanning level value (adjustment) for the green signal in Book
Scan.
DF Scan

[-384 to 255 / -20 / 1 digit]

002 Displays the scanning level value (adjustment) for the green signal in DF
Scan.

4611*

Gray Balance Set: B
Book Scan

[-384 to 255 / -28 / 1 digit]

001 Displays the scanning level value (adjustment) for the blue signal in Book
Scan.
DF Scan

[-384 to 255 / -28 / 1 digit]

002
Displays the scanning level value (adjustment) for the blue signal in DF Scan.

SM Appendix

3-57

D129/D130

Appendix:
Service
Program
Mode Tables

Displays the scanning level value (adjustment) for the red signal in DF Scan.

System SP Tables-4

4623

Black Level Adj. Display
Latest: RE Color

[0 to 16383 / 0 / 1 digit]

001 Displays the black offset value (rough adjustment) for the even red signal in the
SBU (color printing speed).
Latest: RO Color

[0 to 16383 / 0 / 1 digit]

002 Displays the black offset value (rough adjustment) for the odd red signal in the
SBU (color printing speed).



4624

RE: Red Even signal, RO: Red Odd signal

Black Level Adj. Display
Latest: GE Color

001 [0 to 16383 / 0 / 1 digit]
Displays the black offset value (rough adjustment) for the even green signal in
the SBU (color printing speed).
Latest: GO Color
002 [0 to 16383 / 0 / 1 digit]
Displays the black offset value (rough adjustment) for the odd green signal in the
SBU (color printing speed).



4625

GE: Green Even signal, GO: Green Odd signal

Black Level Adj. Display
Latest: BE Color

001 [0 to 16383 / 0 / 1 digit]
Displays the black offset value (rough adjustment) for the even blue signal in the
SBU (color printing speed).
002 Latest: BO Color
D129/D130

3-58

SM Appendix

System SP Tables-4

[0 to 16383 / 0 / 1 digit]
Displays the black offset value (rough adjustment) for the odd blue signal in the
SBU (color printing speed).



BE: Blue Even signal, BO: Blue Odd signal

Analog Gain Adjust
Displays the gain value of the amplifiers on the controller for Red.
Appendix:
Service
Program
Mode Tables

4628

Only for the color scanner
001 Latest: R Color

[0 to 255 / 0 / 1 digit]

Analog Gain Adjust
4629

Displays the gain value of the amplifiers on the controller for Green.
SP4629-003 and -004 are used only for the color scanner model.
001 Latest: G Color

[0 to 7 / 0 / 1 digit]

Analog Gain Adjust
4630
Displays the gain value of the amplifiers on the controller for Blue.
001 Latest: B Color

[0 to 7 / 0 / 1 digit]

Digital Gain Adjust
4631
Displays the gain value of the amplifiers on the controller for RE or RO.
001 Latest: RE Color

[0 to 1023 / 0 / 1 digit]

002 Latest RO Color

[0 to 1023 / 0 / 1 digit]

SM Appendix

3-59

D129/D130

System SP Tables-4

Digital Gain Adjust
4632
Displays the gain value of the amplifiers on the controller for GE or GO.
001 Latest: GE Color

[0 to 1023 / 0 / 1 digit]

002 Latest: GO Color

[0 to 1023 / 0 / 1 digit]

Digital Gain Adjust
4633
Displays the gain value of the amplifiers on the controller for BE or BO.
001 Latest: BE Color

[0 to 1023 / 0 / 1 digit]

002 Latest: BO Color

[0 to 1023 / 0 / 1 digit]

4635*

SSCG Correction Set (DFU)
Apply ON/OFF

[0 to 1 / 1 / 1 digit]

Calculation ON/OFF

[0 to 1 / 1 / 1 digit]

001

002

4636

SSCG Correction Execution (DFU)
SSCG Correction Execution

[0 to 1 / 1 / 1 digit]

SSCG Correction Error Flag

[0 to 2 / 0 / 1 digit]

001

002

SSCG Result Apply
003 Execution 80H

D129/D130

[0 to 1 / 0 / 1 digit]

3-60

SM Appendix

System SP Tables-4

SSCG Result Apply
004 Execution Last

4637

[0 to 1 / 0 / 1 digit]

SSCG Correction Adj (DFU)
Latest:RE

[0 to 225 / 128 / 1]

Latest:RO

[0 to 225 / 128 / 1]

Latest:GE

[0 to 225 / 128 / 1]

Latest:GO

[0 to 225 / 128 / 1]

Latest:BE

[0 to 225 / 128 / 1]

Latest:BO

[0 to 225 / 128 / 1]

Appendix:
Service
Program
Mode Tables

001

002

003

004

005

006

4638*

SSCG Correction Adj (DFU)
Last:RE

[0 to 225 / 128 / 1]

Last:RO

[0 to 225 / 128 / 1]

001

002

SM Appendix

3-61

D129/D130

System SP Tables-4

Last:GE

[0 to 225 / 128 / 1]

Last:GO

[0 to 225 / 128 / 1]

Last:BE

[0 to 225 / 128 / 1]

Last:BO

[0 to 225 / 128 / 1]

003

004

005

006

4639*

SSCG Correction Adj (DFU)
Factory Setting:RE

[0 to 225 / 128 / 1]

Factory Setting:RO

[0 to 225 / 128 / 1]

Factory Setting:GE

[0 to 225 / 128 / 1]

Factory Setting:GO

[0 to 225 / 128 / 1]

Factory Setting:BE

[0 to 225 / 128 / 1]

Factory Setting:BO

[0 to 225 / 128 / 1]

001

002

003

004

005

006

D129/D130

3-62

SM Appendix

System SP Tables-4

4640

SSCG Noise Size (DFU)
Before Adj: RE

[0 to 1023 / 0 / 1 ]

Before Adj: RO

[0 to 1023 / 0 / 1 ]

Before Adj: GE

[0 to 1023 / 0 / 1 ]

Before Adj: GO

[0 to 1023 / 0 / 1 ]

Before Adj: BE

[0 to 1023 / 0 / 1 ]

Before Adj: BO

[0 to 1023 / 0 / 1 ]

After Adj: RE

[0 to 1023 / 0 / 1 ]

After Adj: RO

[0 to 1023 / 0 / 1 ]

After Adj: GE

[0 to 1023 / 0 / 1 ]

After Adj: GO

[0 to 1023 / 0 / 1 ]

001

002

Appendix:
Service
Program
Mode Tables

003

004

005

006

007

008

009

010

SM Appendix

3-63

D129/D130

System SP Tables-4

After Adj: BE

[0 to 1023 / 0 / 1 ]

After Adj: BO

[0 to 1023 / 0 / 1 ]

011

012

Scan Adjust Error
4645
Displays the error value of the white level or black level adjustment.
001 White level

[0 to 65535 / 0 / 1 digit]

002 Black level

[0 to 65535 / 0 / 1 digit]

Scanner Hard Error
Displays the result of the SBU connection check.
4647

[0 to 35535 / 0 / 1 ]
Power-ON

0: OK, 1: SBU connection check failure
If the SBU connection check fails, SC144-001, -002 or
-003 occurs.

4654*

Black Level Adj. Display
Latest Correct Value: RE Color

001 [0 to 16383 / 0 / 1 digit ]
Displays the previous black offset value (rough adjustment) for the even red
signal in the SBU (color printing speed).
Last Correct Value: RO Color
002 [0 to 16383 / 0 / 1 digit ]
Displays the previous black offset value (rough adjustment) for the odd red
signal in the SBU (color printing speed).

D129/D130

3-64

SM Appendix

System SP Tables-4



RE: Red Even signal, RO: Red Odd signal

4655*

Black Level Adj. Display
Last Correct Value: GE Color

001 [0 to 16383 / 0 / 1 digit ]
Displays the previous black offset value (rough adjustment) for the even green

Last Correct Value: GO Color
002 [0 to 16383 / 0 / 1 digit ]
Displays the previous black offset value (rough adjustment) for the even green
signal in the SBU (color printing speed).



GE: Green Even signal, GO: Green Odd signal

4656*

Black Level Adj. Display
Last Correct Value: BE Color

001 [0 to 16383 / 0 / 1 digit ]
Displays the previous black offset value (rough adjustment) for the even blue
signal in the SBU (color printing speed).
Last Correct Value: BO Color
002 [0 to 16383 / 0 / 1 digit ]
Displays the previous black offset value (rough adjustment) for the odd blue
signal in the SBU (color printing speed).

SM Appendix

3-65

D129/D130

Appendix:
Service
Program
Mode Tables

signal in the SBU (color printing speed).

System SP Tables-4



BE: Blue Even signal, BO: Blue Odd signal

Analog Gain Adjust
4658*
Displays the previous gain value of the amplifiers on the controller for Red.
001 Last Correct Value: R Color

[0 to 7 / 0 / 1 digit ]

Analog Gain Adjust
4659*

Displays the previous gain value of the amplifiers on the controller for Green.
SP4659-003 and -004 are used only for the color scanner model.

001 Last Correct Value: G Color

[0 to 7 / 0 / 1 digit ]

Analog Gain Adjust
4660*
Displays the previous gain value of the amplifiers on the controller for Blue.
001 Last Correct Value: B Color

4661*

[0 to 7 / 0 / 1 digit ]

Digital Gain Adjust
Last Correct Value: RE Color

001 [0 to 1023 / 0 / 1 digit ]
Displays the previous 2nd black offset value (rough adjustment) for the even
red signal in the SBU (color printing speed).
Last Correct Value: RO Color
002 [0 to 1023 / 0 / 1 digit ]
Displays the previous 2nd black offset value (rough adjustment) for the odd
red signal in the SBU (color printing speed).

D129/D130

3-66

SM Appendix

System SP Tables-4



RE: Red Even signal, RO: Red Odd signal

4662*

Digital Gain Adjust
Last Correct Value: GE Color

001 [0 to 1023 / 0 / 1 digit ]
Displays the previous 2nd black offset value (rough adjustment) for the even

Last Correct Value: GO Color
002 [0 to 1023 / 0 / 1 digit ]
Displays the previous 2nd black offset value (rough adjustment) for the odd
green signal in the SBU (color printing speed).



GE: Green Even signal, GO: Green Odd signal

4663*

Digital Gain Adjust
Last Correct Value: BE Color

001 [0 to 1023 / 0 / 1 digit ]
Displays the previous 2nd black offset value (rough adjustment) for the even
blue signal in the SBU (color printing speed).
Last Correct Value: BO Color
002 [0 to 1023 / 0 / 1 digit ]
Displays the previous 2nd black offset value (rough adjustment) for the odd
blue signal in the SBU (color printing speed).

SM Appendix

3-67

D129/D130

Appendix:
Service
Program
Mode Tables

green signal in the SBU (color printing speed).

System SP Tables-4



BE: Blue Even signal, BO: Blue Odd signal

4673

Black Level Adj. Display
Factory Setting: RE Color
001 [0 to 16383 / 0 / 1 digit ]
Displays the factory setting value of the 2nd black offset level rough
adjustment for the even red signal in the SBU (color printing speed).
Factory Setting: RO Color
002 [0 to 16383 / 0 / 1 digit ]
Displays the factory setting values of the 2nd black offset level rough
adjustment for the odd red signal in the SBU (color printing speed).



RE: Red Even signal, RO: Red Odd signal

4674

Black Level Adj. Display
Factory Setting: GE Color
001 [0 to 16383 / 0 / 1 digit ]
Displays the factory setting value of the 2nd black offset level rough
adjustment for the even green signal in the SBU (color printing speed).
Factory Setting: GO Color
002 [0 to 16383 / 0 / 1 digit ]
Displays the factory setting values of the 2nd black offset level rough
adjustment for the odd green signal in the SBU (color printing speed).

D129/D130

3-68

SM Appendix

System SP Tables-4



4675

GE: Green Even signal, GO: Green Odd signal

Black Level Adj. Display
Factory Setting: BE Color
001 [0 to 16383 / 0 / 1 digit ]
Displays the factory setting value of the 2nd black offset level rough

Appendix:
Service
Program
Mode Tables

adjustment for the even blue signal in the SBU (color printing speed).
Factory Setting: BO Color
002 [0 to 16383 / 0 / 1 digit ]
Displays the factory setting values of the 2nd black offset level rough
adjustment for the odd blue signal in the SBU (color printing speed).



BE: Blue Even signal, BO: Blue Odd signal

Analog Gain Adjust
4677

Displays the factory setting values of the gain adjustment for Red.
SP4677-003 and -004 are used only for the color scanner model.
001 Factory Setting: R

[ 0 to 7 / 0 / 1 digit]

Analog Gain Adjust
4678

Displays the factory setting values of the gain adjustment for Green.
SP4678-003 and -004 are used only for the color scanner model.
001 Factory Setting: G

SM Appendix

[ 0 to 7 / 0 / 1 digit]

3-69

D129/D130

System SP Tables-4

Analog Gain Adjust
4679
Displays the factory setting values of the gain adjustment for Blue.
001 Factory Setting: B

4680*

[ 0 to 7 / 0 / 1 digit]

Digital Gain Adjust
Factory Setting: RE Color

001 [0 to 1023 / 0 / 1 digit ]
Displays the gain value of the amplifiers on the controller for Red.
Factory Setting: RO Color
002 [0 to 1023 / 0 / 1 digit ]
Displays the gain value of the amplifiers on the controller for odd Red.

4681*

Digital Gain Adjust
Factory Setting: GE Color

001 [0 to 1023 / 0 / 1 digit ]
Displays the gain value of the amplifiers on the controller for Green.
Factory Setting: GO Color
002 [0 to 1023 / 0 / 1 digit ]
Displays the gain value of the amplifiers on the controller for odd Green.

4682*

Digital Gain Adjust
Factory Setting: BE Color

001 [0 to 1023 / 0 / 1 digit ]
Displays the gain value of the amplifiers on the controller for Blue.
Factory Setting: BO Color
002
Displays the gain value of the amplifiers on the controller for odd Blue.

D129/D130

3-70

SM Appendix

System SP Tables-4

Scan Image Density Adjustment
Adjusts the white shading parameter when scanning an image with the ARDF.
4688*

Adjusts the density level if the ID of outputs made in the DF and Platen mode
is different.
[80 to 120 / 98 / 1 % ]

White Level Peak Read
Appendix:
Service
Program
Mode Tables

4690
Displays the peak level of the white level scanning.
001 RE
[0 to 1023 / 0 / 1 digit ]
002 RO

White Level Peak Read
4691
Displays the peak level of the white level scanning.
001 GE
[0 to 1023 / 0 / 1 digit ]
002 GO

White Level Peak Read
4692
Displays the peak level of the white level scanning.
001 BE
[0 to 1023 / 0 / 1 digit ]
002 BO

Black Level Peak Read
4693
Displays the peak level of the black level scanning.
001 RE
[0 to 1023 / 0 / 1 digit ]
002 RO

SM Appendix

3-71

D129/D130

System SP Tables-4

Black Level Peak Read
4694
Display the peak level of the black level scanning.
001 GE
[0 to 1023 / 0 / 1 digit ]
002 GO

Black Level Peak Read
4695
Display the peak level of the black level scanning.
001 BE
[0 to 1023 / 0 / 1 digit ]
002 BO

4802

DF Shading FreeRun
001 Lamp OFF

[0 to 1 / 0 / 1 ]
Executes the scanner free run of the shading
movement with exposure lamp on or off.

002 Lamp ON

Press "OFF" to stop this free run. Otherwise, the free
run continues.

Moves the exposure lamp a short distance
4804

Home Position

and immediately returns it to its home
position.
Touch [Execute] > "Completed" > [Exit]

D129/D130

3-72

SM Appendix

System SP Tables-4

Carriage Save
Moves the exposure lamp a short distance away from the home position and
stops.
Touch [Execute] > "Completed" > [Exit]
4806

Do SP4804 to return the exposure lamp to its home position.


This SP is done before shipping the machine to another location.



Cycling the machine power off/on also returns the exposure lamp to
Appendix:
Service
Program
Mode Tables

its home position.

SBU Test Pattern Change
[0 to 255 / 0 / 1 /step]
4807

1: Grid pattern
2: Gradation main scan
3: Gradation sub scan
4 to 250: Default (Scanning Image)

Factory Setting Input (DFU)
4808*

Execution Flag

[0 to 1 / 0 / 1 /step]

Scanner Lamp Select
[0 to 1 / 1 / 1 /step]
4809*

0: Xenon Lamp
1: LED
This SP switch the light value depends on the scanner lamp type.

SM Appendix

3-73

D129/D130

System SP Tables-4

4810

PWM (DFU)
Latest

[0 to 8191 / 0 / 1 /step]

Factory Setting

[0 to 8191 / 0 / 1 /step]

001

002*

4811

LED White Level Peak Read (DFU)
Latest: RE

[0 to 1023 / 0 / 1 /step]

Latest: RO

[0 to 1023 / 0 / 1 /step]

Latest: GE

[0 to 1023 / 0 / 1 /step]

Latest: GO

[0 to 1023 / 0 / 1 /step]

Latest: BE

[0 to 1023 / 0 / 1 /step]

Latest: BO

[0 to 1023 / 0 / 1 /step]

001

002

003

004

005

006

D129/D130

3-74

SM Appendix

System SP Tables-4

4812*

LED White Level Peak Read (DFU)
Factory Setting: RE

[0 to 1023 / 0 / 1 /step]

Factory Setting: RO

[0 to 1023 / 0 / 1 /step]

Factory Setting: GE

[0 to 1023 / 0 / 1 /step]

Factory Setting: GO

[0 to 1023 / 0 / 1 /step]

Factory Setting: BE

[0 to 1023 / 0 / 1 /step]

Factory Setting: BO

[0 to 1023 / 0 / 1 /step]

001

002

Appendix:
Service
Program
Mode Tables

003

004

005

006

Filter Setting
This SP code sets the threshold value for independent dot erase.
These adjustments are effective only for the "Custom Setting" original type.

4903*

The "0" setting disables independent dot erase.
A higher setting detects more spurious dots for erasing. However, this could
erase dots in images that contain areas filled by dithering.
001 Ind Dot Erase: Text
[0 to 7 / 0 / 1 ]
002 Ind Dot Erase: Generation Copy

SM Appendix

3-75

D129/D130

System SP Tables-4

4905*

Select Gradation Level

4918

Man Gamma Adj (DFU)

Changes the parameters for dithering.
[0 to 255 / 0 / 1 ]

Adjusts the offset data of the printer gamma for black in Photo mode or
Letter mode.
Touch [Change] to open the printer gamma screen.
Enter the manual gamma adjustment screen.

4954

Read/Restore Std
Read New Chart
001
Execute the scanning of the A4 chart.
Recall Prev Chart
002
Clear the data of the scanned A4 chart.
Read Std Chart
003
Execute the scanning of the A4 standard chart.
Set Std Chart
004
Overwrite the standard data.
Read/Restore Std

[0 to 255 / 0 / 1]

005* Adjusts chromaticity rank. When replacing the scanner lamp, select a
number according to the barcode on the new scanner lamp.

D129/D130

3-76

SM Appendix

System SP Tables-4

4991

IPU Image Pass Selection DFU
RGB Frame Memory
Selects the image path. Enter the number to be selected using the 10-key
pad.

001

SM Appendix

0

Scanner input RGB images

1

Scanner I/F RGB images

2

RGB images done by Shading correction (Shading ON, Black offset ON)

3

Shading data

4

Inner pattern data: Gray scale

5

RGB images done by Line skipping correction

6

RGB images done by Digital AE

7

RGB images done by Vertical line correction

8

RGB image done by Scanner gamma correction

9

RGB image done by Filtering correction

10

RGB images done by Full color ADS

11

RGB image done by Color correction

3-77

D129/D130

Appendix:
Service
Program
Mode Tables

[0 to 11 / 2/ 1]

System SP Tables-4

4993*

High Light Correction
Selects the Highlight correction level.
001 Sensitivity Selection

[0 to 9 / 4 / 1 /step]
0: weakest sensitivity
9: strongest sensitivity
Selects the Highlight correction level.

002 Range Selection

[0 to 9 / 4 / 1 /step]
0: weakest skew correction,
9: strongest skew correction

4994*

Text/Photo Detect Level Adj.
High Compression PDF
Selects the definition level between Text and Photo for high compression
PDF.
001 [0 to 2 / 1 / 1 ]
0: Text priority
1: Normal
2: Photo priority

4996*

White Paper Level

001

D129/D130

Select the detection level for the white paper.
[0 to 6 / 3 / 1 ]

3-78

SM Appendix

System SP Tables-5

3.5 SYSTEM SP TABLES-5
3.5.1 SP5-XXX: MODE

mm/inch Display Selection

0: Europe/Asia (mm)
1: North America (inch)

5024*
Selects the unit of measurement.

Appendix:
Service
Program
Mode Tables

After selection, turn the main power switch off and on.

Accounting counter
Selects whether the printer counter is displayed on the LCD.
5045*

[0-1 / 0 / 1]
0: Displays the total counter only.
1: Displays both total counter and printer counter.

5047*

Paper Display
Turns on or off the printed paper display on the LCD.
[0 to 1 / 0 / 1]
0: Not displayed, 1: Displayed

ReturnTimePriorityType
Select the priority to return to the stand-by mode.
5052*

[0 to 1 / 0 / 1]
0: Energy Save has priority
1: Return time has priority

Display IP Address
5055*

Display or does not display the IP address on the LCD.
[0 to 1 / 0 / 1]
0: OFF, 1: ON

SM Appendix

3-79

D129/D130

System SP Tables-5

5056*

Coverage Counter Display
Display or does not display the coverage counter on the LCD.
[0 to 1 / 0 / 1]
0: Not displayed, 1: Displayed

5061*

Toner Remaining Icon Display Change
Display or does not display the remaining toner display icon on the LCD.
[0 to 1 / 0 / 1 ]
0: Not display, 1: Display

Parts Replacement Alert Display
5062
Display or does not display the parts replacement alert on the LCD.
PCU_Bk
001 [0 to 1 / 0 / 1 ]
0: Not displayed, 1: Display
Fuser
002 [0 to 1 / 0 / 1 ]
0: Not displayed, 1: Display
Transfer Unit
003 [0 to 1 / 0 / 1 ]
0: Not displayed, 1: Display
FuserCleaner
004 [0 to 1 / 0 / 1 ]
0: Not displayed, 1: Display

D129/D130

3-80

SM Appendix

System SP Tables-5

5071

Set Bypass Paper Size Display
Turn on or off the paper size confirmation pop-up on the LED. This pop-up
prevents mismatching between a paper size selected by the operation
001 panel and the actual paper size on the by-pass tray.
[0 or 1 / 0 / -]
0: Off, 1: On

Home Screen Login
Appendix:
Service
Program
Mode Tables

5074*
Sets the application that appears when the home key is pressed.
Setting
002 [0 to 11111111 / 0 / 1]
0: OFF, 1: ON
Home Key Customization
091 [0 to 2 / 0 / 1 ]
0: OFF (Function disable), 1: SDK, 2: Reserve (Legacy application)
Product ID
092 Sets the Application product ID.
[0x00 to 0xffff / 0x00 / 1]
Application Screen ID
093 Sets the display category of the application that is specified in the
SP5075-001.
[0 to 255 / 0 / 1 ]

SM Appendix

3-81

D129/D130

System SP Tables-5

5075*

Rev. 11/15/2012

USB Keyboard
Function Setting
001 [0 to 1 / 0 / 1 ]
0: Disable, 1: Enable

5083

[LED Light Switch Setting - Toner Near End]
001 Choose whether or not the [Check Status] key blinks when Toner Near End
is reached.

⇒

[0 to 1 / 0 / 1 ]
[0: Does not blink/ 1: Blinks]

5104*

NOTE: (Requires System/Copy Firmware 2.05 of later)
- This SP makes it possible to set whether or not the [Check
Status] key blinks when Toner Near End is reached.
- With previous firmware versions, this key always blinked
when Toner Near End was reached.

A3/DLT Double Count (SSP)
001

When "Yes" is selected, A3 and DLT paper are counted twice, that is A4 x2
and LT x2 respectively.
[0 to 1 / 1 / 1 ]

⇒

[0: Single Count/ 1: Double Count (Default)]

5113*

NOTE: (Requires System/Copy Firmware
2.06 of later) for default = 1.

Optional Counter Type
Default Optional Counter Type
Selects the type of counter:
0: None
1: Key Card (RK3, 4) Japan only
001 2: Key Card Down
3: Pre-paid Card
4: Coin Rack
5: MF Key Card
11: Exp. Key Card (Add)
12: Exp. Key Card (Deduct)
002 External Optional Counter Type

D129/D130

3-82

SM Appendix

System SP Tables-5

Rev. 8/21/2012

Enables the SDK application. This lets you select a number for the external
device for user access control.
Note: "SDK" refers to software on an SD card.
[0 to 3 / 0 / 1]
0: None
1: Expansion Device 1
2: Expansion Device 2

5114*

Optional Counter I/F
MF Key Card Extension
001 Use this SP and change the setting to "1" only when the "5" (MF Key Card)
is selected with SP5113-001.
[0: Not installed/ 1: Installed (scanning accounting)]

Disable Copying
Temporarily denies access to the machine. Japan Only
5118*

[0 to 1 / 0 / 1]
0: Release for normal operation [Default]
1: Prohibit access to machine

Mode Clear Opt. Counter Removal
Selects if mode clear is done for an optional counter when an optional
5120*

counter is removed.
0: Yes. (Always mode clear)
1: StandBy. (Mode clear before/after a job)
2: No. (No mode clear)

Counter Up Timing
Determines whether the optional key counter counts up at paper feed-in or
5121*

at paper exit.
[0 to 1 / 0 / 1 ]
0: Feed, 1: Exit

SM Appendix

3-83

D129/D130

Appendix:
Service
Program
Mode Tables

3: Expansion Device 3

System SP Tables-5

F Size Original Setting
Selects F size original setting.
5126*

[0 to 2 / 0 / 1 step]
0: 8 1/2 x 13 (Foolscap)
1: 8 1/4 x 13 (Folio)
2: 8 x 13 (F)

APS Mode
5127*

Selects whether the APS function is enabled or disabled with the contact of
a pre-paid card or coin lock.
0: Disable (APS active) [Default], 1: Enable (APS not active)

Paper Size Type Selection
Selects the paper size (type) for both originals and copy paper.
5131*

[0 to 2 / - / 1 step]
0: Japan, 1: North America, 2: Europe
After changing the setting, turn the copier off and on. If the paper size of the
archive files stored on the HDD is different, abnormal copies could result.

Bypass Length Setting
Sets up the by-pass tray for long paper.
5150

[0 to 1 / 0 / 1]
0: Off [Default]
1: On. Sets the tray for feeding paper up to 600 mm long.
With this SP selected on, paper jams are not detected in the paper path.

D129/D130

3-84

SM Appendix

System SP Tables-5

App. Switch Method
Determines whether the application screen is switched with a hardware
5162*

switch or software switch.
0: Soft Key Set
1: Hard Key Set

Z-Fold Position
5165*

5166*

Appendix:
Service
Program
Mode Tables

Not Used

Lump Delete Form Setting
Last Deleted Time
021 Displays the last delete time.
[0 to 4294967295 / 0 / 1]

Fax Printing Mode at Optional Counter Off
Enables or disables the automatic print out without an accounting device.
5167*

This SP is used when the receiving fax is accounted for by an external
accounting device.
0: Automatic printing
1: No automatic printing

CE Login
If you will change the printer bit switches, you must 'log in' to service mode
5169*

with this SP before you go into the printer SP mode.
[0 to 1 / 0 / 1]
0: Off. Printer bit switches cannot be adjusted.
1: On. Printer bit switches can be adjusted.

SM Appendix

3-85

D129/D130

System SP Tables-5

By-pass Tray Paper Size Error

[0 to 1 / 0 / 1 ] 0= OFF, 1= ON

This SP determines whether a paper size error prompt appears when the

5179*

machine detects the wrong paper size for the job and during feed from the
by-pass tray.

Paper Size Setting
5181*
Adjusts the paper size for each tray. [0 to 1 / - / 1]
001 Tray 1: 1

0: A4 LEF, 1: LT LEF

002 Tray 1: 2

0: A3, 1: DLT

003 Tray 1: 3

0: B4, 1: LG

004 Tray 1: 4

0: B5 LEF, 1: Exe LEF

005 Tray 2: 1

0: A4 LEF, 1: LT LEF

006 Tray 2: 2

0: A3, 1: DLT

007 Tray 2: 3

0: B4, 1: LG

008 Tray 2: 4

0: B5 LEF, 1: Exe LEF

009 Tray 3: 1 (Tandem)

0: A4 LEF, 1: LT LEF

010 Tray 3: 2

0: A3, 1: DLT

011 Tray 3: 3

0: B4, 1: LG

012 Tray 3: 4

0: B5 LEF, 1: Exe LEF

013 Tray 4: 1

0: A4 LEF, 1: LT LEF

014 Tray 4: 2

0: A3, 1: DLT

015 Tray 4: 3

0: B4, 1: LG

016 Tray 4: 4

0: B5 LEF, 1: Exe LEF

017 LCT

[0 to 2 / - / 1 ] 0: A4 LEF, 1: LT LEF, 2: B5 LEF

D129/D130

3-86

SM Appendix

System SP Tables-5

RK4: Setting (Japan only)
Enable or distance the prevention for RK4 (Accounting device)
5186

Disconnection. If the RK4 is disconnected for 10 seconds when this SP is
set to "1 (Enable)", the machine automatically jams a sheet of paper and
stops.
[0 to 1 / 0 / 1]

Copy Nv Version
Appendix:
Service
Program
Mode Tables

5188*
Displays the NV version on the controller.

External Controller Info. Settings
5193
DFU

Limitless SW
5195*
DFU

Paper Exit After Staple End
This SP determines whether the machine can output paper if staple supply
5199

runs out.
[0 to 1 / 0 / 1]
0: OFF. Paper cannot exit if no staples are available.
1: ON. Paper can exit with no staples.

SM Appendix

3-87

D129/D130

System SP Tables-5

5212*

Page Numbering
Horizontally positions the page numbers
003

Duplex Printout Left/Right

printed on both sides during duplexing.

Position

[–10 to 10/ 0 / 1 mm]
0 is center, minus is left, + is right.
Vertically positions the page numbers printed

004

Duplex Printout High/Low

on both sides during duplexing.

Position

[–10 to 10/ 0 / 1 mm]
0 is center, minus is down, + is up.

5227*

Page Numbering
Sets the number of input digits for the job
201 Allow Page No. Entry

serial number of the starting page numbering.
[2 to 9 / 9 / 1]
Sets the zero surplus serial number of the

202 Zero Surplus Setting

starting page numbering.
[0 to 1 / 0 / 1]
0: Disable, 1: Enable

5302*

Set Time
Time Difference
Sets the time clock for the local time. This setting is done at the factory
before delivery. The setting is GMT expressed in minutes.
[–1440 to 1440 / - / 1 min.]
Japan: +540 (Tokyo)
002 NA: -300 (NY)
EU: +60 (Paris)
CH: +480 (Peking)
TW: +480 (Taipei)
AS: +480 (Hong Kong)
KO: +540 (Korea)

D129/D130

3-88

SM Appendix

System SP Tables-5

5307

Summer Time
[0 to 1 / 1 (NA/EU), 0 (ASIA) / 1 /step]
Setting

0: Disabled
1: Enabled

001

Enables or disables the summer time mode.


Make sure that both SP5-307-3 and -4 are correctly set. Otherwise,

Rule Set (Start)
Specifies the start setting for the summer time mode.
There are 8 digits in this SP. For months 1 to 9, the "0" cannot be input in the
first digit, so the eight-digit setting for -2 or -3 becomes a seven-digit setting.
1st and 2nd digits: The month. [1 to 12]
3rd digit: The week of the month. [1 to 5]
003

4th digit: The day of the week. [0 to 6 = Sunday to Saturday]
5th and 6th digits: The hour. [00 to 23]
7th digit: The length of the advanced time. [0 to 9 / 1 hour

/step]

8th digit: The length of the advanced time. [0 to 5 / 10 minutes /step]
For example: 3500010
The timer is advanced by 1 hour at am 0:00 on the 5th Sunday in March.
The digits are counted from the left.
Make sure that SP5-307-1 is set to "1".
Rule Set (End)
Specifies the end setting for the summer time mode.
There are 8 digits in this SP.
1st and 2nd digits: The month. [1 to 12]
004

3rd digit: The week of the month. [0 to 5]
4th digit: The day of the week. [0 to 7 = Sunday to Saturday]
5th and 6th digits: The hour. [00 to 23]
The 7th and 8 digits must be set to "00".
The digits are counted from the left.
Make sure that SP5-307-1 is set to "1".

SM Appendix

3-89

D129/D130

Appendix:
Service
Program
Mode Tables

this SP is not activated even if this SP is set to "1".

System SP Tables-5

Access Control (DFU)
5401*
This SP stores the settings that limit uses access to SDK application data.
Default Document ACL
Whenever a new login user is added to the address book in external
certification mode (for Windows, LDAP, RDH), the default document ACL is
updated according to this SP setting.
[0 to 3 / 0 / 1]
103 0: View
1: Edit
2: Edit/Delete
3: Full control
Note: This SP setting is ignored on a machine that is not using document
server.
Specifies the timeout of the
authentication.
104 Authentication Time

[0 to 255 / 0 / 1 sec./step]
0: 60 seconds
1 to 250 seconds
Selects the log out type for the extend
authentication device.

162 Extend Certification Detail

Bit 0: Log-out without an IC card
0: Not allowed (default)
1: Allowed

200 SDK1 Unique ID
201 SDK1 Certification Method
210 SDK2 Unique ID
211 SDK2 Certification Method

"SDK" is the "Software Development
Kit". This data can be converted from
SAS (VAS) when installed or uninstalled.
(DFU)

220 SDK3 Unique ID

D129/D130

3-90

SM Appendix

System SP Tables-5

221 SDK3 Certification Method
230 SDK certification device
Enables or disables the log out
confirmation option.
Bit 0: Log out confirmation option
0: Enable (default), 1: Disable
240 Detail Option

Selects the automatic log out time.
Bit 1 and 2: Automatic log out timer
Appendix:
Service
Program
Mode Tables

reduction
00: 60 seconds (default), 01: 10
seconds,
10: 20 seconds, 11: 30 seconds

Access Control (DFU)
5402
Sets limited uses for SDKJ application data.
101 to 130 SDKJ1 Limit Setting….. SDKJ30 Limit Setting
141 to 170 SDKJ1 Product ID….. SDKJ30 Product ID

User Code Count Clear
5404

Clears the counts of the user codes assigned by the key operator to restrict
the use of the machine. Press [Execute] to clear.

SM Appendix

3-91

D129/D130

System SP Tables-5

5411*

LDAP-Certification
Turns simple authentication on or off for LDAP.
004

Simplified

[0 to 1 / 1 / 1]

Certification

0: OFF
1: ON
This SP is enabled only when SP5411-4 is set to "1"

005

Password Null Not
Permit

(ON).
[0 to 1 / 1 / 1]
0: Password null is permitted.
1: Password null is not permitted.
Determines whether LDAP option (anonymous

006 Detail Option

certification) is turned on or off.
[0 to 11111111 / 0 / 1]
0: OFF, 1: ON

5412

Krb-Certification
Sets the level of Kerberos Certification.
[0x01:AES256-CTS-HMAC-SHA1-96 /
100 Encrypt Mode

0x02:AES128-CTS-HMAC-SHA1-96 /
0x04:DES3-CBC-SHA / 0x08:RC4-HMAC /
0x10:DES-CBC-MD5 / 0xFF:ALL / 0xFF / 1bit]

D129/D130

3-92

SM Appendix

System SP Tables-5

5413

Lockout Setting
Lockout On/Off

[0 to 1 / 0 / 1] 0: OFF, 1:ON

001
Turns on or off the account lock for the local address book account.
Lockout Threshold

[1 to 10 / 5 / 1]

002
Sets the maximum trial times for accessing the address book account.

0: OFF (Lockout is not cancelled.)
Cancellation On/Off
003

1: ON (Lockout is cancelled if a user ID and
password are correctly entered after the lockout
function has been executed and a specific time has
passed.)

Turns on or off the cancellation function of the account lockout.
Cancellation Time

[1 to 9999 / 60 / 1 min]

004 Sets the interval of the retry for accessing the local address book account
after the lockout function has been executed.
This setting is enabled only if SP5413-3 is set to "1" (ON).

5414

Access Mitigation
Mitigation ON/OFF
Permits or does not permit consecutive access to the machine with the
001 same ID and password.
[0 to 1 / 0 / 1]
0: OFF (Permitted)
1: ON (Not permitted)
Mitigation Time
002 Sets the prohibiting time for consecutive access to the machine with the
same ID and password.
[0 to 60 / 15 / 1 min]

SM Appendix

3-93

D129/D130

Appendix:
Service
Program
Mode Tables

[0 to 1 / 0 / 1]

System SP Tables-5

5415*

Password Attack
Permissible Number

[0 to 100 / 30 / 1 times]

001 Sets the threshold number of attempts to attack the system with random
passwords to gain illegal access to the system.
Detect Time

[0 to 10 / 5 / 1 sec]

002
Sets a detection time to count a password attack.

5416*

Access Information
Access User Max Num

[50 to 200 / 200 / 1 ]

001 Sets the number of users for the access exclusion and password attack
detection function.
Access Password Num

[50 to 200 / 200 / 1 ]

002 Sets the number of passwords for the access exclusion and password
attack detection function.
Monitor interval

[1 to 10 / 3 / 1 sec]

003
Sets the interval of watching out for user information and passwords.

D129/D130

3-94

SM Appendix

System SP Tables-5

5417

Access Attack
Access Permissible number

[0 to 500 / 100 / 1]

001
Sets a limit on access attempts to prevent password cracking.
Access Detect Time

[10 to 30 / 10 / 1 sec]

002
Sets a detection time to count password cracking.
[0 to 9 / 3 / 1 sec]

003 Sets the wait time to slow down the speed of certification when an excessive
number of access attempts have been detected.
Attack Max Num

[50 to 200 / 200 / 1]

004 Sets a limit on the number of requests received for certification in order to
slow down the certification speed when an excessive number of access
attempts have been detected.

User Authentication
These settings should be done with the System Administrator.
5420*


These functions are enabled only after the user access feature has
been enabled.
[0 or 1/ 0 / 1] 0: ON. 1: OFF

001 Copy

Determines whether certification is required
before a user can use the copy application.
[0 or 1/ 0 / 1] 0: ON. 1: OFF

011 Document Server

Determines whether certification is required
before a user can use the document server.

SM Appendix

3-95

D129/D130

Appendix:
Service
Program
Mode Tables

Productivity Fall Weight

System SP Tables-5

[0 or 1/ 0 / 1] 0: ON. 1: OFF
021 Fax

Determines whether certification is required
before a user can use the fax application.
[0 or 1/ 0 / 1] 0: ON. 1: OFF

031 Scanner

Determines whether certification is required
before a user can use the scanner
application.
[0 or 1/ 0 / 1] 0: ON. 1: OFF

041 Printer

Determines whether certification is required
before a user can use the printer application.

051 SDK1
061 SDK2
071 SDK3

[0 or 1/ 0 / 1] 0: ON. 1: OFF
Determines whether certification is required
before a user can use the SDK application.

[0 or 1/ 0 / 1] 0: ON. 1: OFF
081 Browser

Determines whether certification is required
before a user can use the browser
application.

5430

Auth Dialog Message Change
Turns on or off the displayed message
001 Message Change On/Off

change for the authentication.
[0 or 1 / 0 / -]
0: Off, 1: On

002 Message Text Download

003 Message Text ID

D129/D130

Executes the message download for the
authentication.
Inputs message text for the authentication.

3-96

SM Appendix

System SP Tables-5

5431

External Auth User Preset

Tag
010

[0 or 1 / 1 / -]
0: Not permit, 1: Permit

Turns on or off the tag copy permission for the external authentication.

Entry

[0 or 1 / 1 / -]
0: Not permit, 1: Permit

011
Appendix:
Service
Program
Mode Tables

Turns on or off the copy permission of the entry information for the external
authentication.

Group

[0 or 1 / 1 / -]
0: Not permit, 1: Permit

012
Turns on or off the copy permission of the group information for the external
authentication.

Mail

[0 or 1 / 1 / -]
0: Not permit, 1: Permit

020
Turns on or off the copy permission of the mail information for the external
authentication.

Fax

[0 or 1 / 1 / -]
0: Not permit, 1: Permit

030
Turns on or off the copy permission of the fax information for the external
authentication.

FaxSub

[0 or 1 / 1 / -]
0: Not permit, 1: Permit

031
Turns on or off the copy permission of the fax additional information for the
external authentication.

Folder

[0 or 1 / 1 / -]
0: Not permit, 1: Permit

032
Turns on or off the copy permission of the folder information for the external
authentication.

SM Appendix

3-97

D129/D130

System SP Tables-5

ProtectCode

[0 or 1 / 1 / -]
0: Not permit, 1: Permit

033
Turns on or off the copy permission of the protection code information for the
external authentication.

SmtpAuth

[0 or 1 / 1 / -]
0: Not permit, 1: Permit

034
Turns on or off the copy permission of the SMTP information for the external
authentication.

LdapAuth

[0 or 1 / 1 / -]
0: Not permit, 1: Permit

035
Turns on or off the copy permission of the LDAP information for the external
authentication.

Smb Ftp Fldr Auth

[0 or 1 / 1 / -]
0: Not permit, 1: Permit

036
Turns on or off the copy permission of the SMB/FTP information for the
external authentication.

AcntAcl

[0 or 1 / 1 / -]
0: Not permit, 1: Permit

037
Turns on or off the copy permission of the account ACL information for the
external authentication.

DocumentAcl

[0 or 1 / 1 / -]
0: Not permit, 1: Permit

038
Turns on or off the copy permission of the document ACL information for the
external authentication.

D129/D130

3-98

SM Appendix

System SP Tables-5

[0 or 1 / 1 / -]

CertCrypt

0: Not permit, 1: Permit

040
Turns on or off the copy permission of the authentication information for the
external authentication.
[0 or 1 / 1 / -]

UserLimitCount

0: Not permit, 1: Permit

050
Turns on or off the copy permission of the maximum number information for
Appendix:
Service
Program
Mode Tables

the external authentication.

Authentication Error Code
5481
These SP codes determine how the authentication failures are displayed.
[0 or 1 / 0 / -]
001 System Log Disp

0: OFF [Default], 1: ON
Determines whether an error code appears in the
system log after a user authentication failure occurs.
[0 or 1 / 1 / 1]
0: OFF, 1: ON [Default]

002 Panel Disp

Determines whether an error code appears on the
operation panel after a user authentication failure
occurs.

SM Appendix

3-99

D129/D130

System SP Tables-5

MF KeyCard (Japan only)
Sets up operation of the machine with a keycard.
5490

[0 to 1 / 0 / 1]
0: Disabled. Cancels operation without a user code.
1: Enabled. Allows operation without a user code.

Optional Counter
Determines whether to cancel the job when MK1 keycard is pulled out from
the machine during job.
5491*

[0 to 11111111 / 0 / 1]
0: On. Cancels the job.
1: Off. Allows operation if MK1 keycard is pulled out from the machine
during the job.

5501*

PM Alarm
PM Alarm Level
001 Sets the PM alarm level.
[0 to 9999 / 0 / 1 k copies/step]
0: No PM alarm
Original Count Alarm (DFU)
002 Selects whether the PM alarm for the number of scans is enabled or not.
If this is "1", the PM alarm function is enabled.
[0 = No / 1 = Yes]

D129/D130

3-100

SM Appendix

System SP Tables-5

Jam Alarm
Sets the alarm to sound for the specified jam level (document misfeeds are
not included).
[0 to 3 / 3 / 1 step]

5504*

0: Zero (Off)
1: Low (2.5K jams)
2: Medium (3K jams)

Appendix:
Service
Program
Mode Tables

3: High (6K jams)

Error Alarm
Sets the number of sheets to clear the error alarm counter.
The error alarm counter counts "1" when any SC is detected. However, the
error alarm counter decreases by "1" when an SC is not detected during a
5505*

set number of copied sheets (for example, default 5000 (C1b) or 10000
(C1c) sheets). The error alarm occurs when the SC error alarm counter
reaches "5".
[0 to 255 / 45 (C2b), 50 (C1b/C1.5b), 60 (C2c), 100 (C1c/C1.5c) / 100
copies / step]

5507*

Supply Alarm
Switches the control call on/off for the paper
supply. (DFU)
001

Paper supply Alarm
(0:Off 1:On)

0: Off, 1: On
0: No alarm.
1: Sets the alarm to sound for the specified
number transfer sheets for each paper size (A3,
A4, B4, B5, DLT, LG, LT, HLT)
Switches the control call on/off for the stapler

002

Staple Supply Alarm
(0:Off 1:On)

installed in the finisher. (DFU)
0: Off, 1: On
0: No alarm
1: Alarm goes off for every 1K of staples used.

SM Appendix

3-101

D129/D130

System SP Tables-5

Switches the control call on/off for the toner end.
003

Toner Supply Alarm
(0:Off 1:On)

(DFU)
0: Off, 1: On
If you select "1" the alarm will sound when the
copier detects toner end.
Changes the timing of the "Toner Supply Call" via
the @Remote, when the following conditions

080 Toner Call Timing

occur.
0: At replacement
1: At near end

128 Interval: Others
132 Interval: A3
133 Interval: A4
134 Interval: A5
The "Paper Supply Call Level: nn" SPs specify the
141 Interval: B4

paper control call interval for the referenced paper

142 Interval: B5

sizes. (DFU)
[250 to 10000 / 1000 / 1 Step]

160 Interval: DLT
164 Interval: LG
166 Interval: LT
172 Interval: HLT

D129/D130

3-102

SM Appendix

System SP Tables-5

5508

CC Call
001 Jam Remains
002 Continuous Jams
003 Continuous Door Open

Enables/disables initiating a call.
[0 to 1 / 1 / 1]
0: Disable
1: Enable
Sets the length of time to determine the

011 Jam Detection: Time Length

length of an unattended paper jam.

012

Jam Detection Continuous
Count

Sets the number of continuous paper jams
required to initiate a call.
[2 to 10 / 5 / 1 time]
Sets the length of time the remains opens

013 Door Open: Time Length

to determine when to initiate a call.
[3 to 30/ 10 / 1 minute]

SC/Alarm Setting
With @Remote in use, these SP codes can be set to issue an SC call when

5515*

an SC error occurs. If this SP is switched off, the SC call is not issued when
an SC error occurs.
001 SC Call
002 Service Parts Near End Call
003 Service Parts End Call

[0 or 1 / 1 / 1]

004 User Call

0: OFF

006 Communication Information Test Call

1: ON

007 Machine Information Notice
008 Alarm Notice

SM Appendix

3-103

D129/D130

Appendix:
Service
Program
Mode Tables

[3 to 30 / 10 / 1 minute]

System SP Tables-5

010 Supply Automatic Ordering Call
011 Supply Management Report Call
012 Jam/Door Open Call

Individual PM Part Alarm Call
5516

With @Remote in use, these SP codes can be set to issue an PM alarm call
when one of SP parts reaches its yield.

001

Disable/Enable Setting (0: Not

[0 or 1 / 1 / - ]

send, 1: Send)

0: Not send, 1: Send

004 Percent yield for triggering PM alert [1 to 255 / 75 / 1 %/step]

Extend Function Setting
5730
DFU

5734

PDF Setting
PDF/A Fixed
001

[0 or 1 / 0 / - ]
0: No Limit
1: Limited

Node Authentication Timuout
5741
DFU

Network Security Level
5743
DFU

D129/D130

3-104

SM Appendix

Rev. 11/15/2012

5744

System SP Tables-5

Management
DFU

EcoCountTime
5745
DFU

Scroll Bar display
204 Vertical
mode
Confirmation dialog display
setting

205

NOTE:
- If enabled, the “Page change
confirmation dialog” is displayed
when the user moves from the
current page to a different one.
- The “SSL certificate confirmation
dialog” is displayed when an
SSL-related problem occurs.
- If the customer is using an internal
(original) Web application, i.e. a fully
trusted application, this SP can be
set to “2” (do not display either
dialog).

0: Always display (Default)
1: Display when pressing “Program Key
Value

Page change
confirmation
dialog

SSL
certificate
confirmation
dialog

0 (Default)

Display

Display

1

Not display

Display

2

Not Display

Not display

3

Display

Not display

IMPORTANT: Only use these SP Modes with Browser
Version 2.00.0 or newer, EXJS version 1.11.00 or newer,
and Specification 2.01 or newer.

206 Displayed but it should not be used (Not for field use).

⇒ 5749

Import/Export

NOTE: Refer to Section 3-13 Detailed Description of SP5749 for more information.

DFU
001 Import
101 Export
251 Export Result Print (SP)
252 Import Result Print (SP)

MCS Debug SW
5792
DFU

ECS Debug SW
5793
DFU

SM Appendix

3-105

D129/D130

Appendix:
Service
Program
Mode Tables

[Vertical Scroll Bar display mode] (See IMPORTANT below)

5747

System SP Tables-5

Memory Clear
5801

Resets NVRAM data to the default settings. Before executing any of these
SP codes, print an SMC Report.
001 All Clear

002 Engine

Initializes items 2 to 15 below.
Initializes all registration settings for the engine and
copy process settings.
Initializes default system settings, SCS (System

003 SCS

Control Service) settings, operation display
coordinates, and ROM update information.

004 IMH Memory Clr

Initializes the image file system.
(IMH: Image Memory Handler)
Initializes the automatic delete time setting for stored

005 MCS

documents.
(MCS: Memory Control Service)

006 Copier application

Initializes all copier application settings.
Initializes the fax reset time, job login ID, all TX/RX

007 Fax Application

settings, local storage file numbers, and off-hook
timer.
Initializes the printer defaults, programs registered,

008 Printer Application

the printer SP bit switches, and the printer CSS
counter.

009 Scanner Application

D129/D130

Initializes the defaults for the scanner and all the
scanner SP modes.

3-106

SM Appendix

System SP Tables-5

Deletes the Netfile (NFA) management files and
010 Web Service

thumbnails, and initializes the Job login ID.
Netfiles: Jobs to be printed from the document server
using a PC and the DeskTopBinder software
Initializes the system defaults and interface settings
(IP addresses also), the SmartDeviceMonitor for

011 NCS

Admin settings, WebStatusMonitor settings, and the
TELNET settings.

012 R-FAX

014 Clear DCS Setting

015 Clear UCS Setting

016 MIRS Setting

017 CCS

018 SRM Memory Clr

Initializes the job login ID, SmartDeviceMonitor for
Admin, job history, and local storage file numbers.
Initializes the DCS (Delivery Control Service) settings.
Initializes the UCS (User Information Control Service)
settings.
Initializes the MIRS (Machine Information Report
Service) settings.
Initializes the CCS (Certification and Charge-control
Service) settings.
Initializes the SRM (System Resource Manager)
settings.

019 LCS

Initializes the LCS (Log Count Service) settings.

020 Web Uapli

Initializes the web user application settings.

021 ECS

Initializes ECS (Engine Control Service).

023 AICS

Initializes the AICS settings.

SM Appendix

3-107

D129/D130

Appendix:
Service
Program
Mode Tables

(NCS: Network Control Service)

System SP Tables-5

FreeRun
Performs a free run on the copier engine.
The correct paper should be loaded in the 1st tray or 2nd tray, but paper is

5802*

not fed.
The main switch has to be turned off and on after using the free run mode
for a test.
001 TRAY1:A4LEF

-

002 TRAY2:A3

-

003 TRAY2:A4SEF

-

Input Check
5803

Displays the signals received from sensors and switches. (

p.3-251

"Input Check")

Output Check
5804

Turns on the electrical components individually for test purposes. (
p.3-263 "Output Check")

Anti-Condensation Heater
5805

[0 or 1 / 0 / -]
0:OFF / 1:ON

5810

SC Reset
Resets all level A service call conditions, such as
001 Fusing SC Reset

fusing errors. To clear the service call, touch
"Execute" on the LCD, then turn the main power
switch off/on.

D129/D130

3-108

SM Appendix

System SP Tables-5

5811

MachineSerial
002 Display

Displays the machine serial number.

003 BCU

Inputs the serial number.

005 FRAM

Displays the FRAM serial number.

Service Tel. No. Setting

001 Service

002 Facsimile

003 Supply

004 Operation

5816

Inputs the telephone number of the CE (displayed when a

Appendix:
Service
Program
Mode Tables

5812*

service call condition occurs.)
Use this to input the fax number of the CE printed on the
Counter Report (UP mode).
Inputs the telephone number of the supplier displayed on the
user mode screen.
Allows the service center contact telephone number to be
displayed on the user mode screen.

Remote Service
I/F Setting
Selects the remote service setting.
001 [0 to 2 / 2 / 1 /step]
0: Remote service off
1: CSS remote service on
2: @Remote service on
CE Call
Performs the CE Call at the start or end of the service.
002 [0 or 1 / 0 / 1 /step]
0: Start of the service
1: End of the service
NOTE: This SP is activated only when SP 5816-001 is set to “2”.

SM Appendix

3-109

D129/D130

System SP Tables-5

Function Flag
Enables or disables the remote service function.
003 [0 to 1 / 0 / 1 /step]
0: Disabled, 1: Enabled
NOTE: This SP setting is changed to "1" after @Remote registration has
been completed.
Communication Test Call
004 This SP issues a test call from a GW machine to determine whether it can
communicate successfully with the call center after it has been set up for
NRS. Successful return will be in the range 0 to 99.
Device Information Call
005 This SP issues a call to notify the NRS device information to the call center.
Successful return will be in the range 0 to 99.
SSL Disable
Uses or does not use the RCG certification by SSL when calling the RCG.
007 [0 to 1 / 0 / 1 /step]
0: Uses the RCG certification
1: Does no use the RCG certification
RCG Connect Timeout
008 Specifies the connect timeout interval when calling the RCG.
[1 to 90 / 30 / 1 second /step]
RCG Write Timeout
009 Specifies the write timeout interval when calling the RCG.
[0 to 100 / 60 / 1 second /step]

D129/D130

3-110

SM Appendix

System SP Tables-5

RCG Read Timeout
010 Specifies the read timeout interval when calling the RCG.
[0 to 100 / 60 / 1 second /step]
Port 80 Enable
011 Enables/disables access via port 80 to the SOAP method.
[0 or 1 / 0 / – ]

Appendix:
Service
Program
Mode Tables

0: Disabled, 1: Enabled
@Remote Communication Permission
[0 to 2 / 1 / 1 ]
012 0: Not permitted
1: Permitted
2: Partially limit
RFU (Remote Firmware Update) Timing
Selects the RFU timing.
013 [0 or 1 / 1 / – ]
0: RFU is executed whenever update request is received.
1: RFU is executed only when the machine is in the sleep mode.
RCG Error Cause
[0 or 1 / 0 / – ]
014 0: Normal
1: Fails to reflect the client/server certificate settings by network failure to
reboot. Transition to 0 on restart the machine.

SM Appendix

3-111

D129/D130

System SP Tables-5

RCG–C Registed
021 This SP displays the Embedded RC Gate installation end flag.
0: Installation not completed
1: Installation completed
Connect Type (N/M)
This SP displays and selects the Embedded RC Gate connection method.
023 [0 or 1 / 0 / 1 /step
0: Internet connection
1: Dial-up connection
Cert. Expire Timing DFU
061
Proximity of the expiration of the certification.
Use Proxy
062 This SP setting determines if the proxy server is used when the machine
communicates with the service center.
Proxy Host
This SP sets the address of the proxy server used for communication
between Embedded RC Gate-N and the gateway. Use this SP to set up or
display the customer proxy server address. The address is necessary to set
063 up Embedded RC Gate-N.


The address display is limited to 128 characters. Characters beyond
the 128 character are ignored.



This address is customer information and is not printed in the SMC
report.

D129/D130

3-112

SM Appendix

System SP Tables-5

Proxy Port Number
This SP sets the port number of the proxy server used for communication
between Embedded RC Gate-N and the gateway. This setting is necessary to
064 set up Embedded RC Gate-N.


This port number is customer information and is not printed in the
SMC report.

Appendix:
Service
Program
Mode Tables

Proxy User Name
This SP sets the HTTP proxy certification user name.
065



The length of the name is limited to 31 characters. Any character
beyond the 31st character is ignored.



This name is customer information and is not printed in the SMC
report.

Proxy Password
This SP sets the HTTP proxy certification password.
066



The length of the password is limited to 31 characters. Any character
beyond the 31st character is ignored.



This name is customer information and is not printed in the SMC
report.

SM Appendix

3-113

D129/D130

System SP Tables-5

CERT: Up State
Displays the status of the certification update.
0

1

2

3

4

11
067
12

The certification used by Embedded RC Gate is set correctly.
The certification request (setAuthKey) for update has been received
from the GW URL and certification is presently being updated.
The certification update is completed and the GW URL is being notified
of the successful update.
The certification update failed, and the GW URL is being notified of the
failed update.
The period of the certification has expired and new request for an
update is being sent to the GW URL.
A rescue update for certification has been issued and a rescue
certification setting is in progress for the rescue GW connection.
The rescue certification setting is completed and the GW URL is being
notified of the certification update request.
The notification of the request for certification update has completed

13

successfully, and the system is waiting for the certification update
request from the rescue GW URL.

14

15

16

The notification of the certification request has been received from the
rescue GW controller, and the certification is being stored.
The certification has been stored, and the GW URL is being notified of
the successful completion of this event.
The storing of the certification has failed, and the GW URL is being
notified of the failure of this event.
The certification update request has been received from the GW URL,

17

the GW URL was notified of the results of the update after it was
completed, but a certification error has been received, and the rescue
certification is being recorded.

D129/D130

3-114

SM Appendix

System SP Tables-5

18

The rescue certification of No. 17 has been recorded, and the GW URL
is being notified of the failure of the certification update.

CERT: Error
Displays a number code that describes the reason for the request for update
of the certification.

1

068

2

3

Normal. There is no request for certification update in progress.
Request for certification update in progress. The current certification
has expired.
An SSL error notification has been issued. Issued after the certification
has expired.
Notification of shift from a common authentication to an individual
certification.

4

Notification of a common certification without ID2.

5

Notification that no certification was issued.

6

Notification that GW URL does not exist.

069 CERT: Up ID

The ID of the request for certification.

083 Firm Up Status

Displays the status of the firmware update.
This SP setting determines if the operator can
confirm the previous version of the firmware
before the firmware update execution. If the

085 Firm Up User Check

option to confirm the previous version is selected,
a notification is sent to the system manager and
the firmware update is done with the firmware
files from the URL.
Allows the service technician to confirm the size

086 Firmware Size

of the firmware data files during the firmware
update execution.

SM Appendix

3-115

D129/D130

Appendix:
Service
Program
Mode Tables

0

System SP Tables-5

087 CERT: Macro Ver.

088 CERT: PAC Ver.

Displays the macro version of the @Remote
certification.
Displays the PAC version of the @Remote
certification.
Displays ID2 for the @Remote certification.
Spaces are displayed as underscores (_).

089 CERT: ID2 Code

Asteriskes (*) indicate that no @Remote
certification exists. "000000___________"
indicates "Common certification".
Displays the common name of the @Remote
certification subject. CN = the following 17 bytes.

090 CERT: Subject

Spaces are displayed as underscores (_).
Asterisks (*) indicate that no @Remote
certification exists. "000000___________"
indicates "Common certification".
Displays serial number for the @Remote

091 CERT: SerialNo.

certification. Asterisks (*) indicate that no
@Remote certification exists.
Displays the common name of the issuer of the

092 CERT: Issuer

@Remote certification. CN = the following 30
bytes. Asteriskes () indicate that no @Remote
certification exists.

093 CERT: Valid Start

094 CERT: Valid End

Displays the start time of the period for which the
current @Remote certification is enabled.
Displays the end time of the period for which the
current @Remote certification is enabled.

Server CN Check
096
Not used

D129/D130

3-116

SM Appendix

System SP Tables-5

GW Host
096
Not used
GW URL Path
097
Not used
Debug RescueG/WURL Set
099

Appendix:
Service
Program
Mode Tables

Not used
102* CERT: Encrypt Level
Displays the encryption level for the NRS certificate.
[1 or 2 / 1 / – ]
1: Indicates that the certificate encryption level is 512-bit.
2: Indicates that the certificate encryption level is 2048-bit.
Selection Country
150
Not used
Line Type Automatic Judgment
151
Not used
Line Type Judgment Result
152
Not used
Selection Dial / Push
153
Not used
Outside Line Outgoing Number
154
Not used
Dial Up User Name
156
Not used

SM Appendix

3-117

D129/D130

System SP Tables-5

Dial Up Password
157
Not used
Local Phone Number
161
Not used
Connection Timing Adjustment Incoming
162
Not used
Access Point
163
Not used
Line Connecting
164
Not used
Modem Serial No.
173
Not used
Retransmission Limit
174
Not used
RCG-C M DebugBitSW
186
Not used
FAX TX Priority
187
Not used
Manual Polling
200
Executes the manual polling.

D129/D130

3-118

SM Appendix

System SP Tables-5

Regist Status
Displays a number that indicates the status of the @Remote service device.
0: Neither the @Remote device nor Embedded RCG Gate is set.
1: The Embedded RCG Gate is being set. Only Box registration is completed.
201 In this status, @Remote device cannot communicate with this device.
2: The Embedded RCG Gate is set. In this status, the @Remote device
cannot communicate with this device.
3: The @Remote device is being set. In this status the Embedded RCG Gate
4: The @Remote module has not started.

202 Letter Number

203 Confirm Execute

Allows entry of the request number needed for the
Embedded RCG Gate.
Executes the confirmation request to the @Remote
Gateway.

204 Confirm Result
Displays a number that indicates the result of the confirmation executed with
SP5816-203.
0: Succeeded
1: Confirmation number error
2: Registration in progress
3: Proxy error (proxy enabled)
4: Proxy error (proxy disabled)
5: Proxy error (Illegal user name or password)
6: Communication error
7: Certification update error
8: Other error
9: Confirmation executing
Confirm Place
205 Displays the result of the notification sent to the device from the Gateway in
answer to the confirmation request. Displayed only when the result is
registered at the Gateway.

SM Appendix

3-119

D129/D130

Appendix:
Service
Program
Mode Tables

cannot be set.

System SP Tables-5

206 Register Execute

Executes "Embedded RCG Registration".

Register Result
Displays a number that indicates the registration result.
0: Succeeded
2: Registration in progress
3: Proxy error (proxy enabled)
207 4: Proxy error (proxy disabled)
5: Proxy error (Illegal user name or password)
6: Communication error
7: Certification update error
8: Other error
9: Registration executing

D129/D130

3-120

SM Appendix

System SP Tables-5

Error Code
Displays a number that describes the error code that was issued when either

Cause

Illegal Modem
Parameter

Code

Meaning

-11001

Chat parameter error

-11002

Chat execution error

-11003

Unexpected error

-12002

-12003

-12004
208

Appendix:
Service
Program
Mode Tables

SP5816-204 or SP5816-207 was executed.

Inquiry, registration attempted without
acquiring device status.
Attempted registration without execution
of an inquiry and no previous registration.
Attempted setting with illegal entries for
certification and ID2.
@Remote communication is prohibited.

-12005

The device has an Embedded RC
gate-related problem.
A confirmation request was made after

Operation Error,
Incorrect Setting

-12006

the confirmation had been already
completed.
The request number used at registration

-12007

was different from the one used at
confirmation.

-12008

-12009

-12010

SM Appendix

Update certification failed because
mainframe was in use.
ID2 mismatch between an individual
certification and NVRAM
Certification area is not initialized.

3-121

D129/D130

System SP Tables-5

Attempted dial up overseas without the
-2385

correct international prefix for the
telephone number.

Error Caused by

-2387

Not supported at the Service Center

Response from GW

-2389

Database out of service

-2390

Program out of service

-2391

Two registrations for same device

-2392

Parameter error

-2393

RCG device not managed

-2394

Device not managed

-2395

Box ID for RCG device is illegal

-2396

Device ID for RCG device is illegal

-2397

Incorrect ID2 format

-2398

Incorrect request number format

URL

Releases the machine from its Embedded RCG
209 Instl Clear

Gate setup.
NOTE: Turn off and on the main power switch after
this setting has been changed.

250 CommLog Print

D129/D130

Prints the communication log.

3-122

SM Appendix

System SP Tables-5

5821*

Remote Service Address
Sets the IP address of the RCG (Remote
002 RCG IP Address

Communication Gate) destination for call
processing at the remote service center.
[00000000h to FFFFFFFFh / 00000000h / 1]
Sets the port number of the RCG (Remote

003 RCG Port

Communication Gate) destination for call
processing at the remote service center.
Appendix:
Service
Program
Mode Tables

[0 to 65535 / 443 / 1]
Sets the URL path of the RCG (Remote
004 RCG URL Path

Communication Gate) destination for call
processing at the remote service center.
[0 to 16 characters / /RCG/services/ /-]

NV-RAM Data Upload
5824

Uploads the NVRAM data to an SD card. Push Execute.
Note: When uploading data in this SP mode, the front door must be open.

NV-RAM Data Download
5825

Downloads data from an SD card to the NVRAM in the machine. After
downloading is completed, remove the card and turn the machine power off
and on.

SM Appendix

3-123

D129/D130

System SP Tables-5

5828

Network Setting
IPv4 Address (Ethernet/IEEE 802.11)
001 This SP allows you to check and reset the IPv4 address for Ethernet and
wireless LAN (802.11): aaa.bbb.ccc.ddd
IPv4 Subnet Mask (Ethernet/IEEE 802.11)
002 This SP allows you to check and reset the IPv4 subnet mask for Ethernet
and wireless LAN (802.11): aaa.bbb.ccc.ddd
IPv4 Default Gateway (Ethernet/IEEE 802.11)
003 This SP allows you to check and reset the IPv4 default gateway used by the
network for Ethernet and wireless LAN (802.11): aaa.bbb.ccc.ddd
DHCP (Ethernet/IEEE 802.11)
This SP code allows you check and change the setting that determines
whether the IP address is used with DHCP on an Ethernet or wireless
006 (802.11) LAN network.
[0 to 1 / 1 / 1]
0: Not used (manual setting)
1: Used
Active IPv4 Address
021 This SP allows you to check the IPv4 address that was used when the
machine started up with DHCP.
Active IPv4 Subnet Mask
022 This SP allows you to check the IPv4 subnet mask setting that was used
when the machine started up with DHCP.
Active IPv4 Gateway Address
023 This SP allows you to check the IPv4 default gateway setting that was used
when the machine started up with DHCP.

D129/D130

3-124

SM Appendix

System SP Tables-5

Enables and disables bi-directional
050

1284 Compatibility
(Centro)

communication on the parallel connection
between the machine and a computer.
[0 to 1 / 1 / 1 ]
0:Off, 1: On
Disables and enables the ECP feature (1284

052 ECP (Centro)

Mode) for data transfer.
[0 to 1 / 1 / 1]
0: Disabled, 1: Enabled

065 Job Spooling

Appendix:
Service
Program
Mode Tables

Switches the job spooling on and off.
[0 to 1 / 0 / 1]
0: No spooling, 1: Spooling enabled
This SP determines whether the job interrupted
at power off is resumed at the next power on.
066

Job Spooling Clear: Start
Time

This SP operates only when SP5828-065 is set
to "1".
[0 to 1 / 1 / 1]
1: OFF Resumes printing spooled jog.
0: ON Clears spooled job.
This SP determines whether job spooling is
enabled or disabled for each protocol. This is a

Job Spooling (Protocol)

8-bit setting.
[0 to 1 / 1 / 1]
0: No spooling, 1: Spooling enabled

069

0

LPR

4

BMLinks (Japan Only)

1

FTP (Not Used)

5

DIPRINT

2

IPP

6

Reserved (Not Used)

3

SMB

7

Reserved (Not Used)

087 @Remote Protocol Cnt (DFU)

SM Appendix

3-125

D129/D130

System SP Tables-5

Disables or enables Telnet operation. If this SP
090

TELNET

is disabled, the Telnet port is closed.

(0:OFF 1:ON)

[0 to 1 / 1 / 1]
0: Disable, 1: Enable

091

Web
(0:OFF 1:ON)

Disables or enables the Web operation.
[0 to 1 / 1 / 1]
0: Disable, 1: Enable
This is the IPv6 local address referenced on the
Ethernet or wireless LAN (802.11) in the format:

145

Active IPv6 Link Local
Address

"Link-Local address" + "Prefix Length"
The IPv6 address consists of a total 128 bits
configured in 8 blocks of 16 bits each. These
notations can be abbreviated. See "Note: IPV6
Addresses " below this table.

147

149

151

153

155

D129/D130

Active IPv6 Stateless
Address 1
Active IPv6 Stateless
Address 2

These SPs are the IPv6 stateless addresses (1
to 5) referenced on the Ethernet or wireless LAN

Active IPv6 Stateless

(802.11) in the format:

Address 3

"Stateless Address" + "Prefix Length"

Active IPv6 Stateless
Address 4

The IPv6 address consists of a total 128 bits
configured in 8 blocks of 16 bits each.

Active IPv6 Stateless
Address 5

3-126

SM Appendix

System SP Tables-5

IPv6 Manual Address
This SP is the IPv6 manually set address referenced on the Ethernet or
wireless LAN (802.11) in the format:
156 "Manual Set Address" + "Prefix Length"
The IPv6 address consists of a total 128 bits configured in 8 blocks of 16 bits
each. These notations can be abbreviated. See "Note: IPV6 Addresses"
below this table.

This SP is the IPv6 gateway address referenced on the Ethernet or wireless
158 LAN (802.11). The IPv6 address consists of a total 128 bits configured in 8
blocks of 16 bits each. These notations can be abbreviated. See "Note: IPV6
Addresses" below this table.
Note: IPV6 Addresses
Ethernet and the Wireless LAN (802.11) reference the IPV6 "Link-Local address + Prefix
Length". The IPV6 address consists of 128 bits divided into 8 blocks of 16 bits:
aaaa:bbbb:cccc:dddd:eeee:ffff:gggg:hhhh:
The prefix length is inserted at the 17th byte (Prefix Range: 0x0 to 0x80). The initial
setting is 0x40 (64).
For example, the data: "2001123456789012abcdef012345678940h" is expressed:
"2001:1234:5678:9012:abcd:ef01:2345:6789": prefixlen 64
However, the actual IPV6 address display is abbreviated according to the following rules.

SM Appendix

3-127

D129/D130

Appendix:
Service
Program
Mode Tables

IPv6 Gateway Address

System SP Tables-5

Rules for Abbreviating IPV6 Addresses
1.

The IPV6 address is expressed in hexadecimal delimited by colons (:) with the
following characters:
0123456789abcdefABCDEF

2.

A colon is inserted as a delimiter every 4th hexadecimal character.
fe80:0000:0000:0000:0207:40ff:0000:340e

3.

The notations can be abbreviated by eliminating zeros where the MSB and digits
following the MSB are zero. The example in "2" above, then, becomes
fe80:0:0:0207:40ff:0:340e

4.

Sections where only zeros exist can be abbreviated with double colons (::). This
abbreviation can be done also where succeeding sections contain only zeros (but
this can be done only at one point in the address). The example in "2" and "3" above
then becomes:
fe80::207:40ff:0:340e (only the first null sets zero digits are abbreviated as "::")
-orfe80:0:0:0:207:40ff::340e (only the last null set before "340e" is abbreviated as "::")
Enable or disables the automatic setting for IPv6
161

IPv6 Stateless Auto

stateless.

Setting

[0 or 1 / 1 / 1]
1: Enable, 0: Disable

Web Item visible
Displays or does not display the Web system items.
236 [0 x 0000 to 0 x ffff / 0 x ffff] 0: Not displayed, 1: Displayed
bit0: Net RICOH
bit1: Consumable Supplier
bit2-15: Reserved (all)
Web shopping link visible
Displays or does not display the link to Net RICOH on the top page and link
237 page of the web system.
[0 to 1 / 1 / 1]
0: Not display, 1:Display

D129/D130

3-128

SM Appendix

System SP Tables-5

Web supplies Link visible
Displays or does not display the link to Consumable Supplier on the top
238 page and link page of the web system.
[0 to 1 / 1 / 1]
0: Not display, 1:Display
Web Link1 Name
239 This SP confirms or changes the URL1 name on the link page of the web
Appendix:
Service
Program
Mode Tables

system. The maximum characters for the URL name are 31 characters.
Web Link1 URL
240 his SP confirms or changes the link to URL1 on the link page of the web
system. The maximum characters for the URL are 127 characters.
Web Link1 visible
Displays or does not display the link to URL1 on the top page of the web
241 system.
[0 to 1 / 1 / 1]
0: Not display, 1:Display
242 Web Link2 Name

Same as "-239"

243 Web Link2 URL

Same as "-240"

244 Web Link2 visible

Same as "-241"

DHCPv6 DUID
Sets DHCPv6 DUID.
249 [0000000000000000000000000000h to
FFFFFFFFFFFFFFFFFFFFFFFFFFFFh /
0000000000000000000000000000h / -]

SM Appendix

3-129

D129/D130

System SP Tables-5

HDD
5832

Enter the SP number for the partition to initialize, then press #. When the
execution ends, cycle the machine off and on.
001 HDD Formatting (All)
002 HDD Formatting (IMH)
003 HDD Formatting (Thumbnail)
004 HDD Formatting (Job Log)
005 HDD Formatting (Printer Fonts)
006 HDD Formatting (User Info)
007 Mail RX Data
008 Mail TX Data
009 HDD Formatting (Data for Design)
010 HDD Formatting (Log)
011 HDD Formatting (Ridoc I/F) (for Ridoc Desk Top Binder)

5836*

Capture Setting
Capture Function (0:Off 1:On)
With this function disabled, the settings related to the capture feature cannot
001 be initialized, displayed, or selected.
[0 to 1 / 0 / 1]
0: Disable, 1: Enable
Panel Setting
Determines whether each capture related setting can be selected or
002 updated from the initial system screen.
[0 to 1 / 0 / 1]
0: Disable, 1: Enable
The setting for SP5836-001 has priority.

D129/D130

3-130

SM Appendix

System SP Tables-5

[0 to 6 / 0 / 1]

072 Reduction for Copy B&W Text

0:1, 1:1/2, 2:1/3, 3:1/4, 6:2/3
[0 to 6 / 0 / 1]

073 Reduction for Copy B&W Other

0:1, 1:1/2, 2:1/3, 3:1/4, 6:2/3
[0 to 6 / 0 / 1]

075 Reduction for Printer B&W

0 1, 1:1/2, 2:1/3, 3:1/4, 6:2/3

078 Reduction for Printer B&W 1200

1: 1/2, 3: 1/4, 4: 1/6, 5: 1/8

082 Format for Copy B&W Text

Appendix:
Service
Program
Mode Tables

[0 to 3 / 1 / 1]
0: JFIF/JPEG, 1: TIFF/MMR, 2:
TIFF/MH, 3: TIFF/MR
[0 to 3 / 1 / 1]
083 Format Copy B&W Other

0: JFIF/JPEG, 1: TIFF/MMR, 2:
TIFF/MH, 3: TIFF/MR
[0 to 3 / 1 / 1]

085 Format for Printer B&W

0: JFIF/JPEG, 1: TIFF/MMR, 2:
TIFF/MH, 3: TIFF/MR

Default for JPEG

[5 to 95 / 50 / 1]

Sets the JPEG format default for documents sent to the document
091 management server with the MLB, with JPEG selected as the format.
Enabled only when optional File Format Converter (MLB: Media Link Board)
is installed.
Sets the IP address for the primary capture
101 Primary srv IP address

server. This is basically adjusted by the
remote system.

102 Primary srv scheme

103 Primary srv port number

SM Appendix

This is basically adjusted by the remote
system.
This is basically adjusted by the remote
system.

3-131

D129/D130

System SP Tables-5

104 Primary srv URL path

This is basically adjusted by the remote
system.
Sets the IP address for the secondary capture

111 Secondary srv IP address

server. This is basically adjusted by the
remote system.

112 Secondary srv scheme

113 Secondary srv port number

114 Secondary srv URL path

122 Reso: Copy (Mono)

This is basically adjusted by the remote
system.
This is basically adjusted by the remote
system.
This is basically adjusted by the remote
system.
[0 to 255 / 3 / 1/step]

Selects the resolution for BW copy mode. This is basically adjusted by the
remote system.
0: 600dpi/ 1: 400dpi/ 2: 300dpi/ 3: 200dpi/ 4: 150dpi/ 5: 100dpi
This is basically adjusted by the remote
124 Reso: Print (Mono)

system.
[0 to 255 / 3 / 1/step]

Selects the resolution for BW print mode. This is basically adjusted by the
remote system.
0: 600dpi/ 1: 400dpi/ 2: 300dpi/ 3: 200dpi/ 4: 150dpi/ 5: 100dpi
This is basically adjusted by the remote
126 Reso: Fax (Mono)

system.
[0 to 255 / 3 / 1/step]

Selects the resolution for BW fax mode. This is basically adjusted by the
remote system.
0: 600dpi/ 1: 400dpi/ 2: 300dpi/ 3: 200dpi/ 4: 150dpi/ 5: 100dpi/ 6: 75dpi

D129/D130

3-132

SM Appendix

System SP Tables-5

This is basically adjusted by the remote
127 Reso: Scan (Color)

system.
[0 to 255 / 4 / 1/step]

Selects the resolution for color scanning mode. This is basically adjusted by
the remote system.
0: 600dpi/ 1: 400dpi/ 2: 300dpi/ 3: 200dpi/ 4: 150dpi/ 5: 100dpi/ 6: 75dpi
This is basically adjusted by the remote
system.
[0 to 255 / 3 / 1/step]
Selects the resolution for BW scanning mode. This is basically adjusted by
the remote system.
0: 600dpi/ 1: 400dpi/ 2: 300dpi/ 3: 200dpi/ 4: 150dpi/ 5: 100dpi/ 6: 75dpi

141 All Addr Info Switch

[0 or 1 / 1 / -]
0: Off, 1: On

Turns on or off the all address information transmission for the captured
resources.
142 Stand-by Doc Max Number

[10 to 9999 / 2000 / 1/step]

Selects the maximum number of captured documents to be transmitted to
the document server.

SM Appendix

3-133

D129/D130

Appendix:
Service
Program
Mode Tables

128 Reso: Scan (Mono)

System SP Tables-5

5840*

IEEE 802.11
Channel MAX
Sets the maximum range of the bandwidth for the wireless LAN. This
006 bandwidth setting varies for different countries.
[1 to 14 / 11 (NA), 13 (EU), 14 (JPN) / 1]
JPN: 1 to 14, NA: 1 to 11, EU: 1 to 13
Channel MIN
Sets the minimum range of the bandwidth for operation of the wireless LAN.
007 This bandwidth setting varies for different countries.
[1 to 14 / 1 / 1]
JPN: 1 to 14, NA: 1 to 11, EU: 1 to 13
Transmission speed

[0 x 00 to 0 x FF / 0 x FF to Auto / -]

0 x FF to Auto [Default]
0 x 11 - 55M Fix
0 x 10 - 48M Fix
008 0 x 0F - 36M Fix

0 x 07 - 11M Fix
0 x 05 - 5.5M Fix
0 x 08 - 1M Fix

0 x 0E - 18M Fix

0 x 13 - 0 x FE (reserved)

0 x 0D - 12M Fix

0 x 12 - 72M (reserved)

0 x 0B - 9M Fix

0 x 09 - 22M (reserved)

0 x 0A - 6M Fix
WEP Key Select
Selects the WEP key.
011 Bit 1 and 0
00: Key1, 01: Key2 (Reserved),
10: Key3 (Reserved), 11: Key4(Reserved)
This SP is displayed only when the IEEE802.11 card is installed.

D129/D130

3-134

SM Appendix

System SP Tables-5

RTS/CTS Thresh
013 Adjusts the RTS/CTS threshold for the IEEE802.11 card.
[0 to 3000 / 2432 / 1]
This SP is displayed only when the IEEE802.11 card is installed.
Fragment Thresh
042 Adjusts the fragment threshold for the IEEE802.11 card.
[256 to 2346 / 2346 / 1]
Appendix:
Service
Program
Mode Tables

This SP is displayed only when the IEEE802.11 card is installed.
11g CTS to Self
043 Determines whether the CTS self function is turned on or off.
[0 to 1 / 1 / 1] 0: Off, 1: On
This SP is displayed only when the IEEE802.11 card is installed.
11g Slot Time
044 Selects the slot time for IEEE802.11.
[0 to 1 / 0 / 1] 0: 20 m, 1: 9 m
This SP is displayed only when the IEEE802.11 card is installed.
WPA Debug Lvl
045 Selects the debug level for WPA authentication application.
[1 to 3 / 3 / 1] 1: Info, 2: warning, 3: error
This SP is displayed only when the IEEE802.11 card is installed.

SM Appendix

3-135

D129/D130

System SP Tables-5

Supply Name Setting
5841*

Press the User Tools key. These names appear when the user presses the
Inquiry button on the User Tools screen.
001 Toner Name Setting: Black
007 OrgStamp
011 StapleStd1
012 StapleStd2
013 StapleStd3
014 StapleStd4
021 StapleBind1
022 StapleBind2
023 StapleBind3

GWWS Analysis (DFU)
Bit

Groups

0

System & other groups (LSB)

1

Capture related

2

Certification related

process.

3

Address book related

Bit SW 0011 1111

4

Machine management related

5

Output related (printing, delivery)

6

Repository related

This is a debugging tool. It
5842*

sets the debugging output
mode of each Net File

D129/D130

3-136

SM Appendix

System SP Tables-5

Default: 00000000 – do not change
001 Setting 1

Netfiles: Jobs to be printed from the document
server using a PC and the DeskTopBinder
software
Adjusts the debug program mode setting.
Bit7: 5682 mmseg-log setting

002 Setting 2

0: Date/Hour/Minute/Second
1: Minute/Second/Msec.

5844

Appendix:
Service
Program
Mode Tables

0 to 6: Not used

USB
Transfer Rate
001 Sets the speed for USB data transmission.
[0 x 01 or 0 x 04 / 0 x 04 /-]
0 x 01 [Full Speed], 0 x 04 [Auto Change]
Vendor ID
002 Sets the vendor ID:
Initial Setting: 0x05A Ricoh Company
[0x0000 to 0xFFFF/1] (DFU)
Product ID
003 Sets the product ID.
[0x0000 to 0xFFFF/1] (DFU)
Device Release No.
Sets the device release number of the BCD (binary coded decimal) display.
004 [0000 to 9999 / 100 / 1] (DFU)
Enter as a decimal number. NCS converts the number to hexadecimal
number recognized as the BCD.

SM Appendix

3-137

D129/D130

System SP Tables-5

005 Fixed USB Port
This SP standardizes for common use the model name and serial number
for USB PnP (Plug & Play). It determines whether the driver requires
re-installation.
[0 to 2 / 0 / 1]
0: OFF
1: Level 1
2: Level 2
006 PnP Model Name
This SP sets the model name to be used by the USB PnP when "Function
Enable (Level 2) is set so the USB Serial No. can have a common name
(SP5844-5).
Default: Laser Printer (up to 20 characters allowed).
007 PnP Serial Number
This SP sets the serial number to be used by the USB PnP when "Function
Enable (Level 2)
set so the USB Serial No. can have a common name (SP5844-5).
Default: None (up to 12 characters allowed for entry).


Make sure that this entry is the same as the serial number in use.



At initialization the serial number generated from the model name is
used, not the setting of this SP code.



D129/D130

At times other than initialization, the value set for this SP code is used.

3-138

SM Appendix

System SP Tables-5

100 Notify Unsupport
This SP determines whether an alert message appears on the control panel
when a USB device (unsupported device) that cannot use an A-connector is
connected.
[0 to 1 / 1 / 1]
0: Function enable
1: Function disable


An unsupported device is a device that cannot use the functions of the
Appendix:
Service
Program
Mode Tables

USB device. For example, a USB mouse cannot be used even if it
connected.


If the PictBridge option is not mounted, even if a digital camera is
connected it cannot be used because it is an unsupported device.

Delivery Server Setting
5845*
These are delivery server settings.
FTP Port No.
001
[0 to 65535 / 3670 / 1]
IP Address (Primary)
002 Use this SP to set the Scan Router Server address. The IP address under
the transfer tab can be used with the initial system setting.
[Range: 000.000.000.000 to 255.255.255.255]
Delivery Error Display Time
Use this setting to set the length of time that the message is shown when a
006 test error occurs during document transfer with the NetFile application and
an external device.
[0 to 999 / 300 / 1 sec]
IP Address (Secondary)
Sets the IP address that is given to the computer that is the secondary
008 delivery server for Scan Router. This SP lets you set only the IP address,
and does not refer to the DNS setting.
[Range: 000.000.000.000 to 255.255.255.255]
SM Appendix

3-139

D129/D130

System SP Tables-5

Delivery Server Model
Lets you change the model of the delivery server that is registered by the I/O
device.
[0 to 4 / 0 / 1 step]
009 0: Unknown
1: SG1 Provided
2: SG1 Package
3: SG2 Provided
4: SG2 Package
Delivery Svr. Capability
Changes the functions that the registered I/O device can do.
[0 to 255 / 0 / 1 step]
Bit7 = 1 Comment information exits
Bit6 = 1 Direct specification of mail address possible
010 Bit5 = 1 Mail RX confirmation setting possible
Bit4 = 1 Address book automatic update function exists
Bit3 = 1 Fax RX delivery function exists
Bit2 = 1 Sender password function exists
Bit1 = 1 Function to link MK-1 user and Sender exists
Bit0 = 1 Sender specification required (if set to 1, Bit6 is set to "0")
Delivery Svr.Capability (Ext)
011 These settings are for future use. They will let you increase the number of
registered devices (in addition to those registered for SP5845 010).
There are eight bits (Bit 0 to Bit 7). All are unused at this time.
013 Server Scheme (Primary)
014 Server port Number (Primary)

[1 to 65535 / 80 / 1]

015 Server URL Path (Primary)
016 Server Scheme (Secondary)
017 Server Port Number(Secondary)

D129/D130

3-140

[1 to 65535 / 80 / 1]

SM Appendix

System SP Tables-5

018 Server URL Path (Secondary)
[0 to 1 / 1 / -]

Rapid Sending Control

0: Disable, 1: Enable

022
Enables or disables the prevention function for the continuous data sending
error.

UCS Setting
Machine ID (for Delivery Server)
Displays the unique device ID in use by the delivery server directory. The
001 value is only displayed and cannot be changed.
This ID is created from the NIC MAC or IEEE 1394 EUI.
The ID is displayed as either 6-byle or 8-byte binary.
Machine ID Clear (for Delivery Server)
Clears the unique ID of the device used as the name in the file transfer
002 directory. Execute this SP if the connection of the device to the delivery
server is unstable. After clearing the ID, the ID will be established again
automatically by cycling the machine off and on.
Maximum Entries
Changes the maximum number of entries that UCS can handle.
003 [2000 to 20000 / 2000 / 1 step]
If a value smaller than the present value is set, the UCS managed data is
cleared, and the data (excluding user code information) is displayed.

SM Appendix

3-141

D129/D130

Appendix:
Service
Program
Mode Tables

5846*

System SP Tables-5

Delivery Server Retry Timer
Sets the interval for retry attempts when the delivery server fails to acquire
006 the delivery server address book.
[0 to 255 / 0 / 1 step]
0: No retries
Delivery Server Retry Times
007 Sets the number of retry attempts when the delivery server fails to acquire
the delivery server address book.
[0 to 255 / 0 / 1step]
Delivery Server Maximum Entries
008 Lets you set the maximum number of account entries and information about
the users of the delivery server controlled by UCS.
[2000 to 20000 / 2000 / 1 step]
LDAP Search Timeout
010 Sets the length of the time-out for the search of the LDAP server.
[1 to 255 / 60 /1 step]
WSD Maximum Entries
020 WSD (Web Services on Devices) is the Microsoft standard for connectivity
to web-service enabled devices.
[50 to 250 / 250 / 1]
Folder Auth Change
This SP determines whether the user login information (Login User name
and Password) or address (destination setting in the address book for
Scan-to-SMB) is used to permit folder access. The machine must be cycled
021 off/on for this setting to take effect if it is changed.
[0 to 1 / 0 / 1]
0: Login User
Uses operator login information (initial value of main machine)
1: Destination
Uses address authorization information

D129/D130

3-142

SM Appendix

System SP Tables-5

Initial Value of Upper Limit Count
022
[0 to 999999 / 500 / 1]
Addr Book Migration (USB -> HDD)
This SP moves the address book data from the SD card or flash ROM on the
controller board to the HDD. You must cycle the machine off and on after
1.

Turn the machine off.

2.

Install the HDD.

3.

Turn the machine on.

4.
040 5.

Appendix:
Service
Program
Mode Tables

executing this SP.

Do SP5846 040.
Turn the machine off/on.


Executing this SP overwrites any address book data already on the
HDD with the data from the flash ROM on the controller board.



We recommend that you back up all directory information to an SD
card with SP5846-051 before you execute this SP.



After the address book data is copied to HDD, all the address book
data is deleted from the flash ROM. If the operation fails, the data is
not erased from the flash ROM.

SM Appendix

3-143

D129/D130

System SP Tables-5

041 Fill Addr Acl Info.
This SP must be executed immediately after installation of an HDD unit in a
basic machine that previously had no HDD. The first time the machine is
powered on with the new HDD installed, the system automatically takes the
address book from the NVRAM and writes it onto the new HDD. However,
the new address book on the HDD can be accessed only by the system
administrator at this stage. Executing this SP by the service technician
immediately after power on grants full address book access to all users.
Procedure
1.

Turn the machine off.

2.

Install the new HDD.

3.

Turn the machine on.

4.

The address book and its initial data are created on the HDD
automatically. However, at this point the address book can be accessed
by only the system administrator or key operator.

5.

Enter the SP mode and do SP5846 041. After this SP executes
successfully, any user can access the address book.

Addr Book Media
Displays the slot number where an address book data is in.
[0 to 30 / - /1]
043

0: Unconfirmed
1: SD Slot 1

20: HDD

2: SD Slot 2

30: Nothing

4: USB Flash ROM
Initialize All Setting & Addr Book
046
Initializes all settings and the address book.
Initialize Local Address Book
047 Clears all of the address information from the local address book of a
machine managed with UCS.

D129/D130

3-144

SM Appendix

System SP Tables-5

Initialize Delivery Addr Book
048 Push [Execute] to delete all items (this does not include user codes) in the
delivery address book that is controlled by UCS.
Initialize LDAP Addr Book
049 Push [Execute] to delete all items (this does not include user codes) in the
LDAP address book that is controlled by UCS.

Appendix:
Service
Program
Mode Tables

Initialize All Addr Book
050 Clears everything (including users codes) in the directory information
managed by UCS. However, the accounts and passwords of the system
administrators are not deleted.
Backup All Addr Book
051 Copies all directory information to the SD card. Do this SP before replacing
the controller board or HDD. The operation may not succeed if the controller
board or HDD is damaged.
Restore All Addr Book
052 Copies back all directory information from the SD card to the flash ROM or
HDD. Upload the address book from the old flash ROM or HDD with
SP5846-51 before removing it. Do SP5846 52 after installing the new HDD.
Clear Backup Info
Deletes the address book uploaded from the SD card in the slot 2. Deletes
053 only the files uploaded for that machine. This feature does not work if the
card is write-protected.
Note: After you do this SP, go out of the SP mode, turn the power off. Do not
remove the SD card until the Power LED stops flashing.

SM Appendix

3-145

D129/D130

System SP Tables-5

Search Option
This SP uses bit switches to set up the fuzzy search options for the UCS
local address book.
Bit

Meaning

0

Checks both upper/lower case characters

1
060

2

Japan Only

3
4

--- Not Used ---

5

--- Not Used ---

6

--- Not Used ---

7

--- Not Used ---

Complexity Option 1
Use this SP to set the conditions for password entry to access the local
address book. Specifically, this SP limits the password entry to upper case
and sets the length of the password.
062 [0 to 32 / 0 / 1step]


This SP does not normally require adjustment.



This SP is enabled only after the system administrator has set up a
group password policy to control access to the address book.

D129/D130

3-146

SM Appendix

System SP Tables-5

Complexity Option 2
Use this SP to set the conditions for password entry to access the local
address book. Specifically, this SP limits the password entry to lower case
and defines the length of the password.
063 [0 to 32 / 0 / 1step]


This SP does not normally require adjustment.



This SP is enabled only after the system administrator has set up a
Appendix:
Service
Program
Mode Tables

group password policy to control access to the address book.
Complexity Option 3
Use this SP to set the conditions for password entry to access the local
address book. Specifically, this SP limits the password entry to numbers and
defines the length of the password.
064 [0 to 32 / 0 / 1step]


This SP does not normally require adjustment.



This SP is enabled only after the system administrator has set up a
group password policy to control access to the address book.

Complexity Option 4
Use this SP to set the conditions for password entry to access the local
address book. Specifically, this SP limits the password entry to symbols and
defines the length of the password.
065 [0 to 32 / 0 / 1step]


This SP does not normally require adjustment.



This SP is enabled only after the system administrator has set up a
group password policy to control access to the address book.

FTP Auth Port Setting
091 Sets the FTP port to get the delivery server address book that is used in the
individual authorization mode.
[0 to 65535 / 3671 / 1step]

SM Appendix

3-147

D129/D130

System SP Tables-5

Encryption Start
094 Shows the status of the encryption function of the address book on the
LDAP server.
[0 to 255 / 1 ] No default

Rep Resolution Reduction
5847-2 through 5847-6 changes the default settings of image data sent
externally by the Net File page reference function.
5847*

5847-21 sets the default for JPEG image quality of image files controlled by
NetFile.
"NetFile" refers to jobs to be printed from the document server with a PC
and the DeskTopBinder software.
002 Rate for Copy B&W Text

[0 to 6 / 0 / 1]

003 Rate for Copy B&W Other

[0 to 6 / 0 / 1]

005 Rate for Printer B&W

[0 to 6 / 0 / 1]

0: 1x
1: 1/2x
2: 1/3x
3: 1/4x
4: 1/5x

007 Rate for Printer B&W 1200dpi [0 to 6 / 1 / 1]

5: 1/8x
6: 2/3x1

Network Quality Default for JPEG
Sets the default value for the quality of JPEG images sent as NetFile pages.
021 This function is available only with the MLB (Media Link Board) option
installed.
[5 to 95 / 50 / 1step]

D129/D130

3-148

SM Appendix

System SP Tables-5

Web Service
5848-2 sets the 4-bit switch assignment for the access control setting.
5848*

Setting of 0001 has no effect on access and delivery from Scan Router.
5848-100 sets the maximum size of images that can be downloaded. The
default is equal to 1 gigabyte.
0000: No access control
002 Acc. Ctrl.: Repository (only Lower 4 Bits)

0001: Denies access to

Appendix:
Service
Program
Mode Tables

DeskTop Binder.
003 Acc. Ctrl.: Doc. Svr. Print (Lower 4 Bits)
004 Acc. Ctrl.: User Directory (Lower 4 Bits)
007 Acc. Ctrl Comm. Log Fax (Lower 4 Bits)
009 Acc. Ctrl.: Job Control (Lower 4 Bits)

Switches access control on
and off.

011 Acc. Ctrl: Device Management (Lower 4 Bits)

0000: OFF, 0001: ON

021 Acc. Ctrl: Delivery (Lower 4 Bits)
022 Acc. Ctrl: User Administration (Lower 4 Bits)
099 Repository: Download Image Setting
Specified the max size of
100 Repository: Download Image Max. Size

the image data that the
machine can download/
[1 to 2048 / 2048 / 1 MB]

Setting: Log Type: Job 1
210
No information is available at this time.
Setting: Log Type: Job 2
211
No information is available at this time.

SM Appendix

3-149

D129/D130

System SP Tables-5

Setting: Log Type: Access
212
No information is available at this time.
Setting: Primary Srv
213
No information is available at this time.
Setting: Secondary Srv
214
No information is available at this time.
Setting: Start Time
215
No information is available at this time.
Setting: Interval Time
216
No information is available at this time.
Setting: Timing
217
No information is available at this time.

Installation Date
5849
Displays or prints the installation date of the machine.

001 Display

The "Counter Clear Day" has been changed to
"Installation Date" or "Inst. Date".
Determines whether the installation date is printed on
the printout for the total counter.

002 Switch to Print

[0 to 1 / 1 / -]
0: OFF (No Print)
1: ON (Print)
When the total number of pages that are made reaches

003 Total Counter

this value, the current date becomes the 'official'
installation date for this machine.
[0 to 99999999 / 0 / 1]

D129/D130

3-150

SM Appendix

System SP Tables-5

5850*

Address Book Function Japan Only
Replacement of Circuit Classification
The machine is sold ready to use with a G3 line. This SP allows you to
003 switch all at once to convert to G4 after you add a G4 line. Conversely, if for
some reason the G4 line becomes unusable, you can easily switch back to
G3.

5851*

Appendix:
Service
Program
Mode Tables

Bluetooth
Sets the operation mode for the Bluetooth Unit. Press either key.
[0: Public] / [1: Private]

Stamp Data Download
Push [Execute] to download the fixed stamp data from the machine ROM
onto the hard disk. Then these stamps can be used by the system. If this is
5853

not done, the user will not have access to the fixed stamps ("Confidential",
"Secret", etc.).
You must always execute this SP after replacing the HDD or after formatting
the HDD. Always switch the machine off and on after executing this SP.

5856

Remote ROM Update
When set to "1" allows reception of firmware data via the local port (IEEE
1284) during a remote ROM update. This setting is reset to zero after the
machine is cycled off and on. Allows the technician to upgrade the firmware
002 using a parallel cable
[0 to 1 / 0 / 1 step]
0: Not allowed
1: Allowed

SM Appendix

3-151

D129/D130

System SP Tables-5

5857

Save Debug Log
On/Off (1:ON 0:OFF)
Switches on the debug log feature. The debug log cannot be captured until
001 this feature is switched on.
[0 to 1 / 0 / 1]
0: OFF, 1: ON
Target (2: HDD 3: SD)
Selects the destination where the debugging information generated by the
002 event selected by SP5858 will be stored if an error is generated
[2 to 3 / 2 / 1]
2: HDD, 3: SD Card
Save to HDD
005
Specifies the decimal key number of the log to be written to the hard disk.
Save to SD Card
006
Specifies the decimal key number of the log to be written to the SD Card.
Copy HDD to SD Card (Latest 4 MB)
Takes the most recent 4 MB of the log written to the hard disk and copies
009 them to the SD Card.
A unique file name is generated to avoid overwriting existing file names on
the SD Card. Up to 4MB can be copied to an SD Card. 4 MB segments can
be copied one by one to each SD Card.
Copy HDD to SD Card Latest 4 MB Any Key)
Takes the log of the specified key from the log on the hard disk and copies it
to the SD Card.
010 A unique file name is generated to avoid overwriting existing file names on
the SD Card. Up to 4 MB can be copied to an SD Card. 4 MB segments can
be copied one by one to each SD Card. This SP does not execute if there is
no log on the HDD with no key specified.

D129/D130

3-152

SM Appendix

System SP Tables-5

Erase HDD Debug Data
011
Erases all debug logs on the HDD
Erase SD Card Debug Data
Erases all debug logs on the SD Card. If the card contains only debugging
012 files generated by an event specified by SP5858, the files are erased when
SP5857 010 or 011 is executed.

Appendix:
Service
Program
Mode Tables

To enable this SP, the machine must be cycled off and on.
Free Space on SD Card
013
Displays the amount of space available on the SD card.
Copy SD to SD (Latest 4MB)
014 Copies the last 4MB of the log (written directly to the card from shared
memory) onto an SD card.
Copy SD to SD (Latest 4MB Any Key)
015 This SP copies the log on an SD card (the file that contains the information
written directly from shared memory) to a log specified by key number.
Make HDD Debug
016
This SP creates a 32 MB file to store a log on the HDD.
Make SD Debug
017
This SP creates a 4 MB file to store a log on an SD card.

SM Appendix

3-153

D129/D130

System SP Tables-5

Debug Save When
These SPs select the content of the debugging information to be saved to

5858*

the destination selected by SP5857-002.
SP5858-003 stores one SC specified by number.

001* Engine SC Error (0:OFF 1:ON)

002*

Stores SC codes generated by copier
engine errors.

Controller SC Error (0:OFF

Stores SC codes generated by GW

1:ON)

controller errors.

003* Any SC Error

[0 to 65535 / 0 / 1step]

004* Jam (0:OFF 1:ON)

Stores jam errors.

5859*

Debug Save Key No.
001 Key 1
002 Key 2
003 Key 3
004 Key 4
005 Key 5

These SPs allow you to set up to 10 keys for log files for
functions that use common memory on the controller board.

006 Key 6

[0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1]

007 Key 7
008 Key 8
009 Key 9
010 Key 10

D129/D130

3-154

SM Appendix

System SP Tables-5

5860*

SMTP/POP3/IMAP4
Partial Mail Receive Timeout
[1 to 168 / 72 / 1 hour]
020 Sets the amount of time to wait before saving a mail that breaks up during
reception. The received mail is discarded if the remaining portion of the mail
is not received during this prescribed time.

Determines whether RFC2298 compliance is switched on for MDN reply
021 mail.
[0 to 1 / 1 / 1]
0: No, 1: Yes
SMTP Auth. From Field Replacement
Determines whether the FROM item of the mail header is switched to the
022 validated account after the SMTP server is validated.
[0 to 1 / 0 / 1]
0: No. "From" item not switched.
1: Yes. "From" item switched.
SMTP Auth Direct Sending
Select the authentication method for SMPT.
Bit 0: LOGIN
Bit 1: PLAIN
025 Bit 2: CRAM_MD5
Bit 3: DIGEST_MD5
Bit 4 to Bit 7: Not Used


This SP is activated only when SMTP authentication is enabled by
UP mode.

SM Appendix

3-155

D129/D130

Appendix:
Service
Program
Mode Tables

MDN Response RFC2298 Compliance

System SP Tables-5

S/MIME: MIME Header Setting
Selects the MIME header type of an E-mail sent by S/MIME.
026 [0 to 2 / 0 / 1]
0: Microsoft Outlook Express standard
1: Internet Draft standard
2: RFC standard
S/MIME: Authentication Check
When sending S/MIME mail, specify whether to check the destination
028 authentication.
[0 to 1 / 0 / 1]
0: Not checked
1: Checked

5866

E-Mail Report

001 Report Validity

Enables or disables the E-mail alert function.
[0 or 1 / 0 / – ] 0: Enabled, 1: Disabled
Adds or does not add the date field to the header of the

005 Add Date Field

alert mail.
[0 or 1 / 0 / – ]
0: Not added, 1: Added

5870

Common Key Info Writing

001 Writing

003 Initialize

004

D129/D130

Writes to flash ROM the common proof for validating the
device for @Remote specifications.
Initializes the data area of the common proof for validating.

Writing:

Writes to flash ROM the common proof (2048-bit) for validating

2048bit

the device for @Remote specifications.

3-156

SM Appendix

System SP Tables-5

SD Card Appli. Move
5873

Allows you to move applications from one SD card another. For more, see
"SD Card Appli Move" in the chapter "System Maintenance (Main Chapters).
001 Move Exec

Executes the move from one SD card to another.

002 Undo Exec

This is an undo function. It cancels the previous execution.

SC Auto Reboot
This SP determines whether the machine reboots automatically when an SC
error occurs.


The reboot does not occur for Type A SC codes.
[0 to 1/ 0 / 1]

001

Reboot
Setting

0: The machine reboots automatically when the machine
issues an SC error and logs the SC error code. If the same
SC occurs again, the machine does not reboot.
1: The machine does not reboot when an SC error occurs.

002 Reboot Type

5878

[0 to 1 / 0 / 1]
0: Manual reboot, 1: Automatic reboot

Option Setup
Press [Execute] to initialize the Data Overwrite
001 Data Overwrite Security

Security option for the copier. For more, see
"DataOverwriteSecurity Unit" in the chapter
"Installation".

Fixed Phase Block Erasing
5881
Detects the Fixed phrase.

SM Appendix

3-157

D129/D130

Appendix:
Service
Program
Mode Tables

5875

System SP Tables-5

CPM Set
5882
DFU

5885*

Set WIM Function
Allows or disallows the functions of web image
monitor.
0: OFF, 1: ON
Bit:
0: Forbid all document server access
020 DocSvr Acc Ctrl

1: Forbid user mode access
2: Forbid print function
3: Forbid Fax
4: Forbid scan sending
5: Forbid download
6: Forbid delete
7: Forbid guest user

DocSvr Format
050 Selects the display type for the document box list.
[0 to 2 / 0 / 1]
0: Thumbnail, 1: Icon, 2: Details
DocSvr Trans
051 Sets the number of documents to be displayed in the document box list.
[5 to 20 / 10 / 1]
Set Signature
[0 to 2 / 0 / 1/step]
0: Signature for each e-mail
100 1: Signature for all e-mails
2: No signature
Selects whether the signature is added to the scanned documents with the
WIM when they are transmitted by an e-mail.

D129/D130

3-158

SM Appendix

System SP Tables-5

Set Encryption
Determines whether the scanned documents with the WIM are encrypted
101 when they are transmitted by an e-mail.
[0 to 1 / 0 / 1]

200 Detect Mem Leak

Not used

201 DocSvr Timeout

Not used
Appendix:
Service
Program
Mode Tables

0: Not encrypted, 1:Encryption

SD Get Counter
5887
This SP determines whether the ROM can be updated.
This SP sends a text file to an SD card inserted in SD card Slot 2 (lower
slot). The operation stores. The file is stored in a folder created in the root
directory of the SD card called SD_COUNTER. The file is saved as a text
001 file (*.txt) prefixed with the number of the machine.
1.

Insert the SD card in SD card Slot 2 (lower slot).

2.

Select SP5887 then touch [EXECUTE].

Touch [Execute] in the message when you are prompted.

Personal Information Protect
Selects the protection level for logs.
5888*

[0 to 1 / 0 / 1]
0: No authentication, No protection for logs
1: No authentication, Protected logs (only an administrator can see the logs)

SM Appendix

3-159

D129/D130

System SP Tables-5

SDK Application Counter
5893
Displays the counter name of each SDK application.
001 SDK-1
002 SDK-2
003 SDK-3
004 SDK-4
005 SDK-5
006 SDK-6

Plug & Play Maker/Model Name
Selects the brand name and the production name for Windows Plug & Play.
This information is stored in the NVRAM. If the NVRAM is defective, these

5907

names should be registered again.
After selecting, press the "Original Type" key and "#" key at the same time.
When the setting is completed, the beeper sounds five times.

LCT Paper Size
Specifies the paper size in the LCT.
5908*

[0 or 1 / 0 / -]
0: A4
1: LT

5913*

Switchover Permission Time
Print Application Timer

[3 to 30 / 3 / 1 second step]

002 Sets the length of time to elapse before allowing another application to take
control of the display when the application currently controlling the display is
not operating because a key has not been pressed.

D129/D130

3-160

SM Appendix

System SP Tables-5

5919*

HDD Encryption
Display Operation State
Shows the status of the encryption function for the HDD.
001

[0 or 1 / 0 / - ]
0: Not Activated

Copy Server: Set Function

0: ON, 1: OFF

Enable and disable the document server. This is a security measure that
5967*

prevents image data from being left in the temporary area of the HDD. After
changing this setting, you must switch the main switch off and on to enable
the new setting.

5973*

User Stamp Registration

101

Frame deletion setting
[0 to 3 / 0 / 1 mm]

Cherry Server
Selects which version of the Scan Router application program, "Light" or
5974*

"Full" (Professional) is installed.
[0 or 1 / 0 / - ]
0: Light
1: Full

SM Appendix

3-161

D129/D130

Appendix:
Service
Program
Mode Tables

1: Activated

System SP Tables-5

Device Setting
The NIC and USB support features are built into the GW controller. Use this

5985

SP to enable and disable these features. In order to use the NIC and USB
functions built into the controller board, these SP codes must be set to "1".
[0 to 2 / 0 / 1 /step]
0: Disable, 1: Enable, 2: Function limitation
When the "Function limitation" is set, "On board NIC" is
limited only for the NRS or LDAP/NT authentication.
001 On Board NIC



Other network applications than @Remote or
LDAP/NT authentication are not available when
this SP is set to "2". Even though you can
change the initial settings of those network
applications, the settings do not work

002 On Board USB

5987*

[0 or 1 / 0 / 1/step]
0: Disable, 1: Enable

Counter Falsification Prevention
This SP detects that a mechanical counter device is removed. If it is
detected, SC610 occurs.
[0 or 1 / 1 / 1/step]
0: OFF. 1: ON

D129/D130

3-162

SM Appendix

System SP Tables-5

SP Print Mode
5990
Prints out the SMC sheets.
001 All ( Data List)
002 SP (Mode Data List)
003 User Program

Appendix:
Service
Program
Mode Tables

004 Logging Data
005 Diagnostic Report
006 Non-Default
007 NIB Summary
008 Capture Log
021 Copier User Program
022 Scanner SP
023 Scanner User Program
024 SDK/J Summary
025 SDK/J Application Info
026 Print SP

SM Appendix

3-163

D129/D130

System SP Tables-5

SP Text Mode
5992
Writes the SMC sheets into the SD card.
001

All ( Data List)

002

SP (Mode Data List)

003

User Program

004

Logging Data

005

Diagnostic Report

006

Non-Default

007

NIB Summary

008

Capture Log

021

Copier User Program

022

Scanner SP

023

Scanner User Program

024

SDK/J Summary

025

SDK/J Application Info

026

Print SP

D129/D130

3-164

SM Appendix

System SP Tables-6

3.6 SYSTEM SP TABLES-6
3.6.1 SP6-XXX: PERIPHERALS

ADF Registration Adjust
Adjusts the side-to-side and leading edge registration for simplex and

6006*

duplex original feeding in ARDF mode.

Appendix:
Service
Program
Mode Tables

SP6006-5 sets the maximum setting allowed for rear edge erase.
001 Side-to-Side Regist: Front
[–3 to 3 / 0 / 0.1 mm / step]
002 Side-to-Side Regist: Rear
003 Leading Edge Registration

[–5 to 5 / 0 / 0.1 mm / step]

005 Buckle: Duplex Front

[–3 to 3 / 0 / 0.1 mm / step]

006 Buckle: Duplex Rear

[–2.5 to 2.5 / 0 / 0.1 mm / step]

007 Rear Edge Erase

[–10 to 10 / 0 / 0.1 mm / step]

6007

ADF Input Check

001

002

003

Original Length 1 (B5
Detection Sensor)
Original Length 2 (A4
Detection Sensor)
Original Length 3 (LG
Detection Sensor)

004 Original Width Sensor 1

0: Paper not detected
1: Paper detected

005 Original Width Sensor 2
006 Original Width Sensor 3
007 Original Width Sensor 4
008 Original Width Sensor 5

SM Appendix

3-165

D129/D130

System SP Tables-6

009 Original Set Sensor
010 Separation Sensor
011 Skew Correction Sensor
012 Scan Entrance Sensor
013 Registration Sensor
014 Exit Sensor

015 Feed Cover Sensor

016 Lift Up Sensor

017 Inverter Sensor

018 Pick-up Roller HP Sensor

019 Original Set HP Sensor

D129/D130

0: ADF cover closed
1: ADF cover open
0: ADF closed
1: ADF open
0: Paper not detected
1: Paper detected
0: HP (Pick-up roller: Up)
1: Not HP (Pick-up roller: Down)
0: HP (Stopper: UP)
1: Not HP (Stopper: Down)

3-166

SM Appendix

System SP Tables-6

6008

ADF Output Check
001 Pick-up Motor Forward
002 Pick-up Motor Reserve
003 Feed Motor Forward
004 Feed Motor Reserve

Appendix:
Service
Program
Mode Tables

005 Relay Motor Forward
007 Inverter Motor Forward
008 Inverter Motor Reserve
011 Inverter Solenoid
012 Stamp
013 Fan Motor

ADF FreeRun
Performs an ARDF free run in duplex mode. Press [ON] to start, press [OFF]

6009

to stop.
Note: This is a general free run controlled from the copier.
001 Free Run: Simplex Motion
002 Free Run: Duplex Motion
003 Free Run: Stamp Motion

ADF Stamp Position Adjust.

[–5 to 5 / 0 / 0.1 mm step]

6010*
Adjusts the horizontal position of the stamp on the scanned originals.

SM Appendix

3-167

D129/D130

System SP Tables-6

Original Size Detect Setting
Specifies the original size for a size detected by the original sensor, since
original sensors cannot recognize all sizes.
(7) 0000 0000 (0)
Different bits are used for detection, depending on the location as shown
below.
Bit

6016*

Size

7

A4 (L)/LT (L)

6

11" x 15"/DLT (L)

5

DLT (L)/ 11" x 15"

4

LT (S)/ US Exec (S)

Location

Japan only

NA only
3

LT (L)/ 8" x 10" (L)

2

LG (L)/ F4 (L)

1

A4 (L)/ 16K (L)

0

8K (L)/ DLT (L)

EU/AA only

DF Magnification Adj.
6017*

[–5 to 5 / 0 / 0.1% step]

Adjusts the magnification in the sub-scan direction for ADF mode.
Use the key to toggle between + and - before entering the value

Skew Correction Moving Setting
Turns the original skew correction in the ARDF for all original sizes on or off.
6020*

[0 to 1 / 0 / 1 ]
0: Off (only for small original sizes)
1: On (for all original sizes)

D129/D130

3-168

SM Appendix

System SP Tables-6

Punch Position: Sub Scan
6128
Adjusts the punching position in the sub scan direction. (For D636/D637)
001 2-Hole: DOM (Japan)
002 3-Hole: NA
003 4-Hole: EU

[-7.5 to 7.5 / 0 / 0.5 mm]

Appendix:
Service
Program
Mode Tables

004 5-Hole: SCAN
005 2-Hole: NA

Punch Position: Main Scan
6129
Adjusts the punching position in the main scan direction. (For D636/D637)
001 2-Hole: DOM (Japan)
002 3-Hole: NA
003 4-Hole: EU

[-2 to 2 / 0 / 0.4 mm]

004 4-Hole: SCAN
005 2-Hole: NA

Skew Correction: Buckle Adj.
6130*

Adjusts the paper buckle at the punch unit for each paper size. (For
D636/D637)
001 A3 SEF
002 B4 SEF
003 A4 SEF
[-5 to 5 / 0 / 0.25 mm]
004 A4 LEF
005 B5 SEF
006 B5 LEF

SM Appendix

3-169

D129/D130

System SP Tables-6

007 DLT SEF
008 LG SEF
009 LT SEF
010 LT LEF
011 12" x 18"
012 Other

Skew Correction Control
6131*
Selects the skew correction control for each paper size. (For D636/D637)
001 A3 SEF
002 B4 SEF
003 A4 SEF
004 A4 LEF
005 B5 SEF
006 B5 LEF
[0 to 1 / 1 / 1 mm]
007 DLT SEF
008 LG SEF
009 LT SEF
010 LT LEF
011 12" x 18"
012 Other

D129/D130

3-170

SM Appendix

System SP Tables-6

Jogger Fence Fine Adj.
This SP adjusts the distance between the jogger fences and the sides of the

6132*

stack on the finisher stapling tray in the (Booklet) Finisher D636/D637. The
adjustment is done perpendicular to the direction of paper feed.
001 A3 SEF
002 B4 SEF

Appendix:
Service
Program
Mode Tables

003 A4 SEF
004 A4 LEF
005 B5 SEF
006 B5 LEF
[-1.5 to 1.5 / 0 / 0.5 mm]
007 DLT SEF
008 LG SEF
009 LT SEF
010 LT LEF
011 12" x 18"
012 Other

Staple Position Adjustment
Adjusts the staple position for each finisher (D636/D637).
6133*

+ Value: Moves the staple position to the rear side.
- Value: Moves the staple position to the front side.
[-3.5 to 3.5 / 0 / 0.5 mm]

SM Appendix

3-171

D129/D130

System SP Tables-6

Saddle Stitch Position Adj.
6134*

Use this SP to adjust the stapling position of the booklet stapler when paper
is stapled and folded in the Booklet Finisher (D637).
001 A3 SEF
002 B4 SEF
[-3 to 3 / 0 / 0.2 mm]
003 A4 SEF
004 B5 SEF

+ Value: Shifts staple position toward the crease.
- Value: Shifts staple position away from the crease

005 DLT SEF
006 LG SEF
007 LT SEF
008 12" x 18"
009 Other

Folder Position Adj.
6135*

This SP corrects the folding position when paper is stapled and folded in the
Booklet Finisher D637.
001 A3 SEF
002 B4 SEF
[-3 to 3 / 0 / 0.2 mm]
003 A4 SEF
004 B5 SEF

+ Value: Shifts staple position toward the crease.
- Value: Shifts staple position away from the crease.

005 DLT SEF
006 LG SEF
007 LT SEF
008 12" x 18"
009 Other

D129/D130

3-172

SM Appendix

System SP Tables-6

Book Fold Repeat
6136*

Sets the number of times that folding is done in the Booklet Finisher D637.
[2 to 30 / 2 / 1 time/step]

Finisher Free Run
6137
These SPs are used for the D588 or D636/D637.

002 Free Run 2

D588: System free run
D636/D637: Free run for paper edge stapling.
Appendix:
Service
Program
Mode Tables

001 Free Run 1

D588: Free run for durability testing
D636/D637: Not used

003 Free Run 3

Not used

004 Free Run 4

Not used

Entrance Sensor
6139

Display the signals received from sensors and switches of the (booklet)
finisher. (D588) (

p.3-251 "Input Check")

FIN (EUP) INPUT Check
6140

Display the signals received from sensors and switches of the (booklet)
finisher. (D636/D637) (

p.3-251 "Input Check")

FIN (KIN) OUPUT Check
6144

Display the signals received from sensors and switches of the (booklet)
finisher. (D588) (

p.3-263 "Output Check")

FIN (EUP) OUPUT Check
6145

Display the signals received from sensors and switches of the (booklet)
finisher. (D636/D637) (

SM Appendix

p.3-263 "Output Check")

3-173

D129/D130

System SP Tables-6

Max. Pre-Stack Sheet

[0 to 3 / 3 / 1 sheets step]

This SP sets the number of sheets sent to the pre-stack tray.
6149*


You may need to adjust this setting or switch it off when feeding
thick or slick paper.

6800

Sheet Conversion (Thick Paper)
Permits punching, including tab sheets.
Note: Do not change this setting.
[1 to 3 / 3 / 1 sheet]
1: 1 Sheet
2: 2 Sheets
3: 3 Sheets

Extra Staples
More than the standard number of sheets can be stapled. This SP sets the
additional number of sheets (This Setting + Standard Number = maximum
number of sheets).

6830*

If the number of the maximum for staples is increased, and the
mechanical warranty of the unit can be guaranteed, then the setting can
take effect without changing the controller software.



However, assurance that mechanical performance can be guaranteed is
required before changing the setting to increase the staple load for more
than the maximum in the feed/exit specifications. Raising this setting
without quality assurance could damage the machine.

Staple positions other than booklet stapling
1
[0 to 50 / 0 /1]
2 Booklet stapling
2
[0 to 50 / 0 /1]

D129/D130

3-174

SM Appendix

System SP Tables-6

6910

Shading Control

ON/OFF
001

[0 to 1 / 0 / 1 ]
0= OFF, 1= ON

Enables or disables the shading adjustment for DF mode.
[0 to 60 / 3 / 1 sec] DFU

003 Shading Interval: B

[0 to 120 / 60 / 1 ] DFU
Appendix:
Service
Program
Mode Tables

002 Shading Interval: A

SM Appendix

3-175

D129/D130

System SP Tables-7

3.7 SYSTEM SP TABLES-7
3.7.1 SP7-XXX: DATA LOG

7401*

Total SC Counter
SC Counter
001 Displays the total number of service calls that have occurred.
This SC counter can be reset by executing SP7807 (SC/Jam Counter
Reset).
Total SC Counter
002 Displays the cumulative sum of service calls that have occurred.
This SC counter cannot be reset by executing SP7807 (SC/Jam Counter
Reset).

7403*

SC History
001 Latest
002 Latest 1
003 Latest 2
004 Latest 3
005 Latest 4
Displays the most recent 10 service calls.
006 Latest 5
007 Latest 6
008 Latest 7
009 Latest 8
010 Latest 9

D129/D130

3-176

SM Appendix

System SP Tables-7

7404*

SC991 History
001 Latest
002 Latest 1
003 Latest 2
004 Latest 3
005 Latest 4
Appendix:
Service
Program
Mode Tables

Displays the 10 most recently detected SC991 codes.
006 Latest 5
007 Latest 6
008 Latest 7
009 Latest 8
010 Latest 9

7502*

Total Paper Jam
Jam Counter
001 Displays the total number of paper jams.
This SC counter can be reset by executing SP7807 (SC/Jam Counter
Reset).
Total Jam Counter
002 Displays the cumulative sum of paper jams.
This SC counter cannot be reset by executing SP7807 (SC/Jam Counter
Reset).

SM Appendix

3-177

D129/D130

System SP Tables-7

7503*

Total Original Jam
Original Jam Counter
001 Displays the total number of original jams.
This SC counter can be reset by executing SP7807 (SC/Jam Counter
Reset).
Total Original Counter
002 Displays the cumulative sum of original jams.
This SC counter cannot be reset by executing SP7807 (SC/Jam Counter
Reset).

Total Jams Location
These SPs display the total number of paper jams by location. A "Check-in"
7504*

(paper late) error occurs when the paper fails to activate the sensor at the
precise time. A "Check-out" ("paper lag") paper jam occurs when the paper
remains at the sensor for longer than the prescribed time.
001 At power On
003 Tray 1: On
004 Tray 2: On
005 Tray 3: On
006 Tray 4: On
007 LCT: On
008 Bypass: On
009 Duplex: On
011 Vertical Transport 1: On
012 Vertical Transport 2: On
013 Bank: Transport Sn 1: On

D129/D130

3-178

SM Appendix

System SP Tables-7

014 Bank: Transport Sn 2: On
017 Registration: On
019 Fusing Exit: On
020 Paper Exit: On
021 Bridge Exit On

Appendix:
Service
Program
Mode Tables

022 Bridge Transport: On
024 Junction Gate Sensor: On
025 Duplex Exit: On
026 Duplex Entrance: On (In)
027 Duplex Entrance: On (Out)
051 Vertical Transport 1: Off
052 Vertical Transport 2: Off
053 Bank Transport 1: Off
054 Bank Transport 2: Off
057 Registration Sensor: Off
058 LCT Feed Sensor: Off
060 Paper Exit: Off
061 Bridge: Exit: Off
062 Bridge: Transport: Off
064 Junction Gate Sensor: Off
065 Duplex Exit: Off
066 Duplex Entrance: Off (In)
067 Duplex Entrance: Off (Out)

SM Appendix

3-179

D129/D130

System SP Tables-7

100 Finisher Entrance: KIN
101 Finisher Shift Tray Exit: KIN
102 Finisher Staple: KIN
103 Finisher Exit: KIN
105 Finisher Tray Lift Motor: KIN
106 Finisher Jogger Motor: KIN
107 Finisher Shift Motor: KIN
108 Finisher Staple Motor: KIN
109 Finisher Exit Motor: KIN
191 Finisher Entrance: EUP
192 Finisher Proof Exit: EUP
193 Finisher Shift Tray Exit: EUP
194 Finisher Staple Exit: EUP
195 Finisher Exit: EUP
198 Finisher Folder: EUP
199 Finisher Tray Motor: EUP
200 Finisher Jogger Motor: EUP
201 Finisher Shift Motor: EUP
202 Finisher Staple Moving Motor: EUP
203 Finisher Staple Motor: EUP
204 Finisher Folder Motor: EUP
206 Finisher Punch Motor: EUP

D129/D130

3-180

SM Appendix

System SP Tables-7

Original Jam Detection
Displays the total number of original jams by location. These jams occur
when the original does not activate the sensors. A Check-in ("paper late")

7505

error occurs when the paper fails to activate the sensor at the precise time. A
Check-out ("paper lag") paper jam occurs when the paper remains at the
sensor for longer than the prescribed time.
001 At Power: On

Appendix:
Service
Program
Mode Tables

003 Separation Sensor: On
004 Skew Correction Sensor: On
005 Interval Sensor: On
006 Registration Sensor: On
007 Inverter Sensor: On
008 Original Exit Sensor: On
053 Separation Sensor: Off
054 Skew Correction Sensor: Off
055 Interval Sensor: Off
056 Registration Sensor: Off
057 Inverter Sensor: Off
058 Original Exit Sensor: Off

SM Appendix

3-181

D129/D130

System SP Tables-7

7506*

Jam Count by Paper Size
005 A4 LEF
006 A5 LEF
014 B5 LEF
038 LT LEF
044 HLT LEF
132 A3 SEF
133 A4 SEF
134 A5 SEF

Displays the total number of copy jams by paper size.

141 B4 SEF
142 B5 SEF
160 DLT SEF
164 LG SEF
166 LT SEF
172 HLT SEF
255 Others

D129/D130

3-182

SM Appendix

System SP Tables-7

7507*

Plotter Jam History
001 Last
002 Latest 1
003 Latest 2

Displays the copy jam history (the most recent 10 jams)
Sample Display:
CODE:007

004 Latest 3
005 Latest 4

SIZE:05h
TOTAL:0000334

006 Latest 5

where:

007 Latest 6

CODE is the SP7504-*** number (see above.

Appendix:
Service
Program
Mode Tables

DATE: Mon Mar 15 11:44:50 2000

SIZE is the ASAP paper size code in hex.
008 Latest 7
009 Latest 8

TOTAL is the total jam error count (SP7502)
DATE is the date the jams occurred.

010 Latest 9
Size

Code

Size

Code

Size

Code

A4 (S)

05

A3 (L)

84

DLT (L)

A0

A5 (S)

06

A4 (L)

85

LG (L)

A4

B5 (S)

0E

A5 (L)

86

LT (L)

A6

LT (S)

26

B4 (L)

8D

HLT (L)

AC

HLT (S)

2C

B5 (L)

8E

Others

FF

SM Appendix

3-183

D129/D130

System SP Tables-7

7508*

Original Jam History
001 Last
002 Last 1
003 Last 2

Displays the original jam history (the most recent 10 jams).
Sample Display:
CODE:007

004 Last 3
005 Last 4

SIZE:05h
TOTAL:0000334
DATE: Mon Mar 15 11:44:50 2000

006 Last 5

where:

007 Last 6

CODE is the SP7505*** number (see above.
SIZE is the ASAP paper size code in hex.

008 Last 7
009 Last 8

TOTAL is the total jam error count (SP7503)
DATE is the date the jams occurred.

010 Last 9
Size

Code

Size

Code

Size

Code

A4 (S)

05

A3 (L)

84

DLT (L)

A0

A5 (S)

06

A4 (L)

85

LG (L)

A4

B5 (S)

0E

A5 (L)

86

LT (L)

A6

LT (S)

26

B4 (L)

8D

HLT (L)

AC

HLT (S)

2C

B5 (L)

8E

Others

FF

D129/D130

3-184

SM Appendix

System SP Tables-7

Part Replacement Operation
7624*
Selects the PM maintenance for each part.
001 PCU-BK
002 Fuser

[0 to 1 / 1 / 1]
0:No (Not PM maintenance)

003 Transfer Unit

1: Yes (PM maintenance)

Appendix:
Service
Program
Mode Tables

004 FuserCleaner

ROM No./Firmware Version
7801

This SP codes display the firmware versions of all ROMs in the system,
including the mainframe, the ARDF, and peripheral devices.

PM Counter Display
7803*
Displays the PM counter since the last PM.
Paper

[0 to 999999 / 0 / 1 page]

001
Displays the paper counter (pages)
Page: PCD

[0 to 999999 / 0 / 1 page]

002
Displays the PCD (Drum and Development unit) counter (pages)
Page: Transfer

[0 to 999999 / 0 / 1 page]

003
Displays the transfer unit counter (pages).
Page: Fuser

[0 to 999999 / 0 / 1 page]

004
Displays the fusing unit counter (pages).
Rotation: PCD

[0 to 999999999 / 0 / 1 mm ]

005
Displays the PCD rotation counter (distance).

SM Appendix

3-185

D129/D130

System SP Tables-7

Rotation: Transfer

[0 to 999999999 / 0 / 1 mm ]

006
Displays the transfer unit rotation counter (distance).
Rotation: Fuser

[0 to 999999999 / 0 / 1 mm ]

007
Displays the fuser unit rotation counter (distance).
Rotation(%): PCD

[0 to 255 / 0 / 1 %]

008
Displays the PCD (%) rotation counter (Distance/PM).
Rotation(%):Transfer

[0 to 255 / 0 / 1 %]

009
Displays the transfer unit (%) rotation counter (distance/PM).
Rotation(%):Fuser

[0 to 255 / 0 / 1 %]

010
Displays the fuser unit (%) rotation counter (distance/PM).
Rotation(%):Web

[0 to 255 / 0 / 1 %]

011
Displays the web unit (%) rotation counter (distance/PM).

PM Counter Reset
7804

Resets the PM counter.
Touch [Execute] two times > "Completed" > [Exit]
Paper
001
Resets the PM counter of the paper.
PCD
002 Resets the PM counter of the PCD (Drum and Development unit except
developer).
Transfer
003
Resets the PM counter of the transfer unit.

D129/D130

3-186

SM Appendix

System SP Tables-7

Fuser
004
Resets the PM counter of the fuser unit.
Web
005
Reset the PM counter of the web unit.
All Clear
006

7805

Appendix:
Service
Program
Mode Tables

Resets all PM counter

Parts Counter
Page: OPC

[0 to 999999 / 0 / 1 page]

001
Displays the parts counter (pages) of the OPC.
Page: Charge Roller

[0 to 999999 / 0 / 1 page]

002
Displays the parts counter (pages) of the charge roller.
Page: Developer

[0 to 999999 / 0 / 1 page]

003
Displays the parts counter (pages) of the developer.
Page: Belt Blade

[0 to 999999 / 0 / 1 page]

004
Displays the parts counter (pages) of the transfer belt cleaning blade.
Page: Heat Roller

[0 to 999999 / 0 / 1 page]

005
Displays the parts counter (pages) of the hot roller.
Page: Pressure Roller

[0 to 999999 / 0 / 1 page]

006
Displays the parts counter (pages) of the pressure roller.
Page: Cleaning Roller

[0 to 999999 / 0 / 1 page]

007
Displays the parts counter (pages) of the cleaning roller.
Page: Thermistor

[0 to 999999 / 0 / 1 page]

008
Displays the parts counter (pages) of the thermistors.

SM Appendix

3-187

D129/D130

System SP Tables-7

Page: Stripper

[0 to 999999 / 0 / 1 page]

009
Displays the parts counter (pages) of the strippers.
Rotation: OPC

[0 to 999999999 / 0 / 1 mm ]

010
Displays the parts counter (rotations) of the OPC.
Rotation: Charge Roller

[0 to 999999999 / 0 / 1 mm ]

011
Displays the parts counter (rotations) of the charge roller.
Rotation: Developer

[0 to 999999999 / 0 / 1 mm ]

012
Displays the parts counter (rotations) of the developer.
Rotation: Belt Blade

[0 to 999999999 / 0 / 1 mm ]

013
Displays the parts counter (rotations) of the transfer belt, blade.
Rotation: Heat Roller

[0 to 999999999 / 0 / 1 mm ]

014
Displays the parts counter (rotations) of the hot roller.
Rotation: Pressure Roller

[0 to 999999999 / 0 / 1 mm ]

015
Displays the parts counter (rotations) of the pressure roller.
Rotation: Cleaning Roller

[0 to 999999999 / 0 / 1 mm ]

016
Displays the parts counter (rotations) of the cleaning roller.
Rotation: Thermistor

[0 to 999999999 / 0 / 1 mm ]

017
Displays the parts counter (rotations) of the thermistors.
Rotation: Stripper

[0 to 999999999 / 0 / 1 mm ]

018
Displays the parts counter (rotations) of the strippers.
Page(%): Web

[0 to 255 / 0 / 1 %]

019
Displays the parts counter (rotations/PM %) of the cleaning web.

D129/D130

3-188

SM Appendix

System SP Tables-7

7806

Counter Clear
OPC
001
Resets the parts counter of the OPC.
Charge Roller
002
Resets the parts counter of the charge roller.
Developer
Appendix:
Service
Program
Mode Tables

003
Resets the parts counter of the developer.
Belt: Blade
004
Resets the parts counter of the transfer belt cleaning blade.
Heat Roller
005
Resets the parts counter of the hot roller.
Pressure Roller
006
Resets the parts counter of the pressure roller.
Cleaning Roller
007
Resets the parts counter of the cleaning roller.
Web
008
Resets the parts counter of the cleaning web.
Thermistor
009
Resets the parts counter of the thermistors.
Stripper
010
Resets the parts counter of the strippers.
All Clear
011
Resets all parts counters.

SM Appendix

3-189

D129/D130

System SP Tables-7

SC/Jam Counter Reset
Resets the SC and jam counters. To reset, press Execute on the touch

7807

panel.
This SP does not reset the jam history counters: SP7507, SP7508.

MF Error Counter Japan Only
7826
Displays the number of counts requested of the card/key counter.

001 Error Total

002 Error Staple

A request for the count total failed at power on. This error
will occur if the device is installed but disconnected.
The request for a staple count failed at power on. This error
will occur if the device is installed but disconnected.

MF Error Counter Clear Japan Only
7827
Press Execute to reset to 0 the values of SP7826. Japan Only

Self-Diagnose Result Display
Execute to open the "Self-Diagnostics Result Display" to view details about
7832

errors. Use the keys in the display on the touch-panel to scroll through all
the information. If no errors have occurred, you will see the "No Error"
message on the screen.

Total Memory Size
7836
Displays the memory capacity of the controller system.

D129/D130

3-190

SM Appendix

System SP Tables-7

DF Glass Dust Check
Counts the number of occurrences (0 to 65,535) when dust was detected on

7852*

the scanning glass of the ADF or resets the dust detection counter.
Counting is done only if SP4-020-1 (Dust Check) is switched on.

002

7853

Dust Detection Clear
Counter

[0 to 65535 / 0 / 1 /step]

[0 to 65535 / 0 / 1 /step]
Appendix:
Service
Program
Mode Tables

001 Dust Detection Counter

Replacement Counter
PCD

[0 to 255 / 0 / 1 ]

001
Displays the replacement counter of the PCD (Drum and Development unit).
Transfer

[0 to 255 / 0 / 1 ]

002
Displays the replacement counter of the transfer unit.
Fuser

[0 to 255 / 0 / 1 ]

003
Displays the replacement counter of the fusing unit.
Web

[0 to 255 / 0 / 1 ]

004
Displays the replacement counter of the cleaning web.

zero cross
7856*

[0 to 255 / 60 / 1 ]

Stores and displays the detected zero cross frequency of the main ac power
supply from the wall socket.

SM Appendix

3-191

D129/D130

System SP Tables-7

Assert Info. DFU
7901

These SP numbers display the results of the occurrence of the most recent
SC code generated by the machine.
001* File Name

Module name

002* Number of Lines

Number of the lines where error occurred.

003* Location

Value

7906

Prev Counter
Page: PCD

[0 to 999999 / 0 / 1 page]

001
Displays the counter (pages) of the previous PCD
Page: Transfer

[0 to 999999 / 0 / 1 page]

002
Displays the previous counter (pages) of the previous transfer unit.
Page: Fuser

[0 to 999999 / 0 / 1 page]

003
Displays the previous counter (pages) of the previous fusing unit.
Rotation: PCD

[0 to 999999999 / 0 / 1 mm ]

004
Displays the previous counter (rotations) of the previous PCD
Rotation: Transfer

[0 to 999999999 / 0 / 1 mm ]

005
Displays the previous counter (rotations) of the previous transfer unit.
Rotation: Fuser

[0 to 999999999 / 0 / 1 mm ]

006
Displays the previous counter (rotations/PM %) of the previous fusing unit.
Rotation(%):PCD

[0 to 255 / 0 / 1 mm]

007
Displays the previous counter (rotations/PM %) of the previous PCD

D129/D130

3-192

SM Appendix

System SP Tables-7

Rotation(%):Transfer

[0 to 255 / 0 / 1 mm]

008
Displays the previous counter (rotations/PM %) of the previous transfer unit.
Rotation(%):Fuser

[0 to 255 / 0 / 1 mm]

009
Displays the previous counter (rotations/PM %) of the previous fusing unit.
Rotation(%):Web

[0 to 255 / 0 / 1 %]

010 Displays the previous counter (rotations/PM %) of the previous cleaning

7950

Appendix:
Service
Program
Mode Tables

web.

Replacement Date
PCD
001
Displays the replacement date of the PCD.
Transfer
002
Displays the replacement date of the transfer unit.
Fuser
003
Displays the replacement date of the fusing unit.
Web
004
Displays the replacement date of the web unit.

SM Appendix

3-193

D129/D130

System SP Tables-7

7951

Remaining Counter
PCD(Page)

[0 to 255 / 255 / 1 days]

001
Displays the remaining counter (pages) of the PCD.
Transfer(Page)

[0 to 255 / 255 / 1 days]

002
Displays the remaining counter (pages) of the transfer unit.
Fuser(Page)

[0 to 255 / 255 / 1 days]

003
Displays the remaining counter (pages) of the fusing unit.
PCD(Rotation)

[0 to 255 / 255 / 1 days]

005
Displays the remaining counter (rotations) of the PCD.
Transfer(Rotation)

[0 to 255 / 255 / 1 days]

006
Displays the remaining counter (rotations) of the transfer unit.
Fuser(Rotation)

[0 to 255 / 255 / 1 days]

007
Displays the remaining counter (rotations) of the fusing unit.
PCD (%)

[0 to 255 / 100 / 1 %]

009
Displays the remaining counter (%) of the PCD.
Transfer (%)

[0 to 255 / 100 / 1 %]

010
Displays the remaining counter (%) of the transfer unit.
Fuser (%)

[0 to 255 / 100 / 1 %]

011
Displays the remaining counter (%) of the fusing unit.
Web (%)

[0 to 255 / 100 / 1 %]

013
Displays the remaining counter (%) of the cleaning web.

D129/D130

3-194

SM Appendix

System SP Tables-7

PM Yield Setting
7952
Sets the each yield of the following.
PCD(Page)

[0 to 99999999/ 160000 / 1 sheet]

001
Sets the PM yield of the PCD (Pages).
Transfer(Page)

[0 to 9999999 / 160000 / 1 sheet]

002

Fuser(Page)

[0 to 9999999 / 160000 / 1 sheet]

003
Sets the PM yield of the fusing unit (Pages).

PCD(Rotation)
005

C2b: [0 to 999999999 / 71990000 / 1 mm]
C2c: [0 to 999999999 / 75500000 / 1 mm]

Sets the PM yield of the PCD (Rotations).

Transfer(Rotation)
006

C2b: [0 to 999999999 / 62770000 / 1 mm]
C2c: [0 to 999999999 / 65420000 / 1 mm]

Sets the PM yield of the transfer unit (Rotations).

Fuser(Rotation)
007

C2b: [0 to 999999999 / 54880000 / 1 mm]
C2b: [0 to 999999999 / 55800000 / 1 mm]

Sets the PM yield of the fusing unit (Rotations).
Web (%)

[0 to 255 / 92 / 1 %]

009
Sets the PM yield (%) of the web unit.
Day Threshold: PCD

[1 to 30 / 15 / 1 days]

021
Adjusts the threshold day for the near end for the PCD.
Day Threshold: Transfer Unit

[1 to 30 / 15 / 1 days]

022
Adjusts the threshold day for the near end for the transfer unit.
Day Threshold: Fusing Unit

[1 to 30 / 15 / 1 days]

023
Adjusts the threshold day for the near end for the fusing unit.

SM Appendix

3-195

D129/D130

Appendix:
Service
Program
Mode Tables

Sets the PM yield of the transfer unit (Pages).

System SP Tables-7

7953

Operation Env Log
T<10

[0 to 99999999 / 0 / 1 mm]

001
Displays the PCU rotation distance in the environment: T<10°C
10<=T<=17

[0 to 99999999 / 0 / 1 mm]

002
Displays the PCU rotation distance in the environment: 10°C<=T<=17°C
17

More (2> "2 or more", 4> "4 or more"

AddBook

Address Book

Apl

Application

B/W

Black & White

Bk

Black

C

Cyan

ColCr

Color Create

ColMode

Color Mode

D129/D130

3-198

SM Appendix

System SP Tables-8

Abbreviation

What It Means

Comb

Combine

Comp

Compression

Deliv

Delivery
Designated Application. The application (Copy, Fax, Scan, Print)
used to store the job on the document server, for example.

Dev Counter

Development Count, no. of pages developed.

Dup, Duplex

Duplex, printing on both sides

Emul

Emulation

FC

Full Color

FIN

Post-print processing, i.e. finishing (punching, stapling, etc.)

Full Bleed

No Margins

GenCopy

Generation Copy Mode

Appendix:
Service
Program
Mode Tables

DesApl

Get Print Counter. For jobs 10 pages or less, this counter does
GPC

not count up. For jobs larger than 10 pages, this counter counts
up by the number that is in excess of 10 (e.g., for an 11-page
job, the counter counts up 11-10 =1)

IFax

ImgEdt

Internet Fax
Image Edit performed on the original with the copier GUI, e.g.
border removal, adding stamps, page numbers, etc.

K

Black (YMCK)

LS

Local Storage. Refers to the document server.

LSize

Large (paper) Size

Mag

Magnification

MC

One color (monochrome)

SM Appendix

3-199

D129/D130

System SP Tables-8

Abbreviation

What It Means
New Remote Service, which allows a service center to monitor

NRS

machines remotely. "NRS" is used overseas, "CSS" is used in
Japan.

Org

Original for scanning

OrgJam

Original Jam
Print Job Manager/Desk Top Editor: A pair of utilities that allows

Palm 2

print jobs to be distributed evenly among the printers on the
network, and allows files to moved around, combined, and
converted to different formats.

PC

Personal Computer
Pages. A page is the total scanned surface of the original.

PGS

Duplex pages count as two pages, and A3 simplex count as two
pages if the A3/DLT counter SP is switched ON.

PJob

Print Jobs

Ppr

Paper

PrtJam

Printer (plotter) Jam

PrtPGS

Print Pages
Red (Toner Remaining). Applies to the wide format model A2

R

only. This machine is under development and currently not
available.

Rez

Resolution

SC

Service Code (Error SC code displayed)

Scn

Scan

Sim, Simplex

Simplex, printing on 1 side.

S-to-Email

Scan-to-E-mail

D129/D130

3-200

SM Appendix

System SP Tables-8

Abbreviation

What It Means
SMC report printed with SP5990. All of the Group 8counters are

SMC

Svr

Server

TonEnd

Toner End

TonSave

Toner Save

TXJob

Send, Transmission

YMC

Yellow, Magenta, Cyan

YMCK

Yellow, Magenta, Cyan, BlacK



Appendix:
Service
Program
Mode Tables

recorded in the SMC report.

All of the Group 8 SPs are reset with SP5 801-1 Memory All Clear.

8001
8002

T:Total Jobs
These SPs count the number of times each
C:Total Jobs

application is used to do a job.
[0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1]

8003

F:Total Jobs

Note: The L: counter is the total number of times the

8004

P:Total Jobs

other applications are used to send a job to the

8005

S:Total Jobs

8006

L:Total Jobs

document server, plus the number of times a file



already on the document server is used.

These SPs reveal the number of times an application is used, not the number of pages
processed.



When an application is opened for image input or output, this counts as one job.



Interrupted jobs (paper jams, etc.) are counted, even though they do not finish.



Only jobs executed by the customer are counted. Jobs executed by the customer engineer
using the SP modes are not counted.



When using secure printing (when a password is required to start the print job), the job is
counted at the time when either "Delete Data" or "Specify Output" is specified.



A job is counted as a fax job when the job is stored for sending.

SM Appendix

3-201

D129/D130

System SP Tables-8



When a fax is received to fax memory, the F: counter increments but the L: counter does
not (the document server is not used).



A fax broadcast counts as one job for the F: counter (the fax destinations in the broadcast
are not counted separately).



A fax broadcast is counted only after all the faxes have been sent to their destinations. If
one transmission generates an error, then the broadcast will not be counted until the
transmission has been completed.



A printed fax report counts as one job for the F: counter.



The F: counter does not distinguish between fax sending or receiving.



When a copy job on the document server is printed, SP8022 also increments, and when a
print job stored on the document server is printed, SP8024 also increments.



When an original is both copied and stored on the document server, the C: and L: counters
both increment.



When a print job is stored on the document server, only the L: counter increments.



When the user presses the Document Server button to store the job on the document
server, only the L: counter increments.



When the user enters document server mode and prints data stored on the document
server, only the L: counter increments.



When an image received from Palm 2 is received and stored, the L: counter increments.



When the customer prints a report (user code list, for example), the O: counter increments.
However, for fax reports and reports executed from the fax application, the F: counter
increments.



8011

T:Jobs/LS

8012

C:Jobs/LS

8013

F:Jobs/LS

8014

P:Jobs/LS

8015

S:Jobs/LS

8016

L:Jobs/LS

8017

O:Jobs/LS

These SPs count the number of jobs stored to the
document server by each application, to reveal how local
storage is being used for input.
[0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1]
The L: counter counts the number of jobs stored from
within the document server mode screen at the operation
panel.

When a scan job is sent to the document server, the S: counter increments. When you
enter document server mode and then scan an original, the L: counter increments.



When a print job is sent to the document server, the P: counter increments.



When a network application sends data to the document server, the O: counter increments.

D129/D130

3-202

SM Appendix

System SP Tables-8



When an image from Palm 2 is stored on the document server, the O: counter increments.



When a fax is sent to the document server, the F: counter increments.

8021

T:Pjob/LS

8022

C:Pjob/LS
These SPs reveal how files printed from the document

8023

F:Pjob/LS

8024

P:Pjob/LS

8025

S:Pjob/LS

8026

L:Pjob/LS

8027

O:Pjob/LS

server were stored on the document server originally.
[0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1]
The L: counter counts the number of jobs stored from
within the document server mode screen at the operation



Appendix:
Service
Program
Mode Tables

panel.

When a copy job stored on the document server is printed with another application, the C:
counter increments.



When an application like DeskTopBinder merges a copy job that was stored on the
document server with a print job that was stored on the document server, the C: and P:
counters both increment.



When a job already on the document server is printed with another application, the L:
counter increments.



When a scanner job stored on the document server is printed with another application, the
S: counter increments. If the original was scanned from within document server mode, then
the L: counter increments.



When images stored on the document server by a network application (including Palm 2),
are printed with another application, the O: counter increments.



When a copy job stored on the document server is printed with a network application (Web
Image Monitor, for example), the C: counter increments.



When a fax on the document server is printed, the F: counter increments.

SM Appendix

3-203

D129/D130

System SP Tables-8

8031

T:Pjob/DesApl

8032

C:Pjob/DesApl
These SPs reveal what applications were used to

8033

F:Pjob/DesApl

8034

P:Pjob/DesApl

8035

S:Pjob/DesApl

8036

L:Pjob/DesApl

8037

O:Pjob/DesApl

output documents from the document server.
[0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1]
The L: counter counts the number of jobs printed from
within the document server mode screen at the
operation panel.



When documents already stored on the document server are printed, the count for the
application that started the print job is incremented.



When the print job is started from a network application (Desk Top Binder, Web Image
Monitor, etc.) the L: counter increments.

8041

T:TX Jobs/LS
These SPs count the applications that stored files on

8042

C:TX Jobs/LS

8043

F:TX Jobs/LS

8044

P:TX Jobs/LS

8045

S:TX Jobs/LS

8046

L:TX Jobs/LS

8047

O:TX Jobs/LS

the document server that were later accessed for
transmission over the telephone line or over a network
(attached to an e-mail, or as a fax image by I-Fax).
[0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1]
Note: Jobs merged for sending are counted separately.
The L: counter counts the number of jobs scanned from
within the document server mode screen at the
operation panel.



When a stored copy job is sent from the document server, the C: counter increments.



When images stored on the document server by a network application or Palm2 are sent as
an e-mail, the O: counter increments.

D129/D130

3-204

SM Appendix

System SP Tables-8

8051

T:TX Jobs/DesApl
These SPs count the applications used to send
C:TX Jobs/DesApl

8053

F:TX Jobs/DesApl

8054

P:TX Jobs/DesApl

8055

S:TX Jobs/DesApl

8056

L:TX Jobs/DesApl

8057

O:TX Jobs/DesApl

files from the document server over the telephone
line or over a network (attached to an e-mail, or as
a fax image by I-Fax). Jobs merged for sending
are counted separately.
[0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1]
The L: counter counts the number of jobs sent
from within the document server mode screen at
the operation panel.



If the send is started from Desk Top Binder or Web Image Monitor, for example, then the O:
counter increments.

T:FIN Jobs
8061

[0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1]

These SPs total the finishing methods. The finishing method is specified by
the application.
C:FIN Jobs

8062

[0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1]

These SPs total finishing methods for copy jobs only. The finishing method
is specified by the application.
F:FIN Jobs

8063

[0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1]

These SPs total finishing methods for fax jobs only. The finishing method is
specified by the application.
Note: Finishing features for fax jobs are not available at this time.
P:FIN Jobs

8064

[0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1]

These SPs total finishing methods for print jobs only. The finishing method is
specified by the application.
S:FIN Jobs

8065

[0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1]

These SPs total finishing methods for scan jobs only. The finishing method
is specified by the application.
Note: Finishing features for scan jobs are not available at this time.

SM Appendix

3-205

D129/D130

Appendix:
Service
Program
Mode Tables

8052

System SP Tables-8

L:FIN Jobs
8066

[0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1]

These SPs total finishing methods for jobs output from within the document
server mode screen at the operation panel. The finishing method is
specified from the print window within document server mode.
O:FIN Jobs

8067

[0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1]

These SPs total finishing methods for jobs executed by an external
application, over the network. The finishing method is specified by the
application.
Number of jobs started in Sort mode. When a stored

806x 1 Sort

copy job is set for Sort and then stored on the
document server, the L: counter increments. (See
SP8066 1)

806x 2 Stack

Number of jobs started out of Sort mode.

806x 3 Staple

Number of jobs started in Staple mode.
Number of jobs started in Booklet mode. If the

806x 4 Booklet

machine is in staple mode, the Staple counter also
increments.

806x 5 Z-Fold

Number of jobs started In any mode other than the
Booklet mode and set for folding (Z-fold).
Number of jobs started in Punch mode. When Punch

806x 6 Punch

is set for a print job, the P: counter increments. (See
SP8064 6.)

806x 7 Other

806x 8 Inside-Fold

806x 9 Three-IN-Fold

Reserved. Not used
Number of jobs started In any mode other than the
Booklet mode and set for folding (Inside-fold).
Letter Fold-in Not Used

806x 10 Three-OUT-Fold

Letter Fold-out Not Used

806x 11 Four-Fold

Double Parallel Fold Not Used

806x 12 KANNON-Fold

Gate Fold Not Used

D129/D130

3-206

SM Appendix

System SP Tables-8

806x 13 Perfect-Bind

Perfect Binder Not Used

806x 14 Ring-Bind

Ring Binder Not Used

T:Jobs/PGS
8071

[0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1]

These SPs count the number of jobs broken down by the number of pages
in the job, regardless of which application was used.

8072

[0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1]

These SPs count and calculate the number of copy jobs by size based on
the number of pages in the job.
F:Jobs/PGS

8073

[0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1]

These SPs count and calculate the number of fax jobs by size based on the
number of pages in the job.
P:Jobs/PGS

8074

[0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1]

These SPs count and calculate the number of print jobs by size based on
the number of pages in the job.
S:Jobs/PGS

8075

[0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1]

These SPs count and calculate the number of scan jobs by size based on
the number of pages in the job.
L:Jobs/PGS

8076

[0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1]

These SPs count and calculate the number of jobs printed from within the
document server mode window at the operation panel, by the number of
pages in the job.
O:Jobs/PGS

8077

[0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1]

These SPs count and calculate the number of "Other" application jobs (Web
Image Monitor, Palm 2, etc.) by size based on the number of pages in the
job.

807x 1 1 Page

807x 8 21 to 50 Pages

807x 2 2 Pages

807x 9 51 to 100 Pages

SM Appendix

3-207

D129/D130

Appendix:
Service
Program
Mode Tables

C:Jobs/PGS

System SP Tables-8



807x 3 3 Pages

807x 10 101 to 300 Pages

807x 4 4 Pages

807x 11 301 to 500 Pages

807x 5 5 Pages

807x 12 501 to 700 Pages

807x 6 6 to 10 Pages

807x 13 701 to 1000 Pages

807x 7 11 to 20 Pages

807x 14 1001 to Pages

For example: When a copy job stored on the document server is printed in document server
mode, the appropriate L: counter (SP8076 0xx) increments.



Printing a fax report counts as a job and increments the F: counter (SP 8073).



Interrupted jobs (paper jam, etc.) are counted, even though they do not finish.



If a job is paused and re-started, it counts as one job.



If the finisher runs out of staples during a print and staple job, then the job is counted at the
time the error occurs.



For copy jobs (SP 8072) and scan jobs (SP 8075), the total is calculated by multiplying the
number of sets of copies by the number of pages scanned. (One duplex page counts as 2.)



The first test print and subsequent test prints to adjust settings are added to the number of
pages of the copy job (SP 8072).



When printing the first page of a job from within the document server screen, the page is
counted.

T:FAX TX Jobs

[0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1]

These SPs count the total number of jobs (color or black-and-white) sent by
8111

fax, either directly or using a file stored on the document server, on a
telephone line.
Note: Color fax sending is not available at this time.
001 B/W

Black TX

F:FAX TX Jobs

[0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1]

These SPs count the total number of jobs (color or black-and-white) sent by

8113

fax directly on a telephone line.
Note: Color fax sending is not available at this time.
001 B/W

D129/D130

Black TX

3-208

SM Appendix

System SP Tables-8



These counters count jobs, not pages.



This SP counts fax jobs sent over a telephone line with a fax application, including
documents stored on the document server.



If the mode is changed during the job, the job will count with the mode set when the job
started.



If the same document is faxed to both a public fax line and an I-Fax at a destination where
both are available, then this counter increments, and the I-Fax counter (812x) also
increments.
The fax job is counted when the job is scanned for sending, not when the job is sent.

T:IFAX TX Jobs

[0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1]

These SPs count the total number of jobs (color or black-and-white) sent,
8121

either directly or using a file stored on the document server, as fax images
using I-Fax.
Note: Color fax sending is not available at this time.
001 B/W

Black TX

F:IFAX TX Jobs

[0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1]

These SPs count the number of jobs (color or black-and-white) sent (not

8123

stored on the document server), as fax images using I-Fax.
Note: Color fax sending is not available at this time.
001 B/W

Black TX



These counters count jobs, not pages.



The counters for color are provided for future use; the color fax feature is not available at
this time.



The fax job is counted when the job is scanned for sending, not when the job is sent.

SM Appendix

3-209

D129/D130

Appendix:
Service
Program
Mode Tables



System SP Tables-8

T:S-to-Email Jobs
8131

[0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1]

These SPs count the total number of jobs scanned and attached to an
e-mail, regardless of whether the document server was used or not.
001 B/W

Black TX

002 Color

Color TX

003 ACS

Color TX

S:S-to-Email Jobs
8135

These SPs count the number of jobs scanned and attached to an e-mail,
without storing the original on the document server.
001 B/W

Black TX

002 Color

Color TX

003 ACS

Color TX



These counters count jobs, not pages.



If the job is stored on the document server, after the job is stored it is determined to be color
or black-and-white then counted.



If the job is cancelled during scanning, or if the job is cancelled while the document is
waiting to be sent, the job is not counted.



If the job is cancelled during sending, it may or may not be counted, depending on what
stage of the process had been reached when the job was cancelled.



If several jobs are combined for sending to the Scan Router, Scan-to-Email, or Scan-to-PC,
or if one job is sent to more than one destination. each send is counted separately. For
example, if the same document is sent by Scan-to-Email as well as Scan-to-PC, then it is
counted twice (once for Scan-to-Email and once for Scan-to-PC).

D129/D130

3-210

SM Appendix

System SP Tables-8

T:Deliv Jobs/Svr
8141

[0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1]

These SPs count the total number of jobs scanned and sent to a Scan

001 B/W

Black Deliv

002 Color

Color Deliv

003 ACS

Color Deliv

S:Deliv Jobs/Svr
8145

These SPs count the number of jobs scanned and sent to a Scan Router
server.
001 B/W

Black Deliv

002 Color

Color Deliv

003 ACS

Color Deliv



These counters count jobs, not pages.



The jobs are counted even though the arrival and reception of the jobs at the Scan Router
server cannot be confirmed.



If even one color image is mixed with black-and-white images, then the job is counted as a
"Color" job.



If the job is cancelled during scanning, or if the job is cancelled while the document is
waiting to be delivered, the job is not counted.



If the job is cancelled during sending, it may or may not be counted, depending on what
stage of the process had been reached when the job was cancelled.



Even if several files are combined for sending, the transmission counts as one job.

SM Appendix

3-211

D129/D130

Appendix:
Service
Program
Mode Tables

Router server.

System SP Tables-8

T:Deliv Jobs/PC

[0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1]

These SPs count the total number of jobs scanned and sent to a folder on a

8151

PC (Scan-to-PC).
Note: At the present time, 8151 and 8155 perform identical counts.
001 B/W

Black Deliv

002 Color

Color Deliv

003 ACS

Color Deliv

S:Deliv Jobs/PC
8155

These SPs count the total number of jobs scanned and sent with
Scan-to-PC.
001 B/W

Black Deliv

002 Color

Color Deliv

003 ACS

Color Deliv



These counters count jobs, not pages.



If the job is cancelled during scanning, it is not counted.



If the job is cancelled while it is waiting to be sent, the job is not counted.



If the job is cancelled during sending, it may or may not be counted, depending on what
stage of the process had been reached when the job was cancelled.



Even if several files are combined for sending, the transmission counts as one job.

8161

T:PCFAX TX Jobs

These SPs count the number of PC Fax
transmission jobs. A job is counted from when it is
registered for sending, not when it is sent.

8163

F:PCFAX TX Jobs

[0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1]
Note: At the present time, these counters perform
identical counts.



This counts fax jobs started from a PC using a PC fax application, and sending the data out
to the destination from the PC through the copier.

D129/D130

3-212

SM Appendix

8171

T:Deliv Jobs/WSD

These SPs count the pages scanned by WSD.

8175

S:Deliv Jobs/WSD

[0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1]

001 B/W

Black Deliv

002 Color

Color Deliv

003 ACS

Color Deliv

8181

T:Scan to Media Jobs

These SPs count the pages scanned to media by
the scanner application.

8185



S:Scan to Media Jobs
001 B/W

Black Deliv

002 Color

Color Deliv

003 ACS

Color Deliv

8191

T:Total Scan PGS

8192

C:Total Scan PGS

8193

F:Total Scan PGS

8195

S:Total Scan PGS

8196

L:Total Scan PGS

[0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1]

These SPs count the pages scanned by each
application that uses the scanner to scan images.
[0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1]

SP 8191 to 8196 count the number of scanned sides of pages, not the number of physical
pages.



These counters do not count reading user stamp data, or reading color charts to adjust
color.



Previews done with a scanner driver are not counted.



A count is done only after all images of a job have been scanned.



Scans made in SP mode are not counted.

Examples


If 3 B5 pages and 1 A3 page are scanned with the scanner application but not stored, the S:
count is 4.



If both sides of 3 A4 sheets are copied and stored to the document server using the Store

SM Appendix

3-213

D129/D130

Appendix:
Service
Program
Mode Tables

System SP Tables-8

System SP Tables-8

File button in the Copy mode window, the C: count is 6 and the L: count is 6.


If both sides of 3 A4 sheets are copied but not stored, the C: count is 6.



If you enter document server mode then scan 6 pages, the L: count is 6.

8201

T:LSize Scan PGS

[0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1]

8203

F Lsize Scan PGS

[0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1]

S:LSize Scan PGS

[0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1]

These SP codes count the total number of large pages input with the
8205

scanner for scan jobs only. Large size paper (A3/DLT) scanned for fax
transmission are not counted.
Note: These counters are displayed in the SMC Report, and in the User
Tools display..

8211

T:Scan PGS/LS

8212

C:Scan PGS/LS

8213

F:Scan PGS/LS

8215

S:Scan PGS/LS

8216

L:Scan PGS/LS

These SPs count the number of pages scanned into
the document server .
[0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1]
The L: counter counts the number of pages stored
from within the document server mode screen at the
operation panel, and with the Store File button from
within the Copy mode screen



Reading user stamp data is not counted.



If a job is cancelled, the pages output as far as the cancellation are counted.



If the scanner application scans and stores 3 B5 sheets and 1 A4 sheet, the S: count is 4.



If pages are copied but not stored on the document server, these counters do not change.



If both sides of 3 A4 sheets are copied and stored to the document server, the C: count is 6
and the L: count is 6.



If you enter document server mode then scan 6 pages, the L: count is 6.

D129/D130

3-214

SM Appendix

System SP Tables-8

ADF Org Feeds
8221

[0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1]

These SPs count the number of pages fed through the ADF for front and
back side scanning.
Number of front sides fed for scanning:
With an ADF that can scan both sides simultaneously, the Front
side count is the same as the number of pages fed for either
simplex or duplex scanning.
With an ADF that cannot scan both sides simultaneously, the
Front side count is the same as the number of pages fed for
duplex front side scanning. (The front side is determined by which
side the user loads face up.)
Number of rear sides fed for scanning:
With an ADF that can scan both sides simultaneously, the Back
count is the same as the number of pages fed for duplex
002 Back

scanning.
With an ADF that cannot scan both sides simultaneously, the
Back count is the same as the number of pages fed for duplex
rear-side scanning.



When 1 sheet is fed for duplex scanning the Front count is 1 and the Back count is 1.



If a jam occurs during the job, recovery processing is not counted to avoid double counting.
Also, the pages are not counted if the jam occurs before the first sheet is output.

SM Appendix

3-215

D129/D130

Appendix:
Service
Program
Mode Tables

001 Front

System SP Tables-8

Scan PGS/Mode
8231

[0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1]

These SPs count the number of pages scanned by each ADF mode to
determine the work load on the ADF.

001 Large Volume

002 SADF

003 Mixed Size

004 Custom Size

005 Platen

006 Mixed 1side/2side



Selectable. Large copy jobs that cannot be loaded in
the ADF at one time.
Selectable. Feeding pages one by one through the
ADF.
Selectable. Select "Mixed Sizes" on the operation
panel.
Selectable. Originals of non-standard size.
Book mode. Raising the ADF and placing the original
directly on the platen.
Selectable. Select "Simplex/Duplex" on the operation
panel.

If the scan mode is changed during the job, for example, if the user switches from ADF to
Platen mode, the count is done for the last selected mode.



The user cannot select mixed sizes or non-standard sizes with the fax application so if the
original's page sizes are mixed or non-standard, these are not counted.



If the user selects "Mixed Sizes" for copying in the platen mode, the Mixed Size count is
enabled.



In the SADF mode if the user copies 1 page in platen mode and then copies 2 pages with
SADF, the Platen count is 1 and the SADF count is 3.

D129/D130

3-216

SM Appendix

System SP Tables-8

T:Scan PGS/Org
8241

[0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1]

These SPs count the total number of scanned pages by original type for all
jobs, regardless of which application was used.
C:Scan PGS/Org

8242

[0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1]

These SPs count the number of pages scanned by original type for Copy
jobs.

8243

[0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1]
Appendix:
Service
Program
Mode Tables

F:Scan PGS/Org

These SPs count the number of pages scanned by original type for Fax
jobs.
S:Scan PGS/Org

8245

[0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1]

These SPs count the number of pages scanned by original type for Scan
jobs.
L:Scan PGS/Org

8246

[0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1]

These SPs count the number of pages scanned and stored from within the
document server mode screen at the operation panel, and with the Store
File button from within the Copy mode screen
8241

8242

8243

8245

8246

824x 1: Text

Yes

Yes

Yes

Yes

Yes

824x 2: Text/Photo

Yes

Yes

Yes

Yes

Yes

824x 3: Photo

Yes

Yes

Yes

Yes

Yes

824x 4: GenCopy, Pale

Yes

Yes

No

Yes

Yes

824x 5: Map

Yes

Yes

No

No

Yes

824x 6: Normal/Detail

Yes

No

Yes

No

No

824x 7: Fine/Super Fine

Yes

No

Yes

No

No

824x 8: Binary

Yes

No

No

Yes

No

824x 9: Grayscale

Yes

No

No

Yes

No

SM Appendix

3-217

D129/D130

System SP Tables-8



824x 10: Color

Yes

No

No

Yes

No

824x 11: Other

Yes

Yes

Yes

Yes

Yes

If the scan mode is changed during the job, for example, if the user switches from ADF to
Platen mode, the count is done for the last selected mode.

8251

T:Scan PGS/ImgEdt

8252

C:Scan PGS/ImgEdt

8255

S:Scan PGS/ImgEdt

8256

L:Scan PGS/ImgEdt

These SPs show how many times Image Edit
features have been selected at the operation panel
for each application. Some examples of these
editing features are:
Erase> Border
Erase> Center
Image Repeat
Centering
Positive/Negative

8257

O:Scan PGS/ImgEdt

[0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1]
Note: The count totals the number of times the edit
features have been used. A detailed breakdown of
exactly which features have been used is not given.

The L: counter counts the number of pages stored from within the document server mode
screen at the operation panel, and with the Store File button from within the Copy mode screen.

D129/D130

3-218

SM Appendix

System SP Tables-8

8281

T:Scan PGS/TWAIN

These SPs count the number of pages scanned
using a TWAIN driver. These counters reveal how
the TWAIN driver is used for delivery functions.

8285

S:Scan PGS/TWAIN

[0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1]
Note: At the present time, these counters perform
identical counts.

T:Scan PGS/Stamp

8293

F:Scan PGS/Stamp

These SPs count the number of pages stamped
with the stamp in the ADF unit.
[0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1]
The L: counter counts the number of pages stored

8295

S:Scan PGS/Stamp

from within the document server mode screen at the
operation panel, and with the Store File button from
within the Copy mode screen

T:Scan PGS/Size
8301

[0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1]

These SPs count by size the total number of pages scanned by all
applications. Use these totals to compare original page size (scanning) and
output (printing) page size [SP 8-441].
C:Scan PGS/Size

8302

[0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1]

These SPs count by size the total number of pages scanned by the Copy
application. Use these totals to compare original page size (scanning) and
output (printing) page size [SP 8-442].
F:Scan PGS/Size

8303

[0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1]

These SPs count by size the total number of pages scanned by the Fax
application. Use these totals to compare original page size (scanning) and
output page size [SP 8-443].
S:Scan PGS/Size

8305

[0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1]

These SPs count by size the total number of pages scanned by the Scan
application. Use these totals to compare original page size (scanning) and
output page size [SP 8-445].

SM Appendix

3-219

D129/D130

Appendix:
Service
Program
Mode Tables

8291

System SP Tables-8

L:Scan PGS/Size

[0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1]

These SPs count by size the total number of pages scanned and stored
8306

from within the document server mode screen at the operation panel, and
with the Store File button from within the Copy mode screen. Use these
totals to compare original page size (scanning) and output page size [SP
8-446].

830x 1

A3

830x 2

A4

830x 3

A5

830x 4

B4

830x 5

B5

830x 6

DLT

830x 7

LG

830x 8

LT

830x 9

HLT

830x 10

Full Bleed

830x 254

Other (Standard)

830x 255

Other (Custom)

D129/D130

3-220

SM Appendix

System SP Tables-8

T:Scan PGS/Rez
8311

[0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1]

These SPs count by resolution setting the total number of pages scanned by
applications that can specify resolution settings.
S:Scan PGS/Rez

8315

[0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1]

These SPs count by resolution setting the total number of pages scanned by
applications that can specify resolution settings.

831x 1

1200dpi to

831x 2

600dpito1199dpi

831x 3

400dpito599dpi

831x 4

200dpito399dpi

831x 5

to199dpi

Appendix:
Service
Program
Mode Tables

Note: At the present time, 8311 and 8315 perform identical counts.



Copy resolution settings are fixed so they are not counted.



The Fax application does not allow finely-adjusted resolution settings so no count is done
for the Fax application.

8381

T:Total PrtPGS
These SPs count the number of pages printed by

8382

C:Total PrtPGS

8383

F:Total PrtPGS

8384

P:Total PrtPGS

8385

S:Total PrtPGS

8386

L:Total PrtPGS

8387

O:Total PrtPGS

the customer. The counter for the application used
for storing the pages increments.
[0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1]
The L: counter counts the number of pages stored
from within the document server mode screen at
the operation panel. Pages stored with the Store
File button from within the Copy mode screen go to
the C: counter.



When the A3/DLT double count function is switched on with SP5104, 1 A3/DLT page is
counted as 2.



When several documents are merged for a print job, the number of pages stored are
counted for the application that stored them.

SM Appendix

3-221

D129/D130

System SP Tables-8



These counters are used primarily to calculate charges on use of the machine, so the
following pages are not counted as printed pages:
Blank pages in a duplex printing job.
Blank pages inserted as document covers, chapter title sheets, and slip sheets.
Reports printed to confirm counts.
All reports done in the service mode (service summaries, engine maintenance reports, etc.)
Test prints for machine image adjustment.
Error notification reports.
Partially printed pages as the result of a copier jam.

LSize PrtPGS
8391

[0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1]

These SPs count pages printed on paper sizes A3/DLT and larger.
Note: In addition to being displayed in the SMC Report, these counters are
also displayed in the User Tools display on the copy machine.

8401

T:PrtPGS/LS

8402

C:PrtPGS/LS

8403

F:PrtPGS/LS

8404

P:PrtPGS/LS

within the document server mode screen at the

8405

S:PrtPGS/LS

operation panel.

These SPs count the number of pages printed from the
document server. The counter for the application used
to print the pages is incremented.
The L: counter counts the number of jobs stored from

[0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1]
8406

L:PrtPGS/LS



Print jobs done with Web Image Monitor and Desk Top Binder are added to the L: count.



Fax jobs done with Web Image Monitor and Desk Top Binder are added to the F: count.

D129/D130

3-222

SM Appendix

System SP Tables-8

This SP counts the amount of paper (front/back
8411

Prints/Duplex

counted as 1 page) used for duplex printing. Last pages
printed only on one side are not counted.
[0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1]

T:PrtPGS/Dup Comb
8421

[0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1]

These SPs count by binding and combine, and n-Up settings the number of

C:PrtPGS/Dup Comb
8422

[0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1]

These SPs count by binding and combine, and n-Up settings the number of
pages processed for printing by the copier application.
F:PrtPGS/Dup Comb

8423

[0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1]

These SPs count by binding and combine, and n-Up settings the number of
pages processed for printing by the fax application.
P:PrtPGS/Dup Comb

8424

[0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1]

These SPs count by binding and combine, and n-Up settings the number of
pages processed for printing by the printer application.
S:PrtPGS/Dup Comb

8425

[0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1]

These SPs count by binding and combine, and n-Up settings the number of
pages processed for printing by the scanner application.
L:PrtPGS/Dup Comb

8426

[0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1]

These SPs count by binding and combine, and n-Up settings the number of
pages processed for printing from within the document server mode window
at the operation panel.
O:PrtPGS/Dup Comb

8427

[0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1]

These SPs count by binding and combine, and n-Up settings the number of
pages processed for printing by Other applications

SM Appendix

3-223

D129/D130

Appendix:
Service
Program
Mode Tables

pages processed for printing. This is the total for all applications.

System SP Tables-8

842x 1

Simplex> Duplex

842x 2

Duplex> Duplex

842x 3

Book> Duplex

842x 4

Simplex Combine

842x 5

Duplex Combine

842x 6

2in1

2 pages on 1 side (2-Up)

842x 7

4in1

4 pages on 1 side (4-Up)

842x 8

6in1

6 pages on 1 side (6-Up)

842x 9

8in1

8pages on 1 side (8-Up)

842x 10

9in1

9 pages on 1 side (9-Up)

842x 11

16in1

16 pages on 1 side (16-Up)

842x 12

Booklet

842x 13

Magazine

842x 14

2in1 + Booklet

842x 15

4in1 + Booklet

842x 16

6in1 + Booklet

842x 17

8in1 + Booklet

842x 18

9in1 + Booklet

842x 19

2in1 + Magazine

842x 20

4in1 + Magazine

842x 21

6in1 + Magazine

842x 22

8in1 + Magazine

842x 23

9in1 + Magazine

842x 24

16in1 + Magazine

D129/D130

3-224

SM Appendix

System SP Tables-8



These counts (SP8421 to SP8427) are especially useful for customers who need to
improve their compliance with ISO standards for the reduction of paper consumption.



Pages that are only partially printed with the n-Up functions are counted as 1 page.



Here is a summary of how the counters work for Booklet and Magazine modes:

Magazine

Original Pages

Count

Original Pages

Count

1

1

1

1

2

2

2

2

3

2

3

2

4

2

4

2

5

3

5

4

6

4

6

4

7

4

7

4

8

4

8

4

T:PrtPGS/ImgEdt
8431

Appendix:
Service
Program
Mode Tables

Booklet

[0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1]

These SPs count the total number of pages output with the three features
below, regardless of which application was used.
C:PrtPGS/ImgEdt

8432

[0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1]

These SPs count the total number of pages output with the three features
below with the copy application.
P:PrtPGS/ImgEdt

8434

[0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1]

These SPs count the total number of pages output with the three features
below with the print application.
L:PrtPGS/ImgEdt

8436

[0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1]

These SPs count the total number of pages output from within the document
server mode window at the operation panel with the three features below.

SM Appendix

3-225

D129/D130

System SP Tables-8

O:PrtPGS/ImgEdt
8437

[0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1]

These SPs count the total number of pages output with the three features
below with Other applications.

843x 1

Cover/Slip Sheet

843x 2

Series/Book

Total number of covers or slip sheets inserted. The
count for a cover printed on both sides counts 2.
The number of pages printed in series (one side) or
printed as a book with booklet right/left pagination.
The number of pages printed where stamps were

843x 3

User Stamp

applied, including page numbering and date
stamping.

T:PrtPGS/Ppr Size
8441

[0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1]

These SPs count by print paper size the number of pages printed by all
applications.
C:PrtPGS/Ppr Size

8442

[0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1]

These SPs count by print paper size the number of pages printed by the
copy application.
F:PrtPGS/Ppr Size

8443

[0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1]

These SPs count by print paper size the number of pages printed by the fax
application.
P:PrtPGS/Ppr Size

8444

[0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1]

These SPs count by print paper size the number of pages printed by the
printer application.
S:PrtPGS/Ppr Size

8445

[0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1]

These SPs count by print paper size the number of pages printed by the
scanner application.
L:PrtPGS/Ppr Size

8446

[0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1]

These SPs count by print paper size the number of pages printed from
within the document server mode window at the operation panel.

D129/D130

3-226

SM Appendix

System SP Tables-8

O:PrtPGS/Ppr Size
8447

[0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1]

These SPs count by print paper size the number of pages printed by Other



844x 1

A3

844x 2

A4

844x 3

A5

844x 4

B4

844x 5

B5

844x 6

DLT

844x 7

LG

844x 8

LT

844x 9

HLT

844x 10

Full Bleed

844x 254

Other (Standard)

844x 255

Other (Custom)

Appendix:
Service
Program
Mode Tables

applications.

These counters do not distinguish between LEF and SEF.

SM Appendix

3-227

D129/D130

System SP Tables-8

PrtPGS/Ppr Tray

[0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1]

8451
These SPs count the number of sheets fed from each paper feed station.
001 Bypass Tray

Bypass Tray

002 Tray 1

Copier

003 Tray 2

Copier

004 Tray 3

Paper Tray Unit (Option)

005 Tray 4

Paper Tray Unit (Option)

006 Tray 5

LCT (Option)

007 Tray 6

Currently not used.

008 Tray 7

Currently not used.

009 Tray 8

Currently not used.

010 Tray 9

Currently not used.

011 Tray 10

Currently not used.

012 Tray 11

Currently not used.

013 Tray 12

Currently not used.

014 Tray 13

Currently not used.

015 Tray 14

Currently not used.

016 Tray 15

Currently not used.

D129/D130

3-228

SM Appendix

System SP Tables-8

T:PrtPGS/Ppr Type

[0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1]

These SPs count by paper type the number pages printed by all
applications.
These counters are not the same as the PM counter. The PM counter is
8461

based on feed timing to accurately measure the service life of the feed
rollers. However, these counts are based on output timing.
Blank sheets (covers, chapter covers, slip sheets) are also counted.
During duplex printing, pages printed on both sides count as 1, and a page

C:PrtPGS/Ppr Type
8462

Appendix:
Service
Program
Mode Tables

printed on one side counts as 1.
[0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1]

These SPs count by paper type the number pages printed by the copy
application.
F:PrtPGS/Ppr Type

8463

[0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1]

These SPs count by paper type the number pages printed by the fax
application.
P:PrtPGS/Ppr Type

8464

[0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1]

These SPs count by paper type the number pages printed by the printer
application.
L:PrtPGS/Ppr Type

8466

[0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1]

These SPs count by paper type the number pages printed from within the
document server mode window at the operation panel.

846x 1

Normal

846x 2

Recycled

846x 3

Special

846x 4

Thick

846x 5

Normal (Back)

846x 6

Thick (Back)

846x 7

OHP

SM Appendix

3-229

D129/D130

System SP Tables-8

846x 8

Other

PrtPGS/Mag

[0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1]

8471
These SPs count by magnification rate the number of pages printed.
001 to 49%
002 50% to 99%
003 100%
004 101% to 200%
005 201% to



Counts are done for magnification adjusted for pages, not only on the operation panel but
performed remotely with an external network application capable of performing
magnification adjustment as well.



Magnification adjustments done with printer drivers with PC applications such as Excel are
also counted.



Magnification adjustments done for adjustments after they have been stored on the
document server are not counted.



Magnification adjustments performed automatically during Auto Reduce/Enlarge copying
are counted.



The magnification rates of blank cover sheets, slip sheets, etc. are automatically assigned
a rate of 100%.

8481

T:PrtPGS/TonSave

8484

P:PrtPGS/TonSave
These SPs count the number of pages printed with the Toner Save feature
switched on.
Note: These SPs return the same results as this SP is limited to the Print
application.
[0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1]

D129/D130

3-230

SM Appendix

System SP Tables-8

T:PrtPGS/Emul
8511

[0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1]

These SPs count by printer emulation mode the total number of pages
printed.
P:PrtPGS/Emul

8514

[0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1]

These SPs count by printer emulation mode the total number of pages
printed.

002 RPDL

Appendix:
Service
Program
Mode Tables

001 RPCS
Japan Only

003 PS3
004 R98
005 R16
006 GL/GL2

Japan Only

007 R55
008 RTIFF
009 PDF
010 PCL5e/5c
011 PCL XL
012 IPDL-C
013 BM-Links

Japan Only

014 Other
015 IPDS



SP8511 and SP8514 return the same results as they are both limited to the Print
application.



Print jobs output to the document server are not counted.

SM Appendix

3-231

D129/D130

System SP Tables-8

T:PrtPGS/FIN
8521

[0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1]

These SPs count by finishing mode the total number of pages printed by all
applications.
C:PrtPGS/FIN

8522

[0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1]

These SPs count by finishing mode the total number of pages printed by the
Copy application.
F:PrtPGS/FIN

[0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1]

These SPs count by finishing mode the total number of pages printed by the
8523

Fax application.
Note:
Print finishing options for received faxes are currently not available.
P:PrtPGS/FIN

8524

[0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1]

These SPs count by finishing mode the total number of pages printed by the
Print application.
S:PrtPGS/FIN

8525

[0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1]

These SPs count by finishing mode the total number of pages printed by the
Scanner application.
L:PrtPGS/FIN

8526

[0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1]

These SPs count by finishing mode the total number of pages printed from
within the document server mode window at the operation panel.

852x 1

Sort

852x 2

Stack

852x 3

Staple

852x 4

Booklet

852x 5

Z-Fold

852x 6

Punch

852x 7

Other

D129/D130

3-232

SM Appendix

852x 8

Inside-Fold

852x 9

Three-IN-Fold

852x 10

Three-OUT-Fold

852x 11

Four-Fold

852x 12

KANNON-Fold

852x 13

Perfect-Bind

852x 14

Ring-Bind



If stapling is selected for finishing and the stack is too large for stapling, the unstapled
pages are still counted.



The counts for staple finishing are based on output to the staple tray, so jam recoveries
are counted.

This SP counts the amount of staples used by the
8531

Staples

machine.
[0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1]

8551

T:PrtBooks/FIN

8552

C:PrtBooks/FIN

8554

P:PrtBooks/FIN

8556

L:PrtBooks/FIN
001 Perfect-Bind

Not Used

002 Ring-Bind

Not Used

SM Appendix

3-233

D129/D130

Appendix:
Service
Program
Mode Tables

System SP Tables-8

System SP Tables-8

8561

T:A Sheet Of Paper

[0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1]

8562

C:A Sheet Of Paper

[0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1]

8563

F:A Sheet Of Paper

[0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1]

8564

P:A Sheet Of Paper

[0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1]

8566

L:A Sheet Of Paper

[0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1]

O:A Sheet Of Paper

[0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1]

8567
These SPs count the totals number of duplex pages printed.
001 Total: Over A3/DLT
002 Total: Under A3/DLT
003 Duplex: Over A3/DLT
004 Duplex: Under A3/DLT

T: Counter

[0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1]

These SPs count the total output broken down by color output, regardless of
the application used. In addition to being displayed in the SMC Report,
8581

these counters are also displayed in the User Tools display on the copy
machine.
Note: This SP is expanded for color MFP and color LP machines. For this
machine, the count is done for black only.

O: Counter

[0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1]

These SPs count the totals for A3/DLT paper use, number of duplex pages

8591

printed, and the number of staples used. These totals are for Other (O:)
applications only.
001 A3/DLT
002 Duplex

D129/D130

3-234

SM Appendix

System SP Tables-8

T:Coverage Counter
8601
These SPs count the total coverage for each color and printout pages.
001 B/W

[0 to 2147483647 / 0 / 1]

011 B/W Printing Pages

[0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1]

C:Coverage Counter

[0 to 2147483647 / 0 / 1]

8602

F:Coverage Counter

Appendix:
Service
Program
Mode Tables

These SPs count the total coverage for B/W.
[0 to 2147483647 / 0 / 1]

8603
These SPs count the total coverage for B/W.
P:Coverage Counter

[0 to 2147483647 / 0 / 1]

8604
These SPs count the total coverage for B/W.
L:Coverage Counter

[0 to 2147483647 / 0 / 1]

8606
These SPs count the total coverage for B/W.

SDK Apli Counter

[0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1]

8617
These SPs count the total printout pages for each SDK applicaion.
001 SDK-1
002 SDK-2
003 SDK-3
004 SDK-4
005 SDK-5
006 SDK-6

SM Appendix

3-235

D129/D130

System SP Tables-8

8621

Func Use Counter

-

001 to 064 Function-001 to Function-064

T:FAX TX PGS
8631

[0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1]

These SPs count by color mode the number of pages sent by fax to a
telephone number.
001 B/W

Black TX

F:FAX TX PGS
8633

[0 to 999999 / 0 / 1]

These SPs count by color mode the number of pages sent by fax to a
telephone number.
001 B/W



Black TX

If a document has color and black-and-white pages mixed, the pages are counted
separately as B/W or Color.



At the present time, this feature is provided for the Fax application only so SP8631 and
SP8633 are the same.



The counts include error pages.



If a document is sent to more than one destination with a Group transmission, the count is
done for each destination.



Polling transmissions are counted but polling RX are not.



Relay, memory, and confidential mailbox transmissions and are counted for each
destination.

D129/D130

3-236

SM Appendix

System SP Tables-8

T:FAX TX PGS
8641

[0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1]

These SPs count by color mode the number of pages sent by fax to as fax
images using I-Fax.
001 B/W

Black TX

F:FAX TX PGS
8643

[0 o 9999999 / 0 / 1]

These SPs count by color mode the number of pages sent by Fax as fax

001 B/W



Appendix:
Service
Program
Mode Tables

images using I-Fax.
Black TX

If a document has color and black-and-white pages mixed, the pages are counted
separately as B/W or Color.



At the present time, this feature is provided for the Fax application only so SP8641 and
SP8643 are the same.



The counts include error pages.



If a document is sent to more than one destination with a Group transmission, the count is
done for each destination.



Polling transmissions are counted but polling RX are not.



Relay, memory, and confidential mailbox transmissions and are counted for each
destination.

SM Appendix

3-237

D129/D130

System SP Tables-8

T:S-to-Email PGS
8651

[0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1]

These SPs count by color mode the total number of pages attached to an
e-mail for both the Scan and document server applications.
001 B/W
002 Color
S:S-to-Email PGS

8655

[0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1]

These SPs count by color mode the total number of pages attached to an
e-mail for the Scan application only.
001 B/W
002 Color



The count for B/W and Color pages is done after the document is stored on the HDD. If
the job is cancelled before it is stored, the pages are not counted.



If Scan-to-Email is used to send a 10-page document to 5 addresses, the count is 10
(the pages are sent to the same SMTP server together).



If Scan-to-PC is used to send a 10-page document to 5 folders, the count is 50 (the
document is sent to each destination of the SMB/FTP server).



Due to restrictions on some devices, if Scan-to-Email is used to send a 10-page
document to a large number of destinations, the count may be divided and counted
separately. For example, if a 10-page document is sent to 200 addresses, the count is
10 for the first 100 destinations and the count is also 10 for the second 100
destinations, for a total of 20).

D129/D130

3-238

SM Appendix

System SP Tables-8

T:Deliv PGS/Svr
8661

[0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1]

These SPs count by color mode the total number of pages sent to a Scan
Router server by both Scan and LS applications.
001 B/W
002 Color

8665

[0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1]

These SPs count by color mode the total number of pages sent to a Scan
Router server by the Scan application.
001 B/W
002 Color



The B/W and Color counts are done after the document is stored on the HDD of the
Scan Router server.



If the job is canceled before storage on the Scan Router server finishes, the counts are
not done.



The count is executed even if regardless of confirmation of the arrival at the Scan
Router server.

SM Appendix

3-239

D129/D130

Appendix:
Service
Program
Mode Tables

S:Deliv PGS/Svr

System SP Tables-8

T: Deliv PGS/PC
8671

[0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1]

These SPs count by color mode the total number of pages sent to a folder
on a PC (Scan-to-PC) with the Scan and LS applications.
001 B/W
002 Color
S: Deliv PGS/PC

8675

[0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1]

These SPs count by color mode the total number of pages sent with
Scan-to-PC with the Scan application.
001 B/W
002 Color

8681

T:PCFAX TXPGS

These SPs count the number of pages sent by PC
Fax. These SPs are provided for the Fax application
only, so the counts for SP8681 and SP8683 are the

8683

F:PCFAX TXPGS

same.
[0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1]



This counts pages sent from a PC using a PC fax application, from the PC through the
copier to the destination.



When sending the same message to more than one place using broadcasting, the pages
are only counted once. (For example, a 10-page fax is sent to location A and location B.
The counter goes up by 10, not 20.)

D129/D130

3-240

SM Appendix

System SP Tables-8

8691

T:TX PGS/LS

8692

C:TX PGS/LS

8693

F:TX PGS/LS

[0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1]

8694

P:TX PGS/LS

The L: counter counts the number of pages stored from

These SPs count the number of pages sent from the
document server. The counter for the application that
was used to store the pages is incremented.

within the document server mode screen at the
S:TX PGS/LS

8696

L:TX PGS/LS

operation panel. Pages stored with the Store File button
from within the Copy mode screen go to the C: counter.



Print jobs done with Web Image Monitor and Desk Top Binder are added to the count.



If several documents are merged for sending, the number of pages stored are counted
for the application that stored them.



When several documents are sent by a Fax broadcast, the F: count is done for the
number of pages sent to each destination.

TX PGS/Port

[0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1]

These SPs count the number of pages sent by the physical port used to

8701

send them. For example, if a 3-page original is sent to 4 destinations via
ISDN G4, the count for ISDN (G3, G4) is 12.
001 PSTN-1
002 PSTN-2
003 PSTN-3
004 ISDN (G3,G4)
005 Network

SM Appendix

3-241

D129/D130

Appendix:
Service
Program
Mode Tables

8695

System SP Tables-8

T:Scan PGS/Comp
8711

[0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1]

These SPs count the number of compressed pages scanned into the
document server, counted by the formats listed below.
001 JPEG/JPEG2000
002 TIFF (Multi/Single)
003 PDF
004 Other
005 PDF/Comp
006 PDF/A

S:Scan PGS/Comp
8715

[0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1]

These SPs count the number of compressed pages scanned by the scan
application, counted by the formats listed below.
001 JPEG/JPEG2000
002 TIFF (Multi/Single)
003 PDF
004 Other
005 PDF/Comp
006 PDF/A

D129/D130

3-242

SM Appendix

System SP Tables-8

8721

T:Deliv PGS/WSD

[0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1]

S:Deliv PGS/WSD

[0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1]

8725
These SPs count the number of pages scanned by each scanner mode.
001 B/W

8731

8735

T:Scan PGS/Media

[0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1]

S:Scan PGS/Media

[0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1]

Appendix:
Service
Program
Mode Tables

002 Color

These SPs count the number of pages scanned and saved in a meia by
each scanner mode.
001 B/W
002 Color

RX PGS/Port
8741

[0to9999999/ 0 / 1]

These SPs count the number of pages received by the physical port used to
receive them.
001 PSTN-1
002 PSTN-2
003 PSTN-3
004 ISDN (G3,G4)
005 Network

SM Appendix

3-243

D129/D130

System SP Tables-8

Dev Counter

[0to9999999/ 0 / 1]

These SPs count the frequency of use (number of rotations of the
8771

development rollers) for black and other color toners.
Note: For machines that do not support color, the Black toner count is the
same as the Total count.

Toner_Botol_Info.
8781

This SP displays the number of toner bottles used. The count is done based
on the equivalent of 1,000 pages per bottle.

This SP displays the percent of space
8791

LS Memory Remain

available on the document server for storing
documents.
[0 to 100 / 0 / 1]

Toner Remain

[0 to 100 / 0 / 1]

This SP displays the percent of toner remaining for each color. This SP
allows the user to check the toner supply at any time.
Note:
8801

This precise method of measuring remaining toner supply (1% steps) is
better than other machines in the market that can only measure in
increments of 10 (10% steps).
This SP is expanded for color MFP and color LP machines. For this
machine, the count is done for black only.

D129/D130

3-244

SM Appendix

System SP Tables-8

8811

Eco Counter
Eco Total

[0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1]

001 Displays the number of pages reduced by using the duplex and the combine
function.
Duplex

[0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1]

004
Displays the number of pages reduced by using the duplex function.
[0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1]

Appendix:
Service
Program
Mode Tables

Combine
005

Displays the number of pages reduced by using the combine function.
Duplex(%)

[0 to 100 / 0 / 1]

008
Displays the utilization ratio of the duplex function.
Combine(%)

[0 to 100 / 0 / 1]

009
Displays the utilization ratio of the duplex function.
Paper Cut(%)

[0 to 100 / 0 / 1]

010
Displays the paper reduction ratio.
Eco Totalr:Last

[0 to 99999999 / 0 / 1]

Duplex:Last

[0 to 99999999 / 0 / 1]

Combine:Last

[0 to 99999999 / 0 / 1]

Duplex(%):Last

[0 to 100 / 0 / 1]

101

104

105

108

SM Appendix

3-245

D129/D130

System SP Tables-8

Combine(%):Last

[0 to 100 / 0 / 1]

Paper Cut(%):Last

[0 to 100 / 0 / 1]

109

110

Cvr Cnt:0-10%
8851

[0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1]

These SPs count the percentage of dot coverage for black other color
toners.
011 0 to 2%: BK
021 3 to 4%: BK
031 5 to 7%: BK
041 8 to 10%: BK

Cvr Cnt:11-20%
8861

[0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1]

These SPs count the percentage of dot coverage for black other color
toners.
001 BK

Black toner

Cvr Cnt:21-30%
8871

[0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1]

These SPs count the percentage of dot coverage for black other color
toners.
001 BK

D129/D130

Black toner

3-246

SM Appendix

System SP Tables-8

Cvr Cnt:31%8881

[0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1]

These SPs count the percentage of dot coverage for black other color
toners.
001 BK

Black toner

Page/Toner Bottle

[0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1]

8891

001 BK

Appendix:
Service
Program
Mode Tables

These SPs display the amount of the remaining current toner.
Black toner

Page/Toner_Prev1

[0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1]

8901
These SPs display the amount of the remaining previous toner.
001 BK

Black toner

Page/Toner_Prev2

[0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1]

8911
These SPs display the amount of the remaining 2nd previous toner.
001 BK

Black toner

Cvr Cnt/Total

[0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1]

8921
Displays the total coverage and total printout number for each color.
001 Coverage (%) BK
011 Coverage/P:BK

SM Appendix

3-247

D129/D130

System SP Tables-8

Machine Status

[0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1]

These SPs count the amount of time the machine spends in each operation

8941

mode. These SPs are useful for customers who need to investigate
machine operation for improvement in their compliance with ISO Standards.
Engine operation time. Does not include time while
001 Operation Time

controller is saving data to HDD (while engine is not
operating).
Engine not operating. Includes time while controller

002 Standby Time

saves data to HDD. Does not include time spent in
Energy Save, Low Power, or Off modes.

003 Energy Save Time

Includes time while the machine is performing
background printing.
Includes time in Energy Save mode with Engine on.

004 Low Power Time

Includes time while machine is performing
background printing.
Includes time while machine is performing

005 Off Mode Time

background printing. Does not include time
machine remains powered off with the power
switches.

006 SC

Total down time due to SC errors.

007 PrtJam

Total down time due to paper jams during printing.

008 OrgJam

009 Supply PM Unit End

D129/D130

Total down time due to original jams during
scanning.
Total down time due to supply unit end.

3-248

SM Appendix

System SP Tables-8

AddBook Register
8951

These SPs count the number of events when the machine manages data
registration.
User Code /User
ID

User code registrations.

002 Mail Address

Mail address registrations.

003 Fax Destination

Fax destination registrations.

004 Group

005 Transfer Request

006 F-Code

Group destination

[0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1]

registrations.
Fax relay destination
registrations for relay TX.
F-Code box registrations.
Copy application

007 Copy Program

registrations with the
Program (job settings)
feature.
Fax application registrations

008 Fax Program

with the Program (job
settings) feature.
Printer application

009 Printer Program

[0 to 255 / 0 / 255]

registrations with the
Program (job settings)
feature.
Scanner application

010 Scanner Program

registrations with the
Program (job settings)
feature.

SM Appendix

3-249

D129/D130

Appendix:
Service
Program
Mode Tables

001

System SP Tables-8

Adomin. Counter List

[0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1]

8999
Display the total coverage and total printout number for each color.
001 Total
003 Copy: BW
007 Printer: BW
010 Fax Print: BW
012 A3/DLT
013 Duplex
023 Copy: BW (%)
027 Printer: BW (%)
030 Fax Print: BW (%)
101 Transmission Total: Color
102 Transmission Total: BW
103 Fax Transmission
104 Scanner Transmission: Color
105 Scanner Transmission: BW

D129/D130

3-250

SM Appendix

Input Check

3.9 INPUT CHECK
3.9.1 COPIER
When entering the Input Check mode, 8 digits display the result for a section. Each digit
corresponds to a different device as shown in the table.

7

6

5

4

3

2

1

0

Result

0 or 1

0 or 1

0 or 1

0 or 1

0 or 1

0 or 1

0 or 1

0 or 1
Appendix:
Service
Program
Mode Tables

Bit No.

Input Check
5803

Reading
Description
0
001 Tray 1: Paper Size Sensor

1

See the table 1 following this table.

002 Tray 1: Tray Set Sensor

Set

Not set

003 Tray 1: Paper Lift Sensor

Not upper limit

Upper limit

004 Tray 1: Paper End Sensor

No paper

Paper remaining

005

Tray 1:
Paper Height Sensor 1
See the table 2 following this table.

006

Tray 1:
Paper Height Sensor 2

007 Tray 2: Paper Size Sensor

See the table 1 following this table.

008 Tray 2: Tray Set Sensor

Set

Not set

009 Tray 2: Paper Lift Sensor

Not upper limit

Upper limit

010 Tray 2: Paper End Sensor

No paper

Paper remaining

011

Tray 2:
Paper Height Sensor 1

SM Appendix

See the table 2 following this table.

3-251

D129/D130

Input Check

012

Tray 2:
Paper Height Sensor 2

013 Tray 1: Paper Feed Sensor

Paper detected

No paper detected

014 Tray 2: Paper Feed Sensor

Paper detected

No paper detected

015 Tray 3: Paper Feed Sensor

Paper detected

No paper detected

016 Tray 4: Paper Feed Sensor

Paper detected

No paper detected

No paper detected

Paper detected

018 Relay Sensor 1

Paper detected

No paper detected

019 Relay Sensor 2

Paper detected

No paper detected

020 Relay Sensor 3

No paper detected

Paper detected

021 Relay Sensor 4

No paper detected

Paper detected

022 Relay Sensor: LCT

No paper detected

Paper detected

Not end

Paper end

017 LCT: Paper Feed Sensor

023 By-pass: Paper End Sensor
024 By-pass: Paper Size Sensor

See the table 3 following this table.

025 Registration Sensor

Paper detected

No paper detected

026 Fusing Exit Sensor

No paper detected

Paper detected

027 Fusing Entrance Sensor

Paper detected

No paper detected

028 Junction Gate Relay Sensor

Paper detected

No paper detected

029 Exit Sensor

Paper detected

No paper detected

030 Paper Overflow Sensor

Not full

Full

031 Right Cover Open/Close

Close

Open

032 Duplex Unit Open/Close

Open

Close

033 Duplex Entrance Sensor

Paper detected

No paper detected

D129/D130

3-252

SM Appendix

Input Check

Paper detected

No paper detected

035 Bank Right Cover Open/Close

Close

Open

036 Tray Cover Open/Close

Close

Open

Set

Not set

038 Bridge/Exit Tray: Exit Sensor

Paper detected

No paper detected

039 Bridge/Exit Tray: Relay Sensor

Paper detected

No paper detected

040 Bridge/Exit/Shift: Set Detection

Set

Not set

Close

Open

Close

Open

Not HP

HP

Set (Bit1)

Not set (Bit1)

Not full

Full

037 LCT Set

041

042

Bridge/Exit Tray: Left Guide
Open/Close
Bridge/Exit Tray: Right Guide
Open/Close

043 Transfer Belt Unit HP Sensor
046 Fusing Unit Set
047 Toner Overflow Sensor

048 Interlock Detection 1

049 Interlock Detection 2

Appendix:
Service
Program
Mode Tables

034 Duplex Exit Sensor

Right or front door is Right or front door is
open.

close.

Right or front door is Right or front door is
open.

close.

050 Key Card Set

Set

Not set

051 Key Counter Set

Set

Not set

Not set

set

Set

Not set

Paper detected

No paper detected

Not end

End

No paper detected

Paper detected

Stay at rear

Stay at front

052 Mechanical Counter Set
053 1-Bin Unit Set
054 1-Bin Unit: Paper Set
057 Cleaning Web End
060 Shift Sensor
064 Shift Tray Sensor
SM Appendix

3-253

D129/D130

Input Check

Bypass Tray Paper Length

065

Paper detected

No paper detected

200 Scanner HP Sensor

Not HP

HP

201 Platen Cover Sensor

Open

Close

Detection

Table 1: Paper Height Sensor
0: Deactivated, 1: Activated (actuator inside sensor)

Remaining paper

Paper height sensor 1

Paper height sensor 2

Full

0

0

Nearly full

1

0

Near end

1

1

Almost empty

0

1

D129/D130

3-254

SM Appendix

Input Check

Table 2: Paper Size Switch
Switch 1 is used for the tray set detection.
0: Pushed, 1: Not pushed

North America

Switch Location
Europe/Asia

4

3

2

0

0

1

0

0

0

11" x 17" SEF*1

A3 SEF*1

(A3 SEF)

(11" x 17" SEF)

8.5" x 14" SEF *2

B4 SEF *2

(B4 SEF)

(8.5" x 14" SEF)

A4 SEF

A4 SEF

1

1

0

8.5" x 11" SEF

8.5" x 11" SEF

1

1

1

B5 SEF

B5 SEF

0

1

1

11" x 81/2" LEF*3

A4 LEF*3

(A4 LEF)

(11" x 81/2" LEF)

1

0

0

10.5" x 7.25" LEF*4

B5 LEF*4

(B5 LEF)

(10.5" x 7.25" LEF)

0

1

0

A5 LEF

A5 LEF

1

0

1

*1: The machine detects either 11" x 17" SEF or A3 SEF, depending on the setting of SP
5-181-002 (Tray 1) or -006 (Tray 2).
*2: The machine detects either 8.5" x 14" SEF or B4 SEF, depending on the setting of SP
5-181-003 (Tray 1) or -007 (Tray 2).
*3: The machine detects either 11" x 81/2" LEF or A4 LEF, depending on the setting of SP
5-181-001 (Tray 1) or -005 (Tray 2).
*4: The machine detects either B5 LEF or 10.5" x 7.25" LEF, depending on the setting of
SP 5-181-004 (Tray 1) or -008 (Tray 2)..

SM Appendix

3-255

D129/D130

Appendix:
Service
Program
Mode Tables

Models

Input Check

Table 3: Paper Size (By-pass Table)
0: Pushed, 1: Not pushed

Models

Bit No.

North America

Europe/Asia

3

2

1

0

11" x 17" SEF*1

A3 SEF*1

(11" x 8.5" LEF)

(A4 LEF)

1

1

1

0

11" x 17" SEF*1

A3 SEF*1

(11" x 8.5" LEF)

(A4 LEF)

1

1

0

0

8.5" x 11" SEF*1

A4 SEF*1

(8.5" x 11" SEF*2)

(A5 LEF)

1

1

0

1

8.5" x 11" SEF*1

A4 SEF*1

(8.5" x 11" SEF*2)

(B5 LEF)

1

0

0

1

5.5" x 8.5" SEF

A5 SEF

1

0

1

1

5.5" x 8.5" SEF

A5 SEF

0

0

1

1

5.5" x 8.5" SEF

A6 SEF

0

1

1

1

5.5" x 8.5" SEF

A6 SEF

1

1

1

1



*1: When the machine determines that the paper feed direction is "LEF", it considers
that the paper size is bracketed size.

D129/D130

3-256

SM Appendix

Input Check

APS Original Size Detection

Original Size

Length Sensor

Width
Sensor

SP4-301

Metric version

Inch version

L3

L2

L1

W1

W2

A3

11" x 17"

O

O

O

O

O

00011111

B4

10" x 14"

O

O

O

O

X

00011110

8.5" x 14"

O

O

O

X

X

00011100

A4 LEF

8.5" x 11"

X

X

X

O

O

00000011

B5 LEF

-

X

X

X

O

X

00000010

A4 SEF

11" x 8.5"

X

O

O

X

X

00001100

B5 SEF

-

X

X

O

X

X

00000100

X

X

X

X

X

00000000

F4
8.5" x 13", 8.25" x
13", or 8" x 13"
SP 5126 controls the
size that is detected

A5 LEF/ SEF

SM Appendix

5.5" x 8.5",
8.5" x 5.5"

3-257

D129/D130

Appendix:
Service
Program
Mode Tables

display

Input Check

3.9.2 OPTIONS
3000/2000-Sheet (Booklet) Finisher (D636/D637)

Reading
6140

Bit Description
0

1

001 Entrance Sensor

No paper detected

Paper detected

002 Proof Exit Sensor

No paper detected

Paper detected

Not Full

Full

No paper

Paper

detected*1

detected*1

No paper detected

Paper detected

Not HP

HP

No paper detected

Paper detected

Not HP

HP

009 Lower Tray Height Sensor

No paper detected

Paper detected

010 Upper Tray Height Sensor

No paper detected

Paper detected

011 Upper Tray Full Sensor

Not Full

Full

012 Stack Roller HP Sensor

Not HP

HP

013 Jogger HP Sensor

Not HP

HP

HP

Not HP

No paper detected

Paper detected

016 Corner Stapler HP Sensor

Not HP

HP

017 Stapler Rotation HP Sensor

Not HP

HP

Not Limit

Limit

Closed

Open

003 Proof Full Detection Sensor

004 Upper Tray Exit Sensor

005 Staple Exit Sensor
006 Shift Roller HP Sensor
007 Shift Exit Sensor
008 Exit Guide Plate HP Sensor

014 Feed Out Belt HP Sensor
015 Stapling Tray Paper Sensor

018 Upper Tray Limit SW
019 Door Switch

D129/D130

3-258

SM Appendix

Input Check

Reading
Bit Description
0

1

Not HP

HP

021 Staple Detection

No staple detected

Staple detected

022 Staple Dip Detection

No staple detected

Staple detected

023 Punch Movement HP Sensor

Not HP

HP

024 Paper Position Slide HP Sensor

Not HP

HP

No paper detected

Paper detected

026 Punch Full Sensor

Not Full

Full

027 Punch HP Sensor

Not HP

HP

020 Corner Stapler Operation

025 Paper Position Sensor

028 Punch DIP SW 1

See *1

029 Punch DIP SW 2

See *1

030 Stack Junction Gate HP Sensor

Not HP

HP

No paper detected

Paper detected

Not HP

HP

No paper detected

Paper detected

034 Bottom Fence HP Sensor

Not HP

HP

035 Fold Cam HP Sensor

Not HP

HP

036 Fold Plate HP Sensor

Not HP

HP

037 Fold Unit Exit Sensor

No paper detected

Paper detected

No paper

Paper

detected*2

detected*2

No paper

Paper

detected*2

detected*2

Not HP

HP

No staple detected

Staple detected

031 Stack Present Sensor
032 Clamp Roller HP Sensor
033 Fold Entrance Sensor

038 Lower Tray Full Sensor: Front

039 Lower Tray Full Sensor: Rear

040 Booklet Stapler 1: Operation
041 Booklet Stapler 1: Staple In (Front)
SM Appendix

3-259

D129/D130

Appendix:
Service
Program
Mode Tables

6140

Input Check

Reading
6140

Bit Description

042

043

Booklet Stapler 1: Staple In
(Leading Edge)
Booklet Stapler 1: Operation
(Rotation/Rear)

044 Booklet Stapler 1: Staple In (Rear)

045

Booklet Stapler 1: Staple In
(Leading Edge/Rear)

046 Upper Tray Full Sensor: 3000

0

1

No staple detected

Staple detected

Not HP

HP

No staple detected

Staple detected

No staple detected

Staple detected

Not Full

Full

*1: Combination of DIP SW 1 and SW 2

DIP SW 1

DIP SW 2

Punch Type

0

0

Japan

1

0

Europe

0

1

North America

1

1

North Europe

*2: Please refer to "Lower Tray (D637 Only)" in the Service Manual for the "3000/2000 (Booklet)
Finisher".

D129/D130

3-260

SM Appendix

Input Check

1000-Sheet Finisher (D588)

Reading
Bit

Description
0

001 Entrance Sensor

002

003

004

005

Paper detected

Shift Exit Sensor

No paper detected

(Lower Tray Exit Sensor)
Staple Entrance Sensor

Paper detected

(Stapler Tray Entrance Sensor)
Staple Moving HP Sensor
(Stapler HP Sensor)
Jogger HP Sensor
(Jogger Fence HP Sensor)

006 Stack Feed-out Belt HP Sensor
007 Staple Tray Paper Sensor

008

Staple Rotation Sensor
(Staple Rotation HP Sensor)

SM Appendix

3-261

No paper
detected

HP

HP

Not HP

No paper detected

Paper detected

Not HP

HP

Staple detected

012 Shift HP Sensor

Paper detected

Not HP

010 Staple READY Detection

(Exit Guide Plate HP Sensor)

detected

HP

Staple detected

Exit Guide Plate HP

No paper

Not HP

009 Staple Sensor

011

1

Appendix:
Service
Program
Mode Tables

6139

No staple
detected
No staple
detected

Not HP

HP

Not HP

HP

D129/D130

Input Check

013

014

015

D129/D130

Paper Sensor
(Stack Height Sensor)
Tray Lower Sensor
(Lower Tray Lower Limit Sensor)
Proof Full Sensor
(Paper Limit Sensor)

3-262

No output tray

Output tray

detected

detected

Lower limit

Not lower limit

Not full

Full

SM Appendix

Output Check

3.10 OUTPUT CHECK
3.10.1 COPIER

5804

Output Check
001 Exit Motor: 350
002 Exit Motor: 175
Appendix:
Service
Program
Mode Tables

003 Exit Motor: 230
Paper exit motor (Mainframe)
004 Exit Motor: 180
005 Exit Motor: 154
006 Exit Motor: 90
007 Feed Motor: 300
008 Feed Motor: 255
009 Feed Motor: 230
Paper feed motor (Mainframe)

010 Feed Motor: 215
011 Feed Motor: 180
012 Feed Motor: 154
013 Feed Motor: 90
014 Bank: Feed Motor: 300
015 Bank: Feed Motor: 255

Paper feed motor (Optional paper

016 Bank: Feed Motor: 230

feed unit)

017 Bank: Feed Motor: 215
018 Bank: Feed Motor: 180

SM Appendix

3-263

D129/D130

Output Check

5804

Output Check
019 Bank: Feed Motor: 154
020 Bank: Feed Motor: 90
021 LCT: Feed Motor: 300
022 LCT: Feed Motor: 255
023 LCT: Feed Motor: 230
Paper feed motor (Optional LCT)

024 LCT: Feed Motor: 215
025 LCT: Feed Motor: 180
026 LCT: Feed Motor: 154
027 LCT: Feed Motor: 90
028 Paper Feed Clutch 1

Paper feed clutch 1/2 (Mainframe)
029 Paper Feed Clutch 2
030 Bank: Paper Feed Clutch 3

Paper feed clutch 3/4 (Optional

031 Bank: Paper Feed Clutch 4

paper feed unit)

032 LCT: Paper Feed Clutch

Paper feed clutch (Optional LCT)

033 Pick-up Solenoid 1
Pick-up Solenoid 1/2 (Mainframe)
034 Pick-up Solenoid 2
035 Bank: Pick-up Solenoid 3

Pick-up Solenoid 3/4 (Optional

036 Bank: Pick-up Solenoid 4

paper feed unit)

037 LCT: Pick-up Solenoid

Pick-up Solenoid (LCT)

038 Tray Lift Motor 1: Up
039 Tray Lift Motor 1: Down

-

040 Tray Lift Motor 2: Up

D129/D130

3-264

SM Appendix

Output Check

5804

Output Check
041 Tray Lift Motor 2: Down
042 Paper Tray Lock Solenoid

Not used

043 Bank: Paper Tray Lock Solenoid

Tray lock solenoid (Optional paper
feed unit)

044 Registration Motor: 230
Appendix:
Service
Program
Mode Tables

045 Registration Motor: 180
046 Registration Motor: 154
047 Registration Motor: 90
048 Exit: Junction Gate Solenoid

Junction gate 1 solenoid

049 Duplex: Inverter Gate Solenoid

Not used

050 Duplex Inverter Motor: Fwd: 230
051 Duplex Inverter Motor: Fwd: 180
052 Duplex Inverter Motor: Fwd: 154
053 Duplex Inverter Motor: Fwd: 90
054 Duplex Inverter Motor: Rev: 230
055 Duplex Inverter Motor: Rev: 180
056 Duplex Inverter Motor: Rev: 154
057 Duplex Inverter Motor: Rev: 90
058 Duplex/By-pass Motor: Fwd: 230
059 Duplex/By-pass Motor: Fwd: 180
060 Duplex/By-pass Motor: Fwd: 154
061 Duplex/By-pass Motor: Fwd: 90
062 Duplex/By-pass Motor: Rev: 230
063 Duplex/By-pass Motor: Rev: 180
SM Appendix

3-265

D129/D130

Output Check

5804

Output Check
064 Duplex/By-pass Motor: Rev: 154
065 Duplex/By-pass Motor: Rev: 90
066 By-pass Feed Clutch

-

067 By-pass Pick-up Solenoid

-

068 Bridge/Exit Tray: Drive Motor: 230
069 Bridge/Exit Tray: Drive Motor: 180
Drive motor (Bridge unit)
070 Bridge/Exit Tray: Drive Motor: 154
071 Bridge/Exit Tray: Drive Motor: 90

072

Bridge/Exit Tray: Junction Gate

Junction Gate Solenoid (Bridge

Solenoid

unit)

073 Bridge/Exit Tray: Drive Motor: Reset

-

074 Bridge/Exit Tray: Drive Motor: Enable

-

075 Bridge: Cooling Fan Motor

Not used

076 Transfer Belt Contact Motor

-

077 OPC Motor: 230
078 OPC Motor: 180
Drum motor
079 OPC Motor: 154
080 OPC Motor: 90
081 Transfer/Development Motor: 230
082 Transfer/Development Motor: 180
083 Transfer/Development Motor: 154
084 Transfer/Development Motor: 90
085 Fusing Motor: 230
086 Fusing Motor: 180

D129/D130

3-266

SM Appendix

Output Check

5804

Output Check
087 Fusing Motor: 154
088 Fusing Motor: 90
089 Development Puddle Motor

-

090 PTL Control

-

091 Fusing Fan Motor: High
Fusing exhaust fan motor
Appendix:
Service
Program
Mode Tables

092 Fusing Fan Motor: Low
093 Exhaust Fan Motor: High
Exhaust fan motor
094 Exhaust Fan Motor: Low
095 Duct Fan Motor

Cooling fan motor

096 Exit Fan Motor: High
Paper exit cooling fan motor
097 Exit Fan Motor: Low
098 PSU Fan Motor

Junction gate 2 solenoid (1-bin

099 1-Bin Junction Gate Solenoid

unit)

100 Polygon Motor: 230
101 Polygon Motor: 180
102 Polygon Motor: 154
103 Polygon Motor: 90
104 LD 1
105 LD 2
106 Toner Bottle Motor: Fwd

Toner supply motor

107 Quenching Lamp

-

108 Charge Bias

-

109 Development Bias

-

SM Appendix

3-267

D129/D130

Output Check

5804

Output Check
110 Transfer Belt Voltage

-

111 ID Sensor LED

-

115 Cleaning Web Motor

Web motor

116 Shift Tray Motor

Not used

117 CTL Cooling FAN

Controller fan

202 Scanner Lamp

-

3.10.2 1000-SHEET FINISHER (D588)

Output Check
6144
Display

Description

001 Upper Relay Motor

Upper Transport Motor

002 Lower Relay Motor

Lower Transport Motor

003 Exit Motor

-

004 Proof Junction Gate SOL

Tray Junction Gate Solenoid

005 Lower Tray Lift Motor

-

006 Jogger Fence Motor

-

007 Stapler Motor

-

008 Stapler Hammer

-

009 Stapler Junction Gate Solenoid

-

010 Positioning Roller Solenoid

-

011 Stack Feed-out Motor

-

012 Shift Motor

-

013 Exit Guide Plate Motor

-

D129/D130

3-268

SM Appendix

Output Check

3.10.3 3000 /2000-SHEET (BOOKLET) FINISHER (D636/D637)

Output
6145
Description

001 Entrance Motor

-

002 Upper Transport Motor

-

003 Lower Transport Motor

-

004 Upper/Proof Tray Exit Motor

-

005 Clamp Roller Retraction Motor

-

006 Shift Roller Motor

-

007 Exit Guide Plate Motor

-

008 Upper Tray Lift Motor

-

009 Stacking Sponge Roller Motor

-

010 Jogger Fence Motor

-

011 Feed Out Belt Motor

-

012 Corner Stapler Movement Motor

-

013 Corner Stapler Rotation Motor

-

014 Corner Stapler

-

015 Proof Junction Gate Solenoid

-

016 Stapling Tray Junction Gate Solenoid

-

017

Stapling Edge Pressure Plate

-

Solenoid

018 Positioning Roller Solenoid

-

019 Booklet Pressure Roller Solenoid

-

020 Stack Junction Gate Motor

-

021 Fold Unit Bottom Fence Lift Motor

-

SM Appendix

Appendix:
Service
Program
Mode Tables

Display

3-269

D129/D130

Output Check

022 Booklet Stapler: Front

-

023 Booklet Stapler: Rear

-

024 Fold Plate Motor

-

025 Fold Roller Motor

-

026 Positioning Roller Motor

-

027 Punch Drive Motor

-

028 Punch Movement Motor

-

029 Paper Position Sensor Slide Motor

-

D129/D130

3-270

SM Appendix

Printer Service Tables

3.11 PRINTER SERVICE TABLES
3.11.1 SP1-XXX (SERVICE MODE)

Bit Switch

001 Bit Switch 1

0

1

bit 0

DFU

-

-

bit 1

DFU

-

-

bit 2

DFU

-

-

bit 3

No I/O Timeout

0: Disable

1: Enable

Enable: The MFP I/O Timeout setting will have no effect. I/O Timeouts will
never occur.
bit 4

SD Card Save Mode

0: Disable

1: Enable

Enable: Print jobs will be saved to an SD Card in the GW SD slot.
bit 5

DFU

-

-

bit 6

DFU

-

-

bit 7

[RPCS,PCL]: Printable area frame border

0: Disable

1: Enable

Enable: The machine prints all RPCS and PCL jobs with a border on the
edges of the printable area.

SM Appendix

3-271

D129/D130

Appendix:
Service
Program
Mode Tables

1001

Printer Service Tables

1001

Bit Switch

002 Bit Switch 2

0

1

bit 0

DFU

-

-

bit 1

DFU

-

-

bit 2

Applying a collation Type

Shift

Normal

Collate

Collate

A collation type (shift or normal) will be applied to all jobs that do not
already have a ‘Collate Type’ configured.

bit 3

If #5-0 is enabled, this Bit Switch has no effect.

[PCL5e/c,PS]: PDL Auto Switching

0: Enable

1: Disable

Disable: The MFPs ability to change the PDL processor mid-job.
Some host systems submit jobs that contain both PS and PCL5e/c. If Auto
PDL switching is disabled, these jobs will not be printed properly.
bit 4

DFU

-

-

bit 5

DFU

-

-

bit 6

DFU

-

-

bit 7

DFU

-

-

D129/D130

3-272

SM Appendix

Printer Service Tables

1001

Bit Switch

003 Bit Switch 3

0

1

bit 0

DFU

-

-

bit 1

DFU

-

-

bit 2

[PCL5e/c]: Legacy HP compatibility

0: Disable

1: Enable

HP4000/HP8000.
In other words, the left margin defined in the job (usually "*r0A")
will be changed to "*r1A"
bit 3

DFU

-

-

bit 4

DFU

-

-

bit 5

DFU

-

-

bit 6

DFU

-

-

bit 7

DFU

-

-

SM Appendix

3-273

D129/D130

Appendix:
Service
Program
Mode Tables

Enable: Uses the same left margin as older HP models such as

Printer Service Tables

1001

Bit Switch

004 Bit Switch 4

0

1

bit 0

DFU

-

-

bit 1

DFU

-

-

bit 2

DFU

-

-

bit 3

IPDS print-side reversal

0: Disable

1: Enable

Enable: Increases printing speed but simplex pages may be printed on the
back side of the sheet.
bit 4

DFU

-

-

bit 5

DFU

-

-

bit 6

DFU

-

-

bit 7

IPDS support tools

0: Disable

1: Enable

Enable: Enables the port for IPDS support tools.

D129/D130

3-274

SM Appendix

Printer Service Tables

1001

Bit Switch

005 Bit Switch 5

0

1

Disable

Enable

Show "Collate Type", "Staple Type" and
"Punch Type" buttons on the operation
panel.
bit 0

If enabled, users will be able to configure a Collate Type, Staple Type, and
Punch Type from the operation panel. The available types will depend on
Appendix:
Service
Program
Mode Tables

the device and configured options.
After enabling the function, the settings will appear under:
"User Tools > Printer Features > System"
bit 1

Multiple copies if a paper size or type
mismatch occurs

0: Disable
(Single
copy)

1: Enable
(Multiple copy)

If a paper size or type mismatch occurs during the printing of multiple
copies, only a single copy is output by default. Using this Bit Switch, the
device can be configured to print all copies even if a paper mismatch
occurs.
bit 2

Prevent SDK applications from altering
the contents of a job

0: Disable

1: Enable

If this BitSw is enabled, SDK applications will not be able to alter print
data. This is achieved by preventing SDK applications from accessing a
module called the "GPS Filter".
Note: The main purpose of this BitSw is for troubleshooting the effects of
SDK applications on data.
bit 3

[PS] PS Criteria

Pattern3

Pattern1

Change the number of PS criterion used by the PS interpreter to
determine whether a job is PS data or not.
Pattern3: includes most PS commands.
Pattern1: A small number of PS tags and headers
bit 4

Increase max number of the stored jobs
to 1000 jobs.

SM Appendix

Disable

Enable (1000)

(100)

3-275

D129/D130

Printer Service Tables

Enable: Changes the maximum number of jobs that can be stored on the
HDD via Job Type settings to 1000. The default is 100.
bit 5

DFU

bit 6

Method for determining the image
rotation for the edge to bind on.

-

-

0: Disable

1: Enable

If enabled, the image rotation will be performed as they were in the
specifications of older models for the binding of pages of mixed orientation
jobs.
The old models are below:
- PCL: Pre-04A models
- PS/PDF/RPCS:Pre-05S models
bit 7

Letterhead mode printing

0: Disable

1: Enable
(Duplex)

Routes all pages through the duplex unit.
If this is disabled, simplex pages or the last page of an odd-paged duplex
job are not routed through the duplex unit. This could result in problems
with letterhead/pre-printed pages.
Only affects pages specified as Letterhead paper.

1001

Bit Switch

006 Bit Switch 6 DFU

D129/D130

-

3-276

-

SM Appendix

Printer Service Tables

1001

Bit Switch

007 Bit Switch 7
Print path

0

1

0: Disable

1: Enable

If enabled, simplex pages (in mixed simplex/duplex PS/PCL5 jobs only)
bit 0

and the last page of an odd paged duplex job (PS, PCL5, PCL6), are
always routed through the duplex unit. Not having to switch paper paths

bit 1
to 7

1001

DFU

Appendix:
Service
Program
Mode Tables

increases the print speed slightly.

-

-

-

-

-

-

0: Disable

1: Enable

(Standard)

(BMS)

Bit Switch

008 Bit Switch 8 DFU
bit 0
to 3

DFU

PCL edge to edge printing setting
bit 4

Switch the edge to edge printing setting for the custom-made machine
(BMS).
bit 5
to 7

SM Appendix

DFU

-

3-277

-

D129/D130

Printer Service Tables

1001

Bit Switch

009 Bit Switch 9
PDL Auto Detection timeout of jobs
submitted via USB or Parallel Port (IEEE
1284).

0

1

"Disabled

"Enabled

(Immediately)"

(10 seconds)"

bit 0
To be used if PDL auto-detection fails. A failure of PDL autodetection doesn't
necessarily mean that the job can't be printed. This bit switch tells the device
whether to time-out immediately (default) upon failure or to wait 10 seconds.
bit 1

DFU

bit 2

Job Cancel

-

-

Disabled
(Not
cancelled)

Enabled
(Cancelled)

If this bit switch, all jobs will be cancelled after a jam occurs.
Note: If this bitsw is enabled, printing under the following conditions might
result in problems:
- Job submission via USB or Parallel Port
- Spool printing (WIM >Configuration > Device Settings > System)
bit 3

PCL/PS bypass tray paper rotation
(SEF/LEF)

0: Disable

1: Enable

This bitsw causes the device to revert to the behavior of previous
generations. It only takes effect if "Bypass Tray Setting Priority" =
"Driver/Command".
Previous spec (bitsw=1): If a standard sized paper mismatch occurred in the
bypass tray, the MFP always prompted for SEF paper.
If this bitsw=0 (default) then in the event of a standard sized paper mismatch,
the MFP will always prompt for paper of the rotation (SEF/LEF) determined by
the MFP bypass tray paper setting or by the bypass tray sensor.

D129/D130

3-278

SM Appendix

Printer Service Tables

bit 4

Response to PJL USTATUS when
multiple collated copies are printed

0: Disable

1: Enable

When enabled, if multiple collated copies are printed, the device no longer
responds to PJL USTATUS with the number of pages in the current copy.
Instead the device will return the total number of pages for all copies.
Bit 5

DFU

-

-

Appendix:
Service
Program
Mode Tables

to 7

SM Appendix

3-279

D129/D130

Printer Service Tables

1001

Bit Switch

010 Bit Switch 10
bit 0
to 4
bit 5

DFU

List / Test Print Lock

0

1

-

-

0: Disable

1: Enable

If enabled, you can lock or unlock the [List/Test Print] items under the
Pinter Features menu when the Store and Skip Errored Job Function is
on.
Bit 6

Optional charge machines

-

-

0: Disable

1: Enable

-

-

0

1

0: Disable

1: Enable

If enabled, you can use the optional charge
machines when the Store and Skip Errored
Job Function is on.
Bit 7

1001

DFU

Bit Switch

011 Bit Switch 11
bit 0

List / Test Print menu

When enabled, [Multiple Lists] menu is displayed in [List / Test Print] under
the Printer Features menu.
bit 1

Interrupt printing

0: Job

1: Page

Selects the interrupting units for the interrupt printing function.
When you select "0," you can interrupt printing of a job while being
processed.
When you select "1," you can interrupt printing of a page while being
processed.
Bit 2

DFU

-

to 7

D129/D130

3-280

-

SM Appendix

Printer Service Tables

1001

Bit Switch

012 Bit Switch 12
bit 0
to 7

1003

DFU

0

1

-

-

[Clear Setting]
Initialize Printer System
Appendix:
Service
Program
Mode Tables

1003 001
Initializes settings in the "System" menu of the user mode.
1003 003 Delete Program

1004

[Print Summary]
Print Printer Summary

1004 001
Prints the service summary sheet (a summary of all the controller settings).

1006

[Sample/Locked Print]

*CTL

0: Link with Doc. Svr, 1: Enable

Enables and disables the document server. When you select "0," the
1006 001

document server is enabled or disabled in accordance with Copy Service
Mode SP5-967. When you select "1," the document server is enabled
regardless of Copy Service Mode SP5-967.

1110

[Media Print Device Setting]

1110 002 0: Disable 1: Enable

1111

1111 001

SM Appendix

Selects the setting for the media print device.

[All Job Delete Mode]
Select whether to include an image

0: excluding New Job

processing job in jobs subject to full

1: including New Job

cancellation from the SCS job list.

3-281

D129/D130

Scanner Service Table

3.12 SCANNER SERVICE TABLE
3.12.1 SP TABLES

SP

Number/Name

Function/[Setting]

1001

Scan NV Version

Displays the version of the scanner NV.
Selects the compression type for binary

1004

Compression Type

picture processing.
[1 to 3 / 1 / 1/step]
1: MH, 2: MR, 3: MMR
Creates an erase margin for all edges of the
scanned image.

1005

Erase Margin

If the machine has scanned the edge of the
original, create a margin.
[0 to 5 / 0 / 1 mm/step]
Enables or disables the TWAIN function.

1009

Remote scan disable

[0 or 1 / 0 / - ]
0: Enable, 1: Disable
Displays or does not display the clear light

1010

Non Display Clear Light PDF

PDF function.
[0 or 1 / 0 / - ]
0: Display, 1: Not display
Displays or does not display the original

1011

Org Count Disp

counter.
[0 or 1 / 0 / - ]
0: Not display, 1: Display
Clears or does not clear a user information

1012

User Info Release

after a job.
[0 or 1 / 1 / - ]
0: Not clear, 1: Clear

D129/D130

3-282

SM Appendix

Scanner Service Table

SP

Number/Name

Function/[Setting]

Compression level (grayscale)
These SP codes set the compression ratio for the grayscale processing mode

2021

that can be selected with the notch settings on the operation panel.

1 Comp 1: 5 - 95

[5 to 95 / 20 / 1 /step]

2 Comp 2: 5 - 95

[5 to 95 / 40 / 1 /step]

3 Comp 3: 5 - 95

[5 to 95 / 65 / 1 /step]

4 Comp 4: 5 - 95

[5 to 95 / 80 / 1 /step]

5 Comp 5: 5 - 95

[5 to 95 / 95 / 1 /step]

Appendix:
Service
Program
Mode Tables

Range: 5 (lowest ratio) <-> 95 (highest ratio)

[Compression ratio of ClearLight PDF]
2024*

Selects the compression ratio for clearlight PDF for the two settings that can be
selected at the operation panel.
1 Compression Ratio (Normal image)

[5 to 95 / 25 / 1 /step ]

2 Compression Ratio (High comp image)

[5 to 95 / 20 / 1 /step ]

SM Appendix

3-283

D129/D130

Detailed Description of SP5-749

Rev. 11/15/2012

⇒ 3.13 DETAILED DESCRIPTION OF SP5-749
5749

ƒ

Import/Export
001

Import

101

Export

251

Export Result Print (SP)

252

Import Result Print (SP)

If part of the panel display for SP5-749 appears garbled, please apply the following
modification firmware to the machine.

Target model

Module

Program No

Version

Effective date

D130

System/Copy

D1295751K

2.04

July 2012 Production

3.13.1 DATA THAT CAN BE IMPORTED AND EXPORTED
ƒ

Copier / Document Server Features

ƒ

Printer Features

ƒ

Scanner Features

ƒ

Facsimile Features

ƒ

Extended Feature Settings

ƒ

Program (Document Server)

ƒ

Program (Copier)

ƒ

Program (Scanner)

ƒ

Web Image Monitor Setting

ƒ

Web Service Settings

ƒ

System Settings

D129/D130

3-284

SM Appendix

Detailed Description of SP5-749

Rev. 11/15/2012

ƒ

Address book

ƒ

Programs (fax function)

ƒ

Programs (printer function)

ƒ

Scanner function programs that include password settings

ƒ

User stamp in the copy default settings

ƒ

Settings for configuring from telnet

ƒ

@Remote-related data

ƒ

Counters

ƒ

Settings that can be specified using Web Image Monitor or Web Service only (such as
Bonjour or SSDP settings)

ƒ

Some System Settings*1 *2

*1 The setting for the date, those settings that require the device certificate, and those settings
that need to be adjusted for each device (for example, image adjustment settings) cannot be
imported or exported.
*2 Settings only for executing functions and settings only for viewing cannot be imported or
exported.

3.13.3 IMPORT/EXPORT CONDITION
Import/export is possible between devices only if their models, region of use, and the following
device configuration match.
ƒ

Input Tray

ƒ

Output Tray

ƒ

Whether or not equipped with the duplex function

ƒ

Whether or not equipped with a finisher and the type of finisher

ƒ

ADF

ƒ

Whether or not equipped with a hard disk

ƒ

Whether or not equipped with the Remote Machine function

3.13.4 LOCATION OF STORED DATA (LOG)
The log is stored in the same location as the exported device setting information file. To use this
function, it is necessary to create the device setting information file with special software and
store it on the web server. For details, contact your sales representative.

SM Appendix

3-285

D129/D130

Appendix:
Service
Program
Mode Tables

3.13.2 DATA THAT CANNOT BE IMPORTED OR EXPORTED

Detailed Description of SP5-749

Rev. 11/15/2012

3.13.5 POSSIBLE SOLUTIONS FOR IMPORT/EXPORT PROBLEMS
If an error occurs, check the log's result code first. Values other than 0 indicate that an error
occurred. The result code will appear in the circled area illustrated below.
- Example of a log file

If you cannot solve the problem or do not know how to solve it after checking the code, note
down the error log entry, and then contact your service representative.
Result Code

Cause

Solutions

2 (INVALID REQUEST)

A file import was attempted between

Import files exported from the same model

different models or machines with

with the same

different device configurations.

device configurations.

Failed to write the device

Check whether the destination device is

information to the destination

operating normally.

4 (INVALID OUTPUT
DIR)

device.
7( MODULE ERROR)

An unexpected error occurred

Switch the power off and then back on, and

during import or export.

then try the operation again. If the error
persists, contact your service representative.

8 (DISK FULL)

9 (DEVICE ERROR)

The available storage space on the

Execute the operation again after making

external medium is insufficient.

sure there is enough storage space.

Failed to write or read the log file.

Check whether the path to the folder for
storing the file or the folder in which the file
is stored is missing.

10 (LOG ERROR)

D129/D130

The hard disk is faulty.

Contact your service representative.

3-286

SM Appendix

Detailed Description of SP5-749

Rev. 11/15/2012

Result Code

Cause

Solutions

20 (PART FAILED)

Failed to import some settings.

The reason for the failure is logged in
"NgCode". Check the code.
♦ Reason for the Error (Ng-Name)
2. INVALID VALUE
The specified value exceeds the allowable
range.
3. PERMISSION ERROR
The permission to edit the setting is missing.

The setting does not exist in the system.
5. INTERLOCK ERROR
The setting cannot be changed because of
the system status or interlocking with other
specified settings.
6. OTHER ERROR
The setting cannot be changed for some
other reason.
21 (INVALID FILE)

Failed to import the file because it is

Check whether the file format is correct. The

in the wrong format in the external

log is in the form of a CSV file

medium.
22 (INVALID KEY)

ƒ

The encryption key is not valid.

Use the correct encryption key.

When exporting device information from the control panel, the data can be saved only
on an SD card.

ƒ

The file format for exports is CSV.

3.13.6 EXPORTING DEVICE INFORMATION
When exporting SP device information from the control panel, the data is saved on an SD card.
1.

Insert an SD card into the media slot on the side of the control panel.

2.

Enter SP mode.

3.

Press SP5-749-001

4.

Select target SP settings to be exported.

SM Appendix

3-287

D129/D130

Appendix:
Service
Program
Mode Tables

4. NOT EXIST

Detailed Description of SP5-749

5.

Rev. 11/15/2012

Select the Option Settings.

Item

Specification

Unique

Unique information of the Unique information that can be updated
machine is included in

Note
#1. Items that are to be use to identify the machine itself among some

exported file if you select devices.
"Unique" setting.

Example: IP address / Host name / Information related to FAX number /Mail
address assigned the machine
#2. Items for specifying the options equipped the machine.
Example: Lot number for developer
Unique information that cannot be updated
#3. Items that the problem may occur by importing
Example: Serial number / Information related to @remote
#4. Items for managing the history of the machine
Example: time and date / counter information / Installation date
#5. Setting value for Engine

Secret

Secret information is

Secret information

exported if you select

#1. Data that absolutely cannot be exported.

"Secret" setting.

(Exported data becomes turned letter)
Example: Password / Encryption key / PIN code
#2. Confidential information for the customer
Example: User name / User ID / Department code / Mail address / Phone
number
#3. Personal information
Example: Document name / Image data
#4. Sensitive information for the customer
Example: IP address / MAC address / Network parameter

D129/D130

3-288

SM Appendix

Detailed Description of SP5-749

Rev. 11/15/2012

6.

Select an Encryption Setting.

Item

Specification

Encryption Select whether perform

Note
If the encryption function is used, setting of encryption key is required by

the encryption function or direct input.
not when exporting.

- Type the arbitrary password using soft keyboard

If you push "Encryption"

- Can enter up to 32 characters

key, you can export secret

7.

Press “Execute” key.

8.

Press [OK].
ƒ

Appendix:
Service
Program
Mode Tables

information.

If data export fails, the details of the error can be viewed in the log.

3.13.7 IMPORTING DEVICE INFORMATION
Import device information saved on an SD card.
1.

Insert an SD card into the media slot on the side of the control panel.

2.

Enter SP mode.

3.

Press SP5-749-101

4.

Select a unique setting.

SM Appendix

3-289

D129/D130

Detailed Description of SP5-749

5.

Rev. 11/15/2012

Press “Encryption key”, if the encryption key was created when the file was exported.

Item

Specification

Note

Unique

If you want to apply the unique

Refer to the above information

information to the target machine,
select the "Unique" key.
Encryption If the encrypted fail is selected as
import file, this setting is required.

6.

Press “Execute” key.

7.

Press [OK].
ƒ

If data export fails, the details of the error can be viewed in the log.

D129/D130

3-290

SM Appendix

SR790(B408)/SR3090(D588)
1000-SHEET FINISHER
REVISION HISTORY
Page

Date

Added/Updated/New
None

1000-SHEET FINISHER B408/D588
TABLE OF CONTENTS
1. REPLACEMENT AND ADJUSTMENT............................................1
1.1 MAIN PCB .................................................................................................... 1
1.2 STAPLER UNIT ............................................................................................ 2
1.3 MOTORS ...................................................................................................... 3
1.3.1 SHIFT MOTOR .................................................................................... 3
1.3.2 STAPLER MOTOR .............................................................................. 3
1.3.3 UPPER TRANSPORT MOTOR AND EXIT MOTOR ........................... 4
1.3.4 LOWER TRANSPORT MOTOR .......................................................... 4
1.4 MOTORS AND SENSORS ........................................................................... 5
1.4.1 PREPARATION ................................................................................... 5
1.4.2 STACK HEIGHT SENSOR .................................................................. 6
1.4.3 STAPLER TRAY PAPER SENSOR..................................................... 6
1.4.4 LOWER TRAY LIFT MOTOR .............................................................. 7
1.4.5 STACK FEED-OUT MOTOR ............................................................... 7

2. TROUBLESHOOTING ....................................................................8
2.1 JAM DETECTION......................................................................................... 8

3. SERVICE TABLES..........................................................................9
3.1 DIP SWITCH SETTINGS ............................................................................. 9

4. DETAILED DESCRIPTIONS .........................................................10
4.1
4.2
4.3
4.4
4.5

GENERAL LAYOUT ................................................................................... 10
ELECTRICAL COMPONENT LAYOUT ...................................................... 11
ELECTRICAL COMPONENT DESCRIPTION ............................................ 13
DRIVE LAYOUT ......................................................................................... 15
JUNCTION GATES .................................................................................... 16
Upper Tray Mode ................................................................................... 16
Sort/Stack Mode .................................................................................... 16
Staple Mode ........................................................................................... 16
4.6 UPPER TRAY............................................................................................. 17
4.7 LOWER TRAY UP/DOWN MECHANISMS ................................................ 18
4.8 PAPER SHIFT MECHANISM ..................................................................... 19
4.9 JOGGER UNIT PAPER POSITIONING MECHANISM............................... 20
4.10 EXIT GUIDE PLATE ................................................................................. 21
4.11 STAPLER MECHANISM .......................................................................... 22
4.12 STAPLER UNIT MOVEMENT MECHANISM ........................................... 23
4.13 PAPER FEED-OUT MECHANISM ........................................................... 24

SM

i

B408/D588

MAIN PCB

1. REPLACEMENT AND ADJUSTMENT
CAUTION
Turn off the main power switch and unplug the machine before beginning
any of the procedures in this section.
NOTE: This manual uses the following symbols.
 : See or Refer to
 : Screws
 : Connector
 : E-ring

 : Clip ring

1.1 MAIN PCB

1000-Sheet
Finisher
SR790/SR3090
B408/D588

[A]
[B]

B408R109.WMF

B408R110.WMF

1. Rear cover [A] ( x 2)
2. Main PCB [B] ( x 4, All )

SM

1

B408/D588

STAPLER UNIT

1.2 STAPLER UNIT
[B]

1. Side cover [A] ( x 2)
[C]

2. Open exit guide plate [B]
3. Upper side cover [C] ( x 2)

[A]

B408R102.WMF

[D]

4. Front cover support plate [D] ( x 1)

[E]

5. Front cover [E]

[F]

6. Front inner cover [F] ( x 2)

B408R113.WMF

7. Harness [G]
8. Unhook the spring [H]
9. Turn the stapler unit [I] and take it
out.

[J]

10. Bracket [J] ( x 2)
[H]

[G]

[I]
B408R114.WMF

B408/D588

2

SM

MOTORS

1.3 MOTORS
1.3.1 SHIFT MOTOR
1. Rear cover (1.1)
2. Shift motor [A] ( x 2,  x 1)

[A]

1000-Sheet
Finisher
SR790/SR3090
B408/D588

B408R123.WMF

1.3.2 STAPLER MOTOR
1. Rear cover (1.1)
2. Stapler motor [A] ( x 2,  x 1)

[A]
B408R124.WMF

SM

3

B408/D588

MOTORS

1.3.3 UPPER TRANSPORT MOTOR AND EXIT MOTOR
1. Rear cover (1.1)
2. Motor assembly [A] ( x 4,  x 2)
3. Upper transport motor [B] ( x 4)

[A]

4. Exit motor [C] ( x 4)

[B]
[C]
B408R112.WMF

1.3.4 LOWER TRANSPORT MOTOR
1. Main PCB (1.1)
2. Lower transport motor [A] ( x 2,  x
1)

[A]

B408R111.WMF

B408/D588

4

SM

MOTORS AND SENSORS

1.4 MOTORS AND SENSORS
[A]

1.4.1 PREPARATION
1. Front cover and inner cover (1.2)

[B]

2. Upper side cover [A] ( x 2)
3. Upper tray [B] ( x 1)

[C]

B408R116.WMF

[E]

5. Loosen the 2 screws [D].

[D]

6. Lower the lower tray guide plate [E].

B408R117.WMF

7. Guide plate [F] ( x 4)

[F]

B408R118.WMF

SM

5

B408/D588

1000-Sheet
Finisher
SR790/SR3090
B408/D588

4. Lower side cover [C] ( x 2)

MOTORS AND SENSORS

1.4.2 STACK HEIGHT SENSOR
1. Stack height sensor assembly [A] ( x
1)
[A]
2. Stack height sensor [B] ( x 1)

[B]

B408R121.WMF

1.4.3 STAPLER TRAY PAPER SENSOR
1. Stapler tray paper sensor [A] ( x 1)

B408R120.WMF

[A]

B408/D588

6

SM

MOTORS AND SENSORS

1.4.4 LOWER TRAY LIFT MOTOR
1. Lower tray lift motor [A] ( x 2,  x 1)

[A]

1000-Sheet
Finisher
SR790/SR3090
B408/D588

B408R119.WMF

1.4.5 STACK FEED-OUT MOTOR
1. Stack feed-out motor [A] ( x 2,  x 1)

[A]

B408R122.WMF

SM

7

B408/D588

JAM DETECTION

2. TROUBLESHOOTING
2.1 JAM DETECTION
Mode
Shift
Staple










Content

Entrance sensor:
On check
Entrance sensor:
Off check
Lower tray exit sensor:
On check



Tray exit sensor:
Off check
Stapler tray entrance sensor:
On check



Stapler tray entrance sensor:
Off check



Lower tray exit sensor:
On check



Lower tray exit sensor:
Off check



B408/D588

Jam

8

The entrance sensor does not turn on
within the normal time after the main
machine exit sensor turns on
The entrance sensor does not turn off
within the normal time after it turns on.
The lower tray exit sensor does not turn
on within the normal time after the
entrance sensor turns off.
The tray exit sensor does not turn off
within the normal time after it turns on.
The stapler tray entrance sensor does
not switch on within the normal time
after the entrance sensor switched on.
The staple tray entrance sensor does
not turn off within the normal time after it
turns on.
The lower exit sensor does not turn on
after the feed-out pawl feeds out the
outputs.
The lower exit sensor turns on when the
feed-out pawl returns to its home
position after feeding out the outputs.

SM

DIP SWITCH SETTINGS

3. SERVICE TABLES
3.1 DIP SWITCH SETTINGS
The DIP switches should not be set to any combination other than those listed in
the table below.
SW100
1
0
1

2
0
0

Description
Normal operation mode (Default)
Packing mode.

1000-Sheet
Finisher
SR790/SR3090
B408/D588

• Before packing the machine, do the following: Set switch 1 to 1 then back to
zero. The lower tray moves to the lowest position. Then turn off the main switch.
• After unpacking the machine, do the following: After turning the main switch back
on, the lower tray returns to home position automatically.

SM

9

B408/D588

GENERAL LAYOUT

4. DETAILED DESCRIPTIONS
4.1 GENERAL LAYOUT
2

3

1
13

4
5
6

12

7

11

10

8
9

B408D101.WMF

1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
6.
7.

Upper Tray
Upper Tray Exit Roller
Entrance Roller
Tray Junction Gate
Upper Transport Roller
Stapler Junction Gate
Lower Transport Rollers

B408/D588

8. Stapler
9. Stack Feed-out Belt
10. Positioning Roller
11. Shift Roller
12. Lower Tray
13. Lower Tray Exit Roller

10

SM

ELECTRICAL COMPONENT LAYOUT

4.2 ELECTRICAL COMPONENT LAYOUT
1

3

2

11
4
5
10

8

7

12

6

B408D102.WMF

19

13

18

14

20

21

15

16
17
B408D103.WMF

1. Upper Cover Switch
2. Paper Limit Sensor
3. Entrance Sensor
4. Exit Guide Plate Motor
5. Exit Guide Plate HP Sensor
6. Front Door Safety Switch
7. Stack Height Sensor
8. Lower Tray Exit Sensor
9. Lower Tray Upper Limit Switch
10. Shift HP Sensor
11. Shift Motor

SM

11

12. Jogger Fence HP Sensor
13. Positioning Roller Solenoid
14. Stapler HP Sensor
15. Stapler Tray Entrance Sensor
16. Stapler Tray Paper Sensor
17. Stapler Hammer Motor
18. Staple Sheet Sensor
19. Stack Feed-out Belt HP Sensor
20. Stapler Rotation HP Sensor
21. Staple Sensor

B408/D588

1000-Sheet
Finisher
SR790/SR3090
B408/D588

9

ELECTRICAL COMPONENT LAYOUT

22
32
31
30
29
28
27

23

26
25

24

B408D104.WMF

22. Tray Junction Gate Solenoid
23. Lower Tray Lift Motor
24. Lower Tray Lower Limit Sensor
25. Stapler Motor
26. Jogger Fence Motor
27. Stack Feed-out Motor
28. Main Board
29. Lower Transport Motor
30. Stapler Junction Gate Solenoid
31. Exit Motor
32. Upper Transport Motor

B408/D588

12

SM

ELECTRICAL COMPONENT DESCRIPTION

4.3 ELECTRICAL COMPONENT DESCRIPTION
Symbol
Motors
M1
M2
M3
M4
M5
M6
M7
M8
M9
M10

Name

Function

Upper
Transport
Lower
Transport
Jogger Fence
Staple Hammer
Stack Feed-out
Exit Guide Plate
Exit
Lower Tray Lift
Shift
Stapler

Drives the entrance roller and upper transport
rollers.
Drives the lower transport rollers and the
positioning roller.
Drives the jogger fences.
Drives the staple hammer.
Drives the stack feed-out belt.
Opens and closes the exit guide plate.
Drives the exit roller.
Moves the lower tray up or down.
Moves the shift roller from side to side.
Moves the stapler unit from side to side.

Entrance

Detects copy paper entering the finisher and
checks for misfeeds.
Detects when the paper stack height in the
upper tray is at its limit.
Detects when the jogger fence is at home
position.
Detects when the shift roller is at home position.
Detects when the stack feed-out belt is at home
position.
Detects when the stapler is at home position.
Detects when the exit guide plate is at home
position.
Detects copy paper entering the stapler tray and
checks for misfeeds.
Checks for misfeeds.
Detects the top of the copy paper stack.
Detects when the lower tray is at its lower limit
position.
Detects when there is copy paper in the stapler
tray.
Detects the leading edge of the staple sheet.
Detects when the staple hammer is at home
position.
Detects whether there are staples in the staple
cartridge.

Index No.
32
29
26
17
27
4
31
23
11
25

S1
S2
S3
S4
S5
S6
S7
S8
S9
S10
S11
S12
S13
S14
S15

Paper Limit
Jogger Fence
HP
Shift HP
Stack Feed-out
Belt HP
Stapler HP
Exit Guide Plate
HP
Stapler Tray
Entrance
Lower Tray Exit
Stack Height
Lower Tray
Lower Limit
Stapler Tray
Paper
Staple Sheet
Stapler Rotation
HP
Staple

3
2
12
10
19
14
5
15
8
7
24
16
18
20
21

Solenoids
SOL1
SOL2

SM

Tray Junction
Gate
Stapler Junction
Gate

Drives the tray junction gate.
Drives the stapler junction gate.

13

22
30

B408/D588

1000-Sheet
Finisher
SR790/SR3090
B408/D588

Sensors

ELECTRICAL COMPONENT DESCRIPTION
Symbol
SOL3

Name
Positioning
Roller

Function
Moves the positioning roller.

Lower Tray
Upper Limit
Front Door
Safety
Upper Cover

Detects when the lower tray is at its upper limit
position.
Cuts the dc power when the front door is
opened.
Cuts the dc power when the upper cover is
opened.

Main

Controls the finisher and communicates with the
copier/printer.

Index No.
13

Switches
SW1
SW2
SW3

9
6
1

PCBs
PCB1

B408/D588

14

28

SM

DRIVE LAYOUT

4.4 DRIVE LAYOUT
1

2

5

4

3

B408D106.WMF

B408D105.WMF

7
8
9

B408D107.WMF

1.
2.
3.
4.
5.

SM

Exit Motor
Upper Transport Motor
Lower Transport Motor
Shift Motor
Exit Guide Plate Motor

6.
7.
8.
9.

15

Lower Tray Lift Motor
Stack Feed-out Motor
Jogger Motor
Stapler Motor

B408/D588

1000-Sheet
Finisher
SR790/SR3090
B408/D588

6

JUNCTION GATES

4.5 JUNCTION GATES

[A]
[C]
[B]
[D]

B408D108.WMF

Depending on the finishing mode, the copies are directed up, straight through, or
down by the combination of the tray junction gate [A] and stapler junction gate [B].
These gates are controlled by the tray junction gate solenoid [C] and stapler
junction gate solenoid [D].

Upper Tray Mode
The tray junction gate solenoid remains off. The copies go up to the upper tray.
Sort/Stack Mode
The tray junction gate solenoid turns on and the stapler junction gate solenoid
remains off. The copies are sent to the lower tray directly.
Staple Mode
The tray junction gate solenoid and the stapler junction gate solenoid both turn on.
The copies go down to the jogger unit.

B408/D588

16

SM

UPPER TRAY

4.6 UPPER TRAY

[A]

When the paper limit sensor [A] switches on during feed-out for each of three
consecutive sheets of paper, paper overflow is detected.

SM

17

B408/D588

1000-Sheet
Finisher
SR790/SR3090
B408/D588

B408D109.WMF

LOWER TRAY UP/DOWN MECHANISMS

4.7 LOWER TRAY UP/DOWN MECHANISMS
[G]
[B]

[F]

[A]

[D]

[E]

[C]

B408D112.WMF

The vertical position of the lower tray [A] depends on the height of the copied paper
stack on the lower tray. The stack height sensor feeler [B] contacts the top of the
stack, and the lower tray lift motor [C] controls the tray height.
When the lower tray reaches its lowest possible position, the actuator [D] turns on
the lower tray lower limit sensor [E], and copying stops.
Tray Up
When the copy paper on the tray is removed, the stack height sensor [F] turns off
and the tray lifts up. Then, the tray stops when the sensor turns on again (the tray
pushes up the feeler).
If the stack height sensor fails, the lower tray upper limit switch [G] detects the tray
and stops the motor. This is a safety measure against stack height sensor failure.
Sort/Stack Mode (Tray Down)
Every five sheets of paper, the tray goes down until the sensor turns off again.
Then, it goes up until the sensor is on again.
Staple Mode (Tray Down)
After a stapled copy is fed out, the tray goes up for 220 ms and stops for 300 ms.
Then, it goes down for 1 second, waits for 500 ms, then goes up until the sensor
turns on.

B408/D588

18

SM

PAPER SHIFT MECHANISM

4.8 PAPER SHIFT MECHANISM
[F]

[C]

[B]
[A]

[D]

B408D110.WMF

In the sort/stack mode, the shift roller [A] moves from side to side to separate the
sets of copies.
The horizontal position of the shift roller is controlled by the shift motor [B] and the
shift gear disk [C]. After the trailing edge of the copy passes the upper transport
roller, the shift motor turns on, driving the shift gear disk and the link [D].
After the paper is delivered to the lower tray [E], the shift roller moves to its home
position, which is detected by the shift HP sensor [F]. Then, when the trailing edge
of the next copy passes the upper transport roller, the shift roller shifts again. This
operation is done every sheet.
When the trailing edge of each page in the next set of copies passes the upper
transport roller, the shift roller shifts in the opposite direction.

SM

19

B408/D588

1000-Sheet
Finisher
SR790/SR3090
B408/D588

[E]

JOGGER UNIT PAPER POSITIONING MECHANISM

4.9 JOGGER UNIT PAPER POSITIONING MECHANISM

B408D113.WMF

[B]

[F]
[E]

[A]
[C]

B408D114.WMF

[D]
In staple mode, each sheet of copy paper is vertically and horizontally aligned
when it arrives in the jogger unit.
For the vertical paper alignment, the positioning roller solenoid [A] turns on shortly
after the stapler tray entrance sensor [B] turns off, and the positioning roller [C]
pushes the copy against the bottom of the stack stopper [D].
For the horizontal paper alignment, the jogger front fence [E] and the rear fence [F]
move to the waiting position, which is 18 mm away from the side of the paper.
When aligning the paper vertically, the jogger fence moves in 14 mm from the
waiting position. After the vertical position has been aligned, the jogger fence
pushes the paper 4 mm against the rear fence to align the paper horizontally. Then
the jogger fence moves back to the previous position.

B408/D588

20

SM

EXIT GUIDE PLATE

4.10 EXIT GUIDE PLATE
[B] [C]

[A]

B408D111.WMF

When stacking a large size of paper (such as A3, DLT) in the jogger unit, the
leading edge of the paper reaches the exit rollers. To prevent the paper from
running into the exit rollers and not being aligned correctly, the exit guide plate [A]
is moved up to make a gap between the exit rollers. This operation is done for all
paper sizes, but is only needed for the larger sizes.
The exit guide plate motor [B] and exit roller release cam [C] control the exit guide
plate movement. When the exit guide plate motor starts, the cam turns and the exit
guide plate moves up. When stapling is finished, the exit guide plate motor turns on
again to close the exit guide plate. When the exit guide plate HP sensor [D] turns
on, the motor stops.

SM

21

B408/D588

1000-Sheet
Finisher
SR790/SR3090
B408/D588

[D]

STAPLER MECHANISM

4.11 STAPLER MECHANISM
[E]

[B]

[D]
[C]
[A]

B408D116.WMF

The staple hammer motor [A] drives the staple hammer.
The staple sheet sensor [B] detects the leading edge of the staple sheet at the
stapling position to prevent the hammer from operating if there are no staples at
the stapling position.
If there is no staple cartridge in the stapler unit or no staples in the staple cartridge,
staple end is indicated on the operation panel. The stapler sensor [C] detects this.
The stapler rotation HP sensor [D] checks whether the staple hammer mechanism
returns to home position after each stack has been stapled.
When excessive load is applied to the staple hammer motor, the copier detects a
staple jam. When a staple jam has occurred, the jammed staple is inside the staple
cartridge [E]. Therefore, the jammed staple can be removed easily after pulling out
the staple cartridge.

B408/D588

22

SM

STAPLER UNIT MOVEMENT MECHANISM

4.12 STAPLER UNIT MOVEMENT MECHANISM

[B]

[A]

The stapler motor moves the stapler [A] from side to side. After the start key is
pressed, the stapler moves from its home position to the stapling position.
If two-staple-position mode is selected, the stapler moves to the front stapling
position first, then moves to the rear stapling position. However, for the next copy
set, it staples in the reverse order (at the rear side first, then at the front side).
After the job is completed, the stapler moves back to its home position. The stapler
HP sensor [B] detects this.

SM

23

B408/D588

1000-Sheet
Finisher
SR790/SR3090
B408/D588

B408D117.WMF

PAPER FEED-OUT MECHANISM

4.13 PAPER FEED-OUT MECHANISM

[A]

[B]
[C]
[D]

B408D118.WMF

After the copies have been stapled, the stack feed-out motor [A] starts. The pawl
[B] on the stack feed-out belt [C] transports the set of stapled copies up and feeds
it to the shift roller. The shift roller takes over stack feed-out after the leading edge
reaches this roller.
Just before the stapled stack passes through the lower tray exit sensor, the stackfeed-out motor turns off until the shift rollers have completely fed the stack out to
the lower tray. Then, the stack-feed-out motor turns on again until the pawl [B]
actuates the stack feed-out belt home position sensor [D].

B408/D588

24

SM

B802/D630
ARDF DF3010/DF3070
R E V I S I O N H I S T O RY
P ag e

Dat e

Ad d ed/ Upd at ed/ New
None

ARDF DF3010/DF3070 (B802/D630)
TABLE OF CONTENTS
1. REPLACEMENT AND ADJUSTMENT........................................... 1
1.1 COVERS AND TRAY .....................................................................................1
1.1.1 FRONT AND REAR COVER ................................................................1
1.1.2 ORIGINAL TRAY ..................................................................................2
1.2 DOCUMENT FEED COMPONENTS .............................................................3
1.2.1 PICK-UP ROLLER ................................................................................3
1.2.2 FEED BELT ..........................................................................................4
1.2.3 SEPARATION ROLLER .......................................................................6
1.3 ELECTRICAL COMPONENTS ......................................................................7
1.3.1 DF DRIVE BOARD ...............................................................................7
1.3.2 ORIGINAL LENGTH SENSORS AND TRAILING EDGE SENSOR......8
1.3.3 ORIGINAL SET, SEPARATION, SKEW CORRECTION AND
SCANNING ENTRANCE SENSOR ...............................................................9
1.3.4 ORIGINAL WIDTH SENSORS ...........................................................10
1.3.5 REGISTRATION SENSOR .................................................................10
1.3.6 ORIGINAL EXIT SENSOR..................................................................11
1.3.7 DF POSITION SENSOR .....................................................................12
1.3.8 COVER SENSOR ...............................................................................12
1.3.9 PICK-UP ROLLER HP AND ORIGINAL STOPPER HP SENSOR .....13
1.3.10
STAMP SOLENOID .....................................................................14
1.4 ORIGINAL FEED DRIVE .............................................................................16
1.4.1 ADF FEED MOTOR ............................................................................16
1.4.2 ADF INVERTER MOTOR ...................................................................17
1.4.3 ADF TRANSPORT MOTOR ...............................................................17
1.4.4 ADF PICK-UP MOTOR .......................................................................18

2. DETAILED DESCRIPTIONS ........................................................ 19
2.1 COMPONENT LAYOUT ..............................................................................19
2.1.1 MECHANICAL COMPONENT LAYOUT .............................................19
2.1.2 ELECTRICAL COMPONENT LAYOUT ..............................................20
Sensors and Drive Components ............................................................20
Electrical Component Descriptions ........................................................21
2.1.3 DRIVE LAYOUT .................................................................................23
SM

i

B802/D630

ADF Feed Motor.....................................................................................24
ADF Transport Motor and ADF Inverter Motor .......................................24
2.2 BASIC OPERATION ....................................................................................25
2.2.1 ORIGINAL SIZE DETECTION ............................................................25
2.2.2 MIXED ORIGINAL SIZE MODE ..........................................................27
Document length detection.....................................................................27
Feed-in cycle ..........................................................................................27
Normal feed-in........................................................................................28
2.2.3 PICK-UP AND SEPARATION .............................................................28
2.2.4 SKEW CORRECTION ........................................................................29
2.2.5 SLIP DETECTION ..............................................................................30
2.2.6 ORIGINAL TRANSPORT AND EXIT ..................................................31
Single-Sided Originals ............................................................................31
Double-Sided Originals ..........................................................................31
Original Sensor ......................................................................................32
2.2.7 CONDITIONS FOR JAM DETECTION ...............................................33

3. SERVICE TABLES ....................................................................... 34
3.1 DIP SWITCHES ...........................................................................................34

B802/D630

ii

SM

READ THIS FIRST
Safety and Symbols
Replacement Procedure Safety


Turn off the main power switch and unplug the machine before beginning any of the
replacement procedures in this manual.

Symbols Used in this Manual
This manual uses the following symbols.
: See or Refer to
: Screws
: Connector
: Clip ring
: E-ring
: Clamp

Covers and Tray

ARDF
DF3010/
DF3070
(B802/D630)

1. REPLACEMENT AND ADJUSTMENT
1.1 COVERS AND TRAY
1.1.1 FRONT AND REAR COVER

1.

Open the left cover [A].

2.

Front cover [B] ( x 1, hook x 2)

3.

Rear cover [C] (x 2, hook x 2)

SM

1

B802/D630

Covers and Tray

1.1.2 ORIGINAL TRAY
1.

Open the left cover.

2.

Rear cover ( "Front and Rear Cover")

3.

Front cover ( "Front and Rear Cover")

4.

Pivot cover [A] ( x 1)

5.

Original tray [B] (x 1,  x 1,  x 2)

B802/D630

2

SM

Document Feed Components

ARDF
DF3010/
DF3070
(B802/D630)

1.2 DOCUMENT FEED COMPONENTS
1.2.1 PICK-UP ROLLER

1.

Open the left cover.

2.

Bushings [A] ( x 1 each)

3.

Pick-up roller [B] (gear x 1, one-way gear x 1)

SM

3

B802/D630

Document Feed Components

1.2.2 FEED BELT
1.

Open the left cover.

2.

Front feed unit cover [A]

3.

Rear feed unit cover [B] (hook x 2)

4.

Feed belt unit [C]

B802/D630

4

SM

ARDF
DF3010/
DF3070
(B802/D630)

Document Feed Components

5.

Slide the tension plate [D] (hook)

6.

Belt unit cover [E] ( x 1)

7.

Belt tension unit [F]

8.

Feed belt [G]

SM

5

B802/D630

Document Feed Components

1.2.3 SEPARATION ROLLER
1.

Open the left cover.

2.

Separation roller cover [A]

3.

Remove the bushing [B] ( x 1).

4.

Slide the separation roller shaft to the front side, and then remove it.

5.

Separation roller [C] ( x 1)

B802/D630

6

SM

Electrical Components

ARDF
DF3010/
DF3070
(B802/D630)

1.3 ELECTRICAL COMPONENTS
1.3.1 DF DRIVE BOARD
1.

Rear cover ("Front and Rear Cover")

2.

DF drive board [A] ( x 4, all s)

SM

7

B802/D630

Electrical Components

1.3.2 ORIGINAL LENGTH SENSORS AND TRAILING EDGE
SENSOR
1.

Open the left cover.

2.

Remove the tray stopper [A], while pushing the hook with a screw driver.

3.

Open the original tray [B].

4.

Original tray cover [C] ( x 3)

5.

Original trailing edge sensor [D] (

6.

Original length sensors [E] (

B802/D630

x 1, hook)

x 1 each, hook)

8

SM

1.3.3 ORIGINAL SET, SEPARATION, SKEW CORRECTION AND
SCANNING ENTRANCE SENSOR
1.

Open the left cover.

2.

Open the inner upper cover [A] (stepped screw x 3).

3.

Original set sensor [B] ( x 1, hook)

4.

Separation sensor [C] ( x 1, hook)

5.

Skew correction sensor [D] ( x 1, hook)

6.

Scanning entrance sensor [E] ( x 1, hook)

SM

9

B802/D630

ARDF
DF3010/
DF3070
(B802/D630)

Electrical Components

Electrical Components

1.3.4 ORIGINAL WIDTH SENSORS
1.

Open the left cover.

2.

Open the inner upper cover ( " Original Set, Separation, Skew Correction and
Registration Sensor").

3.

Original width sensor bracket [A] ( x 2, ground cable x 1).

4.

Original width sensors [B] (

x 1 each, hook)

1.3.5 REGISTRATION SENSOR
1.

Open the ARDF.

2.

White plate [A] (stud screw x 1)

3.

Registration sensor bracket [B] ( x 1)

4.

Registration sensor [C] ( x 1)

B802/D630

10

SM

Electrical Components

ARDF
DF3010/
DF3070
(B802/D630)

1.3.6 ORIGINAL EXIT SENSOR
1.

Open the left cover.

2.

Open the feed-in guide plate [A].

3.

Guide plate [B] ( x 2, stepped screw x 1; front side)

4.

Original exit sensor [C] ( x 1, hook)

SM

11

B802/D630

Electrical Components

1.3.7 DF POSITION SENSOR
1.

Rear cover ( "Front and Rear Cover")

2.

ARDF drive board ( "ARDF Drive Board")

3.

DF position sensor bracket [A] ( x 1)

4.

DF position sensor [B] ( x 1, hook)

1.3.8 COVER SENSOR
1.

Open the left cover.

2.

Rear cover ( "Front and Rear Cover")

3.

Cover sensor [A] ( x 1, hook)

B802/D630

12

SM

Electrical Components

1.

Open the left cover.

2.

Rear cover ( "Front and Rear Cover")

3.

Release the clamp [A] ( x 1), and then slide the harnesses away.

4.

Sensor bracket [B] ( x 1,  x 2)

5.

Pick-up roller HP sensor [C] (hook)

6.

Original stopper HP sensor [D] (hook)

SM

13

ARDF
DF3010/
DF3070
(B802/D630)

1.3.9 PICK-UP ROLLER HP AND ORIGINAL STOPPER HP
SENSOR

B802/D630

Electrical Components

1.3.10 STAMP SOLENOID
1.

Open the left cover.

2.

Remove the platen plate [A].

3.

Stamp solenoid cover [B] ( x 1)

4.

Remove the screw [C] ( x 1).


You cannot remove the stamp solenoid at this time.

5.

Rear cover ( "Front and Rear Cover")

6.

Disconnect the stamp solenoid harness [D].

7.

ADF feed motor ( "ADF Feed Motor")

B802/D630

14

SM

ARDF
DF3010/
DF3070
(B802/D630)

Electrical Components

8.

Put the stamp solenoid harness into the cutout [E].

9.

Pull out the stamp solenoid [F]

SM

15

B802/D630

Original Feed Drive

1.4 ORIGINAL FEED DRIVE
1.4.1 ADF FEED MOTOR
1.

Rear cover ( "Front and Rear Cover")

2.

Harness guide [A] ( x 2, all s, all s)

3.

Remove the spring [B].

4.

Stay bracket [C] (stepped screw x 1)

5.

Slide the feed motor gear [D] to the left side (seen from the front of the machine), and
then remove the timing belt [E].

6.

ADF feed motor bracket [F] ( x 3)

7.

ADF feed motor [G] ( x 1)

B802/D630

16

SM

Original Feed Drive

ARDF
DF3010/
DF3070
(B802/D630)

1.4.2 ADF INVERTER MOTOR
1.

ADF feed motor ( " ADF Feed Motor")

2.

ADF inverter motor bracket [A] ( x 2,  x 1, timing belt)

3.

ADF inverter motor [B] ( x 4)

1.4.3 ADF TRANSPORT MOTOR
1.

Rear cover ( "Front and Rear Cover")

2.

Ground cable [A] ( x 1)

3.

ADF transport motor bracket [B] ( x 2,  x 1)

4.

ADF transport motor [C] ( x 2)

SM

17

B802/D630

Original Feed Drive

1.4.4 ADF PICK-UP MOTOR
1.

Rear cover ( "Front and Rear Cover")

2.

Harness guide [A] ( x 2, all s, all s)

3.

Stay bracket [B] (stepped screw x 1)

4.

Release 6 clamps on the ADF pick-up motor bracket [C] ( x 6).

5.

ADF pick-up motor bracket [D] ( x 3,

6.

ADF pick-up motor [E] ( x 2,  x 1, timing belt)

B802/D630

x 1)

18

SM

Component Layout

ARDF
DF3010/
DF3070
(B802/D630)

2. DETAILED DESCRIPTIONS
2.1 COMPONENT LAYOUT
2.1.1 MECHANICAL COMPONENT LAYOUT

1. Original Width Sensor
2. Skew Correction Roller
3. Skew Correction Sensor
4. Separation Sensor
5. Feed Belt
6. Separation Roller
7. Original Set Sensor
8. Pick-up Roller
9. Original Length Sensor 1
10. Original Length Sensor 2

SM

11. Original Length Sensor 3
12. Inverter Roller
13. Junction Gate
14. Exit Roller
15. Original Exit Sensor
16. Transport Roller
17. Registration Sensor
18. Registration Roller
19. Scanning Entrance Sensor

19

B802/D630

Component Layout

2.1.2 ELECTRICAL COMPONENT LAYOUT
Sensors and Drive Components

1. Original Width Sensors
2. Scanning Entrance Sensor
3. Skew Correction Sensor
4. ADF Transport Motor
5. Left Cover Sensor
6. Pick-up Motor
7. Pick-up Roller HP Sensor
8. Original Stopper HP Sensor
9. ADF Inverter Motor
10. ADF Feed Motor
11. Original Length Sensor 1

B802/D630

12. Original Length Sensor 2
13. Original Length Sensor 4
14. DF Drive Board
15. Original Trailing Edge Sensor
16. Original Set Sensor
17. Stamp Solenoid
18. Separation Sensor
19. Original Exit Sensor
20. Junction Gate Solenoid
21. Registration Sensor

20

SM

Electrical Component Descriptions

Symbol

Name

Function

Index No.

Motors
Drives the feed belt, separation, pick-up, and

-

ADF Feed

-

ADF Transport

Drives the transport and exit rollers

4

-

ADF Inverter

Drives the Inverter rollers

9

-

Pick-up Motor

Moves the pick-up roller up and down.

6

-

DF Position

Detects whether the DF is lifted or not.

-

Skew Correction

-

Registration

-

Cover Sensor

reverse table rollers.

10

Sensors

-

-

-

-

-

SM

Original Width
Sensor - S
Original Width
Sensor - M
Original Width
Sensor - L
Original Width
Sensor - LL
Original Length S

Detects the leading edge of the original to turn
off the DF feed and transport motors.
Detects the original exposure timing, and
checks for original misfeeds.
Detects whether the feed-in cover is opened
or not.

3

21

4

Detects the original width - S.

1

Detects the original width - M.

1

Detects the original width - L.

1

Detects the original width - LL.

1

Detects the original length - S.

11

21

B802/D630

ARDF
DF3010/
DF3070
(B802/D630)

Component Layout

Component Layout

-

Original Length -

Detects the original length - M.

12

-

Original Length - L Detects the original length - L.

13

-

Original Set

16

M

Detects if an original is on the feed table.
Detects the leading edge of the original to turn
on the junction gate solenoid and checks for
original misfeeds.

-

Original Exit

Detects the trailing edge of the original to turn
off the transport and feed motor and junction

19

gate solenoid.
In single-sided mode, used to detect original
misfeeds.
Detects the trailing edge of the last original to
-

Original Trailing

stop copy paper feed and to turn off the

Edge Sensor

transport motor, and checks for original

15

misfeeds.
The machine uses this sensor to check if the
-

Separation

original has slipped during feed-in, to make

Sensor

sure that original feed starts at the correct

18

time.

Solenoids
-

Stamp

Energizes the stamper to mark the original.

17

-

Junction Gate

Opens and closes the junction gate.

20

PCBs
Interfaces the sensor signals with the copier,
-

DF Drive

and transfers the magnetic clutch, solenoid

14

and motor drive signals from the copier.

B802/D630

22

SM

Component Layout

ARDF
DF3010/
DF3070
(B802/D630)

2.1.3 DRIVE LAYOUT

1. Registration Roller
2. Transport Roller
3. Skew Correction Roller
4. Separation Roller
5. Feed Belt
6. ADF Transport Motor
7. Pick-up Roller
8. Exit Roller
9. ADF Inverter Motor
10. ADF Feed Motor
11. Inverter Roller

SM

23

B802/D630

Component Layout

ADF Feed Motor



ADF Feed Motor [A] drives the pick-up [B], feed belt [C], separation [D] and skew correction
rollers [E].

ADF Transport Motor and ADF Inverter Motor



ADF Transport Motor [A] drives the registration roller [B], transport roller [C] and exit roller [D].



ADF Inverter Motor [E] drives the Inverter Roller [F].

B802/D630

24

SM

Basic Operation

ARDF
DF3010/
DF3070
(B802/D630)

2.2 BASIC OPERATION
2.2.1 ORIGINAL SIZE DETECTION

The original size detection mechanism consists of the five original width sensors ([A]: Width
Sensor SS, [B]: Width Sensor S, [C] Width Sensor M, [D]: Width Sensor L, [E]: Width Sensor LL)
and three original length sensors ([F]: Length Sensor S, [G]: Length Sensor M, [H]: Length Sensor
L). Based on the combined output of the length sensors and the width sensors, the machine can
detect the size of the original. This integrated detection mechanism is detailed in the table below.

Width Sensor

Length Sensor

Area

Size
SS

S

M

L

LL

S

M

L

LT

A/B

A3/SEF (297 x 420)

ON

ON

ON

ON

ON

ON

ON

ON

O

O

B4/SEF (257 x 364)

ON

ON

ON

-

-

ON

ON

ON

-

O

A4/SEF (210 x 297)

ON

ON

-

-

-

ON

ON

-

O

O

A4/LEF (297 x 210)

ON

ON

ON

ON

ON

-

-

-

O

O

B5/SEF (182 x 257)

ON

-

-

-

-

ON

-

-

-

O

B5/LEF (257 x 182)

ON

ON

ON

-

-

-

-

-

-

O

A5/SEF (148 x 210)

ON

-

-

-

-

-

-

-

-

O

SM

25

B802/D630

Basic Operation

A5/LEF (210 x 148)

ON

ON

-

-

-

-

-

-

-

O

ON

ON

ON

ON

-

ON

ON

ON

O1

O5

11" x 15"/SEF

ON

ON

ON

ON

-

ON

ON

ON

1

10" x 14"/SEF

ON

ON

ON

ON

ON

ON

ON

ON

O

-

8.5" x 14"/SEF (LG)

ON

ON

-

-

-

ON

ON

ON

O2

-

8.5" x 13"/SEF (F4)

ON

ON

-

-

-

ON

ON

ON

2

8.25" x 13"/SEF

ON

ON

-

-

-

ON

ON

ON

-

-

8" x 13"/SEF (F)

ON

ON

-

-

-

ON

ON

ON

-

-

8.5" x 11"/SEF (LT)

ON

ON

-

-

-

ON

-

-

O3

O6

8.5" x 11"/LEF (LT)

ON

ON

ON

On

-

-

-

-

O4

O7

ON

ON

-

-

-

ON

-

-

O

-

ON

ON

ON

ON

-

-

-

-

4

-

ON

ON

-

-

-

ON

-

-

3

-

-

-

-

-

-

-

-

-

O

-

ON

ON

-

-

-

-

-

-

O

-

267 mm x 390 mm

ON

ON

ON

ON

-

ON

ON

ON

-

5

195 mm x 267 mm

ON

ON

-

-

-

ON

-

-

-

6

267 mm x 195 mm

ON

ON

ON

ON

-

-

-

-

-

7

11" x 17"/SEF
(DLT)

7.25" x 10.5"/SEF
(US EXE)
10.5" x 7.25"/SEF
(US EXE)
10" x 8"/SEF
5.5" x 8.5"/SEF
(HLT)
5.5" x 8.5"/LEF
(HLT)

-

O

Symbols
O: Yes (Default),

: Yes (Can select this with SP mode), ON: Paper present, LT: North America,

A/B: Europe, Asia

B802/D630

26

SM



For "O/ " mark, which has superscripted number, it is possible to change the original
detection size with SP6-016. For example, instead of LT (O3), the machine can be set up
to detect 10” x 8” (

3

).



The F size can be selected with SP5-126. The default is 8.5" x 13"



The machine cannot detect more than one size of original in the same job.

2.2.2 MIXED ORIGINAL SIZE MODE
This section explains what happens when the user selects mixed original size mode.
Because this ARDF is a sheet-through document feeder, the method for original document width
detection is the same as when the originals are the same size, but the document length detection
method is different. Therefore, the scanning speed is slightly slower.

Document length detection
From when the skew correction sensor switches on until it switches off, the CPU counts the
transport motor pulses. The number of pulses determines the length of the original.

Feed-in cycle
When the original size for the copy modes listed below cannot be determined, the image cannot
be correctly scaled (reduced or enlarged) or processed until the original’s length has been
accurately detected. The length must be determined before the image is scanned.

Auto Reduce/Enlarge
Centering
Erase Center/Border
Booklet
Image Repeat

The originals follow this path:
Scanning glass

Inverter table

1.

Length detection

2.

Inverter table

Scanning glass

3.

Inverter table

Scanning glass (image scanned)

SM

Inverter table (restores the original order)

27

Exit tray

B802/D630

ARDF
DF3010/
DF3070
(B802/D630)

Basic Operation

Basic Operation

Normal feed-in
In a copy mode other than those listed above, when the reduction/enlargement ratio has been
determined, the originals are scanned normally. In order to store the scanned images, a large
area of memory (the detected original width x 432 mm length) is prepared. Next, only the portion
of the image up to the detected original length is read from memory and printed.

2.2.3 PICK-UP AND SEPARATION

The original is set with the image facing up. The original pushes actuator and the original set
sensor is activated.
After pressing the start button, the pick-up motor is activated and the original feed unit [A] moves
down. At the same time, the ADF feed motor is activated and the pick-up roller [B] feeds original to
the feed belt [C].
After being fed from feed belt [C], the topmost sheet is separated from the stack by the separation
roller [D] and sent to the skew correction roller.
The mechanism is an FRR system, consisting of the original feed belt [C] and separation roller
[D].

B802/D630

28

SM

Basic Operation

ARDF
DF3010/
DF3070
(B802/D630)

2.2.4 SKEW CORRECTION

When an original is fed into the feeder, the feed motor [A] rotates forwards. At this time, the feed
belt turns but the skew correction roller [B] does not, because these rollers have a one-way gear.
(If the ADF feed motor rotates forward, the feed belt is moved. If the ADF feed motor rotates in
reverse, the skew correction roller is moved.) As a result, when the leading edge of the paper
gets to the skew correction roller, skew in the original is removed.
A short time after the leading edge of the original turns on the skew correction sensor [C], the feed
motor [A] turns off and rotates in reverse. At this time, the skew correction roller [B] and the feed
belt [D] both turn, and original feed continues.
The registration roller also has the same skew correction mechanism, but only for small size
originals (6, A5 or HLT). This function can be effective for all size paper with SP6-020-001.

SM

29

B802/D630

Basic Operation

2.2.5 SLIP DETECTION

[A]: Separation sensor
[B]: Skew correction sensor
These two sensors are used to measure the amount of slippage and to correct for this.
The machine measures the time it takes for the original to get to the separation sensor [A] after
the [Start] key is pressed.


If the original arrives at the correct time, it feeds normally.



If the original arrives late, the machine enters the slip mode.

In the slip mode, the machine measures the time for the leading edge of the original to move from
the separation sensor to the skew correction sensor [B].
The machine uses this time to adjust the length of time that the entrance roller stays off to correct
skew. This stops feed for enough time for the original to be in the correct position for feeding.

B802/D630

30

SM

Basic Operation

ARDF
DF3010/
DF3070
(B802/D630)

2.2.6 ORIGINAL TRANSPORT AND EXIT
Single-Sided Originals

The feed motor feeds the separated original to the skew correction roller [A] at maximum speed.
After skew correction, the feed and transport motors feed the original through the scanning area at
a lower speed (the scanning area contains the original exposure guide [B] and DF exposure glass
[C]). After scanning, the original is fed out by the transport roller [D] and exit roller [E].

Double-Sided Originals

After skew correction, the ADF feed and transport motors drive the skew correction roller [A],
registration roller [B], transport roller [C] and the exit roller [D]. The front side of the original is then
scanned.
When the original exit sensor [E] detects the leading edge of the original, the junction gate
solenoid is activated and the junction gate [F] opens. The original is then transported towards the
inverter table.
Soon after the trailing edge of the original passes the exit sensor, the junction gate solenoid
switches off and the junction gate [F] is closed. When the original has been fed onto the inverter
table, the ADF inverter motor switches on. The original is then fed by the inverter roller [G], and
then by the skew correction roller [A] and registration roller [B] to the scanning area (where the
reverse side will be scanned).

SM

31

B802/D630

Basic Operation

The original is then sent to the inverter table [H] again to be turned over. This is done so that the
duplex copies will be properly stacked front side down in the exit tray [I] in the correct order.

Original Sensor
During one-to-one copying, copy paper is fed to the skew correction roller in advance (while the
original is still being scanned), to increase the copy speed. The original set sensor monitors the
stack of originals in the feeder, and detects when the trailing edge of the last page has been fed in.
The main CPU then stops the copier from feeding an unwanted extra sheet of copy paper.

B802/D630

32

SM

Basic Operation

Jam Mode

ARDF
DF3010/
DF3070
(B802/D630)

2.2.7 CONDITIONS FOR JAM DETECTION

Detection Timing
When turning on the machine, the skew correction sensor, separation
sensor, registration sensor or exit sensor detects an original.

Initial

When the cover is closed or DF is down, the skew correction sensor,
separation sensor, registration sensor or exit sensor detects an original.
When the cover is opened or DF is lifted up, the skew correction sensor,
separation sensor, registration sensor or exit sensor detects an original.
The skew correction sensor does not turn off even if the original was fed
by the maximum length of the original + 150 mm after the skew
correction sensor turned on.

Sensor stays
on too long

The registration sensor does not turn off even if the original was fed by
its length x 1.5 after the registration sensor turned on.
The exit sensor does not turn off even if the original was fed by its
length x 1.5 after the exit sensor turned on.
The separation sensor does not turn on even if the original was fed by
transport path length x 1.5.
The skew correction sensor does not turn on even if the original was fed

Sensor does

by transport path length x 1.5.

not come on

The registration sensor does not turn on even if the original was fed by
transport path length x 1.5 after the skew correction sensor turned on.
The exit sensor does not turn on even the original was fed by transport
path length x 1.5 after the skew correction sensor turned on.

SM

33

B802/D630

Dip Switches

3. SERVICE TABLES
3.1 DIP SWITCHES

DIP-SW
Function
1

2

3

4

0

0

0

0

Normal operating mode (Default)

0

0

0

1

Free run: With original: One-sided mode: 100% speed

0

0

1

0

Free run: With original: Two-sided mode: 100% speed

0

0

1

1

Free run: No original: One-sided mode: 100% speed

0

1

0

0

Free run: No original: Two-sided mode: 100% speed

0

1

0

1

Free run: With original: One-sided mode: 32% speed

0

1

1

0

Free run: With original: Two-sided mode: 32% speed

0

1

1

1

Free run: With original: One-sided mode: 70% speed

1

0

0

0

Free run: With original: Two-sided mode: 70% speed

1

0

0

1

Free run: With original: One-sided mode: 200% speed

1

0

1

0

Free run: With original: Two-sided mode: 200% speed

1

0

1

1

Transport Motor On

1

1

0

0

Feed Motor On

1

1

0

1

Transport Motor On with random mode

1

1

1

0

Feed Motor On with random mode

1

1

1

1

B802/D630

34

SM

D386/D634
BRIDGE UNIT BU3030/BU3060
R E V I S I O N H I S T O RY
P ag e

Dat e

Ad d ed/ Upd at ed/ New
None

BRIDGE UNIT BU3030/BU3060
(D386/D634)
TABLE OF CONTENTS
1. REPLACEMENT AND ADJUSTMENT........................................... 1
1.1 BRIDGE UNIT CONTROL BOARD................................................................1
1.2 BRIDGE UNIT DRIVE MOTOR......................................................................2
1.3 TRAY EXIT SENSOR ....................................................................................3
1.4 RELAY SENSOR ...........................................................................................4

2. DETAILS ........................................................................................ 5
2.1 MECHANICAL COMPONENT LAYOUT ........................................................5
2.2 DRIVE LAYOUT.............................................................................................6
2.3 ELECTRICAL COMPONENT LAYOUT .........................................................7
2.4 ELECTRICAL COMPONENT DESCRIPTION ...............................................8
2.5 JUNCTION GATE MECHANISM ...................................................................9

SM

i

D386/D634

READ THIS FIRST
Safety and Symbols
Replacement Procedure Safety


Turn off the main power switch and unplug the machine before beginning any of the
replacement procedures in this manual.

When taking apart the bridge unit, first take the unit out of the copier.
Symbols Used in this Manual
This manual uses the following symbols.
: See or Refer to
: Screws
: Connector
: Clip ring
: E-ring

Bridge Unit Control Board

1. REPLACEMENT AND ADJUSTMENT
1.1 BRIDGE UNIT CONTROL BOARD

Bridge unit ( "Installation Procedure" in the base copier manual)

2.

Rear cover [A] ( x 2)

3.

Bridge unit control board [B] ( x 3,  x 4)

Bridge Unit
BU3030/
BU3060
(D386/D634)

1.

SM

1

D386/D634

Bridge Unit Drive Motor

1.2 BRIDGE UNIT DRIVE MOTOR

1.

Bridge unit ( "Installation Procedure" in the base copier manual)

2.

Rear cover ( "Bridge Unit Control Board")

3.

Bracket [A] ( x 3,  x 2)

4.

Bridge unit drive motor [B] ( x 4,  x 1)

D386/D634

2

SM

Tray Exit Sensor

1.3 TRAY EXIT SENSOR

Bridge unit ( "Installation Procedure" in the base copier manual)

2.

Rear cover ( "Bridge Unit Control Board")

3.

Paper tray [A]

4.

Exit guide [B] ( x 1)

5.

Tray exit sensor [C] ( x 1)

Bridge Unit
BU3030/
BU3060
(D386/D634)

1.

SM

3

D386/D634

Relay Sensor

1.4 RELAY SENSOR

1.

Bridge unit ( "Installation Procedure" in the base copier manual)

2.

Paper tray [A]

3.

Relay sensor [B] ( x 1)

D386/D634

4

SM

Mechanical Component Layout

2. DETAILS
2.1 MECHANICAL COMPONENT LAYOUT

5. Relay Sensor

2. Tray Exit Sensor

6. 2nd Transport Roller

3. Junction Gate

7. Left Exit Roller

4. 1st Transport Roller

8. Paper Tray

Bridge Unit
BU3030/
BU3060
(D386/D634)

1. Upper Exit Roller

SM

5

D386/D634

Drive Layout

2.2 DRIVE LAYOUT

1.

Left Exit Roller

2.

2nd Transport Roller

3.

1st Transport Roller

4.

Upper Exit Roller

5.

Bridge Unit Drive Motor

D386/D634

6

SM

Electrical Component Layout

2.3 ELECTRICAL COMPONENT LAYOUT

Left Guide Switch

2.

Right Guide Switch

3.

Junction Gate Solenoid

4.

Tray Exit Sensor

5.

Bridge Unit Control Board

6.

Bridge Unit Drive Motor

7.

Relay Sensor

Bridge Unit
BU3030/
BU3060
(D386/D634)

1.

SM

7

D386/D634

Electrical Component Description

2.4 ELECTRICAL COMPONENT DESCRIPTION

Symbol

Name

Function

Index No.

Motors
M1

Drive Motor

Drives the bridge unit.

6

S1

Tray Exit

Checks for misfeeds.

4

S2

Relay

Checks for misfeeds.

7

SW2

Right Guide

Detects when the right guide is opened.

2

SW3

Left Guide

Detects when the left guide is opened.

1

Sensors

Switches

Solenoids
Moves the junction gate to direct the paper
SOL1

Junction Gate

to the upper tray (on top of the bridge unit) or

3

to the finisher.
PCBs

PCB1

D386/D634

Bridge Unit
Control Board

Controls the bridge unit.

8

5

SM

Junction Gate Mechanism

2.5 JUNCTION GATE MECHANISM

The junction gate [A] directs any paper reaching the bridge unit to either the upper tray (on top of
the bridge unit) or to the finisher, depending on which has been selected.
If the junction gate solenoid has been activated, the junction gate [A] points downward and directs
the paper to the upper tray [B] (dotted line path in illustration). When the solenoid is off, the
junction gate points upward and the paper is fed out to the finisher [C] by the transport and left exit

Bridge Unit
BU3030/
BU3060
(D386/D634)

rollers (solid line).

SM

9

D386/D634

PB3110(D537)/PB3130(D580)
PAPER FEED UNIT
R E V I S I O N H I S T O RY
P ag e

Dat e

Ad d ed/ Upd at ed/ New
None

PAPER FEED UNIT (D537/D580)
TABLE OF CONTENTS
1. REPLACEMENT AND ADJUSTMENT ........................................... 1
1.1 EXTERIOR COVER ....................................................................................... 1
1.1.1 REAR COVER ...................................................................................... 1
1.2 ELECTRICAL COMPONENTS ...................................................................... 2
1.2.1 LIFT MOTORS...................................................................................... 2
1.2.2 UPPER AND LOWER PAPER FEED CLUTCHES ............................... 3
1.2.3 PAPER FEED MOTOR ......................................................................... 4
1.2.4 MAIN BOARD ....................................................................................... 4
1.3 FEED ............................................................................................................. 5
1.3.1 PAPER FEED UNIT.............................................................................. 5
1.3.2 PICK-UP, PAPER FEED AND SEPARATION ROLLERS .................... 6
1.3.3 LIFT, PAPER END, AND RELAY SENSORS ....................................... 7

SM

i

D537/D580

Exterior Cover

1. REPLACEMENT AND ADJUSTMENT
1.1 EXTERIOR COVER

1.

Securing brackets [A] (

2.

Rear cover [B] (

SM

Paper Feed
Unit PB3110/
PB3130
D537/D580

1.1.1 REAR COVER

x 1 each)

x 2)

1

D537/D580

Electrical Components

1.2 ELECTRICAL COMPONENTS
1.2.1 LIFT MOTORS

1.

Rear cover (

2.

Lift motors [A][B] (

D537/D580

"Rear Cover")
x 2,

x 1 each)

2

SM

Electrical Components

Paper Feed
Unit PB3110/
PB3130
D537/D580

1.2.2 UPPER AND LOWER PAPER FEED CLUTCHES

1.

Rear cover (

2.

Upper paper feed gear unit [A] (

3.

Upper paper feed clutch bracket [B] (

4.

Upper paper feed clutch [C]

5.

Lower paper feed clutch bracket [D] (

6.

Lower paper feed clutch [E] (

SM

"Rear Cover")
x 3,

x 1)
x 1,

x 2, bushing x 1)

x 1, bushing x 1,

x 2)

x 1)

3

D537/D580

Electrical Components

1.2.3 PAPER FEED MOTOR

"Rear Cover")

1.

Rear cover (

2.

Paper feed motor [A] (


x 1,

x 2)

When installing the paper feed motor, make sure that the gear of the paper feed
motor holds the timing belt [B].

1.2.4 MAIN BOARD

1.

Rear cover (

2.

Main board [A] (All

D537/D580

"Rear Cover")
s,

x 2, snap pin x 2)

4

SM

Feed

1.3 FEED

Paper Feed
Unit PB3110/
PB3130
D537/D580

1.3.1 PAPER FEED UNIT

1.

Right cover [A] (

x 2)

2.

Vertical transport guide [B] of the paper feed unit

3.

Pull the tray 3 (or 4).

4.

Paper guide [C]

5.

Paper feed unit [D] (

x 2,

x 1,

x 2)

When replacing the paper feed unit of tray 4, do the same.

SM

5

D537/D580

Feed

1.3.2 PICK-UP, PAPER FEED AND SEPARATION ROLLERS

1.

Paper feed unit (

"Paper Feed Unit)

2.

Roller holder [A] (

x 1)

3.

Pick-up roller [B]

4.

Paper feed roller [C]

5.

Separation roller [D] (

D537/D580

x 1)

6

SM

Feed

Paper Feed
Unit PB3110/
PB3130
D537/D580

1.3.3 LIFT, PAPER END, AND RELAY SENSORS

1.

Paper feed unit (

2.

Vertical transport sensor bracket [A] (

3.

Vertical transport sensor [B] (

4.

Paper feed sensor bracket [C] (

5.

Paper feed sensor [D] (

6.

Paper end sensor filler [E]

7.

Paper end sensor [F] (

8.

Lift sensor [G] (

SM

"Paper Feed Unit")
x 1)

x 1)
x 1)

x 1)
x 1)

x 1)

7

D537/D580

PB3110(D538)/PB3140(D581)
LARGE CAPACITY TRAY
R E V I S I O N H I S T O RY
P ag e

Dat e

Ad d ed/ Upd at ed/ New
None

LARGE CAPACITY TRAY (D538/D581)
TABLE OF CONTENTS
1. REPLACEMENT AND ADJUSTMENT ........................................... 1
1.1 EXTERIOR COVER ....................................................................................... 1
1.1.1 LEFT AND RIGHT TRAY ...................................................................... 1
1.1.2 CHANGING THE TRAY SIZE ............................................................... 2
1.2 ELECTRICAL COMPONENTS ...................................................................... 3
1.2.1 PAPER HEIGHT SENSORS ON PAPER STORAGE SIDE ................. 3
1.2.2 END FENCE HP SENSOR/PAPER END SENSOR 2 .......................... 3
1.2.3 TRAY LIFT MOTOR ............................................................................. 4
1.2.4 TRAY MOTOR ...................................................................................... 5
1.2.5 MAIN BOARD ....................................................................................... 5
1.2.6 STACK TRANSPORT CLUTCH ........................................................... 6
1.3 FEED ............................................................................................................. 7
1.3.1 PAPER FEED UNIT.............................................................................. 7
1.3.2 PICK-UP, FEED AND SEPARATION ROLLERS ................................. 8
1.3.3 PAPER FEED, PAPER END, LIFT AND RELAY SENSORS ............... 9

SM

i

D538/D581

Exterior Cover

1. REPLACEMENT AND ADJUSTMENT
1.1 EXTERIOR COVER

1.

Large
Capacity Tray
PB3110/
PB3140
D538/D581

1.1.1 LEFT AND RIGHT TRAY

Pull the LCT drawer.


If the right tray comes up with the left tray, push the right tray into the LCT.
x 2)

2.

Left tray [A] (

3.

Remove the right tray [B] pressing down the stopper [C].


When reinstalling the tray, set the tray on the guide rail and carefully push the tray
in, making sure to keep the tray level.

SM

1

D538/D581

Exterior Cover

1.1.2 CHANGING THE TRAY SIZE

x 5).

1.

Remove the fence screws (

2.

Change the position of the fences.


Before fastening the screws, set paper in the tray.

D538/D581

2

SM

Electrical Components

1.2 ELECTRICAL COMPONENTS

Large
Capacity Tray
PB3110/
PB3140
D538/D581

1.2.1 PAPER HEIGHT SENSORS ON PAPER STORAGE SIDE

"Left and Right Tray")

1.

Tray (

2.

Rear fence [A] (

3.

Rear fence bracket [B] (

4.

Paper height sensors [C] (

x 1)
x 2)
x 1 each)

1.2.2 END FENCE HP SENSOR/PAPER END SENSOR 2

1.

Bottom cover [D] (

2.

End fence HP sensor [E] (

3.

Paper end sensor 2 (paper storage side) [F] (

SM

x 1)
x 1)

3

x 1)
D538/D581

Electrical Components

1.2.3 TRAY LIFT MOTOR

1.

Securing brackets [A] (

2.

Rear cover [B] (

3.

Tray lift motor [C] (

D538/D581

x 1 each)

x 2)

x 1,

x 3)

4

SM

Electrical Components

1.

Rear cover (

2.

Tray motor [A] (


Large
Capacity Tray
PB3110/
PB3140
D538/D581

1.2.4 TRAY MOTOR

"Tray Lift Motor")
x 1,

x 2)

When installing the tray motor, make sure that the gear of the tray motor holds the
timing belt [B].

1.2.5 MAIN BOARD

1.

Rear cover (

2.

Main board [A] (All

SM

"Tray Lift Motor" )
s,

x 2, snap x 2)

5

D538/D581

Electrical Components

1.2.6 STACK TRANSPORT CLUTCH

1.

Rear cover (

2.

Stack transport clutch [A] (

D538/D581

"Tray Lift Motor")
x 1,

x 1)

6

SM

Feed

1.3 FEED

Large
Capacity Tray
PB3110/
PB3140
D538/D581

1.3.1 PAPER FEED UNIT

1.

Right cover [A]

2.

Open the vertical guide plate [B]

3.

Guide plate [C]

4.

Pull the LCT drawer [D].

5.

Paper feed unit [E] (

SM

x2

x 1)

7

D538/D581

Feed

1.3.2 PICK-UP, FEED AND SEPARATION ROLLERS

1.

Paper feed unit (

2.

Separation roller [A] (

3.

Roller holder [B] (

4.

Feed roller [C] and pick-up roller [D]

D538/D581

"Paper Feed Unit")
x 1)

x 1)

8

SM

Feed

Large
Capacity Tray
PB3110/
PB3140
D538/D581

1.3.3 PAPER FEED, PAPER END, LIFT AND RELAY SENSORS

"Paper Feed Unit")

1.

Paper feed unit (

2.

Vertical transport sensor bracket [A] (

3.

Relay sensor [B]

4.

Paper feed sensor bracket [C]

5.

Paper feed sensor [D]

6.

Paper end feeler [E]

7.

Paper end sensor holder [F] (hook x 3)

8.

Paper end sensor [G] (

9.

Lift sensor (

SM

x 1,

x 1)

x 1, hook x 3)

x 1, hook x 3)

9

D538/D581

D542/D635
SIDE TRAY TYPE C5501/C5502
R E V I S I O N H I S T O RY
P ag e

Dat e

Ad d ed/ Upd at ed/ New
None

SIDE TRAY TYPE C5501/C5502
(D542/D635)
TABLE OF CONTENTS
1. REPLACEMENT AND ADJUSTMENT........................................... 1
1.1 TRAYS AND COVERS ..................................................................................1
1.1.1 SUB AND MAIN OUTPUT TRAYS .......................................................1
1.1.2 TRAY LEFT FRONT AND REAR COVERS..........................................2
1.2 ELECTRICAL COMPONENTS ......................................................................3
1.2.1 SIDE TRAY CONTROL BOARD ...........................................................3
1.2.2 SIDE TRAY DRIVE MOTOR.................................................................4
1.2.3 SIDE TRAY RELAY SENSOR ..............................................................5
1.2.4 SIDE TRAY EXIT SENSOR ..................................................................6

SM

i

D542/D635

Trays and Covers

1. REPLACEMENT AND ADJUSTMENT
1.1 TRAYS AND COVERS
1.1.1 SUB AND MAIN OUTPUT TRAYS

1.

Sub output tray [A]


2.

Release the rear tab of the sub output tray.

Main output tray [B]
Release the rear tab of the sub output tray.

Side Tray
Type
C5501/C5502
(D542/D635)



SM

1

D542/D635

Trays and Covers

1.1.2 TRAY LEFT FRONT AND REAR COVERS
1.

Sub and main output trays (

2.

Tray left front cover [A]


3.

Sub and Main Output Trays)

Release the hooks of the tray left front cover.

Tray left rear cover [B]


Release the hooks of the tray left rear cover.

D542/D635

2

SM

Electrical Components

1.2 ELECTRICAL COMPONENTS
1.2.1 SIDE TRAY CONTROL BOARD
1.

Sub and main output trays (

2.

Tray left front and rear covers (

3.

Side tray (

4.

Rear cover [A] (

5.

Side tray control board [A] (

Sub and Main Output Trays)
Tray Left Front and Rear Covers)

Installation Procedure in the base copier manual)

x 2)

x 3)

Side Tray
Type
C5501/C5502
(D542/D635)

x 3,

SM

3

D542/D635

Electrical Components

1.2.2 SIDE TRAY DRIVE MOTOR
1.

Sub and main output trays (

2.

Tray left front and rear covers (

3.

Side tray (

4.

Rear cover (

Side Tray Control Board)

5.

Bracket [A] (

x 3,

6.

Side tray drive motor [A] (

D542/D635

Sub and Main Output Trays)
Tray Left Front and Rear Covers)

Installation Procedure in the base copier manual)

x 3,

x 1, timing belt x 1)

x 4,

x 1)

4

SM

Electrical Components

1.2.3 SIDE TRAY RELAY SENSOR
1.

Sub and main output trays (

Sub and Main Output Trays)

2.

Tray left front and rear covers (

3.

Side tray (

4.

Open the paper tray [A].

5.

Remove the ground cable [B] (

6.

Remove the paper tray [A].

7.

Turn over the side tray.

8.

Side tray relay sensor [A] (

9.

Turn over the side tray, and then remove the side tray relay sensor.

Tray Left Front and Rear Covers)

Installation Procedure in the base copier manual)

x 1).

Side Tray
Type
C5501/C5502
(D542/D635)

x 1, hooks)

SM

5

D542/D635

Electrical Components

1.2.4 SIDE TRAY EXIT SENSOR
1.

Sub and main output trays (

2.

Tray left front and rear covers (

3.

Side tray (

4.

Paper tray (

5.

Exit guide [A] (

6.

Side tray exit sensor [A] (

D542/D635

Sub and Main Output Trays)
Tray Left Front and Rear Covers)

Installation Procedure in the base copier manual)
Side Tray Relay Sensor)

x 1)

x 1,

x 1, hooks)

6

SM

D629
FAX OPTION TYPE 5002
R E V I S I O N H I S T O RY
P a ge

Date

3∼4

11/15/2012

A d de d /U pd at e d /N ew
Added step 6 to Installation for Fax Option (D629)

FAX OPTION TYPE 5002 (D629)
TABLE OF CONTENTS
1. INSTALLATION ............................................................................. 1
1.1 FAX OPTION INSTALLATION .......................................................................1
1.1.1 COMPONENT CHECK .........................................................................1
1.1.2 FAX OPTION INSTALLATION PROCEDURE ......................................2
1.2 G3 INTERFACE BOARD INSTALLATION .....................................................5
1.2.1 COMPONENT CHECK .........................................................................5
1.2.2 INSTALLATION: ONE G3 BOARD .......................................................6
1.2.3 INSTALLATION: TWO G3 BOARDS ....................................................8
1.3 FAX UNIT OPTIONS ...................................................................................10
1.3.1 MEMORY UNIT (G578) ......................................................................10
1.3.2 HANDSET (D645) ...............................................................................11

2. REPLACEMENT AND ADJUSTMENT......................................... 13
2.1 FCU .............................................................................................................13
2.1.1 SRAM DATA TRANSFER PROCEDURE ...........................................13

3. TROUBLESHOOTING ................................................................. 19
3.1 ERROR CODES ..........................................................................................19
3.2 IFAX TROUBLESHOOTING ........................................................................41
3.3 IP-FAX TROUBLESHOOTING ....................................................................44
3.3.1 IP-FAX TRANSMISSION ....................................................................44
Cannot send by IP Address/Host Name .................................................44
Cannot send via VoIP Gateway .............................................................46
Cannot send by Alias Fax number. ........................................................47
3.3.2 IP-FAX RECEPTION ..........................................................................49
Cannot receive via IP Address/Host Name. ...........................................49
Cannot receive by VoIP Gateway. .........................................................50
Cannot receive by Alias Fax number. ....................................................51

4. SERVICE TABLES ....................................................................... 53
4.1 CAUTIONS ..................................................................................................53
4.2 SERVICE PROGRAM TABLES ...................................................................54
4.2.1 SP1-XXX (BIT SWITCHES) ................................................................54
SM

i

D629

4.2.2 SP2-XXX (RAM DATA) .......................................................................55
4.2.3 SP3-XXX (TEL LINE SETTINGS) .......................................................57
4.2.4 SP4-XXX (ROM VERSIONS) .............................................................59
4.2.5 SP5-XXX (RAM CLEAR) ....................................................................60
4.2.6 SP6-XXX (REPORTS) ........................................................................61
4.2.7 SP7-XXX (TESTS) ..............................................................................64
4.3 BIT SWITCHES - 1 ......................................................................................66
4.3.1 SYSTEM SWITCHES .........................................................................66
4.4 BIT SWITCHES - 2 ......................................................................................83
4.4.1 I-FAX SWITCHES ...............................................................................83
4.4.2 PRINTER SWITCHES ........................................................................91
4.5 BIT SWITCHES - 3 ......................................................................................99
4.5.1 COMMUNICATION SWITCHES .........................................................99
4.6 BIT SWITCHES - 4 ....................................................................................110
4.6.1 G3 SWITCHES .................................................................................110
4.7 BIT SWITCHES - 5 ....................................................................................121
4.7.1 G3-2 AND G3-3 SWITCHES ............................................................121
4.7.2 G4 INTERNAL SWITCHES ..............................................................130
4.7.3 G4 PARAMETER SWITCHES ..........................................................130
4.8 BIT SWITCHES - 6 ....................................................................................131
4.8.1 IP FAX SWITCHES...........................................................................131
4.9 NCU PARAMETERS .................................................................................140
4.10 DEDICATED TRANSMISSION PARAMETERS ...................................155
4.10.1
PROGRAMMING PROCEDURE ...............................................155
4.10.2
PARAMETERS ..........................................................................156
Fax Parameters ....................................................................................156
E-mail Parameters ...............................................................................160
4.11 SERVICE RAM ADDRESSES .............................................................164

5. DETAILED SECTION DESCRIPTIONS ..................................... 175
5.1 OVERVIEW................................................................................................175
5.2 BOARDS ....................................................................................................176
5.2.1 FCU ..................................................................................................176
5.2.2 SG3 BOARD .....................................................................................178
5.3 VIDEO DATA PATH...................................................................................180
5.3.1 TRANSMISSION...............................................................................180
Memory Transmission and Parallel Memory Transmission ..................180
Immediate Transmission ......................................................................181
JBIG Transmission ...............................................................................181
D629

ii

SM

Adjustments .........................................................................................181
5.3.2 RECEPTION .....................................................................................182
5.4 FAX COMMUNICATION FEATURES ........................................................183
5.4.1 MULTI-PORT ....................................................................................183
5.4.2 DOCUMENT SERVER .....................................................................184
5.4.3 INTERNET MAIL COMMUNICATION...............................................185
Mail Transmission ................................................................................185
Mail Reception .....................................................................................187
Handling Mail Reception Errors............................................................189
Secure Internet Reception....................................................................190
Transfer Request: Request By Mail .....................................................190
E-Mail Options (Sub TX Mode) ............................................................191
5.5 IP-FAX .......................................................................................................195
5.5.1 WHAT IS IP-FAX? ............................................................................195
5.5.2 T.38 PACKET FORMAT ...................................................................195
UDP Related Switches .........................................................................195
5.5.3 SETTINGS ........................................................................................196

6. SPECIFICATIONS ...................................................................... 197
6.1 GENERAL SPECIFICATIONS ...................................................................197
6.1.1 FCU ..................................................................................................197
6.2 CAPABILITIES OF PROGRAMMABLE ITEMS .........................................199
6.3 IFAX SPECIFICATIONS ............................................................................201
6.4 IP-FAX SPECIFICATIONS.........................................................................203
6.5 FAX UNIT CONFIGURATION....................................................................204

SM

iii

D629

READ THIS FIRST
Important Safety Notices


Never install telephone wiring during a lightning storm.



Never install telephone jacks in wet locations unless the jack is specifically designed for
wet locations.



Never touch uninsulated telephone wires or terminals unless the telephone line has been
disconnected at the network interface.



Use caution when installing or modifying telephone lines.



Avoid using a telephone (other than a cordless type) during an electrical storm. There
may be a remote risk of electric shock from lightning.



Do not use a telephone or cellular phone to report a gas leak in the vicinity of the leak.



Before installing the fax unit, switch off the main switch, and disconnect the power cord.



The fax unit contains a lithium battery. The danger of explosion exists if a battery of this
type is incorrectly replaced. Replace only with the same or an equivalent type
recommended by the manufacturer. Discard batteries in accordance with the
manufacturer's instructions and local regulations.



Note for Australia:



Unit must be connected to Telecommunication Network through a line cord which meets
the requirements of ACA Technical Standard TS008.

Symbols and Abbreviations
Conventions Used in this Manual
This manual uses several symbols.

Symbol

What it means
Refer to section number
Screw
Connector
E-ring
Clip ring
Clamp

Cautions, Notes, etc.
The following headings provide special information:


Failure to obey warning information could result in serious injury or death.



Obey these guidelines to ensure safe operation and prevent minor injuries.



Obey these guidelines to avoid problems such as misfeeds, damage to originals, loss of
valuable data and to prevent damage to the machine.



Always obey these guidelines to avoid serious problems such as misfeeds, damage to
originals, loss of valuable data and to prevent damage to the machine. bold is added for
emphasis.



This document provides tips and advice about how to best service the machine.

Fax Option Installation

Fax Option
Type 5002
(D629)

1. INSTALLATION
1.1 FAX OPTION INSTALLATION
1.1.1 COMPONENT CHECK
Check the quantity and condition of the components against the following list.

No.

SM

Description

Q'ty

1

FCU

1

2

Screw: M3x6

3

3

Telephone Cable (NA only)

1

4

Data Display Decal Sheet (21 languages) (EU only)

1

5

FCC Decal (NA only)

1

6

Serial Number Decal

1

7

G3 Decal

1

8

EMC Address (EU only)

1

9

Fax Decal for Operation Panel

1

1

D629

Fax Option Installation

1.1.2 FAX OPTION INSTALLATION PROCEDURE


Before installation:



If there is a printer option in the machine, print out all data in the printer buffer.



Push the operation switch to put the machine in standby mode. Make sure the power
LED is off, turn the main switch off, and then disconnect the power cord and the network
cable.



The copier must be connected to a properly grounded socket outlet.

1.

Attach the serial number decal near the serial number plate of the mainframe.

2.

For NA models, attach the FCC decal near the serial number plate of the mainframe.

3.

Remove the controller cover [A] (

D629

x 2).

2

SM

4.

Remove the FCU cover [A] ( x 3).

5.

Remove the jumper [A] (set to OFF) and set it to

Fax Option
Type 5002
(D629)

Fax Option Installation

Rev. 11/15/2012

ON.
ƒ

The machine may issue SC819, SC820
if the jumper is not set to "ON" correctly.
(Sometimes these SC codes are not
issued.)

⇒
ƒ
6.

The following step is for units installed in Brazil only!

For installation in Brazil, move the jumper switch (CN613) on the FAX board so that the edge
is anchored at “1”. (So that the middle pin and the “1” pin are covered.)
ƒ

7.

In its default position, the switch covers the middle and “3” pin.

Install the FCU [A] ( x 4; use the three screws
which were removed in step 3).

SM

3

D629

Fax Option Installation

Rev. 11/15/2012

8.

Reattach the controller cover [A] ( x2).

9.

Connect the telephone cord to the "LINE 1" jack.

10. Attach the Super G3 decal [A].
11. Attach the Fax decal under the function key on the operation panel.
12. Plug in the machine and turn on the main power switch.
ƒ

After you turn the machine on, if you see a message that tells you the SRAM has
been formatted due to a problem with SRAM, turn the machine off and on again to
clear the message.

13. Enter the "User Tools" mode and set date and time.
14. Do SP3102 in the fax SP mode and enter the serial number for the fax unit.
15. Enter the correct country code with SP1101-016 (NCU Country/Area Code Setting).

D629

4

SM

G3 Interface Board Installation

Fax Option
Type 5002
(D629)

1.2 G3 INTERFACE BOARD INSTALLATION
1.2.1 COMPONENT CHECK
Check the quantity and condition of the components against the following list.

No.

SM

Description

Q'ty

1

SG3 Interface Unit

1

2

Flat Cable

1

3

Screw: M3x6

3

4

Telephone Cable (NA only)

1

5

FCC Decal (NA only)

1

5

D629

G3 Interface Board Installation

1.2.2 INSTALLATION: ONE G3 BOARD

x 2).

1.

Remove the controller cover [A] (

2.

If the fax unit is already installed in the machine, remove the FCU ( x 4). If not, remove the
FCU cover ( x 3).

3.

Attach one end (short length) of the flat cable to the connector [A] of the FCU board.

4.

Attach the other end (long length) of the flat cable to the connector [B] of the CCUIF.

5.

Attach the SG3 interface unit [A] (

D629

x 3).

6

SM

Fax Option
Type 5002
(D629)

G3 Interface Board Installation

6.

Remove the knockout for LINE 2 from the controller cover.

7.

Install the FCU in the machine (for details, refer to Fax Option Installation).

8.

Reattach the controller cover (

9.

Connect the telephone cord to the LINE 2 jack.

x2).

10. Enter the service mode. Set bit 1 of communication switch 16 to "1" (SP1-104-023) for
PSTN-2.
11. Turn the main switch off and on.
12. Print out the system parameter list. Then check that "G3" shows as an option.
13. Set up and program the items required for PSTN-2 communications.
14. Attach the FCC decal near the serial number plate of the mainframe.

SM

7

D629

G3 Interface Board Installation

1.2.3 INSTALLATION: TWO G3 BOARDS

1.

Remove the SG3 board [A] from the second SG3 interface unit [B] for the two-SG3 board
installation (

x 2).
x 2).

2.

Attach the SG3 board [A] to the interface board [C] of the first SG3 interface unit (

3.

Remove the controller cover [A] (

4.

If the fax unit is already installed in the machine, remove the FCU ( x 4). If not, remove the

x 2).

FCU cover ( x 3).

5.

Attach one end (short length) of the flat cable to the connector [A] of the FCU board.

6.

Attach the other end (long length) of the flat cable to the connector [B] of the CCUIF.

D629

8

SM

Fax Option
Type 5002
(D629)

G3 Interface Board Installation

x 3).

7.

Attach the SG3 interface unit [A] (

8.

Remove the knockouts for LINE 2 and LINE 3 from the controller cover.

9.

Install the FCU in the machine (for details, refer to Fax Option Installation).

10. Reattach the controller cover (

x2).

11. Connect the telephone cord to the LINE 3 jack.
12. Enter the service mode. Set bit 3 of communication switch 16 to "1" (SP1-104-023) for
PSTN-3.
13. Turn the main switch off and on.
14. Print out the system parameter list. Then check that "G3" shows as an option.
15. Set up and program the items required for PSTN-3 communications.
16. Attach the FCC decal near the serial number plate of the mainframe.

SM

9

D629

Fax Unit Options

1.3 FAX UNIT OPTIONS
1.3.1 MEMORY UNIT (G578)
1.

FCU (

2.

Install the memory option in the memory slot [A].

3.

Reaasemble the machine.

D629

p.1 "Fax Option Installation")

10

SM

Fax Unit Options



The optional handset is available for the U.S. version only.

x 3).

1.

Remove the scanner left cover [A] (

2.

Make two holes [B] in the scanner left cover.


3.

SM

Fax Option
Type 5002
(D629)

1.3.2 HANDSET (D645)

Drill a hole from the outside of the cover with a screwdriver.

Attach the handset support bracket [C] inside the scanner left cover.

11

D629

Fax Unit Options

4.

Hold the handset bracket [D] and handset support bracket (set inside the scanner left cover).

5.

Secure the handset bracket [D] (

6.

Install the scanner left cover on the machine.

7.

Attach the clamp to the location [E].

8.

Set the handset on the handset bracket.

9.

Clamp the hand set cord.

x 2).

10. Connect the handset cable to the "TEL" jack at the rear of the machine.

D629

12

SM

FCU

Fax Option
Type 5002
(D629)

2. REPLACEMENT AND ADJUSTMENT
2.1 FCU
2.1.1 SRAM DATA TRANSFER PROCEDURE
When you replace the FCU board, transfer the SRAM data from the old FCU board to the new
FCU board. Do the following procedure to back up the SRAM data.


The following data can be transfered: TTI, RTI, CSI, Fax bit switch settings, RAM address
settings, NCU parameter settings

1.

Remove the controller cover [A] ( x 2).

2.

Remove the fax unit [A] ( x 4).

3.

Replace the FCU board.

SM

13

D629

FCU

4.

Move the jumper switch [A] of the new FCU board from "OFF" to "ON".

5.

Remove the speaker [A] from the fax unit ( x 2,

6.

Attach the speaker [A] to the fax unit as shown above.

D629

14

x 2,

x 1).

SM

Fax Option
Type 5002
(D629)

FCU

7.

Connect the speaker harness to the new FCU board [A] through the hole [B].

8.

Connect a flat flexible cable [A] to the new FCU board. This cable is shipped with the new
FCU board.


SM

The blue side [A] of the flat flexible cable must face outward as shown below.

15

D629

FCU

9.

Install the fax unit [A] in the main machine ( x 3).

10. Move the Dip Switch [A] of the old FCU board from “OFF” to “ON”.

11. Connect the flat flexible cable to the old FCU board [A].
12. Turn on the main power switch.
13. SRAM data transmission starts. When the transmission is completed, you will hear a beeper
sound.

D629

16

SM



The beeper sound is the same volume as the speaker sound.



The beeper sounds even if the sperker sound is turned off.



If the beeper does not sound, turn the main power switch on and off repeatedly and
do the transmission procedure 2 or 3 times.



If the beeper does not sound after turning the main switch on and off 3 times, you
need to input the settings stored in SRAM memory manually.

14. When “Ready” appears on the copy display, turn off the main power switch, and then
disconnect the flat flexible cable from the old FCU board.
15. Remove the fax unit from the main machine ( x 3).
16. Disconnect the flat flexible cable from the new FCU board.

17. Remove the speaker [A] from the fax unit (

x 1).

18. Install the speaker [A] in the fax unit as shown above ( x 2,

SM

17

x 2,

x 1).

D629

Fax Option
Type 5002
(D629)

FCU

FCU

19. Slide the fax unit [A] into the main machine ( x 4).

20. Reattach the controller cover ( x 2).
21. Turn on the main power switch, then do SP6-101 to print the system parameter list.
22. Check the system parameter list to make sure that the data was transferred correctly.
23. Set the correct date and time with the User Tools: User Tools > System Settings > Timer
Setting > Set Date/Time.


D629

If any of the SRAM data was not transferred, input those settings manually.

18

SM

Error Codes

Fax Option
Type 5002
(D629)

3. TROUBLESHOOTING
3.1 ERROR CODES
If an error code occurs, retry the communication. If the same problem occurs, try to fix the
problem as suggested below. Note that some error codes appear only in the error code display
and on the service report.

Code
0-00

Meaning

Suggested Cause/Action

DIS/NSF not detected within



Check the line connection.

40 s of Start being pressed



The machine at the other end may be
incompatible.



Replace the FCU.



Check for DIS/NSF with an oscilloscope.



If the rx signal is weak, there may be a bad
line.

0-01

DCN received unexpectedly



The other party is out of paper or has a
jammed printer.



The other party pressed Stop during
communication.

0-03

Incompatible modem at the

The other terminal is incompatible.

other end

SM

19

D629

Error Codes

Code
0-04

Meaning

Suggested Cause/Action

CFR or FTT not received after 
modem training



Check the line connection.
Try changing the tx level and/or cable
equalizer settings.



Replace the FCU.



The other terminal may be faulty; try
sending to another machine.



If the rx signal is weak or defective, there
may be a bad line.

Cross reference
Tx level - NCU Parameter 01 (PSTN)
Cable equalizer - G3 Switch 07 (PSTN)
Dedicated Tx parameters in Service Program
Mode
0-05

Modem training fails even G3



Check the line connection.

shifts down to 2400 bps.



Try adjusting the tx level and/or cable
equalizer.



Replace the FCU.



Check for line problems.

Cross reference
See error code 0-04.
0-06

The other terminal did not



Check the line connection.

reply to DCS



Try adjusting the tx level and/or cable
equalizer settings.



Replace the FCU.



The other end may be defective or
incompatible; try sending to another
machine.



Check for line problems.

Cross reference
See error code 0-04.

D629

20

SM

Error Codes

0-07

Meaning

Suggested Cause/Action

No post-message response



Check the line connection.

from the other end after a



Replace the FCU.

page was sent



The other end may have jammed or run

Fax Option
Type 5002
(D629)

Code

out of paper.


The other end user may have
disconnected the call.



Check for a bad line.



The other end may be defective; try
sending to another machine.

0-08

The other end sent RTN or



Check the line connection.

PIN after receiving a page,



Replace the FCU.

because there were too many



The other end may have jammed, or run

errors

out of paper or memory space.


Try adjusting the tx level and/or cable
equalizer settings.



The other end may have a defective
modem/FCU; try sending to another
machine.



Check for line problems and noise.

Cross reference


Tx level - NCU Parameter 01 (PSTN)



Cable equalizer - G3 Switch 07 (PSTN)



Dedicated Tx parameters in Service
Program Mode

0-14

Non-standard post message



response code received

Incompatible or defective remote terminal;
try sending to another machine.



Noisy line: resend.



Try adjusting the tx level and/or cable
equalizer settings.



Replace the FCU.

Cross reference
See error code 0-08.

SM

21

D629

Error Codes

Code
0-15

Meaning

Suggested Cause/Action

The other terminal is not

The other terminal is not capable of accepting

capable of specific functions.

the following functions, or the other terminal’s
memory is full.

0-16



Confidential rx



Transfer function



SEP/SUB/PWD/SID

CFR or FTT not detected after 

Check the line connection.

modem training in confidential 

Replace the FCU.

or transfer mode



Try adjusting the tx level and/or cable
equalizer settings.



The other end may have disconnected, or
it may be defective; try calling another
machine.



If the rx signal level is too low, there may
be a line problem.

Cross reference
See error code 0-08.
0-17

0-20

Communication was

If the Stop key was not pressed and this error

interrupted by pressing the

keeps occurring, replace the operation panel or

Stop key

the operation panel drive board.

Facsimile data not received



Check the line connection.

within 6 s of retraining



Replace the FCU.



Check for line problems.



Try calling another fax machine.



Try adjusting the reconstruction time for
the first line and/or rx cable equalizer
setting.

Cross reference
Reconstruction time - G3 Switch 0A, bit 6
Rx cable equalizer - G3 Switch 07 (PSTN)

D629

22

SM

Error Codes

Meaning

0-21

EOL signal (end-of-line) from

Suggested Cause/Action


Check the connections between the FCU

the other end not received

and line.

within 5 s of the previous EOL 

Check for line noise or other line problems.

signal

Fax Option
Type 5002
(D629)

Code



Replace the FCU.



The remote machine may be defective or
may have disconnected.

Cross reference
Maximum interval between EOLs and between
ECM frames - G3 Bit Switch 0A, bit 4
0-22

The signal from the other end



Check the line connection.

was interrupted for more than



Replace the FCU.

the acceptable modem carrier 
drop time (default: 200 ms)

Defective remote terminal.



Check for line noise or other line problems.



Try adjusting the acceptable modem
carrier drop time.

Cross reference
Acceptable modem carrier drop time - G3
Switch 0A, bits 0 and 1
0-23

Too many errors during



Check the line connection.

reception



Replace the FCU.



Defective remote terminal



Check for line noise or other line problems.



Try asking the other end to adjust their tx
level.



Try adjusting the rx cable equalizer setting
and/or rx error criteria.

Cross reference
Rx cable equalizer - G3 Switch 07 (PSTN)
Rx error criteria - Communication Switch 02,
bits 0 and 1
0-29

SM

Data block format failure in



Check for line noise or other line problems.

ECM reception



Check the FCU - NCU connectors.



Replace the NCU or FCU.

23

D629

Error Codes

Code
0-30

Meaning

Suggested Cause/Action

The other terminal did not



Check the line connection.

reply to NSS(A) in AI short



Try adjusting the tx level and/or cable

protocol mode

equalizer settings.


The other terminal may not be compatible.

Cross reference
Dedicated tx parameters - Section 4
0-32

The other terminal sent a



Check the protocol dump list.

DCS, which contained



Ask the other party to contact the

functions that the receiving

manufacturer.

machine cannot handle.
0-33

The data reception (not ECM)



Check the line connection.

is not completed within 10



The other terminal may have a defective

minutes.
0-52

0-55

0-56

Polarity changed during

modem/FCU.


Check the line connection.

communication

Retry communication.

FCU does not detect the SG3. 

FCU firmware or board defective.



SG3 firmware or board defective.

The stored message data

SG3 firmware or board defective.

exceeds the capacity of the
mailbox in the SG3.
0-70

The communication mode



The other terminal did not have a

specified in CM/JM was not

compatible communication mode (e.g., the

available

other terminal was a V.34 data modem and

(V.8 calling and called

not a fax modem.)

terminal)



A polling tx file was not ready at the other
terminal when polling rx was initiated from
the calling terminal.

0-74

The calling terminal fell back



to T.30 mode, because it

D629

The calling terminal could not detect
ANSam due to noise, etc.

could not detect ANSam after



ANSam was too short to detect.

sending CI.



Check the line connection and condition.



Try making a call to another V.8/V.34 fax.

24

SM

Error Codes

0-75

Meaning

Suggested Cause/Action

The called terminal fell back to 

0-76

The terminal could not detect ANSam.

T.30 mode, because it could



Check the line connection and condition.

not detect a CM in response



Try receiving a call from another V.8/V.34

to ANSam (ANSam timeout).
The calling terminal fell back

Fax Option
Type 5002
(D629)

Code

fax.


to T.30 mode, because it

The called terminal could not detect a CM
due to noise, etc.

could not detect a JM in



Check the line connection and condition.

response to CM



Try making a call to another V.8/V.34 fax.

(CM timeout).
0-77

The called terminal fell back to 

The calling terminal could not detect a JM

T.30 mode, because it could

due to noise, etc.

not detect a CJ in response to 

A network that has narrow bandwidth

JM

cannot pass JM to the other end.

(JM timeout).



Check the line connection and condition.



Try receiving a call from another V.8/V.34
fax.

0-79

The called terminal detected



Check for line noise or other line problems.

CI while waiting for a V.21



If this error occurs, the called terminal falls

signal.
0-80

0-81

The line was disconnected



these phases. Serious noise, narrow

2 – line probing.

bandwidth, or low signal level can cause

The line was disconnected
3 – equalizer training.
The line was disconnected

these errors.
If these errors happen at the transmitting
terminal:


Try making a call at a later time.



Try using V.17 or a slower modem using
dedicated tx parameters.

due to a timeout in the V.34

SM

The guard timer expired while starting

due to a timeout in V.34 phase

due to a timeout in V.34 phase

0-82

back to T.30 mode.

phase 4 – control channel



Try increasing the tx level.

start-up.



Try adjusting the tx cable equalizer setting.

25

D629

Error Codes

Code
0-83

Meaning

Suggested Cause/Action

The line was disconnected

If these errors happen at the receiving terminal:

due to a timeout in the V.34



Try adjusting the rx cable equalizer setting.

control channel restart



Try increasing the tx level.

sequence.



Try using V.17 or a slower modem if the
same error is frequent when receiving from
multiple senders.

0-84

The line was disconnected



The signal did not stop within 10 s.

due to abnormal signaling in



Turn off the main power switch, then turn it
back on.

V.34 phase 4 – control
channel start-up.



If the same error is frequent, replace the
FCU.

0-85

The line was disconnected



The signal did not stop within 10 s.

due to abnormal signaling in



Turn off the main power switch, then turn it
back on.

V.34 control channel restart.


If the same error is frequent, replace the
FCU.

0-86

The line was disconnected



The other terminal was incompatible.

because the other terminal



Ask the other party to contact the

requested a data rate using

manufacturer.

MPh that was not available in
the currently selected symbol
rate.
0-87

The control channel started



The receiving terminal restarted the control

after an unsuccessful primary

channel because data reception in the

channel.

primary channel was not successful.


This does not result in an error
communication.

0-88

The line was disconnected



Try using a lower data rate at the start.

because PPR was



Try adjusting the cable equalizer setting.

transmitted/received 9
(default) times within the
same ECM frame.

D629

26

SM

Error Codes

2-11

Meaning

Suggested Cause/Action

Only one V.21 connection flag 

Fax Option
Type 5002
(D629)

Code

Replace the FCU.

was received
2-12

Modem clock irregularity



Replace the FCU.

2-13

Modem initialization error



Turn off the machine, then turn it back on.



Update the modem ROM.



Replace the FCU.

2-22

2-23

Counter overflow error of

If error occurs frequently, change the settings

JBIG chip

for resolution, paper size, compression type.

JBIG compression or

Turn off the machine, then turn it back on.

reconstruction error


2-24

JBIG ASIC error

2-25

JBIG data reconstruction error 
(BIH error)

2-26

JBIG data reconstruction error

Turn off the machine, then turn it back on.
JBIG data error



Check the sender’s JBIG function.



Update the FCU ROM.

(Float marker error)
2-27

JBIG data reconstruction error
(End marker error)

2-28

JBIG data reconstruction error
(Timeout)

2-29

JBIG trailing edge maker error 


2-50

2-51

FCU defective
Check the destination device.

The machine resets itself for a 

If this is frequent, update the ROM, or

fatal FCU system error

replace the FCU.

The machine resets itself
because of a fatal



If this is frequent, update the ROM, or
replace the FCU.

communication error

SM

27

D629

Error Codes

Code

Meaning

2-53

Snd msg() in the manual task

Suggested Cause/Action


The user did the same operation many

is an error because the

times, and this gave too much load to the

mailbox for the operation task

machine.

is full.
4-01

4-10

Line current was cut

Communication failed



Check the line connector.



Check for line problems.



Replace the FCU.



Get the ID Codes the same and/or the

because of an ID Code

CSIs programmed correctly, then resend.

mismatch (Closed Network) or 

The machine at the other end may be

Tel. No./CSI mismatch

defective.

(Protection against Wrong
Connections)
5-00

Data reconstruction not

Replace the FCU.

possible
5-10

DCR timer expired



Replace the FCU.

5-20

Storage impossible because



Temporary memory shortage.

of a lack of memory



Test the SAF memory.

5-21

Memory overflow

5-23

Print data error when printing



Test the SAF memory.

a substitute rx or confidential



Ask the other end to resend the message.



Replace an SD card or HDD.



Replace the FCU.

G3 ECM - T1 time out during



Try adjusting the rx cable equalizer.

reception of facsimile data



Replace the FCU.

rx message
5-25

6-00

6-01

SAF file access error

G3 ECM - no V.21 signal was
received

6-02

D629

G3 ECM - EOR was received

28

SM

Error Codes

6-04

Meaning
G3 ECM - RTC not detected

Suggested Cause/Action


Check the line connection.



Check for a bad line or defective remote

Fax Option
Type 5002
(D629)

Code

terminal.

6-05

G3 ECM - facsimile data



Replace the FCU.



Check the line connection.

frame not received within 18 s 

Check for a bad line or defective remote

of CFR, but there was no line

terminal.

fail



Replace the FCU.



Try adjusting the rx cable equalizer

Cross reference

6-06

6-08

6-09



Rx cable equalizer - G3 Switch 07 (PSTN)

G3 ECM - coding/decoding



Defective FCU.

error



The other terminal may be defective.

G3 ECM - PIP/PIN received in 

The other end pressed Stop during

reply to PPS.NULL

communication.

G3 ECM - ERR received



The other terminal may be defective.



Check for a noisy line.



Adjust the tx levels of the communicating
machines.

6-10

6-21

6-22

G3 ECM - error frames still



See code 6-05.



Check for line noise.

received at the other end after 

Adjust the tx level (use NCU parameter 01

all communication attempts at

or the dedicated tx parameter for that

2400 bps

address).


Check the line connection.



Defective remote terminal.

V.21 flag detected during high 

The other terminal may be defective or

speed modem communication

incompatible.

The machine resets the



Check for line noise.

sequence because of an



If the same error occurs frequently, replace
the FCU.

abnormal handshake in the
V.34 control channel

SM



Defective remote terminal.

29

D629

Error Codes

Code
6-99

Meaning

Suggested Cause/Action

V.21 signal not stopped within Replace the FCU.
6s

13-17

SIP user name registration



Double registration of the SIP user name.

error



Capacity for user-name registration in the
SIP server is not sufficient.

13-18

13-24

SIP server access error

SIP authentication error



Incorrect initial setting for the SIP server.



Defective SIP server.



Registered password in the device does
not match the password in the SIP server.

13-25

Network I/F setting error



IPV4 is not active in the active protocol
setting.

13-26

Network I/F setting error at



IP address of the device is not registered.



Active protocol setting does not match the

power on

I/F setting for SIP server.


IP address of the device is not registered.

13-27

IP address setting error



IP address of the device is not registered.

14-00

SMTP Send Error



Error occurred during sending to the SMTP
server. Occurs for any error other than
14-01 to 16. For example, the mail address
of the system administrator is not
registered.

14-01

SMTP Connection Failed



Failed to connect to the SMTP server
(timeout) because the server could not be
found.

D629



The PC is not ready to transfer files.



SMTP server not functioning correctly.



The DNS IP address is not registered.



Network not operating correctly.



Destination folder selection not correct.

30

SM

Error Codes

Meaning

14-02

No Service by SMTP Service

Suggested Cause/Action


(421)

Fax Option
Type 5002
(D629)

Code

SMTP server operating incorrectly, or the
destination for direct SMTP sending is not
correct.



Contact the system administrator and
check that the SMTP server has the
correct settings and operates correctly.



Contact the system administrator for direct
SMTP sending and check the sending
destination.

14-03

Access to SMTP Server



Failed to access the SMTP server because
the access is denied.

Denied (450)


SMTP server operating incorrectly.
Contact the system administrator to
determine if there is a problem with the
SMTP server and to check that the SMTP
server settings are correct.



Folder send destination is incorrect.
Contact the system administrator to
determine that the SMTP server settings
and path to the server are correct.



Device settings incorrect. Confirm that the
user name and password settings are
correct.



Direct SMTP destination incorrect. Contact
the system administrator to determine if
there is a problem at the destination at that
the settings at the destination are correct.

14-04

Access to SMTP Server



SMTP server operating incorrectly

Denied (550)



Direct SMTP sending not operating
correctly

SM

31

D629

Error Codes

Code

Meaning

14-05

SMTP Server HDD Full (452)

Suggested Cause/Action


Failed to access the SMTP server because
the HDD on the server is full.



Insufficient free space on the HDD of the
SMTP server. Contact the system
administrator and check the amount of
space remaining on the SMTP server
HDD.



Insufficient free space on the HDD where
the destination folder is located. Contact
the system administrator and check the
amount of space remaining on the HDD
where the target folder is located.



Insufficient free space on the HDD at the
target destination for SMTP direct sending.
Contact the system administrator and
check the amount of space remaining on
the target HDD.

14-06

User Not Found on SMTP



The designated user does not exist.

Server (551)



The designated user does not exist on the
SMTP server.



The designated address is not for use with
direct SMTP sending.

14-07

Data Send to SMTP Server



Failed to access the SMTP server because
the transmission failed.

Failed (4XX)


PC not operating correctly.



SMTP server operating incorrectly



Network not operating correctly.



Destination folder setting incorrect.



Direct SMTP sending not operating
correctly.

D629

32

SM

Error Codes

14-08

Meaning
Data Send to SMTP Server

Suggested Cause/Action


Fax Option
Type 5002
(D629)

Code

Failed to access the SMTP server because
the transmission failed.

Failed (5XX)


SMTP server operating incorrectly



Destination folder setting incorrect.



Direct SMTP sending not operating
correctly.

14-09

Authorization Failed for



Software application error.



POP-Before-SMTP or SMTP authorization

Sending to SMTP Server

14-10

Addresses Exceeded

failed.


Incorrect setting for file transfer



Number of broadcast addresses exceeded
the limit for the SMTP server.

14-11

Buffer Full



The send buffer is full so the transmission
could not be completed. Buffer is full due
to using Scan-to-Email while the buffer is
being used send mail at the same time.

14-12

Data Size Too Large



Transmission was cancelled because the
detected size of the file was too large.

14-13

Send Cancelled



Processing is interrupted because the user
pressed Stop.

14-14

Security Locked File Error



Update the software because of the
defective software.

14-15

Mail Data Error



The transmitting a mail is interrupted via
DCS due to the incorrect data.



Update the software because of the
defective software.

14-16

Maximum Division Number



Error

When a mail is divided for the mail
transmission and the division number of a
mail are more than the specified number,
the mail transmission is interrupted.



Update the software because of the
defective software.

SM

33

D629

Error Codes

Code
14-17

Meaning
Incorrect Ticket

Suggested Cause/Action


Update the software because of the
defective software.

14-18

Access to MCS File Error



The access to MCS file is denied due to
the no permission of access.



Update the software because of the
defective software.

14-20

SMTP Authentication error

Make sure the administrator's e-mail address is
same as the SMTP authentication address or
POP before SMTP address.

14-21

Transmission error of S/MIME Register the correct user certificate and device
certificate.

14-30

MCS File Creation Failed

Failed to create the MCS file because:


The number of files created with other
applications on the Document Server has
exceeded the limit.

14-31

UFS File Creation Failed



HDD is full or not operating correctly.



Software error.

UFS file could not be created:


Not enough space in UFS area to handle
both Scan-to-Email and IFAX
transmission.

14-32

Cancelled the Mail Due to



HDD full or not operating correctly.



Software error.



Error detected with NFAX and send was

Error Detected by NFAX
14-33

No Mail Address For the
Machine

cancelled due to a software error.


Neither the mail address of the machine
nor the mail address of the network
administrator is registered.

D629

34

SM

Error Codes

14-34

Meaning
Address designated in the

Suggested Cause/Action


Operational error in normal mail sending or
direct SMTP sending.

domain for SMTP sending
does not exist

Fax Option
Type 5002
(D629)

Code



Check the address selected in the address
book for SMTP sending.


14-50

Mail Job Task Error

Check the domain selection.

Due to an FCU mail job task error, the send
was cancelled:


Address book was being edited during
creation of the notification mail.


14-51

Software error.

UCS Destination Download

Not even one return notification can be

Error

downloaded:


The address book was being edited.



The number for the specified destination
does not exist (it was deleted or edited
after the job was created).

14-60

Send Cancel Failed



The cancel operation by the user failed to
cancel the send operation.

14-61

Notification Mail Send Failed



for All Destinations
14-62

Transmission Error due to the

All addresses for return notification mail
failed.



existence of zero line page

When the 0 line page exists in received
pages with G3 communication, the
transmission is interrupted.

15-01

POP3/IMAP4 Server Not



Registered

At startup, the system detected that the IP
address of the POP3/IMAP4 server has
not been registered in the machine.

15-02

POP3/IMAP4 Mail Account



Information Not Registered

The POP3/IMAP4 mail account has not
been registered.

15-03

Mail Address Not Registered



The mail address has not been registered.

15-10

DCS Mail Receive Error



Error other than 15-11 to 15-18.

SM

35

D629

Error Codes

Code
15-11

Meaning
Connection Error

Suggested Cause/Action
The DNS or POP3/IMAP4 server could not be
found:


The IP address for DNS or POP3/IMAP4
server is not stored in the machine.

15-12

Authorization Error



The DNS IP address is not registered.



Network not operating correctly.

POP3/IMAP4 send authorization failed:


Incorrect IFAX user name or password.



Access was attempted by another device,
such as the PC.

15-13

Receive Buffer Full



POP3/IMAP4 settings incorrect.



Occurs only during manual reception.
Transmission cannot be received due to
insufficient buffer space. The buffer is
being used for mail send or Scan-to-Email.

15-14

Mail Header Format Error



The mail header is not standard format.
For example, the Date line description is
incorrect.

15-15

Mail Divide Error



The e-mail is not in standard format. There
is no boundary between parts of the
e-mail, including the header.

15-16

Mail Size Receive Error



The mail cannot be received because it is
too large.

15-17

Receive Timeout



May occur during manual receiving only
because the network is not operating
correctly.

15-18

Incomplete Mail Received



Only one portion of the mail was received.

15-31

Final Destination for Transfer



The format of the final destination for the

Request Reception Format

transfer request was incorrect.

Error

D629

36

SM

Error Codes

15-39

Meaning

Suggested Cause/Action

Send/Delivery Destination

The transmission cannot be delivered to the

Error

final destination:


Destination file format is incorrect.



Could not create the destination for the file

Fax Option
Type 5002
(D629)

Code

transmission.
15-41

SMTP Receive Error



Reception rejected because the
transaction exceeded the limit for the
“Auth. E-mail RX” setting.

15-42

Off Ramp Gateway Error



The delivery destination address was
specified with Off Ramp Gateway OFF.

15-43

Address Format Error



Format error in the address of the Off
Ramp Gateway.

15-44

Addresses Over



The number of addresses for the Off Ramp
Gateway exceeded the limit of 30.

15-61

Attachment File Format Error



15-62

TIFF File Compatibility Error

Could not receive transmission due to:

The attached file is not TIFF format.



Resolution error



Image of resolution greater than 200 dpi
without extended memory.



Resolution is not supported.



Page size error



The page size was larger than A3.



Compression error



File was compressed with other than MH,
MR, or MMR.

15-63

TIFF Parameter Error

The TIFF file sent as the attachment could not
be received because the TIFF header is
incorrect:


The TIFF file attachment is a type not
supported.

SM



The TIFF file attachment is corrupted.



Software error.

37

D629

Error Codes

Code
15-64

Meaning
TIFF Decompression Error

Suggested Cause/Action
The file received as an attachment caused the
TIFF decompression error:


The TIFF format of the attachment is
corrupted.

15-71

Not Binary Image Data



Software error.



The file could not be received because the
attachment was not binary image data.

15-73

MDN Status Error



Could not find the Disposition line in the
header of the Return Receipt, or there is a
problem with the firmware.

15-74

MDN Message ID Error



Could not find the Original Message ID line
in the header of the Return Receipt, or
there is a problem with the firmware.

15-80

Mail Job Task Read Error



Could not receive the transmission
because the destination buffer is full and
the destination could not be created (this
error may occur when receiving a transfer
request or a request for notification of
reception).

15-81

Repeated Destination



Registration Error

Could not repeat receive the transmission
because the destination buffer is full and
the destination could not be created (this
error may occur when receiving a transfer
request or a request for notification of
reception).

15-91

Send Registration Error

Could not receive the file for transfer to the final
destination:


The format of the final destination or the
transfer destination is incorrect.



Destinations are full so the final and
transfer destinations could not be created.

D629

38

SM

Error Codes

15-92

Meaning
Memory Overflow

Suggested Cause/Action


Fax Option
Type 5002
(D629)

Code

Transmission could not be received
because memory overflowed during the
transaction.

15-93

Memory Access Error



Transaction could not complete due to a
malfunction of SAF memory.

15-94

Incorrect ID Code



The machine rejected an incoming e-mail
for transfer request, because the ID code
in the incoming e-mail did not match the ID
code registered in the machine.

15-95

Transfer Station Function



The machine rejected an incoming e-mail
for transfer because the transfer function
was unavailable.

22-00

Original length exceeded the



maximum scan length

Divide the original into more than one
page.



Check the resolution used for scanning.
Lower the scan resolution if possible.

22-01



Add optional page memory.

Memory overflow while



Wait for the files in the queue to be sent.

receiving



Delete unnecessary files from memory.



Transfer the substitute reception files to an
another fax machine, if the machine’s
printer is busy or out of order.



Add an optional SAF memory card or hard
disk.

22-02

Tx or rx job stalled due to line



disconnection at the other end

The job started normally but did not finish
normally; data may or may not have been
received fully.

22-04

22-05



Restart the machine.

The machine cannot store



Update the ROM

received data in the SAF



Replace the FCU.

No G3 parameter confirmation 

Defective FCU board or firmware.

answer

SM

39

D629

Error Codes

Code
23-00

25-00

Meaning

Suggested Cause/Action

Data read timeout during



Restart the machine.

construction



Replace the FCU.

The machine software resets



Update the ROM

itself after a fatal transmission



Replace the FCU.

error occurred
F0-xx

V.34 modem error



Replace the FCU.

F6-xx

SG3 modem error



Update the SG3 modem ROM.



Replace the SG3 board.



Check for line noise or other line problems.



Try communicating another V.8/V.34 fax.

D629

40

SM

3.2 IFAX TROUBLESHOOTING
Use the following procedures to determine whether the machine or another part of the network is
causing the problem.

Communication

Item

Route
General LAN

1. Connection with

Action [Remarks]


to the machine.

the LAN

2. LAN activity

Check that the LAN cable is connected
Check that the LEDs on the hub are lit.

Check that other devices connected to the
LAN can communicate through the LAN.

Between IFAX and

1. Network settings



PC

on the PC

[Is the IP address registered in the TCP/IP

Check the network settings on the PC.

properties in the network setup correct?
Check the IP address with the
administrator of the network.]
2. Check that PC



can connect with the
machine

Use the “ping” command on the PC to
contact the machine.

[At the MS-DOS prompt, type ping then the
IP address of the machine, then press
Enter.]

3. LAN settings in



Check the LAN parameters

the machine



Check if there is an IP address conflict
with other PCs.

[Use the “Network” function in the User
Tools.
If there is an IP address conflict, inform the
administrator.]

SM

41

D629

Fax Option
Type 5002
(D629)

IFAX Troubleshooting

IFAX Troubleshooting

Communication
Route

Item

Action [Remarks]

Between machine

1. LAN settings in



Check the LAN parameters

and e-mail server

the machine



Check if there is an IP address conflict
with other PCs.

[Use the “Network” function in the User
Tools.
If there is an IP address conflict, inform the
administrator.]
2. E-mail account on 

Make sure that the machine can log

the server

into the e-mail server.


Check that the account and password
stored in the server are the same as in
the machine.

[Ask the administrator to check.]
3. E-mail server



Make sure that the client devices
which have an account in the server
can send/receive e-mail.

[Ask the administrator to check.
Send a test e-mail with the machine’s own
number as the destination. The machine
receives the returned e-mail if the
communication is performed successfully.]
Between e-mail

1. E-mail account on 

Make sure that the PC can log into the

server and internet

the Server

e-mail server.


Check that the account and password
stored in the server are the same as in
the machine.

[Ask the administrator to check.]

D629

42

SM

IFAX Troubleshooting

Item

Route

2. E-mail server

Action [Remarks]


Fax Option
Type 5002
(D629)

Communication

Make sure that the client devices
which have an account in the server
can send/receive e-mail.

[Ask the administrator to check.
Send a test e-mail with the machine’s own
number as the destination. The machine
receives the returned e-mail if the
communication is performed successfully.]
3. Destination e-mail 

Make sure that the e-mail address is

address

actually used.


Check that the e-mail address contains
no incorrect characters such as
spaces.

4. Router settings



Use the “ping” command to contact the
router.



Check that other devices connected to
the router can sent data over the
router.

[Ask the administrator of the server to
check.]
5. Error message by



Check whether e-mail can be sent to

e-mail from the

another address on the same network,

network of the

using the application e-mail software.

destination.



Check the error e-mail message.

[Inform the administrator of the LAN.]

SM

43

D629

IP-Fax Troubleshooting

3.3 IP-FAX TROUBLESHOOTING
3.3.1 IP-FAX TRANSMISSION
Cannot send by IP Address/Host Name

Check Point

Action

1

LAN cable connected?

Check the LAN cable connection.

2

Specified IP address/host name correct?

Check the IP address/host name.
Cannot breach the firewall. Send by

3

Firewall/NAT is installed?

using another method (Fax, Internet
Fax)

4

Transmission sent manually?

Manual sending not supported.

5

IP address of local machine registered?

Register the IP address.

Remote terminal port number setting other
6

than 1720 (when using H.323) or 5060

Send by specifying the port number.

(when using SIP)?

7

8

9

Confirm the port number of the remote

Specified port number correct?

fax.

DNS server registered when host name

Contact the network administrator.

specified?

Check whether the remote fax is a T38

Remote fax a T.38 terminal?

terminal.
Check that the remote fax is switched

10 Remote fax switched off or busy?

on.
Request the network administrator to
increase the bandwidth.

11 Network bandwidth too narrow?
Raise the delay level.
IPFAX SW 01 Bit 0 to 3

D629

44

SM

IP-Fax Troubleshooting

Fax Option
Type 5002
(D629)

IP-Fax bandwidth is the same as the
DCS speed. Set IP-Fax SW00 Bit 6 to
1.
Check whether the remote fax

12 Remote fax cancelled transmission?

SM

cancelled the transmission.

45

D629

IP-Fax Troubleshooting

Cannot send via VoIP Gateway

Check Point

Action

1

LAN cable connected?

Check the LAN cable connection.

2

VoIP Gateway T.38 standard?

Contact the network administrator.

3

VoIP Gateway installed correctly?

Contact the network administrator.

4

VoIP Gateway power switched on?

Contact the network administrator.

5

6

Is the IP address/host name of the

Check the IP address/host name.

specified Gateway correct?
Number of the specified fax correct?

Check the remote fax number.
Cannot breach the firewall. Send by

7

Firewall/NAT is installed?

using another method (Fax, Internet
Fax)

8

Transmission sent manually?

Manual sending not supported.

9

IP address of local fax registered?

Register the IP address.

10

DNS registered when host name

Contact the network administrator.

specified?

11 Remote fax a G3 fax?

Check that the remote fax is a G3 fax.

12 G3 fax is connected to VoIP gateway?

Check that G3 fax is connected.

13 Remote G3 fax turned on?

Check that G3 fax is switched on.
Request the network administrator to
increase the bandwidth.
Raise the network delay level.

14 Network bandwidth too narrow?

IPFAX SW 01 Bit 0 to 3
IP-Fax bandwidth is the same as the
DCS speed. Set IP-Fax SW00 Bit 6 to
1.

D629

46

SM

IP-Fax Troubleshooting

Check Point
1

LAN cable connected?

2

Number of specified Alias fax correct?

Fax Option
Type 5002
(D629)

Cannot send by Alias Fax number.

Action
Check the LAN cable connection.
Confirm the Alias of the remote fax.
Error Code: 13-14
Cannot breach the firewall. Send by

3

Firewall/NAT installed?

using another method (Fax, Internet
Fax)

4

Transmission sent manually?

5

Gatekeeper/SIP server installed correctly? Contact the network administrator.

6

7

Manual sending not supported.

Gatekeeper/SIP server power switched

Contact the network administrator.

on?
IP address/host name of Gatekeeper/SIP
server correct?

Check the IP address/host name.

DNS server registered when
8

Gatekeeper/SIP server host name

Contact the network administrator.

specified?
Check the settings.
9

Enable H.323/Enable SIP SW is set to on? See User Parameter SW 34 Bit 0/SW
34 Bit 1

10 IP address of local fax registered?

Register the IP address of the local fax.
Register the Alias number of the local

11 Alias number of local fax registered?

fax.

12 Remote fax registered in Gatekeeper?

Contact the network administrator.
Check whether the remote fax is a T38

13 Remote fax a T.38 terminal?

terminal.

14 Remote fax switched off or busy?

SM

Contact the network administrator.

47

D629

IP-Fax Troubleshooting

Request the system administrator to
increase the bandwidth.
Raise the delay level.
15 Network bandwidth too narrow?

IPFAX SW 01 Bit 0 to 3
Lower the modem transmission baud
rate.
IPFAX SW 05
Check whether the remote fax

16 Remote fax cancelled transmission?

D629

cancelled the transmission.

48

SM

IP-Fax Troubleshooting

Fax Option
Type 5002
(D629)

3.3.2 IP-FAX RECEPTION
Cannot receive via IP Address/Host Name.

Check Point
1

LAN cable connected?

2

Firewall/NAT is installed?

3

IP address of local fax registered?

4

5

Action
Check the LAN cable connection.
Cannot breach the firewall. Send by using
another method (Fax, Internet Fax)
Register the IP address.

Port number specified at remote sender Request the sender to specify the port
fax (if required)?

number.

Specified port number correct (if

Request the sender to check the port

required)?

number.
Contact the network administrator.

6

DNS server registered when host name



specified on sender side?

The sender machine displays this
error code if the sender fax is a
Ricoh model.

Request the system administrator to
increase the bandwidth.
7

Network bandwidth too narrow?

Lower the start modem reception baud
rate on the receiving side.
IPFAX SW06

8

SM

Remote fax cancelled transmission?

Check whether the remote fax cancelled
the transmission.

49

D629

IP-Fax Troubleshooting

Cannot receive by VoIP Gateway.

Check Point
1

LAN cable connected?

Action
Check the LAN cable connection.
Cannot breach the firewall. Request the

2

Firewall/NAT is installed?

remote fax to send by using another
method (Fax, Internet Fax)

3

VoIP Gateway installed correctly?

Contact the network administrator.

4

VoIP Gateway power switched on?

Contact the network administrator.

5

6

IP address/host name of specified VoIP Request the remote fax to check the IP
Gateway correct on sender’s side?
DNS server registered when host name
specified on sender side?

address/host name.

Contact the network administrator.

Request the network administrator to

7

Network bandwidth too narrow?

8

G3 fax connected?

Check that G3 fax is connected.

9

G3 fax power switched on?

Check that G3 fax is switched on.

D629

increase the bandwidth.

50

SM

IP-Fax Troubleshooting

Check Point
1

LAN cable connected?

Fax Option
Type 5002
(D629)

Cannot receive by Alias Fax number.

Action
Check the LAN cable connection.
Cannot the breach firewall. Request the

2

Firewall/NAT is installed?

remote fax to send by using another
method (Fax, Internet Fax)
Contact the network administrator.

3

Gatekeeper/SIP server installed



correctly?

The sender machine displays this
error code when the sender fax is
a Ricoh model.

Contact the network administrator.
4

Power to Gatekeeper/SIP server



switched on?

The sender machine displays this
error code when the sender fax is
a Ricoh model.

Request the sender to check the IP
IP address/host name of
5

address/host name.

Gatekeeper/SIP server correct on the



sender’s side?

The sender machine displays this
error code when the sender fax is
a Ricoh model.

Contact the network administrator.
DNS server registered when
6



Gatekeeper/SIP server host name
specified on sender’s side?

The sender machine displays this
error code when the sender fax is
a Ricoh model.

Request the sender to check the settings.
7

Enable H.323/Enable SIP SW is set to

User Parameter SW 34 Bit 0/SW 34 Bit 1

on?



Only if the remote sender fax is a
Ricoh fax.

SM

51

D629

IP-Fax Troubleshooting

8

Local fax IP address registered?

Register the IP address.

9

Local fax Alias number registered?

Register the Alias number.
Request the system administrator to
increase the bandwidth.

10 Network bandwidth too narrow?

Lower the start modem reception baud rate
on the receiving side.
IPFAX SW06

11 Remote fax cancelled transmission?

Check whether the remote fax cancelled
the transmission.
Contact the network administrator.

12

Local fax registered in Gatekeeper/SIP



server?

The sender machine displays this
error code when the sender fax is
a Ricoh model.

D629

52

SM

Cautions

Fax Option
Type 5002
(D629)

4. SERVICE TABLES
4.1 CAUTIONS


Never turn off the main power switch when the power LED is lit or flashing. To avoid
damaging the hard disk or memory, press the operation power switch to switch the power
off, wait for the power LED to go off, and then switch the main power switch off.



The main power LED lights or flashes while the platen cover or ARDF is open, while the
main machine is communicating with a facsimile or the network server, or while the
machine is accessing the hard disk or memory for reading or writing data.

SM

53

D629

Service Program Tables

4.2 SERVICE PROGRAM TABLES
4.2.1 SP1-XXX (BIT SWITCHES)
Bit Switches

1

Mode No.

Function

System Switch
Change the bit switches for system settings for the

101
001 – 032

00 – 1F

fax option
"System Switches" in "Bit Switches - 1"

Ifax Switch
Change the bit switches for internet fax settings for

102
001 – 016

00 – 0F

the fax option
"I-Fax Switches" in "Bit Switches - 2"

Printer Switch
Change the bit switches for printer settings for the fax

103
001 – 016

00 – 0F

option
"Printer Switches" in "Bit Switches - 2"

Communication Switch
Change the bit switches for communication settings

104
001 – 032

00 – 1F

for the fax option
"Communication Switches" in "Bit Switches - 3"

G3-1 Switch
Change the bit switches for the protocol settings of

105
001 – 016

00 – 0F

the standard G3 board
"G3 Switches" in "Bit Switches - 4"

G3-2 Switch
Change the bit switches for the protocol settings of

106
001 – 016

00 – 0F

the optional G3 board
"G3-2 and G3-3 Switches" in "Bit Switches - 5"

D629

54

SM

Service Program Tables

Fax Option
Type 5002
(D629)

G3-3 Switch
Change the bit switches for the protocol settings of

107
001 – 016

00 – 0F

the optional G3 board
"G3-2 and G3-3 Switches" in "Bit Switches - 5"

G4 Internal Switch
108
001 – 032

00 – 1F

Not used (Do not change the bit switches)

G4 Parameter Switch
109
001 – 016

00 – 0F

Not used (Do not change the bit switches)

IP fax Switch
Change the bit switches for optional IP fax

111
001 – 016

00 – 0F

parameters
"IP Fax Switches" in "Bit Switches - 6"

4.2.2 SP2-XXX (RAM DATA)

2

Mode No.

Function

RAM Read/Write
101

Change RAM data for the fax board directly.

001

p.164 "Service RAM Addresses"

Memory Dump

001

102

002

003

004
103

SM

G3-1 Memory
Dump

Print out RAM data for the fax board.
p.164 "Service RAM Addresses"

G3-2 Memory

Print out RAM data for the optional SG3

Dump

board.

G3-3 Memory

Print out RAM data for the optional SG3

Dump

board.

G4 Memory Dump

Not used

G3-1 NCU Parameters

55

D629

Service Program Tables

001 – 023

CC, 01 – 22

NCU parameter settings for the standard G3
board.

p.140 "NCU Parameters"

G3-2 NCU Parameters
104
001 – 023

CC, 01 – 22

NCU parameter settings for the optional G3
board.

p.140 "NCU Parameters"

G3-3 NCU Parameters
105
001 – 023

D629

CC, 01 – 22

NCU parameter settings for the optional G3
board.

56

p.140 "NCU Parameters"

SM

Service Program Tables

3

Mode No.

Fax Option
Type 5002
(D629)

4.2.3 SP3-XXX (TEL LINE SETTINGS)

Function

Service Station
101

001

Fax Number

Enter the fax number of the service station.

002

Select Line

Select the line type.

Serial Number
102
000

Enter the fax unit’s serial number.

PSTN-1 Port Settings
Select the line type setting for the G3-1 line. If
001

Select Line

the machine is installed on a PABX line, select
“PABX”, “PABX(GND)” or “PABX(FLASH)”.

103
002

003

PSTN Access

Enter the PSTN access number for the

Number

G3-1 line.

Memory Lock
Disabled

Not used

PSTN-2 Port Settings
Select the line setting for the G3-2 line. If the
001

Select Line

machine is installed on a PABX line, select
“PABX”, “PABX(GND)” or “PABX(FLASH)”.

104

002

003

004

SM

PSTN Access

Enter the PSTN access number for the G3-2

Number

line.

Memory Lock
Disabled

Not used

Transmission

If you turn this SP on, the machine does not

Disabled

send any fax messages on the G3-2 line.

57

D629

Service Program Tables

PSTN-3 Port Settings
Select the line setting for the G3-3 line. If the
001

Select Line

machine is installed on a PABX line, select
“PABX”, “PABX(GND)” or “PABX(FLASH)”.

105

002

003

004

PSTN Access

Enter the PSTN access number for the G3-3

Number

line.

Memory Lock
Disabled

Not used

Transmission

If you turn this SP on, the machine does not

Disabled

send any fax messages on the G3-3 line.

ISDN Port Settings
001
106

002

003

106

004

Select Line
PSTN Access
Number
Memory Lock

Not used (Do not change the settings.)

Disabled
Transmission
Disabled

IPFAX Port Settings

107

001

H323 Port

Sets the H323 port number.

002

SIP Port

Sets the SIP port number.

003

RAS Port

Sets the RAS port number.

004

Gatekeeper port

Sets the Gatekeeper port number.

005

T.38 Port

Sets the T.38 port number.

006

SIP Server Port

Sets the SIP port number.

007

D629

IPFAX Protocol
Priority

Select "H323" or "SIP".

58

SM

Service Program Tables

Fax Option
Type 5002
(D629)

FAX SW
201
001 – 032

00 – 1F

4.2.4 SP4-XXX (ROM VERSIONS)

4

Mode No.

Function

101

001

FCU ROM Version

Displays the FCU ROM version.

102

001

Error Codes

Displays the latest 64 fax error codes.

103

001

G3-1 ROM Version

Displays the G3-1 modem version.

104

001

G3-2 ROM Version

Displays the G3-2 modem version.

105

001

G3-3 ROM Version

Displays the G3-3 modem version.

106

001

G4 ROM Version

Not used (Do not change the settings.)

SM

59

D629

Service Program Tables

4.2.5 SP5-XXX (RAM CLEAR)

5

Mode No.

Function

Initialize SRAM (Except Secure)
101
000

Initializes the bit switches and user parameters, user data in
the SRAM, files in the SAF memory, and clock.

Erase All Files
102
000

Erases all files stored in the SAF memory.

Reset Bit Switches (Except Secure)
103
000

Resets the bit switches and user parameters.

Factory Setting
104
000

Resets the bit switches and user parameters, user data in the
SRAM and files in the SAF memory.

Reset All Bit Switches
105
000

Resets all the current bit switch settings.

Reset Security Bit Switches
Resets only the security bit switches. If you select automatic

106
000

output/display for the user parameter switches, the security
settings are initialized.

D629

60

SM

Service Program Tables

6

Mode No.

Fax Option
Type 5002
(D629)

4.2.6 SP6-XXX (REPORTS)

Function

System Parameter List
101
000

-

Touch the “ON” button to print the system
parameter list.

Service Monitor Report
102
000

-

Touch the “ON” button to print the service
monitor report.

G3 Protocol Dump List

001

002

003
103
004

005

006

007

SM

G3 All

Prints the protocol dump list of all

Communications

communications for all G3 lines.

G3-1 (All

Prints the protocol dump list of all

Communications)

communications for the G3-1 line.

G3-1

Prints the protocol dump list of the last

(1 Communication)

communication for the G3-1 line.

G3-2

Prints the protocol dump list of all

(All Communications)

communications for the G3-2 line.

G3-2

Prints the protocol dump list of the last

(1 Communication)

communication for the G3-2 line.

G3-3

Prints the protocol dump list of all

(All Communications)

communications for the G3-3 line.

G3-3

Prints the protocol dump list of the last

(1 Communication)

communication for the G3-3 line.

61

D629

Service Program Tables

G4 Protocol Dump List

104

001

Dch + Bch 1

002

Dch

003

Bch 1 Link Layer

004

Dch Link Layer

005

Dch +Bch 2

006

Bch 2 Link Layer

Not used (Do not change the settings.)

All Files print out
Prints out all the user files in the SAF memory,
including confidential messages.
105
000

-



Do not use this function, unless the
customer is having trouble printing
confidential messages or recovering
files stored using the memory lock
feature.

Journal Print out

106

D629

001

All Journals

002

Specified Date

The machine prints all the communication
records on the report.
The machine prints all communication records
after the specified date.

62

SM

Fax Option
Type 5002
(D629)

Service Program Tables

Log List Print out
001

All log files

002

Printer

003

SC/TRAP Stored

004

Decompression

005

Scanner

006

JOB/SAF

007

Reconstruction

008

JBIG

009

Fax Driver

010

G3CCU

011

Fax Job

012

CCU

013

Scanner Condition

107

These log print out functions are for designer
use only.

IP Protocol Dump List

108

SM

001

All Communications

002

1 Communication

Prints the protocol dump list of all
communications for the IP fax line.
Prints the protocol dump list of the last
communication for the IP fax line.

63

D629

Service Program Tables

4.2.7 SP7-XXX (TESTS)
These are the test modes for PTT approval.

7

Function

101

G3-1 Modem Tests

102

G3-1 DTMF Tests

103

Ringer Test

104

G3-1 V34 (S2400baud)

105

G3-1 V34 (S2800baud)

106

G3-1 V34 (S3000baud)

107

G3-1 V34 (S3200baud)

108

G3-1 V34 (S3429baud)

109

Recorded Message Test

110

G3-2 Modem Tests

111

G3-2 DTMF Tests

112

G3-2 V34 (S2400baud)

113

G3-2 V34 (S2800baud)

114

G3-2 V34 (S3000baud)

115

G3-2 V34 (S3200baud)

116

G3-2 V34 (S3429baud)

117

G3-3 Modem Tests

118

G3-3 DTMF Tests

119

G3-3 V34 (S2400baud)

120

G3-3 V34 (S2800baud)

121

G3-3 V34 (S3000baud)

D629

64

SM

122

G3-3 V34 (S3200baud)

123

G3-3 V34 (S3429baud)

124

IG3-1 Modem Tests - Not used

125

IG3-1 DTMF Tests - Not used

126

IG3-1 V34 (S2400baud) - Not used

127

IG3-1 V34 (S2800baud) - Not used

128

IG3-1 V34 (S3000baud) - Not used

129

IG3-1 V34 (S3200baud) - Not used

130

IG3-1 V34 (S3429baud) - Not used

131

IG3-2 Modem Tests - Not used

132

IG3-2 DTMF Tests - Not used

133

IG3-2 V34 (S2400baud) - Not used

134

IG3-2 V34 (S2800baud) - Not used

135

IG3-2 V34 (S3000baud) - Not used

136

IG3-2 V34 (S3200baud) - Not used

137

IG3-2 V34 (S3429baud) - Not used

SM

Fax Option
Type 5002
(D629)

Service Program Tables

65

D629

Bit Switches - 1

4.3 BIT SWITCHES - 1


Do not adjust a bit switch or use a setting that is described as "Not used", as this may
cause the machine to malfunction or to operate in a manner that is not accepted by local
regulations. Such bits are for use only in other areas, such as Japan.

Default settings for bit switches are not listed in this manual. Refer to the System Parameter List
printed by the machine.

4.3.1 SYSTEM SWITCHES

System Switch 00 (SP No. 1-101-001)
No

0

1

Function
Dedicated transmission

Set this bit to 1 before changing any dedicated

parameter programming

transmission parameters.

0: Disabled

This setting is automatically reset to "0" after

1: Enabled

turning off and on.

Not used

Do not change

Technical data printout on the
2

Journal
0: Disabled
1: Enabled

D629

Comments

1: Instead of the personal name, the following
data are listed on the Journal for each G3
communication.

66

SM

Bit Switches - 1

Fax Option
Type 5002
(D629)

Example:

(1): EQM value (Line quality data). A larger number means more errors.
(2): Symbol rate (V.34 only)
(3): Final modem type used
(4): Starting data rate (for example, 288 means 28.8 kbps)
(5): Final data rate
(6): Rx revel (see below for how to read the rx level)
(7): Total number of error lines that occurred during non-ECM reception.
(8): Total number of burst error lines that occurred during non-ECM reception.


EQM and rx level are fixed at "FFFF" in tx mode.



The seventh and eighth numbers are fixed at "00" for transmission
records and ECM reception records.

Rx level calculation
Example:

The four-digit hexadecimal value (N) after "L" indicates the rx level.
The high byte is given first, followed by the low byte. Divide the decimal value of
N by -16 to get the rx level.
In the above example, the decimal value of N (= 0100 [H]) is 256.
So, the actual rx level is 256/-16 = -16 dB
3

Not used

Do not change this setting.
When "1" is selected, a line error mark is

4

Line error mark print

printed on the printout if a line error occurs

0: OFF, 1: ON (print)

during reception. This shows error locations
when ECM is turned off.
This is a fault-finding aid. The LCD shows the

5

G3/G4 communication

key parameters (see "G3 Communication

parameter display

Parameters" below this table). This is normally

0: Disabled

disabled because it cancels the CSI display for

1: Enabled

the user.
Be sure to reset this bit to "0" after testing.

SM

67

D629

Bit Switches - 1

This is only used for communication
Protocol dump list output after
6

each communication
0: Off

troubleshooting. It shows the content of the
transmitted facsimile protocol signals. Always
reset this bit to 0 after finishing testing.
If system switch 09 bit 6 is at "1", the list is only

1: On

printed if there was an error during the
communication.

7

Not used

Do not change the setting.

G3 Communication Parameters

Modem rate

336: 33600 bps

168: 16800 bps

312: 31200 bps

144: 14400 bps

288: 28800 bps

120: 12000 bps

264: 26400 bps

96: 9600 bps

240: 24000 bps

72: 7200 bps

216: 21600 bps

48: 4800 bps

192: 19200 bps

24: 2400 bps

S: Standard (8 x 3.85 dots/mm)
D: Detail (8 x 7.7 dots/mm)
F: Fine (8 x 15.4 dots/mm)
Resolution

SF: Superfine (16 x 15.4 dots/mm)
21: Standard (200 x 100 dpi)
22: Detail (200 x 200 dpi)
44: Superfine (400 x 400 dpi)
MMR: MMR compression
MR: MR compression

Compression mode MH: MH compression
JBO: JBIG compression (Optional mode)
JBB: JBIG compression (Basic mode)
Communication

ECM: With ECM

mode

NML: With no ECM

D629

68

SM

Bit Switches - 1

reduction

A4: A4 (8.3"), no reduction
Fax Option
Type 5002
(D629)

Width and

B4: B4 (10.1"), no reduction
A3: A3 (11.7"), no reduction
0: 0 ms/line
5: 5 ms/line
10: 10 ms/line
20: 20 ms/line

I/O rate

25: 2.5 ms/line
40: 40 ms/line


"40" is displayed while receiving a fax message using AI
short protocol.

SM

69

D629

Bit Switches - 1

System Switch 01 - Not used (Do not change the factory settings.)

System Switch 02 (SP No. 1-101-003)
No
0

Function
Not used

Do not change these settings.

Forced reset after transmission
2

stalls

complete the job.

Not used

Do not change these settings.

File retention time
4

0: Depends on User Parameter
24 [18(H)]

1: A file that had a communication error will not
be erased unless the communication is
successful.

1: No limit
5

With this setting on, the machine resets itself
automatically if a transmission stalls and fails to

0: Off
1: On

3

Comments

Not used

Do not change this setting.

Memory read/write by RDS

(0,0): All RDS systems are always locked out.

Bit 7

Bit 6

Setting

0

0

Always disabled

0

1

User selectable

1

0

User selectable

1

1

Always enabled

(0,1), (1,0): Normally, RDS systems are locked
out, but the user can temporarily switch RDS
on to allow RDS operations to take place. RDS
will automatically be locked out again after a

6-7

certain time, which is stored in System Switch
03. Note that if an RDS operation takes place,
RDS will not switch off until this time limit has
expired.
(1,1): At any time, an RDS system can access
the machine.

D629

70

SM

Fax Option
Type 5002
(D629)

Bit Switches - 1

System Switch 03 (SP No. 1-101-004)
No

0
to
7

Function

Comments

Length of time that RDS is

00 - 99 hours (BCD).

temporarily switched on when

This setting is only valid if bits 6 and 7 of

bits 6 and 7 of System Switch

System Switch 02 are set to "User selectable".

02 are set to "User selectable"

The default setting is 24 hours.

System Switch 04 (SP No. 1-101-005)
No
0-2

Function
Not used

Comments
Do not change these settings.
1: Each Quick/Speed dial number on the list is

3

Printing dedicated tx

printed with the dedicated tx parameters (10

parameters on Quick/Speed

bytes each).

Dial Lists

The first 10 bytes of data are the programmed

0: Disabled

dedicated tx parameters; 34 bytes of data are

1: Enabled

printed (the other 24 bytes have no use for
service technicians).

4-7

Not used

Do not change these settings.

System Switch 05 - Not used (Do not change the factory settings.)
System Switch 06 - Not used (Do not change the factory settings.)
System Switch 07 - Not used (Do not change the factory settings.)
System Switch 08 - Not used (Do not change the factory settings.)

SM

71

D629

Bit Switches - 1

System Switch 09 (SP No. 1-101-010)
No

Function
Addition of image data from

0

confidential transmissions on
the transmission result report
0: Disabled 1: Enabled

Comments

If this feature is enabled, the top half of the first
page of confidential messages will be printed
on transmission result reports.

Print timing of communication
reports on the Journal when no
1

image data was exchanged.
0: After DCS/NSS
communication (default),

0: The Journal is printed only when image data
is sent.
1: The Journal is printed when any data is sent.

1: After polling

2

Automatic error report printout
0: Disabled 1: Enabled

0: Error reports will not be printed.
1: Error reports will be printed automatically
after failed communications.

Printing of the error code on the 1: Error codes are printed on the error reports.
3

4

error report

This can be used for detecting an error which

0: No 1: Yes

occurs rarely.

Not used

Do not change this setting.
1: A power failure report will be automatically
printed after the power is switched on if a fax

5

Power failure report

message disappeared from the memory when

0: Disabled

the power was turned off last.

1: Enabled (default)

NOTE: If "0" is selected, no reports are printed
and no one may recognize that fax data is gone
due to a power failure.

D629

72

SM

Bit Switches - 1

Conditions for printing the
protocol dump list
6

0: Print for all communications
1: Print only when there is a
communication error

Fax Option
Type 5002
(D629)

This switch becomes effective only when
system switch 00 bit 6 is set to 1.
1: Set this bit to 1 when you wish to print a
protocol dump list only for communications with
errors.
NOTE: The memory size is limited. Use this bit
switch only when some log reports are
necessary.
Priority given to various types of

7

remote terminal ID when

This bit determines which set of priorities the

printing reports

machine uses when listing remote terminal

0: RTI > CSI > Dial label > Tel.

names on reports.

number

Dial Label: The name stored, by the user, for

1: Dial label > Tel. number > RTI the Quick/Speed Dial number.
> CSI

System Switch 0A (SP No. 1-101-011)
No

Function

Comments
When "1" is selected, a suitable port is
automatically selected if the selected port is not

0

Automatic port selection

used.

0: Disabled, 1: Enabled

NOTE: This bit is useful if all communication
lines at a customer site are not the same
quality

1-3

Not used

Do not change these settings.
0: Prevents dialing from the ten-key pad while

Dialing on the ten-key pad when
4

the external telephone is
off-hook
0: Disabled 1: Enabled

the external telephone is off-hook. Use this
setting when the external telephone is not by
the machine, or if a wireless telephone is
connected as an external telephone.
1: The user can dial on the machine's ten-key
pad when the handset is off-hook.

5

SM

On hook dial
0: Disabled 1: Enabled

0: On hook dial is disabled.

73

D629

Bit Switches - 1

6-7

Not used

Do not change the factory settings

System Switch 0B - Not used (Do not change the factory settings.)
System Switch 0C - Not used (Do not change the factory settings.)
System Switch 0D - Not used (Do not change the factory settings.)

System Switch 0E (SP No. 1-101-015)
No
0-1

Function
Not used

Comments
Do not change the settings.
Direct sending cannot operate when the
capture function is on during sending. Setting

2

Enable/disable for direct

this switch to "1" enables direct sending without

sending selection

capture.

0: Direct sending off

Setting this switch to "0" masks the direct

1: Direct sending on

sending function on the operation panel so
direct sending with ScanRouter cannot be
selected.
0: Manual tx is possible while the external
handset is off-hook. However, manual tx during

3

Action when the external

handset off-hook may not be sent to a correct

handset goes off-hook

direction. Manual tx is not possible.

0: Manual tx and rx operation

1: The display stays in standby mode even

1: Memory tx and rx operation

when the external handset is used, so that

(the display remains the same)

other people can use the machine for memory
tx operation. Note that manual tx and rx are not
possible with this setting.

4-7

D629

Not used

Do not change these settings.

74

SM

Fax Option
Type 5002
(D629)

Bit Switches - 1

System Switch 0F (SP No. 1-101-016)
No

Function

Comments

Country/area code for functional
settings (Hex)
00: France

12: Asia

01: Germany

13: Japan

02: UK

14: Hong Kong

03: Italy

15: South Africa
This country/area code determines the

04: Austria

16: Australia

05: Belgium

17: New Zealand

factory settings of bit switches and RAM
addresses. However, it has no effect on
the NCU parameter settings and

0
to
7

06: Denmark

18: Singapore

07: Finland

19: Malaysia

08: Ireland

1A: China

09: Norway

1B: Taiwan

0A: Sweden

1C: Korea

0B: Switz.

1D: Brazil

0C: Portugal

20: Turkey

0D: Holland

21: Greece

0E: Spain

22: Hungary

0F: Israel

23: Czech

10: ---

24: Poland

communication parameter RAM
addresses.
Cross reference
NCU country code:
SP No. 2-103-001 for G3-1
SP No. 2-104-001 for G3-2
SP No. 2-105-001 for G3-3

11: USA

SM

75

D629

Bit Switches - 1

System Switch 10 (SP No. 1-101-017)
No

0-7

Function

Threshold memory level for
parallel memory transmission

Comments
Threshold = N x 128 KB + 256 KB
N can be between 00 - FF(H)
Default setting: 02(H) = 512 KB

System Switch 11 (SP No. 1-101-018)
No

0

1-2

Function

Comments

TTI printing position

Change this bit to 1 if the TTI overprints

0: Superimposed on the page

information that the customer considers to be

data

important (G3 transmissions).

1: Printed before the data

NOTE: If "1" is selected, it is possible that sent

leading edge

data is printed on two sheets of paper.

Not used

Do not change the factory settings.

TTI used for broadcasting
0: The TTIs selected for each
3

Quick/Speed dial are used
1: The same TTI is used for all

1: The TTI (TTI_1 or TTI_2) which is selected
for all destinations during broadcasting.

destinations
4-7

D629

Not used

Do not change the factory settings.

76

SM

Fax Option
Type 5002
(D629)

Bit Switches - 1

System Switch 12 (SP No. 1-101-019)
No

Function

Comments
TTI: 08 to 92 (BCD) mm
Input even numbers only.
This setting determines the print start position

0-7

TTI printing position in the main
scan direction

for the TTI from the left edge of the paper. If the
TTI is moved too far to the right, it may
overwrite the file number which is on the top
right of the page. On an A4 page, if the TTI is
moved over by more than 50 mm, it may
overwrite the page number.

System Switch 13 - Not used (do not change these settings)
System Switch 14 - Not used (do not change these settings)

System Switch 15 (SP No. 1-101-022)
No
0

Function
Not used

Comments
Do not change the settings.
1: The machine will restart from the Energy
Saver mode quickly, because the +5V power

Going into the Energy Saver
1

mode automatically
0: Enabled
1: Disabled

supply is active even in the Energy Saver
mode. The LED of the operation switch is
flashing instead of entering Energy Saver
mode.
Use this setting if an external telephone has to
be used when the machine is in the Energy
Saver mode.

2-3

SM

Not used

Do not change these settings.

77

D629

Bit Switches - 1

Interval for preventing the
machine from entering Energy
Saver mode if there is a pending
If there is a file waiting for transmission, the

transmission file.

machine does not go to Energy Saver mode
Bit 5

Bit 4

Setting

0

0

1 min

0

1

30 min

1

0

1 hour

1

1

24 hours

4-5

during the selected period.
After transmitting the file, if there is no file
waiting for transmission, the machine goes to

6-7

Not used

the Energy Saver mode.

Do not change

System Switch 16 (SP No. 1-101-023)
No

Function

Comments
1: The machine sends messages

Parallel Broadcasting
0

0: Disabled
1: Enabled

simultaneously using all available ports during
broadcasting.
NOTE: If a customer wants to keep a line
available for fax reception or other reasons,
select "0" (Disable).

1

2-7

Priority setting for the G3 line.

This function allows the user to select the

0: PSTN-1 > PSTN-2 or 3

default G3 line type. The optional SG3 units are

1: PSTN-2 or 3 > PSTN-1

required to use the PSTN-2 or 3 setting.

Not used

Do not change these settings.

System Switch 17 - Not used (do not change these settings)
System Switch 18 - Not used (do not change these settings)

D629

78

SM

Fax Option
Type 5002
(D629)

Bit Switches - 1

System Switch 19 (SP No. 1-101-026)
No
0-5

Function
Not used

Comments
Do not change the settings.
0: After installing the memory expansion option,

6

Extended scanner page

the scanner page memory is extended to 4 MB

memory after memory option is

from 2 MB.

installed

1: If this bit is set to 1 after installing the

0: Disabled

memory expansion option, the scanner page

1: Enabled

memory is extended to 12 MB. But the SAF
memory decreases to 18 MB.
1: If the customer frequently wishes to transmit

Special Original mode
7

0: Disabled

a form or letterhead which has a colored or
printed background, change this bit to "1".
"Original 1" and "Original 2" can be selected in

1: Enabled

addition to the "Text", "Text/Photo" and "Photo"
modes.

System Switch 1A (SP No. 1-101-027)
No

Function

Comments
Sets the value to x4KB. When the amount of

0

LS RX memory capacity

to

threshold setting

7

00-FF (0-1020 Kbyte: Hex)

available memory drops below this setting, RX
documents are printed to conserve memory.
Initial setting 0x80 (512 KB)
NOTE: If a customer wants available memory
size to be larger, decrease this threshold

System Switch 1B - Not used (do not change these settings)
System Switch 1C - Not used (do not change these settings)

SM

79

D629

Bit Switches - 1

System Switch 1D (SP No. 1-101-030)
No

Function

RTI/CSI/CPS code display
0

0: Enable

0: RTI, CSI, CPS codes are displayed on the
top line of the LCD panel during
communication.

1: Disable

1-7

Comments

1: Codes are switched off (no display)

Not used

Do not change these settings.

System Switch 1E (SP No. 1-101-031)
No

Function

Comments
0: When this switch is on and the journal
history becomes full, the next report prints. If
the journal history is not deleted, the next
transmission cannot be received. This prevents
overwriting communication records before the

Communication after the
Journal data storage area has
0

become full
0: Impossible
1: Possible

machine can print them.
1: If the buffer memory of the communication
records for the Journal is full, fax
communications are still possible. But the
machine will overwrite the oldest
communication records.


This setting is effective only when
Automatic Journal printout is enabled
but the machine cannot print the report
(e.g., no paper).

D629

80

SM

Bit Switches - 1

Fax Option
Type 5002
(D629)

0: If the SAF memory becomes full during
scanning for a memory transmission, the
successfully scanned pages are transmitted.

1

Action when the SAF memory

1: If the SAF memory becomes full during

has become full during

scanning for a memory transmission, the file is

scanning

erased and no pages are transmitted.

0: The current page is erased.
1: The entire file is erased.



This setting is effective only when
Automatic Journal printout is enabled
but the machine cannot print the report
(e.g., no paper).

2

RTI/CSI display priority
0: RTI 1: CSI

File No. printing
3

0: Enabled
1: Disabled

This bit determines which identifier, RTI or CSI,
is displayed on the LCD while the machine is
communicating in G3 non-standard mode.
1: File numbers are not printed on any reports.
NOTE: The file numbers may not be printed in
the sequential order. If a customer does not like
this numbering, select "0".
0: If the user has stored no acceptable sender
RTIs or CSIs, the user can select “ON” in the

4

Action when authorized

authorized reception setting but the setting

reception is enabled but

becomes invalid (“OFF”). The machine will not

authorized RTIs/CSIs are not

be able to receive any fax messages.

yet programmed

If the customer wishes to receive messages

0: Faxes can be received if the

from any sender that includes an RTI or CSI,

sender has an RTI or CSI

and to block messages from senders that do

1: All fax reception is disabled

not include an RTI or CSI, change this bit to
"0", then enable Authorized Reception.
Otherwise, keep this bit at "1 (default setting)".

5-7

SM

Not used

Do not change the settings

81

D629

Bit Switches - 1

System Switch 1F (SP No. 1-101-032)
No
0

Function
Not used

Comments
Do not change the settings.
0: When an original jams, or the SAF memory

Report printout after an original

overflows during scanning, a report will be

jam during SAF storage or if the printed.
1

SAF memory fills up

Change this bit to "1" if the customer does not

0: Enabled

want to have a report in these cases.

1: Disabled

Memory tx – Memory storage report
Parallel memory tx – Transmission result report

2

Not used

Received fax print start timing
3

(G3 reception)
0: After receiving each page
1: After receiving all pages

4-6

Not used

Do not change the settings.
0: The machine prints each page immediately
after the machine receives it.
1: The machine prints the complete message
after the machine receives all the pages in the
memory.
Do not change the factory settings.
0: When the fax unit detects a fax SC code

Action when a fax SC has
7

occurred
0: Automatic reset
1: Fax unit stops

other than SC1201 and SC1207, the fax unit
automatically resets itself.
1: When the fax unit detects any fax SC code,
the fax unit stops.
Cross Reference
Fax SC codes - See "Troubleshooting"

D629

82

SM

4.4 BIT SWITCHES - 2


Do not adjust a bit switch or use a setting that is described as "Not used", as this may
cause the machine to malfunction or to operate in a manner that is not accepted by local
regulations. Such bits are for use only in other areas, such as Japan.

Default settings for bit switches are not listed in this manual. Refer to the System Parameter List
printed by the machine.

4.4.1 I-FAX SWITCHES

I-fax Switch 00 (SP No. 1-102-001)
No

Function

Comments
This setting sets the maximum size of the

Original Width of TX Attachment File

original that the destination can receive. (Bits
3~7 are reserved for future use or not used.)

0

A4

1

B4

2

A3

3-6

Reserved

7

Not used

-

0: Off (not selected), 1: On (selected)
If more than one of these three bits is set to "1", the larger size has priority. For
example, if both Bit 2 and Bit 1 are set to "1" then the maximum size is "A3" (Bit
2).
When mail is sent, there is no negotiation with the receiving machine at the
destination, so the sending machine cannot make a selection for the receiving
capabilities (original width setting) of the receiving machine. The original width
selected with this switch is used as the RX machine's original width setting, and
the original is reduced to this size before sending. The default is A4.
If the width selected with this switch is higher than the receiving machine can
accept, the machine detects this and this causes an error.

SM

83

D629

Fax Option
Type 5002
(D629)

Bit Switches - 2

Bit Switches - 2

I-fax Switch 01 (SP No. 1-102-002)
No

Function

Comments

Original Line Resolution of TX

These settings set the maximum resolution of

Attachment File

the original that the destination can receive.

0

200x100 Standard

1

200x200 Detail
0: Not selected

2

200x400 Fine

3

300 x 300 Reserve

4

400 x 400 Super Fine

5

600 x 600 Reserve

6

Reserve

7

mm/inch

1: Selected
If more than one of these three bits is set to "1",
the higher resolution has priority. For example,
if both Bit 0 and Bit 2 are set to "1" Then The
Resolution is set for "Bit 2 200 x 400.

This setting selects mm/inch conversion for mail transmission.
0: Off (No conversion), 1: On (Conversion)
When on (set to "1"), the machine converts millimeters to inches for sending mail.
There is no switch for converting inches to millimeters.
Unlike G3 fax transmissions which can negotiate between sender and receiver to
determine the setting, mail cannot negotiate between terminals; the mm/inch
selection is determined by the sender fax.
When this switch is Off (0):


Images scanned in inches are sent in inches.



Images scanned in mm are sent in mm.



Images received in inches are transmitted in inches.



Images received in mm are transmitted in mm.

When this switch is On (1):

D629



Images scanned in inches are sent in inches.



Images scanned in mm are converted to inches.



Images received in inches are transmitted in inches.



Images received in mm are converted to inches.

84

SM

Fax Option
Type 5002
(D629)

Bit Switches - 2

I-fax Switch 02 (SP No. 1-102-003)
No

Function

Comments

RX Text Mail Header Processing
This setting determines whether the header information is printed with text e-mails
when they are received.
0: Prints only text mail.
0

1: Prints mail header information attached to text mail.
When a text mail is received with this switch On (1), the "From" address and
"Subject" address are printed as header information.
When a mail with only binary data is received (a TIFF-F file, for example), this
setting is ignored and no header is printed.
Output from Attached Document at E-mail TX Error
This setting determines whether only the first page or all pages of an e-mail
attachment are printed at the sending station when a transmission error occurs.

1

This allows the customer to see which documents have not reached their
intended destinations if sent to the wrong e-mail addresses, for example.
0: Prints 1st page only.
1: Prints all pages.
Text String for Return Receipt

2-3

This setting determines the text string output for the Return Receipt that confirms
the transmission was received normally at the destination.

SM

85

D629

Bit Switches - 2

00: "Dispatched"
Sends from PC mail a request for a Return Receipt. Receives the Return Receipt
with "dispatched" in the 2nd part:
Disposition: Automatic-action/MDN-send automatically; dispatched
The "dispatched" string is included in the Subject string.
01: "Displayed"
Sends from PC mail a request for a Return Receipt. Receives the Return Receipt
with "displayed" in the 2nd part:
Disposition: Automatic-action/MDN-send automatically; displayed
The "displayed" string is included in the Subject string.
10: Reserved
11: Reserved
A mail requesting a Return Receipt sent from an IFAX with this switch set to "00"
(for "dispatched") received by Microsoft Outlook 2000 may cause an error. If any
setting other than "displayed" (01) causes a problem, change the setting to "01" to
enable normal sending of the Return Receipt.
Media accept feature
This setting adds or does not add the media accept feature to the answer mail to
confirm a reception.
4

0: Does not add the media accept feature to the answer mail
1: Adds the media accept feature to the answer mail.
Use this bit switch if a problem occurs when the machine receives an answer
mail, which contains the media accept feature field.

5-6

Not Used
Image Resolution of RX Text Mail
This setting determines the image resolution of the received mail.

7

0: 200 x 200
1: 400 x 400
The "1" setting requires installation of the Memory Unit in order to have enough
SAF (Store and Forward) memory to receive images at 400 x 400 resolution.

D629

86

SM

Fax Option
Type 5002
(D629)

Bit Switches - 2

I-fax Switch 03 - Not used (do not change these settings)

I-fax Switch 04 (SP No. 1-102-005)
No

Function

Comments

Subject for Delivery TX/Memory Transfer
This setting determines whether the RTI/CSI registered on this machine or the
RTI/CSI of the originator is used in the subject lines of transferred documents.
0: Puts the RTI/CSI of the originator in the Subject line. If this is used, either the
0

RTI or CSI is used. Only one of these can be received for use in the subject line.
1: Puts the RTI/CSI registered on this machine in the Subject line.
When this switch is used to transfer and deliver mail to a PC, the information in
the Subject line that indicates where the transmission originated can be used to
determine automatically the destination folder for each e-mail.
Subject corresponding to mail post database
0: Standard subject
1: Mail post database subject
The standard subject is replaced by the mail post database subject in the
following three cases:
1) When the service technician sets the service (software) switch.

1

2) When memory sending or delivery specified by F code is applied by the SMTP
server
3) With relay broadcasting (1st stage without the Schmidt 4 function).


This switch does not apply for condition 3) when the RX system is set up
for memory sending, delivery by F-code, sending with SMTP RX and
when operators are using FOL (to prevent problems when receiving
transmissions).

2-7

SM

Not Used

87

D629

Bit Switches - 2

I-fax Switch 05 (SP No. 1-102-006)
No

Function

Comments

Mail Addresses of SMTP Broadcast Recipients
Determines whether the e-mail addresses of the destinations that receive
transmissions broadcasted using SMTP protocol are recorded in the Journal.
For example:

0

"1st destination + Total number of destinations: 9" in the Journal indicates a
broadcast to 9 destinations.
0: Not recorded
1: Recorded
1-7

Not Used

I-fax Switch 06 - Not used (do not change the settings)
I-fax Switch 07 - Not used (do not change the settings)

I-fax Switch 08 (SP No. 1-102-009)
No

Function

Comments

Memory Threshold for POP Mail Reception
This setting determines the amount of SAF (Store and Forward) memory. (SAF
stores fax messages to send later for transmission to more than one location, and
also holds incoming messages if they cannot be printed.) When the amount of
0-7

SAF memory available falls below this setting, mail can no longer be received;
received mail is then stored on the mail server.
00-FF (0 to 1024 KB: HEX)
The hexadecimal number you enter is multiplied by 4 KB to determine the amount
of memory.

D629

88

SM

Fax Option
Type 5002
(D629)

Bit Switches - 2

I-fax Switch 09 (SP No. 1-102-010)
No
0-3

Function

Comments

Not used

Do not change the settings
This setting determines the number of retries

4-7

when connection and transmission fails due to

Restrict TX Retries

errors.
01-F (1-15 Hex)

I-fax Switch 0A - Not used (do not change the settings)
I-fax Switch 0B - Not used (do not change the settings)
I-fax Switch 0C - Not used (do not change the settings)

I-fax Switch 0D (SP No. 1-102-014)
No
0-1

Function

Comments

Not used

Do not change the settings

Set to select the signature when
sending mail notification of the send
results

2-3

SM

Bit 2

Bit 3

Setting

0

0

No sign

0

1

No setting

1

0

Individual setting

1

1

Always sign

In response to IEEE2600.1.

89

D629

Bit Switches - 2

4-5

6-7

Set to select the signature when
sending mail.
Bit 5

Bit 4

Setting

0

0

No sign

0

1

No setting

1

0

Individual setting

1

1

Always sign

In response to IEEE2600.1.

Not used

Do not change the settings.

I-fax Switch 0E - Not used (do not change the settings)

I-fax Switch 0F (SP No. 1-102-016)
No

Function

Comments

Delivery Method for SMTP RX Files
This setting determines whether files received with SMTP protocol are delivered
0

or output immediately.
0: Off. Files received via SMTP are output immediately without delivery.
1: On. Files received via SMTP are delivered immediately to their destinations.

1-7

D629

Not used

90

SM

Bit Switches - 2

Fax Option
Type 5002
(D629)

4.4.2 PRINTER SWITCHES

Printer Switch 00 (SP No. 1-103-001)
No

Function

Comments
0: If a 2 page RX transmission is split, [*] is
printed in the bottom right corner of the 1st page
and only a [2] is printed in the upper right corner
of the 2nd page.
1: If a 2 page RX transmission is split into two

Select page separation marks
0

0: Off
1: On

pages, for example, [*] [2] is printed in the bottom
right corner of the 1st page and only a [2] is
printed in the upper right corner of the 2nd page.


This helps the user to identify pages that
have been split because the size of the
paper is smaller than the size of the
document received. (When A5 is used to
print an A4 size document, for example.)

1

Repetition of data when the

1: Default. 10 mm of the trailing edge of the

received page is longer than

previous page are repeated at the top of the next

the printer paper

page.

0: Off

0: The next page continues from where the

1: On

previous page stopped without any repeated text.
This switch is only effective when user parameter

2

Prints the date and time on

02 - bit 2 (printing the received date and time on

received fax messages

received fax messages) is enabled.

0: Disabled

1: The machine prints the received and printed

1: Enabled

date and time at the bottom of each received
page.

3-7

SM

Not used

Do not change the settings.

91

D629

Bit Switches - 2

Printer Switch 01 (SP No. 1-103-002)
No
0-2

Function

Comments

Not used

Do not change the settings.

Maximum print width used in the
setup protocol

3-4

5-6

Bit 4

Bit 3

Setting

0

0

Not used

0

1

A3

1

0

B4

1

1

A4

These bits are only effective when bit 7 of
printer switch 01 is "1".

Not used

Do not change the settings.
0: The machine informs the transmitting
machine of the print width depending on the
paper size available from the paper feed

Received message width
restriction in the protocol signal
7

to the sender
0: Disabled
1: Enabled

stations.
Refer to the table on the next page for how the
machine chooses the paper width used in the
setup protocol (NSF/DIS).
1: The machine informs the transmitting
machine of the fixed paper width which is
specified by bits 3 and 4 above.

Relationship between available paper sizes and printer width used in the setup protocol

Available Paper Size

Printer width used in the Protocol (NSF/DIS)

A4 or 8.5" x 11"

297 mm width

B5

256 mm width

A5 or 8.5" x 5.5"

216 mm width

No paper available (Paper end)

216 mm width

D629

92

SM

Fax Option
Type 5002
(D629)

Bit Switches - 2

Printer Switch 02 (SP No. 1-103-003)
No

Function

Comments

1st paper feed station usage for
0

fax printing
0: Enabled
1: Disabled
2nd paper feed station usage

1

for fax printing

0: The paper feed station can be used to print

0: Enabled

fax messages and reports.

1: Disabled

1: The specified paper feed station will not be

3rd paper feed station usage for
2

fax printing
0: Enabled

used for printing fax messages and reports.


station which has been specified by

1: Disabled

3

Do not disable usage for a paper feed
User Parameter Switch 0F (15), or

4th paper feed station usage for

which is used for the Specified

fax printing

Cassette Selection feature.

0: Enabled
1: Disabled
LCT usage for fax printing

4

0: Enabled
1: Disabled

5-7

SM

Not used

Do not change the settings.

93

D629

Bit Switches - 2

Printer Switch 03 (SP No. 1-103-004)
No

Function

Comments
0: Incoming pages are printed without length
reduction.

0

Length reduction of received

(Page separation threshold: Printer Switch 03,

data

bits 4 to 7)

0: Disabled

1: Incoming page length is reduced when

1: Enabled

printing.
(Maximum reducible length: Printer Switches
04, bits 0 to 4)

1-3

Not used

Do not change the settings
Page separation threshold (with reduction
disabled with switch 03-0 above).

Page separation setting when

For example, if this setting is set to "10", and

4

sub scan compression is

A4 is the selected paper size:

to

forbidden

If the received document is 10 mm or less

7

00-0F (0-15 mm: Hex)

longer than A4, then the 10 mm are cut and

Default: 6 mm

only 1 page prints.
If the received document is 10 mm longer than
A4, then the document is split into 2 pages.

D629

94

SM

Fax Option
Type 5002
(D629)

Bit Switches - 2

Printer Switch 04 (SP No. 1-103-005)
No

Function

Comments

Maximum reducible length when length reduction is enabled with switch 03-0
above.
[Maximum reducible length] = [Paper length] + (N x 5mm)
"N" is the decimal value of the binary setting of bits 0 to 4.

0
to
4

Bit 4

Bit 3

Bit 2

Bit 1

Bit 0

Setting

0

0

0

0

0

0 mm

0

0

0

0

1

5 mm

0

0

1

0

0

20 mm

1

1

1

1

1

155 mm

For A5 sideways and B5 sideways paper
[Maximum reducible length] = [Paper length] + 0.75 x (N x 5mm)
Length of the duplicated image on the next page, when page separation has
taken place.

5

Bit 6

Bit 5

Setting

0

0

4 mm

0

1

10 mm

1

0

15 mm

1

1

Not used

6

7

SM

Not used.

Do not change the setting.

95

D629

Bit Switches - 2

Printer Switch 05 - Not used (do not change the settings)

Printer Switch 06 (SP No. 1-103-007)
No

Function

Comments

Printing while a paper cassette
is pulled out, when the Just Size
Printing feature is enabled.
0

0: Printing will not start

Cross reference

1: Printing will start if another

Just size printing on/off – User switch 05, bit 5

cassette has a suitable size of
paper, based on the paper size
selection priority tables.
1-7

Not used.

Do not change the settings.

Printer Switch 07 (SP No. 1-103-008)
No
0-3

Function
Not used.

Comments
Do not change the settings.

List of destinations in the
Communication Failure Report
4

for broadcasting
0: All destinations
1: Only destinations where

1: Only destinations where communication
failure occurred are printed on the
Communication Failure Report.

communication failure occurred
5-7

Not used.

Do not change the settings.

Printer Switch 08 - Not used (do not change the settings)
Printer Switch 09 - Not used (do not change the settings)
Printer Switch 0A - Not used (do not change the settings)
Printer Switch 0B - Not used (do not change the settings)

D629

96

SM

Bit Switches - 2

Fax Option
Type 5002
(D629)

Printer Switch 0C - Not used (do not change the settings)

Printer Switch 0E (SP No. 1-103-015)
No

Function

Comments
0: A paper size that has the same width

0

Paper size selection priority

as the received data is selected first.

0: Width

1: A paper size which has enough length

1: Length

to print all the received lines without
reduction is selected first.

1

Paper size selected for printing A4

This switch determines which paper size

width fax data

is selected for printing A4 width fax data,

0: 8.5" x 11" size

when the machine has both A4 and 8.5" x

1: A4 size

11" size paper.
1: If all paper sizes in the machine require
page separation to print a received fax

2

Page separation

message, the machine does not print the

0: Enabled

message (Substitute Reception is used).

1: Disabled

After a larger size of paper is set in a
cassette, the machine automatically
prints the fax message.

Printing the sample image on reports
Bit 4

Bit 3

Setting

0

0

The upper half only

0

1

"Same size" means the sample image is
printed at 100%, even if page separation

3-4

occurs.

50% reduction

User Parameter Switch 19 (13H) bit 4

(sub-scan only)

must be set to "0" to enable this switch.
Refer to Detailed Section Descriptions for

5-6

SM

1

0

Same size

1

1

Not used

Not used

more on this feature.

Do not change the settings.

97

D629

Bit Switches - 2

0: When page separation has taken

7

Equalizing the reduction ratio among

place, all the pages are reduced with the

separated pages

same reduction ratio.

(Page Separation)

1: Only the last page is reduced to fit the

0: Enabled

selected paper size when page

1: Disabled

separation has taken place. Other pages
are printed without reduction.

Printer Switch 0F (SP No. 1-103-016)
No

Function

Comments

Smoothing feature
Bit 1

Bit 0

Setting

0

0

Disabled

machine receives halftone images from

0

1

Disabled

other manufacturers fax machines

(0, 0) (0, 1): Disable smoothing if the
0-1

frequently.
1

0

Enabled

1

1

Not used

Duplex printing
2

1: The machine always prints received

0: Disabled

fax messages in duplex printing mode:

1: Enabled

0: Sets the binding for the left edge of

Binding direction for Duplex printing
3

the stack.

0: Left binding

1: Sets the binding for the top of the

1: Top binding

4-7

D629

stack.

Not used

Do not change the settings.

98

SM

4.5 BIT SWITCHES - 3


Do not adjust a bit switch or use a setting that is described as "Not used", as this may
cause the machine to malfunction or to operate in a manner that is not accepted by local
regulations. Such bits are for use only in other areas, such as Japan.

Default settings for bit switches are not listed in this manual. Refer to the System Parameter List
printed by the machine.

4.5.1 COMMUNICATION SWITCHES

Communication Switch 00 (SP No. 1-104-001)
No

Function

Comments

Compression modes available in receive
mode

0-1

Bit 1

Bit 0

0

0

Modes

These bits determine the
compression capabilities to be

MH only

declared in phase B (handshaking)
0

1

MH/MR

1

0

MH/MR/MMR

1

1

MH/MR/MMR/JBIG

of the T.30 protocol.

Compression modes available in transmit
mode
Bit 3

Bit 2

These bits determine the

Modes

compression capabilities to be used
2-3

0

0

MH only

in the transmission and to be

0

1

MH/MR

declared in phase B (handshaking)
of the T.30 protocol.

4

SM

1

0

MH/MR/MMR

1

1

MH/MR/MMR/JBIG

Not used

Do not change the settings.

99

D629

Fax Option
Type 5002
(D629)

Bit Switches - 3

Bit Switches - 3

5

6

JBIG compression method: Reception

Change the setting when

0: Only basic supported

communication problems occur

1: Basic and optional both supported

using JBIG compression.

JBIG compression method: Transmission

Change the setting when

0: Basic mode priority

communication problems occur

1: Optional mode priority

using JBIG compression.
1: Reception will not go ahead if the
polling ID code of the remote

Closed network (reception)
7

terminal does not match the polling

0: Disabled

ID code of the local terminal. This

1: Enabled

function is only available in
NSF/NSS mode.

Communication Switch 01 (SP No. 1-104-002)
No

Function

Comments
If this bit is set to 0, ECM is switched off for all

0

ECM

communications.

0: Off 1: On

In addition, V.8 protocol and JBIG compression
are switched off automatically.

1

Not used

Do not change the setting.

Wrong connection prevention
method

(0,1): The machine will disconnect the line
without sending a fax message, if the last 8
digits of the received CSI do not match the last

Bit 3

Bit 2

Setting

0

0

None

does not work when manually dialed.

0

1

8 digit CSI

(1,0): The same as above, except that only the

8 digits of the dialed telephone number. This
2-3

last 4 digits are compared.

D629

1

0

4 digit CSI

1

1

CSI/RTI

(1,1): The machine will disconnect the line
without sending a fax message, if the other end

100

SM

Bit Switches - 3

Fax Option
Type 5002
(D629)

does not identify itself with an RTI or CSI.
(0,0): Nothing is checked; transmission will
always go ahead.


This function does not work when
dialing is done from the external
telephone.

4-5

Not used

Do not change the setting.

Maximum printable page length
available

6-7

Bit 7

Bit 6

0

0

Setting
No limit

The setting determined by these bits is
informed to the transmitting terminal in the
pre-message protocol exchange (in the

0

1

B4 (364 mm)

1

0

A4 (297 mm)

1

1

Not used

DIS/NSF frames).

Communication Switch 02 (SP No. 1-104-003)
No

Function

Comments
If there are more consecutive error lines in
the received page than the threshold, the
machine will send a negative response.
The Low and High threshold values
depend on the sub-scan resolution, and

0

SM

G3 Burst error threshold
0: Low 1: High

are as follows.
100 dpi

6(L)

200 dpi

12(L)

24(H)

300 dpi

18(L)

36(H)

400 dpi

24(L)

48(H)

101

12(H)

D629

Bit Switches - 3

If the error line ratio for a page exceeds the

Acceptable total error line ratio

1

acceptable ratio, RTN will be sent to the

0: 5% 1: 10%

other end.

Treatment of pages received with
errors during G3 reception
2

0: Pages received with errors are not

0: Deleted from memory without

printed.

printing
1: Printed

0: The next page will be sent even if RTN

3

Hang-up decision when a negative

or PIN is received.

code (RTN or PIN) is received

1: The machine will send DCN and hang up

during G3 immediate transmission

if it receives RTN or PIN.

0: No hang-up, 1: Hang-up

This bit is ignored for memory
transmissions or if ECM is being used.

4-7

Not used

Do not change the settings.

Communication Switch 03 (SP No. 1-104-004)
No

0-7

Function

Comments

Maximum number of page

00 - FF (Hex) times.

retransmissions in a G3

This setting is not used if ECM is switched on.

memory transmission

Default setting - 03(H)

Communication Switch 04 - Not used (do not change the settings)
Communication Switch 05 - Not used (do not change the settings)
Communication Switch 06 - Not used (do not change the settings)
Communication Switch 07 - Not used (do not change the settings)
Communication Switch 08 - Not used (do not change the settings)
Communication Switch 09 - Not used (do not change the settings)

D629

102

SM

Fax Option
Type 5002
(D629)

Bit Switches - 3

Communication Switch 0A (SP No. 1-104-011)
No

0

1-7

Function

Comments

Point of resumption of memory

0: The transmission begins from the page

transmission upon redialing

where transmission failed the previous time.

0: From the error page

1: Transmission begins from the first page,

1: From page 1

using normal memory transmission.

Not used

Do not change the settings.

Communication Switch 0B (SP No. 1-104-012)
No
0-3

Function
Not used

Printout of the message when
4

acting as a Transfer Station
0: Disabled, 1: Enabled

5-7

Not used

Comments
Do not change the settings.
When the machine is acting as a Transfer
Station, this bit determines whether the
machine prints the fax message coming in
from the Requesting Terminal.
Do not change the settings.

Communication Switch 0C - Not used (do not change the settings)

SM

103

D629

Bit Switches - 3

Communication Switch 0D (SP No. 1-104-014)
No

Function

Comments
00 to FF (Hex), unit = 4 kbytes
(e.g., 06(H) = 24 kbytes)
One page is about 24 kbytes.

0-7

The available memory

The machine refers to this setting before each fax

threshold, below which ringing

reception. If the amount of remaining memory is

detection (and therefore

below this threshold, the machine cannot receive

reception into memory) is

any fax messages.

disabled

If this setting is kept at 0, the machine will detect
ringing signals and go into receive mode even if
there is no memory available. This will result in
communication failure.

Communication Switch 0E (SP No. 1-104-015)
No

Function

Comments
06 to FF (Hex), unit = 2 s

0-7

Minimum interval between

(e.g., 06(H) = 12 s)

automatic dialing attempts

This value is the minimum time that the machine
waits before it dials the next destination.

Communication Switch 0F – Not used (do not change the settings.)

Communication Switch 10 (SP No. 1-104-017)
No

Function

Comments

Memory transmission:
0-7

Maximum number of dialing
attempts to the same

01 – FE (Hex) times

destination

D629

104

SM

Fax Option
Type 5002
(D629)

Bit Switches - 3

Communication Switch 11 – Not used (do not change the settings.)

Communication Switch 12 (SP No. 1-104-019)
No

Function

Comments

Memory transmission: Interval
0-7

between dialing attempts to the 01 – FF (Hex) minutes
same destination

Communication Switch 13 – Not used (do not change the settings.)

SM

105

D629

Bit Switches - 3

Communication Switch 14 (SP No. 1-104-021)
No

Function

Comments
0: In immediate transmission, data
scanned in inch format are transmitted
without conversion.
In memory transmission, data stored in
the SAF memory in mm format are

Inch-to-mm conversion during
0

transmission

transmitted without conversion.
Note: When storing the scanned data
into SAF memory, the fax unit always

0: Disabled, 1: Enabled

converts the data into mm format.
1: The machine converts the scanned
data or stored data in the SAF memory
to the format which was specified in the
set-up protocol (DIS/NSF) before
transmission.

1-5

Not used

Do not change the factory settings.

Available unit of resolution in which fax
messages are received
For the best performance, do not change

6-7

Bit 7

Bit 6

0

0

Unit
mm

the factory settings.
The setting determined by these bits is
informed to the transmitting terminal in

0

1

inch

the pre-message protocol exchange (in

1

0

mm and inch

the DIS/NSF frames).

1

1

Not used

Communication Switch 15 – Not used (do not change the settings)

D629

106

SM

Fax Option
Type 5002
(D629)

Bit Switches - 3

Communication Switch 16 (SP No. 1-104-023)
No
0

Function
Not used

Do not change the settings.

Optional G3 unit (G3-2)
1

0: Not installed
1: Installed

2

Comments

Change this bit to 1 when installing the first
optional G3 unit.

Not used
This switch enables the G3-2.

3

Select PSTN connection

0: Off, no connection

0: Off

1: Recognizes and enables G3-2.

1: On

This switch can be used only after G3-2 has been
installed.

4-7

Not used

Do not change the settings.

Communication Switch 17 (SP No. 1-104-024)
No

0

1

Function
SEP reception

0: Polling transmission to another maker's

0: Disabled

machine using the SEP (Selective Polling) signal

1: Enabled

is disabled.

SUB reception

0: Confidential reception to another maker's

0: Disabled

machine using the SUB (Sub-address) signal is

1: Enabled

disabled.

PWD reception
2

0: Disabled
1: Enabled

3-4

SM

Comments

Not used

0: Disables features that require PWD
(Password) signal reception.

Do not change the settings.

107

D629

Bit Switches - 3

PSTN dial-in routing setting
5

0: OFF

numbers in the PSTN dial-in line and transfers
received data from each PSTN dial-in number to

1: ON

6

1: The machine sets multiple PSTN dial-in

each address.

Not used

Do not change the settings.

Action when there is no box
with an F-code that matches
7

the received SUB code
0: Disconnect the line

Change this setting when the customer requires.

1: Receive the message
(using normal reception mode)

Communication Switch 18 (SP No. 1-104-025)
No
0-4

5

Function
Not used

Do not change the settings.

IP-Fax dial-in routing selection

1: Transfers received data to each IP-Fax dial-in

0: Off

number.

1: On

IP-Fax dial-in number is a 4-digit number.

PSTN 2 dial-in routing
6

0: Off
1: On
PSTN 3 dial-in routing

7

0: Off
1: On

D629

Comments

Enables or disables dial-in routing for the PSTN 2
connection.

Enables or disables dial-in routing for the PSTN 3
connection.

108

SM

Fax Option
Type 5002
(D629)

Bit Switches - 3

Communication Switch 19 - Not used (do not change the settings)
Communication Switch 1A - Not used (do not change the settings)

Communication Switch 1B (SP No. 1-104-028)
No

Function

Comments
If the PABX does not support V.8/V.34 protocol

Extension access code (0 to 7)
0-7

to turn V.8 protocol On/Off
0: On

procedure, set this bit to "1" to disable V.8.
Example: If "0" is the PSTN access code, set bit 0
to 1. When the machine detects "0" as the first
dialed number, it automatically disables V.8

1: Off

protocol. (Alternatively, if "3" is the PSTN access
code, set bit 3 to 1.)

Communication Switch 1C (SP No. 1-104-029)
No

Function

Comments
Refer to communication switch 1B.

0-1

Extension access code (8 and

Example: If "8" is the PSTN access code, set bit 0

9) to turn V.8 protocol On/Off

to 1. When the machine detects "8" as the first

0: On

dialed number, it automatically disables V.8

1: Off

protocol. (If "9" is the PSTN access code, use bit
1.)

2-7

Not used

Do not change the settings.

Communication Switch 1D - Not used (do not change the settings)
Communication Switch 1E - Not used (do not change the settings)
Communication Switch 1F - Not used (do not change the settings)

SM

109

D629

Bit Switches - 4

4.6 BIT SWITCHES - 4


Do not adjust a bit switch or use a setting that is described as "Not used", as this may
cause the machine to malfunction or to operate in a manner that is not accepted by local
regulations. Such bits are for use only in other areas, such as Japan.

Default settings for bit switches are not listed in this manual. Refer to the System Parameter List
printed by the machine.

4.6.1 G3 SWITCHES

G3 Switch 00 (SP No. 1-105-001)
No

Function

Comments

Monitor speaker during
communication (tx and rx)
(0, 0): The monitor speaker is disabled all

0
1

Bit 1

Bit 0

Setting

0

0

Disabled

0

1

Up to Phase B

1

0

All the time

1

1

Not used

Monitor speaker during memory
2

transmission
0: Disabled 1: Enabled

3-7

D629

Not used

through the communication.
(0, 1): The monitor speaker is on up to
phase B in the T.30 protocol.
(1, 0): Used for testing. The monitor
speaker is on all through the
communication. Make sure that you reset
these bits after testing.

1: The monitor speaker is enabled during
memory transmission.

Do not change the settings.

110

SM

Fax Option
Type 5002
(D629)

Bit Switches - 4

G3 Switch 01 (SP No. 1-105-002)
No
0-3

Function

Comments

Not used

Do not change the settings.
1: The bytes in the DIS frame after the 4th byte

4

DIS frame length

will not be transmitted (set to 1 if there are

0: 10 bytes 1: 4 bytes

communication problems with PC-based faxes
which cannot receive the extended DIS frames).

5

6

7

Not used

Do not change the setting.

Forbid CED/AMsam output

Do not change this setting (Default: 0: Off),

0: Off

unless communication problem is caused by a

1: On (Forbid output)

CED or ANSam transmission.

Not used

Do not change the setting.

G3 Switch 02 (SP No. 1-105-003)
No

Function

Comments
Change this bit to 1 only when the other end can

0

G3 protocol mode used

only communicate with machines that send

0: Standard and non-standard

T.30-standard frames only.

1: Standard only

1: Disables NSF/NSS signals (these are used in
non-standard mode communication)

1-6

7

SM

Not used

Do not change the settings.

Short preamble

Refer to Appendix B in the Group 3 Facsimile

0: Disabled 1: Enabled

Manual for details about Short Preamble.

111

D629

Bit Switches - 4

G3 Switch 03 (SP No. 1-105-004)
No

Function

DIS detection number
0

(Echo countermeasure)
0: 1
1: 2

1

Not Used

Comments
0: The machine will hang up if it receives the
same DIS frame twice.
1: Before sending DCS, the machine will wait for
the second DIS which is caused by echo on the
line.
Do not change the settings.
0: V.8/V.34 communications will not be possible.

V.8 protocol
2

0: Disabled



Do not set to 0 unless the line condition

1: Enabled

is always bad enough to slow down the
data rate to 14.4 kbps or lower.

ECM frame size
3

0: 256 bytes

Keep this bit at "0" in most cases.

1: 64 bytes
0: When using ECM in non-standard (NSF/NSS)
mode, the machine sends a CTC to drop back the
modem rate after receiving a PPR, if the following
condition is met in communications at 14.4, 12.0,
CTC transmission conditions

9.6, and 7.2 kbps.

0: After one PPR signal
4

received
1: After four PPR signals
received (ITU-T standard)

NTransmit- Number of transmitted frames
NResend- Number of frames to be retransmitted
1: When using ECM, the machine sends a CTC to
drop back the modem rate after receiving four
PPRs.
PPR, CTC: These are ECM protocol signals.
This bit is not effective in V.34 communications.

D629

112

SM

Bit Switches - 4

5

page after receiving a negative
code (RTN or PIN)

Not used

Do not change the settings
This switch is used to prevent reverse polarity in

Select detection of reverse
7

before sending the next page if a negative code is
received. This bit is ignored if ECM is being used.

0: No change 1: Fallback
6

1: The machine's tx modem rate will fall back

Fax Option
Type 5002
(D629)

Modem rate used for the next

ringing on the phone line (applied to PSTN-G3

polarity in ringing

ringing). Do not change this setting

0: Off

0: No detection

1: On

1: Detection (Japan and Korea only)

G3 Switch 04 (SP No. 1-105-005)
No

Function

Comments
0 - F (Hex); 0 - 15 bits

0-3

Training error detection

If the number of error bits in the received TCF is

threshold

below this threshold, the machine informs the
sender that training has succeeded.

4-7

Not used

Do not change the settings.

G3 Switch 05 (SP No. 1-105-006)
No

Function

Comments

Initial Tx modem rate (kbps)
Bit 3

Bit 2

Bit 1

Bit 0

These bits set the initial starting modem
kbps

rate for transmission.
Use the dedicated transmission

0-3

0

0

0

1

2.4

0

0

1

0

4.8

0

0

1

1

7.2

0

1

0

0

9.6

0

1

0

1

12.0

parameters if you need to change this for
specific receivers.
If a modem rate 14.4 kbps or slower is
selected, V.8 protocol should be disabled
manually.

SM

Cross reference
V.8 protocol on/off - G3 switch 03, bit 2

113

D629

Bit Switches - 4

0

1

1

0

14.4

0

1

1

1

16.8

1

0

0

0

19.2

1

0

0

1

21.6

1

0

1

0

24.0

1

0

1

1

26.4

1

1

0

0

28.8

1

1

0

1

31.2

0

0

1

1

33.6

Other settings - Not used
Initial modem type for 9.6 k or 7.2 kbps.
Bit 5

Bit 4

Setting

0

0

V.29

0

1

V.17

1

0

V.34

1

1

Not used

4-5

6-7

D629

These bits set the initial modem type for
9.6 and 7.2 kbps, if the initial modem rate

Not used

is set at these speeds.

Do not change the settings.

114

SM

Fax Option
Type 5002
(D629)

Bit Switches - 4

G3 Switch 06 (SP No. 1-105-007)
No

Function

Comments

Initial Rx modem rate(kbps)
Bit 3

Bit 2

Bit 1

Bit 0

kbps

0

0

0

1

2.4

0

0

1

0

4.8

0

0

1

1

7.2

0

1

0

0

9.6

0

1

0

1

12.0

0

1

1

0

14.4

0

1

1

1

16.8

selected, V.8 protocol should be

1

0

0

0

19.2

disabled manually.

These bits set the initial starting modem
rate for reception.

0-3

Use a lower setting if high speeds pose
problems during reception.
If a modem rate 14.4 kbps or slower is

Cross reference
1

0

0

1

21.6

1

0

1

0

24.0

1

0

1

1

26.4

1

1

0

0

28.8

1

1

0

1

31.2

V.8 protocol on/off - G3 switch 03, bit2

Other settings - Not used

SM

115

D629

Bit Switches - 4

Modem types available for reception
The setting of these bits is used to inform the transmitting terminal of the available
modem type for the machine in receive mode.
If V.34 is not selected, V.8 protocol must be disabled manually.
Cross reference
V.8 protocol on/off - G3 switch 03, bit 2

4-7

Bit 7

Bit 6

Bit 5

Bit 4

Types

0

0

0

1

V.27ter

0

0

1

0

V.27ter, V.29

0

0

1

1

V.27ter, V.29, V.33

0

1

0

0

V.27ter, V.29, V.17/V.33

0

1

0

1

V.27ter, V.29, V.17/V33, V.34

Other settings - Not used

G3 Switch 07 (SP No. 1-105-008)
No

Function

Comments

PSTN cable equalizer

Use a higher setting if there is signal loss

(tx mode: Internal)

at higher frequencies because of the

Bit 1

Bit 0

Setting

0

0

None

0

1

Low

1

0

Medium

1

1

High

length of wire between the modem and
the telephone exchange.
Use the dedicated transmission
parameters for specific receivers.

0-1

Also, try using the cable equalizer if one
or more of the following symptoms
occurs.
Communication error
Modem rate fallback occurs frequently.


This setting is not effective in
V.34 communications.

D629

116

SM

PSTN cable equalizer

Use a higher setting if there is signal loss

(rx mode: Internal)

at higher frequencies because of the

Bit 3

Bit 2

Setting

0

0

None

0

1

Low

1

0

Medium

1

1

High

Fax Option
Type 5002
(D629)

Bit Switches - 4

length of wire between the modem and
the telephone exchange.
Also, try using the cable equalizer if one
or more of the following symptoms

2-3

occurs.
Communication error with error codes
such as 0-20, 0-23, etc.
Modem rate fallback occurs frequently.


This setting is not effective in
V.34 communications.

PSTN cable equalizer
4

(V.8/V.17 rx mode: External)
0: Disabled

Keep this bit at "1".

1: Enabled
5

Not used

Do not change the settings.
0: This uses the fixed table in the ROM

Parameter selection for dial tone
6

detection
0: Normal parameter
1: Specific parameter

for dial tone detection.
1: This uses the specific parameter
adjusted with SRAM (69ECBEH 69ECDEH). Select this if the dial tone
cannot be detected when the "Normal
parameter: 0" is selected.

7

SM

Not used

Do not change the settings.

117

D629

Bit Switches - 4

G3 Switch 08 - Not used (do not change the settings)

G3 Switch 09 - Not used (do not change the settings)

G3 Switch 0A (SP No. 1-105-011)
No

Function

Comments

Maximum allowable carrier drop
during image data reception

0-1

2

3

Bit 1

Bit 0

Value (ms)

0

0

200

These bits set the acceptable modem
carrier drop time.
Try a longer setting if error code 0-22 is

0

1

400

1

0

800

1

1

Not used

frequent.

Select cancellation of high-speed RX

This switch setting determines if

if carrier signal lost while receiving

high-speed receiving ends if the carrier

0: Off

signal is lost when receiving during

1: On

non-ECM mode

Not used

Do not change the settings
This bit set the maximum interval

Maximum allowable frame interval
4

during image data reception.
0: 5 s 1: 13 s

between EOL (end-of-line) signals and
the maximum interval between ECM
frames from the other end.
Try using a longer setting if error code
0-21 is frequent.

5

D629

Not used

Do not change the settings.

118

SM

Bit Switches - 4

Fax Option
Type 5002
(D629)

When the sending terminal is controlled
by a computer, there may be a delay in
receiving page data after the local
machine accepts set-up data and sends
Reconstruction time for the first line in CFR. This is outside the T.30
6

receive mode

recommendation. But, if this delay

0: 6 s 1: 12 s

occurs, set this bit to 1 to give the
sending machine more time to send data.
Refer to error code 0-20.
ITU-T T.30 recommendation: The first line
should come within 5 s of CFR.

7

Not used

Do not change the settings.

G3 Switch 0B Not used (do not change the settings).
G3 Switch 0C Not used (do not change the settings).
G3 Switch 0D Not used (do not change the settings).

G3 Switch 0E (SP No. 1-105-015)
No

Function

Comments

Set CNG send time interval
Some machines on the receiving side may not be able to automatically switch the
3-second CNG interval.
3000-2250ms: 3000-50xNms
0-7

High order bit

3000 – 50 x Nms 0F (3000 ms) <= N <= FF (2250
ms)
00-0E(3000-3700ms: 3000+50xNms

Low order bit

3000 – 50 x Nms 0F (3000 ms) <= N <= 0F (3700
ms)

SM

119

D629

Bit Switches - 4

G3 Switch 0F (SP No. 1-105-016)
No

Function

Comments

Alarm when an error occurred
0

in Phase C or later

If the customer wants to hear an alarm after each

0: Disabled

error communication, change this bit to "1".

1: Enabled
Alarm when the handset is
1

off-hook at the end of

If the customer wants to hear an alarm if the

communication

handset is off-hook at the end of fax

0: Disabled

communication, change this bit to "1".

1: Enabled
2-3

Not used
Sidaa manual calibration

4

setting
0: Off
1: On

5-7

D629

Not used

Do not change the settings.

1: manually calibrates for communication with a
line whose current change occurs such as an
optical fiber line.

Do not change the settings.

120

SM

4.7 BIT SWITCHES - 5


Do not adjust a bit switch or use a setting that is described as "Not used", as this may
cause the machine to malfunction or to operate in a manner that is not accepted by local
regulations. Such bits are for use only in other areas, such as Japan.

Default settings for bit switches are not listed in this manual. Refer to the System Parameter List
printed by the machine.

4.7.1 G3-2 AND G3-3 SWITCHES
These switches require an optional G3 interface unit.
G3-3 switches are the same as for G3-2 switches.

G3-2 Switch 00 (SP No. 1-106-001)
No

Function

Comments

Monitor speaker during
communication (tx and rx)
(0, 0): The monitor speaker is disabled all

0
1

Bit 1

Bit 0

Setting

0

0

Disable

0

1

Up to Phase B

1

0

All the time

1

1

Not used

Monitor speaker during memory
2

transmission
0: Disabled 1: Enabled

3-7

SM

Not used

through the communication.
(0, 1): The monitor speaker is on up to
phase B in the T.30 protocol.
(1, 0): Used for testing. The monitor
speaker is on all through the
communication. Make sure that you reset
these bits after testing.

1: The monitor speaker is enabled during
memory transmission.

Do not change the settings.

121

D629

Fax Option
Type 5002
(D629)

Bit Switches - 5

Bit Switches - 5

G3-2 Switch 01 (SP No. 1-106-002)
No
0-3

Function
Not used

Comments
Do not change the settings.
1: The bytes in the DIS frame after the 4th byte

4

DIS frame length

will not be transmitted (set to 1 if there are

0: 10 bytes 1: 4 bytes

communication problems with PC-based faxes
which cannot receive the extended DIS frames).

5

6

7

Not used

Do not change the setting.

Forbid CED/AMsam output

Do not change this setting (Default: 0: Off),

0: Off

unless communication problem is caused by a

1: On (Forbid output)

CED or ANSam transmission.

Not used

Do not change the setting.

G3-2 Switch 02 (SP No. 1-106-003)
No

Function

Comments
Change this bit to 1 only when the other end can

0

G3 protocol mode used

only communicate with machines that send

0: Standard and non-standard

T.30-standard frames only.

1: Standard only

1: Disables NSF/NSS signals (these are used in
non-standard mode communication)

1-6

7

D629

Not used

Do not change the settings.

Short preamble

Refer to Appendix B in the Group 3 Facsimile

0: Disabled 1: Enabled

Manual for details about Short Preamble.

122

SM

Fax Option
Type 5002
(D629)

Bit Switches - 5

G3-2 Switch 03 (SP No. 1-106-004)
No

Function

DIS detection number
0

(Echo countermeasure)
0: 1
1: 2

1

Not Used

Comments
0: The machine will hang up if it receives the
same DIS frame twice.
1: Before sending DCS, the machine will wait for
the second DIS which is caused by echo on the
line.
Do not change the settings.
0: V.8/V.34 communications will not be possible.

V.8 protocol
2

0: Disabled



Do not set to 0 unless the line condition

1: Enabled

is always bad enough to slow down the
data rate to 14.4 kbps or lower.

ECM frame size
3

0: 256 bytes

Keep this bit at "0" in most cases.

1: 64 bytes
0: When using ECM in non-standard (NSF/NSS)
mode, the machine sends a CTC to drop back the
modem rate after receiving a PPR, if the following
condition is met in communications at 14.4, 12.0,
CTC transmission conditions

9.6, and 7.2 kbps.

0: After one PPR signal
4

received
1: After four PPR signals
received (ITU-T standard)

Ntransmit = Number of transmitted frames
Nresend = Number of frames to be retransmitted
1: When using ECM, the machine sends a CTC to
drop back the modem rate after receiving four
PPRs.
PPR, CTC: These are ECM protocol signals.
This bit is not effective in V.34 communications.

SM

123

D629

Bit Switches - 5

Modem rate used for the next
5

page after receiving a negative
code (RTN or PIN)

Not used

Do not change the settings
This switch is used to prevent reverse polarity in

Select detection of reverse
7

before sending the next page if a negative code is
received. This bit is ignored if ECM is being used.

0: No change 1: Fallback
6

1: The machine's tx modem rate will fall back

ringing on the phone line (applied to PSTN-G3

polarity in ringing

ringing). Do not change this setting

0: Off

0: No detection

1: On

1: Detection (Japan and Korea only)

G3-2 Switch 04 (SP No. 1-106-005)
No

Function

Comments
0 - F (Hex); 0 - 15 bits

0-3

Training error detection

If the number of error bits in the received TCF is

threshold

below this threshold, the machine informs the
sender that training has succeeded.

4-7

Not used

Do not change the settings.

G3-2 Switch 05 (SP No. 1-106-006)
No

Function

Comments

Initial Tx modem rate (kbps)
Bit 3

Bit 2

Bit 1

Bit 0

These bits set the initial starting modem
kbps

rate for transmission.
Use the dedicated transmission

0-3

0

0

0

1

2.4

0

0

1

0

4.8

0

0

1

1

7.2

0

1

0

0

9.6

0

1

0

1

12.0

parameters if you need to change this for
specific receivers.
If a modem rate 14.4 kbps or slower is
selected, V.8 protocol should be disabled
manually.

D629

Cross reference
V.8 protocol on/off - G3 switch 03, bit 2

124

SM

0

1

1

0

14.4

0

1

1

1

16.8

1

0

0

0

19.2

1

0

0

1

21.6

1

0

1

0

24.0

1

0

1

1

26.4

1

1

0

0

28.8

1

1

0

1

31.2

Fax Option
Type 5002
(D629)

Bit Switches - 5

Other settings - Not used
Initial modem type for 9.6 k or 7.2 kbps.
Bit 5

Bit 4

Setting

0

0

V.29

0

1

V.17

1

0

V.34

1

1

Not used

4-5

6-7

SM

These bits set the initial modem type for
9.6 and 7.2 kbps, if the initial modem rate

Not used

is set at these speeds.

Do not change the settings.

125

D629

Bit Switches - 5

G3-2 Switch 06 (SP No. 1-106-007)
No

Function

Comments

Initial Rx modem rate(kbps)
Bit 3

Bit 2

Bit 1

Bit 0

kbps

0

0

0

1

2.4

0

0

1

0

4.8

0

0

1

1

7.2

0

1

0

0

9.6

0

1

0

1

12.0

0

1

1

0

14.4

0

1

1

1

16.8

selected, V.8 protocol should be

1

0

0

0

19.2

disabled manually.

These bits set the initial starting modem
rate for reception.

0-3

Use a lower setting if high speeds pose
problems during reception.
If a modem rate 14.4 kbps or slower is

Cross reference
1

0

0

1

21.6

1

0

1

0

24.0

1

0

1

1

26.4

1

1

0

0

28.8

1

1

0

1

31.2

V.8 protocol on/off - G3 switch 03, bit2

Other settings - Not used
Modem types available for reception
The setting of these bits is used to inform the transmitting terminal of the available
modem type for the machine in receive mode.
If V.34 is not selected, V.8 protocol must be disabled manually.
4-7

Cross reference
V.8 protocol on/off - G3 switch 03, bit 2

D629

Bit 7

Bit 6

Bit 5

Bit 4

Types

0

0

0

1

V.27ter

126

SM

0

0

1

0

V.27ter

0

0

1

1

V.27ter

0

1

0

0

V.27ter

0

1

0

1

V.27ter

Fax Option
Type 5002
(D629)

Bit Switches - 5

Other settings - Not used

SM

127

D629

Bit Switches - 5

G3-2 Switch 07 (SP No. 1-106-008)
No

Function

Comments

PSTN cable equalizer

Use a higher setting if there is signal loss

(tx mode: Internal)

at higher frequencies because of the

Bit 1

Bit 0

Setting

0

0

None

0

1

Low

1

0

Medium

1

1

High

length of wire between the modem and
the telephone exchange.
Use the dedicated transmission
parameters for specific receivers.

0-1

Also, try using the cable equalizer if one
or more of the following symptoms
occurs.
Communication error
Modem rate fallback occurs frequently.


This setting is not effective in
V.34 communications.

PSTN cable equalizer

Use a higher setting if there is signal loss

(rx mode: Internal)

at higher frequencies because of the

Bit 3

Bit 2

Setting

0

0

None

0

1

Low

1

0

Medium

1

1

High

length of wire between the modem and
the telephone exchange.
Also, try using the cable equalizer if one
or more of the following symptoms

2-3

occurs.
Communication error with error codes
such as 0-20, 0-23, etc.
Modem rate fallback occurs frequently.


This setting is not effective in
V.34 communications.

PSTN cable equalizer
4

(V.8/V.17 rx mode: External)
0: Disabled

Keep this bit at "1".

1: Enabled

D629

128

SM

Bit Switches - 5

Not used

Do not change the settings.
Fax Option
Type 5002
(D629)

5-7

G3-2 Switch 08 - Not used (do not change the settings)
G3-2 Switch 09 - Not used (do not change the settings)

G3-2 Switch 0A (SP No. 1-106-011)
No

Function

Comments

Maximum allowable carrier drop
during image data reception

0-1

2

3

Bit 1

Bit 0

Value (ms)

0

0

200

0

1

400

1

0

800

1

1

Not used

These bits set the acceptable modem
carrier drop time.
Try a longer setting if error code 0-22 is
frequent.

Select cancellation of high-speed RX

This switch setting determines if

if carrier signal lost while receiving

high-speed receiving ends if the carrier

0: Off

signal is lost when receiving during

1: On

non-ECM mode

Not used

Do not change the settings
This bit set the maximum interval

Maximum allowable frame interval
4

during image data reception.
0: 5 s 1: 13 s

between EOL (end-of-line) signals and
the maximum interval between ECM
frames from the other end.
Try using a longer setting if error code
0-21 is frequent.

5

SM

Not used

Do not change the settings.

129

D629

Bit Switches - 5

When the sending terminal is controlled
by a computer, there may be a delay in
receiving page data after the local
machine accepts set-up data and sends
Reconstruction time for the first line in CFR. This is outside the T.30
6

receive mode

recommendation. But, if this delay

0: 6 s 1: 12 s

occurs, set this bit to 1 to give the
sending machine more time to send data.
Refer to error code 0-20.
ITU-T T.30 recommendation: The first line
should come within 5 s of CFR.

7

Not used

Do not change the settings.

G3-2 Switch 0B- Not used (do not change the settings)
G3-2 Switch 0C- Not used (do not change the settings)

4.7.2 G4 INTERNAL SWITCHES
The G4 internal switches (SW00 to 1F) are displayed but do not change these settings.

4.7.3 G4 PARAMETER SWITCHES
The G4 parameter switches (SW00 to 0F) are displayed but do not change these settings.

D629

130

SM

4.8 BIT SWITCHES - 6


Do not adjust a bit switch or use a setting that is described as "Not used", as this may
cause the machine to malfunction or to operate in a manner that is not accepted by local
regulations. Such bits are for use only in other areas, such as Japan.

Default settings for bit switches are not listed in this manual. Refer to the System Parameter List
printed by the machine.

4.8.1 IP FAX SWITCHES

IP Fax Switch 00 (SP No. 1-111-001)
No.
0

1

2

Function
Not used
IP Fax Transport
0: TCP, 1: UDP
IP Fax single port selection
0: OFF, 1: ON (enable)

Comments
Do not change this setting.

Selects TCP or UDP protocol for IP-Fax

Selects single data port.

IP Fax double ports (single data
3

port) selection

Selects whether IP-Fax uses a double port.

0: OFF, 1: ON (enable)

4

5

IP Fax Gatekeeper
0: OFF, 1: ON (enable)
IP Fax T30 bit signal reverse
0: LSB first, 1: MSB first

Enables/disables the gatekeeper for IP-Fax.

Reverses the T30 bit signal.

When "0" is selected, the max bit rate does
6

IP Fax max bit rate setting

not affect the value of the DIS/DCS.

0: Not affected, 1: Affected

When "1" is selected, the max bit rate
affects the value of the DIS/DCS.

SM

131

D629

Fax Option
Type 5002
(D629)

Bit Switches - 6

Bit Switches - 6

When "0" is selected, fax data is received
without checking the telephone number.
IP Fax received telephone number
7

confirmation
0: No confirmation, 1: Confirmation

When "1" is selected, fax data is received
only when confirming t